0
登录后你可以
  • 下载海量资料
  • 学习在线课程
  • 观看技术视频
  • 写文章/发帖/加入社区
创作中心
发布
  • 发文章

  • 发资料

  • 发帖

  • 提问

  • 发视频

创作活动
ATSAMD20J15A-ANT

ATSAMD20J15A-ANT

  • 厂商:

    ACTEL(微芯科技)

  • 封装:

    TQFP64

  • 描述:

    IC MCU 32BIT 32KB FLASH 64TQFP

  • 数据手册
  • 价格&库存
ATSAMD20J15A-ANT 数据手册
SAM D20 Family Low-Power, 32-bit Cortex-M0+ MCUs with 12-bit ADC, 10bit DAC, 256-Channel PTC, RTC, and SERCOM Features Operating Conditions • 1.62V – 3.63V, -40°C to +85°C, DC up to 48 MHz • 1.62V – 3.63V, -40°C to +105°C, DC up to 32 MHz • 2.7V – 3.63V, -40°C to +125°C Extended Temperature with compliance to AEC-Q100, DC up to 32MHz Core ® ® • Arm Cortex -M0+ CPU running at up to 48 MHz – Single-cycle hardware multiplier Memories • 16/32/64/128/256 KB in-system self-programmable Flash • 2/4/8/16/32 KB SRAM System • Power-on Reset (POR) and Brown-out Detection (BOD) • Internal and external clock options with 48 MHz Digital Frequency Locked Loop (DFLL48M) • External Interrupt Controller (EIC) • Up to 16 external interrupts • One non-maskable interrupt • Two-pin Serial Wire Debug (SWD) programming, test and debugging interface Low-Power • Idle and Stand-by Sleep modes • SleepWalking peripherals Peripherals • 8-channel Event System • Up to eight 16-bit Timer/Counters (TC), configurable as: – One 16-bit TC with two compare/capture channels – One 8-bit TC with two compare/capture channels – One 32-bit TC with two compare/capture channels, by using two TCs • 32-bit Real Time Counter (RTC) with clock/calendar function • Watchdog Timer (WDT) • CRC-32 generator • Up to six Serial Communication Interfaces (SERCOM), each configurable to operate as either: – USART with full-duplex and single-wire half-duplex configuration – Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) up to 400 kHz – Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) • One 12-bit, 350 ksps Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) with up to 20 channels – Differential and single-ended input – 1/2x to 16x programmable gain stage © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 1 SAM D20 Family • • • – Automatic offset and gain error compensation – Oversampling and decimation in hardware to support 13-bit, 14-bit, 15-bit, or 16-bit resolution 10-bit, 350 ksps Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) Two Analog Comparators (AC) with Window Compare function Peripheral Touch Controller (PTC) – Up to 256-channel capacitive touch and proximity sensing I/O • Up to 52 programmable I/O pins Packages • 64-pin TQFP, VQFN • 64-ball UFBGA (not available in grades Extended Temperature and AEC-QA100) • 48-pin TQFP, VQFN • 45-ball WLCSP (not available in grades Extended Temperature and AEC-QA100) • 32-pin TQFP, VQFN • 27-ball WLCSP (not available in grades Extended Temperature and AEC-QA100) Power Consumption • Power Consumption – Down to 50 µA/MHz in Active mode – Down to 8 µA running the PTC © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 2 SAM D20 Family Table of Contents Features......................................................................................................................................................... 1 1. Configuration Summary.........................................................................................................................11 2. Ordering Information (1)......................................................................................................................... 13 3. Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................................14 4. Pinout.................................................................................................................................................... 15 4.1. 4.2. 4.3. SAM D20J.................................................................................................................................. 15 SAM D20G................................................................................................................................. 17 SAM D20E..................................................................................................................................19 5. Signal Descriptions List.........................................................................................................................21 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations..................................................................................................... 23 6.1. 6.2. 7. Multiplexed Signals.................................................................................................................... 23 Other Functions..........................................................................................................................25 Power Supply and Start-Up Considerations..........................................................................................27 7.1. 7.2. 7.3. 7.4. Power Domain Overview............................................................................................................27 Power Supply Considerations.................................................................................................... 27 Power-Up................................................................................................................................... 29 Power-On Reset and Brown-Out Detector................................................................................. 29 8. Product Mapping................................................................................................................................... 31 9. Memories.............................................................................................................................................. 32 9.1. 9.2. 9.3. 9.4. 9.5. 9.6. Embedded Memories................................................................................................................. 32 Physical Memory Map................................................................................................................ 32 NVM Calibration and Auxiliary Space........................................................................................ 33 NVM User Row Mapping............................................................................................................33 NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping...................................................................................34 Serial Number............................................................................................................................ 35 10. Processor And Architecture.................................................................................................................. 36 10.1. 10.2. 10.3. 10.4. 10.5. 10.6. Cortex M0+ Processor............................................................................................................... 36 Nested Vector Interrupt Controller..............................................................................................37 High-Speed Bus System............................................................................................................ 38 AHB-APB Bridge........................................................................................................................ 40 PAC - Peripheral Access Controller........................................................................................... 41 Register Description................................................................................................................... 41 11. Peripherals Configuration Summary..................................................................................................... 52 12. DSU - Device Service Unit.................................................................................................................... 54 12.1. Overview.................................................................................................................................... 54 12.2. Features..................................................................................................................................... 54 12.3. Block Diagram............................................................................................................................ 54 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 3 SAM D20 Family 12.4. Signal Description...................................................................................................................... 55 12.5. Product Dependencies............................................................................................................... 55 12.6. Debug Operation........................................................................................................................ 56 12.7. Chip Erase..................................................................................................................................57 12.8. Programming..............................................................................................................................58 12.9. Intellectual Property Protection.................................................................................................. 58 12.10. Device Identification.................................................................................................................. 59 12.11. Functional Description...............................................................................................................60 12.12. Register Summary.................................................................................................................... 65 12.13. Register Description..................................................................................................................66 13. Clock System........................................................................................................................................ 89 13.1. 13.2. 13.3. 13.4. 13.5. 13.6. 13.7. 13.8. Clock Distribution....................................................................................................................... 89 Synchronous and Asynchronous Clocks....................................................................................90 Register Synchronization........................................................................................................... 90 Enabling a Peripheral................................................................................................................. 94 Disabling a Peripheral................................................................................................................ 94 On-demand, Clock Requests..................................................................................................... 95 Power Consumption vs. Speed.................................................................................................. 95 Clocks after Reset...................................................................................................................... 95 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller.......................................................................................................... 97 14.1. 14.2. 14.3. 14.4. 14.5. 14.6. 14.7. 14.8. Overview.................................................................................................................................... 97 Features..................................................................................................................................... 97 Block Diagram............................................................................................................................ 97 Signal Description...................................................................................................................... 98 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................... 98 Functional Description................................................................................................................99 Register Summary....................................................................................................................104 Register Description................................................................................................................. 104 15. Power Manager (PM).......................................................................................................................... 115 15.1. 15.2. 15.3. 15.4. 15.5. 15.6. 15.7. 15.8. Overview...................................................................................................................................115 Features................................................................................................................................... 115 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 116 Signal Description.....................................................................................................................116 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 116 Functional Description.............................................................................................................. 118 Register Summary....................................................................................................................125 Register Description................................................................................................................. 125 16. SYSCTRL – System Controller........................................................................................................... 143 16.1. 16.2. 16.3. 16.4. 16.5. 16.6. 16.7. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 143 Features................................................................................................................................... 143 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 144 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 145 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 145 Functional Description..............................................................................................................146 Register Summary....................................................................................................................156 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 4 SAM D20 Family 16.8. Register Description................................................................................................................. 157 17. WDT – Watchdog Timer...................................................................................................................... 186 17.1. 17.2. 17.3. 17.4. 17.5. 17.6. 17.7. 17.8. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 186 Features................................................................................................................................... 186 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 186 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 187 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 187 Functional Description..............................................................................................................188 Register Summary....................................................................................................................192 Register Description................................................................................................................. 192 18. RTC – Real-Time Counter...................................................................................................................201 18.1. 18.2. 18.3. 18.4. 18.5. 18.6. 18.7. 18.8. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 201 Features................................................................................................................................... 201 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 201 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 202 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 202 Functional Description..............................................................................................................204 Register Summary....................................................................................................................208 Register Description................................................................................................................. 210 19. EIC – External Interrupt Controller...................................................................................................... 242 19.1. 19.2. 19.3. 19.4. 19.5. 19.6. 19.7. 19.8. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 242 Features................................................................................................................................... 242 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 242 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 242 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 243 Functional Description..............................................................................................................244 Register Summary....................................................................................................................248 Register Description................................................................................................................. 248 20. NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller...................................................................................... 259 20.1. 20.2. 20.3. 20.4. 20.5. 20.6. 20.7. 20.8. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 259 Features................................................................................................................................... 259 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 259 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 259 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 260 Functional Description..............................................................................................................261 Register Summary....................................................................................................................267 Register Description................................................................................................................. 267 21. PORT - I/O Pin Controller....................................................................................................................280 21.1. 21.2. 21.3. 21.4. 21.5. 21.6. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 280 Features................................................................................................................................... 280 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 281 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 281 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 281 Functional Description..............................................................................................................283 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 5 SAM D20 Family 21.7. Register Summary....................................................................................................................288 21.8. PORT Pin Groups and Register Repetition..............................................................................289 21.9. Register Description................................................................................................................. 289 22. Event System (EVSYS).......................................................................................................................305 22.1. 22.2. 22.3. 22.4. 22.5. 22.6. 22.7. 22.8. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 305 Features................................................................................................................................... 305 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 305 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 306 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 306 Functional Description..............................................................................................................307 Register Summary....................................................................................................................312 Register Description................................................................................................................. 312 23. SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface...................................................................................... 322 23.1. 23.2. 23.3. 23.4. 23.5. 23.6. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 322 Features................................................................................................................................... 322 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 322 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 323 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 323 Functional Description..............................................................................................................324 24. SERCOM USART............................................................................................................................... 330 24.1. 24.2. 24.3. 24.4. 24.5. 24.6. 24.7. 24.8. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 330 USART Features...................................................................................................................... 330 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 331 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 331 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 331 Functional Description..............................................................................................................333 Register Summary....................................................................................................................340 Register Description................................................................................................................. 340 25. SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface....................................................................... 353 25.1. 25.2. 25.3. 25.4. 25.5. 25.6. 25.7. 25.8. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 353 Features................................................................................................................................... 353 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 353 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 354 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 354 Functional Description..............................................................................................................355 Register Summary....................................................................................................................363 Register Description................................................................................................................. 363 26. SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit...............................................................................................377 26.1. 26.2. 26.3. 26.4. 26.5. 26.6. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 377 Features................................................................................................................................... 377 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 377 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 378 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 378 Functional Description..............................................................................................................379 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 6 SAM D20 Family 26.7. Register Summary - I2C Client.................................................................................................390 26.8. Register Description - I2C Client.............................................................................................. 390 26.9. Register Summary - I2C Host.................................................................................................. 402 26.10. Register Description - I2C Host............................................................................................... 402 27. TC – Timer/Counter.............................................................................................................................416 27.1. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 416 27.2. Features................................................................................................................................... 416 27.3. Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 417 27.4. Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 417 27.5. Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 418 27.6. Functional Description..............................................................................................................419 27.7. Register Summary for 8-bit Registers...................................................................................... 429 27.8. Register Description for 8-bit Registers....................................................................................429 27.9. Register Summary for 16-bit Registers.................................................................................... 445 27.10. Register Description for 16-bit Registers................................................................................ 445 27.11. Register Summary for 32-bit Registers................................................................................... 460 27.12. Register Description for 32-bit Registers................................................................................ 460 28. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)......................................................................................................475 28.1. 28.2. 28.3. 28.4. 28.5. 28.6. 28.7. 28.8. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 475 Features................................................................................................................................... 475 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 476 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 476 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 476 Functional Description..............................................................................................................478 Register Summary....................................................................................................................486 Register Description................................................................................................................. 486 29. AC – Analog Comparators.................................................................................................................. 510 29.1. 29.2. 29.3. 29.4. 29.5. 29.6. 29.7. 29.8. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 510 Features................................................................................................................................... 510 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 511 Signal Description.....................................................................................................................511 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 511 Functional Description..............................................................................................................513 Register Summary....................................................................................................................521 Register Description................................................................................................................. 521 30. DAC – Digital-to-Analog Converter..................................................................................................... 536 30.1. 30.2. 30.3. 30.4. 30.5. 30.6. 30.7. 30.8. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 536 Features................................................................................................................................... 536 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 536 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 536 Product Dependencies............................................................................................................. 536 Functional Description..............................................................................................................538 Register Summary....................................................................................................................541 Register Description................................................................................................................. 541 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 7 SAM D20 Family 31. PTC - Peripheral Touch Controller...................................................................................................... 551 31.1. 31.2. 31.3. 31.4. 31.5. 31.6. Overview.................................................................................................................................. 551 Features................................................................................................................................... 551 Block Diagram.......................................................................................................................... 552 Signal Description.................................................................................................................... 553 System Dependencies............................................................................................................. 553 Functional Description..............................................................................................................554 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C........................................................................................................555 32.1. Disclaimer.................................................................................................................................555 32.2. Absolute Maximum Ratings......................................................................................................555 32.3. General Operating Ratings.......................................................................................................556 32.4. Supply Characteristics..............................................................................................................556 32.5. Maximum Clock Frequencies................................................................................................... 557 32.6. Power Consumption................................................................................................................. 558 32.7. Peripheral Power Consumption................................................................................................562 32.8. I/O Pin Characteristics..............................................................................................................563 32.9. Injection Current....................................................................................................................... 565 32.10. Analog Characteristics............................................................................................................ 566 32.11. NVM Characteristics................................................................................................................578 32.12. Oscillators Characteristics.......................................................................................................579 32.13. PTC Typical Characteristics.................................................................................................... 584 32.14. Timing Characteristics.............................................................................................................587 33. Electrical Characteristics at 105°C......................................................................................................591 33.1. 33.2. 33.3. 33.4. 33.5. 33.6. 33.7. 33.8. 33.9. Disclaimer.................................................................................................................................591 Absolute Maximum Ratings......................................................................................................591 General Operating Ratings.......................................................................................................591 Maximum Clock Frequencies................................................................................................... 592 Power Consumption................................................................................................................. 593 Injection Current....................................................................................................................... 596 Analog Characteristics............................................................................................................. 597 NVM Characteristics.................................................................................................................606 Oscillators Characteristics........................................................................................................607 34. AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ ...................................................................................612 34.1. Disclaimer.................................................................................................................................612 34.2. Absolute Maximum Ratings......................................................................................................612 34.3. General Operating Ratings.......................................................................................................614 34.4. Supply Characteristics..............................................................................................................614 34.5. Maximum Clock Frequencies................................................................................................... 615 34.6. Power Consumption................................................................................................................. 616 34.7. Peripheral Power Consumption................................................................................................619 34.8. I/O Pin Characteristics..............................................................................................................620 34.9. Injection Current....................................................................................................................... 621 34.10. Analog Characteristics............................................................................................................ 622 34.11. NVM Characteristics................................................................................................................630 34.12. Oscillators Characteristics.......................................................................................................631 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 8 SAM D20 Family 34.13. PTC Characteristics................................................................................................................ 636 34.14. Timing Characteristics.............................................................................................................638 35. Packaging Information........................................................................................................................ 642 35.1. Thermal Considerations........................................................................................................... 642 35.2. Package Drawings................................................................................................................... 643 35.3. Soldering Profile....................................................................................................................... 691 36. Schematic Checklist............................................................................................................................692 36.1. 36.2. 36.3. 36.4. 36.5. 36.6. 36.7. Introduction...............................................................................................................................692 Power Supply........................................................................................................................... 692 External Analog Reference Connections................................................................................. 694 External Reset Circuit...............................................................................................................695 Clocks and Crystal Oscillators..................................................................................................696 Unused or Unconnected Pins...................................................................................................698 Programming and Debug Ports................................................................................................698 37. Datasheet Revision History.................................................................................................................702 37.1. Revision F - 03/2022................................................................................................................ 702 37.2. Revision E - 11/2020................................................................................................................ 702 37.3. Revision D - 03/2020................................................................................................................703 37.4. Revision C - 11/2019................................................................................................................ 704 37.5. Rev. B - 11/2017.......................................................................................................................705 37.6. Rev. A - 08/2017.......................................................................................................................705 37.7. Rev. P - 09/2016.......................................................................................................................705 37.8. Rev. O - 08/2016...................................................................................................................... 706 37.9. Rev. N - 01/2015...................................................................................................................... 707 37.10. Rev. M - 12/2014.....................................................................................................................707 37.11. Rev. L - 09/2014...................................................................................................................... 708 37.12. Rev. K – 05/2014.....................................................................................................................710 37.13. Rev. J – 12/2013..................................................................................................................... 711 37.14. Rev. I 12/2013........................................................................................................................ 712 37.15. Rev. H 10/2013...................................................................................................................... 718 37.16. Rev. G - 10/2013..................................................................................................................... 719 37.17. Rev. F - 10/2013......................................................................................................................720 37.18. Rev. E - 09/2013..................................................................................................................... 720 37.19. Rev. D - 08/2013..................................................................................................................... 721 37.20. Rev. C – 07/2013.................................................................................................................... 721 37.21. Rev. B – 07/2013.....................................................................................................................722 37.22. Rev. A - 06/2013..................................................................................................................... 723 38. Conventions........................................................................................................................................ 724 38.1. 38.2. 38.3. 38.4. Numerical Notation...................................................................................................................724 Memory Size and Type.............................................................................................................724 Frequency and Time.................................................................................................................724 Registers and Bits.................................................................................................................... 725 39. Acronyms and Abbreviations.............................................................................................................. 726 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 9 SAM D20 Family The Microchip Web Site............................................................................................................................. 729 Customer Change Notification Service...................................................................................................... 729 Customer Support...................................................................................................................................... 729 Microchip Devices Code Protection Feature.............................................................................................. 729 Legal Notice............................................................................................................................................... 730 Trademarks................................................................................................................................................ 730 Quality Management System Certified by DNV......................................................................................... 730 Worldwide Sales and Service.....................................................................................................................731 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 10 SAM D20 Family Configuration Summary 1. Configuration Summary Table 1-1. SAM D20 Device-Specific Features Device Flash (KB) SRAM (KB) ATSAMD20E14 16 2 ATSAMD20E15 32 4 ATSAMD20E16 64 8 ATSAMD20E17 128 16 ATSAMD20E18 256 32 ATSAMD20G14 16 2 ATSAMD20G15 32 4 ATSAMD20G16 64 8 ATSAMD20G17 128 16 ATSAMD20G18 256 32 ATSAMD20J14 16 2 ATSAMD20J15 32 4 ATSAMD20J16 64 8 ATSAMD20J17 128 16 ATSAMD20J18 256 32 Table 1-2. SAM D20 Family Features Feature SAM D20J SAM 20G SAM D20E Packages VQFN64/TQFP64/ UFBGA64 VQFN48/TQFP48 WLCSP45 VQFN32/TQFP32 WLCSP27 Pins 64 48 45 32 27 General Purpose I/O pins (GPIOs) 52 38 35 26 22 Flash 256/128/64/32/16 KB SRAM 32/16/8/4/2 KB Timer Counter (TC) instances 256/128 KB 256/128/64/32/16 KB 32/16 KB 8 2(1) Serial Communication Interface (SERCOM) instances © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries 8/4 KB 6 Waveform output channels per TC instance Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) channels 32/16/8/4/2 KB 64/32 KB 4(2) 6 20 14 Complete Datasheet 10 DS60001504F-page 11 SAM D20 Family Configuration Summary ...........continued Feature SAM D20J SAM 20G SAM D20E Packages VQFN64/TQFP64/ UFBGA64 VQFN48/TQFP48 WLCSP45 Analog Comparators (AC) 2 Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) channels 1 Real-Time Counter (RTC) 1 RTC compare values One 32-bit value or two 16-bit values External Interrupt lines Maximum CPU frequency WLCSP27 Yes RTC alarms Peripheral Touch Controller (PTC) X and Y lines VQFN32/TQFP32 16 16x16 14 12x10 10x6 9x6 48MHz 32.768 kHz crystal oscillator (XOSC32K) 0.4-32 MHz crystal oscillator (XOSC) 32.768 kHz internal oscillator (OSC32K) Oscillators 32 kHz ultra low-power internal oscillator (OSCULP32K) 8 MHz high-accuracy internal oscillator (OSC8M) 48 MHz Digital Frequency Locked Loop (DFLL48M) Event System channels 8 SW Debug Interface Yes Watchdog Timer (WDT) Yes Notes:  1. The WLCSP27 package does not contain TC4/WO[1] and TC5/WO[0],TC5/WO[1] outputs. 2. SERCOM4/SERCOM5 are not available on the VQFN32/TQFP32 and WLCSP27 packages. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 12 SAM D20 Family Ordering Information (1) 2. Ordering Information (1) AT SAMD 20 E 14 A - M U T Product Family Package Carrier SAMD = General Purpose Microcontroller No character = Tray (Default) T = Tape and Reel Product Series Package Grade 20 = Cortex M0+ CPU, Basic Feature Set Pin Count U = -40 - 85oC Matte Sn Plating N = -40 - 105 oC Matte Sn Plating Z = -40 - 125oC Extended Temperature with compliance to AEC-Q100(5) E = 32 Pins / 27 Balls G = 48 Pins / 45 Balls J = 64 Pins / 64 Balls Package Type Flash Memory Density 18 = 256KB 17 = 128KB 16 = 64KB 15 = 32KB 14 = 16KB Device Variant (3,4) A A = TQFP M = VQFN C = UFBGA U = WLCSP (2) A = Default Variant B = Improved Low Power Note:  1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Not all combinations are valid. The available device part numbers are listed in configuration Summary. Variant B is available only for Flash memory density of 64 KB, 32 KB, and 16 KB. Devices in the WLCSP45 package include a factory programmed Boot Loader. Contact your local Microchip sales office for additional information. Devices in the WLCSP27 package include a factory programmed Boot Loader. For additional information, refer ® to the MPLAB Harmony v3 Boot Loader documentation. AEC-Q100 grading is only available for Variant B. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 13 SAM D20 Family Block Diagram Block Diagram IOBUS SWCLK ARM CORTEX-M0+ PROCESSOR Fmax 48MHz SERIAL WIRE SWDIO DEVICE SERVICE UNIT M 256/128/64/32/16KB NVM NVM CONTROLLER Cache S M 32/16/8/4/2KB RAM HIGH SPEED BUS MATRIX S PERIPHERAL ACCESS CONTROLLER S AHB-APB BRIDGE B S S AHB-APB BRIDGE A AHB-APB BRIDGE C SRAM CONTROLLER PERIPHERAL ACCESS CONTROLLER PERIPHERAL ACCESS CONTROLLER SYSTEM CONTROLLER PORT VREF BOD33 66xxSERCOM SERCOM PIN[3:0] 8 x TIMER COUNTER 8 x(See Timer Counter Note1) WO[1:0] OSCULP32K OSC32K XOSC32K OSC8M XIN XOUT XOSC DFLL48M POWER MANAGER CLOCK CONTROLLER RESET CONTROLLER RESET GCLK_IO[7:0] SLEEP CONTROLLER VREFA VREFB AIN[3:0] 2 ANALOG COMPARATORS GENERIC CLOCK CONTROLLER CMP1:0] VOUT DAC REAL TIME COUNTER WATCHDOG TIMER EXTINT[15:0] NMI AIN[19:0] ADC PORT XIN32 XOUT32 EVENT SYSTEM 3. PERIPHERAL TOUCH CONTROLLER EXTERNAL INTERRUPT CONTROLLER VREFA X[15:0] Y[15:0] Note:  1. Some products have different number of SERCOM instances, Timer/Counter instances, PTC signals and ADC signals. Refer to Peripherals Configuration Summary for details. Related Links 11. Peripherals Configuration Summary © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 14 SAM D20 Family Pinout Pinout 4.1 SAM D20J 4.1.1 VQFN64/TQFP64 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 PB03 PB02 PB01 PB00 PB31 PB30 PA31 PA30 VDDIN VDDCORE GND PA28 RESET PA27 PB23 PB22 4. 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 VDDIO GND PA25 PA24 PA23 PA22 PA21 PA20 PB17 PB16 PA19 PA18 PA17 PA16 VDDIO GND PA08 PA09 PA10 PA11 VDDIO GND PB10 PB11 PB12 PB13 PB14 PB15 PA12 PA13 PA14 PA15 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 PA00 PA01 PA02 PA03 PB04 PB05 GNDANA VDDANA PB06 PB07 PB08 PB09 PA04 PA05 PA06 PA07 DIGITAL PIN ANALOG PIN OSCILLATOR GROUND INPUT SUPPLY REGULATED OUTPUT SUPPLY RESET PIN © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 15 SAM D20 Family Pinout 4.1.2 UFBGA64 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 16 SAM D20 Family Pinout SAM D20G 4.2.1 VQFN48/TQFP48 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 PB03 PB02 PA31 PA30 VDDIN VDDCORE GND PA28 RESET PA27 PB23 PB22 4.2 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 VDDIO GND PA25 PA24 PA23 PA22 PA21 PA20 PA19 PA18 PA17 PA16 PA08 PA09 PA10 PA11 VDDIO GND PB10 PB11 PA12 PA13 PA14 PA15 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 PA00 PA01 PA02 PA03 GNDANA VDDANA PB08 PB09 PA04 PA05 PA06 PA07 DIGITAL PIN ANALOG PIN OSCILLATOR GROUND INPUT SUPPLY REGULATED OUTPUT SUPPLY RESET PIN © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 17 SAM D20 Family Pinout 4.2.2 WLCSP45 A © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 18 SAM D20 Family Pinout SAM D20E 4.3.1 VQFN32/TQFP32 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 PA31 PA30 VDDIN VDDCORE GND PA28 RESET PA27 4.3 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 PA25 PA24 PA23 PA22 PA19 PA18 PA17 PA16 VDDANA GND PA08 PA09 PA10 PA11 PA14 PA15 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 PA00 PA01 PA02 PA03 PA04 PA05 PA06 PA07 DIGITAL PIN ANALOG PIN OSCILLATOR GROUND INPUT SUPPLY REGULATED OUTPUT SUPPLY RESET PIN Note:  In the VQFN32/TQFP32 package, both VDDIO and VDDANA are internally connected. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 19 SAM D20 Family Pinout 4.3.2 WLCSP27 9 8 A PA06 B PA16 1 2 PA00 PA01 PA03 PA11 VDDIN PA30 VDDCORE PA31 PA17 PA18 3 PA02 GND PA15 PA14 4 PA04 PA07 PA10 F 6 PA08 PA09 D 5 PA05 VDDANA(1) C E 7 PA28 PA22 PA19 RESET DIGITAL PIN ANALOG PIN OSCILLATOR GROUND INPUT SUPPLY REGULATED OUTPUT SUPPLY RESET PIN Note:  1. In the WLCSP27 package, both VDDIO and VDDANA are internally connected. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 20 SAM D20 Family Signal Descriptions List 5. Signal Descriptions List The following table provides details on signal names classified by peripherals. Signal Name Function Type Active Level Analog Comparators - AC AIN[3:0] AC Analog Inputs Analog CMP[1:0] AC Comparator Outputs Digital Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) AIN[19:0] ADC Analog Inputs Analog VREFA ADC Voltage External Reference A Analog VREFB ADC Voltage External Reference B Analog Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) VOUT DAC Voltage output Analog VREFA DAC Voltage External Reference Analog External Interrupt Controller EXTINT[15:0] External Interrupts Input NMI External Non-Maskable Interrupt Input Generic Clock Generator - GCLK GCLK_IO[7:0] Generic Clock (source clock or generic clock generator output) I/O Power Manager - PM RESET Reset Input Low Serial Communication Interface - SERCOMx PAD[3:0] SERCOM I/O Pads I/O System Control - SYSCTRL XIN Crystal Input Analog/Digital XIN32 32 kHz Crystal Input Analog/Digital XOUT Crystal Output Analog XOUT32 32 kHz Crystal Output Analog Timer Counter - TCx WO[1:0] Waveform Outputs Output Peripheral Touch Controller - PTC X[15:0] PTC Output Analog Y[15:0] PTC Input/Output Analog General Purpose I/O - PORT PA25 - PA00 Parallel I/O Controller I/O Port A I/O PA28 - PA27 Parallel I/O Controller I/O Port A I/O PA31 - PA30 Parallel I/O Controller I/O Port A I/O © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 21 SAM D20 Family Signal Descriptions List ...........continued Signal Name Function Type PB17 - PB00 Parallel I/O Controller I/O Port B I/O PB23 - PB22 Parallel I/O Controller I/O Port B I/O PB31 - PB30 Parallel I/O Controller I/O Port B I/O © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet Active Level DS60001504F-page 22 SAM D20 Family I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations Related Links 32.8.2. I2C Pins 6.1 Multiplexed Signals Each pin is by default controlled by the PORT as a general purpose I/O and alternatively it can be assigned to one of the peripheral functions A, B, C, D, E, F, G, or H. To enable a peripheral function on a pin, the Peripheral Multiplexer Enable bit in the Pin Configuration register corresponding to that pin (PINCFGn.PMUXEN, n = 0-31) in the PORT must be written to one. The selection of peripheral function A to H is done by writing to the Peripheral Multiplexing Odd and Even bits in the Peripheral Multiplexing register (PMUXn.PMUXE/O) in the PORT. This table describes the peripheral signals multiplexed to the PORT I/O pins. Table 6-1. PORT Function Multiplexing Pin/Ball I/O Pin Supply Type B(2) A EIC REF ADC AC PTC DAC C(1) D(1) SERCOM( 3) SERCOMALT E F TC(4) SAM D20E (VQFN32,TQFP32/ WLCSP27) SAM D20G (VQFN48,TQFP48/ WLCSP45) SAM D20J (VQFN64,TQFP64/ UFBGA64) 1/A1 1/C12 1/B1 PA00 VDDANA EXTINT[0] SERCOM1/ PAD[0] TC2/ WO[0] 2/B2 2/B13 2/C1 PA01 VDDANA EXTINT[1] SERCOM1/ PAD[1] TC2/ WO[1] 3/A3 3/C10 3/C3 PA02 VDDANA EXTINT[2] 4/B4 4/C8 4/D3 PA03 VDDANA EXTINT[3] /D11 5/D2 PB04 VDDANA 6/D4 PB05 9/E4 10/E3 7/D9 AIN[0] Y[0] AIN[1] Y[1] EXTINT[4] AIN[12] Y[10] VDDANA EXTINT[5] AIN[13] Y[11] PB06 VDDANA EXTINT[6] AIN[14] Y[12] PB07 VDDANA EXTINT[7] AIN[15] Y[13] 11/E2 PB08 VDDANA EXTINT[8] AIN[2] Y[14] SERCOM4/ PAD[0] TC4/ WO[0] 8/E10 12/F4 PB09 VDDANA EXTINT[9] AIN[3] Y[15] SERCOM4/ PAD[1] TC4/ WO[1] 5/A5 9/F13 13/F1 PA04 VDDANA EXTINT[4] 6/A7 10/F11 14/F2 PA05 VDDANA 7/A9 11/E8 15/G2 PA06 8/B6 12/G12 16/G1 11/C7 13/F9 12/C9 ADC/ VREFA DAC/ VREFA H COM AC/GCLK VOUT AIN[4] AIN[0] Y[2] SERCOM0/ PAD[0] TC0/ WO[0] EXTINT[5] AIN[5] AIN[1] Y[3] SERCOM0/ PAD[1] TC0/ WO[1] VDDANA EXTINT[6] AIN[6] AIN[2] Y[4] SERCOM0/ PAD[2] TC1/ WO[0] PA07 VDDANA EXTINT[7] AIN[7] AIN[3] Y[5] SERCOM0/ PAD[3] TC1/ WO[1] 17/H1 PA08 VDDIO I2C NMI AIN[16] X[0] SERCOM0/ PAD[0] SERCOM2/ PAD[0] TC0/ WO[0] 14/E6 18/H2 PA09 VDDIO I2C EXTINT[9] AIN[17] X[1] SERCOM0/ PAD[1] SERCOM2/ PAD[1] TC0/ WO[1] 13/D8 15/G10 19/F3 PA10 VDDIO EXTINT[10] AIN[18] X[2] SERCOM0/ PAD[2] SERCOM2/ PAD[2] TC1/ WO[0] GCLK_IO[4] 14/D6 16/F7 20/G3 PA11 VDDIO EXTINT[11] AIN[19] X[3] SERCOM0/ PAD[3] SERCOM2/ PAD[3] TC1/ WO[1] GCLK_IO[5] 19 23/G4 PB10 VDDIO EXTINT[10] © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries ADC/ VREFB G Complete Datasheet SERCOM4/ PAD[2] TC5/ WO[0] DS60001504F-page 23 GCLK_IO[4] SAM D20 Family I/O Multiplexing and Considerations ...........continued Pin/Ball SAM D20E (VQFN32,TQFP32/ WLCSP27) I/O Pin Supply Type B(2) A ADC AC PTC DAC SERCOM( 3) SERCOMALT E F TC(4) G H COM AC/GCLK SAM D20J (VQFN64,TQFP64/ UFBGA64) 20 24/E5 PB11 VDDIO 25/F5 PB12 VDDIO I2C EXTINT[12] X[12] SERCOM4/ PAD[0] TC4/ WO[0] GCLK_IO[6] 26/G5 PB13 VDDIO I2C EXTINT[13] X[13] SERCOM4/ PAD[1] TC4/ WO[1] GCLK_IO[7] 27/H5 PB14 VDDIO EXTINT[14] X[14] SERCOM4/ PAD[2] TC5/ WO[0] GCLK_IO[0] 28/E6 PB15 VDDIO EXTINT[15] X[15] SERCOM4/ PAD[3] TC5/ WO[1] GCLK_IO[1] 21/D7 29/F6 PA12 VDDIO I2C EXTINT[12] SERCOM2/ PAD[0] SERCOM4/ PAD[0] TC2/ WO[0] AC/CMP[0] 22/F5 30/G6 PA13 VDDIO I2C EXTINT[13] SERCOM2/ PAD[1] SERCOM4/ PAD[1] TC2/ WO[1] AC/CMP[1] 15/E9 23/G4 31/H6 PA14 VDDIO EXTINT[14] SERCOM2/ PAD[2] SERCOM4/ PAD[2] TC3/ WO[0] GCLK_IO[0] 16/E7 24/G2 32/H7 PA15 VDDIO EXTINT[15] SERCOM2/ PAD[3] SERCOM4/ PAD[3] TC3/ WO[1] GCLK_IO[1] 17/F8 25/D5 35/G7 PA16 VDDIO I2C EXTINT[0] X[4] SERCOM1/ PAD[0] SERCOM3/ PAD[0] TC2/ WO[0] GCLK_IO[2] 18/E5 26/F3 36/F8 PA17 VDDIO I2C EXTINT[1] X[5] SERCOM1/ PAD[1] SERCOM3/ PAD[1] TC2/ WO[1] GCLK_IO[3] 19/F6 27/F1 37/F7 PA18 VDDIO EXTINT[2] X[6] SERCOM1/ PAD[2] SERCOM3/ PAD[2] TC3/ WO[0] AC/CMP[0] 20/F4 28/E4 38/E7 PA19 VDDIO EXTINT[3] X[7] SERCOM1/ PAD[3] SERCOM3/ PAD[3] TC3/ WO[1] AC/CMP[1] 39/D7 PB16 VDDIO I2C EXTINT[0] SERCOM5/ PAD[0] TC6/ WO[0] GCLK_IO[2] 40/D5 PB17 VDDIO I2C EXTINT[1] SERCOM5/ PAD[1] TC6/ WO[1] GCLK_IO[3] 29/E2 41/D6 PA20 VDDIO EXTINT[4] X[8] SERCOM5/ PAD[2] SERCOM3/ PAD[2] TC7/ WO[0] GCLK_IO[4] 30/D1 42/C5 PA21 VDDIO EXTINT[5] X[9] SERCOM5/ PAD[3] SERCOM3/ PAD[3] TC7/ WO[1] GCLK_IO[5] 21/E3 31/C6 43/C6 PA22 VDDIO I2C EXTINT[6] X[10] SERCOM3/ PAD[0] SERCOM5/ PAD[0] TC4/ WO[0] GCLK_IO[6] 22 32/D3 44/C7 PA23 VDDIO I2C EXTINT[7] X[11] SERCOM3/ PAD[1] SERCOM5/ PAD[1] TC4/ WO[1] GCLK_IO[7] 23 33/C2 45/E8 PA24 VDDIO EXTINT[12] SERCOM3/ PAD[2] SERCOM5/ PAD[2] TC5/ WO[0] 24 34/B1 46/D8 PA25 VDDIO EXTINT[13] SERCOM3/ PAD[3] SERCOM5/ PAD[3] TC5/ WO[1] 37 49/A8 PB22 VDDIO EXTINT[6] SERCOM5/ PAD[2] TC7/ WO[0] GCLK_IO[0] 38 50/A7 PB23 VDDIO EXTINT[7] SERCOM5/ PAD[3] TC7/ WO[1] GCLK_IO[1] 25 39/A2 51/B7 PA27 VDDIO EXTINT[15] GCLK_IO[0] 27/E1 41/A4 53/A6 PA28 VDDIO EXTINT[8] GCLK_IO[0] 31/C3 45/B7 57/B5 PA30 VDDIO EXTINT[10] SERCOM1/ PAD[2] TC1/ WO[0] SWCLK 32/D4 46/B9 58/B4 PA31 VDDIO EXTINT[11] SERCOM1/ PAD[3] TC1/ WO[1] SWDIO (5) and its subsidiaries REF D(1) SAM D20G (VQFN48,TQFP48/ WLCSP45) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. EIC C(1) EXTINT[11] SERCOM4/ PAD[3] Complete Datasheet TC5/ WO[1] GCLK_IO[5] DS60001504F-page 24 GCLK_IO[0] SAM D20 Family I/O Multiplexing and Considerations ...........continued Pin/Ball SAM D20E (VQFN32,TQFP32/ WLCSP27) SAM D20G (VQFN48,TQFP48/ WLCSP45) I/O Pin Supply Type SAM D20J (VQFN64,TQFP64/ UFBGA64) B(2) A EIC REF ADC AC PTC DAC C(1) D(1) SERCOM( 3) SERCOMALT E F TC(4) 59/C4 PB30 VDDIO I2C EXTINT[14] SERCOM5/ PAD[0] TC0/ WO[0] 60/B3 PB31 VDDIO I2C EXTINT[15] SERCOM5/ PAD[1] TC0/ WO[1] 61/B2 PB00 VDDANA EXTINT[0] AIN[8] Y[6] SERCOM5/ PAD[2] TC7/ WO[0] 62/A2 PB01 VDDANA EXTINT[1] AIN[9] Y[7] SERCOM5/ PAD[3] TC7/ WO[1] 47/A12 63/A1 PB02 VDDANA EXTINT[2] AIN[10] Y[8] SERCOM5/ PAD[0] TC6/ WO[0] 48/B11 64/C2 PB03 VDDANA EXTINT[3] AIN[11] Y[9] SERCOM5/ PAD[1] TC6/ WO[1] G H COM AC/GCLK Notes:  1. SERCOM4/SERCOM5 are not available on VQFN32/TQFP32 and WLCSP27 packages. 2. All analog pin functions are on peripheral function B. Peripheral function B must be selected to disable the digital control of the pin. 3. Only some pins can be used in SERCOM I2C mode. Refer to the Type column for using a SERCOM pin in I2C mode. Refer to “Electrical Characteristics” for details on the I2C pin characteristics. 4. TC6 and TC7 are not supported on the SAM D20E and SAM D20G devices. Refer to the 1. Configuration Summary for details. 5. The SWDIO function is only activated in the presence of a debugger. Related Links 21. PORT - I/O Pin Controller 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 32.8.2. I2C Pins 6.2 Other Functions 6.2.1 Oscillator Pinout The oscillators are not mapped to the normal PORT functions and their multiplexing are controlled by registers in the System Controller (SYSCTRL). Table 6-2. Oscillator Pinout Oscillator Supply Signal I/O pin XOSC VDDIO XIN PA14 XOUT PA15 XIN32 PA00 XOUT32 PA01 XOSC32K VDDANA Related Links 16. SYSCTRL – System Controller 6.2.2 Serial Wire Debug Interface Pinout Only the SWCLK pin is mapped to the normal PORT functions. A debugger cold-plugging or hot-plugging detection will automatically switch the SWDIO port to the SWDIO function. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 25 SAM D20 Family I/O Multiplexing and Considerations Table 6-3. Serial Wire Debug Interface Pinout Signal Supply I/O pin SWCLK VDDIO PA30 SWDIO VDDIO PA31 Related Links 12. DSU - Device Service Unit © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 26 SAM D20 Family Power Supply and Start-Up Considerations 7. Power Supply and Start-Up Considerations Related Links 32.4. Supply Characteristics ADC PA[7:2] VOLTAGE REGULATOR OSC8M PB[31:10] PA[13:8] BOD12 XOSC AC PB[9:0] VDDIO VDDIN GND VDDCORE GNDANA Power Domain Overview VDDANA 7.1 PA[15:14] PA[31:16] DAC PTC Digital Logic PA[1:0] (CPU, peripherals) XOSC32K POR OSC32K OSCULP32K 7.2 Power Supply Considerations 7.2.1 Power Supplies BOD33 DFLL48M The device has the following power supply pins: • • • • VDDIO: Powers I/O lines, OSC8M and XOSC. Voltage is 1.62V to 3.63V. VDDIN: Powers I/O lines and the internal regulator. Voltage is 1.62V to 3.63V. VDDANA: Powers I/O lines and the ADC, AC, DAC, PTC, OSCULP32K, OSC32K, XOSC32K. Voltage is 1.62V to 3.63V. VDDCORE: Internal regulated voltage output. Powers the core, memories, peripherals, and DFLL48M. Voltage is 1.2V. The same voltage must be applied to both VDDIN, VDDIO and VDDANA. This common voltage is referred to as VDD in the data sheet. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 27 SAM D20 Family Power Supply and Start-Up Considerations The ground pins, GND, are common to VDDCORE, VDDIO and VDDIN. The ground pin for VDDANA is GNDANA. For decoupling recommendations for the different power supplies. Refer to Schematic Checklist for details. Related Links 36. Schematic Checklist 7.2.2 Voltage Regulator The voltage regulator has two different modes: • • 7.2.3 Normal mode: To be used when the CPU and peripherals are running Low-Power (LP) mode: To be used when the regulator draws small static current. It can be used in Standby mode Typical Powering Schematics The device uses a single main supply with a range of 1.62V - 3.63V. The following figure shows the recommended power supply connection. Figure 7-1. Power Supply Connection DEVICE Main Supply (1.62V — 3.63V) VDDIO VDDANA VDDIN VDDCORE GND GNDANA 7.2.4 Power-Up Sequence 7.2.4.1 Minimum Rise Rate The integrated Power-on Reset (POR) circuitry monitoring the VDDANA power supply requires a minimum rise rate. Refer to the Electrical Characteristics for details. Related Links 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 7.2.4.2 Maximum Rise Rate The rise rate of the power supply must not exceed the values described in Electrical Characteristics. Refer to the Electrical Characteristics for details. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 28 SAM D20 Family Power Supply and Start-Up Considerations Related Links 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 7.3 Power-Up This section summarizes the power-up sequence of the device. The behavior after power-up is controlled by the Power Manager. Refer to PM – Power Manager for details. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 7.3.1 Starting of Clocks After power-up, the device is set to its initial state and kept in reset, until the power has stabilized throughout the device. Once the power has stabilized, the device will use a 1MHz clock. This clock is derived from the 8MHz Internal Oscillator (OSC8M), which is divided by eight and used as a clock source for generic clock generator 0. Generic clock generator 0 is the main clock for the Power Manager (PM). Some synchronous system clocks are active, allowing software execution. Refer to the “Clock Mask Register” section in PM – Power Manager for the list of default peripheral clocks running. Synchronous system clocks that are running are by default not divided and receive a 1MHz clock through generic clock generator 0. Other generic clocks are disabled except GCLK_WDT, which is used by the Watchdog Timer (WDT). Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 7.3.2 I/O Pins After power-up, the I/O pins are tri-stated. 7.3.3 Fetching of Initial Instructions After reset has been released, the CPU starts fetching PC and SP values from the reset address, which is 0x00000000. This address points to the first executable address in the internal Flash. The code read from the Internal Flash is free to configure the clock system and clock sources. Refer to PM – Power Manager, GCLK – Generic Clock Controller and SYSCTRL – System Controller for details. Refer to the ARM Architecture Reference Manual for more information on CPU startup (http://www.arm.com). Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 16. SYSCTRL – System Controller 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 15. Power Manager (PM) 7.4 Power-On Reset and Brown-Out Detector The SAM D20 embeds three features to monitor, warn and/or reset the device: • • • 7.4.1 POR: Power-On Reset on VDDANA BOD33: Brown-Out Detector on VDDANA BOD12: Voltage Regulator Internal Brown-Out Detector on VDDCORE. The Voltage Regulator Internal BOD is calibrated in production and its calibration configuration is stored in the NVM User Row. This configuration should not be changed if the user row is written to assure the correct behavior of the BOD12. Power-On Reset on VDDANA POR monitors VDDANA. It is always activated and monitors voltage at startup and also during all the sleep modes. If VDDANA goes below the threshold voltage, the entire chip is reset. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 29 SAM D20 Family Power Supply and Start-Up Considerations 7.4.2 Brown-Out Detector on VDDANA BOD33 monitors VDDANA. Refer to SYSCTRL – System Controller for details. Related Links 16. SYSCTRL – System Controller 7.4.3 Brown-Out Detector on VDDCORE Once the device has started up, BOD12 monitors the internal VDDCORE. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 30 SAM D20 Family Product Mapping 8. Product Mapping Figure 8-1. Product Mapping Global Memory Space Code 0x00000000 0x00000000 Code Internal flash 0x00040000 0x20000000 SRAM 0x20008000 0x1FFFFFFF 0x20000000 Undefined 0x40000000 Reserved SRAM AHB-APB Bridge C Internal SRAM 0x20008000 0x42000400 Peripherals Peripherals 0x40000000 0x43000000 AHB-APB Bridge A Reserved AHB-APB Bridge B IOBUS 0x60000200 Reserved 0x42000000 System System 0xE000E000 0xE000F000 0x40000400 0x40000800 0x40000C00 0x40001000 0x40001400 0x40001800 0x40001C00 0x40FFFFFF PAC0 PM SYSCTRL GCLK WDT RTC EIC Reserved 0x42001C00 0x42002000 0xE0000000 0x40000000 0x42001400 0x42FFFFFF 0xFFFFFFFF AHB-APB Bridge A 0x42000C00 0x42001800 AHB-APB Bridge C 0xE0000000 0x42000800 0x42001000 0x41000000 0x60000000 0x42000000 0xE00FF000 0xE0100000 0xFFFFFFFF Reserved SCS Reserved ROM Table Reserved AHB-APB Bridge B 0x41000000 0x41002000 0x41004000 0x41004400 0x41004800 0x41FFFFFF PAC1 DSU NVMCTRL PORT Reserved 0x42002400 0x42002800 0x42002C00 0x42003000 0x42003400 0x42003800 0x42003C00 0x42004000 0x42004400 0x42004800 0x42004C00 0x42005000 0x42FFFFFF PAC2 EVSYS SERCOM0 SERCOM1 SERCOM2 SERCOM3 SERCOM4 SERCOM5 TC0 TC1 TC2 TC3 TC4 TC5 TC6 TC7 ADC AC DAC PTC Reserved This figure represents the full configuration of the SAM D20 device with maximum flash and SRAM capabilities and a full set of peripherals. Refer to the Configuration Summary for details. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 31 SAM D20 Family Memories 9. Memories 9.1 Embedded Memories • • • 9.2 Internal high-speed Flash Internal high-speed RAM, single-cycle access at full speed Dedicated Flash area for EEPROM Emulation Physical Memory Map The high-speed bus is implemented as a Bus Matrix. All high-speed bus addresses are fixed, and they are never remapped in any way, even during boot. The 32-bit physical address space is mapped as given in the below table. Table 9-1. Physical Memory Map Memory Start Address Size (Kbytes) SAMD20x18 SAMD20x17 SAMD20x16 SAMD20x15 SAMD20x14 Internal Flash 0x00000000 256 128 64 32 16 Internal SRAM 0x20000000 32 16 8 4 2 Peripheral Bridge A 0x40000000 64 64 64 64 64 Peripheral Bridge B 0x41000000 64 64 64 64 64 Peripheral Bridge C 0x42000000 64 64 64 64 64 Note:  x = G, J or E. Refer to Ordering Information. Table 9-2. Flash Memory Parameters Device Flash Size Number of Pages Page Size Row Size SAMD20x18 256 Kbytes 4096 64 bytes 4 pages = 256 bytes SAMD20x17 128 Kbytes 2048 64 bytes 4 pages = 256 bytes SAMD20x16 64 Kbytes 1024 64 bytes 4 pages = 256 bytes SAMD20x15 32 Kbytes 512 64 bytes 4 pages = 256 bytes SAMD20x14 16 Kbytes 256 64 bytes 4 pages = 256 bytes Notes:  1. x = G, J or E. Refer to Ordering Information. 2. The number of pages (NVMP) and page size (PSZ) can be read from the NVM Pages and Page Size bits in the NVM Parameter register in the NVMCTRL (PARAM.NVMP and PARAM.PSZ, respectively). Refer to NVM Parameter (PARAM) register for details. Related Links 10.3. High-Speed Bus System 2. Ordering Information (1) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 32 SAM D20 Family Memories 9.3 NVM Calibration and Auxiliary Space The device calibration data are stored in different sections of the NVM calibration and auxiliary space presented in the following figure. Figure 9-1. Calibration and Auxiliary Space AUX1 0x00806040 0x00800000 Calibration and auxiliary space Area 4: Software calibration area (256bits) NVM base address + 0x00800000 0x00806020 Area 4 offset address Area 3: Reserved (128bits) NVM base address + NVM size 0x00806010 NVM main address space 0x00806008 Area 2: Device configuration area (64 bits) Area 3 offset address Area 2 offset address Area 1: Reserved (64 bits) 0x00806000 Area 1 address offset NVM Base Address 0x00000000 0x00806000 AUX1 AUX1 offset address 0x00804000 AUX0 – NVM User Row 0x00800000 Automatic calibration row AUX0 offset address Calibration and auxiliary space address offset The values from the automatic calibration row are loaded into their respective registers at startup. 9.4 NVM User Row Mapping The first two 32-bit words of the NVM User Row contain calibration data that are automatically read at device power-on. The NVM User Row can be read at address 0x804000. To write the NVM User Row, refer to NVMCTRL – Non-Volatile Memory Controller. When writing to the user row, the values do not get loaded by other modules on the device until a device Reset occurs. Table 9-3. NVM User Row Mapping Bit Position Name Usage 2:0 BOOTPROT Used to select one of eight different bootloader sizes. Refer to the “NVMCTRL – Non-Volatile Memory Controller”. Default value = 0x7 except for WLCSP45 that has default value = 0x3. Note:  WLCSP27 devices boot ROM is not protected as the bootloader is self-upgradable through the I2C interface. . 3(1) Reserved Do not modify the value of a reserved bit. Reading a reserved bit has no significance to the user application. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 33 SAM D20 Family Memories ...........continued Bit Position Name Usage 6:4 EEPROM Used to select one of eight different EEPROM Emulation sizes. Refer to NVMCTRL – Non-Volatile Memory Controller. Default value = 7. 7(1) Reserved Do not modify the value of a reserved bit. Reading a reserved bit has no significance to the user application. 13:8 BOD33 Level BOD33 Threshold Level at power on. Refer to SYSCTRL BOD33 register. Default value = 7 on all package grades except Extended Temperature with compliance to AEC-Q100 which has Default value = 34. 14 BOD33 Enable BOD33 Enable at power on . Refer to SYSCTRL BOD33 register. Default value = 1. 16:15 BOD33 Action BOD33 Action at power on. Refer to SYSCTRL BOD33 register. Default value = 1. 24:17(1) Reserved Do not modify the value of a reserved bit. Reading a reserved bit has no significance to the user application. 25 WDT Enable WDT Enable at power on. Refer to WDT CTRL register. Default value = 0. 26 WDT Always-On WDT Always-On at power on. Refer to WDT CTRL register. Default value = 0. 30:27 WDT Period WDT Period at power on. Refer to WDT CONFIG register. Default value = 0x0B. 34:31 WDT Window WDT Window mode time-out at power on. Refer to WDT CONFIG register. Default value = 0x0B. 38:35 WDT EWOFFSET WDT Early Warning Interrupt Time Offset at power on. Refer to WDT EWCTRL register. Default value = 0xB. 39 WDT WEN 40 BOD33 Hysteresis BOD33 Hysteresis configuration at power on. Refer to SYSCTRL BOD33 register. Default value = 1. 47:41 Reserved Do not modify the value of a reserved bit. Reading a reserved bit has no significance to the user application. 63:48 LOCK NVM Region Lock Bits. Refer to NVMCTRL – Non-Volatile Memory Controller. Default value = 0xFFFF. WDT Timer Window Mode Enable at power on. Refer to WDT CTRL register. Default value = 0. Note:  1. It is required to preserve the value of a reserved bit while modifying the NVM User Row bits. Related Links 20. NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 16.8.14. BOD33 17.8.1. CTRL 17.8.2. CONFIG 17.8.3. EWCTRL 32.10.3.1. BOD33 9.5 NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping The NVM Software Calibration Area contains calibration data that are measured and written during production test. These calibration values should be read by the application software and written back to the corresponding register. The NVM Software Calibration Area can be read at address 0x806020. The NVM Software Calibration Area can not be written. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 34 SAM D20 Family Memories Table 9-4. NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping Bit Position Name Description 26:0 Reserved 34:27 ADC LINEARITY ADC Linearity Calibration. Should be written to ADC CALIB register. 37:35 ADC BIASCAL ADC Bias Calibration. Should be written to ADC CALIB register. 44:38 OSC32K CAL OSC32KCalibration. Should be written to SYSCTRL OSC32K register. 57:45 Reserved 63:58 DFLL48M COARSE CAL1) DFLL48M Coarse calibration value, should be written to SYSCTRL DFLLVAL register. 73:64 DFLL48M fine CAL(1) DFLL48M Fine calibration value, should be written to SYSCTRL.DFLLVAL register. 127:74 Reserved Note:  1. Not applicable for die rev. C and previous. Related Links 28.8.19. CALIB 16.8.7. OSC32K 16.8.11. DFLLVAL 9.6 Serial Number Each device has a unique 128-bit serial number which is a concatenation of four 32-bit words contained at the following addresses: Word 0: 0x0080A00C Word 1: 0x0080A040 Word 2: 0x0080A044 Word 3: 0x0080A048 The uniqueness of the serial number is guaranteed only when using all 128 bits. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 35 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture 10. Processor And Architecture 10.1 Cortex M0+ Processor The SAM D20 implements the ARM® Cortex®-M0+ processor, based on the ARMv6 Architecture and Thumb®-2 ISA. The Cortex M0+ is 100% instruction set compatible with its predecessor, the Cortex-M0 core, and upward compatible to Cortex-M3 and M4 cores. The ARM Cortex-M0+ implemented is revision r0p1. For more information refer to www.arm.com. 10.1.1 Cortex M0+ Configuration Table 10-1. Cortex M0+ Configuration Features Configurable option Device configuration Interrupts External interrupts 0-32 28 Data endianness Little-endian or big-endian Little-endian SysTick timer Present or absent Present Number of watchpoint comparators 0, 1, 2 2 Number of breakpoint comparators 0, 1, 2, 3, 4 4 Halting debug support Present or absent Present Multiplier Fast or small Fast (single cycle) Single-cycle I/O port Present or absent Present Wake-up interrupt controller Supported or not supported Not supported Vector Table Offset Register Present or absent Present Unprivileged/Privileged support Present or absent Absent(1) Memory Protection Unit Not present or 8-region Not present Reset all registers Present or absent Absent Instruction fetch width 16-bit only or mostly 32-bit 32-bit Note:  1. All software run in Privileged mode only. The ARM Cortex-M0+ core has the following two bus interfaces: • Single 32-bit AMBA-3 AHB-Lite system interface that provides connections to peripherals and all system memory, which includes Flash and RAM. • Single 32-bit I/O port bus interfacing to the PORT with 1-cycle loads and stores. 10.1.2 Cortex-M0+ Peripherals • • • System Control Space (SCS) – The processor provides debug through registers in the SCS. Refer to the Cortex-M0+ Technical Reference Manual for details (www.arm.com). System Timer (SysTick) – The System Timer is a 24-bit timer clocked by CLK_CPU that extends the functionality of both the processor and the NVIC. Refer to the Cortex-M0+ Technical Reference Manual for details (www.arm.com). Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) – External interrupt signals connect to the NVIC, and the NVIC prioritizes the interrupts. Software can set the priority of each interrupt. The NVIC and the Cortex-M0+ processor core are closely coupled, providing low © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 36 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture • 10.1.3 latency interrupt processing and efficient processing of late arriving interrupts. Refer to 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller and the Cortex-M0+ Technical Reference Manual for details (www.arm.com). System Control Block (SCB) – The System Control Block provides system implementation information, and system control. This includes configuration, control, and reporting of the system exceptions. Refer to the Cortex-M0+ Devices Generic User Guide for details (www.arm.com). Cortex-M0+ Address Map Table 10-2. Cortex-M0+ Address Map 10.1.4 Address Peripheral 0xE000E000 System Control Space (SCS) 0xE000E010 System Timer (SysTick) 0xE000E100 Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) 0xE000ED00 System Control Block (SCB) I/O Interface 10.1.4.1 Overview Because accesses to the AMBA® AHB-Lite™ and the single cycle I/O interface can be made concurrently, the Cortex-M0+ processor can fetch the next instructions while accessing the I/Os. This enables single cycle I/O accesses to be sustained for as long as needed. Refer to CPU Local Bus for more information. Related Links 21.5.9. CPU Local Bus 10.1.4.2 Description Direct access to PORT registers. 10.2 Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 10.2.1 Overview The Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) in the SAM D20 supports 32 interrupt lines with four different priority levels. For more details, refer to the Cortex-M0+ Technical Reference Manual (www.arm.com). 10.2.2 Interrupt Line Mapping Each of the 28 interrupt lines is connected to one peripheral instance, as shown in the table below. Each peripheral can have one or more interrupt flags, located in the peripheral’s Interrupt Flag Status and Clear (INTFLAG) register. The interrupt flag is set when the interrupt condition occurs. Each interrupt in the peripheral can be individually enabled by writing a one to the corresponding bit in the peripheral’s Interrupt Enable Set (INTENSET) register, and disabled by writing a one to the corresponding bit in the peripheral’s Interrupt Enable Clear (INTENCLR) register. An interrupt request is generated from the peripheral when the interrupt flag is set and the corresponding interrupt is enabled. The interrupt requests for one peripheral are ORed together on system level, generating one interrupt request for each peripheral. An interrupt request will set the corresponding interrupt pending bit in the NVIC interrupt pending registers (SETPEND/CLRPEND bits in ISPR/ICPR). For the NVIC to activate the interrupt, it must be enabled in the NVIC interrupt enable register (SETENA/CLRENA bits in ISER/ICER). The NVIC interrupt priority registers IPR0-IPR7 provide a priority field for each interrupt. Table 10-3. Interrupt Line Mapping Peripheral Source NVIC Line EIC NMI – External Interrupt Controller NMI © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 37 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture ...........continued Peripheral Source NVIC Line PM – Power Manager 0 SYSCTRL – System Control 1 WDT – Watchdog Timer 2 RTC – Real Time Counter 3 EIC – External Interrupt Controller 4 NVMCTRL – Non-Volatile Memory Controller 5 EVSYS – Event System 6 SERCOM0 – Serial Communication Interface 0 7 SERCOM1 – Serial Communication Interface 1 8 SERCOM2 – Serial Communication Interface 2 9 SERCOM3 – Serial Communication Interface 3 10 SERCOM4 – Serial Communication Interface 4 11 SERCOM5 – Serial Communication Interface 5 12 TC0 – Timer Counter 0 13 TC1 – Timer Counter 1 14 TC2 – Timer Counter 2 15 TC3 – Timer Counter 3 16 TC4 – Timer Counter 4 17 TC5 – Timer Counter 5 18 TC6 – Timer Counter 6 19 TC7 – Timer Counter 7 20 ADC – Analog-to-Digital Converter 21 AC – Analog Comparator 22 DAC – Digital-to-Analog Converter 23 PTC – Peripheral Touch Controller 24 10.3 High-Speed Bus System 10.3.1 Features High-Speed Bus Matrix has the following features: • Symmetric crossbar bus switch implementation • Allows concurrent accesses from different hosts to different clients • 32-bit data bus • Operation at a one-to-one clock frequency with the bus hosts © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 38 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture Configuration Internal Flash AHB-APB Bridge A AHB-APB Bridge B AHB-APB Bridge C Internal SRAM High-Speed Bus CLIENTS 0 1 2 3 4 CLIENT ID HOST ID Multi-Client HOSTS 10.3.2 CM0+ 0 DSU DSU 1 Table 10-4. Bus Matrix Hosts Bus Matrix Hosts Host ID CM0+ - Cortex M0+ Processor 0 DSU - Device Service Unit 1 Table 10-5. Bus Matrix Clients Bus Matrix Clients Client ID Internal Flash Memory 0 AHB-APB Bridge A 1 AHB-APB Bridge B 2 AHB-APB Bridge C 3 Internal SRAM 4 Table 10-6. SRAM Port Connection SRAM Port Connection Port ID Connection Type CM0+ - Cortex M0+ Processor 4 Bus Matrix DSU - Device Service Unit 6 Bus Matrix © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 39 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture 10.4 AHB-APB Bridge The AHB-APB bridge is an AHB Client, providing an interface between the high-speed AHB domain and the lowpower APB domain. It is used to provide access to the programmable control registers of peripherals (see Product Mapping). AHB-APB bridge is based on AMBA APB Protocol Specification V2.0 (ref. as APB4) including: • Wait state support • Error reporting • Transaction protection • Sparse data transfer (byte, half-word and word) Additional enhancements: • Address and data cycles merged into a single cycle • Sparse data transfer also apply to read access to operate the AHB-APB bridge, the clock (CLK_HPBx_AHB) must be enabled. See PM – Power Manager for details. Figure 10-1. APB Write Access. T0 T1 T2 T3 PCLK T0 T1 T2 T3 T4 T5 T4 T5 PCLK PADDR Addr 1 PADDR PWRITE PWRITE PSEL PSEL PENABLE PENABLE PWDATA Addr 1 PWDATA Data 1 PREADY Data 1 PREADY No wait states Wait states Figure 10-2. APB Read Access. T0 T1 T2 PCLK PADDR T3 T0 Addr 1 PADDR PWRITE PSEL PSEL PENABLE PENABLE Data 1 PREADY T3 Addr 1 PRDATA Data 1 PREADY No wait states © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries T2 PCLK PWRITE PRDATA T1 Wait states Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 40 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 8. Product Mapping 10.5 PAC - Peripheral Access Controller 10.5.1 Overview One PAC is associated with each AHB-APB bridge and the PAC can provide write protection for registers of each peripheral connected on the same bridge. The PAC peripheral bus clock (CLK_PACx_APB) can be enabled and disabled in the Power Manager. CLK_PAC0_APB and CLK_PAC1_APB are enabled are reset. CLK_PAC2_APB is disabled at reset. Refer to PM – Power Manager for details. The PAC will continue to operate in any Sleep mode where the selected clock source is running. Write-protection does not apply for debugger access. When the debugger makes an access to a peripheral, write-protection is ignored so that the debugger can update the register. Write-protect registers allow the user to disable a selected peripheral’s write-protection without doing a read-modifywrite operation. These registers are mapped into two I/O memory locations, one for clearing and one for setting the register bits. Writing a one to a bit in the Write Protect Clear register (WPCLR) will clear the corresponding bit in both registers (WPCLR and WPSET) and disable the write-protection for the corresponding peripheral, while writing a one to a bit in the Write Protect Set (WPSET) register will set the corresponding bit in both registers (WPCLR and WPSET) and enable the write-protection for the corresponding peripheral. Both registers (WPCLR and WPSET) will return the same value when read. If a peripheral is write-protected, and if a write access is performed, data will not be written, and the peripheral will return an access error (CPU exception). The PAC also offers a safety feature for correct program execution, with a CPU exception generated on double write-protection or double unprotection of a peripheral. If a peripheral n is write-protected and a write to one in WPSET[n] is detected, the PAC returns an error. This can be used to ensure that the application follows the intended program flow by always following a write-protect with an unprotect, and vice versa. However, in applications where a write-protected peripheral is used in several contexts, for example, interrupts, care should be taken so that either the interrupt can not happen while the main application or other interrupt levels manipulate the write-protection status, or when the interrupt handler needs to unprotect the peripheral, based on the current protection status, by reading WPSET. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 10.6 Register Description Atomic 8-, 16- and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Refer to the Product Mapping for PAC locations. Related Links 8. Product Mapping 10.6.1 PAC0 Register Description © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 41 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture 10.6.1.1 Write Protect Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit WPCLR 0x00 0x000000 – 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 EIC R/W 0 5 RTC R/W 0 4 WDT R/W 0 3 GCLK R/W 0 2 SYSCTRL R/W 0 1 PM R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 6 – EIC Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 5 – RTC Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 4 – WDT  Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 3 – GCLK Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 42 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture Bit 2 – SYSCTRL Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 1 – PM Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 43 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture 10.6.1.2 Write Protect Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit WPSET 0x04 0x000000 – 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 EIC R/W 0 5 RTC R/W 0 4 WDT R/W 0 3 GCLK R/W 0 2 SYSCTRL R/W 0 1 PM R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 6 – EIC Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 5 – RTC Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 4 – WDT  Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 3 – GCLK Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 44 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture Bit 2 – SYSCTRL Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 1 – PM Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. 10.6.2 PAC1 Register Description © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 45 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture 10.6.2.1 Write Protect Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit WPCLR 0x00 0x000002 – 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 PORT R/W 0 2 NVMCTRL R/W 0 1 DSU R/W 1 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 3 – PORT Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 2 – NVMCTRL Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 1 – DSU Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 46 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture 10.6.2.2 Write Protect Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit WPSET 0x04 0x000002 – 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 PORT R/W 0 2 NVMCTRL R/W 0 1 DSU R/W 1 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 3 – PORT Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 2 – NVMCTRL Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 1 – DSU Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. 10.6.3 PAC2 Register Description © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 47 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture 10.6.3.1 Write Protect Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit WPCLR 0x00 0x00800000 – 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 PTC R/W 0 18 DAC R/W 0 17 AC R/W 0 16 ADC R/W 0 15 TC7 R/W 0 14 TC6 R/W 0 13 TC5 R/W 0 12 TC4 R/W 0 11 TC3 R/W 0 10 TC2 R/W 0 9 TC1 R/W 0 8 TC0 R/W 0 7 6 5 3 2 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 1 EVSYS R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset 4 SERCOM[5:0] R/W R/W 0 0 Bit 19 – PTC Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 18 – DAC  Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 17 – AC Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 16 – ADC Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 48 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture Bits 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15 – TC Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bits 7:2 – SERCOM[5:0] Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 1 – EVSYS Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 49 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture 10.6.3.2 Write Protect Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit WPSET 0x04 0x00800000 – 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 PTC R/W 0 18 DAC R/W 0 17 AC R/W 0 16 ADC R/W 0 15 TC7 R/W 0 14 TC6 R/W 0 13 TC5 R/W 0 12 TC4 R/W 0 11 TC3 R/W 0 10 TC2 R/W 0 9 TC1 R/W 0 8 TC0 R/W 0 7 SERCOM5 R/W 0 6 SERCOM4 R/W 0 5 SERCOM3 R/W 0 4 SERCOM2 R/W 0 3 SERCOM1 R/W 0 2 SERCOM0 R/W 0 1 EVSYS R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 19 – PTC Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 18 – DAC  Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 17 – AC Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 16 – ADC Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 50 SAM D20 Family Processor And Architecture Bits 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15 – TC Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bits 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 – SERCOM Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. Bit 1 – EVSYS Writing a zero to these bits has no effect. Writing a one to these bits will clear the Write Protect bit for the corresponding peripherals. Value Description 0 Write-protection is disabled. 1 Write-protection is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 51 SAM D20 Family Peripherals Configuration Summary 11. Peripherals Configuration Summary The following table shows an overview of all the peripherals in the device. The IRQ Line column shows the interrupt mapping, as described in “Nested Vector Interrupt Controller” on page 30. The AHB and APB clock indexes correspond to the bit in the AHBMASK and APBMASK (x = A, B or C) registers in the Power Manager, while the Enabled at Reset column shows whether the peripheral clock is enabled at reset (Y) or not (N). Refer to the Power Manager AHBMASK, APBAMASK, APBBMASK and APBCMASK registers for details. The Generic Clock Index column corresponds to the value of the Generic Clock Selection ID bits in the Generic Clock Control register (CLKCTRL.ID) in the Generic Clock Controller. Refer to the GCLK CLKCTRL register description for details. The PAC Index column corresponds to the bit in the PACi (i = 0, 1 or 2) registers, while the Prot at Reset column shows whether the peripheral is protected at reset (Y) or not (N). Refer to “PAC – Peripheral Access Controller” for details. The numbers in the Events User column correspond to the value of the User Multiplexer Selection bits in the User Multiplexer register (USER.USER) in the Event System. See the USER register description and Table 22-6 for details. The numbers in the Events Generator column correspond to the value of the Event Generator bits in the Channel register (CHANNEL.EVGEN) in the Event System. See the CHANNEL register description and Table 22-3 for details. Table 11-1. Peripherals Configuration Summary Peripheral Name Base Address IRQ Line AHB Clock APB Clock Generic Clock PAC AHB-APB Bridge A 0x40000000 PAC0 0x40000000 PM 0x40000400 SYSCTRL 0x40000800 Index Enabled at Reset Index Enabled at Reset Index Index Prot at Reset 0 Y 0 Y 0 1 Y 1 N Y 1 2 Y 2 N Y GCLK 0x40000C00 WDT 0x40001000 2 3 Y 3 N Y 4 Y 1 4 N RTC 0x40001400 3 5 Y 2 5 N 0: DFLL48M reference Events User Generator 1: CMP0/ALARM0 SleepWalking Y 2: CMP1 3: OVF 4-11: PER0-7 EIC 0x40001800 NMI, 4 AHB-APB Bridge B 0x41000000 PAC1 0x41000000 DSU 0x41002000 NVMCTRL 0x41004000 PORT 0x41004400 AHB-APB Bridge C 0x42000000 PAC2 0x42000000 EVSYS 0x42000400 6 SERCOM0 0x42000800 7 5 6 Y 3 6 N 12-27: EXTINT0-15 Y 1 Y 0 Y 3 Y 1 Y 1 Y 4 Y 2 Y 2 N 3 Y 3 N 0 N 1 N 4-11: one per CHANNEL 1 N Y 2 N 13: CORE 2 N Y 3 N Y 4 N Y 5 N Y 2 Y 12:SLOW SERCOM1 0x42000C00 8 3 N 14:CORE 12: SLOW SERCOM2 0x42001000 9 4 N 15:CORE 12: SLOW SERCOM3 0x42001400 10 5 N 16:CORE 12: SLOW © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 52 SAM D20 Family Peripherals Configuration Summary ...........continued Peripheral Name SERCOM4 Base Address 0x42001800 IRQ Line AHB Clock APB Clock Generic Clock PAC Index Index Enabled at Reset Index Index Prot at Reset 6 N 17:CORE 6 N Y 7 N Y 8 N Enabled at Reset 11 Events User Generator SleepWalking 12: SLOW SERCOM5 0x42001C00 12 7 N 18:CORE 12: SLOW TC0 0x42002000 13 8 N 19 0: TC 28: OVF Y 29-30: MC0-1 TC1 0x42002400 14 9 N 19 9 N 1: TC 31: OVF Y 32-33: MC0-1 TC2 0x42002800 15 10 N 20 10 N 2: TC 34: OVF Y 35-36: MC0-1 TC3 0x42002C00 16 11 N 20 11 N 3: TC 37: OVF Y 38-39: MC0-1 TC4 0x42003000 17 12 N 21 12 N 4: TC 40: OVF Y 41-42: MC0-1 TC5 0x42003400 18 13 N 21 13 N 5: TC 43: OVF Y 44-45: MC0-1 TC6 0x42003800 19 14 N 22 14 N 6: TC 46: OVF Y 47-48: MC0-1 TC7 0x42003C00 20 15 N 22 15 N 7: TC 49: OVF Y 50-51: MC0-1 ADC AC 0x42004000 0x42004400 21 22 16 17 Y N 23 24: DIG 16 17 N N 8: START 52: RESRDY 9: SYNC 53: WINMON 10-11: COMP0-1 54-55: COMP0-1 25: ANA Y Y 56: WIN0 DAC 0x42004800 23 18 N 26 18 N 12: START 57: EMPTY PTC 0x42004C00 24 19 N 27 19 N 13: STCONV 58: EOC Y 59:WCOMP © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 53 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12. DSU - Device Service Unit 12.1 Overview The Device Service Unit (DSU) provides a means of detecting debugger probes. It enables the ARM Debug Access Port (DAP) to have control over multiplexed debug pads and CPU reset. The DSU also provides system-level services to debug adapters in an ARM debug system. It implements a CoreSight Debug ROM that provides device identification as well as identification of other debug components within the system. Hence, it complies with the ARM Peripheral Identification specification. The DSU also provides system services to applications that need memory testing, as required for IEC60730 Class B compliance, for example. The DSU can be accessed simultaneously by a debugger and the CPU, as it is connected on the High-Speed Bus Matrix. For security reasons, some of the DSU features will be limited or unavailable when the device is protected by the NVMCTRL security bit. Related Links 20. NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.6.6. Security Bit 12.2 Features • • • • • • • • 12.3 CPU reset extension Debugger probe detection (Cold- and Hot-Plugging) Chip-Erase command and status 32-bit cyclic redundancy check (CRC32) of any memory accessible through the bus matrix ARM® CoreSight™ compliant device identification Two debug communications channels Debug access port security filter Onboard memory built-in self-test (MBIST) Block Diagram Figure 12-1. DSU Block Diagram DSU RESET SWCLK debugger_present DEBUGGER PROBE INTERFACE cpu_reset_extension CPU DAP AHB-AP DAP SECURITY FILTER NVMCTRL DBG CORESIGHT ROM PORT M S CRC-32 SWDIO MBIST M HIGH-SPEED BUS MATRIX CHIP ERASE © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 54 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.4 Signal Description The DSU uses three signals to function. Signal Name Type Description RESET Digital Input External reset SWCLK Digital Input SW clock SWDIO Digital I/O SW bidirectional data pin Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 12.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. 12.5.1 I/O Lines The SWCLK pin is by default assigned to the DSU module to allow debugger probe detection and to stretch the CPU reset phase. For more information, refer to 12.6.3. Debugger Probe Detection. The Hot-Plugging feature depends on the PORT configuration. If the SWCLK pin function is changed in the PORT or if the PORT_MUX is disabled, the Hot-Plugging feature is disabled until a power-reset or an external reset is performed. 12.5.2 Power Management The DSU will continue to operate in Idle mode. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 12.5.3 Clocks The DSU bus clocks (CLK_DSU_APB and CLK_DSU_AHB) can be enabled and disabled by the Power Manager. Refer to PM – Power Manager Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 12.5.4 Interrupts Not applicable. 12.5.5 Events Not applicable. 12.5.6 Register Access Protection Registers with write-access can be optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC), except for the following: • • Debug Communication Channel 0 register (DCC0) Debug Communication Channel 1 register (DCC1) Note:  Optional write-protection is indicated by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in the register description. Write-protection does not apply for accesses through an external debugger. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 55 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.5.7 Analog Connections Not applicable. 12.6 12.6.1 Debug Operation Principle of Operation The DSU provides basic services to allow on-chip debug using the ARM Debug Access Port and the ARM processor debug resources: • CPU reset extension • Debugger probe detection For more details on the ARM debug components, refer to the ARM Debug Interface v5 Architecture Specification. 12.6.2 CPU Reset Extension “CPU reset extension” refers to the extension of the reset phase of the CPU core after the external reset is released. This ensures that the CPU is not executing code at startup while a debugger is connects to the system. The debugger is detected on a RESET release event when SWCLK is low. At startup, SWCLK is internally pulled up to avoid false detection of a debugger if the SWCLK pin is left unconnected. When the CPU is held in the reset extension phase, the CPU Reset Extension bit of the Status A register (STATUSA.CRSTEXT) is set. To release the CPU, write a '1' to STATUSA.CRSTEXT. STATUSA.CRSTEXT will then be set to '0'. Writing a '0' to STATUSA.CRSTEXT has no effect. For security reasons, it is not possible to release the CPU reset extension when the device is protected by the NVMCTRL security bit. Trying to do so sets the Protection Error bit (PERR) of the Status A register (STATUSA.PERR). Figure 12-2. Typical CPU Reset Extension Set and Clear Timing Diagram SWCLK RESET DSU CRSTEXT Clear CPU reset extension CPU_STATE reset running Related Links 20. NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.6.6. Security Bit 12.6.3 Debugger Probe Detection 12.6.3.1 Cold Plugging Cold-Plugging is the detection of a debugger when the system is in reset. Cold-Plugging is detected when the CPU reset extension is requested, as described above. 12.6.3.2 Hot Plugging Hot-Plugging is the detection of a debugger probe when the system is not in reset. Hot-Plugging is not possible under reset because the detector is reset when POR or RESET are asserted. Hot-Plugging is active when a SWCLK falling edge is detected. The SWCLK pad is multiplexed with other functions and the user must ensure that its © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 56 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit default function is assigned to the debug system. If the SWCLK function is changed, the Hot-Plugging feature is disabled until a power-reset or external reset occurs. Availability of the Hot-Plugging feature can be read from the Hot-Plugging Enable bit of the Status B register (STATUSB.HPE). Figure 12-3. Hot-Plugging Detection Timing Diagram SWCLK RESET CPU_STATE reset running Hot-Plugging The presence of a debugger probe is detected when either Hot-Plugging or Cold-Plugging is detected. Once detected, the Debugger Present bit of the Status B register (STATUSB.DBGPRES) is set. For security reasons, Hot-Plugging is not available when the device is protected by the NVMCTRL security bit. This detection requires that pads are correctly powered. Thus, at cold startup, this detection cannot be done until POR is released. If the device is protected, Cold-Plugging is the only way to detect a debugger probe, and so the external reset timing must be longer than the POR timing. If external reset is deasserted before POR release, the user must retry the procedure above until it gets connected to the device. Related Links 20. NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.6.6. Security Bit 12.7 Chip Erase Chip-Erase consists of removing all sensitive information stored in the chip and clearing the NVMCTRL security bit. Therefore, all volatile memories and the Flash memory (including the EEPROM Emulation area) will be erased. The Flash auxiliary rows, including the user row, will not be erased. When the device is protected, the debugger must first reset the device in order to be detected. This ensures that internal registers are reset after the protected state is removed. The Chip-Erase operation is triggered by writing a '1' to the Chip-Erase bit in the Control register (CTRL.CE). This command will be discarded if the DSU is protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC). Once issued, the module clears volatile memories prior to erasing the Flash array. To ensure that the Chip-Erase operation is completed, check the Done bit of the Status A register (STATUSA.DONE). The Chip-Erase operation depends on clocks and power management features that can be altered by the CPU. For that reason, it is recommended to issue a Chip- Erase after a Cold-Plugging procedure to ensure that the device is in a known and safe state. The recommended sequence is as follows: 1. Issue the Cold-Plugging procedure (refer to 12.6.3.1. Cold Plugging). The device then: a. Detects the debugger probe. b. Holds the CPU in reset. 2. Issue the Chip-Erase command by writing a '1' to CTRL.CE. The device then: a. Clears the system volatile memories. b. Erases the whole Flash array (including the EEPROM Emulation area, not including auxiliary rows). c. Erases the lock row, removing the NVMCTRL security bit protection. 3. Check for completion by polling STATUSA.DONE (read as '1' when completed). 4. Reset the device to let the NVMCTRL update the fuses. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 57 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.8 Programming Programming the Flash or RAM memories is only possible when the device is not protected by the NVMCTRL security bit. The programming procedure is as follows: 1. At power up, RESET is driven low by a debugger. The on-chip regulator holds the system in a POR state until the input supply is above the POR threshold (refer to Powe-On Reset (POR) characteristics). The system continues to be held in this static state until the internally regulated supplies have reached a safe operating state. 2. The PM starts, clocks are switched to the slow clock (Core Clock, System Clock, Flash Clock and any Bus Clocks that do not have clock gate control). Internal resets are maintained due to the external reset. 3. The debugger maintains a low level on SWCLK. RESET is released, resulting in a debugger Cold-Plugging procedure. 4. The debugger generates a clock signal on the SWCLK pin, the Debug Access Port (DAP) receives a clock. 5. The CPU remains in Reset due to the Cold-Plugging procedure; meanwhile, the rest of the system is released. 6. A Chip-Erase is issued to ensure that the Flash is fully erased prior to programming. 7. Programming is available through the AHB-AP. 8. After the operation is completed, the chip can be restarted either by asserting RESET or toggling power. Make sure that the SWCLK pin is high when releasing RESET to prevent extending the CPU reset. Related Links 20. NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.6.6. Security Bit 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 32.10.2. Power-On Reset (POR) Characteristics 12.9 Intellectual Property Protection Intellectual property protection consists of restricting access to internal memories from external tools when the device is protected, and this is accomplished by setting the NVMCTRL security bit. This protected state can be removed by issuing a Chip-Erase (refer to 12.7. Chip Erase). When the device is protected, read/write accesses using the AHB-AP are limited to the DSU address range and DSU commands are restricted. When issuing a Chip-Erase, sensitive information is erased from volatile memory and Flash. The DSU implements a security filter that monitors the AHB transactions inside the DAP. If the device is protected, then AHB-AP read/write accesses outside the DSU external address range are discarded, causing an error response that sets the ARM AHB-AP sticky error bits (refer to the ARM Debug Interface v5 Architecture Specification on www.arm.com). The DSU is intended to be accessed either: • Internally from the CPU, without any limitation, even when the device is protected • Externally from a debug adapter, with some restrictions when the device is protected For security reasons, DSU features have limitations when used from a debug adapter. To differentiate external accesses from internal ones, the first 0x100 bytes of the DSU register map has been mirrored at offset 0x100: • The first 0x100 bytes form the internal address range • The next 0x100 bytes form the external address range When the device is protected, the DAP can only issue MEM-AP accesses in the DSU range 0x0100-0x2000. The DSU operating registers are located in the 0x0000-0x00FF area and remapped in 0x0100-0x01FF to differentiate accesses coming from a debugger and the CPU. If the device is protected and an access is issued in the region 0x0100-0x01FF, it is subject to security restrictions. For more information, refer to the Table 12-1. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 58 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit Figure 12-4. APB Memory Mapping 0x0000 DSU operating registers Internal address range (cannot be accessed from debug tools when the device is protected by the NVMCTRL security bit) 0x00FF 0x0100 Mirrored DSU operating registers 0x01FF Empty External address range (can be accessed from debug tools with some restrictions) 0x1000 DSU CoreSight ROM 0x1FFF Some features not activated by APB transactions are not available when the device is protected: Table 12-1. Feature Availability Under Protection Features Availability when the device is protected CPU Reset Extension Yes Clear CPU Reset Extension No Debugger Cold-Plugging Yes Debugger Hot-Plugging No Related Links 20. NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.6.6. Security Bit 12.10 Device Identification Device identification relies on the ARM CoreSight component identification scheme, which allows the chip to be identified as a SAM device implementing a DSU. The DSU contains identification registers to differentiate the device. 12.10.1 CoreSight Identification A system-level ARM® CoreSight™ ROM table is present in the device to identify the vendor and the chip identification method. Its address is provided in the MEM-AP BASE register inside the ARM Debug Access Port. The CoreSight ROM implements a 64-bit conceptual ID composed as follows from the PID0 to PID7 CoreSight ROM Table registers: © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 59 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit Figure 12-5. Conceptual 64-bit Peripheral ID Table 12-2. Conceptual 64-Bit Peripheral ID Bit Descriptions Field Size Description Location JEP-106 CC code 4 Continuation code: 0x0 PID4 JEP-106 ID code 7 Device ID: 0x1F PID1+PID2 4KB count 4 Indicates that the CoreSight component is a ROM: 0x0 PID4 RevAnd 4 Not used; read as 0 PID3 CUSMOD 4 Not used; read as 0 PID3 PARTNUM 12 Contains 0xCD0 to indicate that DSU is present PID0+PID1 REVISION 4 DSU revision (starts at 0x0 and increments by 1 at both major and minor revisions). Identifies DSU identification method variants. If 0x0, this indicates that device identification can be completed by reading the Device Identification register (DID) PID2 For more information, refer to the ARM Debug Interface Version 5 Architecture Specification. 12.10.2 Chip Identification Method The DSU DID register identifies the device by implementing the following information: • • • • 12.11 Processor identification Product family identification Product series identification Device select Functional Description 12.11.1 Principle of Operation The DSU provides memory services, such as CRC32 or MBIST that require almost the same interface. Hence, the Address, Length and Data registers (ADDR, LENGTH, DATA) are shared. These shared registers must be configured first; then a command can be issued by writing the Control register. When a command is ongoing, other commands are discarded until the current operation is completed. Hence, the user must wait for the STATUSA.DONE bit to be set prior to issuing another one. 12.11.2 Basic Operation 12.11.2.1 Initialization The module is enabled by enabling its clocks. For more details, refer to 12.5.3. Clocks. The DSU registers can be PAC write-protected. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 60 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.11.2.2 Operation From a Debug Adapter Debug adapters should access the DSU registers in the external address range 0x100 – 0x2000. If the device is protected by the NVMCTRL security bit, accessing the first 0x100 bytes causes the system to return an error. Refer to 12.9. Intellectual Property Protection. Related Links 20. NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.6.6. Security Bit 12.11.2.3 Operation From the CPU There are no restrictions when accessing DSU registers from the CPU. However, the user should access DSU registers in the internal address range (0x0 – 0x100) to avoid external security restrictions. Refer to 12.9. Intellectual Property Protection. 12.11.3 32-bit Cyclic Redundancy Check CRC32 The DSU unit provides support for calculating a cyclic redundancy check (CRC32) value for a memory area (including Flash and AHB RAM). When the CRC32 command is issued from: • The internal range, the CRC32 can be operated at any memory location • The external range, the CRC32 operation is restricted; DATA, ADDR, and LENGTH values are forced (see below) Table 12-3. AMOD Bit Descriptions when Operating CRC32 AMOD[1:0] Short name External range restrictions 0 ARRAY CRC32 is restricted to the full Flash array area (EEPROM Emulation area not included) DATA forced to 0xFFFFFFFF before calculation (no seed) 1 EEPROM CRC32 of the whole EEPROM Emulation area DATA forced to 0xFFFFFFFF before calculation (no seed) 2-3 Reserved The algorithm employed is the industry standard CRC32 algorithm using the generator polynomial 0xEDB88320 (reversed representation). 12.11.3.1 Starting CRC32 Calculation CRC32 calculation for a memory range is started after writing the start address into the Address register (ADDR) and the size of the memory range into the Length register (LENGTH). Both must be word-aligned. The initial value used for the CRC32 calculation must be written to the Data register (DATA). This value will usually be 0xFFFFFFFF, but can be, for example, the result of a previous CRC32 calculation if generating a common CRC32 of separate memory blocks. Once completed, the calculated CRC32 value can be read out of the Data register. The read value must be complemented to match standard CRC32 implementations or kept non-inverted if used as starting point for subsequent CRC32 calculations. If the device is in protected state by the NVMCTRL security bit, it is only possible to calculate the CRC32 of the entire Flash array when operated from the external debug interface, where the Address, Length, and Data registers will be forced to predefined values once the CRC32 operation is started, and values written by the user are ignored. Such restriction is not applicable when the DSU is accessed by the CPU using the internal address range, as shown in Figure 12-4. The actual test is started by writing a '1' in the 32-bit Cyclic Redundancy Check bit of the Control register (CTRL.CRC). A running CRC32 operation can be canceled by resetting the module (writing '1' to CTRL.SWRST). Related Links 20. NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.6.6. Security Bit © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 61 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.11.3.2 Interpreting the Results The user should monitor the Status A register. When the operation is completed, STATUSA.DONE is set. Then the Bus Error bit of the Status A register (STATUSA.BERR) must be read to ensure that no bus error occurred. 12.11.4 Debug Communication Channels The Debug Communication Channels (DCCO and DCC1) consist of a pair of registers with associated handshake logic, accessible by both CPU and debugger even if the device is protected by the NVMCTRL security bit. The registers can be used to exchange data between the CPU and the debugger, during run time as well as in debug mode. This enables the user to build a custom debug protocol using only these registers. The DCC0 and DCC1 registers are accessible when the protected state is active. When the device is protected, however, it is not possible to connect a debugger while the CPU is running (STATUSA.CRSTEXT is not writable and the CPU is held under Reset). Two Debug Communication Channel status bits in the Status B registers (STATUS.DCCDx) indicate whether a new value has been written in DCC0 or DCC1. These bits, DCC0D and DCC1D, are located in the STATUSB registers. They are automatically set on write and cleared on read. Note:  The DCC0 and DCC1 registers are shared with the on-board memory testing logic (MBIST). Accordingly, DCC0 and DCC1 must not be used while performing MBIST operations. Related Links 20. NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.6.6. Security Bit 12.11.5 Testing of On-Board Memories MBIST The DSU implements a feature for automatic testing of memory, also known as MBIST (memory built-in self test). This is primarily intended for production test of on-board memories. MBIST cannot be operated from the external address range when the device is protected by the NVMCTRL security bit. If an MBIST command is issued when the device is protected, a protection error is reported in the Protection Error bit in the Status A register (STATUSA.PERR). 1. Algorithm The algorithm used for testing is a type of March algorithm called "March LR". This algorithm is able to detect a wide range of memory defects, while still keeping a linear run time. The algorithm is: a. b. c. d. e. f. Write entire memory to '0', in any order. Bit by bit read '0', write '1', in descending order. Bit by bit read '1', write '0', read '0', write '1', in ascending order. Bit by bit read '1', write '0', in ascending order. Bit by bit read '0', write '1', read '1', write '0', in ascending order. Read '0' from entire memory, in ascending order. The specific implementation used as a run time which depends on the CPU clock frequency and the number of bytes tested in the RAM. The detected faults are: 2. – Address decoder faults – Stuck-at faults – Transition faults – Coupling faults – Linked Coupling faults Starting MBIST To test a memory, you need to write the start address of the memory to the ADDR.ADDR bit field, and the size of the memory into the Length register. For best test coverage, an entire physical memory block should be tested at once. It is possible to test only a subset of a memory, but the test coverage will then be somewhat lower. The actual test is started by writing a '1' to CTRL.MBIST. A running MBIST operation can be canceled by writing a '1' to CTRL.SWRST. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 62 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 3. 4. Interpreting the Results The tester should monitor the STATUSA register. When the operation is completed, STATUSA.DONE is set. There are two different modes: – ADDR.AMOD=0: exit-on-error (default) In this mode, the algorithm terminates either when a fault is detected or on successful completion. In both cases, STATUSA.DONE is set. If an error was detected, STATUSA.FAIL will be set. User then can read the DATA and ADDR registers to locate the fault. – ADDR.AMOD=1: pause-on-error In this mode, the MBIST algorithm is paused when an error is detected. In such a situation, only STATUSA.FAIL is asserted. The state machine waits for user to clear STATUSA.FAIL by writing a '1' in STATUSA.FAIL to resume. Prior to resuming, user can read the DATA and ADDR registers to locate the fault. Locating Faults If the test stops with STATUSA.FAIL set, one or more bits failed the test. The test stops at the first detected error. The position of the failing bit can be found by reading the following registers: – ADDR: Address of the word containing the failing bit – DATA: contains data to identify which bit failed, and during which phase of the test it failed. The DATA register will in this case contains the following bit groups: Figure 12-6. DATA bits Description When MBIST Operation Returns an Error Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 Bit 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 phase Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 0 1 bit_index • • bit_index: contains the bit number of the failing bit phase: indicates which phase of the test failed and the cause of the error, as listed in the following table. Table 12-4. MBIST Operation Phases Phase Test actions 0 Write all bits to zero. This phase cannot fail. 1 Read '0', write '1', increment address 2 Read '1', write '0' 3 Read '0', write '1', decrement address 4 Read '1', write '0', decrement address 5 Read '0', write '1' 6 Read '1', write '0', decrement address 7 Read all zeros. bit_index is not used © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 63 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit Table 12-5. AMOD Bit Descriptions for MBIST AMOD[1:0] Description 0x0 Exit on Error 0x1 Pause on Error 0x2, 0x3 Reserved Related Links 20. NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.6.6. Security Bit 9.2. Physical Memory Map 12.11.6 System Services Availability when Accessed Externally and Device is Protected External access: Access performed in the DSU address offset 0x200-0x1FFF range. Internal access: Access performed in the DSU address offset 0x000-0x100 range. Table 12-6. Available Features when Operated From The External Address Range and Device is Protected Features Availability From The External Address Range and Device is Protected Chip-Erase command and status Yes CRC32 Yes, only full array (EEPROM Emulation area not included) or full EEPROM Emulation CoreSight Compliant Device identification Yes Debug communication channels Yes Testing of onboard memories (MBIST) No STATUSA.CRSTEXT clearing No (STATUSA.PERR is set when attempting to do so) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 64 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.12 Register Summary Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 CTRL STATUSA STATUSB Reserved 7:0 7:0 7:0 0x04 ADDR 0x08 LENGTH 0x0C DATA 0x10 DCC0 0x14 DCC1 0x18 DID 0x1C ... 0x0FFF 0x1000 ENTRY0 ENTRY1 0x1008 END 0x100C ... 0x1FCB Reserved 0x1FD0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CE PERR HPE MBIST FAIL DCCD1 CRC BERR DCCD0 CRSTEXT DBGPRES SWRST DONE PROT ADDR[5:0] AMOD[1:0] ADDR[13:6] ADDR[21:14] ADDR[29:22] LENGTH[5:0] LENGTH[13:6] LENGTH[21:14] LENGTH[29:22] DATA[7:0] DATA[15:8] DATA[23:16] DATA[31:24] DATA[7:0] DATA[15:8] DATA[23:16] DATA[31:24] DATA[7:0] DATA[15:8] DATA[23:16] DATA[31:24] DEVSEL[7:0] DIE[3:0] REVISION[3:0] FAMILY[0] SERIES[5:0] PROCESSOR[3:0] FAMILY[4:1] Reserved 0x1004 0x1FCC 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7 MEMTYPE PID4 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries FMT EPRES FMT EPRES ADDOFF[3:0] ADDOFF[11:4] ADDOFF[19:12] ADDOFF[3:0] ADDOFF[11:4] ADDOFF[19:12] END[7:0] END[15:8] END[23:16] END[31:24] SMEMP FKBC[3:0] JEPCC[3:0] Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 65 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit ...........continued Offset Name 0x1FD4 ... 0x1FDF Reserved 0x1FE0 0x1FE4 0x1FE8 0x1FEC 0x1FF0 0x1FF4 0x1FF8 0x1FFC 12.13 PID0 PID1 PID2 PID3 CID0 CID1 CID2 CID3 Bit Pos. 7 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 PARTNBL[7:0] JEPIDCL[3:0] PARTNBH[3:0] REVISION[3:0] JEPU REVAND[3:0] JEPIDCH[2:0] CUSMOD[3:0] PREAMBLEB0[7:0] CCLASS[3:0] PREAMBLE[3:0] PREAMBLEB2[7:0] PREAMBLEB3[7:0] Register Description Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16- and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers are optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC). Optional PAC writeprotection is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. For details, refer to Register Access Protection. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 66 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.1 Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 CTRL 0x0000 0x00 PAC Write-Protection 6 5 Access Reset 4 CE W 0 3 MBIST W 0 2 CRC W 0 1 0 SWRST W 0 Bit 4 – CE Chip-Erase Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit starts the Chip-Erase operation. Bit 3 – MBIST Memory Built-In Self-Test Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit starts the memory BIST algorithm. Bit 2 – CRC 32-bit Cyclic Redundancy Check Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit starts the cyclic redundancy check algorithm. Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit resets the module. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 67 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.2 Status A Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 STATUSA 0x0001 0x00 PAC Write-Protection 6 5 Access Reset 4 PERR R/W 0 3 FAIL R/W 0 2 BERR R/W 0 1 CRSTEXT R/W 0 0 DONE R/W 0 Bit 4 – PERR Protection Error Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit clears the Protection Error bit. This bit is set when a command that is not allowed in protected state is issued. Bit 3 – FAIL Failure Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit clears the Failure bit. This bit is set when a DSU operation failure is detected. Bit 2 – BERR Bus Error Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit clears the Bus Error bit. This bit is set when a bus error is detected. Bit 1 – CRSTEXT CPU Reset Phase Extension Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit clears the CPU Reset Phase Extension bit. This bit is set when a debug adapter Cold-Plugging is detected, which extends the CPU reset phase. Bit 0 – DONE Done Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit clears the Done bit. This bit is set when a DSU operation is completed. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 68 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.3 Status B Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit STATUSB 0x0002 0x1X PAC Write-Protection 7 6 Access Reset 5 4 HPE R 1 3 DCCD1 R 0 2 DCCD0 R 0 1 DBGPRES R 0 0 PROT R 0 Bit 4 – HPE Hot-Plugging Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit has no effect. This bit is set when Hot-Plugging is enabled. This bit is cleared when Hot-Plugging is disabled. This is the case when the SWCLK function is changed. Only a power-reset or a external reset can set it again. Bits 2, 3 – DCCDx Debug Communication Channel x Dirty [x=1..0] Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit has no effect. This bit is set when DCCx is written. This bit is cleared when DCCx is read. Bit 1 – DBGPRES Debugger Present Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit has no effect. This bit is set when a debugger probe is detected. This bit is never cleared. Bit 0 – PROT Protected Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit has no effect. This bit is set at power-up when the device is protected. This bit is never cleared. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 69 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.4 Address Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit ADDR 0x0004 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection 31 30 29 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 23 22 21 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 28 27 ADDR[29:22] R/W R/W 0 0 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 4 3 2 1 20 19 ADDR[21:14] R/W R/W 0 0 12 ADDR[13:6] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 0 ADDR[5:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 AMOD[1:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 31:2 – ADDR[29:0] Address Initial word start address needed for memory operations. Bits 1:0 – AMOD[1:0] Access Mode The functionality of these bits is dependent on the operation mode. Bit description when operating CRC32: refer to 12.11.3. 32-bit Cyclic Redundancy Check CRC32 Bit description when testing onboard memories (MBIST): refer to 12.11.5. Testing of On-Board Memories MBIST © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 70 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.5 Length Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset LENGTH 0x0008 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection 31 30 29 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 23 22 21 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 R/W 0 R/W 0 28 27 LENGTH[29:22] R/W R/W 0 0 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 20 19 LENGTH[21:14] R/W R/W 0 0 12 11 LENGTH[13:6] R/W R/W 0 0 4 LENGTH[5:0] R/W R/W 0 0 Bits 31:2 – LENGTH[29:0] Length Length in words needed for memory operations. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 71 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.6 Data Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit DATA 0x000C 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection 31 30 29 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 23 22 21 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 28 27 DATA[31:24] R/W R/W 0 0 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 20 19 DATA[23:16] R/W R/W 0 0 12 DATA[15:8] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 DATA[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 31:0 – DATA[31:0] Data Memory operation initial value or result value. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 72 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.7 Debug Communication Channel 0 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit DCC0 0x0010 0x00000000 - 31 30 29 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 23 22 21 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 28 27 DATA[31:24] R/W R/W 0 0 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 20 19 DATA[23:16] R/W R/W 0 0 12 DATA[15:8] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 DATA[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 31:0 – DATA[31:0] Data Data register. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 73 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.8 Debug Communication Channel 1 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit DCC1 0x0014 0x00000000 - 31 30 29 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 23 22 21 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 28 27 DATA[31:24] R/W R/W 0 0 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 20 19 DATA[23:16] R/W R/W 0 0 12 DATA[15:8] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 DATA[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 31:0 – DATA[31:0] Data Data register. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 74 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.9 Device Identification Name:  Offset:  Property:  DID 0x0018 PAC Write-Protection The information in this register is related to the Ordering Information. Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 31 30 29 PROCESSOR[3:0] R R p p 28 R p R f 23 FAMILY[0] R f 22 20 19 15 14 R p 21 27 26 25 24 R f R f R f 18 17 16 FAMILY[4:1] SERIES[5:0] R s R s R s R s R s R s 13 12 11 8 R r 10 9 REVISION[3:0] R R r r R r 3 2 1 0 R x R x R x R x DIE[3:0] Access Reset R d R d R d R d Bit 7 6 5 4 DEVSEL[7:0] Access Reset R x R x R x R x Bits 31:28 – PROCESSOR[3:0] Processor The value of this field defines the processor used on the device. For this device, the value of this field is 0x1, corresponding to a microcontroller embedding an Arm Cortex-M0+ processor. Bits 27:23 – FAMILY[4:0] Product Family The value of this field corresponds to the product family part of the ordering code. For this device, the value of this field is 0x0, corresponding to the General Purpose Family. Bits 21:16 – SERIES[5:0] Product Series The value of this field corresponds to the product series part of the ordering code. For this device, the value of this field is 0x00 corresponding to an Arm Cortex-M0+ processor with basic feature set. Bits 15:12 – DIE[3:0] Die Number Identifies the die family. For this device, the value of this field is 0x0 (for revisions B and C of Variant A) or 0x1. Bits 11:8 – REVISION[3:0] Revision Number Identifies the die revision number. 0x0=rev.A, 0x1=rev.B etc. Note:  The device variant (last letter of the ordering number) is independent of the die revision (DSU.DID.REVISION): The device variant denotes functional differences, whereas the die revision marks evolution of the die. Bits 7:0 – DEVSEL[7:0] Device Selection This bit field identifies a device within a product family and product series. Refer to the SAM D20 Family Silicon Errata and Data Sheet Clarification document for matching the DEVSEL value with the associated part number. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 75 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.10 CoreSight ROM Table Entry 0 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  ENTRY0 0x1000 0xXXXXX00X PAC Write-Protection Bit 31 30 29 28 27 ADDOFF[19:12] R R x x 26 25 24 Access Reset R x R x R x R x R x R x Bit 23 22 21 18 17 16 R x 20 19 ADDOFF[11:4] R R x x Access Reset R x R x R x R x R x Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 FMT R 1 0 EPRES R x ADDOFF[3:0] Access Reset R x R x R x R x Bit 7 6 5 4 Access Reset Bits 31:12 – ADDOFF[19:0] Address Offset The base address of the component, relative to the base address of this ROM table. Bit 1 – FMT Format Always reads as '1', indicating a 32-bit ROM table. Bit 0 – EPRES Entry Present This bit indicates whether an entry is present at this location in the ROM table. This bit is set at power-up if the device is not protected indicating that the entry is not present. This bit is cleared at power-up if the device is not protected indicating that the entry is present. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 76 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.11 CoreSight ROM Table Entry 1 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  ENTRY1 0x1004 0xXXXXX00X PAC Write-Protection Bit 31 30 29 28 27 ADDOFF[19:12] R R x x 26 25 24 Access Reset R x R x R x R x R x R x Bit 23 22 21 18 17 16 R x 20 19 ADDOFF[11:4] R R x x Access Reset R x R x R x R x R x Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 FMT R 1 0 EPRES R x ADDOFF[3:0] Access Reset R x R x R x R x Bit 7 6 5 4 Access Reset Bits 31:12 – ADDOFF[19:0] Address Offset The base address of the component, relative to the base address of this ROM table. Bit 1 – FMT Format Always read as '1', indicating a 32-bit ROM table. Bit 0 – EPRES Entry Present This bit indicates whether an entry is present at this location in the ROM table. This bit is set at power-up if the device is not protected indicating that the entry is not present. This bit is cleared at power-up if the device is not protected indicating that the entry is present. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 77 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.12 CoreSight ROM Table End Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit END 0x1008 0x00000000 - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 19 18 17 16 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 11 10 9 8 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 3 2 1 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 END[31:24] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bit 23 22 21 20 END[23:16] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 END[15:8] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 END[7:0] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bits 31:0 – END[31:0] End Marker Indicates the end of the CoreSight ROM table entries. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 78 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.13 CoreSight ROM Table Memory Type Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit MEMTYPE 0x1FCC 0x0000000x - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 SMEMP R x Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 0 – SMEMP System Memory Present This bit indicates whether system memory is present on the bus that connects to the ROM table. This bit is set at power-up if the device is not protected, indicating that the system memory is accessible from a debug adapter. This bit is cleared at power-up if the device is protected, indicating that the system memory is not accessible from a debug adapter. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 79 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.14 Peripheral Identification 4 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit PID4 0x1FD0 0x00000000 - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R 0 R 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit FKBC[3:0] Access Reset R 0 R 0 JEPCC[3:0] R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bits 7:4 – FKBC[3:0] 4KB Count These bits will always return zero when read, indicating that this debug component occupies one 4KB block. Bits 3:0 – JEPCC[3:0] JEP-106 Continuation Code These bits will always return zero when read. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 80 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.15 Peripheral Identification 0 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit PID0 0x1FE0 0x00000000 - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit PARTNBL[7:0] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bits 7:0 – PARTNBL[7:0] Part Number Low These bits will always return 0xD0 when read, indicating that this device implements a DSU module instance. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 81 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.16 Peripheral Identification 1 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit PID1 0x1FE4 0x000000FC - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 0 R 1 R 1 R 1 1 PARTNBH[3:0] R R 1 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit JEPIDCL[3:0] Access Reset R 1 R 1 R 0 Bits 7:4 – JEPIDCL[3:0] Low part of the JEP-106 Identity Code These bits will always return 0xF when read (JEP-106 identity code is 0x1F). Bits 3:0 – PARTNBH[3:0] Part Number High These bits will always return 0xC when read, indicating that this device implements a DSU module instance. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 82 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.17 Peripheral Identification 2 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit PID2 0x1FE8 0x00000009 - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 Bit 7 6 4 1 JEPIDCH[2:0] R 0 0 R 0 3 JEPU R 1 2 Access Reset 5 REVISION[3:0] R R 0 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 1 Bits 7:4 – REVISION[3:0] Revision Number Revision of the peripheral. Starts at 0x0 and increments by one at both major and minor revisions. Bit 3 – JEPU JEP-106 Identity Code is used This bit will always return one when read, indicating that JEP-106 code is used. Bits 2:0 – JEPIDCH[2:0] JEP-106 Identity Code High These bits will always return 0x1 when read, (JEP-106 identity code is 0x1F). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 83 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.18 Peripheral Identification 3 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit PID3 0x1FEC 0x00000000 - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R 0 R 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit REVAND[3:0] Access Reset R 0 R 0 CUSMOD[3:0] R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bits 7:4 – REVAND[3:0] Revision Number These bits will always return 0x0 when read. Bits 3:0 – CUSMOD[3:0] ARM CUSMOD These bits will always return 0x0 when read. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 84 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.19 Component Identification 0 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CID0 0x1FF0 0x0000000D - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 Bit 7 6 5 2 1 0 Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 4 3 PREAMBLEB0[7:0] R R 0 1 R 1 R 0 R 1 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bits 7:0 – PREAMBLEB0[7:0] Preamble Byte 0 These bits will always return 0x0000000D when read. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 85 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.20 Component Identification 1 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CID1 0x1FF4 0x00000010 - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 0 R 0 R 1 R 0 2 1 PREAMBLE[3:0] R R 0 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit CCLASS[3:0] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 Bits 7:4 – CCLASS[3:0] Component Class These bits will always return 0x1 when read indicating that this ARM CoreSight component is ROM table (refer to the ARM Debug Interface v5 Architecture Specification at http://www.arm.com). Bits 3:0 – PREAMBLE[3:0] Preamble These bits will always return 0x00 when read. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 86 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.21 Component Identification 2 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CID2 0x1FF8 0x00000005 - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 Bit 7 6 5 2 1 0 Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 4 3 PREAMBLEB2[7:0] R R 0 0 R 1 R 0 R 1 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bits 7:0 – PREAMBLEB2[7:0] Preamble Byte 2 These bits will always return 0x00000005 when read. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 87 SAM D20 Family DSU - Device Service Unit 12.13.22 Component Identification 3 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CID3 0x1FFC 0x000000B1 - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 Bit 7 6 5 2 1 0 Access Reset R 1 R 0 R 1 4 3 PREAMBLEB3[7:0] R R 1 0 R 0 R 0 R 1 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bits 7:0 – PREAMBLEB3[7:0] Preamble Byte 3 These bits will always return 0x000000B1 when read. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 88 SAM D20 Family Clock System 13. Clock System This chapter summarizes the clock distribution and terminology in the SAM D20 device. It will not explain every detail of its configuration. For in-depth documentation, see the respective peripherals descriptions and the Generic Clock documentation. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller Clock Distribution Figure 13-1. Clock distribution PM GCLK_DFLL48M_REF SYSCTRL XOSC GCLK Generator 0 GCLK Generator 1 XOSCP32K OSC8M DFLL48M Generic Clock Multiplexer 0 Main Clock Controller (DFLL48M Reference) OSCULP32K OSC32K GCLK_MAIN GCLK GCLK Generator x Generic Clock Multiplexer 1 Generic Clock Multiplexer y Peripheral 0 Generic Clocks Peripheral z AHB/APB System Clocks 13.1 The clock system on the SAM D20 consists of: • • Clock sources, controlled by SYSCTRL – A clock source provides a time base that is used by other components, such as Generic Clock Generators. Example clock sources are the internal 8MHz oscillator (OSC8M), External crystal oscillator (XOSC) and the Digital frequency locked loop (DFLL48M). Generic Clock Controller (GCLK) which controls the clock distribution system, made up of: • Generic Clock Generators: These are programmable prescalers that can use any of the system clock sources as a time base. The Generic Clock Generator 0 generates the clock signal GCLK_MAIN, which is used by the Power Manager, which in turn generates synchronous clocks. • • Generic Clocks: These are clock signals generated by Generic Clock Generators and output by the Generic Clock Multiplexer, and serve as clocks for the peripherals of the system. Multiple instances of a peripheral will typically have a separate Generic Clock for each instance. Generic Clock 0 serves as the clock source for the DFLL48M clock input (when multiplying another clock source). Power Manager (PM) • The PM generates and controls the synchronous clocks on the system. This includes the CPU, bus clocks (APB, AHB) as well as the synchronous (to the CPU) user interfaces of the peripherals. It contains clock masks that can turn on/off the user interface of a peripheral as well as prescalers for the CPU and bus clocks. The next figure shows an example where SERCOM0 is clocked by the DFLL48M in open loop mode. The DFLL48M is enabled, the Generic Clock Generator 1 uses the DFLL48M as its clock source and feeds into Peripheral Channel 20. The Generic Clock 20, also called GCLK_SERCOM0_CORE, is connected to SERCOM0. The SERCOM0 interface, clocked by CLK_SERCOM0_APB, has been unmasked in the APBC Mask register in the PM. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 89 SAM D20 Family Clock System Figure 13-2. Example of SERCOM clock PM Synchronous Clock Controller SYSCTRL DFLL48M 13.2 CLK_SERCOM0_APB GCLK Generic Clock Generator 1 Generic Clock Multiplexer 20 GCLK_SERCOM0_CORE SERCOM 0 Synchronous and Asynchronous Clocks As the CPU and the peripherals can be in different clock domains, i.e. they are clocked from different clock sources and/or with different clock speeds, some peripheral accesses by the CPU need to be synchronized. In this case the peripheral includes a SYNCBUSY status register that can be used to check if a sync operation is in progress. For a general description, see 13.3. Register Synchronization. Some peripherals have specific properties described in their individual sub-chapter “Synchronization”. In the datasheet, references to Synchronous Clocks are referring to the CPU and bus clocks, while asynchronous clocks are generated by the Generic Clock Controller (GCLK). 13.3 Register Synchronization There are two different register synchronization schemes implemented on this device: common synchronizer register synchronization and distributed synchronizer register synchronization. The modules using a common synchronizer register synchronization are: GCLK, WDT, RTC, EIC, TC, ADC, AC and DAC. The modules adopting a distributed synchronizer register synchronization are: SERCOM USART, SERCOM SPI, SERCOM I2C. 13.3.1 Common Synchronizer Register Synchronization 13.3.1.1 Overview All peripherals are composed of one digital bus interface connected to the APB or AHB bus and running from a corresponding clock in the Main Clock domain, and one peripheral core running from the peripheral Generic Clock (GCLK). Communication between these clock domains must be synchronized. This mechanism is implemented in hardware, so the synchronization process takes place even if the peripheral generic clock is running from the same clock source and on the same frequency as the bus interface. All registers in the bus interface are accessible without synchronization. All registers in the peripheral core are synchronized when written. Some registers in the peripheral core are synchronized when read. Each individual register description will have the properties "Read-Synchronized" and/or "Write-Synchronized" if a register is synchronized. As shown in the figure below, the common synchronizer is used for all registers in one peripheral. Therefore, status register (STATUS) of each peripheral can be synchronized at a time. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 90 SAM D20 Family Clock System Figure 13-3. Synchronization Asynchronous Domain (generic clock) Synchronous Domain (CLK_APB) Sync Non Synced reg Peripheral bus INTFLAG Write-Synced reg SYNCBUSY STATUS READREQ Synchronizer Write-Synced reg R/W-Synced reg 13.3.1.2 Write-Synchronization Write-Synchronization is triggered by writing to a register in the peripheral clock domain. The Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY) will be set when the write-synchronization starts and cleared when the write-synchronization is complete. Refer to 13.3.1.8. Synchronization Delay for details on the synchronization delay. When the write-synchronization is ongoing (STATUS.SYNCBUSY is one), any of the following actions will cause the peripheral bus to stall until the synchronization is complete: • • • Writing a generic clock peripheral core register Reading a read-synchronized peripheral core register Reading the register that is being written (and thus triggered the synchronization) Peripheral core registers without read-synchronization will remain static once they have been written and synchronized, and can be read while the synchronization is ongoing without causing the peripheral bus to stall. APB registers can also be read while the synchronization is ongoing without causing the peripheral bus to stall. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 91 SAM D20 Family Clock System 13.3.1.3 Read-Synchronization Reading a read-synchronized peripheral core register will cause the peripheral bus to stall immediately until the read-synchronization is complete. STATUS.SYNCBUSY will not be set. Refer to 13.3.1.8. Synchronization Delay for details on the synchronization delay. Note that reading a read-synchronized peripheral core register while STATUS.SYNCBUSY is one will cause the peripheral bus to stall twice; first because of the ongoing synchronization, and then again because reading a read-synchronized core register will cause the peripheral bus to stall immediately. 13.3.1.4 Completion of synchronization The user can either poll STATUS.SYNCBUSY or use the Synchronisation Ready interrupt (if available) to check when the synchronization is complete. It is also possible to perform the next read/write operation and wait, as this next operation will be started once the previous write/read operation is synchronized and/or complete. 13.3.1.5 Read Request The read request functionality is only available to peripherals that have the Read Request register (READREQ) implemented. Refer to the register description of individual peripheral chapters for details. To avoid forcing the peripheral bus to stall when reading read-synchronized peripheral core registers, the read request mechanism can be used. Basic Read Request Writing a '1' to the Read Request bit in the Read Request register (READREQ.RREQ) will request read-synchronization of the register specified in the Address bits in READREQ (READREQ.ADDR) and set STATUS.SYNCBUSY. When read-synchronization is complete, STATUS.SYNCBUSY is cleared. The readsynchronized value is then available for reading without delay until READREQ.RREQ is written to '1' again. The address to use is the offset to the peripheral's base address of the register that should be synchronized. Continuous Read Request Writing a '1' to the Read Continuously bit in READREQ (READREQ.RCONT) will force continuous readsynchronization of the register specified in READREQ.ADDR. The latest value is always available for reading without stalling the bus, as the synchronization mechanism is continuously synchronizing the given value. The READREQ.RCONT prevents READREQ.RREQ from clearing automatically. For the continuous read mode, the RREQ bit is required to be set once the RCONT bit is set. SYNCBUSY is set for the first synchronization, but not for the subsequent synchronizations. If another synchronization is attempted, i.e. by executing a write-operation of a write-synchronized register, the read request will be stopped, and will have to be manually restarted. Note:  The continuous read-synchronization is paused in sleep modes where the generic clock is not running. This means that a new read request is required if the value is needed immediately after exiting sleep. 13.3.1.6 Enable Write-Synchronization Writing to the Enable bit in the Control register (CTRL.ENABLE) will also trigger write-synchronization and set STATUS.SYNCBUSY. CTRL.ENABLE will read its new value immediately after being written. The Synchronisation Ready interrupt (if available) cannot be used for Enable write-synchronization. When the enable write-synchronization is ongoing (STATUS.SYNCBUSY is one), attempt to do any of the following will cause the peripheral bus to stall until the enable synchronization is complete: • • • Writing a peripheral core register Writing an APB register Reading a read-synchronized peripheral core register APB registers can be read while the enable write-synchronization is ongoing without causing the peripheral bus to stall. 13.3.1.7 Software Reset Write-Synchronization Writing a '1' to the Software Reset bit in CTRL (CTRL.SWRST) will also trigger write-synchronization and set STATUS.SYNCBUSY. When writing a '1' to the CTRL.SWRST bit it will immediately read as '1'. CTRL.SWRST and STATUS.SYNCBUSY will be cleared by hardware when the peripheral has been reset. Writing a zero to the © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 92 SAM D20 Family Clock System CTRL.SWRST bit has no effect. The Synchronisation Ready interrupt (if available) cannot be used for Software Reset write-synchronization. When the software reset is in progress (STATUS.SYNCBUSY and CTRL.SWRST are '1'), attempt to do any of the following will cause the peripheral bus to stall until the Software Reset synchronization and the reset is complete: • • • Writing a peripheral core register Writing an APB register Reading a read-synchronized register APB registers can be read while the software reset is being write-synchronized without causing the peripheral bus to stall. 13.3.1.8 Synchronization Delay The synchronization will delay write and read accesses by a certain amount. This delay D is within the range of: 5 × PGCLK + 2 × PAPB < D < 6 × PGCLK + 3 × PAPB 13.3.2 Where PGCLK is the period of the generic clock and PAPB is the period of the peripheral bus clock. A normal peripheral bus register access duration is 2 × PAPB. Distributed Synchronizer Register Synchronization 13.3.2.1 Overview All peripherals are composed of one digital bus interface connected to the APB or AHB bus and running from a corresponding clock in the Main Clock domain, and one peripheral core running from the peripheral Generic Clock (GCLK). Communication between these clock domains must be synchronized. This mechanism is implemented in hardware, so the synchronization process takes place even if the peripheral generic clock is running from the same clock source and on the same frequency as the bus interface. All registers in the bus interface are accessible without synchronization. All registers in the peripheral core are synchronized when written. Some registers in the peripheral core are synchronized when read. Registers that need synchronization has this denoted in each individual register description. 13.3.2.2 General Write synchronization Write-Synchronization is triggered by writing to a register in the peripheral clock domain. The respective bit in the Synchronization Busy register (SYNCBUSY) will be set when the write-synchronization starts and cleared when the write-synchronization is complete. Refer to 13.3.2.7. Synchronization Delay for details on the synchronization delay. When write-synchronization is ongoing for a register, any subsequent write attempts to this register will be discarded, and an error will be reported. Example: REGA, REGB are 8-bit peripheral core registers. REGC is 16-bit peripheral core register. Offset Register 0x00 REGA 0x01 REGB 0x02 REGC 0x03 Synchronization is per register, so multiple registers can be synchronized in parallel. Consequently, after REGA (8-bit access) was written, REGB (8-bit access) can be written immediately without error. REGC (16-bit access) can be written without affecting REGA or REGB. If REGC is written to in two consecutive 8-bit accesses without waiting for synchronization, the second write attempt will be discarded and an error is generated. A 32-bit access to offset 0x00 will write all three registers. Note that REGA, REGB and REGC can be updated at different times because of independent write synchronization. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 93 SAM D20 Family Clock System 13.3.2.3 General read synchronization Read-synchronized registers are synchronized when the register value is updated. During synchronization the corresponding bit in SYNCBUSY will be set. Reading a read-synchronized register will return its value immediately and the corresponding bit in SYNCBUSY will not be set. 13.3.2.4 Completion of synchronization In order to check if synchronization is complete, the user can either poll the relevant bits in SYNCBUSY or use the Synchronisation Ready interrupt (if available). The Synchronization Ready interrupt flag will be set when all ongoing synchronizations are complete, i.e. when all bits in SYNCBUSY are '0'. 13.3.2.5 Enable Write-Synchronization Setting the Enable bit in a module's Control register (CTRL.ENABLE) will also trigger write-synchronization and set SYNCBUSY.ENABLE. CTRL.ENABLE will read its new value immediately after being written. SYNCBUSY.ENABLE will be cleared by hardware when the operation is complete. The Synchronisation Ready interrupt (if available) cannot be used for Enable write-synchronization. 13.3.2.6 Software Reset Write-Synchronization Setting the Software Reset bit in CTRLA (CTRLA.SWRST=1) will trigger write-synchronization and set SYNCBUSY.SWRST. When writing a ‘1’ to the CTRLA.SWRST bit it will immediately read as ‘1’. CTRL.SWRST and SYNCBUSY.SWRST will be cleared by hardware when the peripheral has been reset. Writing a '0' to the CTRL.SWRST bit has no effect. The Ready interrupt (if available) cannot be used for Software Reset writesynchronization. 13.3.2.7 Synchronization Delay The synchronization will delay write and read accesses by a certain amount. This delay D is within the range of: 5 × PGCLK + 2 × PAPB < D < 6 × PGCLK + 3 × PAPB Where PGCLK is the period of the generic clock and PAPB is the period of the peripheral bus clock. A normal peripheral bus register access duration is 2 × PAPB. 13.4 Enabling a Peripheral In order to enable a peripheral that is clocked by a Generic Clock, the following parts of the system needs to be configured: • • • • 13.5 A running Clock Source. A clock from the Generic Clock Generator must be configured to use one of the running Clock Sources, and the Generator must be enabled. The Generic Clock Multiplexer that provides the Generic Clock signal to the peripheral must be configured to use a running Generic Clock Generator, and the Generic Clock must be enabled. The user interface of the peripheral needs to be unmasked in the PM. If this is not done the peripheral registers will read all 0’s and any writing attempts to the peripheral will be discarded. Disabling a Peripheral When disabling a peripheral and if a pin change interrupt is enabled on pins driven by the respective peripheral, a wake condition may be generated. If this happen the interrupt flag will not be set. As a consequence the system will not be able to identify the wake source. To avoid this, the interrupt enable register of the peripheral must be cleared (or the Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) Enable for the peripheral must be cleared) before disabling the peripheral. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 94 SAM D20 Family Clock System 13.6 On-demand, Clock Requests Figure 13-4. Clock request routing Clock request DFLL48M Generic Clock Generator ENABLE GENEN RUNSTDBY RUNSTDBY Clock request Generic Clock Multiplexer Clock request Peripheral ENABLE CLKEN RUNSTDBY ONDEMAND All clock sources in the system can be run in an on-demand mode: the clock source is in a stopped state unless a peripheral is requesting the clock source. Clock requests propagate from the peripheral, via the GCLK, to the clock source. If one or more peripheral is using a clock source, the clock source will be started/kept running. As soon as the clock source is no longer needed and no peripheral has an active request, the clock source will be stopped until requested again. The clock request can reach the clock source only if the peripheral, the generic clock and the clock from the Generic Clock Generator in-between are enabled. The time taken from a clock request being asserted to the clock source being ready is dependent on the clock source startup time, clock source frequency as well as the divider used in the Generic Clock Generator. The total startup time Tstart from a clock request until the clock is available for the peripheral is between: Tstart_max = Clock source startup time + 2 × clock source periods + 2 × divided clock source periods Tstart_min = Clock source startup time + 1 × clock source period + 1 × divided clock source period The time between the last active clock request stopped and the clock is shut down, Tstop, is between: Tstop_min = 1 × divided clock source period + 1 × clock source period Tstop_max = 2 × divided clock source periods + 2 × clock source periods The On-Demand function can be disabled individually for each clock source by clearing the ONDEMAND bit located in each clock source controller. Consequently, the clock will always run whatever the clock request status is. This has the effect of removing the clock source startup time at the cost of power consumption. The clock request mechanism can be configured to work in standby mode by setting the RUNSDTBY bits of the modules, see Figure 13-4. 13.7 Power Consumption vs. Speed When targeting for either a low-power or a fast acting system, some considerations have to be taken into account due to the nature of the asynchronous clocking of the peripherals: If clocking a peripheral with a very low clock, the active power consumption of the peripheral will be lower. At the same time the synchronization to the synchronous (CPU) clock domain is dependent on the peripheral clock speed, and will take longer with a slower peripheral clock. This will cause worse response times and longer synchronization delays. 13.8 Clocks after Reset On any reset the synchronous clocks start to their initial state: • • • OSC8M is enabled and divided by 8 Generic Generator 0 uses OSC8M as source and generates GCLK_MAIN CPU and BUS clocks are undivided On a Power Reset, the GCLK module starts to its initial state: • All Generic Clock Generators are disabled except © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 95 SAM D20 Family Clock System • – Generator 0 is using OSC8M as source without division and generates GCLK_MAIN – Generator 2 uses OSCULP32K as source without division All Generic Clocks are disabled except: – WDT Generic Clock uses the Generator 2 as source On a User Reset the GCLK module starts to its initial state, except for: • • Generic Clocks that are write-locked , i.e., the according WRTLOCK is set to 1 prior to Reset or WDT Generic Clock if the WDT Always-On at power on bit set in the NVM User Row Generic Clock is dedicated to the RTC if the RTC Generic Clock is enabled On any reset the clock sources are reset to their initial state except the 32KHz clock sources which are reset only by a power reset. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 96 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 14.1 Overview Depending on the application, peripherals may require specific clock frequencies to operate correctly. The Generic Clock controller GCLK provides nine Generic Clock Generators that can provide a wide range of clock frequencies. Generators can be set to use different external and internal oscillators as source. The clock of each Generator can be divided. The outputs from the Generators are used as sources for the Generic Clock Multiplexers, which provide the Generic Clock (GCLK_PERIPHERAL) to the peripheral modules, as shown in Generic Clock Controller Block Diagram. The number of Peripheral Clocks depends on how many peripherals the device has. Note:  The Generator 0 is always the direct source of the GCLK_MAIN signal. 14.2 Features • • • 14.3 Provides Generic Clocks Wide frequency range Clock source for the generator can be changed on the fly Block Diagram The generation of Peripheral Clock signals (GCLK_PERIPHERAL) and the Main Clock (GCLK_MAIN) can be seen in the figure below. Figure 14-1. Device Clocking Diagram GENERIC CLOCK CONTROLLER SYSCTRL Generic Clock Generator XOSC OSCULP32K Generic Clock Multiplexer OSC32K GCLK_PERIPHERAL XOSC32K OSC8M DFLL48M Clock Divider & Masker Clock Gate PERIPHERALS GCLK_IO GCLK_MAIN PM The GCLK block diagram is shown in the next figure. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 97 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller Figure 14-2. Generic Clock Controller Block Diagram(1) Generic Clock Generator 0 Clock Sources Clock Divider & Masker GCLK_IO[0] (I/O input) GCLK_MAIN GCLKGEN[0] Generic Clock Multiplexer 0 Clock Gate Generic Clock Generator 1 Clock Divider & Masker GCLK_IO[1] (I/O input) Generic Clock Multiplexer 1 GCLK_IO[0] (I/O output) GCLK_PERIPHERAL[0] GCLK_IO[1] (I/O output) GCLKGEN[1] Clock Gate GCLK_PERIPHERAL[1] Generic Clock Generator n Clock Divider & Masker GCLK_IO[n] (I/O input) GCLK_IO[n] (I/O output) GCLKGEN[n] Generic Clock Multiplexer m Clock Gate GCLK_PERIPHERAL[m] GCLKGEN[n:0] Note:  1. If GENCTRL.SRC=0x01(GCLKIN), the GCLK_IO is set as an input. 14.4 Signal Description Table 14-1. Signal Description Signal Name Type Description GCLK_IO[7:0] Digital I/O Clock source for Generators when input Generic Clock signal when output Refer to PORT Function Multiplexing table in I/O Multiplexing and Considerations for details on the pin mapping for this peripheral. Note:  One signal can be mapped on several pins. Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 14.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. 14.5.1 I/O Lines Using the GCLK I/O lines requires the I/O pins to be configured. Related Links 21. PORT - I/O Pin Controller 14.5.2 Power Management The GCLK can operate in sleep modes, if required. Refer to the sleep mode description in the Power Manager (PM) section. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 98 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 14.5.3 Clocks The GCLK bus clock (CLK_GCLK_APB) can be enabled and disabled in the Power Manager, and the default state of CLK_GCLK_APB can be found in the Peripheral Clock Masking section of PM – Power Manager. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 15.8.8. APBAMASK 14.5.4 Interrupts Not applicable. 14.5.5 Events Not applicable. 14.5.6 Debug Operation Not applicable. Related Links 18.8.19. FREQCORR 14.5.7 Register Access Protection All registers with write-access can be optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC). Note:  Optional write-protection is indicated by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in the register description. Write-protection does not apply for accesses through an external debugger. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller 14.5.8 Analog Connections Not applicable. 14.6 Functional Description 14.6.1 Principle of Operation The GCLK module is comprised of eight Generic Clock Generators (Generators) sourcing m Generic Clock Multiplexers. A clock source selected as input to a Generator can either be used directly, or it can be prescaled in the Generator. A generator output is used as input to one or more the Generic Clock Multiplexers to provide a peripheral (GCLK_PERIPHERAL). A generic clock can act as the clock to one or several of peripherals. 14.6.2 Basic Operation 14.6.2.1 Initialization Before a Generator is enabled, the corresponding clock source should be enabled. The Peripheral clock must be configured as outlined by the following steps: 1. The Generic Clock Generator division factor must be set by performing a single 32-bit write to the Generic Clock Generator Division register (GENDIV): – The Generic Clock Generator that will be selected as the source of the generic clock by setting the ID bit group (GENDIV.ID). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 99 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 2. 3. – The division factor must be selected by the DIV bit group (GENDIV.DIV) Note:  Refer to Generic Clock Generator Division register (GENDIV) for details. The generic clock generator must be enabled by performing a single 32-bit write to the Generic Clock Generator Control register (GENCTRL): – The Generic Clock Generator will be selected as the source of the generic clock by the ID bit group (GENCTRL.ID) – The Generic Clock generator must be enabled (GENCTRL.GENEN=1) Note:  Refer to Generic Clock Generator Control register (GENCTRL) for details. The generic clock must be configured by performing a single 16-bit write to the Generic Clock Control register (CLKCTRL): – The Generic Clock that will be configured via the ID bit group (CLKCTRL.ID) – The Generic Clock Generator used as the source of the generic clock by writing the GEN bit group (CLKCTRL.GEN) Note:  Refer to Generic Clock Control register (CLKCTRL) for details. Related Links 14.8.3. CLKCTRL 14.8.4. GENCTRL 14.8.5. GENDIV 14.6.2.2 Enabling, Disabling and Resetting The GCLK module has no enable/disable bit to enable or disable the whole module. The GCLK is reset by setting the Software Reset bit in the Control register (CTRL.SWRST) to 1. All registers in the GCLK will be reset to their initial state, except for Generic Clocks Multiplexer and associated Generators that have their Write Lock bit set to 1 (CLKCTRL.WRTLOCK). For further details, refer to 14.6.3.4. Configuration Lock. 14.6.2.3 Generic Clock Generator Each Generator (GCLK_GEN) can be set to run from one of eight different clock sources except GCLKGEN[1], which can be set to run from one of seven sources. GCLKGEN[1] is the only Generator that can be selected as source to other Generators but can not act as source to itself. Each generator GCLKGEN[x] can be connected to one specific pin GCLK_IO[x]. The GCLK_IO[x] can be set to act as source to GCLKGEN[x] or GCLK_IO[x] can be set up to output the clock generated by GCLKGEN[x]. The selected source can be divided. Each Generator can be enabled or disabled independently. Each GCLKGEN clock signal can then be used as clock source for Generic Clock Multiplexers. Each Generator output is allocated to one or several Peripherals. GCLKGEN[0], is used as GCLK_MAIN for the synchronous clock controller inside the Power Manager. Refer to PM-Power Manager for details on the synchronous clock generation. Figure 14-3. Generic Clock Generator GCLKGENSRC Clock Sources 0 GCLKGENSRC DIVIDER Clock Gate GCLKGEN[x] 1 GCLK_IO[x] GENCTRL.GENEN GENCTRL.SRC GENCTRL.DIVSEL GENDIV.DIV Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 100 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 14.6.2.4 Enabling a Generic Clock Generator A Generator is enabled by setting the Generic Clock Generator Enable bit in the Generic Clock Generator Control register (GENCTRL.GENEN=1). 14.6.2.5 Disabling a Generic Clock Generator A Generator is disabled by clearing GENCTRL.GENEN. When GENCTRL.GENEN=0, the GCLKGEN clock is disabled and clock gated. 14.6.2.6 Selecting a Clock Source for the Generic Clock Generator Each Generator can individually select a clock source by setting the Source Select bit group in GENCTRL (GENCTRL.SRC). Changing from one clock source, for example A, to another clock source, B, can be done on the fly: If clock source B is not ready, the Generator will continue running with clock source A. As soon as clock source B is ready, however, the generic clock generator will switch to it. During the switching operation, the Generator holds clock requests to clock sources A and B and then releases the clock source A request when the switch is done. The available clock sources are device dependent (usually the crystal oscillators, RC oscillators, PLL and DFLL). Only GCLKGEN[1] can be used as a common source for all other generators except Generator 1. 14.6.2.7 Changing Clock Frequency The selected source (GENCLKSRC) for a Generator can be divided by writing a division value in the Division Factor bit group in the Generic Clock Generator Division register (GENDIV.DIV). How the actual division factor is calculated is depending on the Divide Selection bit in GENCTRL (GENCTRL.DIVSEL), it can be interpreted in two ways by the integer divider. Note:  The number of DIV bits for each Generator is device dependent. Related Links 14.8.5. GENDIV 14.8.4. GENCTRL 14.6.2.8 Duty Cycle When dividing a clock with an odd division factor, the duty-cycle will not be 50/50. Writing the Improve Duty Cycle bit in GENCTRL (GENCTRL.IDC=1) will result in a 50/50 duty cycle. 14.6.2.9 Generic Clock Output on I/O Pins Each Generator's output can be directed to a GCLK_IO pin. If the Output Enable bit in GENCTRL is '1' (GENCTRL.OE=1) and the Generator is enabled (GENCTRL.GENEN=1), the Generator requests its clock source and the GCLKGEN clock is output to a GCLK_IO pin. If GENCTRL.OE=0, GCLK_IO is set according to the Output Off Value bit. If the Output Off Value bit in GENCTRL (GENCTRL.OOV) is zero, the output clock will be low when generic clock generator is turned off. If GENCTRL.OOV=1, the output clock will be high when Generator is turned off. In standby mode, if the clock is output (GENCTRL.OE=1), the clock on the GCLK_IO pin is frozen to the OOV value if the Run In Standby bit in GENCTRL (GENCTRL.RUNSTDBY) is zero. If GENCTRL.RUNSTDBY=1, the GCLKGEN clock is kept running and output to GCLK_IO. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 101 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 14.6.3 Generic Clock Figure 14-4. Generic Clock Multiplexer GCLKGEN[0] GCLKGEN[1] GCLKGEN[2] Clock Gate GCLKGEN[n] CLKCTRL.CLKEN GCLK_PERIPHERAL CLKCTRL.GEN 14.6.3.1 Enabling a Generic Clock Before a generic clock is enabled, one of the Generators must be selected as the source for the generic clock by writing to CLKCTRL.GEN. The clock source selection is individually set for each generic clock. When a Generator has been selected, the generic clock is enabled by setting the Clock Enable bit in CLKCTRL (CLKCTRL.CLKEN=1). The CLKCTRL.CLKEN bit must be synchronized to the generic clock domain. CLKCTRL.CLKEN will continue to read as its previous state until the synchronization is complete. 14.6.3.2 Disabling a Generic Clock A generic clock is disabled by writing CLKCTRL.CLKEN=0. The SYNCBUSY bit will be cleared when this writesynchronization is complete. CLKCTRL.CLKEN will stay in its previous state until the synchronization is complete. The generic clock is gated when disabled. 14.6.3.3 Selecting a Clock Source for the Generic Clock When changing a generic clock source by writing to CLKCTRL.GEN, the generic clock must be disabled before being re-enabled with the new clock source setting. This prevents glitches during the transition: 1. Write CLKCTRL.CLKEN=0 2. Assert that CLKCTRL.CLKEN reads '0' 3. Change the source of the generic clock by writing CLKCTRL.GEN 4. Re-enable the generic clock by writing CLKCTRL.CLKEN=1 14.6.3.4 Configuration Lock The generic clock configuration can be locked for further write accesses by setting the Write Lock bit in the CLKCTRL register (CLKCTRL.WRTLOCK). All writes to the CLKCTRL register will be ignored. It can only be unlocked by a Power Reset. The Generator source of a locked generic clock are also locked, too: The corresponding GENCTRL and GENDIV are locked, and can be unlocked only by a Power Reset. There is one exception concerning the GCLKGEN[0]. As it is used as GCLK_MAIN, it can not be locked. It is reset by any Reset and will start up in a known configuration. The software reset (CTRL.SWRST) can not unlock the registers. 14.6.4 Additional Features 14.6.4.1 Indirect Access The Generic Clock Generator Control and Division registers (GENCTRL and GENDIV) and the Generic Clock Control register (CLKCTRL) are indirectly addressed as shown in the next figure. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 102 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller Figure 14-5. GCLK Indirect Access User Interface GENCTRL GENDIV CLKCTRL GENCTRL.ID=i Generic Clock Generator [i] GENCTRL GENDIV.ID=i CLKCTRL.ID=j GENDIV Generic Clock[j] CLKCTRL Writing these registers is done by setting the corresponding ID bit group. To read a register, the user must write the ID of the channel, i, in the corresponding register. The value of the register for the corresponding ID is available in the user interface by a read access. For example, the sequence to read the GENCTRL register of generic clock generator i is: 1. Do an 8-bit write of the i value to GENCTRL.ID 2. Read the value of GENCTRL 14.6.4.2 Generic Clock Enable after Reset The Generic Clock Controller must be able to provide a generic clock to some specific peripherals after a reset. That means that the configuration of the Generators and generic clocks after Reset is device-dependent. Refer to GENCTRL.ID for details on GENCTRL reset. Refer to GENDIV.ID for details on GENDIV reset. Refer to CLKCTRL.ID for details on CLKCTRL reset. Related Links 14.8.3. CLKCTRL 14.8.4. GENCTRL 14.8.5. GENDIV 14.6.5 Sleep Mode Operation 14.6.5.1 Sleep Walking The GCLK module supports the Sleep Walking feature. If the system is in a sleep mode where the Generic Clocks are stopped, a peripheral that needs its clock in order to execute a process must request it from the Generic Clock Controller. The Generic Clock Controller receives this request, determines which Generic Clock Generator is involved and which clock source needs to be awakened. It then wakes up the respective clock source, enables the Generator and generic clock stages successively, and delivers the clock to the peripheral. 14.6.5.2 Run in Standby Mode In standby mode, the GCLK can continuously output the generator output to GCLK_IO. When set, the GCLK can continuously output the generator output to GCLK_IO. Refer to 14.6.2.9. Generic Clock Output on I/O Pins for details. 14.6.6 Synchronization Due to asynchronicity between the main clock domain and the peripheral clock domains, some registers need to be synchronized when written or read. When executing an operation that requires synchronization, the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY) will be set immediately, and cleared when synchronization is complete. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 103 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller If an operation that requires synchronization is executed while STATUS.SYNCBUSY=1, the bus will be stalled. All operations will complete successfully, but the CPU will be stalled and interrupts will be pending as long as the bus is stalled. The following registers are synchronized when written: • • • Generic Clock Generator Control register (GENCTRL) Generic Clock Generator Division register (GENDIV) Control register (CTRL) Required write-synchronization is denoted by the "Write-Synchronized" property in the register description. Related Links 13.3. Register Synchronization 14.7 Register Summary Table 14-2. Register Summary Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 0x9 0xA 0xB 14.8 CTRL STATUS CLKCTRL GENCTRL GENDIV 7:0 7:0 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 SWRST SYNCBUSY ID[5:0] WRTLOCK CLKEN RUNSTDBY DIVSEL OE GEN[3:0] ID[3:0] SRC[4:0] OOV IDC GENEN ID[3:0] DIV[7:0] DIV[15:8] Register Description Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16-, and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers require synchronization when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the "ReadSynchronized" and/or "Write-Synchronized" property in each individual register description. Refer to 14.5.7. Register Access Protection for details. Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the module is disabled. Enableprotection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in each individual register description. Refer to 14.6.6. Synchronization for details. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 104 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 14.8.1 Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 CTRL 0x0 0x00 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 0 SWRST R/W 0 Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit resets all registers in the GCLK to their initial state after a power reset, except for generic clocks and associated generators that have their WRTLOCK bit in CLKCTRL read as one. Refer to GENCTRL.ID for details on GENCTRL reset. Refer to GENDIV.ID for details on GENDIV reset. Refer to CLKCTRL.ID for details on CLKCTRL reset. Due to synchronization, there is a delay from writing CTRL.SWRST until the reset is complete. CTRL.SWRST and STATUS.SYNCBUSY will both be cleared when the reset is complete. Value Description 0 There is no reset operation ongoing. 1 There is a reset operation ongoing. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 105 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 14.8.2 Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset 7 SYNCBUSY R 0 STATUS 0x1 0x00 - 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 7 – SYNCBUSY Synchronization Busy Status This bit is cleared when the synchronization of registers between the clock domains is complete. This bit is set when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is started. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 106 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 14.8.3 Generic Clock Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit CLKCTRL 0x2 0x0000 Write-Protected 15 WRTLOCK R/W 0 14 CLKEN R/W 0 13 7 6 5 12 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 GEN[3:0] R/W 0 4 3 ID[5:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit 15 – WRTLOCK Write Lock When this bit is written, it will lock from further writes the generic clock pointed to by CLKCTRL.ID, the generic clock generator pointed to in CLKCTRL.GEN and the division factor used in the generic clock generator. It can only be unlocked by a power reset. One exception to this is generic clock generator 0, which cannot be locked. Value Description 0 The generic clock and the associated generic clock generator and division factor are not locked. 1 The generic clock and the associated generic clock generator and division factor are locked. Bit 14 – CLKEN Clock Enable This bit is used to enable and disable a generic clock. Value Description 0 The generic clock is disabled. 1 The generic clock is enabled. Bits 11:8 – GEN[3:0] Generic Clock Generator Table 14-3. Generic Clock Generator GEN[3:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8-0xF GCLKGEN0 GCLKGEN1 GCLKGEN2 GCLKGEN3 GCLKGEN4 GCLKGEN5 GCLKGEN6 GCLKGEN7 Reserved Generic clock generator 0 Generic clock generator 1 Generic clock generator 2 Generic clock generator 3 Generic clock generator 4 Generic clock generator 5 Generic clock generator 6 Generic clock generator 7 Reserved Bits 5:0 – ID[5:0] Generic Clock Selection ID These bits select the generic clock that will be configured. The value of the ID bit group versus module instance is shown in the table below. A power reset will reset the CLKCTRL register for all IDs, including the RTC. If the WRTLOCK bit of the corresponding ID is zero and the ID is not the RTC, a user reset will reset the CLKCTRL register for this ID. After a power reset, the reset value of the CLKCTRL register versus module instance is as shown in the next table. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 107 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller Table 14-4. Generic Clock Selection ID and CLKCTRL value after Power Reset Module Instance Reset Value after Power Reset CLKCTRL.GEN CLKCTRL.CLKEN CLKCTRL.WRTLOCK RTC WDT 0x00 0x02 Others 0x00 0x00 0x01 if WDT Enable bit in NVM User Row written to one 0x00 if WDT Enable bit in NVM User Row written to zero 0x00 0x00 0x01 if WDT Always-On bit in NVM User Row written to one 0x00 if WDT Always-On bit in NVM User Row written to zero 0x00 After a user reset, the reset value of the CLKCTRL register versus module instance is as shown in the table below. Table 14-5. Generic Clock Selection ID and CLKCTRL Value after User Reset Module Instance Reset Value after a User Reset RTC WDT Others Value 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x08 0x09 0x0A 0x0B 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E 0x0F 0x10 0x11 0x12 0x13 0x14 0x15 0x16 0x17 0x18 0x19 CLKCTRL.GEN CLCTRL.CLKEN CLKCTRL.WRTLOCK 0x00 if WRTLOCK=0 and CLKEN=0 No change if WRTLOCK=1 or CLKEN=1 0x02 if WRTLOCK=0 No change if WRTLOCK=1 0x00 if WRTLOCK=0 and CLKEN=0 No change if WRTLOCK=1 or CLKEN=1 No change If WRTLOCK=0 0x01 if WDT Enable bit in NVM User Row written to one 0x00 if WDT Enable bit in NVM User Row written to zero If WRTLOCK=1 no change 0x00 if WRTLOCK=0 No change if WRTLOCK=1 No change 0x00 if WRTLOCK=0 No change if WRTLOCK=1 Name GCLK_DFLL48M_REF GCLK_WDT GCLK_RTC GCLK_EIC GCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_0 GCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_1 GCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_2 GCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_3 GCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_4 GCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_5 GCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_6 GCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_7 GCLK_SERCOMx_SLOW GCLK_SERCOM0_CORE GCLK_SERCOM1_CORE GCLK_SERCOM2_CORE GCLK_SERCOM3_CORE GCLK_SERCOM4_CORE GCLK_SERCOM5_CORE GCLK_TC0, GCLK_TC1 GCLK_TC2, GCLK_TC3 GCLK_TC4, GCLK_TC5 GCLK_TC6, GCLK_TC7 GCLK_ADC GCLK_AC_DIG GCLK_AC_ANA © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries No change Description DFLL48M Reference WDT RTC EIC EVSYS_CHANNEL_0 EVSYS_CHANNEL_1 EVSYS_CHANNEL_2 EVSYS_CHANNEL_3 EVSYS_CHANNEL_4 EVSYS_CHANNEL_5 EVSYS_CHANNEL_6 EVSYS_CHANNEL_7 SERCOMx_SLOW SERCOM0_CORE SERCOM1_CORE SERCOM2_CORE SERCOM3_CORE SERCOM4_CORE SERCOM5_CORE TC0, TC1 TC2, TC3 TC4, TC5 TC6, TC7 ADC AC_DIG AC_ANA Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 108 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller Value 0x1A 0x1B 0x1C-0x3 F Name GCLK_DAC GCLK_PTC - © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Description DAC PTC Reserved Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 109 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 14.8.4 Generic Clock Generator Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit GENCTRL 0x4 0x00000000 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 20 DIVSEL R/W 0 19 OE R/W 0 18 OOV R/W 0 17 IDC R/W 0 16 GENEN R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 10 SRC[4:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 7 6 5 ID[3:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit 21 – RUNSTDBY Run in Standby This bit is used to keep the generic clock generator running when it is configured to be output to its dedicated GCLK_IO pin. If GENCTRL.OE is zero, this bit has no effect and the generic clock generator will only be running if a peripheral requires the clock. Value Description 0 The generic clock generator is stopped in standby and the GCLK_IO pin state (one or zero) will be dependent on the setting in GENCTRL.OOV. 1 The generic clock generator is kept running and output to its dedicated GCLK_IO pin during standby mode. Bit 20 – DIVSEL Divide Selection This bit is used to decide how the clock source used by the generic clock generator will be divided. If the clock source should not be divided, the DIVSEL bit must be zero and the GENDIV.DIV value for the corresponding generic clock generator must be zero or one. Value Description 0 The generic clock generator equals the clock source divided by GENDIV.DIV. 1 The generic clock generator equals the clock source divided by 2^(GENDIV.DIV+1). Bit 19 – OE Output Enable This bit is used to enable output of the generated clock to GCLK_IO when GCLK_IO is not selected as a source in the GENCLK.SRC bit group. Value Description 0 The generic clock generator is not output. 1 The generic clock generator is output to the corresponding GCLK_IO, unless the corresponding GCLK_IO is selected as a source in the GENCLK.SRC bit group. Bit 18 – OOV Output Off Value This bit is used to control the value of GCLK_IO when GCLK_IO is not selected as a source in the GENCLK.SRC bit group. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 110 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller Value 0 1 Description The GCLK_IO will be zero when the generic clock generator is turned off or when the OE bit is zero. The GCLK_IO will be one when the generic clock generator is turned off or when the OE bit is zero. Bit 17 – IDC Improve Duty Cycle This bit is used to improve the duty cycle of the generic clock generator when odd division factors are used. Value Description 0 The generic clock generator duty cycle is not 50/50 for odd division factors. 1 The generic clock generator duty cycle is 50/50. Bit 16 – GENEN Generic Clock Generator Enable This bit is used to enable and disable the generic clock generator. Value Description 0 The generic clock generator is disabled. 1 The generic clock generator is enabled. Bits 12:8 – SRC[4:0] Source Select These bits define the clock source to be used as the source for the generic clock generator, as shown in the table below. Value Name Description 0x00 XOSC XOSC oscillator output 0x01 GCLKIN Generator input pad 0x02 GCLKGEN1 Generic clock generator 1 output 0x03 OSCULP32K OSCULP32K oscillator output 0x04 OSC32K OSC32K oscillator output 0x05 XOSC32K XOSC32K oscillator output 0x06 OSC8M OSC8M oscillator output 0x07 DFLL48M DFLL48M output 0x08-0x1 Reserved Reserved for future use F Bits 3:0 – ID[3:0] Generic Clock Generator Selection These bits select the generic clock generator that will be configured or read. The value of the ID bit group versus which generic clock generator is configured is shown in the next table. A power reset will reset the GENCTRL register for all IDs, including the generic clock generator used by the RTC. If a generic clock generator ID other than generic clock generator 0 is not a source of a “locked” generic clock or a source of the RTC generic clock, a user reset will reset the GENCTRL for this ID. Values Names Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8-0xF GCLKGEN0 GCLKGEN0 GCLKGEN0 GCLKGEN0 GCLKGEN0 GCLKGEN0 GCLKGEN0 GCLKGEN0 - Generic clock generator 0 Generic clock generator 0 Generic clock generator 0 Generic clock generator 0 Generic clock generator 0 Generic clock generator 0 Generic clock generator 0 Generic clock generator 0 Reserved for future use After a power reset, the reset value of the GENCTRL register is as shown in the next table. GCLK Generator ID Reset Value after a Power Reset 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x00010600 0x00000001 0x00010302 0x00000003 0x00000004 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 111 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller ...........continued GCLK Generator ID Reset Value after a Power Reset 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x00000005 0x00000006 0x00000007 After a user reset, the reset value of the GENCTRL register is as shown in the table below. GCLK Generator ID Reset Value after a User Reset 0x00 0x01 0x00010600 0x00000001 if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of a 'locked' generic clock No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one 0x00010302 if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of a 'locked' generic clock No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one 0x00000003 if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of a 'locked' generic clock No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one 0x00000004 if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of a 'locked' generic clock No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one 0x00000005 if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of a 'locked' generic clock No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one 0x00000006 if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of a 'locked' generic clock No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one 0x00000007 if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of a 'locked' generic clock No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 112 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 14.8.5 Generic Clock Generator Division Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit GENDIV 0x8 0x00000000 Write-Synchronized 31 30 29 28 23 22 21 20 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit DIV[15:8] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 DIV[7:0] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 ID[3:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 23:8 – DIV[15:0] Division Factor These bits apply a division on each selected generic clock generator. The number of DIV bits each generator has can be seen in the table below. Writes to bits above the specified number will be ignored. Generator Division Factor Bits Maximum Division Factor Generic clock generator 0 Generic clock generator 1 Generic clock generators 2 Generic clock generators 3-8 8 division factor bits - DIV[7:0] 16 division factor bits - DIV[15:0] 5 division factor bits - DIV[4:0] 8 division factor bits - DIV[7:0] 512 131072 64 512 Bits 3:0 – ID[3:0] Generic Clock Generator Selection These bits select the generic clock generator on which the division factor will be applied, as shown in the table below. Values Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8-0xF Generic clock generator 0 Generic clock generator 1 Generic clock generator 2 Generic clock generator 3 Generic clock generator 4 Generic clock generator 5 Generic clock generator 6 Generic clock generator 7 Reserved A power reset will reset the GENDIV register for all IDs, including the generic clock generator used by the RTC. If a generic clock generator ID, other than generic clock generator ‘0’, is not a source of locked generic clock or a source of the RTC generic clock. A user reset will reset the GENDIV register for this ID. After a power reset, the reset value of the GENDIV register is as shown in the table below. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 113 SAM D20 Family GCLK - Generic Clock Controller GCLK Generator ID Reset Value after a Power Reset 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x00000000 0x00000001 0x00000002 0x00000003 0x00000004 0x00000005 0x00000006 0x00000007 After a user reset, the reset value of the GENDIV register is as shown in the table below. GCLK Generator ID Reset Value after a User Reset 0x00 0x01 0x00000000 0x00000001, if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of locked generic clock . No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one. 0x00000002, if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of locked generic clock. No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one. 0x00000003, if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of locked generic clock . No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one. 0x00000004, if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of locked generic clock . No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one. 0x00000005, if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of locked generic clock . No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one. 0x00000006, if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of locked generic clock . No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one. 0x00000007, if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of locked generic clock . No change if the generator is used by the RTC or used by a GCLK with a WRTLOCK as one. 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 114 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15. 15.1 Power Manager (PM) Overview The Power Manager (PM) controls the reset, clock generation and sleep modes of the device. Utilizing a main clock chosen from a large number of clock sources from the GCLK, the clock controller provides synchronous system clocks to the CPU and the modules connected to the AHB and the APBx bus. The synchronous system clocks are divided into a number of clock domains; one for the CPU and AHB and one for each APBx. Any synchronous system clock can be changed at run-time during normal operation. The clock domains can run at different speeds, enabling the user to save power by running peripherals at a relatively low clock frequency, while maintaining high CPU performance. In addition, the clock can be masked for individual modules, enabling the user to minimize power consumption. If for some reason the main clock stops oscillating, the clock failure detector allows switching the main clock to the safe OSC8M clock. Before entering the STANDBY sleep mode the user must make sure that a significant amount of clocks and peripherals are disabled, so that the voltage regulator is not overloaded. This is because during STANDBY sleep mode the internal voltage regulator will be in low power mode. Various sleep modes are provided in order to fit power consumption requirements. This enables the PM to stop unused modules in order to save power. In active mode, the CPU is executing application code. When the device enters a sleep mode, program execution is stopped and some modules and clock domains are automatically switched off by the PM according to the sleep mode. The application code decides which sleep mode to enter and when. Interrupts from enabled peripherals and all enabled reset sources can restore the device from a sleep mode to active mode. The PM also contains a reset controller to collect all possible reset sources. It issues a device reset and sets the device to its initial state, and allows the reset source to be identified by software. 15.2 Features • • • Reset control – Reset the microcontroller and set it to an initial state according to the reset source – Multiple reset sources • Power reset sources: POR, BOD12, BOD33 • User reset sources: External reset (RESET), Watchdog Timer reset, software reset – Reset status register for reading the reset source from the application code Clock control – Controls CPU, AHB and APB system clocks • Multiple clock sources and division factor from GCLK • Clock prescaler with 1x to 128x division – Safe run-time clock switching from GCLK – Module-level clock gating through maskable peripheral clocks – Clock failure detector Power management control – Sleep modes: IDLE, STANDBY – SleepWalking support on GCLK clocks © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 115 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.3 Block Diagram Figure 15-1. PM Block Diagram POWER MANAGER CLK_APB OSC8M GCLK CLK_AHB SYNCHRONOUS CLOCK CONTROLLER PERIPHERALS CLK_CPU CPU SLEEP MODE CONTROLLER BOD12 USER RESET BOD33 POWER RESET POR WDT RESET CONTROLLER CPU RESET RESET SOURCES 15.4 Signal Description Signal Name Type Description RESET Digital input External reset Refer to I/O Multiplexing and Considerations for details on the pin mapping for this peripheral. One signal can be mapped on several pins. Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 15.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. 15.5.1 I/O Lines Not applicable. 15.5.2 Power Management Not applicable. 15.5.3 Clocks The PM bus clock (CLK_PM_APB) can be enabled and disabled in the Power Manager, and the default state of CLK_PM_APB can be found in Peripheral Clock Default State table in the Peripheral Clock Masking section. If this clock is disabled in the Power Manager, it can only be re-enabled by a reset. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 116 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) A generic clock (GCLK_MAIN) is required to generate the main clock. The clock source for GCLK_MAIN is configured by default in the Generic Clock Controller, and can be reconfigured by the user if needed. Refer to GCLK – Generic Clock Controller for details. Related Links 15.6.2.6. Peripheral Clock Masking 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 15.5.3.1 Main Clock The main clock (CLK_MAIN) is the common source for the synchronous clocks. This is fed into the common 8-bit prescaler that is used to generate synchronous clocks to the CPU, AHB and APBx modules. 15.5.3.2 CPU Clock The CPU clock (CLK_CPU) is routed to the CPU. Halting the CPU clock inhibits the CPU from executing instructions. 15.5.3.3 AHB Clock The AHB clock (CLK_AHB) is the root clock source used by peripherals requiring an AHB clock. The AHB clock is always synchronous to the CPU clock and has the same frequency, but may run even when the CPU clock is turned off. A clock gate is inserted from the common AHB clock to any AHB clock of a peripheral. 15.5.3.4 APBx Clocks The APBx clock (CLK_APBX) is the root clock source used by modules requiring a clock on the APBx bus. The APBx clock is always synchronous to the CPU clock, but can be divided by a prescaler, and will run even when the CPU clock is turned off. A clock gater is inserted from the common APB clock to any APBx clock of a module on APBx bus. 15.5.4 Interrupts The interrupt request line is connected to the Interrupt Controller. Using the PM interrupt requires the Interrupt Controller to be configured first. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 15.5.5 Events Not applicable. 15.5.6 Debug Operation When the CPU is halted in debug mode, the PM continues normal operation. In sleep mode, the clocks generated from the PM are kept running to allow the debugger accessing any modules. As a consequence, power measurements are not possible in debug mode. 15.5.7 Register Access Protection Registers with write-access can be optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC), except for the following: • • Interrupt Flag register (INTFLAG). Reset Cause register (RCAUSE). Note:  Optional write-protection is indicated by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in the register description. Write-protection does not apply for accesses through an external debugger. Refer to PAC – Peripheral Access Controller for details. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller 15.8.13. INTFLAG 15.8.14. RCAUSE 15.5.8 Analog Connections Not applicable. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 117 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.6 Functional Description 15.6.1 Principle of Operation 15.6.1.1 Synchronous Clocks The GCLK_MAIN clock from GCLK module provides the source for the main clock, which is the common root for the synchronous clocks for the CPU and APBx modules. The main clock is divided by an 8-bit prescaler, and each of the derived clocks can run from any tapping off this prescaler or the undivided main clock, as long as fCPU ≥ fAPBx. The synchronous clock source can be changed on the fly to respond to varying load in the application. The clocks for each module in each synchronous clock domain can be individually masked to avoid power consumption in inactive modules. Depending on the sleep mode, some clock domains can be turned off (see Table 15-4). 15.6.1.2 Reset Controller The Reset Controller collects the various reset sources and generates reset for the device. The device contains a power-on-reset (POR) detector, which keeps the system reset until power is stable. This eliminates the need for external reset circuitry to guarantee stable operation when powering up the device. 15.6.1.3 Sleep Mode Controller In ACTIVE mode, all clock domains are active, allowing software execution and peripheral operation. The PM Sleep Mode Controller allows the user to choose between different sleep modes depending on application requirements, to save power (see Table 15-4). 15.6.2 Basic Operation 15.6.2.1 Initialization After a power-on reset, the PM is enabled and the Reset Cause register indicates the POR source (RCAUSE.POR). The default clock source of the GCLK_MAIN clock is started and calibrated before the CPU starts running. The GCLK_MAIN clock is selected as the main clock without any division on the prescaler. The device is in the ACTIVE mode. By default, only the necessary clocks are enabled (see Table   1). Related Links 15.8.14. RCAUSE 15.6.2.2 Enabling, Disabling and Resetting The PM module is always enabled and can not be reset. 15.6.2.3 Selecting the Main Clock Source Refer to GCLK – Generic Clock Controller for details on how to configure the main clock source. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 15.6.2.4 Selecting the Synchronous Clock Division Ratio The main clock feeds an 8-bit prescaler, which can be used to generate the synchronous clocks. By default, the synchronous clocks run on the undivided main clock. The user can select a prescaler division for the CPU clock by writing the CPU Prescaler Selection bits in the CPU Select register (CPUSEL.CPUDIV), resulting in a CPU clock frequency determined by this equation: fmain fCPU = CPUDIV 2 Similarly, the clock for the APBx can be divided by writing their respective registers (APBxSEL.APBxDIV). To ensure correct operation, frequencies must be selected so that fCPU ≥ fAPBx. Also, frequencies must never exceed the specified maximum frequency for each clock domain. Note:  The AHB clock is always equal to the CPU clock. CPUSEL and APBxSEL can be written without halting or disabling peripheral modules. Writing CPUSEL and APBxSEL allows a new clock setting to be written to all synchronous clocks at the same time. It is possible to © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 118 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) keep one or more clocks unchanged. This way, it is possible to, for example, scale the CPU speed according to the required performance, while keeping the APBx frequency constant. Figure 15-2. Synchronous Clock Selection and Prescaler Sleep Controller Sleep mode APBCMASK Clock gate APBCDIV GCLK_MAIN CLK_PERIPHERAL_APBC_n CLK_PERIPHERAL_APBC_1 CLK_PERIPHERAL_APBC_0 APBBMASK Clock gate CLK_APBB Clock gate CLK_APBA APBBDIV GCLK Clock gate Clock gate Clock gate CLK_APBC Clock gate Clock gate Clock gate CLK_PERIPHERAL_APBB_n CLK_PERIPHERAL_APBB_1 CLK_PERIPHERAL_APBB_0 APBAMASK Clock gate Clock gate Clock gate CLK_PERIPHERAL_APBA_n CLK_PERIPHERAL_APBA_1 CLK_PERIPHERAL_APBA_0 Clock gate Clock gate Clock gate CLK_PERIPHERAL_AHB_n CLK_PERIPHERAL_AHB_1 CLK_PERIPHERAL_AHB_0 CLK_MAIN APBADIV OSC8M BKUPCLK Clock Failure Detector Prescaler AHBMASK Clock gate CLK_AHB Clock gate CLK_CPU CPUDIV 15.6.2.5 Clock Ready Flag There is a slight delay from when CPUSEL and APBxSEL are written until the new clock setting becomes effective. During this interval, the Clock Ready flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.CKRDY) will read as zero. If CKRDY in the INTENSET register is written to one, the Power Manager interrupt can be triggered when the new clock setting is effective. CPUSEL must not be re-written while CKRDY is zero, or the system may become unstable or hang. Related Links 15.8.3. CPUSEL 15.8.12. INTENSET 15.6.2.6 Peripheral Clock Masking It is possible to disable or enable the clock for a peripheral in the AHB or APBx clock domain by writing the corresponding bit in the Clock Mask register (APBxMASK - refer to APBAMASK register for details) to zero or one. Refer to the table below for the default state of each of the peripheral clocks. Table 15-1. Peripheral Clock Default State Peripheral Clock Default State CLK_PAC0_APB Enabled CLK_PM_APB Enabled CLK_SYSCTRL_APB Enabled CLK_GCLK_APB Enabled © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 119 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) ...........continued Peripheral Clock Default State CLK_WDT_APB Enabled CLK_RTC_APB Enabled CLK_EIC_APB Enabled CLK_PAC1_APB Enabled CLK_DSU_APB Enabled CLK_NVMCTRL_APB Enabled CLK_PORT_APB Enabled CLK_PAC2_APB Disabled CLK_SERCOMx_APB Disabled CLK_TCx_APB Disabled CLK_ADC_APB Enabled CLK_AC_APB Disabled CLK_DAC_APB Disabled CLK_PTC_APB Disabled When the APB clock for a module is not provided its registers cannot be read or written. The module can be re-enabled later by writing the corresponding mask bit to one. A module may be connected to several clock domains (for instance, AHB and APB), in which case it will have several mask bits. Note:  Clocks should only be switched off if it is certain that the module will not be used. Switching off the clock for the NVM Controller (NVMCTRL) will cause a problem if the CPU needs to read from the flash memory. Switching off the clock to the Power Manager (PM), which contains the mask registers, or the corresponding APBx bridge, will make it impossible to write the mask registers again. In this case, they can only be re-enabled by a system reset. Related Links 15.8.8. APBAMASK 15.6.2.7 Clock Failure Detector This mechanism allows the main clock to be switched automatically to the safe OSC8M clock when the main clock source is considered off. This may happen for instance when an external crystal oscillator is selected as the clock source for the main clock and the crystal fails. The mechanism is to designed to detect, during a OSCULP32K clock period, at least one rising edge of the main clock. If no rising edge is seen, the clock is considered failed. The clock failure detector is enabled by writing a '1' to the Clock Failure Detector Enable bit in CTRL (CFDEN_CTRL). As soon as the Clock Failure Detector Enable bit (CTRL.CFDEN) is one, the clock failure detector (CFD) will monitor the undivided main clock. When a clock failure is detected, the main clock automatically switches to the OSC8M clock and the Clock Failure Detector flag in the interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.CFD) is set and the corresponding interrupt request will be generated if enabled. The BKUPCLK bit in the CTRL register is set by hardware to indicate that the main clock comes from OSC8M. The GCLK_MAIN clock source can be selected again by writing a zero to the CTRL.BKUPCLK bit. However, writing the bit does not fix the failure. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 120 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) Notes:  1. The detector does not monitor while the main clock is temporarily unavailable (start-up time after a wake-up, etc.) or in sleep mode. The Clock Failure Detector must be disabled before entering standby mode. 2. The clock failure detector must not be enabled if the source of the main clock is not significantly faster than the OSCULP32K clock. For instance, if GCLK_MAIN is the internal 32kHz RC, then the clock failure detector must be disabled. 3. The OSC8M internal oscillator should be enabled to allow the main clock switching to the OSC8M clock. Related Links 15.8.1. CTRL 15.6.2.8 Reset Controller The latest reset cause is available in RCAUSE, and can be read during the application boot sequence in order to determine proper action. There are two groups of reset sources: • • Power Reset: Resets caused by an electrical issue. User Reset: Resets caused by the application. The table below lists the parts of the device that are reset, depending on the reset type. Table 15-2. Effects of the Different Reset Events Power Reset User Reset POR, BOD12, BOD33 External Reset WDT Reset, SysResetReq RTC All the 32kHz sources WDT with ALWAYSON feature Generic Clock with WRTLOCK feature Y N N Debug logic Y Y N Others Y Y Y The external reset is generated when pulling the RESET pin low. This pin has an internal pull-up, and does not need to be driven externally during normal operation. The POR, BOD12 and BOD33 reset sources are generated by their corresponding module in the System Controller Interface (SYSCTRL). The WDT reset is generated by the Watchdog Timer. The System Reset Request (SysResetReq) is a software reset generated by the CPU when asserting the SYSRESETREQ bit located in the Reset Control register of the CPU (See the ARM® Cortex® Technical Reference Manual on http://www.arm.com). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 121 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) Figure 15-3. Reset Controller RESET CONTROLLER BOD12 BOD33 POR RTC 32kHz clock sources WDT with ALWAYSON Generic Clock with WRTLOCK Debug Logic RESET WDT Others CPU RESET SOURCES RCAUSE 15.6.2.9 Sleep Mode Controller Sleep mode is activated by the Wait For Interrupt instruction (WFI). The Idle bits in the Sleep Mode register (SLEEP.IDLE) and the SLEEPDEEP bit of the System Control register of the CPU should be used as argument to select the level of the sleep mode. There are two main types of sleep mode: • IDLE mode: The CPU is stopped. Optionally, some synchronous clock domains are stopped, depending on the IDLE argument. Regulator operates in normal mode. • STANDBY mode: All clock sources are stopped, except those where the RUNSTDBY bit is set. Regulator operates in low-power mode. Before entering standby mode the user must make sure that a significant amount of clocks and peripherals are disabled, so that the voltage regulator is not overloaded. Table 15-3. Sleep Mode Entry and Exit Table Mode Level Mode Entry Wake-Up Sources IDLE 0 SCR.SLEEPDEEP = 0 SLEEP.IDLE=Level WFI Synchronous(2) (APB, AHB), asynchronous(1) 1 2 STANDBY Synchronous (APB), asynchronous Asynchronous SCR.SLEEPDEEP = 1 WFI Asynchronous Notes:  1. Asynchronous: interrupt generated on generic clock or external clock or external event. 2. Synchronous: interrupt generated on the APB clock. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 122 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) Table 15-4. Sleep Mode Overview Sleep Mode CPU Clock AHB Clock APB Clock Oscillators ONDEMAND = 0 ONDEMAND = 1 RUNSTDBY=0 RUNSTDBY=1 RUNSTDBY=0 RUNSTDBY=1 Main Clock Regulator Mode RAM Mode Idle 0 Stop Run Run Run Run Run if requested Run if requested Run Normal Normal Idle 1 Stop Stop Run Run Run Run if requested Run if requested Run Normal Normal Idle 2 Stop Stop Stop Run Run Run if requested Run if requested Run Normal Normal Standby Stop Stop Stop Stop Run Stop Run if requested Stop Low power Low power 15.6.2.9.1 IDLE Mode The IDLE modes allow power optimization with the fastest wake-up time. The CPU is stopped. To further reduce power consumption, the user can disable the clocking of modules and clock sources by configuring the SLEEP.IDLE bit group. The module will be halted regardless of the bit settings of the mask registers in the Power Manager (PM.AHBMASK, PM.APBxMASK). Regulator operates in normal mode. • • Entering IDLE mode: The IDLE mode is entered by executing the WFI instruction. Additionally, if the SLEEPONEXIT bit in the ARM Cortex System Control register (SCR) is set, the IDLE mode will also be entered when the CPU exits the lowest priority ISR. This mechanism can be useful for applications that only require the processor to run when an interrupt occurs. Before entering the IDLE mode, the user must configure the IDLE mode configuration bit group and must write a zero to the SCR.SLEEPDEEP bit. Exiting IDLE mode: The processor wakes the system up when it detects the occurrence of any interrupt that is not masked in the NVIC Controller with sufficient priority to cause exception entry. The system goes back to the ACTIVE mode. The CPU and affected modules are restarted. 15.6.2.9.2 STANDBY Mode The STANDBY mode allows achieving very low power consumption. In this mode, all clocks are stopped except those which are kept running if requested by a running module or have the ONDEMAND bit set to zero. For example, the RTC can operate in STANDBY mode. In this case, its Generic Clock clock source will also be enabled. The regulator and the RAM operate in low-power mode. A SLEEPONEXIT feature is also available. • • 15.6.3 Entering STANDBY mode: This mode is entered by executing the WFI instruction with the SCR.SLEEPDEEP bit of the CPU is written to 1. Exiting STANDBY mode: Any peripheral able to generate an asynchronous interrupt can wake up the system. For example, a module running on a Generic clock can trigger an interrupt. When the enabled asynchronous wake-up event occurs and the system is woken up, the device will either execute the interrupt service routine or continue the normal program execution according to the Priority Mask Register (PRIMASK) configuration of the CPU. SleepWalking SleepWalking is the capability for a device to temporarily wake-up clocks for the peripheral to perform a task without waking-up the CPU in STANDBY sleep mode. At the end of the sleepwalking task, the device can either be awakened by an interrupt (from a peripheral involved in SleepWalking) or enter into STANDBY sleep mode again. In this device, SleepWalking is supported only on GCLK clocks by using the on-demand clock principle of the clock sources. Refer to On-demand, Clock Requests for more details. Related Links 13.6. On-demand, Clock Requests 15.6.4 Interrupts The peripheral has the following interrupt sources: © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 123 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) • • Clock Ready flag Clock failure detector Each interrupt source has an interrupt flag associated with it. The interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear (INTFLAG) register is set when the interrupt condition occurs. Each interrupt can be individually enabled by writing a one to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Set (INTENSET) register, and disabled by writing a one to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Clear (INTENCLR) register. An interrupt request is generated when the interrupt flag is set and the corresponding interrupt is enabled. The interrupt request remains active until the interrupt flag is cleared, the interrupt is disabled or the peripheral is reset. An interrupt flag is cleared by writing a one to the corresponding bit in the INTFLAG register. Each peripheral can have one interrupt request line per interrupt source or one common interrupt request line for all the interrupt sources. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. If the peripheral has one common interrupt request line for all the interrupt sources, the user must read the INTFLAG register to determine which interrupt condition is present. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 15.6.5 Events Not applicable. 15.6.6 Sleep Mode Operation In all IDLE sleep modes, the power manager is still running on the selected main clock. In STANDDBY sleep mode, the power manager is frozen and is able to go back to ACTIVE mode upon any asynchronous interrupt. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 124 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.7 Register Summary Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x00 0x01 0x02 ... 0x07 0x08 0x09 0x0A 0x0B 0x0C ... 0x13 CTRL SLEEP 7:0 7:0 0x14 CPUSEL APBASEL APBBSEL APBCSEL AHBMASK 0x1C APBBMASK 15.8 5 4 3 BKUPCLK 2 1 0 CFDEN IDLE[1:0] 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 CPUDIV[2:0] APBADIV[2:0] APBBDIV[2:0] APBCDIV[2:0] Reserved APBAMASK 0x24 ... 0x33 0x34 0x35 0x36 0x37 0x38 6 Reserved 0x18 0x20 7 APBCMASK 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 EIC SERCOM5 TC7 SERCOM4 TC6 RTC SERCOM3 TC5 NVMCTRL DSU HPB2 HPB1 HPB0 WDT GCLK SYSCTRL PM PAC0 PORT NVMCTRL DSU PAC1 SERCOM1 TC3 PTC SERCOM0 TC2 DAC EVSYS TC1 AC PAC2 TC0 ADC CFD CFD CFD CKRDY CKRDY CKRDY BOD12 POR SERCOM2 TC4 Reserved INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG Reserved RCAUSE 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 SYST WDT EXT BOD33 Register Description Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16-, and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Exception for APBASEL, APBBSEL and APBCSEL: These registers must only be accessed with 8-bit access. Optional write-protection by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC) is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 125 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.1 Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRL 0x00 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 Access Reset 5 4 BKUPCLK R/W 0 3 2 CFDEN R/W 0 1 0 Bit 4 – BKUPCLK Backup Clock Select This bit is set by hardware when a clock failure is detected. Value Description 0 The GCLK_MAIN clock is selected for the main clock. 1 The OSC8M backup clock is selected for the main clock. Bit 2 – CFDEN Clock Failure Detector Enable This bit is set by hardware when a clock failure is detected. Value Description 0 The clock failure detector is disabled. 1 The clock failure detector is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 126 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.2 Sleep Mode Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit SLEEP 0x01 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 IDLE[1:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 1:0 – IDLE[1:0] Idle Mode Configuration These bits select the Idle mode configuration after a WFI instruction. IDLE[1:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 CPU AHB APB The CPU clock domain is stopped The CPU and AHB clock domains are stopped The CPU, AHB and APB clock domains are stopped Reserved © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 127 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.3 CPU Clock Select Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CPUSEL 0x08 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 5 4 3 2 Access Reset R/W 0 1 CPUDIV[2:0] R/W 0 0 R/W 0 Bits 2:0 – CPUDIV[2:0] CPU Prescaler Selection These bits define the division ratio of the main clock prescaler (2n). CPUDIV[2:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 DIV1 DIV2 DIV4 DIV8 DIV16 DIV32 DIV64 DIV128 Divide by 1 Divide by 2 Divide by 4 Divide by 8 Divide by 16 Divide by 32 Divide by 64 Divide by 128 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 128 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.4 APBA Clock Select Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit APBASEL 0x09 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 R/W 0 1 APBADIV[2:0] R/W 0 0 R/W 0 Bits 2:0 – APBADIV[2:0] APBA Prescaler Selection These bits define the division ratio of the APBA clock prescaler (2n). APBADIV[2:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 DIV1 DIV2 DIV4 DIV8 DIV16 DIV32 DIV64 DIV128 Divide by 1 Divide by 2 Divide by 4 Divide by 8 Divide by 16 Divide by 32 Divide by 64 Divide by 128 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 129 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.5 APBB Clock Select Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit APBBSEL 0x0A 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 R/W 0 1 APBBDIV[2:0] R/W 0 0 R/W 0 Bits 2:0 – APBBDIV[2:0] APBB Prescaler Selection These bits define the division ratio of the APBB clock prescaler (2n). APBBDIV[2:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 DIV1 DIV2 DIV4 DIV8 DIV16 DIV32 DIV64 DIV128 Divide by 1 Divide by 2 Divide by 4 Divide by 8 Divide by 16 Divide by 32 Divide by 64 Divide by 128 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 130 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.6 APBC Clock Select Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit APBCSEL 0x0B 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 R/W 0 1 APBCDIV[2:0] R/W 0 0 R/W 0 Bits 2:0 – APBCDIV[2:0] APBC Prescaler Selection These bits define the division ratio of the APBC clock prescaler (2n). APBCDIV[2:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 DIV1 DIV2 DIV4 DIV8 DIV16 DIV32 DIV64 DIV128 Divide by 1 Divide by 2 Divide by 4 Divide by 8 Divide by 16 Divide by 32 Divide by 64 Divide by 128 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 131 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.7 AHB Mask Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit AHBMASK 0x14 0x0000007F Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 NVMCTRL R/W 1 3 DSU R/W 1 2 HPB2 R/W 1 1 HPB1 R/W 1 0 HPB0 R/W 1 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 4 – NVMCTRL NVMCTRL AHB Clock Mask Value Description 0 The AHB clock for the NVMCTRL is stopped. 1 The AHB clock for the NVMCTRL is enabled. Bit 3 – DSU DSU AHB Clock Mask Value Description 0 The AHB clock for the DSU is stopped. 1 The AHB clock for the DSU is enabled. Bit 2 – HPB2 HPB2 AHB Clock Mask Value Description 0 The AHB clock for the HPB2 is stopped. 1 The AHB clock for the HPB2 is enabled. Bit 1 – HPB1 HPB1 AHB Clock Mask Value Description 0 The AHB clock for the HPB1 is stopped. 1 The AHB clock for the HPB1 is enabled. Bit 0 – HPB0 HPB0 AHB Clock Mask Value Description 0 The AHB clock for the HPB0 is stopped. 1 The AHB clock for the HPB0 is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 132 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.8 APBA Mask Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit APBAMASK 0x18 0x0000007F Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 EIC R/W 1 5 RTC R/W 1 4 WDT R/W 1 3 GCLK R/W 1 2 SYSCTRL R/W 1 1 PM R/W 1 0 PAC0 R/W 1 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 6 – EIC EIC APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBA clock for the EIC is stopped. 1 The APBA clock for the EIC is enabled. Bit 5 – RTC RTC APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBA clock for the RTC is stopped. 1 The APBA clock for the RTC is enabled. Bit 4 – WDT WDT APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBA clock for the WDT is stopped. 1 The APBA clock for the WDT is enabled. Bit 3 – GCLK GCLK APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBA clock for the GCLK is stopped. 1 The APBA clock for the GCLK is enabled. Bit 2 – SYSCTRL SYSCTRL APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBA clock for the SYSCTRL is stopped. 1 The APBA clock for the SYSCTRL is enabled. Bit 1 – PM PM APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBA clock for the PM is stopped. 1 The APBA clock for the PM is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 133 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) Bit 0 – PAC0 PAC0 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBA clock for the PAC0 is stopped. 1 The APBA clock for the PAC0 is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 134 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.9 APBB Mask Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit APBBMASK 0x1C 0x0000007F Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 PORT R/W 1 2 NVMCTRL R/W 1 1 DSU R/W 1 0 PAC1 R/W 1 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 3 – PORT PORT APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBB clock for the PORT is stopped. 1 The APBB clock for the PORT is enabled. Bit 2 – NVMCTRL NVMCTRL APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBB clock for the NVMCTRL is stopped. 1 The APBB clock for the NVMCTRL is enabled. Bit 1 – DSU DSU APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBB clock for the DSU is stopped. 1 The APBB clock for the DSU is enabled. Bit 0 – PAC1 PAC1 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBB clock for the PAC1 is stopped. 1 The APBB clock for the PAC1 is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 135 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.10 APBC Mask Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit APBCMASK 0x20 0x00010000 Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 PTC R/W 0 18 DAC R/W 0 17 AC R/W 0 16 ADC R/W 1 15 TC7 R/W 0 14 TC6 R/W 0 13 TC5 R/W 0 12 TC4 R/W 0 11 TC3 R/W 0 10 TC2 R/W 0 9 TC1 R/W 0 8 TC0 R/W 0 7 SERCOM5 R/W 0 6 SERCOM4 R/W 0 5 SERCOM3 R/W 0 4 SERCOM2 R/W 0 3 SERCOM1 R/W 0 2 SERCOM0 R/W 0 1 EVSYS R/W 0 0 PAC2 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 19 – PTC PTC APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the PTC is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the PTC is enabled. Bit 18 – DAC DAC APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the DAC is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the DAC is enabled. Bit 17 – AC AC APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the AC is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the AC is enabled. Bit 16 – ADC ADC APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the ADC is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the ADC is enabled. Bit 15 – TC7 TC7 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the TC7 is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the TC7 is enabled. Bit 14 – TC6 TC6 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the TC6 is stopped. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 136 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) Value 1 Description The APBC clock for the TC6 is enabled. Bit 13 – TC5 TC5 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the TC5 is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the TC5 is enabled. Bit 12 – TC4 TC4 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the TC4 is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the TC4 is enabled. Bit 11 – TC3 TC3 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the TC3 is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the TC3 is enabled. Bit 10 – TC2 TC2 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the TC2 is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the TC2 is enabled. Bit 9 – TC1 TC1 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the TC1 is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the TC1 is enabled. Bit 8 – TC0 TC0 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the TC0 is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the TC0 is enabled. Bit 7 – SERCOM5 SERCOM5 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the SERCOM5 is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the SERCOM5 is enabled. Bit 6 – SERCOM4 SERCOM4 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the SERCOM4 is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the SERCOM4 is enabled. Bit 5 – SERCOM3 SERCOM2 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the SERCOM3 is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the SERCOM3 is enabled. Bit 4 – SERCOM2 SERCOM2 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the SERCOM2 is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the SERCOM2 is enabled. Bit 3 – SERCOM1 SERCOM1 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the SERCOM1 is stopped. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 137 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) Value 1 Description The APBC clock for the SERCOM1 is enabled. Bit 2 – SERCOM0 SERCOM0 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the SERCOM0 is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the SERCOM0 is enabled. Bit 1 – EVSYS EVSYS APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the EVSYS is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the EVSYS is enabled. Bit 0 – PAC2 PAC2 APB Clock Enable Value Description 0 The APBC clock for the PAC2 is stopped. 1 The APBC clock for the PAC2 is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 138 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.11 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTENCLR 0x34 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 CFD R/W 0 0 CKRDY R/W 0 Bit 1 – CFD Clock Failure Detector Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Clock Failure Detector Interrupt Enable bit and the corresponding interrupt request. Value Description 0 The Clock Failure Detector interrupt is disabled. 1 The Clock Failure Detector interrupt is enabled and will generate an interrupt request when the Clock Failure Detector Interrupt flag is set. Bit 0 – CKRDY Clock Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Clock Ready Interrupt Enable bit and the corresponding interrupt request. Value Description 0 The Clock Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Clock Ready interrupt is enabled and will generate an interrupt request when the Clock Ready Interrupt flag is set. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 139 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.12 Interrupt Enable Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTENSET 0x35 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 CFD R/W 0 0 CKRDY R/W 0 Bit 1 – CFD Clock Failure Detector Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Clock Failure Detector Interrupt Enable bit and the corresponding interrupt request. Value Description 0 The Clock Failure Detector interrupt is disabled. 1 The Clock Failure Detector interrupt is enabled and will generate an interrupt request when the Clock Failure Detector Interrupt flag is set. Bit 0 – CKRDY Clock Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Clock Ready Interrupt Enable bit and enable the Clock Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Clock Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Clock Ready interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 140 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.13 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTFLAG 0x36 0x00 - 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 CFD R/W 0 0 CKRDY R/W 0 Bit 1 – CFD Clock Failure Detector Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Clock Failure Detector Interrupt Enable bit and the corresponding interrupt request. Value Description 0 The Clock Failure Detector interrupt is disabled. 1 The Clock Failure Detector interrupt is enabled and will generate an interrupt request when the Clock Failure Detector Interrupt flag is set. Bit 0 – CKRDY Clock Ready This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag. This flag is set when the synchronous CPU and APBx clocks have frequencies as indicated in the CPUSEL and APBxSEL registers, and will generate an interrupt if INTENCLR/SET.CKRDY is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Clock Ready Interrupt flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 141 SAM D20 Family Power Manager (PM) 15.8.14 Reset Cause Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit RCAUSE 0x38 0x01 - 7 Access Reset 6 SYST R 0 5 WDT R 0 4 EXT R 0 3 2 BOD33 R 0 1 BOD12 R 0 0 POR R 1 Bit 6 – SYST System Reset Request This bit is set if a system reset request has been performed. Refer to the Cortex processor documentation for more details. Bit 5 – WDT Watchdog Reset This flag is set if a Watchdog Timer reset occurs. Bit 4 – EXT External Reset This flag is set if an external reset occurs. Bit 2 – BOD33 Brown Out 33 Detector Reset This flag is set if a BOD33 reset occurs. Bit 1 – BOD12 Brown Out 12 Detector Reset This flag is set if a BOD12 reset occurs. Bit 0 – POR Power On Reset This flag is set if a POR occurs. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 142 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16. SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.1 Overview The System Controller (SYSCTRL) provides a user interface to the clock sources, brown out detectors, on-chip voltage regulator and voltage reference of the device. Through the interface registers, it is possible to enable, disable, calibrate and monitor the SYSCTRL sub-peripherals. All sub-peripheral statuses are collected in the Power and Clocks Status register (PCLKSR). They can additionally trigger interrupts upon status changes via the INTENSET (INTENSET), INTENCLR (INTENCLR) and INTFLAG (INTFLAG) registers. Additionally, BOD33 interrupts can be used to wake up the device from standby mode upon a programmed brown-out detection. Related Links 16.8.4. PCLKSR 16.8.2. INTENSET 16.8.3. INTFLAG 16.8.14. BOD33 16.8.1. INTENCLR 16.2 Features • • • • • • • 0.4-32MHz Crystal Oscillator (XOSC) – Tunable gain control – Programmable start-up time – Crystal or external input clock on XIN I/O 32.768kHz Crystal Oscillator (XOSC32K) – Automatic or manual gain control – Programmable start-up time – Crystal or external input clock on XIN32 I/O 32.768kHz High Accuracy Internal Oscillator (OSC32K) – Frequency fine tuning – Programmable start-up time 32.768kHz Ultra Low Power Internal Oscillator (OSCULP32K) – Ultra low power, always-on oscillator – Frequency fine tuning – Calibration value loaded from Flash Factory Calibration at reset 8MHz Internal Oscillator (OSC8M) – Fast startup – Output frequency fine tuning – 4/2/1MHz divided output frequencies available – Calibration value loaded from Flash Factory Calibration at reset Digital Frequency Locked Loop (DFLL48M) – Internal oscillator with no external components – 48MHz output frequency – Operates standalone as a high-frequency programmable oscillator in open loop mode – Operates as an accurate frequency multiplier against a known frequency in closed loop mode 3.3V Brown-Out Detector (BOD33) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 143 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller – – – – • • 16.3 Programmable threshold Threshold value loaded from Flash User Calibration at startup Triggers resets or interrupts Operating modes: • Continuous mode • Sampled mode for low power applications (programmable refresh frequency) – Hysteresis Internal Voltage Regulator system (VREG) – Operating modes: • Normal mode • Low-power mode – With an internal non-configurable Brown-out detector (BOD12) Voltage Reference System (VREF) – Bandgap voltage generator with programmable calibration value – Temperature sensor – Bandgap calibration value loaded from Flash Factory Calibration at start-up Block Diagram Figure 16-1. SYSCTRL Block Diagram XOSC XOSC32K OSCILLATORS CONTROL OSC32K OSCULP32K OSC8M DFLL48M POWER MONITOR CONTROL BOD33 VOLTAGE REFERENCE CONTROL VOLTAGE REFERENCE SYSTEM STATUS (PCLKSR register) INTERRUPTS GENERATOR © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Interrupts Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 144 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.4 Signal Description Signal Name Types Description XIN Analog Input Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator or external clock generator input XOUT Analog Output External Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator output XIN32 Analog Input 32kHz Crystal Oscillator or external clock generator input XOUT32 Analog Output 32kHz Crystal Oscillator output The I/O lines are automatically selected when XOSC or XOSC32K are enabled. Refer to Oscillator Pinout. Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 6.2.1. Oscillator Pinout 16.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. 16.5.1 I/O Lines I/O lines are configured by SYSCTRL when either XOSC or XOSC32K are enabled, and need no user configuration. 16.5.2 Power Management The BOD33 and BOD12 can trigger resets when the I/O supply or core supply voltages drop below the programmed threshold value. BOD33 and BOD12 can additionally wake up the system from standby mode when I/O or core supply failure is detected. However, BOD33 and BOD12 cannot be used in continuous mode when the system is in standby mode, and will, therefore, be automatically disabled until the system is woken up. Only sampled mode operation is allowed when the system is in standby mode. All oscillators except XOSC32K, OSC32K and OSCULP32K are turned off in some sleep modes and turned automatically on when the chip wakes up. The SYSCTRL can continue to operate in any sleep mode where the selected source clock is running. The SYSCTRL interrupts can be used to wake up the device from sleep modes. The events can trigger other operations in the system without exiting sleep modes. Refer to PM – Power Manager on the different sleep modes. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 16.5.3 Clocks The SYSCTRL gathers controls for all device oscillators and provides clock sources to the Generic Clock Controller (GCLK). The available clock sources are: XOSC, XOSC32K, OSC32K, OSCULP32K, OSC8M and DFLL48M. The SYSCTRL bus clock (CLK_SYSCTRL_APB) can be enabled and disabled in the Power Manager, and the default state of CLK_SYSCTRL_APB can be found in the Peripheral Clock Masking section in the PM – Power Manager. The clock used by BOD33in sampled mode is asynchronous to the user interface clock (CLK_SYSCTRL_APB). Likewise, the DFLL48M control logic uses the DFLL oscillator output, which is also asynchronous to the user interface clock (CLK_SYSCTRL_APB). Due to this asynchronicity, writes to certain registers will require synchronization between the clock domains. Refer to 16.6.12. Synchronization for further details. 16.5.4 Interrupts The interrupt request line is connected to the Interrupt Controller. Using the SYSCTRL interrupts requires the Interrupt Controller to be configured first. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 145 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.5.5 Debug Operation When the CPU is halted in debug mode, the SYSCTRL continues normal operation. If the SYSCTRL is configured in a way that requires it to be periodically serviced by the CPU through interrupts or similar, improper operation or data loss may result during debugging. If debugger cold-plugging is detected by the system, BOD33 reset will be masked. The BOD resets keep running under hot-plugging. This allows to correct a BOD33 user level too high for the available supply. 16.5.6 Register Access Protection Registers with write-access can be optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC), except for the following: • Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG) Note:  Optional write-protection is indicated by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in the register description. Write-protection does not apply for accesses through an external debugger. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller 16.8.3. INTFLAG 16.5.7 Analog Connections When used, the 32.768kHz crystal must be connected between the XIN32 and XOUT32 pins, and the 0.4-32MHz crystal must be connected between the XIN and XOUT pins, along with any required load capacitors. For details on recommended oscillator characteristics and capacitor load, refer to the Electrical Characteristics for details. Related Links 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 16.6 16.6.1 Functional Description Principle of Operation XOSC, XOSC32K, OSC32K, OSCULP32K, OSC8M, DFLL48M, BOD33, and VREF are configured via SYSCTRL control registers. Through this interface, the sub-peripherals are enabled, disabled or have their calibration values updated. The Power and Clocks Status register gathers different status signals coming from the sub-peripherals controlled by the SYSCTRL. The status signals can be used to generate system interrupts, and in some cases wake up the system from standby mode, provided the corresponding interrupt is enabled. The oscillator must be enabled to run. The oscillator is enabled by writing a one to the ENABLE bit in the respective oscillator control register, and disabled by writing a zero to the oscillator control register. In idle mode, the default operation of the oscillator is to run only when requested by a peripheral. In standby mode, the default operation of the oscillator is to stop. This behavior can be changed by the user, see below for details. The behavior of the oscillators in the different sleep modes is shown in the table below. Table 16-1. Behavior of the Oscillators Oscillator Idle 0, 1, 2 Standby XOSC Run on request Stop XOSC32K Run on request Stop OSC32K Run on request Stop OSCULP32K Run Run OSC8M Run on request Stop © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 146 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller ...........continued Oscillator Idle 0, 1, 2 Standby DFLL48M Run on request Stop To force an oscillator to always run in idle mode, and not only when requested by a peripheral, the oscillator ONDEMAND bit must be written to zero. The default value of this bit is one, and thus the default operation in idle mode is to run only when requested by a peripheral. To force the oscillator to run in standby mode, the RUNSTDBY bit must be written to one. The oscillator will then run in standby mode when requested by a peripheral (ONDEMAND is one). To force an oscillator to always run in standby mode, and not only when requested by a peripheral, the ONDEMAND bit must be written to zero and RUNSTDBY must be written to one. The next table shows the behavior in the different sleep modes, depending on the settings of ONDEMAND and RUNSTDBY. Table 16-2. Behavior in the different sleep modes Sleep mode ONDEMAND RUNSTDBY Behavior Idle 0, 1, 2 0 X Run Idle 0, 1, 2 1 X Run when requested by a peripheral Standby 0 0 Stop Standby 0 1 Run Standby 1 0 Stop Standby 1 1 Run when requested by a peripheral Note:  This does not apply to the OSCULP32K oscillator, which is always running and cannot be disabled. 16.6.2 External Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator (XOSC) Operation The XOSC can operate in two different modes: • • External clock, with an external clock signal connected to the XIN pin Crystal oscillator, with an external 0.4-32MHz crystal The XOSC can be used as a clock source for generic clock generators, as described in the GCLK – Generic Clock Controller. At reset, the XOSC is disabled, and the XIN/XOUT pins can be used as General Purpose I/O (GPIO) pins or by other peripherals in the system. When XOSC is enabled, the operating mode determines the GPIO usage. When in crystal oscillator mode, the XIN and XOUT pins are controlled by the SYSCTRL, and GPIO functions are overridden on both pins. When in external clock mode, only the XIN pin will be overridden and controlled by the SYSCTRL, while the XOUT pin can still be used as a GPIO pin. The XOSC is enabled by writing a one to the Enable bit in the External Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator Control register (XOSC.ENABLE). To enable the XOSC as a crystal oscillator, a one must be written to the XTAL Enable bit (XOSC.XTALEN). If XOSC.XTALEN is zero, external clock input will be enabled. When in crystal oscillator mode (XOSC.XTALEN is one), the External Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator Gain (XOSC.GAIN) must be set to match the external crystal oscillator frequency. If the External Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator Automatic Amplitude Gain Control (XOSC.AMPGC) is one, the oscillator amplitude will be automatically adjusted, and in most cases result in a lower power consumption. The XOSC will behave differently in different sleep modes based on the settings of XOSC.RUNSTDBY, XOSC.ONDEMAND and XOSC.ENABLE: XOSC.RUNSTDBY XOSC.ONDEMAND XOSC.ENABLE Sleep Behavior - - © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries 0 Disabled Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 147 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller ...........continued XOSC.RUNSTDBY XOSC.ONDEMAND XOSC.ENABLE Sleep Behavior 0 0 1 Always run in IDLE sleep modes. Disabled in STANDBY sleep mode. 0 1 1 Only run in IDLE sleep modes if requested by a peripheral. Disabled in STANDBY sleep mode. 1 0 1 Always run in IDLE and STANDBY sleep modes. 1 1 1 Only run in IDLE or STANDBY sleep modes if requested by a peripheral. After a hard reset, or when waking up from a sleep mode where the XOSC was disabled, the XOSC will need a certain amount of time to stabilize on the correct frequency. This start-up time can be configured by changing the Oscillator Start-Up Time bit group (XOSC.STARTUP) in the External Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator Control register. During the start-up time, the oscillator output is masked to ensure that no unstable clock propagates to the digital logic. The External Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator Ready bit in the Power and Clock Status register (PCLKSR.XOSCRDY) is set when the user-selected start-up time is over. An interrupt is generated on a zero-to-one transition on PCLKSR.XOSCRDY if the External Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator Ready bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET.XOSCRDY) is set. Note:  Do not enter standby mode when an oscillator is in start-up: Wait for the OSCxRDY bit in SYSCTRL.PCLKSR register to be set before going into standby mode. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 16.6.3 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator (XOSC32K) Operation The XOSC32K can operate in two different modes: • • External clock, with an external clock signal connected to XIN32 Crystal oscillator, with an external 32.768kHz crystal connected between XIN32 and XOUT32 The XOSC32K can be used as a source for generic clock generators, as described in the GCLK – Generic Clock Controller. At power-on reset (POR) the XOSC32K is disabled, and the XIN32/XOUT32 pins can be used as General Purpose I/O (GPIO) pins or by other peripherals in the system. When XOSC32K is enabled, the operating mode determines the GPIO usage. When in crystal oscillator mode, XIN32 and XOUT32 are controlled by the SYSCTRL, and GPIO functions are overridden on both pins. When in external clock mode, only the XIN32 pin will be overridden and controlled by the SYSCTRL, while the XOUT32 pin can still be used as a GPIO pin. The external clock or crystal oscillator is enabled by writing a one to the Enable bit (XOSC32K.ENABLE) in the 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator Control register. To enable the XOSC32K as a crystal oscillator, a one must be written to the XTAL Enable bit (XOSC32K.XTALEN). If XOSC32K.XTALEN is zero, external clock input will be enabled. The oscillator is disabled by writing a zero to the Enable bit (XOSC32K.ENABLE) in the 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator Control register while keeping the other bits unchanged. Writing to the XOSC32K.ENABLE bit while writing to other bits may result in unpredictable behavior. The oscillator remains enabled in all sleep modes if it has been enabled beforehand. The start-up time of the 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator is selected by writing to the Oscillator Start-Up Time bit group (XOSC32K.STARTUP) in the in the 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator Control register. The SYSCTRL masks the oscillator output during the start-up time to ensure that no unstable clock propagates to the digital logic. The 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator Ready bit (PCLKSR.XOSC32KRDY) in the Power and Clock Status register is set when the user-selected startup time is over. An interrupt is generated on a zero-to-one transition of PCLKSR.XOSC32KRDY if the 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator Ready bit (INTENSET.XOSC32KRDY) in the Interrupt Enable Set Register is set. As a crystal oscillator usually requires a very long start-up time (up to one second), the 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator will keep running across resets, except for power-on reset (POR). XOSC32K can provide two clock outputs when connected to a crystal. The XOSC32K has a 32.768kHz output enabled by writing a one to the 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator 32kHz Output Enable bit (XOSC32K.EN32K) in the © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 148 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator Control register. XOSC32K.EN32K is only usable when XIN32 is connected to a crystal, and not when an external digital clock is applied on XIN32. Note:  Do not enter standby mode when an oscillator is in start-up: Wait for the OSCxRDY bit in SYSCTRL.PCLKSR register to be set before going into standby mode. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 16.6.4 32kHz Internal Oscillator (OSC32K) Operation The OSC32K provides a tunable, low-speed and low-power clock source. The OSC32K can be used as a source for the generic clock generators, as described in the GCLK – Generic Clock Controller. The OSC32K is disabled by default. The OSC32K is enabled by writing a one to the 32kHz Internal Oscillator Enable bit (OSC32K.ENABLE) in the 32kHz Internal Oscillator Control register. It is disabled by writing a zero to OSC32K.ENABLE. The OSC32K has a 32.768kHz output enabled by writing a one to the 32kHz Internal Oscillator 32kHz Output Enable bit (OSC32K.EN32K). The frequency of the OSC32K oscillator is controlled by the value in the 32kHz Internal Oscillator Calibration bits (OSC32K.CALIB) in the 32kHz Internal Oscillator Control register. The OSC32K.CALIB value must be written by the user. Flash Factory Calibration values are stored in the NVM Software Calibration Area (refer to NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping). When writing to the Calibration bits, the user must wait for the PCLKSR.OSC32KRDY bit to go high before the value is committed to the oscillator. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 9.5. NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping 16.6.5 32kHz Ultra Low Power Internal Oscillator (OSCULP32K) Operation The OSCULP32K provides a tunable, low-speed and ultra-low-power clock source. The OSCULP32K is factorycalibrated under typical voltage and temperature conditions. The OSCULP32K should be preferred to the OSC32K whenever the power requirements are prevalent over frequency stability and accuracy. The OSCULP32K can be used as a source for the generic clock generators, as described in the GCLK – Generic Clock Controller. The OSCULP32K is enabled by default after a power-on reset (POR) and will always run except during POR. The OSCULP32K has a 32.768kHz output and a 1.024kHz output that are always running. The frequency of the OSCULP32K oscillator is controlled by the value in the 32kHz Ultra Low Power Internal Oscillator Calibration bits (OSCULP32K.CALIB) in the 32kHz Ultra Low Power Internal Oscillator Control register. OSCULP32K.CALIB is automatically loaded from Flash Factory Calibration during startup, and is used to compensate for process variation, as described in the Electrical Characteristics. The calibration value can be overridden by the user by writing to OSCULP32K.CALIB. Related Links 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 16.6.6 8MHz Internal Oscillator (OSC8M) Operation OSC8M is an internal oscillator operating in open-loop mode and generating an 8MHz frequency. The OSC8M is factory-calibrated under typical voltage and temperature conditions. OSC8M is the default clock source that is used after a power-on reset (POR). The OSC8M can be used as a source for the generic clock generators, as described in the GCLK – Generic Clock Controller. In order to enable OSC8M, the Oscillator Enable bit in the OSC8M Control register (OSC8M.ENABLE) must be written to one. OSC8M will not be enabled until OSC8M.ENABLE is set. In order to disable OSC8M, OSC8M.ENABLE must be written to zero. OSC8M will not be disabled until OSC8M is cleared. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 149 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller The frequency of the OSC8M oscillator is controlled by the value in the calibration bits (OSC8M.CALIB) in the OSC8M Control register. CALIB is automatically loaded from Flash Factory Calibration during start-up, and is used to compensate for process variation, as described in the Electrical Characteristics. The user can control the oscillation frequency by writing to the Frequency Range (FRANGE) and Calibration (CALIB) bit groups in the 8MHz RC Oscillator Control register (OSC8M). It is not recommended to update the FRANGE and CALIB bits when the OSC8M is enabled. As this is in open-loop mode, the frequency will be voltage, temperature and process dependent. Refer to the Electrical Characteristics for details. OSC8M is automatically switched off in certain sleep modes to reduce power consumption, as described in the PM – Power Manager. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 16.6.7 Digital Frequency Locked Loop (DFLL48M) Operation The DFLL48M can operate in both open-loop mode and closed-loop mode. In closed-loop mode, a low-frequency clock with high accuracy can be used as the reference clock to get high accuracy on the output clock (CLK_DFLL48M). The DFLL48M can be used as a source for the generic clock generators, as described in the GCLK – Generic Clock Controller. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 16.6.7.1 Basic Operation 16.6.7.1.1 Open-Loop Operation After any reset, the open-loop mode is selected. When operating in open-loop mode, the output frequency of the DFLL48M will be determined by the values written to the DFLL Coarse Value bit group and the DFLL Fine Value bit group (DFLLVAL.COARSE and DFLLVAL.FINE) in the DFLL Value register. Using "DFLL48M COARSE CAL" value from NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping in DFLL.COARSE helps to output a frequency close to 48 MHz. It is possible to change the values of DFLLVAL.COARSE and DFLLVAL.FINE and thereby the output frequency of the DFLL48M output clock, CLK_DFLL48M, while the DFLL48M is enabled and in use. CLK_DFLL48M is ready to be used when PCLKSR.DFLLRDY is set after enabling the DFLL48M. Related Links 9.5. NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping 16.6.7.1.2 Closed-Loop Operation In closed-loop operation, the output frequency is continuously regulated against a reference clock. Once the multiplication factor is set, the oscillator fine tuning is automatically adjusted. The DFLL48M must be correctly configured before closed-loop operation can be enabled. After enabling the DFLL48M, it must be configured in the following way: 1. 2. 3. Enable and select a reference clock (CLK_DFLL48M_REF). CLK_DFLL48M_REF is Generic Clock Channel 0 (GCLK_DFLL48M_REF). Refer to GCLK – Generic Clock Controller for details. Select the maximum step size allowed in finding the Coarse and Fine values by writing the appropriate values to the DFLL Coarse Maximum Step and DFLL Fine Maximum Step bit groups (DFLLMUL.CSTEP and DFLLMUL.FSTEP) in the DFLL Multiplier register. A small step size will ensure low overshoot on the output frequency, but will typically result in longer lock times. A high value might give a large overshoot, but will typically provide faster locking. DFLLMUL.CSTEP and DFLLMUL.FSTEP should not be higher than 50% of the maximum value of DFLLVAL.COARSE and DFLLVAL.FINE, respectively. Select the multiplication factor in the DFLL Multiply Factor bit group (DFLLMUL.MUL) in the DFLL Multiplier register. Care must be taken when choosing DFLLMUL.MUL so that the output frequency does not exceed the maximum frequency of the DFLL. If the target frequency is below the minimum frequency of the DFLL48M, the output frequency will be equal to the DFLL minimum frequency. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 150 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 4. Start the closed loop mode by writing a one to the DFLL Mode Selection bit (DFLLCTRL.MODE) in the DFLL Control register. The frequency of CLK_DFLL48M (Fclkdfll48m) is given by: Fclkdfll48m = DFLLMUL ⋅ MUL × Fclkdfll48mref where Fclkdfll48mref is the frequency of the reference clock (CLK_DFLL48M_REF). DFLLVAL.COARSE and DFLLVAL.FINE are read-only in closed-loop mode, and are controlled by the frequency tuner to meet user specified frequency. In closed-loop mode, the value in DFLLVAL.COARSE is used by the frequency tuner as a starting point for Coarse. Writing DFLLVAL.COARSE to a value close to the final value before entering closed-loop mode will reduce the time needed to get a lock on Coarse. Using "DFLL48M COARSE CAL" from NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping for DFLL.COARSE will start DFLL with a frequency close to 48 MHz. Following Software sequence should be followed while using the same. 1. 2. 3. load "DFLL48M COARSE CAL" from NVM User Row Mapping in DFLL.COARSE register Set DFLLCTRL.BPLCKC bit Start DFLL close loop This procedure will reduce DFLL Lock time to DFLL Fine lock time. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 9.5. NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping 16.6.7.1.3 Frequency Locking The locking of the frequency in closed-loop mode is divided into two stages. In the first, coarse stage, the control logic quickly finds the correct value for DFLLVAL.COARSE and sets the output frequency to a value close to the correct frequency. On coarse lock, the DFLL Locked on Coarse Value bit (PCLKSR.DFLLLOCKC) in the Power and Clocks Status register will be set. In the second, fine stage, the control logic tunes the value in DFLLVAL.FINE so that the output frequency is very close to the desired frequency. On fine lock, the DFLL Locked on Fine Value bit (PCLKSR.DFLLLOCKF) in the Power and Clocks Status register will be set. Interrupts are generated by both PCLKSR.DFLLLOCKC and PCLKSR.DFLLLOCKF if INTENSET.DFLLOCKC or INTENSET.DFLLOCKF are written to one. CLK_DFLL48M is ready to be used when the DFLL Ready bit (PCLKSR.DFLLRDY) in the Power and Clocks Status register is set, but the accuracy of the output frequency depends on which locks are set. For lock times, refer to the Electrical Characteristics. Related Links 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 16.6.7.1.4 Frequency Error Measurement The ratio between CLK_DFLL48M_REF and CLK48M_DFLL is measured automatically when the DFLL48M is in closed-loop mode. The difference between this ratio and the value in DFLLMUL.MUL is stored in the DFLL Multiplication Ratio Difference bit group(DFLLVAL.DIFF) in the DFLL Value register. The relative error on CLK_DFLL48M compared to the target frequency is calculated as follows: ERROR = DIFF MUL 16.6.7.1.5 Drift Compensation If the Stable DFLL Frequency bit (DFLLCTRL.STABLE) in the DFLL Control register is zero, the frequency tuner will automatically compensate for drift in the CLK_DFLL48M without losing either of the locks. This means that DFLLVAL.FINE can change after every measurement of CLK_DFLL48M. The DFLLVAL.FINE value overflows or underflows can occur in close loop mode when the clock source reference drifts or is unstable. This will set the DFLL Out Of Bounds bit (PCLKSR.DFLLOOB) in the Power and Clocks Status register. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 151 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller To avoid this error, the reference clock in close loop mode must be stable, an external oscillator is recommended and internal oscillator forbidden. The better choice is to use an XOSC32K. 16.6.7.1.6 Reference Clock Stop Detection If CLK_DFLL48M_REF stops or is running at a very low frequency (slower than CLK_DFLL48M/(2 * MULMAX)), the DFLL Reference Clock Stopped bit (PCLKSR.DFLLRCS) in the Power and Clocks Status register will be set. Detecting a stopped reference clock can take a long time, on the order of 217 CLK_DFLL48M cycles. When the reference clock is stopped, the DFLL48M will operate as if in open-loop mode. Closed-loop mode operation will automatically resume if the CLK_DFLL48M_REF is restarted. An interrupt is generated on a zero-to-one transition on PCLKSR.DFLLRCS if the DFLL Reference Clock Stopped bit (INTENSET.DFLLRCS) in the Interrupt Enable Set register is set. 16.6.7.2 Additional Features 16.6.7.2.1 Dealing with Delay in the DFLL in Closed-Loop Mode The time from selecting a new CLK_DFLL48M frequency until this frequency is output by the DFLL48M can be up to several microseconds. If the value in DFLLMUL.MUL is small, this can lead to instability in the DFLL48M locking mechanism, which can prevent the DFLL48M from achieving locks. To avoid this, a chill cycle, during which the CLK_DFLL48M frequency is not measured, can be enabled. The chill cycle is enabled by default, but can be disabled by writing a one to the DFLL Chill Cycle Disable bit (DFLLCTRL.CCDIS) in the DFLL Control register. Enabling chill cycles might double the lock time. Another solution to this problem consists of using less strict lock requirements. This is called Quick Lock (QL), which is also enabled by default, but it can be disabled by writing a one to the Quick Lock Disable bit (DFLLCTRL.QLDIS) in the DFLL Control register. The Quick Lock might lead to a larger spread in the output frequency than chill cycles, but the average output frequency is the same. 16.6.7.2.2 Wake from Sleep Modes DFLL48M can optionally reset its lock bits when it is disabled. This is configured by the Lose Lock After Wake bit (DFLLCTRL.LLAW) in the DFLL Control register. If DFLLCTRL.LLAW is zero, the DFLL48M will be re-enabled and start running with the same configuration as before being disabled, even if the reference clock is not available. The locks will not be lost. When the reference clock has restarted, the Fine tracking will quickly compensate for any frequency drift during sleep if DFLLCTRL.STABLE is zero. If DFLLCTRL.LLAW is one when the DFLL is turned off, the DFLL48M will lose all its locks, and needs to regain these through the full lock sequence. 16.6.7.2.3 Accuracy There are three main factors that determine the accuracy of Fclkdfll48m. These can be tuned to obtain maximum accuracy when fine lock is achieved. • • • 16.6.8 Fine resolution: The frequency step between two Fine values. This is relatively smaller for high output frequencies. Resolution of the measurement: If the resolution of the measured Fclkdfll48m is low, i.e., the ratio between the CLK_DFLL48M frequency and the CLK_DFLL48M_REF frequency is small, then the DFLL48M might lock at a frequency that is lower than the targeted frequency. It is recommended to use a reference clock frequency of 32kHz or lower to avoid this issue for low target frequencies. The accuracy of the reference clock. 3.3V Brown-Out Detector Operation The 3.3V BOD monitors the 3.3V VDDANA supply (BOD33). It supports continuous or sampling modes. The threshold value action (reset the device or generate an interrupt), the Hysteresis configuration, as well as the enable/disable settings are loaded from Flash User Calibration at startup, and can be overridden by writing to the corresponding BOD33 register bit groups. 16.6.8.1 3.3V Brown-Out Detector (BOD33) The 3.3V Brown-Out Detector (BOD33) monitors the VDDANA supply and compares the voltage with the brown-out threshold level set in the BOD33 Level bit group (BOD33.LEVEL) in the BOD33 register. The BOD33 can generate either an interrupt or a reset when VDDANA crosses below the brown-out threshold level. The BOD33 detection status can be read from the BOD33 Detection bit (PCLKSR.BOD33DET) in the Power and Clocks Status register. At start-up or at power-on reset (POR), the BOD33 register values are loaded from the Flash User Row. Refer to NVM User Row Mapping for more details. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 152 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller Related Links 9.4. NVM User Row Mapping 16.6.8.2 Continuous Mode When the BOD33 Mode bit (BOD33.MODE) in the BOD33 register is written to zero and the BOD33 is enabled, the BOD33 operates in continuous mode. In this mode, the BOD33 is continuously monitoring the VDDANA supply voltage. Continuous mode is the default mode for BOD33. 16.6.8.3 Sampling Mode The sampling mode is a low-power mode where the BOD33 is being repeatedly enabled on a sampling clock’s ticks. The BOD33 will monitor the supply voltage for a short period of time and then go to a low-power disabled state until the next sampling clock tick. Sampling mode is enabled by writing one to BOD33.MODE. The frequency of the clock ticks (Fclksampling) is controlled by the BOD33 Prescaler Select bit group (BOD33.PSEL) in the BOD33 register. Fclksampling = Fclkprescaler 2 PSEL+1 The prescaler signal (Fclkprescaler) is a 1kHz clock, output from the32kHz Ultra Low Power Oscillator, OSCULP32K. As the sampling mode clock is different from the APB clock domain, synchronization among the clocks is necessary. The next figure shows a block diagram of the sampling mode. The BOD33Synchronization Ready bits (PCLKSR.B33SRDY) in the Power and Clocks Status register show the synchronization ready status of the synchronizer. Writing attempts to the BOD33 register are ignored while PCLKSR.B33SRDY is zero. Figure 16-2. Sampling Mode Block diagram USER INTERFACE REGISTERS (APB clock domain) PSEL CEN SYNCHRONIZER MODE PRESCALER (clk_prescaler domain) CLK_SAMPLING ENABLE CLK_APB CLK_PRESCALER The BOD33 Clock Enable bit (BOD33.CEN) in the BOD33 register should always be disabled before changing the prescaler value. To change the prescaler value for the BOD33 during sampling mode, the following steps need to be taken: 1. Wait until the PCLKSR.B33SRDY bit is set. 2. Write the selected value to the BOD33.PSEL bit group. 16.6.8.4 Hysteresis The hysteresis functionality can be used in both continuous and sampling mode. Writing a one to the BOD33 Hysteresis bit (BOD33.HYST) in the BOD33 register will add hysteresis to the BOD33 threshold level. 16.6.9 Voltage Reference System Operation The Voltage Reference System (VREF) consists of a Bandgap Reference Voltage Generator and a temperature sensor. The Bandgap Reference Voltage Generator is factory-calibrated under typical voltage and temperature conditions. At reset, the VREF.CAL register value is loaded from Flash Factory Calibration. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 153 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller The temperature sensor can be used to get an absolute temperature in the temperature range of CMIN to CMAX degrees Celsius. The sensor will output a linear voltage proportional to the temperature. The output voltage and temperature range are located in the Electrical Characteristics. To calculate the temperature from a measured voltage, the following formula can be used: CMIN + Vmes+ − VoutMAX ∆temperature ∆voltage Related Links 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 16.6.9.1 User Control of the Voltage Reference System To enable the temperature sensor, write a one the Temperature Sensor Enable bit (VREF.TSEN) in the VREF register. The temperature sensor can be redirected to the ADC for conversion. The Bandgap Reference Voltage Generator output can also be routed to the ADC if the Bandgap Output Enable bit (VREF.BGOUTEN) in the VREF register is set. The Bandgap Reference Voltage Generator output level is determined by the CALIB bit group (VREF.CALIB) value in the VREF register.The default calibration value can be overridden by the user by writing to the CALIB bit group. 16.6.10 Voltage Regulator System Operation The embedded Voltage Regulator (VREG) is an internal voltage regulator that provides the core logic supply (VDDCORE). 16.6.11 Interrupts The SYSCTRL has the following interrupt sources: • • • • • • • • • • • • XOSCRDY - Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator Ready: A “0-to-1” transition on the PCLKSR.XOSCRDY bit is detected XOSC32KRDY - 32kHz Crystal Oscillator Ready: A “0-to-1” transition on the PCLKSR.XOSC32KRDY bit is detected OSC32KRDY - 32kHz Internal Oscillator Ready: A “0-to-1” transition on the PCLKSR.OSC32KRDY bit is detected OSC8MRDY - 8MHz Internal Oscillator Ready: A “0-to-1” transition on the PCLKSR.OSC8MRDY bit is detected DFLLRDY - DFLL48M Ready: A “0-to-1” transition on the PCLKSR.DFLLRDY bit is detected DFLLOOB - DFLL48M Out Of Boundaries: A “0-to-1” transition on the PCLKSR.DFLLOOB bit is detected DFLLLOCKF - DFLL48M Fine Lock: A “0-to-1” transition on the PCLKSR.DFLLLOCKF bit is detected DFLLLOCKC - DFLL48M Coarse Lock: A “0-to-1” transition on the PCLKSR.DFLLLOCKC bit is detected DFLLRCS - DFLL48M Reference Clock has Stopped: A “0-to-1” transition on the PCLKSR.DFLLRCS bit is detected BOD33RDY - BOD33 Ready: A “0-to-1” transition on the PCLKSR.BOD33RDY bit is detected BOD33DET - BOD33 Detection: A “0-to-1” transition on the PCLKSR.BOD33DET bit is detected. This is an asynchronous interrupt and can be used to wake-up the device from any sleep mode. B33SRDY - BOD33 Synchronization Ready: A “0-to-1” transition on the PCLKSR.B33SRDY bit is detected Each interrupt source has an interrupt flag associated with it. The interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear (INTFLAG) register is set when the interrupt condition occurs. Each interrupt can be individually enabled by writing a one to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Set (INTENSET) register, and disabled by writing a one to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Clear (INTENCLR) register. An interrupt request is generated when the interrupt flag is set and the corresponding interrupt is enabled. The interrupt request remains active until the interrupt flag is cleared, the interrupt is disabled, or the SYSCTRL is reset. See Interrupt Flag Status and Clear (INTFLAG) register for details on how to clear interrupt flags. All interrupt requests from the peripheral are ORed together on system level to generate one combined interrupt request to the NVIC. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. The user must read the INTFLAG register to determine which interrupt condition is present. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 154 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller Note:  Interrupts must be globally enabled for interrupt requests to be generated. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 16.6.12 Synchronization Due to the multiple clock domains, values in the DFLL48M control registers need to be synchronized to other clock domains. The status of this synchronization can be read from the Power and Clocks Status register (PCLKSR). Before writing to any of the DFLL48M control registers, the user must check that the DFLL Ready bit (PCLKSR.DFLLRDY) in PCLKSR is set to one. When this bit is set, the DFLL48M can be configured and CLK_DFLL48M is ready to be used. Any write to any of the DFLL48M control registers while DFLLRDY is zero will be ignored. An interrupt is generated on a zero-to-one transition of DFLLRDY if the DFLLRDY bit (INTENSET.DFLLDY) in the Interrupt Enable Set register is set. In order to read from any of the DFLL48M configuration registers, the user must request a read synchronization by writing a one to DFLLSYNC.READREQ. The registers can be read only when PCLKSR.DFLLRDY is set. If DFLLSYNC.READREQ is not written before a read, a synchronization will be started, and the bus will be halted until the synchronization is complete. Reading the DFLL48M registers when the DFLL48M is disabled will not halt the bus. The prescaler counter used to trigger one-shot brown-out detections also operates asynchronously from the peripheral bus. As a consequence, the prescaler registers require synchronization when written or read. The synchronization results in a delay from when the initialization of the write or read operation begins until the operation is complete. The write-synchronization is triggered by a write to the BOD33 control register. The Synchronization Ready bit (PCLKSR.B33SRDY) in the PCLKSR register will be cleared when the write-synchronization starts and set when the write-synchronization is complete. When the write-synchronization is ongoing (PCLKSR.B33SRDYis zero), an attempt to do any of the following will cause the peripheral bus to stall until the synchronization is complete: • • Writing to the BOD33control register Reading the BOD33 control register that was written The user can either poll PCLKSR.B33SRDY or use the INTENSET.B33SRDY interrupts to check when the synchronization is complete. It is also possible to perform the next read/write operation and wait, as this next operation will be completed after the ongoing read/write operation is synchronized. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 155 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.7 Offset 0x00 Register Summary Name Bit Pos. 7 6 5 4 7:0 DFLLLCKC DFLLLCKF DFLLOOB DFLLRDY INTENCLR 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 0x04 INTENSET INTFLAG PCLKSR 0x10 XOSC 0x12 ... 0x13 Reserved 0x14 XOSC32K 0x16 ... 0x17 Reserved 0x18 OSC32K 0x1C 0x1D ... 0x1F OSCULP32K 0x20 DFLLLCKF DFLLOOB DFLLRDY DFLLLCKC DFLLLCKF 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 DFLLOOB DFLLRDY [3:0] DFLLLCKC DFLLLCKF DFLLRDY 7:0 15:8 ONDEMAND RUNSTDBY 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 ONDEMAND RUNSTDBY 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 ONDEMAND RUNSTDBY XOSC32KRD Y BOD33DET BOD33RDY XOSC32KRD Y BOD33DET BOD33RDY XOSC32KRD Y BOD33DET BOD33RDY XOSC32KRD Y BOD33DET BOD33RDY OSC8MRDY OSC32KRDY B33SRDY ONDEMAND RUNSTDBY STARTUP[3:0] 0 OSC8MRDY OSC32KRDY B33SRDY [11:4] [19:12] DFLLOOB 1 OSC8MRDY OSC32KRDY B33SRDY 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 0x0C DFLLLCKC 2 OSC8MRDY OSC32KRDY B33SRDY 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 0x08 3 XTALEN ENABLE GAIN[2:0] XTALEN ENABLE STARTUP[2:0] EN32K ENABLE STARTUP[2:0] AMPGC AAMPEN EN32K WRTLOCK WRTLOCK XOSCRDY DFLLRCS XOSCRDY DFLLRCS XOSCRDY DFLLRCS XOSCRDY DFLLRCS CALIB[6:0] WRTLOCK CALIB[4:0] Reserved OSC8M 0x24 DFLLCTRL 0x26 ... 0x27 Reserved 0x28 DFLLVAL 0x2C DFLLMUL 0x30 DFLLSYNC 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 CALIB[7:0] FRANGE[1:0] ONDEMAND LLAW STABLE CALIB[11:8] MODE ENABLE QLDIS CCDIS FINE[7:0] COARSE[5:0] FINE[9:8] DIFF[7:0] DIFF[15:8] MUL[7:0] MUL[15:8] FSTEP[7:0] CSTEP[5:0] FSTEP[9:8] READREQ © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries ENABLE PRESC[1:0] Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 156 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller ...........continued Offset Name 0x31 ... 0x33 Reserved 0x34 BOD33 0x38 ... 0x3B Reserved 0x3C VREG 0x3E ... 0x3F Reserved 0x40 16.8 Bit Pos. VREF 7 6 5 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 RUNSTDBY PSEL[3:0] 7:0 15:8 RUNSTDBY 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 4 3 ACTION[1:0] 2 1 0 HYST ENABLE CEN MODE LEVEL[5:0] ENABLE FORCELDO BGOUTEN TSEN CALIB[7:0] CALIB[10:8] Register Description Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16-, and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers require synchronization when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the "ReadSynchronized" and/or "Write-Synchronized" property in each individual register description. Optional write-protection by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC) is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 157 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.1 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTENCLR 0x00 0x00000000 Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 B33SRDY R/W 0 10 BOD33DET R/W 0 9 BOD33RDY R/W 0 8 DFLLRCS R/W 0 7 DFLLLCKC R/W 0 6 DFLLLCKF R/W 0 5 DFLLOOB R/W 0 4 DFLLRDY R/W 0 3 OSC8MRDY R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset 2 1 OSC32KRDY XOSC32KRDY R/W R/W 0 0 0 XOSCRDY R/W 0 Bit 11 – B33SRDY BOD33 Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the BOD33 Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the BOD33 Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The BOD33 Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The BOD33 Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the BOD33 Synchronization Ready Interrupt flag is set. Bit 10 – BOD33DET BOD33 Detection Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the BOD33 Detection Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the BOD33 Detection interrupt. Value Description 0 The BOD33 Detection interrupt is disabled. 1 The BOD33 Detection interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the BOD33 Detection Interrupt flag is set. Bit 9 – BOD33RDY BOD33 Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the BOD33 Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the BOD33 Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The BOD33 Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The BOD33 Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the BOD33 Ready Interrupt flag is set. Bit 8 – DFLLRCS DFLL Reference Clock Stopped Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 158 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller Writing a one to this bit will clear the DFLL Reference Clock Stopped Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the DFLL Reference Clock Stopped interrupt. Value Description 0 The DFLL Reference Clock Stopped interrupt is disabled. 1 The DFLL Reference Clock Stopped interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the DFLL Reference Clock Stopped Interrupt flag is set. Bit 7 – DFLLLCKC DFLL Lock Coarse Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the DFLL Lock Coarse Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the DFLL Lock Coarse interrupt. Value Description 0 The DFLL Lock Coarse interrupt is disabled. 1 The DFLL Lock Coarse interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the DFLL Lock Coarse Interrupt flag is set. Bit 6 – DFLLLCKF DFLL Lock Fine Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the DFLL Lock Fine Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the DFLL Lock Fine interrupt. Value Description 0 The DFLL Lock Fine interrupt is disabled. 1 The DFLL Lock Fine interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the DFLL Lock Fine Interrupt flag is set. Bit 5 – DFLLOOB DFLL Out Of Bounds Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the DFLL Out Of Bounds Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the DFLL Out Of Bounds interrupt. Value Description 0 The DFLL Out Of Bounds interrupt is disabled. 1 The DFLL Out Of Bounds interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the DFLL Out Of Bounds Interrupt flag is set. Bit 4 – DFLLRDY DFLL Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the DFLL Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the DFLL Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The DFLL Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The DFLL Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the DFLL Ready Interrupt flag is set. Bit 3 – OSC8MRDY OSC8M Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the OSC8M Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the OSC8M Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The OSC8M Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The OSC8M Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the OSC8M Ready Interrupt flag is set. Bit 2 – OSC32KRDY OSC32K Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the OSC32K Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the OSC32K Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The OSC32K Ready interrupt is disabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 159 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller Value 1 Description The OSC32K Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the OSC32K Ready Interrupt flag is set. Bit 1 – XOSC32KRDY XOSC32K Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the XOSC32K Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the XOSC32K Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The XOSC32K Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The XOSC32K Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the XOSC32K Ready Interrupt flag is set. Bit 0 – XOSCRDY XOSC Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the XOSC Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the XOSC Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The XOSC Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The XOSC Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the XOSC Ready Interrupt flag is set. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 160 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.2 Interrupt Enable Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTENSET 0x04 0x00000000 Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 B33SRDY R/W 0 10 BOD33DET R/W 0 9 BOD33RDY R/W 0 8 DFLLRCS R/W 0 7 DFLLLCKC R/W 0 6 DFLLLCKF R/W 0 5 DFLLOOB R/W 0 4 DFLLRDY R/W 0 3 OSC8MRDY R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset 2 1 OSC32KRDY XOSC32KRDY R/W R/W 0 0 0 XOSCRDY R/W 0 Bit 11 – B33SRDY BOD33 Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the BOD33 Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the BOD33 Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The BOD33 Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The BOD33 Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the BOD33 Synchronization Ready Interrupt flag is set. Bit 10 – BOD33DET BOD33 Detection Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the BOD33 Detection Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the BOD33 Detection interrupt. Value Description 0 The BOD33 Detection interrupt is disabled. 1 The BOD33 Detection interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the BOD33 Detection Interrupt flag is set. Bit 9 – BOD33RDY BOD33 Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the BOD33 Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the BOD33 Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The BOD33 Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The BOD33 Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the BOD33 Ready Interrupt flag is set. Bit 8 – DFLLRCS DFLL Reference Clock Stopped Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 161 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller Writing a one to this bit will set the DFLL Reference Clock Stopped Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the DFLL Reference Clock Stopped interrupt. Value Description 0 The DFLL Reference Clock Stopped interrupt is disabled. 1 The DFLL Reference Clock Stopped interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the DFLL Reference Clock Stopped Interrupt flag is set. Bit 7 – DFLLLCKC DFLL Lock Coarse Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the DFLL Lock Coarse Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the DFLL Lock Coarse interrupt. Value Description 0 The DFLL Lock Coarse interrupt is disabled. 1 The DFLL Lock Coarse interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the DFLL Lock Coarse Interrupt flag is set. Bit 6 – DFLLLCKF DFLL Lock Fine Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the DFLL Lock Fine Interrupt Disable/Enable bit, disable the DFLL Lock Fine interrupt and set the corresponding interrupt request. Value Description 0 The DFLL Lock Fine interrupt is disabled. 1 The DFLL Lock Fine interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the DFLL Lock Fine Interrupt flag is set. Bit 5 – DFLLOOB DFLL Out Of Bounds Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the DFLL Out Of Bounds Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the DFLL Out Of Bounds interrupt. Value Description 0 The DFLL Out Of Bounds interrupt is disabled. 1 The DFLL Out Of Bounds interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the DFLL Out Of Bounds Interrupt flag is set. Bit 4 – DFLLRDY DFLL Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the DFLL Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the DFLL Ready interrupt and set the corresponding interrupt request. Value Description 0 The DFLL Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The DFLL Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the DFLL Ready Interrupt flag is set. Bit 3 – OSC8MRDY OSC8M Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the OSC8M Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the OSC8M Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The OSC8M Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The OSC8M Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the OSC8M Ready Interrupt flag is set. Bit 2 – OSC32KRDY OSC32K Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the OSC32K Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the OSC32K Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The OSC32K Ready interrupt is disabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 162 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller Value 1 Description The OSC32K Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the OSC32K Ready Interrupt flag is set. Bit 1 – XOSC32KRDY XOSC32K Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the XOSC32K Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the XOSC32K Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The XOSC32K Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The XOSC32K Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the XOSC32K Ready Interrupt flag is set. Bit 0 – XOSCRDY XOSC Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the XOSC Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the XOSC Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The XOSC Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The XOSC Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the XOSC Ready Interrupt flag is set. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 163 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.3 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 31 INTFLAG 0x08 0x00000000 - 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 19 18 17 16 [19:12] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bit 23 22 21 20 [11:4] Access Reset R 0 R 0 Bit 15 14 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 13 12 10 BOD33DET R/W 0 9 BOD33RDY R/W 0 8 DFLLRCS R/W 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 11 B33SRDY R/W 0 7 DFLLLCKC R/W 0 6 DFLLLCKF R/W 0 5 DFLLOOB R/W 0 4 DFLLRDY R/W 0 3 OSC8MRDY R/W 0 [3:0] Access Reset Bit Access Reset 2 1 OSC32KRDY XOSC32KRDY R/W R/W 0 0 0 XOSCRDY R/W 0 Bits 31:12 – [19:0] Reserved These bits are unused and reserved for future use. For compatibility with future devices, always write these bits to zero when this register is written. These bits will always return zero when read. Bit 11 – B33SRDY BOD33 Synchronization Ready This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set on a zero-to-one transition of the BOD33 Synchronization Ready bit in the Status register (PCLKSR.B33SRDY) and will generate an interrupt request if INTENSET.B33SRDY is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the BOD33 Synchronization Ready interrupt flag Bit 10 – BOD33DET BOD33 Detection This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set on a zero-to-one transition of the BOD33 Detection bit in the Status register (PCLKSR.BOD33DET) and will generate an interrupt request if INTENSET.BOD33DET is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the BOD33 Detection interrupt flag. Bit 9 – BOD33RDY BOD33 Ready This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set on a zero-to-one transition of the BOD33 Ready bit in the Status register (PCLKSR.BOD33RDY) and will generate an interrupt request if INTENSET.BOD33RDY is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the BOD33 Ready interrupt flag. Bit 8 – DFLLRCS DFLL Reference Clock Stopped This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set on a zero-to-one transition of the DFLL Reference Clock Stopped bit in the Status register (PCLKSR.DFLLRCS) and will generate an interrupt request if INTENSET.DFLLRCS is one. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 164 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the DFLL Reference Clock Stopped interrupt flag. Bit 7 – DFLLLCKC DFLL Lock Coarse This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set on a zero-to-one transition of the DFLL Lock Coarse bit in the Status register (PCLKSR.DFLLLCKC) and will generate an interrupt request if INTENSET.DFLLLCKC is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the DFLL Lock Coarse interrupt flag. Bit 6 – DFLLLCKF DFLL Lock Fine This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set on a zero-to-one transition of the DFLL Lock Fine bit in the Status register (PCLKSR.DFLLLCKF) and will generate an interrupt request if INTENSET.DFLLLCKF is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the DFLL Lock Fine interrupt flag. Bit 5 – DFLLOOB DFLL Out Of Bounds This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set on a zero-to-one transition of the DFLL Out Of Bounds bit in the Status register (PCLKSR.DFLLOOB) and will generate an interrupt request if INTENSET.DFLLOOB is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the DFLL Out Of Bounds interrupt flag. Bit 4 – DFLLRDY DFLL Ready This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set on a zero-to-one transition of the DFLL Ready bit in the Status register (PCLKSR.DFLLRDY) and will generate an interrupt request if INTENSET.DFLLRDY is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the DFLL Ready interrupt flag. Bit 3 – OSC8MRDY OSC8M Ready This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set on a zero-to-one transition of the OSC8M Ready bit in the Status register (PCLKSR.OSC8MRDY) and will generate an interrupt request if INTENSET.OSC8MRDY is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the OSC8M Ready interrupt flag. Bit 2 – OSC32KRDY OSC32K Ready This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set on a zero-to-one transition of the OSC32K Ready bit in the Status register (PCLKSR.OSC32KRDY) and will generate an interrupt request if INTENSET.OSC32KRDY is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the OSC32K Ready interrupt flag. Bit 1 – XOSC32KRDY XOSC32K Ready This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set on a zero-to-one transition of the XOSC32K Ready bit in the Status register (PCLKSR.XOSC32KRDY) and will generate an interrupt request if INTENSET.XOSC32KRDY is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the XOSC32K Ready interrupt flag. Bit 0 – XOSCRDY XOSC Ready This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set on a zero-to-one transition of the XOSC Ready bit in the Status register (PCLKSR.XOSCRDY) and will generate an interrupt request if INTENSET.XOSCRDY is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the XOSC Ready interrupt flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 165 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.4 Power and Clocks Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit PCLKSR 0x0C 0x00000000 - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 B33SRDY R 0 10 BOD33DET R 0 9 BOD33RDY R 0 8 DFLLRCS R 0 7 DFLLLCKC R 0 6 DFLLLCKF R 0 5 DFLLOOB R 0 4 DFLLRDY R 0 3 OSC8MRDY R 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset 2 1 OSC32KRDY XOSC32KRDY R R 0 0 0 XOSCRDY R 0 Bit 11 – B33SRDY BOD33 Synchronization Ready Value Description 0 BOD33 synchronization is complete. 1 BOD33 synchronization is ongoing. Bit 10 – BOD33DET BOD33 Detection Value Description 0 No BOD33 detection. 1 BOD33 has detected that the I/O power supply is going below the BOD33 reference value. Bit 9 – BOD33RDY BOD33 Ready Value Description 0 BOD33 is not ready. 1 BOD33 is ready. Bit 8 – DFLLRCS DFLL Reference Clock Stopped Value Description 0 DFLL reference clock is running. 1 DFLL reference clock has stopped. Bit 7 – DFLLLCKC DFLL Lock Coarse Value Description 0 No DFLL coarse lock detected. 1 DFLL coarse lock detected. Bit 6 – DFLLLCKF DFLL Lock Fine Value Description 0 No DFLL fine lock detected. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 166 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller Value 1 Description DFLL fine lock detected. Bit 5 – DFLLOOB DFLL Out Of Bounds Value Description 0 No DFLL Out Of Bounds detected. 1 DFLL Out Of Bounds detected. Bit 4 – DFLLRDY DFLL Ready This bit is cleared when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is complete. This bit is set when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is started. Value Description 0 The Synchronization is ongoing. 1 The Synchronization is complete. Bit 3 – OSC8MRDY OSC8M Ready Value Description 0 OSC8M is not ready. 1 OSC8M is stable and ready to be used as a clock source. Bit 2 – OSC32KRDY OSC32K Ready Value Description 0 OSC32K is not ready. 1 OSC32K is stable and ready to be used as a clock source. Bit 1 – XOSC32KRDY XOSC32K Ready Value Description 0 XOSC32K is not ready. 1 XOSC32K is stable and ready to be used as a clock source. Bit 0 – XOSCRDY XOSC Ready Value Description 0 XOSC is not ready. 1 XOSC is stable and ready to be used as a clock source. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 167 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.5 External Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator (XOSC) Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 15 Access Reset Bit Access Reset XOSC 0x10 0x0080 Write-Protected 14 13 STARTUP[3:0] R/W R/W 0 0 R/W 0 7 ONDEMAND R/W 1 6 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 5 12 R/W 0 11 AMPGC R/W 0 4 3 10 R/W 0 9 GAIN[2:0] R/W 0 2 XTALEN R/W 0 1 ENABLE R/W 0 8 R/W 0 0 Bits 15:12 – STARTUP[3:0] Start-Up Time These bits select start-up time for the oscillator according to the table below. The OSCULP32K oscillator is used to clock the start-up counter. STARTUP[3:0] Number of OSCULP32K Clock Cycles Number of XOSC Clock Cycles Approximate Equivalent Time(1)(2)(3) 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 0x9 0xA 0xB 0xC 0xD 0xE 0xF 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 31 μs 61 μs 122 μs 244 μs 488 μs 977 μs 1953 μs 3906 μs 7813 μs 15625 μs 31250 μs 62500 μs 125000 μs 250000 μs 500000 μs 1000000 μs 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 128 256 512 1024 2048 4096 8192 16384 32768 Notes:  1. Number of cycles for the start-up counter 2. Number of cycles for the synchronization delay, before PCLKSR.XOSCRDY is set. 3. Actual start-up time is n OSCULP32K cycles + 3 XOSC cycles, but given the time neglects the three XOSC cycles. Bit 11 – AMPGC Automatic Amplitude Gain Control Note:  The configuration of the oscillator gain is mandatory even if AMPGC feature is enabled at startup. Value 0 1 Description The automatic amplitude gain control is disabled The automatic amplitude gain control is enabled. Amplitude gain will be automatically adjusted during Crystal Oscillator operation. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 168 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller Bits 10:8 – GAIN[2:0] Oscillator Gain These bits select the gain for the oscillator. The listed maximum frequencies are recommendations, and might vary based on capacitive load and crystal characteristics. These bits must be properly configured even when the Automatic Amplitude Gain Control is active. GAIN[2:0] Recommended Max Frequency 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5-0x7 2 MHz 4 MHz 8 MHz 16 MHz 30 MHz Reserved Bit 7 – ONDEMAND On Demand Control The On Demand operation mode allows an oscillator to be enabled or disabled, depending on peripheral clock requests. In On Demand operation mode (i.e., if the XOSC.ONDEMAND bit has been previously written to one), the oscillator will be running only when requested by a peripheral. If there is no peripheral requesting the oscillator s clock source, the oscillator will be in a disabled state. If On Demand is disabled, the oscillator will always be running when enabled. In Standby Sleep mode, the On Demand operation is still active if the XOSC.RUNSTDBY bit is one. If XOSC.RUNSTDBY is zero, the oscillator is disabled. Value Description 0 The oscillator is always on, if enabled 1 The oscillator is enabled when a peripheral is requesting the oscillator to be used as a clock source. The oscillator is disabled if no peripheral is requesting the clock source. Bit 6 – RUNSTDBY Run in Standby This bit controls how the XOSC behaves during Standby Sleep mode: Value Description 0 The oscillator is disabled in Standby Sleep mode. 1 The oscillator is not stopped in Standby Sleep mode. If XOSC.ONDEMAND is one, the clock source will be running when a peripheral is requesting the clock. If XOSC.ONDEMAND is zero, the clock source will always be running in Standby Sleep mode. Bit 2 – XTALEN Crystal Oscillator Enable This bit controls the connections between the I/O pads and the external clock or crystal oscillator: Value Description 0 External clock connected on XIN. XOUT can be used as general purpose I/O. 1 Crystal connected to XIN/XOUT Bit 1 – ENABLE Oscillator Enable Value Description 0 The oscillator is disabled 1 The oscillator is enabled © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 169 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.6 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator (XOSC32K) Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit XOSC32K 0x14 0x0080 Write-Protected 15 14 13 Access Reset Bit Access Reset 7 ONDEMAND R/W 1 6 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 12 WRTLOCK R/W 0 11 4 3 EN32K R/W 0 5 AAMPEN R/W 0 10 R/W 0 9 STARTUP[2:0] R/W 0 2 XTALEN R/W 0 1 ENABLE R/W 0 8 R/W 0 0 Bit 12 – WRTLOCK Write Lock This bit locks the XOSC32K register for future writes to fix the XOSC32K configuration. Value Description 0 The XOSC32K configuration is not locked. 1 The XOSC32K configuration is locked. Bits 10:8 – STARTUP[2:0] Oscillator Start-Up Time These bits select the start-up time for the oscillator. The OSCULP32K oscillator is used to clock the start-up counter. Table 16-3. Start-Up Time for 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator STARTUP[2:0] Number of OSCULP32K Clock Cycles Number of XOSC32K Clock Cycles Approximate Equivalent Time (OSCULP = 32kHz)(1)(2)(3) 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 122μs 1068μs 62592μs 125092μs 500092μs 1000092μs 2000092μs 4000092μs 1 32 2048 4096 16384 32768 65536 131072 Notes: 1. Number of cycles for the start-up counter. 2. Number of cycles for the synchronization delay, before PCLKSR.XOSC32KRDY is set. 3. Start-up time is n OSCULP32K cycles + 3 XOSC32K cycles. Bit 7 – ONDEMAND On Demand Control The On Demand operation mode allows an oscillator to be enabled or disabled depending on peripheral clock requests. In On Demand operation mode, i.e., if the ONDEMAND bit has been previously written to one, the oscillator will only be running when requested by a peripheral. If there is no peripheral requesting the oscillator s clock source, the oscillator will be in a disabled state. If On Demand is disabled the oscillator will always be running when enabled. In standby sleep mode, the On Demand operation is still active if the XOSC32K.RUNSTDBY bit is one. If XOSC32K.RUNSTDBY is zero, the oscillator is disabled. Value Description 0 The oscillator is always on, if enabled. 1 The oscillator is enabled when a peripheral is requesting the oscillator to be used as a clock source. The oscillator is disabled if no peripheral is requesting the clock source. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 170 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller Bit 6 – RUNSTDBY Run in Standby This bit controls how the XOSC32K behaves during standby sleep mode: Value Description 0 The oscillator is disabled in standby sleep mode. 1 The oscillator is not stopped in standby sleep mode. If XOSC32K.ONDEMAND is one, the clock source will be running when a peripheral is requesting the clock. If XOSC32K.ONDEMAND is zero, the clock source will always be running in standby sleep mode. Bit 5 – AAMPEN Automatic Amplitude Control Enable Value Description 0 The automatic amplitude control for the crystal oscillator is disabled. 1 The automatic amplitude control for the crystal oscillator is enabled. Bit 3 – EN32K 32kHz Output Enable This bit controls the connections between the I/O pads and the external clock or crystal oscillator: Value Description 0 The 32kHz output is disabled. 1 The 32kHz output is enabled. Bit 2 – XTALEN Crystal Oscillator Enable This bit controls the connections between the I/O pads and the external clock or crystal oscillator: Value Description 0 External clock connected on XIN32. XOUT32 can be used as general-purpose I/O. 1 Crystal connected to XIN32/XOUT32. Bit 1 – ENABLE Oscillator Enable Value Description 0 The oscillator is disabled. 1 The oscillator is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 171 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.7 32kHz Internal Oscillator (OSC32K) Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit OSC32K 0x18 0x003F0080 Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 1 R/W 1 19 CALIB[6:0] R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 R/W 1 14 13 12 WRTLOCK R/W 0 11 10 8 R/W 0 9 STARTUP[2:0] R/W 0 4 3 2 EN32K R/W 0 1 ENABLE R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 15 Access Reset Bit Access Reset 7 ONDEMAND R/W 1 6 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 5 R/W 0 0 Bits 22:16 – CALIB[6:0] Oscillator Calibration These bits control the oscillator calibration. This value must be written by the user. Factory calibration values can be loaded from the non-volatile memory. Bit 12 – WRTLOCK Write Lock This bit locks the OSC32K register for future writes to fix the OSC32K configuration. Value Description 0 The OSC32K configuration is not locked. 1 The OSC32K configuration is locked. Bits 10:8 – STARTUP[2:0] Oscillator Start-Up Time These bits select start-up time for the oscillator. The OSCULP32K oscillator is used as input clock to the startup counter. Table 16-4. Start-Up Time for 32kHz Internal Oscillator STARTUP[2:0] Number of OSC32K clock cycles Approximate Equivalent Time (OSCULP= 32 kHz)(1)(2)(3) 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 3 4 6 10 18 34 66 130 92μs 122μs 183μs 305μs 549μs 1038μs 2014μs 3967μs Notes: 1. Number of cycles for the start-up counter. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 172 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 2. Number of cycles for the synchronization delay, before PCLKSR.OSC32KRDY is set. 3. Start-up time is n OSC32K cycles + 2 OSC32K cycles. Bit 7 – ONDEMAND On Demand Control The On Demand operation mode allows an oscillator to be enabled or disabled depending on peripheral clock requests. In On Demand operation mode, i.e., if the ONDEMAND bit has been previously written to one, the oscillator will only be running when requested by a peripheral. If there is no peripheral requesting the oscillator s clock source, the oscillator will be in a disabled state. If On Demand is disabled the oscillator will always be running when enabled. In standby sleep mode, the On Demand operation is still active if the OSC32K.RUNSTDBY bit is one. If OSC32K.RUNSTDBY is zero, the oscillator is disabled. Value Description 0 The oscillator is always on, if enabled. 1 The oscillator is enabled when a peripheral is requesting the oscillator to be used as a clock source. The oscillator is disabled if no peripheral is requesting the clock source. Bit 6 – RUNSTDBY Run in Standby This bit controls how the OSC32K behaves during standby sleep mode: Value Description 0 The oscillator is disabled in standby sleep mode. 1 The oscillator is not stopped in standby sleep mode. If OSC32K.ONDEMAND is one, the clock source will be running when a peripheral is requesting the clock. If OSC32K.ONDEMAND is zero, the clock source will always be running in standby sleep mode. Bit 2 – EN32K 32kHz Output Enable Value Description 0 The 32kHz output is disabled. 1 The 32kHz output is enabled. 0 The oscillator is disabled. 1 The oscillator is enabled. Bit 1 – ENABLE Oscillator Enable Value Description 0 The oscillator is disabled. 1 The oscillator is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 173 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.8 32kHz Ultra Low Power Internal Oscillator (OSCULP32K) Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset OSCULP32K 0x1C 0xXX Write-Protected 7 WRTLOCK R/W 0 6 5 4 3 R/W x R/W x 2 CALIB[4:0] R/W x 1 0 R/W x R/W x Bit 7 – WRTLOCK Write Lock This bit locks the OSCULP32K register for future writes to fix the OSCULP32K configuration. Value Description 0 The OSCULP32K configuration is not locked. 1 The OSCULP32K configuration is locked. Bits 4:0 – CALIB[4:0] Oscillator Calibration These bits control the oscillator calibration. These bits are loaded from Flash Calibration at startup. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 174 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.9 8MHz Internal Oscillator (OSC8M) Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit OSC8M 0x20 0xXXXX0382 Write-Protected 31 30 FRANGE[1:0] R/W R/W x x Access Reset Bit 23 22 29 28 27 26 25 24 CALIB[11:8] 21 20 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 19 18 17 16 R/W x CALIB[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 7 ONDEMAND R/W 1 6 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 5 4 3 2 Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset 8 PRESC[1:0] R/W R/W 1 1 1 ENABLE R/W 1 0 Bits 31:30 – FRANGE[1:0] Oscillator Frequency Range These bits control the oscillator frequency range according to the table below. These bits are loaded from Flash Calibration at startup. FRANGE[1:0] Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 4 to 6MHz 6 to 8MHz 8 to 11MHz 11 to 15MHz Bits 27:16 – CALIB[11:0] Oscillator Calibration These bits control the oscillator calibration. The calibration field is split in two: CALIB[11:6] is for temperature calibration CALIB[5:0] is for overall process calibration These bits are loaded from Flash Calibration at startup. Bits 9:8 – PRESC[1:0] Oscillator Prescaler These bits select the oscillator prescaler factor setting according to the table below. PRESC[1:0] Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 1 2 4 8 Bit 7 – ONDEMAND On Demand Control The On Demand operation mode allows an oscillator to be enabled or disabled depending on peripheral clock requests. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 175 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller In On Demand operation mode, i.e., if the ONDEMAND bit has been previously written to one, the oscillator will only be running when requested by a peripheral. If there is no peripheral requesting the oscillator's clock source, the oscillator will be in a disabled state. If On Demand is disabled the oscillator will always be running when enabled. In standby sleep mode, the On Demand operation is still active if the OSC8M.RUNSTDBY bit is one. If OSC8M.RUNSTDBY is zero, the oscillator is disabled. Value Description 0 The oscillator is always on, if enabled. 1 The oscillator is enabled when a peripheral is requesting the oscillator to be used as a clock source. The oscillator is disabled if no peripheral is requesting the clock source. Bit 6 – RUNSTDBY Run in Standby This bit controls how the OSC8M behaves during standby sleep mode: Value Description 0 The oscillator is disabled in standby sleep mode. 1 The oscillator is not stopped in standby sleep mode. If OSC8M.ONDEMAND is one, the clock source will be running when a peripheral is requesting the clock. If OSC8M.ONDEMAND is zero, the clock source will always be running in standby sleep mode. Bit 1 – ENABLE Oscillator Enable The user must ensure that the OSC8M is fully disabled before enabling it, and that the OSC8M is fully enabled before disabling it by reading OSC8M.ENABLE. Value Description 0 The oscillator is disabled or being enabled. 1 The oscillator is enabled or being disabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 176 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.10 DFLL48M Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit DFLLCTRL 0x24 0x0080 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 QLDIS R/W 0 8 CCDIS R/W 0 7 ONDEMAND R/W 1 6 5 4 LLAW R/W 0 3 STABLE R/W 0 2 MODE R/W 0 1 ENABLE R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 9 – QLDIS Quick Lock Disable Value Description 0 Quick Lock is enabled. 1 Quick Lock is disabled. Bit 8 – CCDIS Chill Cycle Disable Value Description 0 Chill Cycle is enabled. 1 Chill Cycle is disabled. Bit 7 – ONDEMAND On Demand Control The On Demand operation mode allows an oscillator to be enabled or disabled depending on peripheral clock requests. In On Demand operation mode, i.e., if the ONDEMAND bit has been previously written to one, the oscillator will only be running when requested by a peripheral. If there is no peripheral requesting the oscillator s clock source, the oscillator will be in a disabled state. If On Demand is disabled the oscillator will always be running when enabled. In standby sleep mode, the On Demand operation is still active if the DFLLCTRL.RUNSTDBY bit is one. If DFLLCTRL.RUNSTDBY is zero, the oscillator is disabled. Value Description 0 The oscillator is always on, if enabled. 1 The oscillator is enabled when a peripheral is requesting the oscillator to be used as a clock source. The oscillator is disabled if no peripheral is requesting the clock source. Bit 4 – LLAW Lose Lock After Wake Value Description 0 Locks will not be lost after waking up from sleep modes if the DFLL clock has been stopped. 1 Locks will be lost after waking up from sleep modes if the DFLL clock has been stopped. Bit 3 – STABLE Stable DFLL Frequency Value Description 0 FINE calibration tracks changes in output frequency. 1 FINE calibration register value will be fixed after a fine lock. Bit 2 – MODE Operating Mode Selection Value Description 0 The DFLL operates in open-loop operation. 1 The DFLL operates in closed-loop operation. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 177 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller Bit 1 – ENABLE DFLL Enable Due to synchronization, there is delay from updating the register until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to DFLLCTRL.ENABLE will read back immediately after written. Value Description 0 The DFLL oscillator is disabled. 1 The DFLL oscillator is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 178 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.11 DFLL48M Value Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 31 DFLLVAL 0x28 0x00000000 Read-Synchronized, Write-Protected 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 19 18 17 16 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 11 10 9 DIFF[15:8] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bit 23 22 21 20 DIFF[7:0] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 Bit 15 14 13 Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 R 0 12 COARSE[5:0] R/W R/W 0 0 5 8 FINE[9:8] 4 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 FINE[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 31:16 – DIFF[15:0] Multiplication Ratio Difference In closed-loop mode (DFLLCTRL.MODE is written to one), this bit group indicates the difference between the ideal number of DFLL cycles and the counted number of cycles. This value is not updated in open-loop mode, and should be considered invalid in that case. Bits 15:10 – COARSE[5:0] Coarse Value Set the value of the Coarse Calibration register. In closed-loop mode, this field is read-only. Bits 9:0 – FINE[9:0] Fine Value Set the value of the Fine Calibration register. In closed-loop mode, this field is read-only. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 179 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.12 DFLL48M Multiplier Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 31 DFLLMUL 0x2C 0x00000000 Write-Protected 30 29 28 27 26 25 CSTEP[5:0] Access Reset Bit 24 FSTEP[9:8] R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 23 22 21 20 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 FSTEP[7:0] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 MUL[15:8] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 MUL[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 31:26 – CSTEP[5:0] Coarse Maximum Step This bit group indicates the maximum step size allowed during coarse adjustment in closed-loop mode. When adjusting to a new frequency, the expected output frequency overshoot depends on this step size. Bits 25:16 – FSTEP[9:0] Fine Maximum Step This bit group indicates the maximum step size allowed during fine adjustment in closed-loop mode. When adjusting to a new frequency, the expected output frequency overshoot depends on this step size. Bits 15:0 – MUL[15:0] DFLL Multiply Factor This field determines the ratio of the CLK_DFLL output frequency to the CLK_DFLL_REF input frequency. Writing to the MUL bits will cause locks to be lost and the fine calibration value to be reset to its midpoint. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 180 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.13 DFLL48M Synchronization Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset DFLLSYNC 0x30 0x00 Write-Protected 7 READREQ W 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 7 – READREQ Read Request To be able to read the current value of DFLLVAL in closed-loop mode, this bit should be written to one. The updated value is available in DFLLVAL when PCLKSR.DFLLRDY is set. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 181 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.14 3.3V Brown-Out Detector (BOD33) Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit BOD33 0x34 0x00XX00XX Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 31 30 29 28 27 23 22 21 20 19 26 25 24 18 17 16 Access Reset Bit LEVEL[5:0] Access Reset Bit 15 14 R/W x R/W x R/W x R/W x R/W x R/W x 13 12 11 10 9 CEN R/W 0 8 MODE R/W 0 2 HYST R/W x 1 ENABLE R/W x 0 PSEL[3:0] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 5 4 Access Reset 3 ACTION[1:0] R/W R/W x x Bits 21:16 – LEVEL[5:0] BOD33 Threshold Level This field sets the triggering voltage threshold for the BOD33. See the Electrical Characteristics for actual voltage levels. Note that any change to the LEVEL field of the BOD33 register should be done when the BOD33 is disabled in order to avoid spurious resets or interrupts. These bits are loaded from Flash User Row at start-up. Refer to NVM User Row Mapping for more details. Bits 15:12 – PSEL[3:0] Prescaler Select Selects the prescaler divide-by output for the BOD33 sampling mode according to the table below. The input clock comes from the OSCULP32K 1kHz output. PSEL[3:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 0x9 0xA 0xB 0xC 0xD 0xE 0xF DIV2 DIV4 DIV8 DIV16 DIV32 DIV64 DIV128 DIV256 DIV512 DIV1K DIV2K DIV4K DIV8K DIV16K DIV32K DIV64K Divide clock by 2 Divide clock by 4 Divide clock by 8 Divide clock by 16 Divide clock by 32 Divide clock by 64 Divide clock by 128 Divide clock by 256 Divide clock by 512 Divide clock by 1024 Divide clock by 2048 Divide clock by 4096 Divide clock by 8192 Divide clock by 16384 Divide clock by 32768 Divide clock by 65536 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 182 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller Bit 9 – CEN Clock Enable Writing a zero to this bit will stop the BOD33 sampling clock. Writing a one to this bit will start the BOD33 sampling clock. Value Description 0 The BOD33 sampling clock is either disabled and stopped, or enabled but not yet stable. 1 The BOD33 sampling clock is either enabled and stable, or disabled but not yet stopped. Bit 8 – MODE Operation Mode Value Description 0 The BOD33 operates in continuous mode. 1 The BOD33 operates in sampling mode. Bit 6 – RUNSTDBY Run in Standby Value Description 0 The BOD33 is disabled in standby sleep mode. 1 The BOD33 is enabled in standby sleep mode. Bits 4:3 – ACTION[1:0] BOD33 Action These bits are used to select the BOD33 action when the supply voltage crosses below the BOD33 threshold. These bits are loaded from Flash User Row at start-up. ACTION[1:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 NONE RESET INTERRUPT No action The BOD33 generates a reset The BOD33 generates an interrupt Reserved Bit 2 – HYST Hysteresis This bit indicates whether hysteresis is enabled for the BOD33 threshold voltage: This bit is loaded from Flash User Row at start-up. Refer to NVM User Row Mapping for more details. Value Description 0 No hysteresis. 1 Hysteresis enabled. Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable This bit is loaded from Flash User Row at startup. Refer to NVM User Row Mapping for more details. Value Description 0 BOD33 is disabled. 1 BOD33 is enabled. Related Links 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 9.4. NVM User Row Mapping © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 183 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.15 Voltage Regulator System (VREG) Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit VREG 0x3C 0x0X02 Write-Protected 15 14 13 FORCELDO R/W 0 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 ENABLE R/W 1 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 13 – FORCELDO Force LDO Voltage Regulator Value Description 0 The voltage regulator is in low-power and low-drive configuration in Standby Sleep mode 1 The voltage regulator is in low-power and high-drive configuration in Standby Sleep mode Bit 6 – RUNSTDBY Run in Standby Value Description 0 The voltage regulator is in low-power configuration in Standby Sleep mode 1 The voltage regulator is in normal configuration in Standby Sleep mode Bit 1 – ENABLE Must be set to 1. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 184 SAM D20 Family SYSCTRL – System Controller 16.8.16 Voltage References System (VREF) Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit VREF 0x40 0x0XXX0000 Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 R/W x 25 CALIB[10:8] R/W x R/W x 19 18 17 16 Access Reset Bit 23 22 21 20 26 24 CALIB[7:0] Access Reset Bit R/W x R/W x R/W x R/W x R/W x R/W x R/W x R/W x 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 BGOUTEN R/W 0 1 TSEN R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bits 26:16 – CALIB[10:0] Bandgap Voltage Generator Calibration These bits are used to calibrate the output level of the bandgap voltage reference. These bits are loaded from Flash Calibration Row at start-up. Bit 2 – BGOUTEN Bandgap Output Enable Value Description 0 The bandgap output is not available as an ADC input channel 1 The bandgap output is routed to an ADC input channel Bit 1 – TSEN Temperature Sensor Enable(1) Note:  As explained in the Disclaimer for the AEC-Q100 Electrical characteristics at 125°C, the Temperature Sensor (TSENS) feature must not be used with AECQ100 parts. Value 0 1 Description Temperature sensor is disabled Temperature sensor is enabled and routed to an ADC input channel © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 185 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer 17. WDT – Watchdog Timer 17.1 Overview The Watchdog Timer (WDT) is a system function for monitoring correct program operation. It makes it possible to recover from error situations such as runaway or deadlocked code. The WDT is configured to a predefined time-out period, and is constantly running when enabled. If the WDT is not cleared within the time-out period, it will issue a system reset. An early-warning interrupt is available to indicate an upcoming watchdog time-out condition. The window mode makes it possible to define a time slot (or window) inside the total time-out period during which the WDT must be cleared. If the WDT is cleared outside this window, either too early or too late, a system reset will be issued. Compared to the normal mode, this can also catch situations where a code error causes the WDT to be cleared frequently. When enabled, the WDT will run in active mode and all sleep modes. It is asynchronous and runs from a CPUindependent clock source. The WDT will continue operation and issue a system reset or interrupt even if the main clocks fail. 17.2 Features • • • • • • 17.3 Issues a system reset if the Watchdog Timer is not cleared before its time-out period Early Warning interrupt generation Asynchronous operation from dedicated oscillator Two types of operation: – Normal mode – Window mode Selectable time-out periods – From 8 cycles to 16,000 cycles in normal mode – From 16 cycles to 32,000 cycles in window mode Always-on capability Block Diagram Figure 17-1. WDT Block Diagram 0xA5 0 CLEAR GCLK_WDT COUNT PER/WINDOW/EWOFFSET Early Warning Interrupt Reset © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 186 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer 17.4 Signal Description Not applicable. 17.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. 17.5.1 I/O Lines Not applicable. 17.5.2 Power Management The WDT can continue to operate in any sleep mode where the selected source clock is running. The WDT interrupts can be used to wake up the device from sleep modes. The events can trigger other operations in the system without exiting sleep modes. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 17.5.3 Clocks The WDT bus clock (CLK_WDT_APB) is enabled by default, and can be enabled and disabled in the Power Manager. Refer to PM – Power Manager for details. A generic clock (GCLK_WDT) is required to clock the WDT. This clock must be configured and enabled in the Generic Clock Controller before using the WDT. Refer to GCLK – Generic Clock Controller for details. This generic clock is asynchronous to the user interface clock (CLK_WDT_APB). Due to this asynchronicity, accessing certain registers will require synchronization between the clock domains. Refer to Synchronization for further details. GCLK_WDT is intended to be sourced from the clock of the internal ultra-low-power (ULP) oscillator. Due to the ultralow- power design, the oscillator is not very accurate, and so the exact time-out period may vary from device to device. This variation must be kept in mind when designing software that uses the WDT to ensure that the time-out periods used are valid for all devices. For more information on ULP oscillator accuracy, consult the Ultra Low Power Internal 32kHz RC Oscillator (OSCULP32K) Characteristics. GCLK_WDT can also be clocked from other sources if a more accurate clock is needed, but at the cost of higher power consumption. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 16.6.5. 32kHz Ultra Low Power Internal Oscillator (OSCULP32K) Operation 17.6.5. Synchronization 17.5.4 Interrupts The interrupt request line is connected to the interrupt controller. Using the WDT interrupt(s) requires the interrupt controller to be configured first. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 17.5.5 Events Not applicable. 17.5.6 Debug Operation When the CPU is halted in debug mode the WDT will halt normal operation. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 187 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer 17.5.7 Register Access Protection Registers with write-access can be optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC), except for the following: • Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG) Note:  Optional write-protection is indicated by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in the register description. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller 17.5.8 Analog Connections Not applicable. 17.6 Functional Description 17.6.1 Principle of Operation The Watchdog Timer (WDT) is a system for monitoring correct program operation, making it possible to recover from error situations such as runaway code, by issuing a Reset. When enabled, the WDT is a constantly running timer that is configured to a predefined time-out period. Before the end of the time-out period, the WDT should be set back, or else, a system Reset is issued. The WDT has two modes of operation, Normal mode and Window mode. Both modes offer the option of Early Warning interrupt generation. The description for each of the basic modes is given below. The settings in the Control register (CTRL) and the Interrupt Enable register (handled by INTENCLR/SET) determine the mode of operation: Table 17-1. WDT Operating Modes 17.6.2 CTRL.ENABLE CTRL.WEN INTENSET.EW Mode 0 x x Stopped 1 0 0 Normal 1 0 1 Normal with Early Warning interrupt 1 1 0 Window 1 1 1 Window with Early Warning interrupt Basic Operation 17.6.2.1 Initialization The following bits are enable-protected: • Window Mode Enable in the Control register (CTRL.WEN) • Always-On in the Control register (CTRL-ALWAYSON) The following registers are enable-protected: • • Configuration register (CONFIG) Early Warning Interrupt Control register (EWCTRL) Any writes to these bits or registers when the WDT is enabled or is being enabled (CTRL.ENABLE=1) will be discarded. Writes to these registers while the WDT is being disabled will be completed after the disabling is complete. Enable-protection is denoted by the Enable-Protected property in the register description. Initialization of the WDT can be done only while the WDT is disabled. The WDT is configured by defining the required Time-Out Period bits in the Configuration register (CONFIG.PER). If window-mode operation is required, the Window Enable bit in the Control register (CTRL.WEN) must be written to one and the Window Period bits in the Configuration register (CONFIG.WINDOW) must be defined. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 188 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer Normal Mode • Defining the required Time-Out Period bits in the Configuration register (CONFIG.PER). Normal Mode with Early Warning interrupt • Defining the required Time-Out Period bits in the Configuration register (CONFIG.PER). • Defining Early Warning Interrupt Time Offset bits in the Early Warning Interrupt Control register (EWCTRL. EWOFFSET). • Setting Early Warning Interrupt Enable bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET.EW). Window Mode • Defining Time-Out Period bits in the Configuration register (CONFIG.PER). • Defining Window Mode Time-Out Period bits in the Configuration register (CONFIG.WINDOW). • Setting Window Enable bit in the Control register (CTRL.WEN). Window Mode with Early Warning interrupt • Defining Time-Out Period bits in the Configuration register (CONFIG.PER). • Defining Window Mode Time-Out Period bits in the Configuration register (CONFIG.WINDOW). • Setting Window Enable bit in the Control register (CTRL.WEN). • Defining Early Warning Interrupt Time Offset bits in the Early Warning Interrupt Control register (EWCTRL. EWOFFSET). • Setting Early Warning Interrupt Enable bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET.EW). 17.6.2.2 Configurable Reset Values After a Power-on Reset, some registers will be loaded with initial values from the NVM User Row. Refer to NVM User Row Mapping for more details. This encompasses the following bits and bit groups: • • • • • • Enable bit in the Control register, CTRL.ENABLE Always-On bit in the Control register, CTRL.ALWAYSON Watchdog Timer Windows Mode Enable bit in the Control register, CTRL.WEN Watchdog Timer Windows Mode Time-Out Period bits in the Configuration register, CONFIG.WINDOW Time-Out Period in the Configuration register, CONFIG.PER Early Warning Interrupt Time Offset bits in the Early Warning Interrupt Control register, EWCTRL.EWOFFSET For more information about fuse locations, see NVM User Row Mapping. Related Links 9.4. NVM User Row Mapping 17.6.2.3 Enabling and Disabling The WDT is enabled by writing a '1' to the Enable bit in the Control register (CTRL.ENABLE). The WDT is disabled by writing a '0' to CTRL.ENABLE. The WDT can be disabled only if the Always-On bit in the Control register (CTRL.ALWAYSON) is '0'. 17.6.2.4 Normal Mode In Normal mode operation, the length of a time-out period is configured in CONFIG.PER. The WDT is enabled by writing a '1' to the Enable bit in the Control register (CTRL.ENABLE). Once enabled, the WDT will issue a system reset if a time-out occurs. This can be prevented by clearing the WDT at any time during the time-out period. The WDT is cleared and a new WDT time-out period is started by writing 0xA5 to the Clear register (CLEAR). Writing any other value than 0xA5 to CLEAR will issue an immediate system reset. There are 12 possible WDT time-out (TOWDT) periods, selectable from 8ms to 16s. By default, the early warning interrupt is disabled. If it is desired, the Early Warning Interrupt Enable bit in the Interrupt Enable register (INTENSET.EW) must be written to '1'. The Early Warning Interrupt is disabled again by writing a '1' to the Early Warning Interrupt bit in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR.EW). If the Early Warning Interrupt © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 189 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer is enabled, an interrupt is generated prior to a WDT time-out condition. In Normal mode, the Early Warning Offset bits in the Early Warning Interrupt Control register, EWCTRL.EWOFFSET, define the time when the early warning interrupt occurs. The Normal mode operation is illustrated in the figure Normal-Mode Operation. Figure 17-2. Normal-Mode Operation WDT Count Timely WDT Clear PER[3:0] = 1 WDT Timeout System Reset EWOFFSET[3:0] = 0 Early Warning Interrupt t[ms] 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 TOWDT 17.6.2.5 Window Mode In Window mode operation, the WDT uses two different time specifications: the WDT can only be cleared by writing 0xA5 to the CLEAR register after the closed window time-out period (TOWDTW), during the subsequent Normal time-out period (TOWDTW). If the WDT is cleared before the time window opens (before TOWDTW is over), the WDT will issue a system reset. Both parameters TOWDTW and TOWDT are periods in a range from 8ms to 16s, so the total duration of the WDT time-out period is the sum of the two parameters. The closed window period is defined by the Window Period bits in the Configuration register (CONFIG.WINDOW), and the open window period is defined by the Period bits in the Configuration register (CONFIG.PER). By default, the Early Warning interrupt is disabled. If it is desired, the Early Warning Interrupt Enable bit in the Interrupt Enable register (INTENSET.EW) must be written to '1'. The Early Warning Interrupt is disabled again by writing a '1' to the Early Warning Interrupt bit in the Interrupt Enable Clear (INTENCLR.EW) register. If the Early Warning interrupt is enabled in Window mode, the interrupt is generated at the start of the open window period, i.e. after TOWDTW. The Window mode operation is illustrated in figure Window-Mode Operation. Figure 17-3. Window-Mode Operation WDT Count Timely WDT Clear PER[3:0] = 0 Open WDT Timeout Early WDT Clear WINDOW[3:0] = 0 Closed Early Warning Interrupt System Reset t[ms] 5 10 15 20 TOWDTW 17.6.3 25 30 35 TOWDT Additional Features 17.6.3.1 Always-On Mode The Always-On mode is enabled by setting the Always-On bit in the Control register (CTRLA.ALWAYSON=1). When the Always-On mode is enabled, the WDT runs continuously, regardless of the state of CTRL.ENABLE. Once written, the Always-On bit can only be cleared by a power-on reset. The Configuration (CONFIG) and Early Warning Control (EWCTRL) registers are read-only registers while the CTRL.ALWAYSON bit is set. Thus, the time period configuration bits (CONFIG.PER, CONFIG.WINDOW, EWCTRL.EWOFFSET) of the WDT cannot be changed. Enabling or disabling Window mode operation by writing the Window Enable bit (CTRLA.WEN) is allowed while in Always-On mode, but note that CONFIG.PER cannot be changed. The CTRL.ALWAYSON bit must never be set to one by software if any of the following conditions is true: 1. The GCLK_WDT is disabled © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 190 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer 2. 3. The clock generator for the GCLK_WDT is disabled The source clock of the clock generator for the GCLK_WDT is disabled or off The Interrupt Clear and Interrupt Set registers are accessible in the Always-On mode. The Early Warning interrupt can still be enabled or disabled while in the Always-On mode, but note that EWCTRL.EWOFFSET cannot be changed. Table 17-2. WDT Operating Modes With Always-On 17.6.4 WEN Interrupt enable Mode 0 0 Always-on and normal mode 0 1 Always-on and normal mode with Early Warning interrupt 1 0 Always-on and window mode 1 1 Always-on and window mode with Early Warning interrupt Interrupts The WDT has the following interrupt source: • Early Warning (EW) Each interrupt source has an interrupt flag associated with it. The interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear (INTFLAG) register is set when the interrupt condition occurs. Each interrupt can be individually enabled by writing a '1' to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Set (INTENSET) register, and disabled by writing a '1' to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Clear (INTENCLR) register. An interrupt request is generated when the interrupt flag is set and the corresponding interrupt is enabled. The interrupt request remains active until the interrupt flag is cleared, the interrupt is disabled, or the WDT is reset. See the INTFLAG register description for details on how to clear interrupt flags. The WDT has one common interrupt request line for all the interrupt sources. The user must read the INTFLAG register to determine which interrupt condition is present. Note:  Interrupts must be globally enabled for interrupt requests to be generated. The Early Warning interrupt behaves differently in normal mode and in window mode. In normal mode, the Early Warning interrupt generation is defined by the Early Warning Offset in the Early Warning Control register (EWCTRL.EWOFFSET). The Early Warning Offset bits define the number of GCLK_WDT clocks before the interrupt is generated, relative to the start of the watchdog time-out period. For example, if the WDT is operating in normal mode with CONFIG.PER = 0x2 and EWCTRL.EWOFFSET = 0x1, the Early Warning interrupt is generated 16 GCLK_WDT clock cycles from the start of the watchdog time-out period, and the watchdog time-out system reset is generated 32 GCLK_WDT clock cycles from the start of the watchdog time-out period. The user must take caution when programming the Early Warning Offset bits. If these bits define an Early Warning interrupt generation time greater than the watchdog time-out period, the watchdog time-out system reset is generated prior to the Early Warning interrupt. Thus, the Early Warning interrupt will never be generated. In window mode, the Early Warning interrupt is generated at the start of the open window period. In a typical application where the system is in sleep mode, it can use this interrupt to wake up and clear the Watchdog Timer, after which the system can perform other tasks or return to sleep mode. 17.6.5 Synchronization Due to asynchronicity between the main clock domain and the peripheral clock domains, some registers need to be synchronized when written or read. When executing an operation that requires synchronization, the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY) will be set immediately, and cleared when synchronization is complete. If an operation that requires synchronization is executed while STATUS.SYNCBUSY='1', the bus will be stalled. All operations will complete successfully, but the CPU will be stalled and interrupts will be pending as long as the bus is stalled. The following registers are synchronized when written: © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 191 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer • • Control register (CTRL) Clear register (CLEAR) Required write-synchronization is denoted by the "Write-Synchronized" property in the register description. Related Links 13.3. Register Synchronization 17.7 Register Summary Register summary Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 17.8 CTRL CONFIG EWCTRL Reserved INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG STATUS CLEAR 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 ALWAYSON WEN ENABLE PER[3:0] EWOFFSET[3:0] WINDOW[3:0] EW EW EW SYNCBUSY CLEAR[7:0] Register Description Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16-, and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers require synchronization when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the "ReadSynchronized" and/or "Write-Synchronized" property in each individual register description. Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the module is disabled. Enableprotection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in each individual register description. Optional write-protection by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC) is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 192 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer 17.8.1 Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset 7 ALWAYSON R/W x CTRL 0x0 N/A - Loaded from NVM User Row at start-up Write-Protected, Enable-Protected, Write-Synchronized 6 5 4 3 2 WEN R/W x 1 ENABLE R/W x 0 Bit 7 – ALWAYSON Always-On This bit allows the WDT to run continuously. After being written to one, this bit cannot be written to zero, and the WDT will remain enabled until a power-on reset is received. When this bit is one, the Control register (CTRL), the Configuration register (CONFIG) and the Early Warning Control register (EWCTRL) will be read-only, and any writes to these registers are not allowed. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. This bit is not enable-protected. These bits are loaded from NVM User Row at start-up. Refer to NVM User Row Mapping for more details. Value Description 0 The WDT is enabled and disabled through the ENABLE bit. 1 The WDT is enabled and can only be disabled by a power-on reset (POR). Bit 2 – WEN Watchdog Timer Window Mode Enable The initial value of this bit is loaded from Flash Calibration. This bit is loaded from NVM User Row at start-up. Refer to NVM User Row Mapping for more details. Value Description 0 Window mode is disabled (normal operation). 1 Window mode is enabled. Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable This bit enables or disables the WDT. Can only be written while CTRL.ALWAYSON is zero. Due to synchronization, there is delay from writing CTRL.ENABLE until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to CTRL.ENABLE will read back immediately, and the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY) will be set. STATUS.SYNCBUSY will be cleared when the operation is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. This bit is loaded from NVM User Row at start-up. Refer to NVM User Row Mapping for more details. Value Description 0 The WDT is disabled. 1 The WDT is enabled. Related Links 9.4. NVM User Row Mapping © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 193 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer 17.8.2 Configuration Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset 7 R/W x CONFIG 0x1 N/A - Loaded from NVM User Row at startup Write-Protected, Enable-Protected, Write-Synchronized 6 5 WINDOW[3:0] R/W R/W x x 4 3 2 1 0 R/W x R/W x PER[3:0] R/W x R/W x R/W x Bits 7:4 – WINDOW[3:0] Window Mode Time-Out Period In window mode, these bits determine the watchdog closed window period as a number of oscillator cycles. These bits are loaded from NVM User Row at start-up. Refer to NVM User Row Mapping for more details. Value Description 0x0 8 clock cycles 0x1 16 clock cycles 0x2 32 clock cycles 0x3 64 clock cycles 0x4 128 clock cycles 0x5 256 clocks cycles 0x6 512 clocks cycles 0x7 1024 clock cycles 0x8 2048 clock cycles 0x9 4096 clock cycles 0xA 8192 clock cycles 0xB 16384 clock cycles 0xC-0xF Reserved Bits 3:0 – PER[3:0] Time-Out Period These bits determine the watchdog time-out period as a number of GCLK_WDT clock cycles. In window mode operation, these bits define the open window period. These bits are loaded from NVM User Row at start-up. Refer to NVM User Row Mapping for more details. Value Description 0x0 8 clock cycles 0x1 16 clock cycles 0x2 32 clock cycles 0x3 64 clock cycles 0x4 128 clock cycles 0x5 256 clocks cycles 0x6 512 clocks cycles 0x7 1024 clock cycles 0x8 2048 clock cycles 0x9 4096 clock cycles 0xA 8192 clock cycles 0xB 16384 clock cycles 0xC-0xF Reserved Related Links 9.4. NVM User Row Mapping © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 194 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer 17.8.3 Early Warning Interrupt Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 EWCTRL 0x2 N/A - Loaded from NVM User Row at start-up Write-Protected, Enable-Protected 6 Access Reset 5 4 3 R/W x 2 1 EWOFFSET[3:0] R/W R/W x x 0 R/W x Bits 3:0 – EWOFFSET[3:0] Early Warning Interrupt Time Offset These bits determine the number of GCLK_WDT clocks in the offset from the start of the watchdog time-out period to when the Early Warning interrupt is generated. These bits are loaded from NVM User Row at start-up. Refer to NVM User Row Mapping for more details. Value Description 0x0 8 clock cycles 0x1 16 clock cycles 0x2 32 clock cycles 0x3 64 clock cycles 0x4 128 clock cycles 0x5 256 clocks cycles 0x6 512 clocks cycles 0x7 1024 clock cycles 0x8 2048 clock cycles 0x9 4096 clock cycles 0xA 8192 clock cycles 0xB 16384 clock cycles 0xC-0xF Reserved Related Links 9.4. NVM User Row Mapping © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 195 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer 17.8.4 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 INTENCLR 0x4 0x00 Write-Protected 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 0 EW R/W 0 Bit 0 – EW Early Warning Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit disables the Early Warning interrupt. Value Description 0 The Early Warning interrupt is disabled. 1 The Early Warning interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 196 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer 17.8.5 Interrupt Enable Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 INTENSET 0x5 0x00 Write-Protected 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 0 EW R/W 0 Bit 0 – EW Early Warning Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit enables the Early Warning interrupt. Value Description 0 The Early Warning interrupt is disabled. 1 The Early Warning interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 197 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer 17.8.6 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTFLAG 0x6 0x00 – 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 0 EW R/W 0 Bit 0 – EW Early Warning This flag is set when an Early Warning interrupt occurs, as defined by the EWOFFSET bit group in EWCTRL. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Early Warning interrupt flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 198 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer 17.8.7 Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset 7 SYNCBUSY R 0 STATUS 0x7 0x00 – 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 7 – SYNCBUSY Synchronization Busy This bit is cleared when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is complete. This bit is set when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is started. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 199 SAM D20 Family WDT – Watchdog Timer 17.8.8 Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CLEAR 0x8 0x00 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 W 0 W 0 W 0 W 0 CLEAR[7:0] Access Reset W 0 W 0 W 0 W 0 Bits 7:0 – CLEAR[7:0] Watchdog Clear Writing 0xA5 to this register will clear the Watchdog Timer and the watchdog time-out period is restarted. Writing any other value will issue an immediate system reset. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 200 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18. RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.1 Overview The Real-Time Counter (RTC) is a 32-bit counter with a 10-bit programmable prescaler that typically runs continuously to keep track of time. The RTC can wake up the device from sleep modes using the alarm/compare wake up, periodic wake up, or overflow wake up mechanisms. The RTC can be clocked from several clock sources selectable through the Generic Clock module (GCLK). This GCLK_RTC clock can then be divided with CTRLA.PRESCALER to achieve the required resolution. The RTC can generate periodic peripheral events from outputs of the prescaler, as well as alarm/compare interrupts and peripheral events, which can trigger at any counter value. Additionally, the timer can trigger an overflow interrupt and peripheral event, and can be reset on the occurrence of an alarm/compare match. This allows periodic interrupts and peripheral events at very long and accurate intervals. The 10-bit programmable prescaler can scale down the clock source. By this, a wide range of resolutions and time-out periods can be configured. With a 32.768kHz clock source, the minimum counter tick interval is 30.5µs, and time-out periods can range up to 36 hours. For a counter tick interval of 1s, the maximum time-out period is more than 136 years. 18.2 Features • • • • • • 18.3 32-bit counter with 10-bit prescaler Multiple clock sources 32-bit or 16-bit Counter mode – One 32-bit or two 16-bit compare values Clock/Calendar mode – Time in seconds, minutes and hours (12/24) – Date in day of month, month and year – Leap year correction Digital prescaler correction/tuning for increased accuracy Overflow, alarm/compare match and prescaler interrupts and events – Optional clear on alarm/compare match Block Diagram Figure 18-1. RTC Block Diagram (Mode 0 — 32-Bit Counter) 0 MATCHCLR GCLK_RTC 10-bit Prescaler CLK_RTC_CNT Overflow COUNT 32 = Periodic Events Compare n 32 COMPn © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 201 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter Figure 18-2. RTC Block Diagram (Mode 1 — 16-Bit Counter) 0 GCLK_RTC 10-bit Prescaler CLK_RTC_CNT COUNT = 16 Overflow 16 Periodic Events PER = Compare n 16 COMPn Figure 18-3. RTC Block Diagram (Mode 2 — Clock/Calendar) 0 MATCHCLR GCLK_RTC 10-bit Prescaler CLK_RTC_CNT 32 Y/M/D H:M:S = MASKn Periodic Events 18.4 Overflow CLOCK 32 Alarm n Y/M/D H:M:S ALARMn Signal Description Not applicable. 18.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. 18.5.1 I/O Lines Not applicable. 18.5.2 Power Management The RTC will continue to operate in any sleep mode where the selected source clock is running. The RTC interrupts can be used to wake up the device from sleep modes. Events connected to the event system can trigger other operations in the system without exiting sleep modes. Refer to the Power Manager for details on the different sleep modes. The RTC will be reset only at power-on (POR) or by setting the Software Reset bit in the Control register (CTRL.SWRST=1). Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 18.5.3 Clocks The RTC bus clock (CLK_RTC_APB) can be enabled and disabled in the Power Manager, and the default state of CLK_RTC_APB can be found in the Peripheral Clock Masking section. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 202 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter A generic clock (GCLK_RTC) is required to clock the RTC. This clock must be configured and enabled in the Generic Clock Controller before using the RTC. Refer to GCLK – Generic Clock Controller for details. This generic clock is asynchronous to the user interface clock (CLK_RTC_APB). Due to this asynchronicity, accessing certain registers will require synchronization between the clock domains. Refer to 18.6.8. Synchronization for further details. The RTC should not work with the Generic Clock Generator 0. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 18.5.4 DMA Not applicable. 18.5.5 Interrupts The interrupt request line is connected to the Interrupt Controller. Using the RTC interrupts requires the Interrupt Controller to be configured first. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 18.5.6 Events The events are connected to the Event System. Related Links 22. Event System (EVSYS) 18.5.7 Debug Operation When the CPU is halted in debug mode the RTC will halt normal operation. The RTC can be forced to continue operation during debugging. Refer to the Debug Control (DBGCTRL) register for details. 18.5.8 Register Access Protection Registers with write-access can be optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC), except for the following: • • • • Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG) Read Request register (READREQ) Status register (STATUS) Debug register (DBGCTRL) Note:  Optional write-protection is indicated by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in the register description. Write-protection does not apply for accesses through an external debugger. Related Links 18.8.17. STATUS 18.8.18. DBGCTRL 18.8.4. READREQ 18.8.15. INTFLAG 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller 18.5.9 Analog Connections A 32.768kHz crystal can be connected to the XIN32 and XOUT32 pins, along with any required load capacitors. For details on recommended crystal characteristics and load capacitors, refer to Electrical Characteristics for details. Related Links 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 203 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.6 Functional Description 18.6.1 Principle of Operation The RTC keeps track of time in the system and enables periodic events, as well as interrupts and events at a specified time. The RTC consists of a 10-bit prescaler that feeds a 32-bit counter. The actual format of the 32-bit counter depends on the RTC operating mode. The RTC can function in one of these modes: • Mode 0 - COUNT32: RTC serves as 32-bit counter • Mode 1 - COUNT16: RTC serves as 16-bit counter • Mode 2 - CLOCK: RTC serves as clock/calendar with alarm functionality 18.6.2 Basic Operation 18.6.2.1 Initialization The following bits are enable-protected, meaning that they can only be written when the RTC is disabled (CTRL.ENABLE=0): • • • • Operating Mode bits in the Control register (CTRL.MODE) Prescaler bits in the Control register (CTRL.PRESCALER) Clear on Match bit in the Control register (CTRL.MATCHCLR) Clock Representation bit in the Control register (CTRL.CLKREP) The following register is enable-protected: • Event Control register (EVCTRL) Any writes to these bits or registers when the RTC is enabled or being enabled (CTRL.ENABLE=1) will be discarded. Writes to these bits or registers while the RTC is being disabled will be completed after the disabling is complete. Enable-protection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in the register description. Before the RTC is enabled, it must be configured, as outlined by the following steps: 1. RTC operation mode must be selected by writing the Operating Mode bit group in the Control register (CTRL.MODE) 2. Clock representation must be selected by writing the Clock Representation bit in the Control register (CTRL.CLKREP) 3. Prescaler value must be selected by writing the Prescaler bit group in the Control register (CTRL.PRESCALER) The RTC prescaler divides the source clock for the RTC counter. Note:  In Clock/Calendar mode, the prescaler must be configured to provide a 1Hz clock to the counter for correct operation. The frequency of the RTC clock (CLK_RTC_CNT) is given by the following formula: fGCLK_RTC fCLK_RTC_CNT = PRESCALER 2 The frequency of the generic clock, GCLK_RTC, is given by fGCLK_RTC, and fCLK_RTC_CNT is the frequency of the internal prescaled RTC clock, CLK_RTC_CNT. Related Links 18.8.5. EVCTRL 18.8.1. CTRL 18.6.2.2 Enabling, Disabling and Resetting The RTC is enabled by setting the Enable bit in the Control register (CTRL.ENABLE=1). The RTC is disabled by writing CTRL.ENABLE=0. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 204 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter The RTC is reset by setting the Software Reset bit in the Control register (CTRL.SWRST=1). All registers in the RTC, except DEBUG, will be reset to their initial state, and the RTC will be disabled. The RTC must be disabled before resetting it. Related Links 18.8.1. CTRL 18.6.3 Operating Modes The RTC counter supports three RTC operating modes: 32-bit Counter, 16-bit Counter and Clock/Calendar. The operating mode is selected by writing to the Operating Mode bit group in the Control register (CTRL.MODE). 18.6.3.1 32-Bit Counter (Mode 0) When the RTC Operating Mode bits in the Control register are zero (CTRL.MODE=00), the counter operates in 32-bit Counter mode. The block diagram of this mode is shown in Figure 18-1. When the RTC is enabled, the counter will increment on every 0-to-1 transition of CLK_RTC_CNT. The counter will increment until it reaches the top value of 0xFFFFFFFF, and then wrap to 0x00000000. This sets the Overflow Interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.OVF). The RTC counter value can be read from or written to the Counter Value register (COUNT) in 32-bit format. The counter value is continuously compared with the 32-bit Compare register (COMP). When a compare match occurs, the Compare interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.CMP) is set on the next 0-to-1 transition of CLK_RTC_CNT. If the Clear on Match bit in the Control register (CTRL.MATCHCLR) is '1', the counter is cleared on the next counter cycle when a compare match with COMP occurs. This allows the RTC to generate periodic interrupts or events with longer periods than are possible with the prescaler events. Note that when CTRL.MATCHCLR is '1', INTFLAG.CMP and INTFLAG.OVF will both be set simultaneously on a compare match with COMP. 18.6.3.2 16-Bit Counter (Mode 1) When the RTC Operating Mode bits in the Control register (CTRL.MODE) are 1, the counter operates in 16-bit Counter mode as shown in Figure 18-2. When the RTC is enabled, the counter will increment on every 0-to-1 transition of CLK_RTC_CNT. In 16-bit Counter mode, the 16-bit Period register (PER) holds the maximum value of the counter. The counter will increment until it reaches the PER value, and then wrap to 0x0000. This sets the Overflow interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.OVF). The RTC counter value can be read from or written to the Counter Value register (COUNT) in 16-bit format. The counter value is continuously compared with the 16-bit Compare registers (COMPn, n=0–). When a compare match occurs, the Compare n interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.CMPn, n=0–) is set on the next 0-to-1 transition of CLK_RTC_CNT. 18.6.3.3 Clock/Calendar (Mode 2) When CTRL.MODE is two, the counter operates in Clock/Calendar mode, as shown in Figure 18-3. When the RTC is enabled, the counter will increment on every 0-to-1 transition of CLK_RTC_CNT. The selected clock source and RTC prescaler must be configured to provide a 1Hz clock to the counter for correct operation in this mode. The time and date can be read from or written to the Clock Value register (CLOCK) in a 32-bit time/date format. Time is represented as: • • • Seconds Minutes Hours Hours can be represented in either 12- or 24-hour format, selected by the Clock Representation bit in the Control register (CTRL.CLKREP). This bit can be changed only while the RTC is disabled. Date is represented as: • • • Day as the numeric day of the month (starting at 1) Month as the numeric month of the year (1 = January, 2 = February, etc.) Year as a value counting the offset from a reference value that must be defined in software © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 205 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter The date is automatically adjusted for leap years, assuming every year divisible by 4 is a leap year. Therefore, the reference value must be a leap year, e.g. 2000. The RTC will increment until it reaches the top value of 23:59:59 December 31st of year 63, and then wrap to 00:00:00 January 1st of year 0. This will set the Overflow interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear registers (INTFLAG.OVF). The clock value is continuously compared with the 32-bit Alarm register (ALARM). When an alarm match occurs, the Alarm Interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear registers (INTFLAG.ALARMn0) is set on the next 0-to-1 transition of CLK_RTC_CNT. E.g. For a 1Hz clock counter, it means the Alarm 0 Interrupt flag is set with a delay of 1s after the occurrence of alarm match. A valid alarm match depends on the setting of the Alarm Mask Selection bits in the Alarm A valid alarm match depends on the setting of the Alarm Mask Selection bits in the Alarm Mask register (MASK.SEL). These bits determine which time/date fields of the clock and alarm values are valid for comparison and which are ignored. If the Clear on Match bit in the Control register (CTRL.MATCHCLR) is one, the counter is cleared on the next counter cycle when an alarm match with ALARM occurs. This allows the RTC to generate periodic interrupts or events with longer periods than are possible with the prescaler events (see 18.6.9.1. Periodic Events). Note that when CTRL.MATCHCLR is '1', INTFLAG.ALARM0 and INTFLAG.OVF will both be set simultaneously on an alarm match with ALARM. 18.6.4 DMA Operation Not applicable. 18.6.5 Interrupts The RTC has the following interrupt sources which are asynchronous interrupts and can wake-up the device from any sleep mode.: • • • • Overflow (INTFLAG.OVF): Indicates that the counter has reached its top value and wrapped to zero. Compare n (INTFLAG.CMPn): Indicates a match between the counter value and the compare register. Alarm n (INTFLAG.ALARMn): Indicates a match between the clock value and the alarm register. Synchronization Ready (INTFLAG.SYNCRDY): Indicates an operation requires synchronization. Each interrupt source has an interrupt flag associated with it. The interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear (INTFLAG) register is set when the interrupt condition occurs. Each interrupt can be individually enabled by setting the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET=1), and disabled by setting the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR=1). An interrupt request is generated when the interrupt flag is raised and the corresponding interrupt is enabled. The interrupt request remains active until either the interrupt flag is cleared, the interrupt is disabled or the RTC is reset. See the description of the INTFLAG registers for details on how to clear interrupt flags. All interrupt requests from the peripheral are ORed together on system level to generate one combined interrupt request to the NVIC. Refer to the Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. The user must read the INTFLAG register to determine which interrupt condition is present. Note:  Interrupts must be globally enabled for interrupt requests to be generated. Refer to the Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 18.6.6 Events The RTC can generate the following output events, which are generated in the same way as the corresponding interrupts: • • • • Overflow (OVF): Indicates that the counter has reached its top value and wrapped to zero. Period n (PERn): The corresponding bit in the prescaler has toggled. Refer to 18.6.9.1. Periodic Events for details. Compare n (CMPn): Indicates a match between the counter value and the compare register. Alarm n (ALARMn): Indicates a match between the clock value and the alarm register. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 206 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter Setting the Event Output bit in the Event Control Register (EVCTRL.xxxEO=1) enables the corresponding output event. Writing a zero to this bit disables the corresponding output event. Refer to the EVSYS - Event System for details on configuring the event system. Related Links 22. Event System (EVSYS) 18.6.7 Sleep Mode Operation The RTC will continue to operate in any sleep mode where the source clock is active. The RTC interrupts can be used to wake up the device from a sleep mode. RTC events can trigger other operations in the system without exiting the sleep mode. An interrupt request will be generated after the wake-up if the Interrupt Controller is configured accordingly. Otherwise the CPU will wake up directly, without triggering any interrupt. In this case, the CPU will continue executing right from the first instruction that followed the entry into sleep. The periodic events can also wake up the CPU through the interrupt function of the Event System. In this case, the event must be enabled and connected to an event channel with its interrupt enabled. See Event System for more information. Related Links 22. Event System (EVSYS) 18.6.8 Synchronization Due to asynchronicity between the main clock domain and the peripheral clock domains, some registers need to be synchronized when written or read. When executing an operation that requires synchronization, the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY) will be set immediately, and cleared when synchronization is complete. The Synchronization Ready interrupt can be used to signal when synchronization is complete. This can be accessed via the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.SYNCRDY). If an operation that requires synchronization is executed while STATUS.SYNCBUSY is one, the bus will be stalled. All operations will complete successfully, but the CPU will be stalled and interrupts will be pending as long as the bus is stalled. The following bits are synchronized when written: • • Software Reset bit in the Control register (CTRL.SWRST) Enable bit in the Control register (CTRL.ENABLE) The following registers are synchronized when written: • • • • • • • Counter Value register (COUNT) Clock Value register (CLOCK) Counter Period register (PER) Compare n Value registers (COMPn) Alarm n Value registers (ALARMn) Frequency Correction register (FREQCORR) Alarm n Mask register (MASKn) Required write-synchronization is denoted by the "Write-Synchronized" property in the register description. The following registers are synchronized when read: • • The Counter Value register (COUNT) The Clock Value register (CLOCK) Required read-synchronization is denoted by the "Read-Synchronized" property in the register description. Related Links 13.3. Register Synchronization © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 207 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.6.9 Additional Features 18.6.9.1 Periodic Events The RTC prescaler can generate events at periodic intervals, allowing flexible system tick creation. Any of the upper eight bits of the prescaler (bits 2 to 9) can be the source of an event. When one of the eight Periodic Event Output bits in the Event Control register (EVCTRL.PEREO[n=0..7]) is '1', an event is generated on the 0-to-1 transition of the related bit in the prescaler, resulting in a periodic event frequency of: fPERIODIC = fGCLK_RTC 2n + 3 fGCLK_RTC is the frequency of the internal prescaler clock, GCLK_RTC, and n is the position of the EVCTRL.PEREOn bit. For example, PER0 will generate an event every eight CLK_RTC_OSC cycles, PER1 every 16 cycles, etc. This is shown in the figure below. Periodic events are independent of the prescaler setting used by the RTC counter, except if CTRL.PRESCALER is zero. Then, no periodic events will be generated. Figure 18-4. Example Periodic Events GCLK_RTC PEREO0 PEREO1 PEREO2 PEREO3 PEREO4 18.6.9.2 Frequency Correction The RTC Frequency Correction module employs periodic counter corrections to compensate for a too-slow or too-fast oscillator. Frequency correction requires that CTRL.PRESCALER is greater than 1. The digital correction circuit adds or subtracts cycles from the RTC prescaler to adjust the frequency in approximately 1 ppm steps. Digital correction is achieved by adding or skipping a single count in the prescaler once every 4096 GCLK_RTC_OSC cycles. The Value bit group in the Frequency Correction register (FREQCORR.VALUE) determines the number of times the adjustment is applied over 240 of these periods. The resulting correction is as follows: Correction in ppm = (FREQCORR.VALUE / 4096 * 240) * 106ppm This results in a resolution of 1.017 PPM. The Sign bit in the Frequency Correction register (FREQCORR.SIGN) determines the direction of the correction. A positive value will add counts and increase the period (reducing the frequency), and a negative value will reduce counts per period (speeding up the frequency). Digital correction also affects the generation of the periodic events from the prescaler. When the correction is applied at the end of the correction cycle period, the interval between the previous periodic event and the next occurrence may also be shortened or lengthened depending on the correction value. 18.7 Register Summary The register mapping depends on the Operating Mode bits in the Control register (CTRL.MODE). The register summary is presented for each of the three modes. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 208 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter Table 18-1. MODE0 - Mode Register Summary Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x08 0x09 0x0A 0x0B 0x0C 0x0D ... 0x0F 0x10 0x11 0x12 0x13 0x14 ... 0x17 0x18 0x19 0x1A 0x1B CTRL READREQ EVCTRL INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG Reserved STATUS DBGCTRL FREQCORR 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 MATCHCLR MODE[1:0] ENABLE SWRST PRESCALER[3:0] ADDR[5:0] RREQ PEREO7 OVFEO OVF OVF OVF RCONT PEREO6 PEREO5 PEREO4 PEREO3 PEREO2 PEREO1 SYNCRDY SYNCRDY SYNCRDY PEREO0 CMPEO0 CMP0 CMP0 CMP0 SYNCBUSY DBGRUN SIGN VALUE[6:0] Reserved COUNT 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 COUNT[7:0] COUNT[15:8] COUNT[23:16] COUNT[31:24] 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 COMP[7:0] COMP[15:8] COMP[23:16] COMP[31:24] Reserved COMP0 Table 18-2. MODE1 - Mode Register Summary Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x08 0x09 0x0A 0x0B 0x0C 0x0D ... 0x0F 0x10 0x11 0x12 0x13 0x14 0x15 0x16 0x17 CTRL READREQ EVCTRL INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG Reserved STATUS DBGCTRL FREQCORR 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 MODE[1:0] ENABLE PRESCALER[3:0] SWRST ADDR[5:0] RREQ PEREO7 OVFEO OVF OVF OVF RCONT PEREO6 PEREO5 PEREO4 PEREO3 SYNCRDY SYNCRDY SYNCRDY PEREO2 PEREO1 PEREO0 CMPEO1 CMP1 CMP1 CMP1 CMPEO0 CMP0 CMP0 CMP0 SYNCBUSY DBGRUN SIGN VALUE[6:0] Reserved COUNT 7:0 15:8 COUNT[7:0] COUNT[15:8] 7:0 15:8 PER[7:0] PER[15:8] Reserved Reserved PER Reserved Reserved © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 209 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter ...........continued Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x18 0x19 0x1A 0x1B COMP0 COMP1 7:0 COMP[7:0] 15:8 7:0 15:8 COMP[15:8] COMP[7:0] COMP[15:8] Table 18-3. MODE2 - Mode Register Summary Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x08 0x09 0x0A 0x0B 0x0C 0x0D ... 0x0F 0x10 0x11 0x12 0x13 0x14 ... 0x17 0x18 0x19 0x1A 0x1B 0x1C 18.8 CTRL READREQ EVCTRL INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG Reserved STATUS DBGCTRL FREQCORR 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 7:0 7:0 7:0 MATCHCLR CLKREP RREQ PEREO7 OVFEO OVF OVF OVF RCONT PEREO6 7:0 7:0 7:0 SYNCBUSY MODE[1:0] ENABLE PRESCALER[3:0] SWRST ADDR[5:0] PEREO5 PEREO4 PEREO3 PEREO2 PEREO1 SYNCRDY SYNCRDY SYNCRDY PEREO0 ALARMEO0 ALARM0 ALARM0 ALARM0 DBGRUN SIGN VALUE[6:0] Reserved CLOCK 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 MINUTE[1:0] 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 MINUTE[1:0] SECOND[5:0] HOUR[3:0] MINUTE[5:2] MONTH[1:0] DAY[4:0] HOUR[4] MONTH[3:2] YEAR[5:0] Reserved ALARM0 MASK SECOND[5:0] HOUR[3:0] MINUTE[5:2] MONTH[1:0] DAY[4:0] YEAR[5:0] HOUR[4] MONTH[3:2] SEL[2:0] Register Description Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16-, and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Optional write-protection by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC) is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. Some registers require synchronization when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the "ReadSynchronized" and/or "Write-Synchronized" property in each individual register description. Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the module is disabled. Enableprotection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 210 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.1 Control - MODE0 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRL 0x00 0x0000 Enable-Protected, Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 15 14 13 12 Access Reset Bit Access Reset 11 10 9 PRESCALER[3:0] R/W R/W 0 0 R/W 0 7 MATCHCLR R/W 0 6 5 4 3 2 MODE[1:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 1 ENABLE R/W 0 8 R/W 0 0 SWRST W 0 Bits 11:8 – PRESCALER[3:0] Prescaler These bits define the prescaling factor for the RTC clock source (GCLK_RTC) to generate the counter clock (CLK_RTC_CNT). These bits are not synchronized. PRESCALER[3:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 0x9 0xA 0xB-0xF DIV1 DIV2 DIV4 DIV8 DIV16 DIV32 DIV64 DIV128 DIV256 DIV512 DIV1024 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/1 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/2 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/4 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/8 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/16 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/32 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/64 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/128 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/256 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/512 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/1024 Reserved Bit 7 – MATCHCLR Clear on Match This bit is valid only in Mode 0 and Mode 2. This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 The counter is not cleared on a Compare/Alarm 0 match. 1 The counter is cleared on a Compare/Alarm 0 match. Bits 3:2 – MODE[1:0] Operating Mode These bits define the operating mode of the RTC. These bits are not synchronized. MODE[1:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 COUNT32 COUNT16 CLOCK Mode 0: 32-bit Counter Mode 1: 16-bit Counter Mode 2: Clock/Calendar Reserved © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 211 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable Due to synchronization, there is delay from writing CTRL.ENABLE until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to CTRL.ENABLE will read back immediately, and the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY) will be set. STATUS.SYNCBUSY will be cleared when the operation is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 The peripheral is disabled or being disabled. 1 The peripheral is enabled or being enabled. Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit resets all registers in the RTC, except DBGCTRL, to their initial state, and the RTC will be disabled. Writing a one to CTRL.SWRST will always take precedence, meaning that all other writes in the same write-operation will be discarded. Due to synchronization, there is a delay from writing CTRL.SWRST until the reset is complete. CTRL.SWRST and STATUS.SYNCBUSY will both be cleared when the reset is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 There is no reset operation ongoing. 1 The reset operation is ongoing. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 212 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.2 Control - MODE1 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRL 0x00 0x0000 Enable-Protected, Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 15 14 13 12 Access Reset 11 10 9 PRESCALER[3:0] R/W R/W 0 0 R/W 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 MODE[1:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 1 ENABLE R/W 0 8 R/W 0 0 SWRST W 0 Bits 11:8 – PRESCALER[3:0] Prescaler These bits define the prescaling factor for the RTC clock source (GCLK_RTC) to generate the counter clock (CLK_RTC_CNT). These bits are not synchronized. PRESCALER[3:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 0x9 0xA 0xB-0xF DIV1 DIV2 DIV4 DIV8 DIV16 DIV32 DIV64 DIV128 DIV256 DIV512 DIV1024 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/1 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/2 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/4 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/8 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/16 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/32 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/64 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/128 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/256 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/512 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/1024 Reserved Bits 3:2 – MODE[1:0] Operating Mode These bits define the operating mode of the RTC. These bits are not synchronized. MODE[1:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 COUNT32 COUNT16 CLOCK Mode 0: 32-bit Counter Mode 1: 16-bit Counter Mode 2: Clock/Calendar Reserved Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable Due to synchronization, there is delay from writing CTRL.ENABLE until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to CTRL.ENABLE will read back immediately, and the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY) will be set. STATUS.SYNCBUSY will be cleared when the operation is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 The peripheral is disabled or being disabled. 1 The peripheral is enabled or being enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 213 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit resets all registers in the RTC, except DBGCTRL, to their initial state, and the RTC will be disabled. Writing a one to CTRL.SWRST will always take precedence, meaning that all other writes in the same write-operation will be discarded. Due to synchronization, there is a delay from writing CTRL.SWRST until the reset is complete. CTRL.SWRST and STATUS.SYNCBUSY will both be cleared when the reset is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 There is no reset operation ongoing. 1 The reset operation is ongoing. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 214 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.3 Control - MODE2 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRL 0x00 0x0000 Enable-Protected, Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 15 14 13 12 Access Reset Bit Access Reset 11 10 9 PRESCALER[3:0] R/W R/W 0 0 R/W 0 7 MATCHCLR R/W 0 6 CLKREP R/W 0 5 4 3 2 MODE[1:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 1 ENABLE R/W 0 8 R/W 0 0 SWRST W 0 Bits 11:8 – PRESCALER[3:0] Prescaler These bits define the prescaling factor for the RTC clock source (GCLK_RTC) to generate the counter clock (CLK_RTC_CNT). These bits are not synchronized. PRESCALER[3:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 0x9 0xA 0xB-0xF DIV1 DIV2 DIV4 DIV8 DIV16 DIV32 DIV64 DIV128 DIV256 DIV512 DIV1024 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/1 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/2 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/4 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/8 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/16 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/32 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/64 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/128 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/256 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/512 CLK_RTC_CNT = GCLK_RTC/1024 Reserved Bit 7 – MATCHCLR Clear on Match This bit is valid only in Mode 0 and Mode 2. This bit can be written only when the peripheral is disabled. This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 The counter is not cleared on a Compare/Alarm 0 match. 1 The counter is cleared on a Compare/Alarm 0 match. Bit 6 – CLKREP Clock Representation This bit is valid only in Mode 2 and determines how the hours are represented in the Clock Value (CLOCK) register. This bit can be written only when the peripheral is disabled. This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 24 Hour 1 12 Hour (AM/PM) Bits 3:2 – MODE[1:0] Operating Mode These bits define the operating mode of the RTC. These bits are not synchronized. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 215 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter MODE[1:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 COUNT32 COUNT16 CLOCK Mode 0: 32-bit Counter Mode 1: 16-bit Counter Mode 2: Clock/Calendar Reserved Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable Due to synchronization, there is delay from writing CTRL.ENABLE until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to CTRL.ENABLE will read back immediately, and the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY) will be set. STATUS.SYNCBUSY will be cleared when the operation is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 The peripheral is disabled or being disabled. 1 The peripheral is enabled or being enabled. Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit resets all registers in the RTC, except DBGCTRL, to their initial state, and the RTC will be disabled. Writing a one to CTRL.SWRST will always take precedence, meaning that all other writes in the same write-operation will be discarded. Due to synchronization, there is a delay from writing CTRL.SWRST until the reset is complete. CTRL.SWRST and STATUS.SYNCBUSY will both be cleared when the reset is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 There is no reset operation ongoing. 1 The reset operation is ongoing. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 216 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.4 Read Request Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit READREQ 0x02 0x0010 - 15 RREQ W 0 14 RCONT R/W 0 13 12 11 7 6 5 4 3 10 9 8 2 1 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 ADDR[5:0] Access Reset R 0 R 1 R 0 Bit 15 – RREQ Read Request Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit requests synchronization of the register pointed to by the Address bit group (READREQ.ADDR) and sets the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY). Bit 14 – RCONT Read Continuously Writing a zero to this bit disables continuous synchronization. Writing a one to this bit enables continuous synchronization of the register pointed to by READREQ.ADDR. The register value will be synchronized automatically every time the register is updated. READREQ.RCONT prevents READREQ.RREQ from clearing automatically. For the continuous read mode, RREQ bit is required to be set once the RCONT bit is set. This bit is cleared when an RTC register is written. Note:  Once the continuous synchronization is enabled, the first write in the COUNT/CLOCK register will be stalled for a maximum of 6 APB + 6 RTC clock cycles (the time for the on-going read synchronization to complete). Bits 5:0 – ADDR[5:0] Address These bits select the offset of the register that needs read synchronization. In the RTC only COUNT and CLOCK, which share the same address, are available for read synchronization. Therefore, ADDR is a read-only constant of 0x10. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 217 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.5 Event Control - MODE0 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset EVCTRL 0x04 0x0000 Enable-Protected, Write-Protected 15 OVFEO R/W 0 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 CMPEO0 R/W 0 7 PEREOx R/W 0 6 PEREOx R/W 0 5 PEREOx R/W 0 4 PEREOx R/W 0 3 PEREOx R/W 0 2 PEREOx R/W 0 1 PEREOx R/W 0 0 PEREOx R/W 0 Bit 15 – OVFEO Overflow Event Output Enable Value Description 0 Overflow event is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Overflow event is enabled and will be generated for every overflow. Bit 8 – CMPEO0 Compare 0 Event Output Enable Value Description 0 Compare 0 event is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Compare 0 event is enabled and will be generated for every compare match. Bits 7,6,5,4,3,2,1,0 – PEREOx  Periodic Interval x Event Output Enable [x=7:0] Value Description 0 Periodic Interval x event is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Periodic Interval x event is enabled and will be generated. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 218 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.6 Event Control - MODE1 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset EVCTRL 0x04 0x0000 Enable-Protected, Write-Protected 15 OVFEO R/W 0 14 13 12 11 10 9 CMPEOx R/W 0 8 CMPEOx R/W 0 7 PEREOx R/W 0 6 PEREOx R/W 0 5 PEREOx R/W 0 4 PEREOx R/W 0 3 PEREOx R/W 0 2 PEREOx R/W 0 1 PEREOx R/W 0 0 PEREOx R/W 0 Bit 15 – OVFEO Overflow Event Output Enable Value Description 0 Overflow event is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Overflow event is enabled and will be generated for every overflow. Bits 9,8 – CMPEOx  Compare x Event Output Enable [x=1:0] Value Description 0 Compare x event is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Compare x event is enabled and will be generated for every compare match. Bits 7,6,5,4,3,2,1,0 – PEREOx  Periodic Interval x Event Output Enable [x=7:0] Value Description 0 Periodic Interval x event is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Periodic Interval x event is enabled and will be generated. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 219 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.7 Event Control - MODE2 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset EVCTRL 0x04 0x0000 Enable-Protected, Write-Protected 15 OVFEO R/W 0 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 ALARMEO0 R/W 0 7 PEREOx R/W 0 6 PEREOx R/W 0 5 PEREOx R/W 0 4 PEREOx R/W 0 3 PEREOx R/W 0 2 PEREOx R/W 0 1 PEREOx R/W 0 0 PEREOx R/W 0 Bit 15 – OVFEO Overflow Event Output Enable Value Description 0 Overflow event is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Overflow event is enabled and will be generated for every overflow. Bit 8 – ALARMEO0 Alarm 0 Event Output Enable Value Description 0 Alarm 0 event is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Alarm 0 event is enabled and will be generated for every alarm. Bits 7,6,5,4,3,2,1,0 – PEREOx  Periodic Interval x Event Output Enable [x=7:0] Value Description 0 Periodic Interval x event is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Periodic Interval x event is enabled and will be generated. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 220 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.8 Interrupt Enable Clear - MODE0 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset INTENCLR 0x06 0x00 Write-Protected 7 OVF R/W 0 6 SYNCRDY R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 CMP0 R/W 0 Bit 7 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Overflow Interrupt Enable bit and disable the corresponding interrupt. Value Description 0 The Overflow interrupt is disabled. 1 The Overflow interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the Overflow interrupt flag is set. Bit 6 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable bit and disable the corresponding interrupt. Value Description 0 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the Synchronization Ready interrupt flag is set. Bit 0 – CMP0 Compare 0 Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Compare 0 Interrupt Enable bit and disable the corresponding interrupt. Value Description 0 The Compare 0 interrupt is disabled. 1 The Compare 0 interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the Compare x interrupt flag is set. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 221 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.9 Interrupt Enable Clear - MODE1 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset INTENCLR 0x06 0x00 Write-Protected 7 OVF R/W 0 6 SYNCRDY R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 CMPx R/W 0 0 CMPx R/W 0 Bit 7 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Overflow Interrupt Enable bit and disable the corresponding interrupt. Value Description 0 The Overflow interrupt is disabled. 1 The Overflow interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the Overflow interrupt flag is set. Bit 6 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable bit and disable the corresponding interrupt. Value Description 0 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the Synchronization Ready interrupt flag is set. Bits 1,0 – CMPx  Compare x Interrupt Enable [x=1:0] Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Compare x Interrupt Enable bit and disable the corresponding interrupt. Value Description 0 The Compare x interrupt is disabled. 1 The Compare x interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the Compare x interrupt flag is set. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 222 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.10 Interrupt Enable Clear - MODE2 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset INTENCLR 0x06 0x00 Write-Protected 7 OVF R/W 0 6 SYNCRDY R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 ALARM0 R/W 0 Bit 7 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Overflow Interrupt Enable bit and disable the corresponding interrupt. Value Description 0 The Overflow interrupt is disabled. 1 The Overflow interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the Overflow interrupt flag is set. Bit 6 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable bit and disable the corresponding interrupt. Value Description 0 The synchronization ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The synchronization ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the Synchronization Ready interrupt flag is set. Bit 0 – ALARM0 Alarm 0 Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit disables the Alarm 0 interrupt. Value Description 0 The Alarm 0 interrupt is disabled. 1 The Alarm 0 interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the Alarm 0 interrupt flag is set. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 223 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.11 Interrupt Enable Set - MODE0 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset INTENSET 0x07 0x00 Write-Protected 7 OVF R/W 0 6 SYNCRDY R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 CMP0 R/W 0 Bit 7 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Overflow Interrupt Enable bit and enable the Overflow interrupt. Value Description 0 The overflow interrupt is disabled. 1 The overflow interrupt is enabled. Bit 6 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable bit and enable the Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The synchronization ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The synchronization ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – CMP0 Compare 0 Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Compare 0 Interrupt Enable bit and enable the Compare 0 interrupt. Value Description 0 The compare 0 interrupt is disabled. 1 The compare 0 interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 224 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.12 Interrupt Enable Set - MODE1 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset INTENSET 0x07 0x00 Write-Protected 7 OVF R/W 0 6 SYNCRDY R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 CMPx R/W 0 0 CMPx R/W 0 Bit 7 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Overflow interrupt bit and enable the Overflow interrupt. Value Description 0 The overflow interrupt is disabled. 1 The overflow interrupt is enabled. Bit 6 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable bit and enable the Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The synchronization ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The synchronization ready interrupt is enabled. Bits 1,0 – CMPx  Compare x Interrupt Enable [x=1:0] Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Compare x Interrupt Enable bit and enable the Compare x interrupt. Value Description 0 The compare x interrupt is disabled. 1 The compare x interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 225 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.13 Interrupt Enable Set - MODE2 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset INTENSET 0x07 0x00 Write-Protected 7 OVF R/W 0 6 SYNCRDY R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 ALARM0 R/W 0 Bit 7 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Overflow Interrupt Enable bit and enable the Overflow interrupt. Value Description 0 The overflow interrupt is disabled. 1 The overflow interrupt is enabled. Bit 6 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Synchronization Ready Interrupt bit and enable the Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The synchronization ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The synchronization ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – ALARM0 Alarm 0 Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Alarm 0 Interrupt Enable bit and enable the Alarm 0 interrupt. Value Description 0 The alarm 0 interrupt is disabled. 1 The alarm 0 interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 226 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.14 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear - MODE0 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset INTFLAG 0x08 0x00 - 7 OVF R/W 0 6 SYNCRDY R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 CMP0 R/W 0 Bit 7 – OVF Overflow This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag. This flag is set on the next CLK_RTC_CNT cycle after an overflow condition occurs, and an interrupt request will be generated if INTENCLR/SET.OVF is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Overflow interrupt flag. Bit 6 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag. This flag is set on a 1-to-0 transition of the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY), except when caused by enable or software reset, and an interrupt request will be generated if INTENCLR/ SET.SYNCRDY is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Synchronization Ready interrupt flag. Bit 0 – CMP0 Compare 0 This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag. This flag is set on the next CLK_RTC_CNT cycle after a match with the compare condition, and an interrupt request will be generated if INTENCLR/SET.CMP0 is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Compare 0 interrupt flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 227 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.15 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear - MODE1 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset INTFLAG 0x08 0x00 - 7 OVF R/W 0 6 SYNCRDY R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 CMPx R/W 0 0 CMPx R/W 0 Bit 7 – OVF Overflow This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag. This flag is set on the next CLK_RTC_CNT cycle after an overflow condition occurs, and an interrupt request will be generated if INTENCLR/SET.OVF is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Overflow interrupt flag. Bit 6 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag. This flag is set on a 1-to-0 transition of the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY), except when caused by enable or software reset, and an interrupt request will be generated if INTENCLR/ SET.SYNCRDY is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Synchronization Ready interrupt flag. Bits 1,0 – CMPx  Compare x [x=1:0] This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag. This flag is set on the next CLK_RTC_CNT cycle after a match with the compare condition and an interrupt request will be generated if INTENCLR/SET.CMPx is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Compare x interrupt flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 228 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.16 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear - MODE2 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset INTFLAG 0x08 0x00 - 7 OVF R/W 0 6 SYNCRDY R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 ALARM0 R/W 0 Bit 7 – OVF Overflow This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag. This flag is set on the next CLK_RTC_CNT cycle after an overflow condition occurs, and an interrupt request will be generated if INTENCLR/SET.OVF is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Overflow interrupt flag. Bit 6 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag. This flag is set on a 1-to-0 transition of the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY), except when caused by enable or software reset, and an interrupt request will be generated if INTENCLR/ SET.SYNCRDY is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Synchronization Ready interrupt flag. Bit 0 – ALARM0 Alarm 0 This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag. This flag is set on the next CLK_RTC_CNT cycle after a match with ALARM0 condition occurs, and an interrupt request will be generated if INTENCLR/SET.ALARM0 is also one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Alarm 0 interrupt flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 229 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.17 Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset STATUS 0x0A 0x00 - 7 SYNCBUSY R 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 7 – SYNCBUSY Synchronization Busy This bit is cleared when the synchronization of registers between the clock domains is complete. This bit is set when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is started. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 230 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.18 Debug Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit DBGCTRL 0x0B 0x00 - 7 6 5 4 3 2 Access Reset 1 0 DBGRUN R/W 0 Bit 0 – DBGRUN Run During Debug This bit is not reset by a software reset. Writing a zero to this bit causes the RTC to halt during debug mode. Writing a one to this bit allows the RTC to continue normal operation during debug mode. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 231 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.19 Frequency Correction Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset FREQCORR 0x0C 0x00 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 7 SIGN R/W 0 6 5 4 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 VALUE[6:0] R/W 0 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit 7 – SIGN Correction Sign Value Description 0 The correction value is positive, i.e., frequency will be decreased. 1 The correction value is negative, i.e., frequency will be increased. Bits 6:0 – VALUE[6:0] Correction Value These bits define the amount of correction applied to the RTC prescaler. 1–127: The RTC frequency is adjusted according to the value. Value Description 0 Correction is disabled and the RTC frequency is unchanged. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 232 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.20 Counter Value - MODE0 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset COUNT 0x10 0x00000000 Read-Synchronized, Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 31 30 29 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 23 22 21 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 28 27 COUNT[31:24] R/W R/W 0 0 20 19 COUNT[23:16] R/W R/W 0 0 12 11 COUNT[15:8] R/W R/W 0 0 4 3 COUNT[7:0] R/W R/W 0 0 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 31:0 – COUNT[31:0] Counter Value These bits define the value of the 32-bit RTC counter. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 233 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.21 Counter Value - MODE1 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset COUNT 0x10 0x0000 Read-Synchronized, Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 12 11 COUNT[15:8] R/W R/W 0 0 4 3 COUNT[7:0] R/W R/W 0 0 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 15:0 – COUNT[15:0] Counter Value These bits define the value of the 16-bit RTC counter. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 234 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.22 Clock Value - MODE2 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CLOCK 0x10 0x00000000 Read-Synchronized, Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 31 30 29 28 27 26 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 21 20 18 17 R/W 0 R/W 0 19 DAY[4:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 13 12 11 10 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 5 4 3 R/W 0 R/W 0 YEAR[5:0] Access Reset R/W 0 Bit R/W 0 23 22 MONTH[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit 15 14 HOUR[3:0] Access Reset R/W 0 Bit R/W 0 7 6 MINUTE[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 Access Reset 25 24 MONTH[3:2] R/W R/W 0 0 9 MINUTE[5:2] R/W R/W 0 0 2 SECOND[5:0] R/W R/W 0 0 16 HOUR[4] R/W 0 8 R/W 0 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 31:26 – YEAR[5:0] Year The year offset with respect to the reference year (defined in software). The year is considered a leap year if YEAR[1:0] is zero. Bits 25:22 – MONTH[3:0] Month 1 – January 2 – February ... 12 – December Bits 21:17 – DAY[4:0] Day Day starts at 1 and ends at 28, 29, 30 or 31, depending on the month and year. Bits 16:12 – HOUR[4:0] Hour When CTRL.CLKREP is zero, the Hour bit group is in 24-hour format, with values 0-23. When CTRL.CLKREP is one, HOUR[3:0] has values 1-12 and HOUR[4] represents AM (0) or PM (1). Table 18-4. Hour HOUR[4:0] CLOCK.HOUR[4] 0 0x00 - 0x17 0x18 - 0x1F 0 1 1 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries CLOCK.HOUR[3:0] Description 0x0 0x1 - 0xC 0xD - 0xF 0x0 0x1 - 0xC 0xF - 0xF Hour (0 - 23) Reserved Reserved AM Hour (1 - 12) Reserved Reserved PM Hour (1 - 12) Reserved Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 235 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter Bits 11:6 – MINUTE[5:0] Minute 0 – 59. Bits 5:0 – SECOND[5:0] Second 0– 59. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 236 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.23 Counter Period - MODE1 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit PER 0x14 0x0000 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 PER[15:8] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 PER[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 15:0 – PER[15:0] Counter Period These bits define the value of the 16-bit RTC period. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 237 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.24 Compare n Value - MODE0 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit COMP 0x18 0x00000000 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 31 30 29 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 23 22 21 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 28 27 COMP[31:24] R/W R/W 0 0 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 20 19 COMP[23:16] R/W R/W 0 0 12 11 COMP[15:8] R/W R/W 0 0 4 COMP[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 31:0 – COMP[31:0] Compare Value The 32-bit value of COMPn is continuously compared with the 32-bit COUNT value. When a match occurs, the Compare n interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.CMPn) is set on the next counter cycle, and the counter value is cleared if CTRL.MATCHCLR is one. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 238 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.25 Compare n Value - MODE1 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit COMPn 0x18+n*0x2 [n=0..1] 0x0000 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 12 11 COMP[15:8] R/W R/W 0 0 4 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 COMP[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 15:0 – COMP[15:0] Compare Value The 16-bit value of COMPn is continuously compared with the 16-bit COUNT value. When a match occurs, the Compare n interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.CMPn) is set on the next counter cycle. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 239 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.26 Alarm 0 Value - MODE2 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  ALARM0 0x18 0x00000000 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized The 32-bit value of ALARM0 is continuously compared with the 32-bit CLOCK value, based on the masking set by MASKn.SEL. When a match occurs, the Alarm 0 interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.ALARMn) is set on the next counter cycle, and the counter is cleared if CTRL.MATCHCLR is one. Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 21 20 18 17 R/W 0 R/W 0 19 DAY[4:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 13 12 11 10 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 5 4 3 R/W 0 R/W 0 YEAR[5:0] Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 23 22 MONTH[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 15 14 HOUR[3:0] Access Reset Bit Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 MINUTE[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 25 24 MONTH[3:2] R/W R/W 0 0 9 MINUTE[5:2] R/W R/W 0 0 2 SECOND[5:0] R/W R/W 0 0 16 HOUR[4] R/W 0 8 R/W 0 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 31:26 – YEAR[5:0] Year The alarm year. Years are only matched if MASKn.SEL is 6. Bits 25:22 – MONTH[3:0] Month The alarm month. Months are matched only if MASKn.SEL is greater than 4. Bits 21:17 – DAY[4:0] Day The alarm day. Days are matched only if MASKn.SEL is greater than 3. Bits 16:12 – HOUR[4:0] Hour The alarm hour. Hours are matched only if MASKn.SEL is greater than 2. Bits 11:6 – MINUTE[5:0] Minute The alarm minute. Minutes are matched only if MASKn.SEL is greater than 1. Bits 5:0 – SECOND[5:0] Second The alarm second. Seconds are matched only if MASKn.SEL is greater than 0. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 240 SAM D20 Family RTC – Real-Time Counter 18.8.27 Alarm n Mask - MODE2 Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit MASK 0x1C 0x00 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 R/W 0 1 SEL[2:0] R/W 0 0 R/W 0 Bits 2:0 – SEL[2:0] Alarm Mask Selection These bits define which bit groups of Alarm n are valid. SEL[2:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 OFF SS MMSS HHMMSS DDHHMMSS MMDDHHMMSS YYMMDDHHMMSS Alarm Disabled Match seconds only Match seconds and minutes only Match seconds, minutes, and hours only Match seconds, minutes, hours, and days only Match seconds, minutes, hours, days, and months only Match seconds, minutes, hours, days, months, and years Reserved © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 241 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19. EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19.1 Overview The External Interrupt Controller (EIC) allows external pins to be configured as interrupt lines. Each interrupt line can be individually masked and can generate an interrupt on rising, falling, or both edges, or on high or low levels. Each external pin has a configurable filter to remove spikes. Each external pin can also be configured to be asynchronous in order to wake up the device from sleep modes where all clocks have been disabled. External pins can also generate an event. A separate non-maskable interrupt (NMI) is also supported. It has properties similar to the other external interrupts, but is connected to the NMI request of the CPU, enabling it to interrupt any other interrupt mode. 19.2 Features • • • • • • • 19.3 Up to 16 external pins (EXTINTx), plus one non-maskable pin (NMI) Dedicated, individually maskable interrupt for each pin Interrupt on rising, falling, or both edges Interrupt on high or low levels Asynchronous interrupts for sleep modes without clock Filtering of external pins Event generation from EXTINTx Block Diagram Figure 19-1. EIC Block Diagram FILTENx SENSEx[2:0] Interrupt EXTINTx Filter Edge/Level Detection Wake Event NMIFILTEN NMI Edge/Level Detection Wake 19.4 inwake_extint evt_extint NMISENSE[2:0] Interrupt Filter intreq_extint intreq_nmi inwake_nmi Signal Description Signal Name Type Description EXTINT[15..0] Digital Input External interrupt pin NMI Digital Input Non-maskable interrupt pin One signal may be available on several pins. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 242 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 19.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this EIC, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. 19.5.1 I/O Lines Using the EIC’s I/O lines requires the I/O pins to be configured. Related Links 21. PORT - I/O Pin Controller 19.5.2 Power Management All interrupts are available down to STANDBY sleep mode, but the EIC can be configured to automatically mask some interrupts in order to prevent device wake-up. The EIC will continue to operate in any sleep mode where the selected source clock is running. The EIC’s interrupts can be used to wake up the device from sleep modes. Events connected to the Event System can trigger other operations in the system without exiting sleep modes. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 19.5.3 Clocks The EIC bus clock (CLK_EIC_APB) can be enabled and disabled in the Power Manager, and the default state of CLK_EIC_APB can be found in the Peripheral Clock Masking section in PM – Power Manager. A generic clock (GCLK_EIC) is required to clock the peripheral. This clock must be configured and enabled in the Generic Clock Controller before using the peripheral. Refer to GCLK – Generic Clock Controller. This generic clock is asynchronous to the user interface clock (CLK_EIC_APB). Due to this asynchronicity, writes to certain registers will require synchronization between the clock domains. Refer to 19.6.8. Synchronization for further details. Related Links 19.6.8. Synchronization 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 19.5.4 Interrupts There are several interrupt request lines, at least one for the external interrupts (EXTINT) and one for non-maskable interrupt (NMI). The EXTINT interrupt request line is connected to the interrupt controller. Using the EIC interrupt requires the interrupt controller to be configured first. The NMI interrupt request line is also connected to the interrupt controller, but does not require the interrupt to be configured. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 19.5.5 Events The events are connected to the Event System. Using the events requires the Event System to be configured first. Related Links 22. Event System (EVSYS) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 243 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19.5.6 Debug Operation When the CPU is halted in debug mode, the EIC continues normal operation. If the EIC is configured in a way that requires it to be periodically serviced by the CPU through interrupts or similar, improper operation or data loss may result during debugging. 19.5.7 Register Access Protection All registers with write-access can be write-protected optionally by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC), except for the following registers: • • Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG) Non-Maskable Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (NMIFLAG) Optional write-protection by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC) is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. PAC write-protection does not apply to accesses through an external debugger. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller 19.5.8 Analog Connections Not applicable. 19.6 Functional Description 19.6.1 Principle of Operation The EIC detects edge or level condition to generate interrupts to the CPU interrupt controller or events to the Event System. Each external interrupt pin (EXTINT) can be filtered using majority vote filtering, clocked by GCLK_EIC 19.6.2 Basic Operation 19.6.2.1 Initialization The EIC must be initialized in the following order: 1. Enable CLK_EIC_APB 2. If edge detection or filtering is required, GCLK_EIC must be enabled 3. Write the EIC configuration registers (EVCTRL, WAKEUP, CONFIGy) 4. Enable the EIC To use NMI, GCLK_EIC must be enabled after EIC configuration (NMICTRL). 19.6.2.2 Enabling, Disabling and Resetting The EIC is enabled by writing a '1' the Enable bit in the Control register (CTRL.ENABLE). The EIC is disabled by writing CTRL.ENABLE to '0'. The EIC is reset by setting the Software Reset bit in the Control register (CTRL.SWRST). All registers in the EIC will be reset to their initial state, and the EIC will be disabled. Refer to the CTRL register description for details. 19.6.3 External Pin Processing Each external pin can be configured to generate an interrupt/event on edge detection (rising, falling or both edges) or level detection (high or low). The sense of external interrupt pins is configured by writing the Input Sense x bits in the Config n register (CONFIGn.SENSEx). The corresponding interrupt flag (INTFLAG.EXTINT[x]) in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG) is set when the interrupt condition is met. When the interrupt flag has been cleared in edge-sensitive mode, INTFLAG.EXTINT[x] will only be set if a new interrupt condition is met. In level-sensitive mode, when interrupt has been cleared, INTFLAG.EXTINT[x] will be set immediately if the EXTINTx pin still matches the interrupt condition. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 244 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller Each external pin can be filtered by a majority vote filtering, clocked by GCLK_EIC. Filtering is enabled if bit Filter Enable x in the Configuration n register (CONFIGn.FILTENx) is written to '1'. The majority vote filter samples the external pin three times with GCLK_EIC and outputs the value when two or more samples are equal. Table 19-1. Majority Vote Filter Samples [0, 1, 2] Filter Output [0,0,0] 0 [0,0,1] 0 [0,1,0] 0 [0,1,1] 1 [1,0,0] 0 [1,0,1] 1 [1,1,0] 1 [1,1,1] 1 When an external interrupt is configured for level detection, or if filtering is disabled, detection is made asynchronously, and GCLK_EIC is not required. If filtering or edge detection is enabled, the EIC automatically requests the GCLK_EIC to operate (GCLK_EIC must be enabled in the GCLK module, see GCLK – Generic Clock Controller for details). If level detection is enabled, GCLK_EIC is not required, but interrupt and events can still be generated. When an external interrupt is configured for level detection and when filtering is disabled, detection is done asynchronously. Asynchronuous detection does not require GCLK_EIC, but interrupt and events can still be generated. If filtering or edge detection is enabled, the EIC automatically requests GCLK_EIC to operate. GCLK_EIC must be enabled in the GCLK module. Figure 19-2. Interrupt Detections GCLK_EIC CLK_EIC_APB EXTINTx intreq_extint[x] (level detection / no filter) No interrupt intreq_extint[x] (level detection / filter) intreq_extint[x] (edge detection / no filter) No interrupt intreq_extint[x] (edge detection / filter) clear INTFLAG.EXTINT[x] The detection delay depends on the detection mode. Table 19-2. Interrupt Latency Detection mode Latency (worst case) Level without filter Three CLK_EIC_APB periods Level with filter Four GCLK_EIC periods + Three CLK_EIC_APB periods Edge without filter Four GCLK_EIC periods + Three CLK_EIC_APB periods Edge with filter Six GCLK_EIC periods + Three CLK_EIC_APB periods © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 245 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 19.6.4 Additional Features 19.6.4.1 Non-Maskable Interrupt (NMI) The non-maskable interrupt pin can also generate an interrupt on edge or level detection, but it is configured with the dedicated NMI Control register (NMICTRL). To select the sense for NMI, write to the NMISENSE bit group in the NMI Control register (NMICTRL.NMISENSE). NMI filtering is enabled by writing a '1' to the NMI Filter Enable bit (NMICTRL.NMIFILTEN). If edge detection or filtering is required, enable GCLK_EIC or CLK_ULP32K. NMI detection is enabled only by the NMICTRL.NMISENSE value, and the EIC is not required to be enabled. When an NMI is detected, the non-maskable interrupt flag in the NMI Flag Status and Clear register is set (NMIFLAG.NMI). NMI interrupt generation is always enabled, and NMIFLAG.NMI generates an interrupt request when set. 19.6.5 Interrupts The EIC has the following interrupt sources: • • External interrupt pins (EXTINTx). See 19.6.2. Basic Operation. Non-maskable interrupt pin (NMI). See 19.6.4. Additional Features. Each interrupt source has an associated interrupt flag. The interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG) is set when an interrupt condition occurs (NMIFLAG for NMI). Each interrupt, except NMI, can be individually enabled by setting the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET=1), and disabled by setting the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR=1). An interrupt request is generated when the interrupt flag is set and the corresponding interrupt is enabled. The interrupt request remains active until the interrupt flag is cleared, the interrupt is disabled, or the EIC is reset. See the INTFLAG register for details on how to clear interrupt flags. The EIC has one interrupt request line for each external interrupt (EXTINTx) and one line for NMI. The user must read the INTFLAG (or NMIFLAG) register to determine which interrupt condition is present. Notes:  1. Interrupts must be globally enabled for interrupt requests to be generated. 2. If an external interrupts (EXTINT) is common on two or more I/O pins, only one will be active (the first one programmed). Related Links 10. Processor And Architecture 19.6.6 Events The EIC can generate the following output events: • External event from pin (EXTINTx). Setting an Event Output Control register (EVCTRL.EXTINTEO) enables the corresponding output event. Clearing this bit disables the corresponding output event. Refer to Event System for details on configuring the Event System. When the condition on pin EXTINTx matches the configuration in the CONFIGn register, the corresponding event is generated, if enabled. Related Links 22. Event System (EVSYS) 19.6.7 Sleep Mode Operation In sleep modes, an EXTINTx pin can wake up the device if the corresponding condition matches the configuration in CONFIGy register. Writing a one to a Wake-Up Enable bit (WAKEUP.WAKEUPEN[x]) enables the wake-up from pin EXTINTx. Writing a zero to a Wake-Up Enable bit (WAKEUP.WAKEUPEN[x]) disables the wake-up from pin EXTINTx. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 246 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller Using WAKEUPEN[x]=1 with INTENSET=0 is not recommended. In sleep modes, an EXTINTx pin can wake up the device if the corresponding condition matches the configuration in CONFIGn register, and the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET) is written to '1'. WAKEUP.WAKEUPEN[x]=1 can enable the wake-up from pin EXTINTx. Figure 19-3. Wake-Up Operation Example (High-Level Detection, No Filter, WAKEUPEN[x]=1) CLK_EIC_APB EXTINTx intwake_extint[x] intreq_extint[x] wake from sleep mode 19.6.8 clear INTFLAG.EXTINT[x] Synchronization Due to asynchronicity between the main clock domain and the peripheral clock domains, some registers need to be synchronized when written or read. When executing an operation that requires synchronization, the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY) will be set immediately, and cleared when synchronization is complete. If an operation that requires synchronization is executed while STATUS.SYNCBUSY is one, the bus will be stalled. All operations will complete successfully, but the CPU will be stalled, and interrupts will be pending as long as the bus is stalled. The following bits are synchronized when written: • • Software Reset bit in the Control register (CTRL.SWRST) Enable bit in the Control register (CTRL.ENABLE) Related Links 13.3. Register Synchronization © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 247 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19.7 Register Summary Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 CTRL STATUS NMICTRL NMIFLAG 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 0x04 EVCTRL 0x08 INTENCLR 0x0C INTENSET 0x10 INTFLAG 0x14 WAKEUP 0x18 CONFIG0 0x1C CONFIG1 19.8 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ENABLE SWRST SYNCBUSY NMIFILTEN NMISENSE[2:0] EXTINTEO7 EXTINTEO6 EXTINTEO5 EXTINTEO4 EXTINTEO3 EXTINTEO2 EXTINTEO1 EXTINTEO15 EXTINTEO14 EXTINTEO13 EXTINTEO12 EXTINTEO11 EXTINTEO10 EXTINTEO9 NMI EXTINTEO0 EXTINTEO8 EXTINT7 EXTINT15 EXTINT6 EXTINT14 EXTINT5 EXTINT13 EXTINT4 EXTINT12 EXTINT3 EXTINT11 EXTINT2 EXTINT10 EXTINT1 EXTINT9 EXTINT0 EXTINT8 EXTINT7 EXTINT15 EXTINT6 EXTINT14 EXTINT5 EXTINT13 EXTINT4 EXTINT12 EXTINT3 EXTINT11 EXTINT2 EXTINT10 EXTINT1 EXTINT9 EXTINT0 EXTINT8 EXTINT7 EXTINT15 EXTINT6 EXTINT14 EXTINT5 EXTINT13 EXTINT4 EXTINT12 EXTINT3 EXTINT11 EXTINT2 EXTINT10 EXTINT1 EXTINT9 EXTINT0 EXTINT8 WAKEUPEN7 WAKEUPEN6 WAKEUPEN5 WAKEUPEN4 WAKEUPEN3 WAKEUPEN2 WAKEUPEN1 WAKEUPEN0 WAKEUPEN1 WAKEUPEN1 WAKEUPEN1 WAKEUPEN1 WAKEUPEN1 WAKEUPEN1 WAKEUPEN9 WAKEUPEN8 5 4 3 2 1 0 FILTENx FILTENx FILTENx FILTENx FILTENx FILTENx FILTENx FILTENx SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] FILTENx FILTENx FILTENx FILTENx FILTENx FILTENx FILTENx FILTENx SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] SENSEx[2:0] Register Description Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16-, and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers require synchronization when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the "ReadSynchronized" and/or "Write-Synchronized" property in each individual register description. Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the module is disabled. Enableprotection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 248 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19.8.1 Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 CTRL 0x00 0x00 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 ENABLE R/W 0 0 SWRST R/W 0 Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable Due to synchronization, there is delay from writing CTRL.ENABLE until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to CTRL.ENABLE will read back immediately, and the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY) will be set. STATUS.SYNCBUSY will be cleared when the operation is complete. Value Description 0 The EIC is disabled. 1 The EIC is enabled. Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit resets all registers in the EIC to their initial state, and the EIC will be disabled. Writing a one to CTRL.SWRST will always take precedence, meaning that all other writes in the same write operation will be discarded. Due to synchronization, there is a delay from writing CTRL.SWRST until the reset is complete. CTRL.SWRST and STATUS.SYNCBUSY will both be cleared when the reset is complete. Value Description 0 There is no ongoing reset operation. 1 The reset operation is ongoing. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 249 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19.8.2 Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset 7 SYNCBUSY R 0 STATUS 0x01 0x00 - 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 7 – SYNCBUSY Synchronization Busy This bit is cleared when the synchronization of registers between the clock domains is complete. This bit is set when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is started. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 250 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19.8.3 Non-Maskable Interrupt Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit NMICTRL 0x02 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 5 4 Access Reset 3 NMIFILTEN R/W 0 2 R/W 0 1 NMISENSE[2:0] R/W 0 0 R/W 0 Bit 3 – NMIFILTEN Non-Maskable Interrupt Filter Enable Value Description 0 NMI filter is disabled. 1 NMI filter is enabled. Bits 2:0 – NMISENSE[2:0] Non-Maskable Interrupt Sense These bits define on which edge or level the NMI triggers. NMISENSE[2:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6-0x7 NONE RISE FALL BOTH HIGH LOW No detection Rising-edge detection Falling-edge detection Both-edges detection High-level detection Low-level detection Reserved © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 251 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19.8.4 Non-Maskable Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 NMIFLAG 0x03 0x00 - 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 0 NMI R/W 0 Bit 0 – NMI Non-Maskable Interrupt This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set when the NMI pin matches the NMI sense configuration, and will generate an interrupt request. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the non-maskable interrupt flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 252 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19.8.5 Event Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit EVCTRL 0x04 0x00000000 Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 14 EXTINTEO14 R/W 0 13 EXTINTEO13 R/W 0 12 EXTINTEO12 R/W 0 11 EXTINTEO11 R/W 0 10 EXTINTEO10 R/W 0 9 EXTINTEO9 R/W 0 8 EXTINTEO8 R/W 0 6 EXTINTEO6 R/W 0 5 EXTINTEO5 R/W 0 4 EXTINTEO4 R/W 0 3 EXTINTEO3 R/W 0 2 EXTINTEO2 R/W 0 1 EXTINTEO1 R/W 0 0 EXTINTEO0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 15 EXTINTEO15 Access R/W Reset 0 Bit Access Reset 7 EXTINTEO7 R/W 0 Bits 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15 – EXTINTEO External Interrupt x Event Output Enable [x=15..0] These bits indicate whether the event associated with the EXTINTx pin is enabled or not to generated for every detection. Value Description 0 Event from pin EXTINTx is disabled. 1 Event from pin EXTINTx is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 253 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19.8.6 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTENCLR 0x08 0x00000000 Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 EXTINT15 R/W 0 14 EXTINT14 R/W 0 13 EXTINT13 R/W 0 12 EXTINT12 R/W 0 11 EXTINT11 R/W 0 10 EXTINT10 R/W 0 9 EXTINT9 R/W 0 8 EXTINT8 R/W 0 7 EXTINT7 R/W 0 6 EXTINT6 R/W 0 5 EXTINT5 R/W 0 4 EXTINT4 R/W 0 3 EXTINT3 R/W 0 2 EXTINT2 R/W 0 1 EXTINT1 R/W 0 0 EXTINT0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bits 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15 – EXTINT External Interrupt x Enable [x=15..0] Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the External Interrupt x Enable bit, which disables the external interrupt. Value Description 0 The external interrupt x is disabled. 1 The external interrupt x is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 254 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19.8.7 Interrupt Enable Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTENSET 0x0C 0x00000000 Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 EXTINT15 R/W 0 14 EXTINT14 R/W 0 13 EXTINT13 R/W 0 12 EXTINT12 R/W 0 11 EXTINT11 R/W 0 10 EXTINT10 R/W 0 9 EXTINT9 R/W 0 8 EXTINT8 R/W 0 7 EXTINT7 R/W 0 6 EXTINT6 R/W 0 5 EXTINT5 R/W 0 4 EXTINT4 R/W 0 3 EXTINT3 R/W 0 2 EXTINT2 R/W 0 1 EXTINT1 R/W 0 0 EXTINT0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bits 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15 – EXTINT External Interrupt x Enable [x=15..0] Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the External Interrupt x Enable bit, which enables the external interrupt. Value Description 0 The external interrupt x is disabled. 1 The external interrupt x is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 255 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19.8.8 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTFLAG 0x10 0x00000000 - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 EXTINT15 R/W 0 14 EXTINT14 R/W 0 13 EXTINT13 R/W 0 12 EXTINT12 R/W 0 11 EXTINT11 R/W 0 10 EXTINT10 R/W 0 9 EXTINT9 R/W 0 8 EXTINT8 R/W 0 7 EXTINT7 R/W 0 6 EXTINT6 R/W 0 5 EXTINT5 R/W 0 4 EXTINT4 R/W 0 3 EXTINT3 R/W 0 2 EXTINT2 R/W 0 1 EXTINT1 R/W 0 0 EXTINT0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bits 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15 – EXTINT External Interrupt x [x=15..0] This flag is cleared by writing a one to it. This flag is set when EXTINTx pin matches the external interrupt sense configuration and will generate an interrupt request if INTENCLR/SET.EXTINT[x] is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the External Interrupt x flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 256 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19.8.9 Wake-Up Enable Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit WAKEUP 0x14 0x00000000 Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 WAKEUPEN15 WAKEUPEN14 WAKEUPEN13 WAKEUPEN12 WAKEUPEN11 WAKEUPEN10 WAKEUPEN9 Access R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 WAKEUPEN7 Access R/W Reset 0 6 WAKEUPEN6 R/W 0 5 WAKEUPEN5 R/W 0 4 WAKEUPEN4 R/W 0 3 WAKEUPEN3 R/W 0 2 WAKEUPEN2 R/W 0 1 WAKEUPEN1 R/W 0 8 WAKEUPEN8 R/W 0 0 WAKEUPEN0 R/W 0 Bits 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15 – WAKEUPEN External Interrupt x Wake-up Enable [x=15..0] This bit enables or disables wake-up from sleep modes when the EXTINTx pin matches the external interrupt sense configuration. Value Description 0 Wake-up from the EXTINTx pin is disabled. 1 Wake-up from the EXTINTx pin is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 257 SAM D20 Family EIC – External Interrupt Controller 19.8.10 Configuration n Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset CONFIG 0x18 + n*0x04 [n=0..1] 0x00000000 Write-Protected 31 FILTENx R 0 30 23 FILTENx R 0 22 15 FILTENx R 0 14 7 FILTENx R 0 6 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 29 SENSEx[2:0] R 0 28 21 SENSEx[2:0] R 0 20 13 SENSEx[2:0] R 0 12 5 SENSEx[2:0] R 0 4 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 27 FILTENx R 0 26 19 FILTENx R 0 18 11 FILTENx R 0 10 3 FILTENx R 0 2 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 25 SENSEx[2:0] R 0 24 17 SENSEx[2:0] R 0 16 9 SENSEx[2:0] R 0 8 1 SENSEx[2:0] R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 0 R 0 Bits 31, 27, 23, 19, 15, 11, 7,3 – FILTENx Filter 0 Enable [x=7..0] 0: 1: Filter is disabled for EXTINT[n*8+x] input. Filter is enabled for EXTINT[n*8+x] input. Bits 30:28, 26:24, 22:20, 18:16, 14:12, 10:8, 6:4, 2:0 – SENSEx Input Sense 0 Configuration [x=7..0] SENSE0[2:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6-0x7 NONE RISE FALL BOTH HIGH LOW No detection Rising-edge detection Falling-edge detection Both-edges detection High-level detection Low-level detection Reserved © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 258 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20. NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.1 Overview Non-Volatile Memory (NVM) is a reprogrammable Flash memory that retains program and data storage even with power off. The NVM Controller (NVMCTRL) connects to the AHB and APB bus interfaces for system access to the NVM block. The AHB interface is used for reads and writes to the NVM block, while the APB interface is used for commands and configuration. 20.2 Features • • • • • • • • • • 32-bit AHB interface for reads and writes All NVM sections are memory mapped to the AHB, including calibration and system configuration 32-bit APB interface for commands and control Programmable wait states for read optimization 16 regions can be individually protected or unprotected Additional protection for boot loader Supports device protection through a security bit Interface to Power Manager for power-down of Flash blocks in sleep modes Can optionally wake up on exit from sleep or on first access Direct-mapped cache Note:  A register with property "Enable-Protected" may contain bits that are not enable-protected. 20.3 Block Diagram Figure 20-1. Block Diagram NVMCTRL AHB Cache NVM Interface APB 20.4 NVM Block Command and Control Signal Description Not applicable. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 259 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described in the following sections. 20.5.1 Power Management The NVMCTRL will continue to operate in any sleep mode where the selected source clock is running. The NVMCTRL interrupts can be used to wake up the device from sleep modes. The Power Manager will automatically put the NVM block into a low-power state when entering sleep mode. This is based on the Control B register (CTRLB) SLEEPPRM bit setting. Refer to the 20.8.2. CTRLB. SLEEPPRM register description for more details. The NVM block goes into low-power mode automatically when the device enters STANDBY mode regardless of SLEEPPRM. The NVM Page Buffer is lost when the NVM goes into low power mode therefore a write command must be issued prior entering the NVM low power mode. NVMCTRL SLEEPPRM can be disabled to avoid such loss when the CPU goes into sleep except if the device goes into STANDBY mode for which there is no way to retain the Page Buffer. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 20.5.2 Clocks Two synchronous clocks are used by the NVMCTRL. One is provided by the AHB bus (CLK_NVMCTRL_AHB) and the other is provided by the APB bus (CLK_NVMCTRL_APB). For higher system frequencies, a programmable number of wait states can be used to optimize performance. When changing the AHB bus frequency, the user must ensure that the NVM Controller is configured with the proper number of wait states. Refer to the Electrical Characteristics for the exact number of wait states to be used for a particular frequency range. Related Links 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 20.5.3 Interrupts The NVM Controller interrupt request line is connected to the interrupt controller. Using the NVMCTRL interrupt requires the interrupt controller to be programmed first. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 20.5.4 Debug Operation When an external debugger forces the CPU into debug mode, the peripheral continues normal operation. Access to the NVM block can be protected by the security bit. In this case, the NVM block will not be accessible. See the section on the NVMCTRL 20.6.6. Security Bit for details. 20.5.5 Register Access Protection All registers with write-access are optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC), except the following registers: • • Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG) Status register (STATUS) Optional write-protection by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC) is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller 20.5.6 Analog Connections Not applicable. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 260 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.6 Functional Description 20.6.1 Principle of Operation The NVM Controller is a client on the AHB and APB buses. It responds to commands, read requests and write requests, based on user configuration. 20.6.1.1 Initialization After power up, the NVM Controller goes through a power-up sequence. During this time, access to the NVM Controller from the AHB bus is halted. Upon power-up completion, the NVM Controller is operational without any need for user configuration. 20.6.2 Memory Organization Refer to the Physical Memory Map for memory sizes and addresses for each device. The NVM is organized into rows, where each row contains four pages, as shown in the figure below. The NVM has a row-erase granularity, while the write granularity is by page. In other words, a single row erase will erase all four pages in the row, while four write operations are used to write the complete row. Figure 20-2. NVM Row Organization Row n Page (n*4) + 3 Page (n*4) + 2 Page (n*4) + 1 Page (n*4) + 0 The NVM block contains a calibration and auxiliary space. Refer to the NVM Organization figure below for details. The calibration and auxiliary space contains factory calibration and system configuration information. These spaces can be read from the AHB bus in the same way as the main NVM main address space. In addition, a boot loader section can be allocated at the beginning of the main array, and an EEPROM Emulation section can be allocated at the end of the NVM main address space. Figure 20-3. NVM Memory Organization Calibration and Auxillary Space NVM Base Address + 0x00800000 NVM Base Address + NVM Size NVM Main Address Space NVM Base Address The lower rows in the NVM main address space can be allocated as a boot loader section by using the BOOTPROT fuses, and the upper rows can be allocated to EEPROM Emulation, as shown in the figure below. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 261 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller The boot loader section is protected by the lock bit(s) corresponding to this address space and by the BOOTPROT[2:0] fuse. The EEPROM Emulation rows can be written regardless of the region lock status. The number of rows protected by BOOTPROT is given in Boot Loader Size, the number of rows allocated to the EEPROM Emulation are given in EEPROM Size. Figure 20-4. EEPROM Emulation and Boot Loader Allocation 20.6.3 Region Lock Bits The NVM block is grouped into 16 equally sized regions. The region size is dependent on the Flash memory size, and is given in the table below. Each region has a dedicated lock bit preventing writing and erasing pages in the region. After production, all regions will be unlocked. Table 20-1. Region Size Memory Size [KB] Region Size [KB] 256 16 128 8 64 4 32 2 To lock or unlock a region, the Lock Region and Unlock Region commands are provided. Writing one of these commands will temporarily lock/unlock the region containing the address loaded in the ADDR register. ADDR can be written by software, or the automatically loaded value from a write operation can be used. The new setting will stay in effect until the next Reset, or until the setting is changed again using the Lock and Unlock commands. The current status of the lock can be determined by reading the LOCK register. To change the default lock/unlock setting for a region, the user configuration section of the auxiliary space must be written using the Write Auxiliary Page command. Writing to the auxiliary space will take effect after the next Reset. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 262 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller Therefore, a boot of the device is needed for changes in the lock/unlock setting to take effect. Refer to the Physical Memory Map for calibration and auxiliary space address mapping. Related Links 9.2. Physical Memory Map 20.6.4 Command and Data Interface The NVM Controller is addressable from the APB bus, while the NVM main address space is addressable from the AHB bus. Read and automatic page write operations are performed by addressing the NVM main address space directly, while other operations such as manual page writes and row erases must be performed by issuing commands through the NVM Controller. When performing a write operation the flash will be stalled during the whole operation. If running code from the flash, the next instruction will not be executed until after the operation has completed. To issue a command, the CTRLA.CMD bits must be written along with the CTRLA.CMDEX value. When a command is issued, INTFLAG.READY will be cleared until the command has completed. Any commands written while INTFLAG.READY is low will be ignored. The CTRLB register must be used to control the power reduction mode, read wait states, and the write mode. 20.6.4.1 NVM Read Reading from the NVM main address space is performed via the AHB bus by addressing the NVM main address space or auxiliary address space directly. Read data is available after the configured number of read wait states (CTRLB.RWS) set in the NVM Controller. The number of cycles data are delayed to the AHB bus is determined by the read wait states. Examples of using zero and one wait states are shown in Figure Read Wait State Examples below. Reading the NVM main address space while a programming or erase operation is ongoing on the NVM main array results in an AHB bus stall until the end of the operation. Figure 20-5. Read Wait State Examples 0 Wait States AHB Command Rd 0 Idle Rd 1 AHB Client Ready AHB Client Data Data 1 Data 0 1 Wait States AHB Command Rd 0 Idle Rd 1 AHB Client Ready AHB Client Data Data 0 Data 1 20.6.4.2 NVM Write The NVM Controller requires that an erase must be done before programming. The entire NVM main address space can be erased by a debugger Chip Erase command. Alternatively, rows can be individually erased by the Erase Row command. After programming the NVM main array, the region that the page resides in can be locked to prevent spurious write or erase sequences. Locking is performed on a per-region basis, and so, locking a region will lock all pages inside the region. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 263 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller Data to be written to the NVM block are first written to and stored in an internal buffer called the page buffer. The page buffer contains the same number of bytes as an NVM page. Writes to the page buffer must be 16 or 32 bits. 8-bit writes to the page buffer are not allowed and will cause a system exception. Writing to the NVM block via the AHB bus is performed by a load operation to the page buffer. For each AHB bus write, the address is stored in the ADDR register. After the page buffer has been loaded with the required number of bytes, the page can be written to the NVM main array by setting CTRLA.CMD to 'Write Page' and setting the key value to CMDEX. The LOAD bit in the STATUS register indicates whether the page buffer has been loaded or not. Before writing the page to memory, the accessed row must be erased. Automatic page writes are enabled by writing the manual write bit to zero (CTRLB.MANW=0). This will trigger a write operation to the page addressed by ADDR when the last location of the page is written. Because the address is automatically stored in ADDR during the I/O bus write operation, the last given address will be present in the ADDR register. There is no need to load the ADDR register manually, unless a different page in memory is to be written. 20.6.4.2.1 Procedure for Manual Page Writes (CTRLB.MANW=1) The row to be written to must be erased before the write command is given. • • • Write to the page buffer by addressing the NVM main address space directly Write the page buffer to memory: CTRL.CMD='Write Page' and CMDEX The READY bit in the INTFLAG register will be low while programming is in progress, and access through the AHB will be stalled 20.6.4.2.2 Procedure for Automatic Page Writes (CTRLB.MANW=0) The row to be written to must be erased before the last write to the page buffer is performed. Note that partially written pages must be written with a manual write. • • Write to the page buffer by addressing the NVM main address space directly. When the last location in the page buffer is written, the page is automatically written to NVM main address space. INTFLAG.READY will be zero while programming is in progress and access through the AHB will be stalled. 20.6.4.3 Page Buffer Clear The page buffer is automatically set to all '1' after a page write is performed. If a partial page has been written and it is desired to clear the contents of the page buffer, the Page Buffer Clear command can be used. 20.6.4.4 Erase Row Before a page can be written, the row containing that page must be erased. The Erase Row command can be used to erase the desired row in the NVM main address space. Erasing the row sets all bits to '1'. If the row resides in a region that is locked, the erase will not be performed and the Lock Error bit in the Status register (STATUS.LOCKE) will be set. 20.6.4.4.1 Procedure for Erase Row • Write the address of the row to erase to ADDR. Any address within the row can be used. • Issue an Erase Row command. Note:  The NVM Address bit field in the Address register (ADDR.ADDR) uses 16-bit addressing. 20.6.4.5 Lock and Unlock Region These commands are used to lock and unlock regions as detailed in section 20.6.3. Region Lock Bits. 20.6.4.6 Set and Clear Power Reduction Mode The NVM Controller and block can be taken in and out of power reduction mode through the Set and Clear Power Reduction Mode commands. When the NVM Controller and block are in power reduction mode, the Power Reduction Mode bit in the Status register (STATUS.PRM) is set. 20.6.5 NVM User Configuration The NVM user configuration resides in the auxiliary space. Refer to the Physical Memory Map of the device for calibration and auxiliary space address mapping. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 264 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller The bootloader resides in the main array starting at offset zero. The allocated boot loader section is write-protected. Table 20-2. Boot Loader Size BOOTPROT [2:0] Rows Protected by BOOTPROT Boot Loader Size in Bytes 0x7(1) None 0 0x6 2 512 0x5 4 1024 0x4 8 2048 0x3 16 4096 0x2 32 8192 0x1 64 16384 0x0 128 32768 Note:  1. Default value is 0x7 for all variants, except for theWLCSP45 package, where the default value is 0x3. The WLCSP27 devices boot ROM is not protected as the bootloader is self-upgradable through the I2C interface. . The EEPROM[2:0] bits indicate the EEPROM Emulation size, see the table below. The EEPROM Emulation resides in the upper rows of the NVM main address space and is writable, regardless of the region lock status. Table 20-3. EEPROM Emulation Size EEPROM[2:0] Rows Allocated to EEPROM Emulation EEPROM Emulation Size in Bytes 7 None 0 6 1 256 5 2 512 4 4 1024 3 8 2048 2 16 4096 1 32 8192 0 64 16384 Related Links 9.2. Physical Memory Map 20.6.6 Security Bit The security bit allows the entire chip to be locked from external access for code security. The security bit can be written by a dedicated command, Set Security Bit (SSB). Once set, the only way to clear the security bit is through a debugger Chip Erase command. After issuing the SSB command, the PROGE error bit can be checked. In order to increase the security level it is recommended to enable the internal BOD33 when the security bit is set. Related Links 12. DSU - Device Service Unit 20.6.7 Cache The NVM Controller cache reduces the device power consumption and improves system performance when wait states are required. Only the NVM main array address space is cached. It is a direct-mapped cache that implements . NVM Controller cache can be enabled by writing a '0' to the Cache Disable bit in the Control B register (CTRLB.CACHEDIS). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 265 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller The cache can be configured to three different modes using the Read Mode bit group in the Control B register (CTRLB.READMODE). The INVALL command can be issued using the Command bits in the Control A register to invalidate all cache lines (CTRLA.CMD=INVALL). Commands affecting NVM content automatically invalidate cache lines. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 266 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.7 Register Summary Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x00 CTRLA 7:0 15:8 0x02 ... 0x03 Reserved 0x04 CTRLB 0x08 PARAM 0x0C 0x0D ... 0x0F 0x10 0x11 ... 0x13 0x14 0x15 ... 0x17 INTENCLR 0x18 STATUS 0x1A ... 0x1B Reserved 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 CMD[6:0] CMDEX[7:0] MANW RWS[3:0] CACHEDIS SLEEPPRM[1:0] READMODE[1:0] NVMP[7:0] NVMP[15:8] PSZ[2:0] ERROR READY 7:0 ERROR READY 7:0 ERROR READY LOAD PRM SB Reserved INTENSET Reserved INTFLAG Reserved 0x1C ADDR 0x20 LOCK 20.8 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 7 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 NVME LOCKE PROGE ADDR[7:0] ADDR[15:8] ADDR[21:16] LOCK[7:0] LOCK[15:8] Register Description Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16-, and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers require synchronization when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the "ReadSynchronized" and/or "Write-Synchronized" property in each individual register description. Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the module is disabled. Enableprotection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 267 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.8.1 Control A Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset CTRLA 0x00 0x0000 PAC Write-Protection 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit Access Reset 12 11 CMDEX[7:0] R/W R/W 0 0 3 CMD[6:0] R/W 0 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 15:8 – CMDEX[7:0] Command Execution When this bit group is written to the key value 0xA5, the command written to CMD will be executed. If a value different from the key value is tried, the write will not be performed and the Programming Error bit in the Status register (STATUS.PROGE) will be set. PROGE is also set if a previously written command is not completed yet. The key value must be written at the same time as CMD. If a command is issued through the APB bus on the same cycle as an AHB bus access, the AHB bus access will be given priority. The command will then be executed when the NVM block and the AHB bus are idle. INTFLAG.READY must be '1' when the command is issued. Bit 0 of the CMDEX bit group will read back as '1' until the command is issued. Note:  The NVM Address bit field in the Address register (ADDR.ADDR) uses 16-bit addressing. Bits 6:0 – CMD[6:0] Command These bits define the command to be executed when the CMDEX key is written. CMD[6:0] Group Configuration 0x00-0x01 0x02 ER 0x03 0x04 WP 0x05 EAR 0x06 WAP 0x07-0x3F 0x40 LR 0x41 UR 0x42 0x43 0x44 0x45 SPRM CPRM PBC SSB 0x46 INVALL © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Description Reserved Erase Row - Erases the row addressed by the ADDR register in the NVM main array. Reserved Write Page - Writes the contents of the page buffer to the page addressed by the ADDR register. Erase Auxiliary Row - Erases the auxiliary row addressed by the ADDR register. This command can be given only when the security bit is not set and only to the User Configuration Row. Write Auxiliary Page - Writes the contents of the page buffer to the page addressed by the ADDR register. This command can be given only when the security bit is not set and only to the User Configuration Row. Reserved Lock Region - Locks the region containing the address location in the ADDR register. Unlock Region - Unlocks the region containing the address location in the ADDR register. Sets the Power Reduction Mode. Clears the Power Reduction Mode. Page Buffer Clear - Clears the page buffer. Set Security Bit - Sets the security bit by writing 0x00 to the first byte in the lockbit row. Invalidates all cache lines. Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 268 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller ...........continued CMD[6:0] Group Configuration 0x47-0x7F - © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Description Reserved Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 269 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.8.2 Control B Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRLB 0x04 0x00000080 PAC Write-Protection 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 CACHEDIS R/W 0 17 16 READMODE[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 SLEEPPRM[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 7 MANW R/W 1 6 5 4 3 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 RWS[3:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit 18 – CACHEDIS Cache Disable This bit is used to disable the cache. Value Description 0 The cache is enabled 1 The cache is disabled Bits 17:16 – READMODE[1:0] NVMCTRL Read Mode Value Name Description 0x0 NO_MISS_PENALTY The NVM Controller (cache system) does not insert wait states on a cache miss. Gives the best system performance. 0x1 LOW_POWER Reduces power consumption of the cache system, but inserts a wait state each time there is a cache miss. This mode may not be relevant if CPU performance is required, as the application will be stalled and may lead to increased run time. 0x2 DETERMINISTIC The cache system ensures that a cache hit or miss takes the same amount of time, determined by the number of programmed Flash wait states. This mode can be used for real-time applications that require deterministic execution timings. 0x3 Reserved Bits 9:8 – SLEEPPRM[1:0] Power Reduction Mode during Sleep Indicates the Power Reduction Mode during sleep. Value Name Description 0x0 WAKEUPACCESS NVM block enters low-power mode when entering sleep. NVM block exits low-power mode upon first access. 0x1 WAKEUPINSTANT NVM block enters low-power mode when entering sleep. NVM block exits low-power mode when exiting sleep. 0x2 Reserved 0x3 DISABLED Auto power reduction disabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 270 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller Bit 7 – MANW Manual Write Note that reset value of this bit is '1'. Value Description 0 Writing to the last word in the page buffer will initiate a write operation to the page addressed by the last write operation. This includes writes to memory and auxiliary rows. 1 Write commands must be issued through the CTRLA.CMD register. Bits 4:1 – RWS[3:0] NVM Read Wait States These bits control the number of wait states for a read operation. '0' indicates zero wait states, '1' indicates one wait state, etc., up to 15 wait states. This register is initialized to 0 wait states. Software can change this value based on the NVM access time and system frequency. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 271 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.8.3 NVM Parameter Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit PARAM 0x08 0x000XXXXX PAC Write-Protection 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 16 R x 17 PSZ[2:0] R x 11 10 9 8 R x R x R x R x 3 2 1 0 R x R x R x R x Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 15 14 13 12 R x NVMP[15:8] Access Reset R x R x R x R x Bit 7 6 5 4 NVMP[7:0] Access Reset R x R x R x R x Bits 18:16 – PSZ[2:0] Page Size Indicates the page size. Not all devices of the device families will provide all the page sizes indicated in the table. Value Name Description 0x0 8 8 bytes 0x1 16 16 bytes 0x2 32 32 bytes 0x3 64 64 bytes 0x4 128 128 bytes 0x5 256 256 bytes 0x6 512 512 bytes 0x7 1024 1024 bytes Bits 15:0 – NVMP[15:0] NVM Pages Indicates the number of pages in the NVM main address space. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 272 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.8.4 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENCLR 0x0C 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to disable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 ERROR R/W 0 0 READY R/W 0 Bit 1 – ERROR Error Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit clears the ERROR interrupt enable. This bit will read as the current value of the ERROR interrupt enable. Bit 0 – READY NVM Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit clears the READY interrupt enable. This bit will read as the current value of the READY interrupt enable. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 273 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.8.5 Interrupt Enable Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENSET 0x10 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to enable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 ERROR R/W 0 0 READY R/W 0 Bit 1 – ERROR Error Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit sets the ERROR interrupt enable. This bit will read as the current value of the ERROR interrupt enable. Bit 0 – READY NVM Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit sets the READY interrupt enable. This bit will read as the current value of the READY interrupt enable. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 274 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.8.6 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTFLAG 0x14 0x00 – 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 ERROR R/W 0 0 READY R 0 Bit 1 – ERROR Error This flag is set on the occurrence of an NVME, LOCKE or PROGE error. This bit can be cleared by writing a '1' to its bit location. Value Description 0 No errors have been received since the last clear. 1 At least one error has occurred since the last clear. Bit 0 – READY NVM Ready Value Description 0 The NVM controller is busy programming or erasing. 1 The NVM controller is ready to accept a new command. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 275 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.8.7 Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit STATUS 0x18 0x0X00 – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 SB R x 7 6 5 4 NVME R/W 0 3 LOCKE R/W 0 2 PROGE R/W 0 1 LOAD R/W 0 0 PRM R 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 8 – SB Security Bit Status Value Description 0 The Security bit is inactive. 1 The Security bit is active. Bit 4 – NVME NVM Error This bit can be cleared by writing a '1' to its bit location. Value Description 0 No programming or erase errors have been received from the NVM controller since this bit was last cleared. 1 At least one error has been registered from the NVM Controller since this bit was last cleared. Bit 3 – LOCKE Lock Error Status This bit can be cleared by writing a '1' to its bit location. Value Description 0 No programming of any locked lock region has happened since this bit was last cleared. 1 Programming of at least one locked lock region has happened since this bit was last cleared. Bit 2 – PROGE Programming Error Status This bit can be cleared by writing a '1' to its bit location. Value Description 0 No invalid commands or bad keywords were written in the NVM Command register since this bit was last cleared. 1 An invalid command and/or a bad keyword was/were written in the NVM Command register since this bit was last cleared. Bit 1 – LOAD NVM Page Buffer Active Loading This bit indicates that the NVM page buffer has been loaded with one or more words. Immediately after an NVM load has been performed, this flag is set. It remains set until a page write or a page buffer clear (PBCLR) command is given. This bit can be cleared by writing a '1' to its bit location. Bit 0 – PRM Power Reduction Mode This bit indicates the current NVM power reduction state. The NVM block can be set in power reduction mode in two ways: through the command interface or automatically when entering sleep with SLEEPPRM set accordingly. PRM can be cleared in three ways: through AHB access to the NVM block, through the command interface (SPRM and CPRM) or when exiting sleep with SLEEPPRM set accordingly. Value Description 0 NVM is not in power reduction mode. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 276 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller Value 1 Description NVM is in power reduction mode. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 277 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.8.8 Address Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit ADDR 0x1C 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection 31 30 29 28 27 23 22 21 20 19 R/W 0 R/W 0 13 12 26 25 24 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 15 14 18 ADDR[21:16] R/W R/W 0 0 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 ADDR[15:8] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 ADDR[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 21:0 – ADDR[21:0] NVM Address ADDR drives the hardware half-word offset from the start address of the corresponding NVM section when a command is executed using CMDEX. This register is also automatically updated when writing to the page buffer. The effective address for the operation is Start address of the section + 2*ADDR. Example: For erasing the 3rd row in the Flash memory, spanning from 0x00000200 to 0x000002FF, ADDR must be written with the half-word offset address of any half-word within this range, that is any value between 0x100 and 0x17F. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 278 SAM D20 Family NVMCTRL – Nonvolatile Memory Controller 20.8.9 Lock Section Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit LOCK 0x20 0xXXXX – 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 R x R x R x R x 3 2 1 0 R x R x R x R x LOCK[15:8] Access Reset R x R x R x R x Bit 7 6 5 4 LOCK[7:0] Access Reset R x R x R x R x Bits 15:0 – LOCK[15:0] Region Lock Bits To set or clear these bits, the CMD register must be used. Default state after erase will be unlocked (0xFFFF). Default state after reset will be loaded from the NVM User Row. Value Description 0 The corresponding lock region is locked. 1 The corresponding lock region is not locked. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 279 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21. PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.1 Overview The IO Pin Controller (PORT) controls the I/O pins of the device. The I/O pins are organized in a series of groups, collectively referred to as a PORT group. Each PORT group can have up to 32 pins that can be configured and controlled individually or as a group. The number of PORT groups on a device may depend on the package/number of pins. Each pin may either be used for general-purpose I/O under direct application control or be assigned to an embedded device peripheral. When used for general-purpose I/O, each pin can be configured as input or output, with highly configurable driver and pull settings. All I/O pins have true read-modify-write functionality when used for general-purpose I/O; the direction or the output value of one or more pins may be changed (set, reset or toggled) explicitly without unintentionally changing the state of any other pins in the same port group by a single, atomic 8-, 16- or 32-bit write. The PORT is connected to the high-speed bus matrix through an AHB/APB bridge. The Pin Direction, Data Output Value and Data Input Value registers may also be accessed using the low-latency CPU local bus (IOBUS; ARM® single-cycle I/O port) . 21.2 Features • • • • • Selectable input and output configuration for each individual pin Software-controlled multiplexing of peripheral functions on I/O pins Flexible pin configuration through a dedicated Pin Configuration register Configurable output driver and pull settings: – Totem-pole (push-pull) – Pull configuration – Driver strength Configurable input buffer and pull settings: – Internal pull-up or pull-down – Input sampling criteria – Input buffer can be disabled if not needed for lower power consumption © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 280 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.3 Block Diagram Figure 21-1. PORT Block Diagram PORT Peripheral Mux Select Control and Status Port Line Bundles Pad Line Bundles I/O PADS PORTMUX IP Line Bundles PERIPHERALS Digital Controls of Analog Blocks 21.4 Analog Pad Connections ANALOG BLOCKS Signal Description Table 21-1. Signal description for PORT Signal name Type Description Pxy Digital I/O General-purpose I/O pin y in group x Refer to the I/O Multiplexing and Considerations for details on the pin mapping for this peripheral. One signal can be mapped on several pins. Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 21.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly as follows. 21.5.1 I/O Lines The I/O lines of the PORT are mapped to pins of the physical device. The following naming scheme is used: Each line bundle with up to 32 lines is assigned an identifier 'xy', with letter x=A, B, C… and two-digit number y=00, 01, …31. Examples: A24, C03. PORT pins are labeled 'Pxy' accordingly, for example PA24, PC03. This identifies each pin in the device uniquely. Each pin may be controlled by one or more peripheral multiplexer settings, which allow the pad to be routed internally to a dedicated peripheral function. When the setting is enabled, the selected peripheral has control over the output state of the pad, as well as the ability to read the current physical pad state. Refer to I/O Multiplexing and Considerations for details. Device-specific configurations may cause some lines (and the corresponding Pxy pin) not to be implemented. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 281 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 21.5.2 Power Management During Reset, all PORT lines are configured as inputs with input buffers, output buffers and pull disabled. The PORT peripheral will continue operating in any sleep mode where its source clock is running. 21.5.3 Clocks The PORT bus clock (CLK_PORT_APB) can be enabled and disabled in the Power Manager, and the default state of CLK_PORT_APB can be found in the Peripheral Clock Masking section in PM – Power Manager. The PORT requires an APB clock, which may be divided from the CPU main clock and allows the CPU to access the registers of PORT through the high-speed matrix and the AHB/APB bridge. The PORT also requires an AHB clock for CPU IOBUS accesses to the PORT. That AHB clock is the internal PORT clock. The priority of IOBUS accesses is higher than APB accesses. One clock cycle latency can be observed on the APB access in case of concurrent PORT accesses. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 21.5.4 Interrupts Not applicable. 21.5.5 Events The events of this peripheral are connected to the Event System. Related Links 22. Event System (EVSYS) 21.5.6 Debug Operation When the CPU is halted in debug mode, this peripheral will continue normal operation. 21.5.7 Register Access Protection All registers with write-access can be optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC). Note:  Optional write-protection is indicated by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in the register description. Write-protection does not apply for accesses through an external debugger. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller 21.5.8 Analog Connections Analog functions are connected directly between the analog blocks and the I/O pads using analog buses. However, selecting an analog peripheral function for a given pin will disable the corresponding digital features of the pad. 21.5.9 CPU Local Bus The CPU local bus (IOBUS) is an interface that connects the CPU directly to the PORT. It is a single-cycle bus interface, which does not support wait states. It supports 8-bit, 16-bit and 32-bit sizes. This bus is generally used for low latency operation. The Data Direction (DIR) and Data Output Value (OUT) registers can be read, written, set, cleared or be toggled using this bus, and the Data Input Value (IN) registers can be read. Since the IOBUS cannot wait for IN register resynchronization, the Control register (CTRL) must be configured to continuous sampling of all pins that need to be read via the IOBUS in order to prevent stale data from being read. Note:  Refer to the Product Mapping chapter for the IOBUS address. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 282 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller Related Links 21.9.1. DIR 21.9.9. IN 21.9.1. DIR 21.9.10. CTRL 21.6 Functional Description Figure 21-2. Overview of the PORT PORT PULLENx DRIVEx OUTx PAD PULLEN DRIVE Pull Resistor PG OUT PAD APB Bus VDD DIRx INENx INx OE NG INEN IN Q D R Q D R Synchronizer Input to Other Modules 21.6.1 Analog Input/Output Principle of Operation Each PORT group of up to 32 pins is controlled by the registers in PORT, as described in the figure. These registers in PORT are duplicated for each PORT group, with increasing base addresses. The number of PORT groups may depend on the package/number of pins. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 283 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller Figure 21-3. Overview of the peripheral functions multiplexing PORTMUX PORT bit y Port y PINCFG PMUXEN Port y Data+Config Port y PMUX[3:0] Port y Peripheral Mux Enable Port y Line Bundle 0 Port y PMUX Select Pad y PAD y Line Bundle Periph Signal 0 0 Periph Signal 1 1 1 Peripheral Signals to be muxed to Pad y Periph Signal 15 15 The I/O pins of the device are controlled by PORT peripheral registers. Each port pin has a corresponding bit in the Data Direction (DIR) and Data Output Value (OUT) registers to enable that pin as an output and to define the output state. The direction of each pin in a PORT group is configured by the DIR register. If a bit in DIR is set to '1', the corresponding pin is configured as an output pin. If a bit in DIR is set to '0', the corresponding pin is configured as an input pin. When the direction is set as output, the corresponding bit in the OUT register will set the level of the pin. If bit y in OUT is written to '1', pin y is driven HIGH. If bit y in OUT is written to '0', pin y is driven LOW. Pin configuration can be set by Pin Configuration (PINCFGy) registers, with y=00, 01, ..31 representing the bit position. The Data Input Value (IN) is set as the input value of a port pin with resynchronization to the PORT clock. To reduce power consumption, these input synchronizers can be clocked only when system requires reading the input value, as specified in the SAMPLING field of the Control register (CTRL). The value of the pin can always be read, whether the pin is configured as input or output. If the Input Enable bit in the Pin Configuration registers (PINCFGy.INEN) is '0', the input value will not be sampled. In PORT, the Peripheral Multiplexer Enable bit in the PINCFGy register (PINCFGy.PMUXEN) can be written to '1' to enable the connection between peripheral functions and individual I/O pins. The Peripheral Multiplexing n (PMUXn) registers select the peripheral function for the corresponding pin. This will override the connection between the PORT and that I/O pin, and connect the selected peripheral signal to the particular I/O pin instead of the PORT line bundle. Related Links 21.9.1. DIR 21.9.9. IN 21.9.1. DIR 21.9.13. PINCFG 21.9.12. PMUX 21.6.2 Basic Operation 21.6.2.1 Initialization After reset, all standard function device I/O pads are connected to the PORT with outputs tri-stated and input buffers disabled, even if there is no clock running. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 284 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller However, specific pins, such as those used for connection to a debugger, may be configured differently, as required by their special function. 21.6.2.2 Operation Each I/O pin Pxy can be controlled by the registers in PORT. Each PORT group x has its own set of PORT registers, with a base address at byte address (PORT + 0x80 * group index) (A corresponds to group index 0, B to 1, etc...). Within that set of registers, the pin index is y, from 0 to 31. Refer to I/O Multiplexing and Considerations for details on available pin configuration and PORT groups. Configuring Pins as Output To use pin Pxy as an output, write bit y of the DIR register to '1'. This can also be done by writing bit y in the DIRSET register to '1' - this will avoid disturbing the configuration of other pins in that group. The y bit in the OUT register must be written to the desired output value. Similarly, writing an OUTSET bit to '1' will set the corresponding bit in the OUT register to '1'. Writing a bit in OUTCLR to '1' will set that bit in OUT to zero. Writing a bit in OUTTGL to '1' will toggle that bit in OUT. Configuring Pins as Input To use pin Pxy as an input, bit y in the DIR register must be written to '0'. This can also be done by writing bit y in the DIRCLR register to '1' - this will avoid disturbing the configuration of other pins in that group. The input value can be read from bit y in register IN as soon as the INEN bit in the Pin Configuration register (PINCFGy.INEN) is written to '1'. By default, the input synchronizer is clocked only when an input read is requested. This will delay the read operation by two cycles of the PORT clock. To remove the delay, the input synchronizers for each PORT group of eight pins can be configured to be always active, but this will increase power consumption. This is enabled by writing '1' to the corresponding SAMPLINGn bit field of the CTRL register, see CTRL.SAMPLING for details. Using Alternative Peripheral Functions To use pin Pxy as one of the available peripheral functions, the corresponding PMUXEN bit of the PINCFGy register must be '1'. The PINCFGy register for pin Pxy is at byte offset (PINCFG0 + y). The peripheral function can be selected by setting the PMUXO or PMUXE in the PMUXn register. The PMUXO/ PMUXE is at byte offset PMUX0 + (y/2). The chosen peripheral must also be configured and enabled. Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 21.6.3 I/O Pin Configuration The Pin Configuration register (PINCFGy) is used for additional I/O pin configuration. A pin can be set in a totem-pole or pull configuration. As pull configuration is done through the Pin Configuration register, all intermediate PORT states during switching of pin direction and pin values are avoided. The I/O pin configurations are described further in this chapter, and summarized in Table 21-2. 21.6.3.1 Pin Configurations Summary Table 21-2. Pin Configurations Summary DIR INEN PULLEN OUT Configuration 0 0 0 X Reset or analog I/O: all digital disabled 0 0 1 0 Pull-down; input disabled 0 0 1 1 Pull-up; input disabled 0 1 0 X Input 0 1 1 0 Input with pull-down © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 285 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller ...........continued DIR INEN PULLEN OUT Configuration 0 1 1 1 Input with pull-up 1 0 X X Output; input disabled 1 1 X X Output; input enabled 21.6.3.2 Input Configuration Figure 21-4. I/O configuration - Standard Input PULLEN PULLEN INEN DIR 0 1 0 PULLEN INEN DIR 1 1 0 DIR OUT IN INEN Figure 21-5. I/O Configuration - Input with Pull PULLEN DIR OUT IN INEN Note:  When pull is enabled, the pull value is defined by the OUT value. 21.6.3.3 Totem-Pole Output When configured for totem-pole (push-pull) output, the pin is driven low or high according to the corresponding bit setting in the OUT register. In this configuration there is no current limitation for sink or source other than what the pin is capable of. If the pin is configured for input, the pin will float if no external pull is connected. Note:  Enabling the output driver will automatically disable pull. Figure 21-6. I/O Configuration - Totem-Pole Output with Disabled Input PULLEN PULLEN INEN DIR 0 0 1 DIR OUT IN INEN © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 286 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller Figure 21-7. I/O Configuration - Totem-Pole Output with Enabled Input PULLEN PULLEN INEN DIR 0 1 1 PULLEN INEN DIR 1 0 0 DIR OUT IN INEN Figure 21-8. I/O Configuration - Output with Pull PULLEN DIR OUT IN INEN 21.6.3.4 Digital Functionality Disabled Neither Input nor Output functionality are enabled. Figure 21-9. I/O Configuration - Reset or Analog I/O: Digital Output, Input and Pull Disabled PULLEN PULLEN INEN DIR 0 0 0 DIR OUT IN INEN 21.6.4 PORT Access Priority The PORT is accessed by different systems: • • The ARM® CPU through the ARM® single-cycle I/O port (IOBUS) The ARM® CPU through the high-speed matrix and the AHB/APB bridge (APB) The following priority is adopted: 1. 2. ARM® CPU IOBUS (No wait tolerated) APB © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 287 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.7 Register Summary Offset Name 0x00 DIR 0x04 DIRCLR 0x08 DIRSET 0x0C DIRTGL 0x10 OUT 0x14 OUTCLR 0x18 OUTSET 0x1C OUTTGL 0x20 IN 0x24 CTRL 0x28 WRCONFIG 0x2C ... 0x2F 0x30 ... 0x3F 0x40 ... 0x5F Bit Pos. 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 DIR[7:0] DIR[15:8] DIR[23:16] DIR[31:24] DIRCLR[7:0] DIRCLR[15:8] DIRCLR[23:16] DIRCLR[31:24] DIRSET[7:0] DIRSET[15:8] DIRSET[23:16] DIRSET[31:24] DIRTGL[7:0] DIRTGL[15:8] DIRTGL[23:16] DIRTGL[31:24] OUT[7:0] OUT[15:8] OUT[23:16] OUT[31:24] OUTCLR[7:0] OUTCLR[15:8] OUTCLR[23:16] OUTCLR[31:24] OUTSET[7:0] OUTSET[15:8] OUTSET[23:16] OUTSET[31:24] OUTTGL[7:0] OUTTGL[15:8] OUTTGL[23:16] OUTTGL[31:24] IN[7:0] IN[15:8] IN[23:16] IN[31:24] SAMPLING[7:0] SAMPLING[15:8] SAMPLING[23:16] SAMPLING[31:24] PINMASK[7:0] PINMASK[15:8] HWSEL DRVSTR WRPINCFG WRPMUX PULLEN INEN PMUX[3:0] PMUXEN Reserved PMUX0 7:0 PMUXO[3:0] PMUX15 PINCFG0 7:0 7:0 PMUXO[3:0] DRVSTR PMUXE[3:0] PULLEN INEN PMUXEN PINCFG31 7:0 DRVSTR PULLEN INEN PMUXEN © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet PMUXE[3:0] DS60001504F-page 288 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.8 PORT Pin Groups and Register Repetition Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. 21.9 Register Description Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16- and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers are optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC). Optional PAC writeprotection is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. For details, refer to Register Access Protection. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 289 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.9.1 Data Direction Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  DIR 0x00 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to configure one or more I/O pins as an input or output. This register can be manipulated without doing a read-modify-write operation by using the Data Direction Toggle (DIRTGL), Data Direction Clear (DIRCLR) and Data Direction Set (DIRSET) registers. Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 19 18 17 16 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 11 10 9 8 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 3 2 1 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 DIR[31:24] Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 23 22 21 20 DIR[23:16] Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 DIR[15:8] Access Reset Bit RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 7 6 5 4 DIR[7:0] Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bits 31:0 – DIR[31:0] Port Data Direction These bits set the data direction for the individual I/O pins in the PORT group. Value Description 0 The corresponding I/O pin in the PORT group is configured as an input. 1 The corresponding I/O pin in the PORT group is configured as an output. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 290 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.9.2 Data Direction Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  DIRCLR 0x04 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to set one or more I/O pins as an input, without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Data Direction (DIR), Data Direction Toggle (DIRTGL) and Data Direction Set (DIRSET) registers. Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. Bit 31 30 29 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 23 22 21 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 15 14 13 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 7 6 5 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit Access Reset 28 27 DIRCLR[31:24] RW RW 0 0 20 19 DIRCLR[23:16] RW RW 0 0 12 11 DIRCLR[15:8] RW RW 0 0 4 3 DIRCLR[7:0] RW RW 0 0 26 25 24 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 18 17 16 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 10 9 8 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 2 1 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bits 31:0 – DIRCLR[31:0] Port Data Direction Clear Writing a '0' to a bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to a bit will clear the corresponding bit in the DIR register, which configures the I/O pin as an input. Value Description 0 The corresponding I/O pin in the PORT group will keep its configuration. 1 The corresponding I/O pin in the PORT group is configured as input. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 291 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.9.3 Data Direction Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  DIRSET 0x08 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to set one or more I/O pins as an output, without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Data Direction (DIR), Data Direction Toggle (DIRTGL) and Data Direction Clear (DIRCLR) registers. Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. Bit 31 30 29 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 23 22 21 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 Bit 15 Access Reset Bit 28 27 DIRSET[31:24] RW RW 0 0 26 25 24 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 18 17 16 RW 0 20 19 DIRSET[23:16] RW RW 0 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 14 13 12 10 9 8 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 7 6 5 3 2 1 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 11 DIRSET[15:8] RW RW 0 0 4 DIRSET[7:0] Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bits 31:0 – DIRSET[31:0] Port Data Direction Set Writing '0' to a bit has no effect. Writing '1' to a bit will set the corresponding bit in the DIR register, which configures the I/O pin as an output. Value Description 0 The corresponding I/O pin in the PORT group will keep its configuration. 1 The corresponding I/O pin in the PORT group is configured as an output. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 292 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.9.4 Data Direction Toggle Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  DIRTGL 0x0C 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to toggle the direction of one or more I/O pins, without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Data Direction (DIR), Data Direction Set (DIRSET) and Data Direction Clear (DIRCLR) registers. Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. Bit 31 30 29 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 23 22 21 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 Bit 15 Access Reset Bit 28 27 DIRTGL[31:24] RW RW 0 0 26 25 24 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 18 17 16 RW 0 20 19 DIRTGL[23:16] RW RW 0 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 14 13 12 10 9 8 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 7 6 5 3 2 1 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 11 DIRTGL[15:8] RW RW 0 0 4 DIRTGL[7:0] Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bits 31:0 – DIRTGL[31:0] Port Data Direction Toggle Writing '0' to a bit has no effect. Writing '1' to a bit will toggle the corresponding bit in the DIR register, which reverses the direction of the I/O pin. Value Description 0 The corresponding I/O pin in the PORT group will keep its configuration. 1 The direction of the corresponding I/O pin is toggled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 293 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.9.5 Data Output Value Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  OUT 0x10 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection This register sets the data output drive value for the individual I/O pins in the PORT. This register can be manipulated without doing a read-modify-write operation by using the Data Output Value Clear (OUTCLR), Data Output Value Set (OUTSET), and Data Output Value Toggle (OUTTGL) registers. Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 19 18 17 16 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 11 10 9 8 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 3 2 1 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 OUT[31:24] Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 23 22 21 20 OUT[23:16] Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 OUT[15:8] Access Reset Bit RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 7 6 5 4 OUT[7:0] Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bits 31:0 – OUT[31:0] PORT Data Output Value For pins configured as outputs via the Data Direction register (DIR), these bits set the logical output drive level. For pins configured as inputs via the Data Direction register (DIR) and with pull enabled via the Pull Enable bit in the Pin Configuration register (PINCFG.PULLEN), these bits will set the input pull direction. Value Description 0 The I/O pin output is driven low, or the input is connected to an internal pull-down. 1 The I/O pin output is driven high, or the input is connected to an internal pull-up. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 294 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.9.6 Data Output Value Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  OUTCLR 0x14 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to set one or more output I/O pin drive levels low, without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Data Output Value (OUT), Data Output Value Toggle (OUTTGL) and Data Output Value Set (OUTSET) registers. Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. Bit 31 30 29 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 23 22 21 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 15 14 13 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 7 6 5 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit Access Reset 28 27 OUTCLR[31:24] RW RW 0 0 20 19 OUTCLR[23:16] RW RW 0 0 12 11 OUTCLR[15:8] RW RW 0 0 4 3 OUTCLR[7:0] RW RW 0 0 26 25 24 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 18 17 16 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 10 9 8 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 2 1 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bits 31:0 – OUTCLR[31:0] PORT Data Output Value Clear Writing '0' to a bit has no effect. Writing '1' to a bit will clear the corresponding bit in the OUT register. Pins configured as outputs via the Data Direction register (DIR) will be set to low output drive level. Pins configured as inputs via DIR and with pull enabled via the Pull Enable bit in the Pin Configuration register (PINCFG.PULLEN) will set the input pull direction to an internal pull-down. Value Description 0 The corresponding I/O pin in the PORT group will keep its configuration. 1 The corresponding I/O pin output is driven low, or the input is connected to an internal pull-down. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 295 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.9.7 Data Output Value Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  OUTSET 0x18 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to set one or more output I/O pin drive levels high, without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Data Output Value (OUT), Data Output Value Toggle (OUTTGL) and Data Output Value Clear (OUTCLR) registers. Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. Bit 31 30 29 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 23 22 21 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 15 14 13 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 7 6 5 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit Access Reset 28 27 OUTSET[31:24] RW RW 0 0 20 19 OUTSET[23:16] RW RW 0 0 12 11 OUTSET[15:8] RW RW 0 0 4 3 OUTSET[7:0] RW RW 0 0 26 25 24 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 18 17 16 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 10 9 8 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 2 1 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bits 31:0 – OUTSET[31:0] PORT Data Output Value Set Writing '0' to a bit has no effect. Writing '1' to a bit will set the corresponding bit in the OUT register, which sets the output drive level high for I/O pins configured as outputs via the Data Direction register (DIR). For pins configured as inputs via Data Direction register (DIR) with pull enabled via the Pull Enable register (PULLEN), these bits will set the input pull direction to an internal pull-up. Value Description 0 The corresponding I/O pin in the group will keep its configuration. 1 The corresponding I/O pin output is driven high, or the input is connected to an internal pull-up. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 296 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.9.8 Data Output Value Toggle Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  OUTTGL 0x1C 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to toggle the drive level of one or more output I/O pins, without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Data Output Value (OUT), Data Output Value Set (OUTSET) and Data Output Value Clear (OUTCLR) registers. Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. Bit 31 30 29 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 23 22 21 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 15 14 13 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 7 6 5 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit Access Reset 28 27 OUTTGL[31:24] RW RW 0 0 20 19 OUTTGL[23:16] RW RW 0 0 12 11 OUTTGL[15:8] RW RW 0 0 4 3 OUTTGL[7:0] RW RW 0 0 26 25 24 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 18 17 16 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 10 9 8 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 2 1 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bits 31:0 – OUTTGL[31:0] PORT Data Output Value Toggle Writing '0' to a bit has no effect. Writing '1' to a bit will toggle the corresponding bit in the OUT register, which inverts the output drive level for I/O pins configured as outputs via the Data Direction register (DIR). For pins configured as inputs via Data Direction register (DIR) with pull enabled via the Pull Enable register (PULLEN), these bits will toggle the input pull direction. Value Description 0 The corresponding I/O pin in the PORT group will keep its configuration. 1 The corresponding OUT bit value is toggled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 297 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.9.9 Data Input Value Name:  Offset:  Reset:  IN 0x20 0x40000000 Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. Bit 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 19 18 17 16 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 11 10 9 8 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 3 2 1 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 IN[31:24] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bit 23 22 21 20 IN[23:16] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 IN[15:8] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 IN[7:0] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bits 31:0 – IN[31:0] PORT Data Input Value These bits are cleared when the corresponding I/O pin input sampler detects a logical low level on the input pin. These bits are set when the corresponding I/O pin input sampler detects a logical high level on the input pin. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 298 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.9.10 Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  CTRL 0x24 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. Bit 31 30 29 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 23 22 21 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit 15 14 13 Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 7 6 5 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bit Access Reset 28 27 SAMPLING[31:24] RW RW 0 0 20 19 SAMPLING[23:16] RW RW 0 0 12 11 SAMPLING[15:8] RW RW 0 0 4 3 SAMPLING[7:0] RW RW 0 0 26 25 24 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 18 17 16 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 10 9 8 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 2 1 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bits 31:0 – SAMPLING[31:0] Input Sampling Mode Configures the input sampling functionality of the I/O pin input samplers, for pins configured as inputs via the Data Direction register (DIR). The input samplers are enabled and disabled in sub-groups of eight. Thus if any pins within a byte request continuous sampling, all pins in that eight pin sub-group will be continuously sampled. Value Description 0 On demand sampling of I/O pin is enabled. 1 Continuous sampling of I/O pin is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 299 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.9.11 Write Configuration Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  WRCONFIG 0x28 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. This write-only register is used to configure several pins simultaneously with the same configuration and/or peripheral multiplexing. In order to avoid side effect of non-atomic access, 8-bit or 16-bit writes to this register will have no effect. Reading this register always returns zero. Bit 31 HWSEL W 0 30 WRPINCFG W 0 29 28 WRPMUX W 0 27 W 0 23 22 DRVSTR W 0 21 20 19 Bit 15 14 13 Access Reset W 0 W 0 Bit 7 Access Reset W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset 26 25 24 W 0 W 0 W 0 18 PULLEN W 0 17 INEN W 0 16 PMUXEN W 0 10 9 8 W 0 12 11 PINMASK[15:8] W W 0 0 W 0 W 0 W 0 6 5 4 2 1 0 W 0 W 0 W 0 W 0 W 0 PMUX[3:0] 3 PINMASK[7:0] W W 0 0 Bit 31 – HWSEL Half-Word Select This bit selects the half-word field of a 32-PORT group to be reconfigured in the atomic write operation. This bit will always read as zero. Value Description 0 The lower 16 pins of the PORT group will be configured. 1 The upper 16 pins of the PORT group will be configured. Bit 30 – WRPINCFG Write PINCFG This bit determines whether the atomic write operation will update the Pin Configuration register (PINCFGy) or not for all pins selected by the WRCONFIG.PINMASK and WRCONFIG.HWSEL bits. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit updates the configuration of the selected pins with the written WRCONFIG.DRVSTR, WRCONFIG.PULLEN, WRCONFIG.INEN, WRCONFIG.PMUXEN, and WRCONFIG.PINMASK values. This bit will always read as zero. Value Description 0 The PINCFGy registers of the selected pins will not be updated. 1 The PINCFGy registers of the selected pins will be updated. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 300 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller Bit 28 – WRPMUX Write PMUX This bit determines whether the atomic write operation will update the Peripheral Multiplexing register (PMUXn) or not for all pins selected by the WRCONFIG.PINMASK and WRCONFIG.HWSEL bits. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit updates the pin multiplexer configuration of the selected pins with the written WRCONFIG. PMUX value. This bit will always read as zero. Value Description 0 The PMUXn registers of the selected pins will not be updated. 1 The PMUXn registers of the selected pins will be updated. Bits 27:24 – PMUX[3:0] Peripheral Multiplexing These bits determine the new value written to the Peripheral Multiplexing register (PMUXn) for all pins selected by the WRCONFIG.PINMASK and WRCONFIG.HWSEL bits, when the WRCONFIG.WRPMUX bit is set. These bits will always read as zero. Bit 22 – DRVSTR Output Driver Strength Selection This bit determines the new value written to PINCFGy.DRVSTR for all pins selected by the WRCONFIG.PINMASK and WRCONFIG.HWSEL bits, when the WRCONFIG.WRPINCFG bit is set. This bit will always read as zero. Bit 18 – PULLEN Pull Enable This bit determines the new value written to PINCFGy.PULLEN for all pins selected by the WRCONFIG.PINMASK and WRCONFIG.HWSEL bits, when the WRCONFIG.WRPINCFG bit is set. This bit will always read as zero. Bit 17 – INEN Input Enable This bit determines the new value written to PINCFGy.INEN for all pins selected by the WRCONFIG.PINMASK and WRCONFIG.HWSEL bits, when the WRCONFIG.WRPINCFG bit is set. This bit will always read as zero. Bit 16 – PMUXEN Peripheral Multiplexer Enable This bit determines the new value written to PINCFGy.PMUXEN for all pins selected by the WRCONFIG.PINMASK and WRCONFIG.HWSEL bits, when the WRCONFIG.WRPINCFG bit is set. This bit will always read as zero. Bits 15:0 – PINMASK[15:0] Pin Mask for Multiple Pin Configuration These bits select the pins to be configured within the half-word group selected by the WRCONFIG.HWSEL bit. These bits will always read as zero. Value Description 0 The configuration of the corresponding I/O pin in the half-word group will be left unchanged. 1 The configuration of the corresponding I/O pin in the half-word PORT group will be updated. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 301 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.9.12 Peripheral Multiplexing n Name:  Offset:  Property:  PMUX 0x30 + n*0x01 [n=0..15] PAC Write-Protection Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. There are up to 16 Peripheral Multiplexing registers in each group, one for every set of two subsequent I/O lines. The ‘n’ denotes the number of the set of I/O lines. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 PMUXO[3:0] Access Reset RW 0 RW 0 1 0 RW 0 RW 0 PMUXE[3:0] RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 RW 0 Bits 7:4 – PMUXO[3:0] Peripheral Multiplexing for Odd-Numbered Pin These bits select the peripheral function for odd-numbered pins (2*n + 1) of a PORT group, if the corresponding PINCFGy.PMUXEN bit is '1'. Not all possible values for this selection may be valid. For more details, refer to the I/O Multiplexing and Considerations. PMUXO[3:0] Name 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 0x9 - 0xF A B C D E F G H I - Description Peripheral function A selected Peripheral function B selected Peripheral function C selected Peripheral function D selected Peripheral function E selected Peripheral function F selected Peripheral function G selected Peripheral function H selected Peripheral function I selected Reserved Bits 3:0 – PMUXE[3:0] Peripheral Multiplexing for Even-Numbered Pin These bits select the peripheral function for even-numbered pins (2*n) of a PORT group, if the corresponding PINCFGy.PMUXEN bit is '1'. Not all possible values for this selection may be valid. For more details, refer to the I/O Multiplexing and Considerations. PMUXE[3:0] Name 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 0x9 - 0xF A B C D E F G H I - © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Description Peripheral function A selected Peripheral function B selected Peripheral function C selected Peripheral function D selected Peripheral function E selected Peripheral function F selected Peripheral function G selected Peripheral function H selected Peripheral function I selected Reserved Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 302 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 303 SAM D20 Family PORT - I/O Pin Controller 21.9.13 Pin Configuration Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  PINCFG 0x40 + n*0x01 [n=0..31] 0x00 PAC Write-Protection Tip:  The I/O pins are assembled in pin groups (”PORT groups”) with up to 32 pins. Group 0 consists of the PA pins, group 1 is for the PB pins, etc. Each pin group has its own PORT registers, with a 0x80 address spacing. For example, the register address offset for the Data Direction (DIR) register for group 0 (PA00 to PA31) is 0x00, and the register address offset for the DIR register for group 1 (PB00 to PB31) is 0x80. There are up to 32 Pin Configuration registers in each PORT group, one for each I/O line. Bit 7 Access Reset 6 DRVSTR RW 0 5 4 3 2 PULLEN RW 0 1 INEN RW 0 0 PMUXEN RW 0 Bit 6 – DRVSTR Output Driver Strength Selection This bit controls the output driver strength of an I/O pin configured as an output. Value Description 0 Pin drive strength is set to normal drive strength. 1 Pin drive strength is set to stronger drive strength. Bit 2 – PULLEN Pull Enable This bit enables the internal pull-up or pull-down resistor of an I/O pin configured as an input. Value Description 0 Internal pull resistor is disabled, and the input is in a high-impedance configuration. 1 Internal pull resistor is enabled, and the input is driven to a defined logic level in the absence of external input. Bit 1 – INEN Input Enable This bit controls the input buffer of an I/O pin configured as either an input or output. Writing a zero to this bit disables the input buffer completely, preventing read-back of the physical pin state when the pin is configured as either an input or output. Value Description 0 Input buffer for the I/O pin is disabled, and the input value will not be sampled. 1 Input buffer for the I/O pin is enabled, and the input value will be sampled when required. Bit 0 – PMUXEN Peripheral Multiplexer Enable This bit enables or disables the peripheral multiplexer selection set in the Peripheral Multiplexing register (PMUXn) to enable or disable alternative peripheral control over an I/O pin direction and output drive value. Writing a zero to this bit allows the PORT to control the pad direction via the Data Direction register (DIR) and output drive value via the Data Output Value register (OUT). The peripheral multiplexer value in PMUXn is ignored. Writing '1' to this bit enables the peripheral selection in PMUXn to control the pad. In this configuration, the physical pin state may still be read from the Data Input Value register (IN) if PINCFGn.INEN is set. Value Description 0 The peripheral multiplexer selection is disabled, and the PORT registers control the direction and output drive value. 1 The peripheral multiplexer selection is enabled, and the selected peripheral function controls the direction and output drive value. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 304 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) 22. 22.1 Event System (EVSYS) Overview The Event System (EVSYS) allows autonomous, low-latency and configurable communication between peripherals. Several peripherals can be configured to generate and/or respond to signals known as events. The exact condition to generate an event, or the action taken upon receiving an event, is specific to each peripheral. Peripherals that respond to events are called event users. Peripherals that generate events are called event generators. A peripheral can have one or more event generators and can have one or more event users. Communication is made without CPU intervention and without consuming system resources such as bus or RAM bandwidth. This reduces the load on the CPU and other system resources, compared to a traditional interrupt-based system. 22.2 Features • • • • • • • • • 22.3 8 configurable event channels: – Can be connected to any event generator – Can provide a pure asynchronous, resynchronized, or synchronous path 59 Event Generators 14 Event Users Configurable Edge Detector Peripherals can be Event Generators, Event Users, or both SleepWalking and interrupt for operation in sleep modes Software Event Generation Each Event User can choose which channel to respond to Each Event User can choose which channel to respond to, and several Event Users can share the same channel and therefore answer to the same event Block Diagram Figure 22-1. Event System Block Diagram EVSYS PERIPHERALS GENERATOR EVENTS EVENT CHANNELS USER MUX PERIPHERALS USERS EVENTS CLOCK REQUESTS GCLK © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 305 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) 22.4 Signal Description Not applicable. 22.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. 22.5.1 I/O Lines Not applicable. 22.5.2 Power Management The EVSYS can be used to wake up the CPU from all sleep modes, even if the clock used by the EVSYS channel and the EVSYS bus clock are disabled. Refer to the PM – Power Manager for details on the different sleep modes. In all sleep modes, although the clock for the EVSYS is stopped, the device still can wake up the EVSYS clock. Some event generators can generate an event when their clocks are stopped. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 22.5.3 Clocks The EVSYS bus clock (CLK_EVSYS_APB) can be enabled and disabled in the Main Clock module, and the default state of CLK_EVSYS_APB can be found in Peripheral Clock Masking. Each EVSYS channel has a dedicated generic clock (GCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_n). These are used for event detection and propagation for each channel. These clocks must be configured and enabled in the generic clock controller before using the EVSYS. Refer to GCLK - Generic Clock Controller for details. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 22.5.4 Interrupts The interrupt request line is connected to the Interrupt Controller. Using the EVSYS interrupts requires the interrupt controller to be configured first. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 22.5.5 Events Not applicable. 22.5.6 Debug Operation When the CPU is halted in debug mode, this peripheral will continue normal operation. If the peripheral is configured to require periodical service by the CPU through interrupts or similar, improper operation or data loss may result during debugging. This peripheral can be forced to halt operation during debugging. 22.5.7 Register Access Protection Registers with write-access can be optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC), except for the following: • Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG) Note:  Optional write-protection is indicated by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in the register description. Write-protection does not apply for accesses through an external debugger. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 306 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) 22.5.8 Analog Connections Not applicable. 22.6 Functional Description 22.6.1 Principle of Operation The Event System consists of several channels which route the internal events from peripherals (generators) to other internal peripherals or IO pins (users). Each event generator can be selected as source for multiple channels, but a channel cannot be set to use multiple event generators at the same time. 22.6.2 Basic Operation 22.6.2.1 Initialization Before enabling events routing within the system, the User Multiplexer (USER) and Channel (CHANNEL) register must be configured. The User Multiplexer (USER) must be configured first. Configure the User Multiplexer (USER) register: 1. The channel to be connected to a user is written to the Channel bit group (USER.CHANNEL) 2. The user to connect the channel is written to the User bit group (USER.USER) Configure the Channel (CHANNEL) register: 1. The channel to be configured is written to the Channel Selection bit group (CHANNEL.CHANNEL) 2. The path to be used is written to the Path Selection bit group (CHANNEL.PATH) 3. The type of edge detection to use on the channel is written to the Edge Selection bit group (CHANNEL.EDGSEL) 4. The event generator to be used is written to the Event Generator bit group (CHANNEL.EVGEN) 22.6.2.2 Enabling, Disabling and Resetting The EVSYS is always enabled. The EVSYS is reset by writing a ‘1’ to the Software Reset bit in the Control register (CTRL.SWRST). All registers in the EVSYS will be reset to their initial state and all ongoing events will be canceled. Refer to CTRL.SWRST register for details. 22.6.2.3 User Multiplexer Setup The user multiplexer defines the channel to be connected to which event user. Each user multiplexer is dedicated to one event user. A user multiplexer receives all event channels output and must be configured to select one of these channels, as shown in the next figure. The channel is selected with the Channel bit group in the USER register (USER.CHANNEL). The user multiplexer must always be configured before the channel. A full list of selectable users can be found in the User Multiplexer register (USER) description. Refer to UserList for details. To configure a user multiplexer, the USER register must be written in a single 16-bit write. It is possible to read out the configuration of a user by first selecting the user by writing to USER.USER using an 8-bit write and then performing a read of the 16-bit USER register. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 307 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) Figure 22-2. User MUX CHANNEL_EVT_0 CHANNEL_EVT_1 CHANNEL_EVT_m USER MUX USER.CHANNEL USER_EVT_x USER_EVT_y PERIPHERAL A USER_EVT_z PERIPHERAL B 22.6.2.4 Channel Setup An event channel can select one event from a list of event generators. Depending on configuration, the selected event could be synchronized, resynchronized or asynchronously sent to the users. When synchronization or resynchronization is required, the channel includes an internal edge detector, allowing the Event System to generate internal events when rising, falling or both edges are detected on the selected event generator. An event channel is able to generate internal events for the specific software commands. All these configurations are available in the Channel register (CHANNEL). To configure a channel, the Channel register must be written in a single 32-bit write. It is possible to read out the configuration of a channel by first selecting the channel by writing to CHANNEL.CHANNEL using a, 8-bit write, and then performing a read of the CHANNEL register. 22.6.2.5 Channel Path There are three different ways to propagate the event provided by an event generator: • • • Asynchronous path Synchronous path Resynchronized path © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 308 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) Figure 22-3. Channel The path is selected by writing to the Path Selection bit group in the Channel register (CHANNEL.PATH). 22.6.2.5.1 Asynchronous Path When using the asynchronous path, the events are propagated from the event generator to the event user without intervention from the Event System. The GCLK for this channel (GCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_n) is not mandatory, meaning that an event will be propagated to the user without any clock latency. When the asynchronous path is selected, the channel cannot generate any interrupts, and the Channel Status register (CHSTATUS) is always zero. No edge detection is available; this must be handled in the event user. When the event generator and the event user share the same generic clock, using the asynchronous path will propagate the event with the least amount of latency. 22.6.2.5.2 Synchronous Path The synchronous path should be used when the event generator and the event channel share the same generator for the generic clock and also if event user supports synchronous path. If event user doesn't support synchronous path, asynchronous path has to be selected. If they do not share the same clock, a logic change from the event generator to the event channel might not be detected in the channel, which means that the event will not be propagated to the event user. For details on generic clock generators, refer to GCLK - Generic Clock Controller. When using the synchronous path, the channel is able to generate interrupts. The channel status bits in the Channel Status register (CHSTATUS) are also updated and available for use. If the Generic Clocks Request bit in the Control register (CTRL.GCLKREQ) is zero, the channel operates in SleepWalking mode and request the configured generic clock only when an event is to be propagated through the channel. If CTRL.GCLKREQ is one, the generic clock will always be on for the configured channel. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 22.6.2.5.3 Resynchronized Path The resynchronized path should be used when the event generator and the event channel do not share the same generic clock generator. When the resynchronized path is used, resynchronization of the event from the event generator is done in the channel. For details on generic clock generators, refer to GCLK - Generic Clock Controller. When the resynchronized path is used, the channel is able to generate interrupts. The channel status bits in the Channel Status register (CHSTATUS) are also updated and available for use. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 309 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) If the Generic Clocks Request bit in the Control register is zero (CTRL.GCLKREQ=0), the channel operates in SleepWalking mode and requests the configured generic clock only when an event is to be propagated through the channel. If CTRL.GCLKREQ=1 , the generic clock will always be on for the configured channel. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 22.6.2.6 Edge Detection When synchronous or resynchronized paths are used, edge detection must be used. The event system can perform edge detection in three different ways: • • • Generate an event only on the rising edge Generate an event only on the falling edge Generate an event on rising and falling edges Edge detection is selected by writing to the Edge Selection bit group in the Channel register (CHANNEL.EDGSEL). If the generator event is a pulse, both edges cannot be selected. Use the rising edge or falling edge detection methods, depending on the generator event default level. 22.6.2.7 Event Generators Each event channel can receive the events form all event generators. All event generators are listed in the statement of CHANNEL.EVGEN. For details on event generation, refer to the corresponding module chapter. The channel event generator is selected by the Event Generator bit group in the Channel register (CHANNEL.EVGEN). By default, the channels are not connected to any event generators (ie, CHANNEL.EVGEN = 0) 22.6.2.8 Channel Status The Channel Status register (CHSTATUS) shows the status of the channels when using a synchronous or resynchronized path. There are two different status bits in CHSTATUS for each of the available channels: • The CHSTATUS.CHBUSYn bit will be set when an event on the corresponding channel n has not been handled by all event users connected to that channel. • The CHSTATUS.USRRDYn bit will be set when all event users connected to the corresponding channel are ready to handle incoming events on that channel. 22.6.2.9 Software Event A software event can be initiated on a channel by setting the Software Event bit in the Channel register (CHANNEL.SWEVT) to ‘1’ at the same time as writing the Channel bits (CHANNEL.CHANNEL). This will generate a software event on the selected channel. The software event can be used for application debugging, and functions like any event generator. To use the software event, the event path must be configured to either a synchronous path or resynchronized path (CHANNEL.PATH = 0x0 or 0x1), edge detection must be configured to rising-edge detection (CHANNEL.EDGSEL= 0x1) and the Generic Clock Request bit must be set to '1' (CTRL.GCLKREQ=0x1). 22.6.3 Interrupts The EVSYS has the following interrupt sources: • • Overrun Channel n (OVRn): for details, refer to The Overrun Channel n Interrupt section. Event Detected Channel n (EVDn): for details, refer to The Event Detected Channel n Interrupt section. These interrupts events are asynchronous wake-up sources. See Sleep Mode Controller. Each interrupt source has an interrupt flag which is in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear (INTFLAG) register. The flag is set when the interrupt is issued. Each interrupt event can be individually enabled by setting a ‘1’ to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Set (INTENSET) register, and disabled by setting a ‘1’ to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Clear (INTENCLR) register. An interrupt event is generated when the interrupt flag is set and the corresponding interrupt is enabled. The interrupt event works until the interrupt flag is cleared, the interrupt is disabled, or the Event System is reset. See INTFLAG for details on how to clear interrupt flags. All interrupt events from the peripheral are ORed together on system level to generate one combined interrupt request to the NVIC. Refer to the Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. The event user must read the INTFLAG register to determine what the interrupt condition is. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 310 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) Note that interrupts must be globally enabled for interrupt requests to be generated. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 15.6.1.3. Sleep Mode Controller 22.6.3.1 The Overrun Channel n Interrupt The Overrun Channel n interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (CHINTFLAGn.OVR) will be set, and the optional interrupt will be generated in the following cases: • • One or more event users on channel n is not ready when there is a new event. An event occurs when the previous event on channel m has not been handled by all event users connected to that channel. The flag will only be set when using resynchronized paths. In the case of asynchronous path, the CHINTFLAGn.OVR is always read as zero. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 22.6.3.2 The Event Detected Channel n Interrupt The Event Detected Channel n interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (CHINTFLAGn.EVD) is set when an event coming from the event generator configured on channel n is detected. The flag will only be set when using a resynchronized path. In the case of asynchronous path, the CHINTFLAGn.EVD is always zero. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 22.6.4 Sleep Mode Operation The EVSYS can generate interrupts to wake up the device from any sleep mode. Some event generators can generate an event when the system clock is stopped. The generic clock (GCLK_EVSYS_CHANNELx) for this channel will be restarted if the channel uses a synchronized path or a resynchronized path, without waking the system from sleep. The clock remains active only as long as necessary to handle the event. After the event has been handled, the clock will be turned off and the system will remain in the original sleep mode. This is known as SleepWalking. When an asynchronous path is used, there is no need for the clock to be activated for the event to be propagated to the user. On a software reset, all registers are set to their reset values and any ongoing events are canceled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 311 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) 22.7 Register Summary Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x00 0x01 ... 0x03 CTRL 7:0 0x04 CHANNEL USER 0x0A ... 0x0B Reserved 0x10 0x14 0x18 22.8 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 GCLKREQ SWRST Reserved 0x08 0x0C 7 CHSTATUS INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 CHANNEL[7:0] SWEVT EVGEN[7:0] EDGSEL[1:0] PATH[1:0] USER[7:0] CHANNEL[7:0] USRRDYn CHBUSYn USRRDYn CHBUSYn USRRDYn CHBUSYn USRRDYn CHBUSYn USRRDYn CHBUSYn USRRDYn CHBUSYn USRRDYn CHBUSYn USRRDYn CHBUSYn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn OVRn EVDn Register Description Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16-, and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the module is disabled. Enableprotection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in each individual register description. Refer to 22.5.7. Register Access Protection. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 312 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) 22.8.1 Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRL 0x00 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 Access Reset 5 4 GCLKREQ R/W 0 3 2 1 0 SWRST W 0 Bit 4 – GCLKREQ Generic Clock Requests This bit is used to determine whether the generic clocks used for the different channels should be on all the time or only when an event needs the generic clock. Events propagated through asynchronous paths will not need a generic clock. Value Description 0 Generic clock is requested and turned on only if an event is detected. 1 Generic clock for a channel is always on. Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit resets all registers in the EVSYS to their initial state. Writing a one to CTRL.SWRST will always take precedence, meaning that all other writes in the same write-operation will be discarded. Note:  Before applying a Software Reset it is recommended to disable the event generators. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 313 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) 22.8.2 Channel Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CHANNEL 0x04 0x00000000 Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 Access Reset Bit Access Reset 23 22 21 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 7 6 5 4 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit 27 26 EDGSEL[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 20 19 EVGEN[7:0] R/W R/W 0 0 11 25 R/W 0 R/W 0 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 10 9 8 SWEVT R/W 0 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset 3 CHANNEL[7:0] R/W R/W 0 0 24 PATH[1:0] Bits 27:26 – EDGSEL[1:0] Edge Detection Selection These bits set the type of edge detection to be used on the channel. These bits must be written to zero when using the asynchronous path. EDGSEL[1:0] Name 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 Description NO_EVT_OUTPUT No event output when using the resynchronized or synchronous path RISING_EDGE Event detection only on the rising edge of the signal from the event generator when using the resynchronized or synchronous path FALLING_EDGE Event detection only on the falling edge of the signal from the event generator when using the resynchronized or synchronous path BOTH_EDGES Event detection on rising and falling edges of the signal from the event generator when using the resynchronized or synchronous path Bits 25:24 – PATH[1:0] Path Selection These bits are used to choose the path to be used by the selected channel. The path choice can be limited by the channel source. PATH[1:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 SYNCHRONOUS RESYNCHRONIZED ASYNCHRONOUS - Synchronous path Resynchronized path Asynchronous path Reserved Bits 23:16 – EVGEN[7:0] Event Generator Selection These bits are used to choose which event generator to connect to the selected channel. Value Event Generator Description 0x00 0x01 NONE RTC CMP0 No event generator selected Compare 0 (mode 0 and 1) or Alarm 0 (mode 2) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 314 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) ...........continued Value Event Generator Description 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x08 0x09 0x0A 0x0B 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E 0x0F 0x10 0x11 0x12 0x13 0x14 0x15 0x16 0x17 0x18 0x19 0x1A 0x1B 0x1C 0x1D 0x1E 0x1F 0x20 0x21 0x22 0x23 0x24 0x25 0x26 0x27 0x28 0x29 0x2A 0x2B 0x2C 0x2D 0x2E 0x2F 0x30 0x31 0x32 0x33 0x34 0x35 0x36 RTC CMP1 RTC OVF RTC PER0 RTC PER1 RTC PER2 RTC PER3 RTC PER4 RTC PER5 RTC PER6 RTC PER7 EIC EXTINT0 EIC EXTINT1 EIC EXTINT2 EIC EXTINT3 EIC EXTINT4 EIC EXTINT5 EIC EXTINT6 EIC EXTINT7 EIC EXTINT8 EIC EXTINT9 EIC EXTINT10 EIC EXTINT11 EIC EXTINT12 EIC EXTINT13 EIC EXTINT14 EIC EXTINT15 TC0 OVF TC0 MC0 TC0 MC1 TC1 OVF TC1 MC0 TC1 MC1 TC2 OVF TC2 MC0 TC2 MC1 TC3 OVF TC3 MC0 TC3 MC1 TC4 OVF TC4 MC0 TC4 MC1 TC5 OVF TC5 MC0 TC5 MC1 TC6 OVF TC6 MC0 TC6 MC1 TC7 OVF TC7 MC0 TC7 MC1 ADC RESRDY ADC WINMON AC COMP0 Compare 1 Overflow Period 0 Period 1 Period 2 Period 3 Period 4 Period 5 Period 6 Period 7 External Interrupt 0 External Interrupt 1 External Interrupt 2 External Interrupt 3 External Interrupt 4 External Interrupt 5 External Interrupt 6 External Interrupt 7 External Interrupt 8 External Interrupt 9 External Interrupt 10 External Interrupt 11 External Interrupt 12 External Interrupt 13 External Interrupt 14 External Interrupt 15 Overflow/Underflow Match/Capture 0 Match/Capture 1 Overflow/Underflow Match/Capture 0 Match/Capture 1 Overflow/Underflow Match/Capture 0 Match/Capture 1 Overflow/Underflow Match/Capture 0 Match/Capture 1 Overflow/Underflow Match/Capture 0 Match/Capture 1 Overflow/Underflow Match/Capture 0 Match/Capture 1 Overflow/Underflow Match/Capture 0 Match/Capture 1 Overflow/Underflow Match/Capture 0 Match/Capture 1 Result Ready Window Monitor Comparator 0 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 315 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) ...........continued Value Event Generator Description 0x37 0x38 0x39 0x3A 0x3B 0x3C-0x7F AC COMP1 AC WIN0 DAC EMPTY PTC EOC PTC WCOMP Reserved Comparator 1 Window 0 Data Buffer Empty End of Conversion Window Comparator - Bit 8 – SWEVT Software Event This bit is used to insert a software event on the channel selected by the CHANNEL.CHANNEL bit group. This bit has the same behavior similar to an event. This bit must be written together with CHANNEL.CHANNEL using a 16-bit write. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will trigger a software event for the corresponding channel. This bit will always return zero when read. Bits 7:0 – CHANNEL[7:0] Channel Selection These bits are used to select the channel to be set up or read from. Value Channel number 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x08-0xFF 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Reserved © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 316 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) 22.8.3 User Multiplexer Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit USER 0x08 0x0000 Write-Protected 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 12 11 CHANNEL[7:0] R/W R/W 0 0 4 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 USER[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 15:8 – CHANNEL[7:0] Channel Event Selection These bits are used to select the channel to connect to the event user. Note that to select channel n, the value (n+1) must be written to the USER.CHANNEL bit group. CHANNEL[7:0] Channel Number 0x0 0x1-0x08 0x09-0xFF No Channel Output Selected Channel n-1 selected Reserved Bits 7:0 – USER[7:0] User Multiplexer Selection These bits select the event user to be configured with a channel, or the event user to read the channel value from. Table 22-1. User Multiplexer Selection USER[7:0] User Multiplexer 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x08 0x09 0x0A 0x0B 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E-0xFF TC0 TC1 TC2 TC3 TC4 TC5 TC6 TC7 ADC START ADC SYNC AC COMP0 AC COMP1 DAC START PTC STCONV Reserved © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Description Path Type ADC start conversion Flush ADC Start comparator 0 Start comparator 1 DAC start conversion PTC start conversion - Asynchronous, synchronous and resynchronized paths Asynchronous, synchronous and resynchronized paths Asynchronous, synchronous and resynchronized paths Asynchronous, synchronous and resynchronized paths Asynchronous, synchronous and resynchronized paths Asynchronous, synchronous and resynchronized paths Asynchronous, synchronous and resynchronized paths Asynchronous, synchronous and resynchronized paths Asynchronous path only Asynchronous path only Asynchronous path only Asynchronous path only Asynchronous path only Asynchronous path only Reserved Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 317 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) 22.8.4 Channel Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CHSTATUS 0x0C 0x000F00FF - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 CHBUSYn R 0 14 CHBUSYn R 0 13 CHBUSYn R 0 12 CHBUSYn R 0 11 CHBUSYn R 0 10 CHBUSYn R 0 9 CHBUSYn R 0 8 CHBUSYn R 0 7 USRRDYn R 0 6 USRRDYn R 0 5 USRRDYn R 0 4 USRRDYn R 0 3 USRRDYn R 0 2 USRRDYn R 0 1 USRRDYn R 0 0 USRRDYn R 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bits 15,14,13,12,11,10,9,8 – CHBUSYn  Channel n Busy [n=7..0] This bit is cleared when channel n is idle This bit is set if an event on channel n has not been handled by all event users connected to channel n. Bits 7,6,5,4,3,2,1,0 – USRRDYn  Channel n User Ready [n=7..0] This bit is cleared when at least one of the event users connected to the channel is not ready. This bit is set when all event users connected to channel n are ready to handle incoming events on channel n. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 318 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) 22.8.5 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTENCLR 0x10 0x00000000 Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 EVDn R/W 0 14 EVDn R/W 0 13 EVDn R/W 0 12 EVDn R/W 0 11 EVDn R/W 0 10 EVDn R/W 0 9 EVDn R/W 0 8 EVDn R/W 0 7 OVRn R/W 0 6 OVRn R/W 0 5 OVRn R/W 0 4 OVRn R/W 0 3 OVRn R/W 0 2 OVRn R/W 0 1 OVRn R/W 0 0 OVRn R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bits 15,14,13,12,11,10,9,8 – EVDn  Channel n Event Detection Interrupt Enable [n=7..0] Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Event Detected Channel n Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Event Detected Channel n interrupt. Value Description 0 The Event Detected Channel n interrupt is disabled. 1 The Event Detected Channel n interrupt is enabled. Bits 7,6,5,4,3,2,1,0 – OVRn  Channel n Overrun Interrupt Enable [n=7..0] Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Overrun Channel n Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Overrun Channel n interrupt. Value Description 0 The Overrun Channel n interrupt is disabled. 1 The Overrun Channel n interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 319 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) 22.8.6 Interrupt Enable Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTENSET 0x14 0x00000000 Write-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 EVDn R/W 0 14 EVDn R/W 0 13 EVDn R/W 0 12 EVDn R/W 0 11 EVDn R/W 0 10 EVDn R/W 0 9 EVDn R/W 0 8 EVDn R/W 0 7 OVRn R/W 0 6 OVRn R/W 0 5 OVRn R/W 0 4 OVRn R/W 0 3 OVRn R/W 0 2 OVRn R/W 0 1 OVRn R/W 0 0 OVRn R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bits 15,14,13,12,11,10,9,8 – EVDn  Channel n Event Detection Interrupt Enable [n=7..0] Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Event Detected Channel n Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Event Detected Channel n interrupt. Value Description 0 The Event Detected Channel n interrupt is disabled. 1 The Event Detected Channel n interrupt is enabled. Bits 7,6,5,4,3,2,1,0 – OVRn Channel n Overrun Interrupt Enable [n=7..0] Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Overrun Channel n Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Overrun Channel n interrupt. Value Description 0 The Overrun Channel n interrupt is disabled. 1 The Overrun Channel n interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 320 SAM D20 Family Event System (EVSYS) 22.8.7 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTFLAG 0x18 0x00000000 - 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 EVDn R/W 0 14 EVDn R/W 0 13 EVDn R/W 0 12 EVDn R/W 0 11 EVDn R/W 0 10 EVDn R/W 0 9 EVDn R/W 0 8 EVDn R/W 0 7 OVRn R/W 0 6 OVRn R/W 0 5 OVRn R/W 0 4 OVRn R/W 0 3 OVRn R/W 0 2 OVRn R/W 0 1 OVRn R/W 0 0 OVRn R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bits 15,14,13,12,11,10,9,8 – EVDn  Channel n Event Detection [n=7..0] This flag is set on the next CLK_EVSYS_APB cycle when an event is being propagated through the channel, and an interrupt request will be generated if INTENCLR/SET.EVDn is one. When the event channel path is asynchronous, the EVDn interrupt flag will not be set. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Event Detected Channel n interrupt flag. Bits 7,6,5,4,3,2,1,0 – OVRn  Channel n Overrun [n=7..0] This flag is set on the next CLK_EVSYS cycle after an overrun channel condition occurs, and an interrupt request will be generated if INTENCLR/SET.OVRn is one. When the event channel path is asynchronous, the OVRn interrupt flag will not be set. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Overrun Channel n interrupt flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 321 SAM D20 Family SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface 23. SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface 23.1 Overview There are up to six instances of the serial communication interface (SERCOM) peripheral. A SERCOM can be configured to support a number of modes: I2C, SPI, and USART. When an instance of SERCOM is configured and enabled, all of the resources of that SERCOM instance will be dedicated to the selected mode. The SERCOM serial engine consists of a transmitter and receiver, baud-rate generator and address matching functionality. It can use the internal generic clock or an external clock. Using an external clock allows the SERCOM to be operated in all Sleep modes. Related Links 24. SERCOM USART 25. SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 26. SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 23.2 Features • Interface for configuring into one of the following: • • • • – I2C – Two-wire serial interface SMBus™ compatible – SPI – Serial peripheral interface – USART – Universal synchronous and asynchronous serial receiver and transmitter Single transmit buffer and double receive buffer Baud-rate generator Address match/mask logic Operational in all sleep modes See the Related Links for full feature lists of the interface configurations. 23.3 Block Diagram Figure 23-1. SERCOM Block Diagram SERCOM Register Interface CONTROL/STATUS Mode Specific TX/RX DATA BAUD/ADDR Serial Engine Mode n Mode 1 Transmitter Baud Rate Generator Mode 0 Receiver © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet PAD[3:0] Address Match DS60001504F-page 322 SAM D20 Family SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface 23.4 Signal Description See the respective SERCOM mode chapters for details. Related Links 24. SERCOM USART 25. SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 26. SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 23.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. 23.5.1 I/O Lines Using the SERCOM I/O lines requires the I/O pins to be configured using port configuration (PORT). The SERCOM has four internal pads, PAD[3:0], and the signals from I2C, SPI and USART are routed through these SERCOM pads via a multiplexer. The configuration of the multiplexer is available from the different SERCOM modes. Refer to the mode specific chapters for details. Related Links 24. SERCOM USART 25. SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 26. SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 21. PORT - I/O Pin Controller 24.3. Block Diagram 23.5.2 Power Management The SERCOM can operate in any Sleep mode provided the selected clock source is running. SERCOM interrupts can be configured to wake the device from Sleep modes. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 23.5.3 Clocks The SERCOM bus clock (CLK_SERCOMx_APB) can be enabled and disabled in the Power Manager. Refer to Peripheral Clock Masking for details and default status of this clock. The SERCOM uses two generic clocks: GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE and GCLK_SERCOMx_SLOW. The core clock (GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE) is required to clock the SERCOM while working as a host. The slow clock (GCLK_SERCOMx_SLOW) is only required for certain functions. See specific mode chapters for details. These clocks must be configured and enabled in the Generic Clock Controller (GCLK) before using the SERCOM. The generic clocks are asynchronous to the user interface clock (CLK_SERCOMx_APB). Due to this asynchronicity, writing to certain registers will require synchronization between the clock domains. Refer to 23.6.7. Synchronization for details. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 23.5.4 Interrupts The interrupt request line is connected to the Interrupt Controller (NVIC). The NVIC must be configured before the SERCOM interrupts are used. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 323 SAM D20 Family SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface 23.5.5 Events Not applicable. 23.5.6 Debug Operation When the CPU is halted in debug mode, this peripheral will continue normal operation. If the peripheral is configured to require periodical service by the CPU through interrupts or similar, improper operation or data loss may result during debugging. This peripheral can be forced to halt operation during debugging - refer to the Debug Control (DBGCTRL) register for details. 23.5.7 Register Access Protection All registers with write-access can be write-protected optionally by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC), except for the following registers: • • • • Interrupt Flag Clear and Status register (INTFLAG) Status register (STATUS) Data register (DATA) Address register (ADDR) Optional write-protection by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC) is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. PAC write-protection does not apply to accesses through an external debugger. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller 23.5.8 Analog Connections Not applicable. 23.6 Functional Description 23.6.1 Principle of Operation The basic structure of the SERCOM serial engine is shown in Figure 23-2. Labels in capital letters are synchronous to the system clock and accessible by the CPU; labels in lowercase letters can be configured to run on the GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE clock or an external clock. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 324 SAM D20 Family SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface Figure 23-2. SERCOM Serial Engine Address Match Transmitter BAUD Selectable Internal Clk (GCLK) Ext Clk TX DATA ADDR/ADDRMASK Baud Rate Generator 1/- /2- /16 TX Shift Register Receiver RX Shift Register Equal Status Baud Rate Generator STATUS RX Buffer RX DATA The transmitter consists of a single write buffer and a shift register. The receiver consists of a one-level (I2C), two-level (USART, SPI) receive buffer and a shift register. The baud-rate generator is capable of running on the GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE clock or an external clock. Address matching logic is included for SPI and I2C operation. 23.6.2 Basic Operation 23.6.2.1 Initialization The SERCOM must be configured to the desired mode by writing the Operating Mode bits in the Control A register (CTRLA.MODE) as shown in the table below. Table 23-1. SERCOM Modes CTRLA.MODE Description 0x0 USART with external clock 0x1 USART with internal clock 0x2 SPI in client operation 0x3 SPI in host operation 0x4 I2C client operation 0x5 I2C host operation 0x6-0x7 Reserved For further initialization information, see the respective SERCOM mode chapters: Related Links 24. SERCOM USART 25. SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 26. SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 325 SAM D20 Family SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface 23.6.2.2 Enabling, Disabling, and Resetting This peripheral is enabled by writing '1' to the Enable bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.ENABLE), and disabled by writing '0' to it. Writing ‘1’ to the Software Reset bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.SWRST) will reset all registers of this peripheral to their initial states, except the DBGCTRL register, and the peripheral is disabled. Refer to the CTRLA register description for details. 23.6.2.3 Clock Generation – Baud-Rate Generator The baud-rate generator, as shown in Figure 23-3, generates internal clocks for asynchronous and synchronous communication. The output frequency (fBAUD) is determined by the Baud register (BAUD) setting and the baud reference frequency (fref). The baud reference clock is the serial engine clock, and it can be internal or external. For asynchronous communication, the /16 (divide-by-16) output is used when transmitting, whereas the /1 (divideby-1) output is used while receiving. For synchronous communication, the /2 (divide-by-2) output is used. This functionality is automatically configured, depending on the selected operating mode. Figure 23-3. Baud Rate Generator Selectable Internal Clk (GCLK) Baud Rate Generator 1 Ext Clk fref 0 Base Period /2 /1 CTRLA.MODE[0] /8 /2 /16 0 Tx Clk 1 1 CTRLA.MODE 0 1 Clock Recovery Rx Clk 0 Table 23-2 contains equations for the baud rate (in bits per second) and the BAUD register value for each operating mode. For asynchronous operation, the BAUD register value is 16 bits (0 to 65,535). For synchronous operation, the BAUD register value is 8 bits (0 to 255). Table 23-2. Baud Rate Equations Operating Mode Asynchronous Arithmetic Synchronous Condition fBAUD ≤ fBAUD ≤ fref 16 fref 2 Baud Rate (Bits Per Second) fBAUD = fBAUD = fref 1 − BAUD 16 65536 fref 2 ⋅ BAUD + 1 The baud rate error is represented by the following formula: Error = 1 − BAUD Register Value Calculation f BAUD = 65536 ⋅ 1 − 16 ⋅ BAUD fref BAUD = fref −1 2 ⋅ fBAUD ExpectedBaudRate ActualBaudRate Asynchronous Arithmetic Mode BAUD Value Selection The formula given for fBAUD calculates the average frequency over 65536 fref cycles. Although the BAUD register can be set to any value between 0 and 65536, the actual average frequency of fBAUD over a single frame is more © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 326 SAM D20 Family SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface granular. The BAUD register values that will affect the average frequency over a single frame lead to an integer increase in the cycles per frame (CPF) where CPF = • • fref D+S fBAUD D represent the data bits per frame S represent the sum of start and first stop bits, if present. Table below shows the BAUD register value versus baud frequency fBAUD at a serial engine frequency of 48 MHz. This assumes a D value of 8 bits and an S value of 2 bits (10 bits, including start and stop bits). Table 23-3. BAUD Register Value vs. Baud Frequency 23.6.3 BAUD Register Value Serial Engine CPF fBAUD at 48MHz Serial Engine Frequency (fREF) 0 – 406 160 3MHz 407 – 808 161 2.981MHz 809 – 1205 162 2.963MHz ... ... ... 65206 31775 15.11kHz 65207 31871 15.06kHz 65208 31969 15.01kHz Additional Features 23.6.3.1 Address Match and Mask The SERCOM address match and mask feature is capable of matching either one address, two unique addresses, or a range of addresses with a mask, based on the mode selected. The match uses seven or eight bits, depending on the mode. Address With Mask An address written to the Address bits in the Address register (ADDR.ADDR), and a mask written to the Address Mask bits in the Address register (ADDR.ADDRMASK) will yield an address match. All bits that are masked are not included in the match. Note that writing the ADDR.ADDRMASK to 'all zeros' will match a single unique address, while writing ADDR.ADDRMASK to 'all ones' will result in all addresses being accepted. Figure 23-4. Address With Mask ADDR ADDRMASK == Match rx shift register Two Unique Addresses The two addresses written to ADDR and ADDRMASK will cause a match. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 327 SAM D20 Family SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface Figure 23-5. Two Unique Addresses ADDR == Match rx shift register == ADDRMASK Address Range The range of addresses between and including ADDR.ADDR and ADDR.ADDRMASK will cause a match. ADDR.ADDR and ADDR.ADDRMASK can be set to any two addresses, with ADDR.ADDR acting as the upper limit and ADDR.ADDRMASK acting as the lower limit. Figure 23-6. Address Range ADDRMASK 23.6.4 rx shift register ADDR == Match Interrupts Interrupt sources are mode-specific. See the respective SERCOM mode chapters for details. Each interrupt source has its own interrupt flag. The interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG) will be set when the interrupt condition is met. Each interrupt can be individually enabled by writing '1' to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET), and disabled by writing '1' to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR). An interrupt request is generated when the interrupt flag is set and the corresponding interrupt is enabled. The interrupt request remains active until either the interrupt flag is cleared, the interrupt is disabled, or the SERCOM is reset. For details on clearing interrupt flags, refer to the INTFLAG register description. The value of INTFLAG indicates which interrupt condition occurred. The user must read the INTFLAG register to determine which interrupt condition is present. Note:  Interrupts must be globally enabled for interrupt requests. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 23.6.5 Events Not applicable. 23.6.6 Sleep Mode Operation The peripheral can operate in any sleep mode where the selected serial clock is running. This clock can be external or generated by the internal baud-rate generator. The SERCOM interrupts can be used to wake up the device from sleep modes. Refer to the different SERCOM mode chapters for details. 23.6.7 Synchronization Due to asynchronicity between the main clock domain and the peripheral clock domains, some registers need to be synchronized when written or read. Required write-synchronization is denoted by the "Write-Synchronized" property in the register description. Required read-synchronization is denoted by the "Read-Synchronized" property in the register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 328 SAM D20 Family SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface Related Links 13.3. Register Synchronization © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 329 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24. SERCOM USART 24.1 Overview The Universal Synchronous and Asynchronous Receiver and Transmitter (USART) is one of the available modes in the Serial Communication Interface (SERCOM). The USART uses the SERCOM transmitter and receiver, see 24.3. Block Diagram. Labels in uppercase letters are synchronous to CLK_SERCOMx_APB and accessible for CPU. Labels in lowercase letters can be programmed to run on the internal generic clock or an external clock. The transmitter consists of a single write buffer, a Shift register, and control logic for different frame formats. The write buffer support data transmission without any delay between frames. The receiver consists of a two-level receive buffer and a Shift register. Status information of the received data is available for error checking. Data and clock recovery units ensure robust synchronization and noise filtering during asynchronous data reception. Related Links 23. SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface 24.2 USART Features • • • • • • • • • • • • • Full-duplex operation Asynchronous (with clock reconstruction) or synchronous operation Internal or external clock source for asynchronous and synchronous operation Baud-rate generator Supports serial frames with 5, 6, 7, 8 or 9 data bits and 1 or 2 stop bits Odd or even parity generation and parity check Selectable LSB- or MSB-first data transfer Buffer overflow and frame error detection Noise filtering, including false start-bit detection and digital low-pass filter Can operate in all sleep modes Operation at speeds up to half the system clock for internally generated clocks Operation at speeds up to the system clock for externally generated clocks Start-of-frame detection © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 330 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.3 Block Diagram Figure 24-1. USART Block Diagram BAUD GCLK (internal) TX DATA Baud Rate Generator /1 - /2 - /16 CTRLA.MODE TX Shift Register TxD RX Shift Register RxD XCK CTRLA.MODE 24.4 Status RX Buffer STATUS RX DATA Signal Description Table 24-1. SERCOM USART Signals Signal Name Type Description PAD[3:0] Digital I/O General SERCOM pins One signal can be mapped to one of several pins. Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 24.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. 24.5.1 I/O Lines Using the USART’s I/O lines requires the I/O pins to be configured using the I/O Pin Controller (PORT). When the SERCOM is used in USART mode, the SERCOM controls the direction and value of the I/O pins according to the table below. If the receiver or transmitter is disabled, these pins can be used for other purposes. Table 24-2. USART Pin Configuration Pin Pin Configuration TxD Output RxD Input XCK Output or input The combined configuration of PORT and the Transmit Data Pinout and Receive Data Pinout bit fields in the Control A register (CTRLA.TXPO and CTRLA.RXPO, respectively) will define the physical position of the USART signals in Table 24-2. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 331 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART Related Links 21. PORT - I/O Pin Controller 24.5.2 Power Management This peripheral can continue to operate in any sleep mode where its source clock is running. The interrupts can wake up the device from sleep modes. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 24.5.3 Clocks The SERCOM bus clock (CLK_SERCOMx_APB) can be enabled and disabled in the Power Manager. Refer to Peripheral Clock Masking for details and default status of this clock. A generic clock (GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE) is required to clock the SERCOMx_CORE. This clock must be configured and enabled in the Generic Clock Controller before using the SERCOMx_CORE. Refer to GCLK - Generic Clock Controller for details. This generic clock is asynchronous to the bus clock (CLK_SERCOMx_APB). Therefore, writing to certain registers will require synchronization to the clock domains. Refer to Synchronization for further details. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 23.6.7. Synchronization 15.6.2.6. Peripheral Clock Masking 24.5.4 Interrupts The interrupt request line is connected to the Interrupt Controller. In order to use interrupt requests of this peripheral, the Interrupt Controller (NVIC) must be configured first. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 24.5.5 Events Not applicable. 24.5.6 Debug Operation When the CPU is halted in debug mode, this peripheral will continue normal operation. If the peripheral is configured to require periodical service by the CPU through interrupts or similar, improper operation or data loss may result during debugging. This peripheral can be forced to halt operation during debugging - refer to the Debug Control (DBGCTRL) register for details. Related Links 24.8.3. DBGCTRL 24.5.7 Register Access Protection Registers with write-access can be write-protected optionally by the peripheral access controller (PAC). PAC Write-Protection is not available for the following registers: • • • Interrupt Flag Clear and Status register (INTFLAG) Status register (STATUS) Data register (DATA) Optional PAC Write-Protection is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. Write-protection does not apply to accesses through an external debugger. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 332 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.5.8 Analog Connections Not applicable. 24.6 Functional Description 24.6.1 Principle of Operation The USART uses the following lines for data transfer: • • • RxD for receiving TxD for transmitting XCK for the transmission clock in synchronous operation USART data transfer is frame based. A serial frame consists of: • • • • 1 start bit From 5 to 9 data bits (MSB or LSB first) No, even or odd parity bit 1 or 2 stop bits A frame starts with the start bit followed by one character of data bits. If enabled, the parity bit is inserted after the data bits and before the first stop bit. After the stop bit(s) of a frame, either the next frame can follow immediately, or the communication line can return to the idle (high) state. The figure below illustrates the possible frame formats. Brackets denote optional bits. Figure 24-2. Frame Formats Frame (IDLE) St St 0 1 3 4 [5] [6] [7] [8] [P] Sp1 [Sp2] [St/IDL] Start bit. Signal is always low. n, [n] Data bits. 0 to [5..9] [P] Parity bit. Either odd or even. Sp, [Sp] IDLE 24.6.2 2 Stop bit. Signal is always high. No frame is transferred on the communication line. Signal is always high in this state. Basic Operation 24.6.2.1 Initialization The following registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the USART is disabled (CTRL.ENABLE=0): • • • Control A register (CTRLA), except the Enable (ENABLE) and Software Reset (SWRST) bits. Control B register (CTRLB), except the Receiver Enable (RXEN) and Transmitter Enable (TXEN) bits. Baud register (BAUD) When the USART is enabled or is being enabled (CTRLA.ENABLE=1), any writing attempt to these registers will be discarded. If the peripheral is being disabled, writing to these registers will be executed after disabling is completed. Enable-protection is denoted by the "Enable-Protection" property in the register description. Before the USART is enabled, it must be configured by these steps: 1. Select either external (0x0) or internal clock (0x1) by writing the Operating Mode value in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.MODE). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 333 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 2. Select either asynchronous (0) or or synchronous (1) communication mode by writing the Communication Mode bit in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.CMODE). 3. Select pin for receive data by writing the Receive Data Pinout value in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.RXPO). 4. Select pads for the transmitter and external clock by writing the Transmit Data Pinout bit in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.TXPO). 5. Configure the Character Size field in the CTRLB register (CTRLB.CHSIZE) for character size. 6. Set the Data Order bit in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.DORD) to determine MSB- or LSB-first data transmission. 7. To use parity mode: a. Enable parity mode by writing 0x1 to the Frame Format field in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.FORM). b. Configure the Parity Mode bit in the CTRLB register (CTRLB.PMODE) for even or odd parity. 8. Configure the number of stop bits in the Stop Bit Mode bit in the CTRLB register (CTRLB.SBMODE). 9. When using an internal clock, write the Baud register (BAUD) to generate the desired baud rate. 10. Enable the transmitter and receiver by writing '1' to the Receiver Enable and Transmitter Enable bits in the CTRLB register (CTRLB.RXEN and CTRLB.TXEN). 24.6.2.2 Enabling, Disabling, and Resetting This peripheral is enabled by writing '1' to the Enable bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.ENABLE), and disabled by writing '0' to it. Writing ‘1’ to the Software Reset bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.SWRST) will reset all registers of this peripheral to their initial states, except the DBGCTRL register, and the peripheral is disabled. Refer to the CTRLA register description for details. 24.6.2.3 Clock Generation and Selection For both synchronous and asynchronous modes, the clock used for shifting and sampling data can be generated internally by the SERCOM baud-rate generator or supplied externally through the XCK line. The synchronous mode is selected by writing a '1' to the Communication Mode bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.CMODE), the asynchronous mode is selected by writing a zero to CTRLA.CMODE. The internal clock source is selected by writing 0x1 to the Operation Mode bit field in the Control A register (CTRLA.MODE), the external clock source is selected by writing 0x0 to CTRLA.MODE. The SERCOM baud-rate generator is configured as in the figure below. In asynchronous mode (CTRLA.CMODE=0), the 16-bit Baud register value is used. In synchronous mode (CTRLA.CMODE=1), the eight LSBs of the Baud register are used. Refer to Clock Generation – Baud-Rate Generator for details on configuring the baud rate. Figure 24-3. Clock Generation XCKInternal Clk (GCLK) Baud Rate Generator 1 0 Base Period CTRLA.MODE[0] /2 /1 /8 /2 /8 0 Tx Clk 1 1 CTRLA.CMODE 0 XCK 1 Rx Clk 0 Related Links 23.6.2.3. Clock Generation – Baud-Rate Generator © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 334 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.6.2.3.1 Synchronous Clock Operation In synchronous mode, the CTRLA.MODE bit field determines whether the transmission clock line (XCK) serves either as input or output. The dependency between clock edges, data sampling, and data change is the same for internal and external clocks. Data input on the RxD pin is sampled at the opposite XCK clock edge when data is driven on the TxD pin. The Clock Polarity bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.CPOL) selects which XCK clock edge is used for RxD sampling, and which is used for TxD change: When CTRLA.CPOL is '0', the data will be changed on the rising edge of XCK, and sampled on the falling edge of XCK. When CTRLA.CPOL is '1', the data will be changed on the falling edge of XCK, and sampled on the rising edge of XCK. Figure 24-4. Synchronous Mode XCK Timing Change XCK CTRLA.CPOL=1 RxD / TxD Change Sample XCK CTRLA.CPOL=0 RxD / TxD Sample When the clock is provided through XCK (CTRLA.MODE=0x0), the shift registers operate directly on the XCK clock. This means that XCK is not synchronized with the system clock and, therefore, can operate at frequencies up to the system frequency. 24.6.2.4 Data Register The USART Transmit Data register (TxDATA) and USART Receive Data register (RxDATA) share the same I/O address, referred to as the Data register (DATA). Writing the DATA register will update the TxDATA register. Reading the DATA register will return the contents of the RxDATA register. 24.6.2.5 Data Transmission Data transmission is initiated by writing the data to be sent into the DATA register. Then, the data in TxDATA will be moved to the Shift register when the Shift register is empty and ready to send a new frame. After the Shift register is loaded with data, the data frame will be transmitted. When the entire data frame including Stop bit(s) has been transmitted and no new data was written to DATA, the Transmit Complete Interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.TXC) will be set, and the optional interrupt will be generated. The Data Register Empty flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.DRE) indicates that the register is empty and ready for new data. The DATA register should only be written to when INTFLAG.DRE is set. Disabling the Transmitter The transmitter is disabled by writing '0' to the Transmitter Enable bit in the CTRLB register (CTRLB.TXEN). Disabling the transmitter will complete only after any ongoing and pending transmissions are completed, i.e., there is no data in the transmit shift register and TxDATA to transmit. 24.6.2.6 Data Reception The receiver accepts data when a valid Start bit is detected. Each bit following the Start bit will be sampled according to the baud rate or XCK clock, and shifted into the receive Shift register until the first Stop bit of a frame is received. The second Stop bit will be ignored by the receiver. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 335 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART When the first Stop bit is received and a complete serial frame is present in the Receive Shift register, the contents of the Shift register will be moved into the two-level receive buffer. Then, the Receive Complete Interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.RXC) will be set, and the optional interrupt will be generated. The received data can be read from the DATA register when the Receive Complete Interrupt flag is set. Disabling the Receiver Writing '0' to the Receiver Enable bit in the CTRLB register (CTRLB.RXEN) will disable the receiver, flush the two-level receive buffer, and data from ongoing receptions will be lost. Error Bits The USART receiver has three error bits in the Status (STATUS) register: Frame Error (FERR), Buffer Overflow (BUFOVF), and Parity Error (PERR). Once an error happens, the corresponding error bit will be set until it is cleared by writing ‘1’ to it. These bits are also cleared automatically when the receiver is disabled. There are two methods for buffer overflow notification, selected by the Immediate Buffer Overflow Notification bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.IBON): When CTRLA.IBON=1, STATUS.BUFOVF is raised immediately upon buffer overflow. Software can then empty the receive FIFO by reading RxDATA, until the receiver complete interrupt flag (INTFLAG.RXC) is cleared. When CTRLA.IBON=0, the buffer overflow condition is attending data through the receive FIFO. After the received data is read, STATUS.BUFOVF will be set along with INTFLAG.RXC. Asynchronous Data Reception The USART includes a clock recovery and data recovery unit for handling asynchronous data reception. The clock recovery logic can synchronize the incoming asynchronous serial frames at the RxD pin to the internally generated baud-rate clock. The data recovery logic samples and applies a low-pass filter to each incoming bit, thereby improving the noise immunity of the receiver. Asynchronous Operational Range The operational range of the asynchronous reception depends on the accuracy of the internal baud-rate clock, the rate of the incoming frames, and the frame size (in number of bits). In addition, the operational range of the receiver is depending on the difference between the received bit rate and the internally generated baud rate. If the baud rate of an external transmitter is too high or too low compared to the internally generated baud rate, the receiver will not be able to synchronize the frames to the start bit. There are two possible sources for a mismatch in baud rate: First, the reference clock will always have some minor instability. Second, the baud-rate generator cannot always do an exact division of the reference clock frequency to get the baud rate desired. In this case, the BAUD register value should be set to give the lowest possible error. Refer to Clock Generation – Baud-Rate Generator for details. Recommended maximum receiver baud-rate errors for various character sizes are shown in the table below. Table 24-3. Asynchronous Receiver Error for 16-fold Oversampling D (Data bits+Parity) RSLOW [%] RFAST [%] Max. total error [%] Recommended max. Rx error [%] 5 91.42 107.69 +5.88/-7.69 ±2.5 6 94.92 106.67 +5.08/-6.67 ±2.0 7 95.52 105.88 +4.48/-5.88 ±2.0 8 96.00 105.26 +4.00/-5.26 ±2.0 9 96.39 104.76 +3.61/-4.76 ±1.5 10 96.70 104.35 +3.30/-4.35 ±1.5 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 336 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART The following equations calculate the ratio of the incoming data rate and internal receiver baud rate: 16 D + 1 16 D + 2 , RFAST = 16 D + 1 + 6 16 D + 1 + 8 RSLOW is the ratio of the slowest incoming data rate that can be accepted in relation to the receiver baud rate RFAST is the ratio of the fastest incoming data rate that can be accepted in relation to the receiver baud rate D is the sum of character size and parity size (D = 5 to 10 bits) RSLOW = • • • The recommended maximum Rx Error assumes that the receiver and transmitter equally divide the maximum total error. Its connection to the SERCOM Receiver error acceptance is depicted in this figure: Figure 24-5. USART Rx Error Calculation SERCOM Receiver error acceptance from RSLOW and RFAST formulas Error Max (%) + + offset error Baud Generator depends on BAUD register value Clock source error + Recommended max. Rx Error (%) Baud Rate Error Min (%) The recommendation values in the table above accommodate errors of the clock source and the baud generator. The following figure gives an example for a baud rate of 3Mbps: Figure 24-6. USART Rx Error Calculation Example SERCOM Receiver error acceptance sampling = x16 data bits = 10 parity = 0 start bit = stop bit = 1 Error Max 3.3% + No baud generator offset error + Fbaud(3Mbps) = 48MHz *1(BAUD=0) /16 Error Max 3.3% Accepted + Receiver Error + DFLL source at 3MHz Transmitter Error* +/-0.3% Error Max 3.0% Baud Rate 3Mbps Error Min -4.05% Error Min -4.35% Error Min -4.35% security margin *Transmitter Error depends on the external transmitter used in the application. It is advised that it is within the Recommended max. Rx Error (+/-1.5% in this example). Larger Transmitter Errors are acceptable but must lie within the Accepted Receiver Error. Recommended max. Rx Error +/-1.5% (example) Related Links 23.6.2.3. Clock Generation – Baud-Rate Generator 24.6.3 Additional Features 24.6.3.1 Parity Even or odd parity can be selected for error checking by writing 0x1 to the Frame Format bit field in the Control A register (CTRLA.FORM). If even parity is selected (CTRLB.PMODE=0), the parity bit of an outgoing frame is '1' if the data contains an odd number of bits that are '1', making the total number of '1' even. If odd parity is selected (CTRLB.PMODE=1), the parity bit of an outgoing frame is '1' if the data contains an even number of bits that are '0', making the total number of '1' odd. When parity checking is enabled, the parity checker calculates the parity of the data bits in incoming frames and compares the result with the parity bit of the corresponding frame. If a parity error is detected, the Parity Error bit in the Status register (STATUS.PERR) is set. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 337 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.6.3.2 Loop-Back Mode For loop-back mode, configure the Receive Data Pinout (CTRLA.RXPO) and Transmit Data Pinout (CTRLA.TXPO) to use the same data pins for transmit and receive. The loop-back is through the pad, so the signal is also available externally. 24.6.3.3 Start-of-Frame Detection The USART start-of-frame detector can wake up the CPU when it detects a start bit. In standby sleep mode, the internal fast startup oscillator must be selected as the GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE source. When a 1-to-0 transition is detected on RxD, the 8MHz Internal Oscillator is powered up and the USART clock is enabled. After startup, the rest of the data frame can be received, provided that the baud rate is slow enough in relation to the fast startup internal oscillator start-up time. Refer to Electrical Characteristics for details. The start-up time of this oscillator varies with supply voltage and temperature. The USART start-of-frame detection works both in asynchronous and synchronous modes. It is enabled by writing ‘1’ to the Start of Frame Detection Enable bit in the Control B register (CTRLB.SFDE). If the Receive Start Interrupt Enable bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET.RXS) is set, the Receive Start interrupt is generated immediately when a start is detected. When using start-of-frame detection without the Receive Start interrupt, start detection will force the 8MHz Internal Oscillator and USART clock active while the frame is being received. In this case, the CPU will not wake up until the Receive Complete interrupt is generated. Related Links 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 24.6.4 Interrupts The USART has the following interrupt sources. These are asynchronous interrupts, and can wake up the device from any sleep mode: • • • • Data Register Empty (DRE) Receive Complete (RXC) Transmit Complete (TXC) Receive Start (RXS) Each interrupt source has its own interrupt flag. The interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG) will be set when the interrupt condition is met. Each interrupt can be individually enabled by writing '1' to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET), and disabled by writing '1' to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR). An interrupt request is generated when the interrupt flag is set and if the corresponding interrupt is enabled. The interrupt request remains active until either the interrupt flag is cleared, the interrupt is disabled, or the USART is reset. For details on clearing interrupt flags, refer to the INTFLAG register description. The USART has one common interrupt request line for all the interrupt sources. The value of INTFLAG indicates which interrupt is executed. Note that interrupts must be globally enabled for interrupt requests. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 24.6.5 Sleep Mode Operation The behavior in sleep mode is depending on the clock source and the Run In Standby bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.RUNSTDBY): • Internal clocking, CTRLA.RUNSTDBY=1: GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE can be enabled in all sleep modes. Any interrupt can wake up the device. • External clocking, CTRLA.RUNSTDBY=1: The Receive Complete interrupt(s) can wake up the device. • Internal clocking, CTRLA.RUNSTDBY=0: Internal clock will be disabled, after any ongoing transfer was completed. The Receive Complete interrupt(s) can wake up the device. • External clocking, CTRLA.RUNSTDBY=0: External clock will be disconnected, after any ongoing transfer was completed. All reception will be dropped. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 338 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.6.6 Synchronization Due to asynchronicity between the main clock domain and the peripheral clock domains, some registers need to be synchronized when written or read. Required write-synchronization is denoted by the "Write-Synchronized" property in the register description. Required read-synchronization is denoted by the "Read-Synchronized" property in the register description. Related Links 13.3. Register Synchronization © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 339 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.7 Register Summary Offset Name 0x00 CTRLA 0x04 CTRLB 0x08 0x09 DBGCTRL Reserved 0x0A BAUD 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E 0x0F INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG Reserved 0x10 STATUS 0x12 ... 0x17 Reserved 0x18 DATA 24.8 Bit Pos. 7 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 RUNSTDBY 5 4 3 2 MODE[2:0] DORD SBMODE RXPO[1:0] CPOL CMODE PMODE 1 0 ENABLE SWRST IBON TXPO FORM[3:0] CHSIZE[2:0] SFDE RXEN TXEN DBGSTOP 7:0 15:8 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 15:8 6 BAUD[7:0] BAUD[15:8] RXS RXS RXS RXC RXC RXC TXC TXC TXC DRE DRE DRE BUFOVF FERR PERR SYNCBUSY 7:0 15:8 DATA[7:0] DATA[8] Register Description Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16-, and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers require synchronization when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the "ReadSynchronized" and/or "Write-Synchronized" property in each individual register description. Optional write-protection by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC) is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the module is disabled. Enableprotection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 340 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.8.1 Control A Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRLA 0x00 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected, Write-Synchronized 31 Access Reset Bit 23 30 DORD R/W 0 29 CPOL R/W 0 28 CMODE R/W 0 27 R/W 0 22 21 20 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 19 18 17 16 TXPO R/W 0 FORM[3:0] RXPO[1:0] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 IBON R 0 7 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 6 5 4 3 MODE[2:0] R/W 0 2 1 ENABLE R/W 0 0 SWRST R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit 30 – DORD Data Order This bit selects the data order when a character is shifted out from the Data register. This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 MSB is transmitted first. 1 LSB is transmitted first. Bit 29 – CPOL Clock Polarity This bit selects the relationship between data output change and data input sampling in synchronous mode. This bit is not synchronized. CPOL TxD Change RxD Sample 0x0 0x1 Rising XCK edge Falling XCK edge Falling XCK edge Rising XCK edge Bit 28 – CMODE Communication Mode This bit selects asynchronous or synchronous communication. This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 Asynchronous communication. 1 Synchronous communication. Bits 27:24 – FORM[3:0] Frame Format These bits define the frame format. These bits are not synchronized. FORM[3:0] Description 0x0 0x1 USART frame USART frame with parity © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 341 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART ...........continued FORM[3:0] Description 0x2-0x0xF Reserved Bits 21:20 – RXPO[1:0] Receive Data Pinout These bits define the receive data (RxD) pin configuration. These bits are not synchronized. RXPO[1:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 PAD[0] PAD[1] PAD[2] PAD[3] SERCOM PAD[0] is used for data reception SERCOM PAD[1] is used for data reception SERCOM PAD[2] is used for data reception SERCOM PAD[3] is used for data reception Bit 16 – TXPO Transmit Data Pinout These bits define the transmit data (TxD) and XCK pin configurations. This bit is not synchronized. TXPO TxD Pin Location XCK Pin Location (When Applicable) 0x0 0x1 SERCOM PAD[0] SERCOM PAD[2] SERCOM PAD[1] SERCOM PAD[3] Bit 8 – IBON Immediate Buffer Overflow Notification This bit controls when the buffer overflow status bit (STATUS.BUFOVF) is asserted when a buffer overflow occurs. Value Description 0 STATUS.BUFOVF is asserted when it occurs in the data stream. 1 STATUS.BUFOVF is asserted immediately upon buffer overflow. Bit 7 – RUNSTDBY Run In Standby This bit defines the functionality in standby sleep mode. This bit is not synchronized. RUNSTDBY External Clock Internal Clock 0x0 Generic clock is disabled when ongoing transfer is finished. The device can wake up on Receive Start or Transfer Complete interrupt. Generic clock is enabled in all sleep modes. Any interrupt can wake up the device. 0x1 External clock is disconnected when ongoing transfer is finished. All reception is dropped. Wake on Receive Start or Receive Complete interrupt. Bits 4:2 – MODE[2:0] Operating Mode These bits select the USART serial communication interface of the SERCOM. These bits are not synchronized. Value Description 0x0 USART with external clock 0x1 USART with internal clock Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable Due to synchronization, there is delay from writing CTRLA.ENABLE until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to CTRLA.ENABLE will read back immediately and the Enable Synchronization Busy bit in the Synchronization Busy register (SYNCBUSY.ENABLE) will be set. SYNCBUSY.ENABLE is cleared when the operation is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 The peripheral is disabled or being disabled. 1 The peripheral is enabled or being enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 342 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit resets all registers in the SERCOM, except DBGCTRL, to their initial state, and the SERCOM will be disabled. Writing '1' to CTRLA.SWRST will always take precedence, meaning that all other writes in the same write-operation will be discarded. Any register write access during the ongoing reset will result in an APB error. Reading any register will return the reset value of the register. Due to synchronization, there is a delay from writing CTRLA.SWRST until the reset is complete. CTRLA.SWRST and SYNCBUSY.SWRST will both be cleared when the reset is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 There is no reset operation ongoing. 1 The reset operation is ongoing. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 343 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.8.2 Control B Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRLB 0x04 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected, Write-Synchronized 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 RXEN R/W 0 16 TXEN R/W 0 15 14 13 PMODE R/W 0 12 11 10 9 SFDE R/W 0 8 7 6 SBMODE R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 CHSIZE[2:0] R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit 17 – RXEN Receiver Enable Writing '0' to this bit will disable the USART receiver. Disabling the receiver will flush the receive buffer and clear the FERR, PERR and BUFOVF bits in the STATUS register. Writing '1' to CTRLB.RXEN when the USART is disabled will set CTRLB.RXEN immediately. When the USART is enabled, CTRLB.RXEN will be cleared, and SYNCBUSY.CTRLB will be set and remain set until the receiver is enabled. When the receiver is enabled, CTRLB.RXEN will read back as '1'. Writing '1' to CTRLB.RXEN when the USART is enabled will set SYNCBUSY.CTRLB, which will remain set until the receiver is enabled, and CTRLB.RXEN will read back as '1'. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 The receiver is disabled or being enabled. 1 The receiver is enabled or will be enabled when the USART is enabled. Bit 16 – TXEN Transmitter Enable Writing '0' to this bit will disable the USART transmitter. Disabling the transmitter will not become effective until ongoing and pending transmissions are completed. Writing '1' to CTRLB.TXEN when the USART is disabled will set CTRLB.TXEN immediately. When the USART is enabled, CTRLB.TXEN will be cleared, and SYNCBUSY.CTRLB will be set and remain set until the transmitter is enabled. When the transmitter is enabled, CTRLB.TXEN will read back as '1'. Writing '1' to CTRLB.TXEN when the USART is enabled will set SYNCBUSY.CTRLB, which will remain set until the receiver is enabled, and CTRLB.TXEN will read back as '1'. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 The transmitter is disabled or being enabled. 1 The transmitter is enabled or will be enabled when the USART is enabled. Bit 13 – PMODE Parity Mode This bit selects the type of parity used when parity is enabled (CTRLA.FORM is '1'). The transmitter will automatically generate and send the parity of the transmitted data bits within each frame. The receiver will generate a parity value © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 344 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART for the incoming data and parity bit, compare it to the parity mode and, if a mismatch is detected, STATUS.PERR will be set. This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 Even parity. 1 Odd parity. Bit 9 – SFDE Start of Frame Detection Enable This bit controls whether the start-of-frame detector will wake up the device when a start bit is detected on the RxD line. This bit is not synchronized. SFDE INTENSET.RXS INTENSET.RXC Description 0 1 1 X 0 0 X 0 1 1 1 0 1 1 1 Start-of-frame detection disabled. Reserved Start-of-frame detection enabled. RXC wakes up the device from all sleep modes. Start-of-frame detection enabled. RXS wakes up the device from all sleep modes. Start-of-frame detection enabled. Both RXC and RXS wake up the device from all sleep modes. Bit 6 – SBMODE Stop Bit Mode This bit selects the number of stop bits transmitted. This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 One stop bit. 1 Two stop bits. Bits 2:0 – CHSIZE[2:0] Character Size These bits select the number of bits in a character. These bits are not synchronized. CHSIZE[2:0] Description 0x0 0x1 0x2-0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 8 bits 9 bits Reserved 5 bits 6 bits 7 bits © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 345 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.8.3 Debug Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit DBGCTRL 0x08 0x00 PAC Write-Protection 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 0 DBGSTOP R/W 0 Bit 0 – DBGSTOP Debug Stop Mode This bit controls the baud-rate generator functionality when the CPU is halted by an external debugger. Value Description 0 The baud-rate generator continues normal operation when the CPU is halted by an external debugger. 1 The baud-rate generator is halted when the CPU is halted by an external debugger. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 346 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.8.4 Baud Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 15 BAUD 0x0A 0x0000 Enable-Protected, PAC Write-Protection 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 BAUD[15:8] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 BAUD[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 15:0 – BAUD[15:0] Baud Value These bits control the clock generation, as described in the SERCOM Baud Rate section. • Bits 15:0 - BAUD[15:0]: Baud Value These bits control the clock generation, as described in the SERCOM Clock Generation – Baud-Rate Generator section. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 347 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.8.5 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENCLR 0x0C 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to disable an interrupt without read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET). This register allows the user to disable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET). Bit 7 6 Access Reset 5 4 3 RXS R/W 0 2 RXC R/W 0 1 TXC R/W 0 0 DRE R/W 0 Bit 3 – RXS Receive Start Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Receive Start Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Receive Start interrupt. Value Description 0 Receive Start interrupt is disabled. 1 Receive Start interrupt is enabled. Bit 2 – RXC Receive Complete Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Receive Complete Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Receive Complete interrupt. Value Description 0 Receive Complete interrupt is disabled. 1 Receive Complete interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – TXC Transmit Complete Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Transmit Complete Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Receive Complete interrupt. Value Description 0 Transmit Complete interrupt is disabled. 1 Transmit Complete interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – DRE Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Data Register Empty interrupt. Value Description 0 Data Register Empty interrupt is disabled. 1 Data Register Empty interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 348 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.8.6 Interrupt Enable Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENSET 0x0D 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to enable an interrupt without read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR) . This register allows the user to disable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR). Bit 7 6 Access Reset 5 4 3 RXS R/W 0 2 RXC R/W 0 1 TXC R/W 0 0 DRE R/W 0 Bit 3 – RXS Receive Start Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will set the Receive Start Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Receive Start interrupt. Value Description 0 Receive Start interrupt is disabled. 1 Receive Start interrupt is enabled. Bit 2 – RXC Receive Complete Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will set the Receive Complete Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Receive Complete interrupt. Value Description 0 Receive Complete interrupt is disabled. 1 Receive Complete interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – TXC Transmit Complete Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will set the Transmit Complete Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Transmit Complete interrupt. Value Description 0 Transmit Complete interrupt is disabled. 1 Transmit Complete interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – DRE Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will set the Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Data Register Empty interrupt. Value Description 0 Data Register Empty interrupt is disabled. 1 Data Register Empty interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 349 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.8.7 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 INTFLAG 0x0E 0x00 - 6 5 4 Access Reset 3 RXS R/W 0 2 RXC R 0 1 TXC R/W 0 0 DRE R 0 Bit 3 – RXS Receive Start This flag is cleared by writing '1' to it. This flag is set when a start condition is detected on the RxD line and start-of-frame detection is enabled (CTRLB.SFDE is '1'). Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Receive Start interrupt flag. Bit 2 – RXC Receive Complete This flag is cleared by reading the Data register (DATA) or by disabling the receiver. This flag is set when there are unread data in DATA. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit has no effect. Bit 1 – TXC Transmit Complete This flag is cleared by writing '1' to it or by writing new data to DATA. This flag is set when the entire frame in the transmit shift register has been shifted out and there are no new data in DATA. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the flag. Bit 0 – DRE Data Register Empty This flag is cleared by writing new data to DATA. This flag is set when DATA is empty and ready to be written. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit has no effect. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 350 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.8.8 Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit STATUS 0x10 0x0000 - 15 SYNCBUSY R/W 0 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 BUFOVF R/W 0 1 FERR R/W 0 0 PERR R/W 0 Access Reset Bit 15 – SYNCBUSY Synchronization Busy This bit is cleared when the synchronization of registers between the clock domains is complete. This bit is set when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is started. Bit 2 – BUFOVF Buffer Overflow Reading this bit before reading the Data register will indicate the error status of the next character to be read. This bit is cleared by writing '1' to the bit or by disabling the receiver. This bit is set when a buffer overflow condition is detected. A buffer overflow occurs when the receive buffer is full, there is a new character waiting in the receive shift register and a new start bit is detected. Value Description 0 Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. 1 Writing '1' to this bit will clear it. Bit 1 – FERR Frame Error Reading this bit before reading the Data register will indicate the error status of the next character to be read. This bit is cleared by writing '1' to the bit or by disabling the receiver. This bit is set if the received character had a frame error, i.e., when the first stop bit is zero. Value Description 0 Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. 1 Writing '1' to this bit will clear it. Bit 0 – PERR Parity Error Reading this bit before reading the Data register will indicate the error status of the next character to be read. This bit is cleared by writing '1' to the bit or by disabling the receiver. This bit is set if parity checking is enabled (CTRLA.FORM is 0x1) and a parity error is detected. Value Description 0 Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. 1 Writing '1' to this bit will clear it. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 351 SAM D20 Family SERCOM USART 24.8.9 Data Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit DATA 0x18 0x0000 - 15 14 13 12 7 6 5 4 11 10 9 8 DATA[8] R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit DATA[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 8:0 – DATA[8:0] Data Reading these bits will return the contents of the Receive Data register. The register should be read only when the Receive Complete Interrupt Flag bit in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.RXC) is set. The status bits in STATUS should be read before reading the DATA value in order to get any corresponding error. Writing these bits will write the Transmit Data register. This register should be written only when the Data Register Empty Interrupt Flag bit in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.DRE) is set. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 352 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25. 25.1 SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface Overview The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is one of the available modes in the Serial Communication Interface (SERCOM). The SPI uses the SERCOM transmitter and receiver configured as shown in 25.3. Block Diagram. Each side, host and client, depicts a separate SPI containing a Shift register, a transmit buffer and a two-level receive buffer. In addition, the SPI host uses the SERCOM baud-rate generator, while the SPI client can use the SERCOM address match logic. Labels in capital letters are synchronous to CLK_SERCOMx_APB and accessible by the CPU, while labels in lowercase letters are synchronous to the SCK clock. Related Links 23. SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface 25.2 Features SERCOM SPI includes the following features: • • • • • • • Full-duplex, four-wire interface (MISO, MOSI, SCK, SS) Single-buffered transmitter, double-buffered receiver Supports all four SPI modes of operation Single data direction operation allows alternate function on MISO or MOSI pin Selectable LSB- or MSB-first data transfer Host operation: – Serial clock speed, fSCK=1/tSCK(1) – 8-bit clock generator Client operation: – Serial clock speed, fSCK=1/tSSCK(1) – Optional 8-bit address match operation – Operation in all sleep modes Note:  1. For tSCK and tSSCK values, refer to SPI Timing Characteristics. Related Links 23. SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface 25.3 Block Diagram Figure 25-1. Full-Duplex SPI Host Client Interconnection Host BAUD Client Tx DATA Tx DATA ADDR/ADDRMASK SCK SS baud rate generator shift register MISO shift register MOSI © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries rx buffer rx buffer Rx DATA Rx DATA Complete Datasheet == Address Match DS60001504F-page 353 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.4 Signal Description Table 25-1. SERCOM SPI Signals Signal Name Type Description PAD[3:0] Digital I/O General SERCOM pins One signal can be mapped to one of several pins. Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 25.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. 25.5.1 I/O Lines In order to use the SERCOM’s I/O lines, the I/O pins must be configured using the IO Pin Controller (PORT). When the SERCOM is configured for SPI operation, the SERCOM controls the direction and value of the I/O pins according to the table below. Both PORT control bits PINCFGn.PULLEN and PINCFGn.DRVSTR are still effective. If the receiver is disabled, the data input pin can be used for other purposes. In Host mode, the Client select line (SS) is controlled by software. Table 25-2. SPI Pin Configuration Pin Host SPI Client SPI MOSI Output Input MISO Input Output SCK Output Input SS User defined output enable Input The combined configuration of PORT, the Data In Pinout and the Data Out Pinout bit groups in the Control A register (CTRLA.DIPO and CTRLA.DOPO) define the physical position of the SPI signals in the table above. Related Links 21. PORT - I/O Pin Controller 25.5.2 Power Management This peripheral can continue to operate in any sleep mode where its source clock is running. The interrupts can wake up the device from sleep modes. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 25.5.3 Clocks The SERCOM bus clock (CLK_SERCOMx_APB) can be enabled and disabled in the Power Manager. Refer to Peripheral Clock Masking for details and default status of this clock. A generic clock (GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE) is required to clock the SPI. This clock must be configured and enabled in the Generic Clock Controller before using the SPI. This generic clock is asynchronous to the bus clock (CLK_SERCOMx_APB). Therefore, writes to certain registers will require synchronization to the clock domains. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 354 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 25.6.6. Synchronization 25.5.4 Interrupts The interrupt request line is connected to the Interrupt Controller. In order to use interrupt requests of this peripheral, the Interrupt Controller (NVIC) must be configured first. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 25.5.5 Events Not applicable. 25.5.6 Debug Operation When the CPU is halted in debug mode, this peripheral will continue normal operation. If the peripheral is configured to require periodical service by the CPU through interrupts or similar, improper operation or data loss may result during debugging. This peripheral can be forced to halt operation during debugging - refer to the Debug Control (DBGCTRL) register for details. 25.5.7 Register Access Protection Registers with write-access can be write-protected optionally by the peripheral access controller (PAC). PAC Write-Protection is not available for the following registers: • • • Interrupt Flag Clear and Status register (INTFLAG) Status register (STATUS) Data register (DATA) Optional PAC Write-Protection is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. Write-protection does not apply to accesses through an external debugger. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller 25.5.8 Analog Connections Not applicable. 25.6 Functional Description 25.6.1 Principle of Operation The SPI is a high-speed synchronous data transfer interface. It allows high-speed communication between the device and peripheral devices. The SPI can operate as host or client. As host, the SPI initiates and controls all data transactions. The SPI is single buffered for transmitting and double buffered for receiving. When transmitting data, the Data register can be loaded with the next character to be transmitted during the current transmission. When receiving, the data is transferred to the two-level receive buffer, and the receiver is ready for a new character. The SPI transaction format is shown in SPI Transaction Format. Each transaction can contain one or more characters. The character size is configurable, and can be either 8 or 9 bits. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 355 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface Figure 25-2. SPI Transaction Format Transaction Character MOSI/MISO Character 0 Character 1 Character 2 SS The SPI host must pull the SPI select line (SS) of the desired client low to initiate a transaction if multiple clients are connected to the bus. The SPI select line can be wired low if there is only one SPI client on the bus. The host and client prepare data to send via their respective Shift registers, and the host generates the serial clock on the SCK line. Data is always shifted from host to client on the Host Output Client Input line (MOSI); data is shifted from client to host on the Host Input Client Output line (MISO). Each time character is shifted out from the host, a character will be shifted out from the client simultaneously. To signal the end of a transaction, the host will pull the SS line high. 25.6.2 Basic Operation 25.6.2.1 Initialization The following registers are enable-protected, meaning that they can only be written when the SPI is disabled (CTRL.ENABLE=0): • • • • Control A register (CTRLA), except Enable (CTRLA.ENABLE) and Software Reset (CTRLA.SWRST) Control B register (CTRLB), except Receiver Enable (CTRLB.RXEN) Baud register (BAUD) Address register (ADDR) When the SPI is enabled or is being enabled (CTRLA.ENABLE=1), any writing to these registers will be discarded. when the SPI is being disabled, writing to these registers will be completed after the disabling. Enable-protection is denoted by the Enable-Protection property in the register description. Initialize the SPI by following these steps: 1. Select SPI mode in Host / Client operation in the Operating Mode bit group in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.MODE= 0x2 or 0x3 ). 2. Select transfer mode for the Clock Polarity bit and the Clock Phase bit in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.CPOL and CTRLA.CPHA) if desired. 3. Select the Frame Format value in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.FORM). 4. Configure the Data In Pinout field in the Control A register (CTRLA.DIPO) for SERCOM pads of the receiver. 5. Configure the Data Out Pinout bit group in the Control A register (CTRLA.DOPO) for SERCOM pads of the transmitter. 6. Select the Character Size value in the CTRLB register (CTRLB.CHSIZE). 7. Write the Data Order bit in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.DORD) for data direction. 8. If the SPI is used in Host mode: a. Select the desired baud rate by writing to the Baud register (BAUD). 9. Enable the receiver by writing the Receiver Enable bit in the CTRLB register (CTRLB.RXEN=1). 25.6.2.2 Enabling, Disabling, and Resetting This peripheral is enabled by writing '1' to the Enable bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.ENABLE), and disabled by writing '0' to it. Writing ‘1’ to the Software Reset bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.SWRST) will reset all registers of this peripheral to their initial states, except the DBGCTRL register, and the peripheral is disabled. Refer to the CTRLA register description for details. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 356 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.6.2.3 Clock Generation In the SPI host operation (CTRLA.MODE=0x3), the serial clock (SCK) is generated internally by the SERCOM Baud Rate Generator (BRG). In SPI mode, the BRG is set to Synchronous mode. The 8-bit Baud register (BAUD) value is used for generating SCK and clocking the Shift register. Refer to Clock Generation – Baud-Rate Generator for more details. In SPI client operation (CTRLA.MODE is 0x2), the clock is provided by an external host on the SCK pin. This clock is used to clock the SPI Shift register. Related Links 23.6.2.3. Clock Generation – Baud-Rate Generator 25.6.2.4 Data Register The SPI Transmit Data register (TxDATA) and SPI Receive Data register (RxDATA) share the same I/O address, referred to as the SPI Data register (DATA). Writing DATA register will update the Transmit Data register. Reading the DATA register will return the contents of the Receive Data register. 25.6.2.5 SPI Transfer Modes There are four combinations of SCK phase and polarity to transfer serial data. The SPI Data Transfer modes are shown in SPI Transfer Modes (Table) and SPI Transfer Modes (Figure). SCK phase is configured by the Clock Phase bit in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.CPHA). SCK polarity is programmed by the Clock Polarity bit in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.CPOL). Data bits are shifted out and latched in on opposite edges of the SCK signal. This ensures sufficient time for the data signals to stabilize. Table 25-3. SPI Transfer Modes Mode CPOL CPHA Leading Edge Trailing Edge 0 0 0 Rising, sample Falling, setup 1 0 1 Rising, setup Falling, sample 2 1 0 Falling, sample Rising, setup 3 1 1 Falling, setup Rising, sample Note:  Leading edge is the first clock edge in a clock cycle. Trailing edge is the second clock edge in a clock cycle. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 357 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface Figure 25-3. SPI Transfer Modes Mode 0 Mode 2 SAMPLE I MOSI/MISO CHANGE 0 MOSI PIN CHANGE 0 MISO PIN SS MSB first (DORD = 0) MSB LSB first (DORD = 1) LSB Bit 6 Bit 1 Bit 5 Bit 2 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 2 Bit 5 Bit 1 Bit 6 LSB MSB Mode 1 Mode 3 SAMPLE I MOSI/MISO CHANGE 0 MOSI PIN CHANGE 0 MISO PIN SS MSB first (DORD = 0) LSB first (DORD = 1) MSB LSB Bit 6 Bit 1 Bit 5 Bit 2 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 3 Bit 4 Bit 2 Bit 5 Bit 1 Bit 6 LSB MSB 25.6.2.6 Transferring Data Host In Host mode (CTRLA.MODE=0x3), the SS line must be configured as an output. SS can be assigned to any general purpose I/O pin. When the SPI is ready for a data transaction, software must pull the SS line low. When writing a character to the Data register (DATA), the character will be transferred to the shift register. Once the content of TxDATA has been transferred to the shift register, the Data Register Empty flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.DRE) will be set. And a new character can be written to DATA. Each time one character is shifted out from the Host, another character will be shifted in from the Client simultaneously. If the receiver is enabled (CTRLA.RXEN=1), the contents of the shift register will be transferred to the two-level receive buffer. The transfer takes place in the same clock cycle as the last data bit is shifted in. And the Receive Complete Interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.RXC) will be set. The received data can be retrieved by reading DATA. When the last character has been transmitted and there is no valid data in DATA, the Transmit Complete Interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.TXC) will be set. When the transaction is finished, the Host must pull the SS line high to notify the Client. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 358 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface Client In Client mode (CTRLA.MODE=0x2), the SPI interface will remain inactive with the MISO line tri-stated as long as the SS pin is pulled high. Software may update the contents of DATA at any time as long as the Data Register Empty flag in the Interrupt Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.DRE) is set. When SS is pulled low and SCK is running, the Client will sample and shift out data according to the transaction mode set. When the content of TxDATA has been loaded into the shift register, INTFLAG.DRE will be set, and new data can be written to DATA. Similar to the Host, the Client will receive one character for each character transmitted. A character will be transferred into the two-level receive buffer within the same clock cycle its last data bit is received. The received character can be retrieved from DATA when the Receive Complete interrupt flag (INTFLAG.RXC) is set. When the Host pulls the SS line high, the transaction is done and the Transmit Complete Interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.TXC) will be set. After DATA is written it takes up to three SCK clock cycles until the content of DATA is ready to be loaded into the shift register on the next character boundary. As a consequence, the first character transferred in a SPI transaction will not be the content of DATA. This can be avoided by using the preloading feature. Refer to 25.6.3.2. Preloading of the Client Shift Register. When transmitting several characters in one SPI transaction, the data has to be written into DATA register with at least three SCK clock cycles left in the current character transmission. If this criteria is not met, the previously received character will be transmitted. Once the DATA register is empty, it takes three CLK_SERCOM_APB cycles for INTFLAG.DRE to be set. 25.6.2.7 Receiver Error Bit The SPI receiver has one error bit: the Buffer Overflow bit (BUFOVF), which can be read from the Status register (STATUS). Once an error happens, the bit will stay set until it is cleared by writing '1' to it. The bit is also automatically cleared when the receiver is disabled. There are two methods for buffer overflow notification, selected by the immediate buffer overflow notification bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.IBON): If CTRLA.IBON=1, STATUS.BUFOVF is raised immediately upon buffer overflow. Software can then empty the receive FIFO by reading RxDATA until the receiver complete interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.RXC) goes low. If CTRLA.IBON=0, the buffer overflow condition travels with data through the receive FIFO. After the received data is read, STATUS.BUFOVF will be set along with INTFLAG.RXC, and RxDATA will be zero. 25.6.3 Additional Features 25.6.3.1 Address Recognition When the SPI is configured for client operation (CTRLA.MODE=0x2) with address recognition (CTRLA.FORM is 0x2), the SERCOM address recognition logic is enabled: the first character in a transaction is checked for an address match. If there is a match, the Receive Complete Interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.RXC) is set, the MISO output is enabled, and the transaction is processed. If the device is in Sleep mode, an address match can wake-up the device in order to process the transaction. If there is no match, the complete transaction is ignored. If a 9-bit frame format is selected, only the lower 8 bits of the Shift register are checked against the Address register (ADDR). Preload must be disabled (CTRLB.PLOADEN=0) in order to use this mode. Related Links 23.6.3.1. Address Match and Mask © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 359 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.6.3.2 Preloading of the Client Shift Register When starting a transaction, the client will first transmit the contents of the shift register before loading new data from DATA. The first character sent can be either the reset value of the shift register (if this is the first transmission since the last reset) or the last character in the previous transmission. Preloading can be used to preload data into the shift register while SS is high: this eliminates sending a dummy character when starting a transaction. If the shift register is not preloaded, the current contents of the shift register will be shifted out. Only one data character will be preloaded into the shift register while the synchronized SS signal is high. If the next character is written to DATA before SS is pulled low, the second character will be stored in DATA until transfer begins. For proper preloading, sufficient time must elapse between SS going low and the first SCK sampling edge, as in Timing Using Preloading. See also the Electrical Characteristics chapters for timing details. Preloading is enabled by writing '1' to the Client Data Preload Enable bit in the CTRLB register (CTRLB.PLOADEN). Figure 25-4. Timing Using Preloading Required _SS-to-SCK time using PRELOADEN _SS _SS synchronized to system domain SCK Synchronization to system domain MISO to SCK setup time 25.6.3.3 Host with Several Clients If the bus consists of several SPI clients, a SPI host can use general purpose I/O pins to control the SS line to each of the clients on the bus, as shown in the following figure. In this configuration, the single selected SPI client will drive the tri-state MISO line. Figure 25-5. Multiple Clients in Parallel shift register MOSI MISO SCK SS[0] MOSI MISO SCK SS SS[n-1] MOSI MISO shift register SPI Client 0 SPI Host shift register SCK SS SPI Client n-1 Another configuration is multiple clients in series, as shown in the following figure. In this configuration, all n attached clients are connected in series. A common SS line is provided to all clients, enabling them simultaneously. The host must shift n characters for a complete transaction. The SS line is controlled by a normal GPIO. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 360 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface Figure 25-6. Multiple Clients in Series shift register SPI Host MOSI MOSI MISO SCK SS MISO SCK SS MOSI MISO SCK SS shift register SPI Client 0 shift register SPI Client n-1 25.6.3.4 Loop-Back Mode For loop-back mode, configure the Data In Pinout (CTRLA.DIPO) and Data Out Pinout (CTRLA.DOPO) to use the same data pins for transmit and receive. The loop-back is through the pad, so the signal is also available externally. 25.6.4 Interrupts The SPI has the following interrupt sources. These are asynchronous interrupts, and can wake up the device from any sleep mode: • • • Data Register Empty (DRE) Receive Complete (RXC) Transmit Complete (TXC) Each interrupt source has its own interrupt flag. The interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG) will be set when the interrupt condition is met. Each interrupt can be individually enabled by writing '1' to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET), and disabled by writing '1' to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR). An interrupt request is generated when the interrupt flag is set and if the corresponding interrupt is enabled. The interrupt request remains active until either the interrupt flag is cleared, the interrupt is disabled, or the SPI is reset. For details on clearing interrupt flags, refer to the INTFLAG register description. The SPI has one common interrupt request line for all the interrupt sources. The value of INTFLAG indicates which interrupt is executed. Note that interrupts must be globally enabled for interrupt requests. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 25.6.5 Sleep Mode Operation The behavior in Sleep mode is depending on the host/client configuration and the Run In Standby bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.RUNSTDBY): • • • • 25.6.6 Host operation, CTRLA.RUNSTDBY=1: The peripheral clock GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE will continue to run in Idle Sleep mode and in Standby Sleep mode. Any interrupt can wake-up the device. Host operation, CTRLA.RUNSTDBY=0: GLK_SERCOMx_CORE will be disabled after the ongoing transaction is finished. Any interrupt can wake up the device. Client operation, CTRLA.RUNSTDBY=1: The Receive Complete interrupt can wake-up the device. Client operation, CTRLA.RUNSTDBY=0: All reception will be dropped, including the ongoing transaction. Synchronization Due to asynchronicity between the main clock domain and the peripheral clock domains, some registers need to be synchronized when written or read. The following bits are synchronized when written: © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 361 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface • • • Software Reset bit in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.SWRST) Enable bit in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.ENABLE) Receiver Enable bit in the CTRLB register (CTRLB.RXEN) Note:  CTRLB.RXEN is write-synchronized somewhat differently. See also CTRLB register for details. Required write-synchronization is denoted by the "Write-Synchronized" property in the register description. Related Links 13.3. Register Synchronization 25.8.2. CTRLB © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 362 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.7 Register Summary Offset Name 0x00 CTRLA 0x04 CTRLB 0x08 0x09 0x0A 0x0B 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E 0x0F DBGCTRL Reserved BAUD Reserved INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG Reserved 0x10 STATUS 0x12 ... 0x13 Reserved 0x14 ADDR 0x18 DATA 25.8 Bit Pos. 7 6 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 RUNSTDBY DORD PLOADEN AMODE[1:0] 5 4 3 1 MODE[2:0] DIPO[1:0] CPOL CPHA 0 ENABLE SWRST IBON DOPO[1:0] FORM[3:0] CHSIZE[2:0] RXEN DBGSTOP 7:0 BAUD[7:0] 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 15:8 2 RXC RXC RXC TXC TXC TXC DRE DRE DRE BUFOVF SYNCBUSY 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 ADDR[7:0] ADDRMASK[7:0] DATA[7:0] DATA[8] Register Description Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16-, and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers require synchronization when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the "ReadSynchronized" and/or "Write-Synchronized" property in each individual register description. Refer to 25.6.6. Synchronization Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the module is disabled. Enableprotection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in each individual register description. Optional write-protection by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC) is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. Refer to 25.5.7. Register Access Protection. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 363 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.8.1 Control A Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRLA 0x00 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected, Write-Synchronized 31 Access Reset Bit 23 30 DORD R/W 0 29 CPOL R/W 0 22 21 28 CPHA R/W 0 27 R/W 0 20 19 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 18 17 FORM[3:0] DIPO[1:0] Access Reset Bit 16 DOPO[1:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 IBON R/W 0 7 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 6 5 4 3 MODE[2:0] R/W 0 2 1 ENABLE R/W 0 0 SWRST R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit 30 – DORD Data Order This bit selects the data order when a character is shifted out from the shift register. This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 MSB is transferred first. 1 LSB is transferred first. Bit 29 – CPOL Clock Polarity In combination with the Clock Phase bit (CPHA), this bit determines the SPI transfer mode. This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 SCK is low when idle. The leading edge of a clock cycle is a rising edge, while the trailing edge is a falling edge. 1 SCK is high when idle. The leading edge of a clock cycle is a falling edge, while the trailing edge is a rising edge. Bit 28 – CPHA Clock Phase In combination with the Clock Polarity bit (CPOL), this bit determines the SPI transfer mode. This bit is not synchronized. Mode CPOL CPHA Leading Edge Trailing Edge 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 Rising, sample Rising, change Falling, sample Falling, change Falling, change Falling, sample Rising, change Rising, sample Value 0 1 Description The data is sampled on a leading SCK edge and changed on a trailing SCK edge. The data is sampled on a trailing SCK edge and changed on a leading SCK edge. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 364 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface Bits 27:24 – FORM[3:0] Frame Format This bit field selects the various frame formats supported by the SPI in client mode. When the 'SPI frame with address' format is selected, the first byte received is checked against the ADDR register. FORM[3:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3-0xF SPI SPI_ADDR - SPI frame Reserved SPI frame with address Reserved Bits 21:20 – DIPO[1:0] Data In Pinout These bits define the data in (DI) pad configurations. In host operation, DI is MISO. In client operation, DI is MOSI. These bits are not synchronized. DIPO[1:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 PAD[0] PAD[1] PAD[2] PAD[3] SERCOM PAD[0] is used as data input SERCOM PAD[1] is used as data input SERCOM PAD[2] is used as data input SERCOM PAD[3] is used as data input Bits 17:16 – DOPO[1:0] Data Out Pinout This bit defines the available pad configurations for data out (DO), the serial clock (SCK) and the SPI select (SS). In Client operation, the SPI Select line (SS) is controlled by DOPO. In host operation, DO is MOSI. In client operation, DO is MISO. These bits are not synchronized. DOPO DO SCK Client SS Host SS 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 PAD[0] PAD[2] PAD[3] PAD[0] PAD[1] PAD[3] PAD[1] PAD[3] PAD[2] PAD[1] PAD[2] PAD[1] PAD[2] PAD[1] PAD[2] PAD[1] Bit 8 – IBON Immediate Buffer Overflow Notification This bit controls when the buffer overflow status bit (STATUS.BUFOVF) is set when a buffer overflow occurs. This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 STATUS.BUFOVF is set when it occurs in the data stream. 1 STATUS.BUFOVF is set immediately upon buffer overflow. Bit 7 – RUNSTDBY Run In Standby This bit defines the functionality in standby sleep mode. These bits are not synchronized. RUNSTDBY Client Host 0x0 Disabled. All reception is dropped, including the ongoing transaction. Ongoing transaction continues, wake on Receive Complete interrupt. Generic clock is disabled when ongoing transaction is finished. All interrupts can wake up the device. Generic clock is enabled while in sleep modes. All interrupts can wake up the device. 0x1 Bits 4:2 – MODE[2:0] Operating Mode These bits must be written to 0x2 or 0x3 to select the SPI serial communication interface of the SERCOM. 0x2: SPI client operation 0x3: SPI host operation These bits are not synchronized. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 365 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable Due to synchronization, there is delay from writing CTRLA.ENABLE until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to CTRL.ENABLE will read back immediately and the Synchronization Enable Busy bit in the Synchronization Busy register (SYNCBUSY.ENABLE) will be set. SYNCBUSY.ENABLE is cleared when the operation is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 The peripheral is disabled or being disabled. 1 The peripheral is enabled or being enabled. Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit resets all registers in the SERCOM, except DBGCTRL, to their initial state, and the SERCOM will be disabled. Writing ''1' to CTRL.SWRST will always take precedence, meaning that all other writes in the same write-operation will be discarded. Any register write access during the ongoing reset will result in an APB error. Reading any register will return the reset value of the register. Due to synchronization, there is a delay from writing CTRLA.SWRST until the reset is complete. CTRLA.SWRST and SYNCBUSY. SWRST will both be cleared when the reset is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 There is no reset operation ongoing. 1 The reset operation is ongoing. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 366 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.8.2 Control B Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRLB 0x04 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 RXEN R/W 0 16 13 12 11 10 9 8 5 4 3 2 1 CHSIZE[2:0] R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 15 14 AMODE[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit 7 6 PLOADEN R/W 0 Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit 17 – RXEN Receiver Enable Writing '0' to this bit will disable the SPI receiver immediately. The receive buffer will be flushed, data from ongoing receptions will be lost and STATUS.BUFOVF will be cleared. Writing '1' to CTRLB.RXEN when the SPI is disabled will set CTRLB.RXEN immediately. When the SPI is enabled, CTRLB.RXEN will be cleared, SYNCBUSY.CTRLB will be set and remain set until the receiver is enabled. When the receiver is enabled CTRLB.RXEN will read back as '1'. Writing '1' to CTRLB.RXEN when the SPI is enabled will set SYNCBUSY.CTRLB, which will remain set until the receiver is enabled, and CTRLB.RXEN will read back as '1'. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 The receiver is disabled or being enabled. 1 The receiver is enabled or it will be enabled when SPI is enabled. Bits 15:14 – AMODE[1:0] Address Mode These bits set the Client addressing mode when the frame format (CTRLA.FORM) with address is used. They are unused in Host mode. AMODE[1:0] Name 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 Description MASK ADDRMASK is used as a mask to the ADDR register 2_ADDRS The Client responds to the two unique addresses in ADDR and ADDRMASK RANGE The Client responds to the range of addresses between and including ADDR and ADDRMASK. ADDR is the upper limit Reserved Bit 6 – PLOADEN Client Data Preload Enable Setting this bit will enable preloading of the Client shift register when there is no transfer in progress. If the SS line is high when DATA is written, it will be transferred immediately to the shift register. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 367 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface Bits 2:0 – CHSIZE[2:0] Character Size CHSIZE[2:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2-0x7 8BIT 9BIT - 8 bits 9 bits Reserved © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 368 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.8.3 Debug Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit DBGCTRL 0x08 0x00 PAC Write-Protection 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 0 DBGSTOP R/W 0 Bit 0 – DBGSTOP Debug Stop Mode This bit controls the functionality when the CPU is halted by an external debugger. Value Description 0 The baud-rate generator continues normal operation when the CPU is halted by an external debugger. 1 The baud-rate generator is halted when the CPU is halted by an external debugger. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 369 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.8.4 Baud Rate Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit BAUD 0x0A 0x00 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 BAUD[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 7:0 – BAUD[7:0] Baud Register These bits control the clock generation, as described in the SERCOM Clock Generation – Baud-Rate Generator. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 370 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.8.5 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENCLR 0x0C 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to disable an interrupt without read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 RXC R/W 0 1 TXC R/W 0 0 DRE R/W 0 Bit 2 – RXC Receive Complete Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Receive Complete Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Receive Complete interrupt. Value Description 0 Receive Complete interrupt is disabled. 1 Receive Complete interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – TXC Transmit Complete Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Transmit Complete Interrupt Enable bit, which disable the Transmit Complete interrupt. Value Description 0 Transmit Complete interrupt is disabled. 1 Transmit Complete interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – DRE Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Data Register Empty interrupt. Value Description 0 Data Register Empty interrupt is disabled. 1 Data Register Empty interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 371 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.8.6 Interrupt Enable Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENSET 0x0D 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to disable an interrupt without read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 RXC R/W 0 1 TXC R/W 0 0 DRE R/W 0 Bit 2 – RXC Receive Complete Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will set the Receive Complete Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Receive Complete interrupt. Value Description 0 Receive Complete interrupt is disabled. 1 Receive Complete interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – TXC Transmit Complete Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will set the Transmit Complete Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Transmit Complete interrupt. Value Description 0 Transmit Complete interrupt is disabled. 1 Transmit Complete interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – DRE Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will set the Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Data Register Empty interrupt. Value Description 0 Data Register Empty interrupt is disabled. 1 Data Register Empty interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 372 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.8.7 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTFLAG 0x0E 0x00 - 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 RXC R 0 1 TXC R/W 0 0 DRE R 0 Bit 2 – RXC Receive Complete This flag is cleared by reading the Data (DATA) register or by disabling the receiver. This flag is set when there are unread data in the receive buffer. If address matching is enabled, the first data received in a transaction will be an address. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit has no effect. Bit 1 – TXC Transmit Complete This flag is cleared by writing '1' to it or by writing new data to DATA. In Host mode, this flag is set when the data have been shifted out and there are no new data in DATA. In Client mode, this flag is set when the SS pin is pulled high. If address matching is enabled, this flag is only set if the transaction was initiated with an address match. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the flag. Bit 0 – DRE Data Register Empty This flag is cleared by writing new data to DATA. This flag is set when DATA is empty and ready for new data to transmit. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit has no effect. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 373 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.8.8 Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit STATUS 0x10 0x0000 – 15 SYNCBUSY R/W 0 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 BUFOVF R/W 0 1 0 Access Reset Bit 15 – SYNCBUSY Synchronization Busy This bit is cleared when the synchronization of registers between the clock domains is complete. This bit is set when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is in progress. Bit 2 – BUFOVF Buffer Overflow Reading this bit before reading DATA will indicate the error status of the next character to be read. This bit is cleared by writing '1' to the bit or by disabling the receiver. This bit is set when a buffer overflow condition is detected. See also CTRLA.IBON for overflow handling. When set, the corresponding RxDATA will be zero. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear it. Value Description 0 No Buffer Overflow has occurred. 1 A Buffer Overflow has occurred. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 374 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.8.9 Address Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit ADDR 0x14 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected 31 30 29 28 23 22 21 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 7 6 5 4 27 26 25 24 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 20 19 ADDRMASK[7:0] R/W R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit ADDR[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 23:16 – ADDRMASK[7:0] Address Mask These bits hold the address mask when the transaction format with address is used (CTRLA.FORM, CTRLB.AMODE). Bits 7:0 – ADDR[7:0] Address These bits hold the address when the transaction format with address is used (CTRLA.FORM, CTRLB.AMODE). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 375 SAM D20 Family SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface 25.8.10 Data Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit DATA 0x18 0x0000 – 15 14 13 12 7 6 5 4 11 10 9 8 DATA[8] R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit DATA[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 8:0 – DATA[8:0] Data Reading these bits will return the contents of the receive data buffer. The register should be read only when the Receive Complete Interrupt Flag bit in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.RXC) is set. Writing these bits will write the transmit data buffer. This register should be written only when the Data Register Empty Interrupt Flag bit in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.DRE) is set. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 376 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26. SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.1 Overview The inter-integrated circuit ( I2C) interface is one of the available modes in the serial communication interface (SERCOM). The I2C interface uses the SERCOM transmitter and receiver configured as shown in Figure 26-1. Labels in capital letters are registers accessible by the CPU, while lowercase labels are internal to the SERCOM. A SERCOM instance can be configured to be either an I2C host or an I2C client. Both host and client have an interface containing a shift register, a transmit buffer and a receive buffer. In addition, the I2C host uses the SERCOM baud-rate generator, while the I2C client uses the SERCOM address match logic. Related Links 23. SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface 26.2 Features SERCOM I2C includes the following features: • • • • • • 26.3 Host or Client operation Philips I2C compatible SMBus™ compatible Support of 100 kHz and 400 kHz I2C mode low system clock frequencies Physical interface includes: – Slew-rate limited outputs – Filtered inputs Client operation: – Operation in all sleep modes – Wake-up on address match – 7-bit Address match in hardware for: – • Unique address and/or 7-bit general call address • Address range • Two unique addresses Block Diagram Figure 26-1. I2C Single-Host Single-Client Interconnection Host BAUD TxDATA 0 baud rate generator Client TxDATA SCL SCL hold low 0 SCL hold low shift register shift register 0 SDA 0 RxDATA © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries ADDR/ADDRMASK RxDATA Complete Datasheet == DS60001504F-page 377 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.4 Signal Description Signal Name Type Description PAD[0] Digital I/O SDA PAD[1] Digital I/O SCL PAD[2] Digital I/O SDA_OUT (4-wire operation) PAD[3] Digital I/O SCL_OUT (4-wire operation) One signal can be mapped on several pins. Not all the pins are I2C pins. The pins supporting the 400 kHz I2C mode are detailed in Table 6-1. PORT Function Multiplexing (see column "type”). Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 26.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. 26.5.1 I/O Lines In order to use the I/O lines of this peripheral, the I/O pins must be configured using the I/O Pin Controller (PORT). When the SERCOM is used in I2C mode, the SERCOM controls the direction and value of the I/O pins. Both PORT control bits PINCFGn.PULLEN and PINCFGn.DRVSTR are still effective. If the receiver or transmitter is disabled, these pins can be used for other purposes. Related Links 21. PORT - I/O Pin Controller 26.5.2 Power Management This peripheral can continue to operate in any sleep mode where its source clock is running. The interrupts can wake up the device from sleep modes. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 26.5.3 Clocks The SERCOM bus clock (CLK_SERCOMx_APB) can be enabled and disabled in the Power Manager. Refer to Peripheral Clock Masking for details and default status of this clock. Two generic clocks are used by SERCOM: GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE and GCLK_SERCOM_SLOW. The core clock (GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE) can clock the I2C when working as a host. The slow clock (GCLK_SERCOM_SLOW) is required only for certain functions, e.g. SMBus timing. These two clocks must be configured and enabled in the Generic Clock Controller (GCLK) before using the I2C. These generic clocks are asynchronous to the bus clock (CLK_SERCOMx_APB). Due to this asynchronicity, writes to certain registers will require synchronization between the clock domains. Refer to 26.6.6. Synchronization for further details. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 15. Power Manager (PM) 26.5.4 Interrupts The interrupt request line is connected to the Interrupt Controller. In order to use interrupt requests of this peripheral, the Interrupt Controller (NVIC) must be configured first. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 378 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 26.5.5 Events Not applicable. 26.5.6 Debug Operation When the CPU is halted in debug mode, this peripheral will continue normal operation. If the peripheral is configured to require periodical service by the CPU through interrupts or similar, improper operation or data loss may result during debugging. This peripheral can be forced to halt operation during debugging - refer to the Debug Control (DBGCTRL) register for details. Related Links 26.10.3. DBGCTRL 26.5.7 Register Access Protection Registers with write-access can be write-protected optionally by the peripheral access controller (PAC). PAC Write-Protection is not available for the following registers: • • • • Interrupt Flag Clear and Status register (INTFLAG) Status register (STATUS) Data register (DATA) Address register (ADDR) Optional PAC Write-Protection is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. Write-protection does not apply to accesses through an external debugger. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller 26.5.8 Analog Connections Not applicable. 26.6 Functional Description 26.6.1 Principle of Operation The I2C interface uses two physical lines for communication: • Serial Data Line (SDA) for data transfer • Serial Clock Line (SCL) for the bus clock A transaction starts with the I2C host sending the Start condition, followed by a 7-bit address and a direction bit (read or write to/from the client). The addressed I2C client will then Acknowledge (ACK) the address, and data packet transactions can begin. Every 9-bit data packet consists of 8 data bits followed by a one-bit reply indicating whether the data was acknowledged or not. If a data packet is Not Acknowledged (NACK), whether by the I2C client or host, the I2C host takes action by either terminating the transaction by sending the Stop condition, or by sending a repeated start to transfer more data. The figure below illustrates the possible transaction formats and Transaction Diagram Symbols explains the transaction symbols. These symbols will be used in the following descriptions. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 379 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit Figure 26-2. Transaction Diagram Symbols Bus Driver Special Bus Conditions Host driving bus S START condition Client driving bus Sr repeated START condition Either Host or Client driving bus P STOP condition Data Package Direction R Acknowledge Host Read '0' '1' W Acknowledge (ACK) A A Host Write Not Acknowledge (NACK) '1' '0' Figure 26-3. Basic I2C Transaction Diagram SDA SCL 6..0 S ADDRESS S ADDRESS 7..0 R/W R/W ACK DATA A DATA 7..0 ACK A DATA ACK/NACK DATA A/A P P Direction Address Packet Data Packet #0 Data Packet #1 Transaction 26.6.2 Basic Operation 26.6.2.1 Initialization The following registers are enable-protected, meaning they can be written only when the I2C interface is disabled (CTRLA.ENABLE is ‘0’): • Control A register (CTRLA), except Enable (CTRLA.ENABLE) and Software Reset (CTRLA.SWRST) bits • Control B register (CTRLB), except Acknowledge Action (CTRLB.ACKACT) and Command (CTRLB.CMD) bits • Baud register (BAUD) • Address register (ADDR) in client operation. When the I2C is enabled or is being enabled (CTRLA.ENABLE=1), writing to these registers will be discarded. If the I2C is being disabled, writing to these registers will be completed after the disabling. Enable-protection is denoted by the "Enable-Protection" property in the register description. Before the I2C is enabled it must be configured as outlined by the following steps: © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 380 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Select I2C Host or Client mode by writing 0x4 (Client mode) or 0x5 (Host mode) to the Operating Mode bits in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.MODE). If desired, select the SDA Hold Time value in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.SDAHOLD). If desired, enable smart operation by setting the Smart Mode Enable bit in the CTRLB register (CTRLB.SMEN). If desired, enable SCL low time-out by setting the SCL Low Time-Out bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.LOWTOUTEN). In Host mode: a. Select the inactive bus time-out in the Inactive Time-Out bit group in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.INACTOUT). b. Write the Baud Rate register (BAUD) to generate the desired baud rate. In Client mode: a. Configure the address match configuration by writing the Address Mode value in the CTRLB register (CTRLB.AMODE). b. Set the Address and Address Mask value in the Address register (ADDR.ADDR and ADDR.ADDRMASK) according to the address configuration. 26.6.2.2 Enabling, Disabling, and Resetting This peripheral is enabled by writing '1' to the Enable bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.ENABLE), and disabled by writing '0' to it. Refer to CTRLA regsiter for details. Related Links 26.10.1. CTRLA 26.6.2.3 I2C Bus State Logic The Bus state logic includes several logic blocks that continuously monitor the activity on the I2C bus lines in all Sleep modes with running GCLK_SERCOM_x clocks. The start and stop detectors and the bit counter are all essential in the process of determining the current Bus state. The Bus state is determined according to Bus State Diagram. Software can get the current Bus state by reading the Host Bus State bits in the Status register (STATUS.BUSSTATE). The value of STATUS.BUSSTATE in the figure is shown in binary. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 381 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit Figure 26-4. Bus State Diagram RESET UNKNOWN (0b00) Timeout or Stop Condition Start Condition IDLE (0b01) Timeout or Stop Condition BUSY (0b11) Write ADDR to generate Start Condition OWNER (0b10) Lost Arbitration Repeated Start Condition Stop Condition Write ADDR to generate Repeated Start Condition The Bus state machine is active when the I2C host is enabled. After the I2C host has been enabled, the Bus state is UNKNOWN (0b00). From the UNKNOWN state, the bus will transition to IDLE (0b01) by either: • Forcing by writing 0b01 to STATUS.BUSSTATE • A Stop condition is detected on the bus • If the inactive bus time-out is configured for SMBus compatibility (CTRLA.INACTOUT) and a time-out occurs. Note:  Once a known Bus state is established, the Bus state logic will not re-enter the UNKNOWN state. When the bus is IDLE it is ready for a new transaction. If a Start condition is issued on the bus by another I2C host in a multi-host setup, the bus becomes BUSY (0b11). The bus will re-enter IDLE either when a Stop condition is detected, or when a time-out occurs (inactive bus time-out needs to be configured). If a Start condition is generated internally by writing the Address bit group in the Address register (ADDR.ADDR) while IDLE, the OWNER state (0b10) is entered. If the complete transaction was performed without interference, i.e., arbitration was not lost, the I2C host can issue a Stop condition, which will change the Bus state back to IDLE. However, if a packet collision is detected while in OWNER state, the arbitration is assumed lost and the Bus state becomes BUSY until a Stop condition is detected. A repeated Start condition will change the Bus state only if arbitration is lost while issuing a repeated start. Note:  Violating the protocol may cause the I2C to hang. If this happens it is possible to recover from this state by a software Reset (CTRLA.SWRST='1'). Related Links 26.10.1. CTRLA 26.6.2.4 I2C Host Operation The I2C Host is byte-oriented and interrupt based. The number of interrupts generated is kept at a minimum by automatic handling of most incidents. The software driver complexity and code size are reduced by auto-triggering of operations, and a Special Smart mode, which can be enabled by the Smart Mode Enable bit in the Control B register (CTRLB.SMEN). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 382 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit When SCL Stretch Mode (CTRLA.SCLSM) is '0', SCL is stretched before or after the Acknowledge bit . In this mode the I2C Host operates according to Host Behavioral Diagram (SCLSM=0). The circles labeled "Mn" (M1, M2..) indicate the nodes the bus logic can jump to, based on software or hardware interaction. This diagram is used as reference for the description of the I2C Host operation throughout the document. Figure 26-5. I2C Host Behavioral Diagram APPLICATION HOST BUS INTERRUPT + SCL HOLD M1 M2 BUSY P M3 IDLE S M4 ADDRESS Wait for IDLE SW R/W BUSY SW R/W A SW P SW Sr W A M1 BUSY M2 IDLE M3 BUSY DATA SW A/A CLIENT BUS INTERRUPT + SCL HOLD SW Software interaction SW A BUSY The host provides data on the bus A/A Addressed client provides data on the bus A/A Sr P IDLE M4 M2 M3 A/A R A DATA Host Clock Generation The SERCOM peripheral supports several I2C bidirectional modes: • Standard mode (Sm) up to 100 kHz • Fast mode (Fm) up to 400 kHz The Host clock configuration for Sm and Fm are described as follows: Clock Generation (Standard-Mode, Fast-Mode, and Fast-Mode Plus) In I2C Sm and Fm mode, the Host clock (SCL) frequency is determined as described in this section: The low (TLOW) and high (THIGH) times are determined by the Baud Rate register (BAUD), while the rise (TRISE) and fall (TFALL) times are determined by the bus topology. Because of the wired-AND logic of the bus, TFALL will be considered as part of TLOW. Similarly, TRISE will be in a state between TLOW and THIGH until a high state has been detected. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 383 M4 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit Figure 26-6. SCL Timing TRISE P S Sr TLOW SCL THIGH TFALL TBUF SDA TSU;STO THD;STA TSU;STA The following parameters are timed using the SCL low time period TLOW. This comes from the Host Baud Rate Low bit group in the Baud Rate register (BAUD.BAUDLOW). When BAUD.BAUDLOW=0, or the Host Baud Rate bit group in the Baud Rate register (BAUD.BAUD) determines it. • TLOW – Low period of SCL clock • TSU;STO – Set-up time for stop condition • TBUF – Bus free time between stop and start conditions • THD;STA – Hold time (repeated) start condition • TSU;STA – Set-up time for repeated start condition • THIGH is timed using the SCL high time count from BAUD.BAUD • TRISE is determined by the bus impedance; for internal pull-ups. Refer to Electrical Characteristics. • TFALL is determined by the open-drain current limit and bus impedance; can typically be regarded as zero. Refer to Electrical Characteristics for details. The SCL frequency is given by: fSCL = 1 TLOW + THIGH + TRISE fSCL = fGCLK 10 + 2BAUD + fGCLK ⋅ TRISE fSCL = fGCLK 10 + BAUD + BAUDLOW + fGCLK ⋅ TRISE When BAUD.BAUDLOW is zero, the BAUD.BAUD value is used to time both SCL high and SCL low. In this case the following formula will give the SCL frequency: When BAUD.BAUDLOW is non-zero, the following formula determines the SCL frequency: The following formulas can determine the SCL TLOW and THIGH times: TLOW = BAUDLOW + 5 fGCLK THIGH = BAUD + 5 fGCLK Startup Timing The minimum time between SDA transition and SCL rising edge is 6 APB cycles when the DATA register is written in smart mode. If a greater startup time is required due to long rise times, the time between DATA write and IF clear must be controlled by software. Note:  When timing is controlled by user, the Smart Mode cannot be enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 384 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit Transmitting Address Packets The I2C Host starts a bus transaction by writing the I2C Client address to ADDR.ADDR and the direction bit, as described in 26.6.1. Principle of Operation. If the bus is busy, the I2C Host will wait until the bus becomes idle before continuing the operation. When the bus is idle, the I2C Host will issue a start condition on the bus. The I2C Host will then transmit an address packet using the address written to ADDR.ADDR. After the address packet has been transmitted by the I2C Host, one of four cases will arise according to arbitration and transfer direction. Case 1: Arbitration lost or bus error during address packet transmission If arbitration was lost during transmission of the address packet, the Host on Bus bit in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.MB) and the Arbitration Lost bit in the Status register (STATUS.ARBLOST) are both set. Serial data output to SDA is disabled, and the SCL is released, which disables clock stretching. In effect the I2C Host is no longer allowed to execute any operation on the bus until the bus is idle again. A bus error will behave similarly to the arbitration lost condition. In this case, the MB interrupt flag and Host Bus Error bit in the Status register (STATUS.BUSERR) are both set in addition to STATUS.ARBLOST. The Host Received Not Acknowledge bit in the Status register (STATUS.RXNACK) will always contain the last successfully received acknowledge or not acknowledge indication. In this case, software will typically inform the application code of the condition and then clear the interrupt flag before exiting the interrupt routine. No other flags have to be cleared at this moment, because all flags will be cleared automatically the next time the ADDR.ADDR register is written. Case 2: Address packet transmit complete – No ACK received If there is no I2C Client device responding to the address packet, then the INTFLAG.MB interrupt flag and STATUS.RXNACK will be set. The clock hold is active at this point, preventing further activity on the bus. The missing ACK response can indicate that the I2C Client is busy with other tasks or sleeping. Therefore, it is not able to respond. In this event, the next step can be either issuing a stop condition (recommended) or resending the address packet by a repeated start condition. When using SMBus logic, the Client must ACK the address. If there is no response, it means that the Client is not available on the bus. Case 3: Address packet transmit complete – Write packet, Host on Bus set If the I2C Host receives an acknowledge response from the I2C Client, INTFLAG.MB will be set and STATUS.RXNACK will be cleared. The clock hold is active at this point, preventing further activity on the bus. In this case, the software implementation becomes highly protocol dependent. Three possible actions can enable the I2C operation to continue: • Initiate a data transmit operation by writing the data byte to be transmitted into DATA.DATA. • Transmit a new address packet by writing ADDR.ADDR. A repeated start condition will automatically be inserted before the address packet. • Issue a stop condition, consequently terminating the transaction. Case 4: Address packet transmit complete – Read packet, Client on Bus set If the I2C Host receives an ACK from the I2C Client, the I2C Host proceeds to receive the next byte of data from the I2C Client. When the first data byte is received, the Client on Bus bit in the Interrupt Flag register (INTFLAG.SB) will be set and STATUS.RXNACK will be cleared. The clock hold is active at this point, preventing further activity on the bus. In this case, the software implementation becomes highly protocol dependent. Three possible actions can enable the I2C operation to continue: • Let the I2C Host continue to read data by acknowledging the data received. ACK can be sent by software, or automatically in smart mode. • Transmit a new address packet. • Terminate the transaction by issuing a stop condition. Note:  An ACK or NACK will be automatically transmitted if smart mode is enabled. The Acknowledge Action bit in the Control B register (CTRLB.ACKACT) determines whether ACK or NACK should be sent. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 385 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit Transmitting Data Packets When an address packet with direction Host Write (see Figure 26-3) was transmitted successfully , INTFLAG.MB will be set. The I2C Host will start transmitting data via the I2C bus by writing to DATA.DATA, and monitor continuously for packet collisions. If a collision is detected, the I2C Host will lose arbitration and STATUS.ARBLOST will be set. If the transmit was successful, the I2C Host will receive an ACK bit from the I2C Client, and STATUS.RXNACK will be cleared. INTFLAG.MB will be set in both cases, regardless of arbitration outcome. It is recommended to read STATUS.ARBLOST and handle the arbitration lost condition in the beginning of the I2C Host on Bus interrupt. This can be done as there is no difference between handling address and data packet arbitration. STATUS.RXNACK must be checked for each data packet transmitted before the next data packet transmission can commence. The I2C Host is not allowed to continue transmitting data packets if a NACK is received from the I2C Client. Receiving Data Packets When INTFLAG.SB is set, the I2C Host will already have received one data packet. The I2C Host must respond by sending either an ACK or NACK. Sending a NACK may be unsuccessful when arbitration is lost during the transmission. In this case, a lost arbitration will prevent setting INTFLAG.SB. Instead, INTFLAG.MB will indicate a change in arbitration. Handling of lost arbitration is the same as for data bit transmission. 26.6.2.5 I2C Client Operation The I2C Client is byte-oriented and interrupt-based. The number of interrupts generated is kept at a minimum by automatic handling of most events. The software driver complexity and code size are reduced by auto-triggering of operations, and a special smart mode, which can be enabled by the Smart Mode Enable bit in the Control B register (CTRLB.SMEN). This diagram is used as reference for the description of the I2C Client operation throughout the document. Figure 26-7. I2C Client Behavioral Diagram AMATCH INTERRUPT S1 S3 S2 S DRDY INTERRUPT A ADDRESS R S W S1 S2 Sr S3 S W A A P S1 P S2 Sr S3 DATA PREC INTERRUPT W Interrupt on STOP Condition Enabled S W S W A DATA S W A/A S W Software interaction The host provides data on the bus Addressed client provides data on the bus © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 386 A/A SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit Receiving Address Packets When a start condition is detected, the successive address packet will be received and checked by the address match logic. If the received address is not a match, the packet will be rejected, and the I2C Client will wait for a new start condition. If the received address is a match, the Address Match bit in the Interrupt Flag register (INTFLAG.AMATCH) will be set. SCL will be stretched until the I2C Client clears INTFLAG.AMATCH. As the I2C Client holds the clock by forcing SCL low, the software has unlimited time to respond. The direction of a transaction is determined by reading the Read / Write Direction bit in the Status register (STATUS.DIR). This bit will be updated only when a valid address packet is received. If the Transmit Collision bit in the Status register (STATUS.COLL) is set, this indicates that the last packet addressed to the I2C Client had a packet collision. A collision causes the SDA and SCL lines to be released without any notification to software. Therefore, the next AMATCH interrupt is the first indication of the previous packet’s collision. Collisions are intended to follow the SMBus Address Resolution Protocol (ARP). After the address packet has been received from the I2C Host, one of two cases will arise based on transfer direction. Case 1: Address packet accepted – Read flag set The STATUS.DIR bit is ‘1’, indicating an I2C Host read operation. The SCL line is forced low, stretching the bus clock. If an ACK is sent, I2C Client hardware will set the Data Ready bit in the Interrupt Flag register (INTFLAG.DRDY), indicating data are needed for transmit. If a NACK is sent, the I2C Client will wait for a new start condition and address match. Typically, software will immediately acknowledge the address packet by sending an ACK/NACK bit. The I2C Client Command bit field in the Control B register (CTRLB.CMD) can be written to '0x3' for both read and write operations as the command execution is dependent on the STATUS.DIR bit. Writing ‘1’ to INTFLAG.AMATCH will also cause an ACK/NACK to be sent corresponding to the CTRLB.ACKACT bit. Case 2: Address packet accepted – Write flag set The STATUS.DIR bit is cleared, indicating an I2C Host write operation. The SCL line is forced low, stretching the bus clock. If an ACK is sent, the I2C Client will wait for data to be received. Data, repeated start or stop can be received. If a NACK is sent, the I2C Client will wait for a new start condition and address match. Typically, software will immediately acknowledge the address packet by sending an ACK/NACK. The I2C Client command CTRLB.CMD = 3 can be used for both read and write operation as the command execution is dependent on STATUS.DIR. Writing ‘1’ to INTFLAG.AMATCH will also cause an ACK/NACK to be sent corresponding to the CTRLB.ACKACT bit. Receiving and Transmitting Data Packets After the I2C Client has received an address packet, it will respond according to the direction either by waiting for the data packet to be received or by starting to send a data packet by writing to DATA.DATA. When a data packet is received or sent, INTFLAG.DRDY will be set. After receiving data, the I2C Client will send an acknowledge according to CTRLB.ACKACT. Case 1: Data received INTFLAG.DRDY is set, and SCL is held low, pending for SW interaction. Case 2: Data sent When a byte transmission is successfully completed, the INTFLAG.DRDY interrupt flag is set. If NACK is received, indicated by STATUS.RXNACK=1, the I2C Client must expect a stop or a repeated start to be received. The I2C Client must release the data line to allow the I2C Host to generate a stop or repeated start. Upon detecting a stop condition, the Stop Received bit in the Interrupt Flag register (INTFLAG.PREC) will be set and the I2C Client will return to IDLE state. 26.6.3 Additional Features 26.6.3.1 SMBus The I2C includes three hardware SCL low time-outs which allow a time-out to occur for SMBus SCL low time-out, host extend time-out, and client extend time-out. This allows for SMBus functionality These time-outs are driven by the GCLK_SERCOM_SLOW clock. The GCLK_SERCOM_SLOW clock is used to accurately time the time-out and © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 387 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit must be configured to use a 32.768 kHz oscillator. The I2C interface also allows for a SMBus compatible SDA hold time. • • • TTIMEOUT: SCL low time of 25..35ms – Measured for a single SCL low period. It is enabled by CTRLA.LOWTOUTEN. TLOW:SEXT: Cumulative clock low extend time of 25 ms – Measured as the cumulative SCL low extend time by a client device in a single message from the initial START to the STOP. It is enabled by CTRLA.SEXTTOEN. TLOW:MEXT: Cumulative clock low extend time of 10 ms – Measured as the cumulative SCL low extend time by the host device within a single byte from START-to-ACK, ACK-to-ACK, or ACK-to-STOP. It is enabled by CTRLA.MEXTTOEN. 26.6.3.2 Smart Mode The I2C interface has a smart mode that simplifies application code and minimizes the user interaction needed to adhere to the I2C protocol. The smart mode accomplishes this by automatically issuing an ACK or NACK (based on the content of CTRLB.ACKACT) as soon as DATA.DATA is read. 26.6.3.3 4-Wire Mode Writing a '1' to the Pin Usage bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.PINOUT) will enable 4-Wire mode operation. In this mode, the internal I2C tri-state drivers are bypassed, and an external I2C compliant tri-state driver is needed when connecting to an I2C bus. Figure 26-8. I2C Pad Interface SCL_OUT/ SDA_OUT SCL_OUT/ SDA_OUT pad PINOUT I2C Driver SCL/SDA pad SCL_IN/ SDA_IN PINOUT 26.6.3.4 Quick Command Setting the Quick Command Enable bit in the Control B register (CTRLB.QCEN) enables quick command. When quick command is enabled, the corresponding Interrupt flag (INTFLAG.SB or INTFLAG.MB) is set immediately after the client acknowledges the address. At this point, the software can either issue a Stop command or a repeated start by writing CTRLB.CMD or ADDR.ADDR. 26.6.4 Interrupts The I2C Client has the following interrupt sources. These are asynchronous interrupts. They can wake-up the device from any sleep mode: • • • Data Ready (DRDY) Address Match (AMATCH) Stop Received (PREC) The I2C Host has the following interrupt sources. These are asynchronous interrupts. They can wake-up the device from any sleep mode: • • Client on Bus (SB) Host on Bus (MB) Each interrupt source has its own interrupt flag. The interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG) will be set when the interrupt condition is meet. Each interrupt can be individually enabled by writing ‘1’ to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET), and disabled by writing ‘1’ to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR). An interrupt request is generated when the interrupt flag is set and the corresponding interrupt is enabled. The interrupt request active until the interrupt flag is cleared, the interrupt is disabled or the I2C is reset. Refer to INTFLAG register for details on how to clear interrupt flags. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 388 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit The I2C has one common interrupt request line for all the interrupt sources. The value of INTFLAG indicates which interrupt is executed. Note that interrupts must be globally enabled for interrupt requests. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 26.10.7. INTFLAG 26.6.5 Sleep Mode Operation I2C Host Operation The generic clock (GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE) will continue to run in idle sleep mode. If the Run In Standby bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.RUNSTDBY) is '1', the GLK_SERCOMx_CORE will also run in Standby Sleep mode. Any interrupt can wake-up the device. If CTRLA.RUNSTDBY=0, the GLK_SERCOMx_CORE will be disabled after any ongoing transaction is finished. Any interrupt can wake-up the device. I2C Client Operation Writing CTRLA.RUNSTDBY=1 will allow the Address Match interrupt to wake-up the device. When CTRLA.RUNSTDBY=0, all receptions will be dropped. 26.6.6 Synchronization Due to asynchronicity between the main clock domain and the peripheral clock domains, some registers need to be synchronized when written or read. The following bits are synchronized when written: • • • • • Software Reset bit in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.SWRST) Enable bit in the CTRLA register (CTRLA.ENABLE) Command bits in CTRLB register (CTRLB.CMD) Write to Bus State bits in the Status register (STATUS.BUSSTATE) Address bits in the Address register (ADDR.ADDR) when in host operation. The following registers are synchronized when written: • Data (DATA) when in host operation Required write-synchronization is denoted by the "Write-Synchronized" property in the register description. Related Links 13.3. Register Synchronization © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 389 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.7 Register Summary - I2C Client Offset Name 0x00 CTRLA 0x04 7 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 RUNSTDBY CTRLB 0x08 ... 0x0B 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E 0x0F INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG Reserved 0x10 STATUS 0x12 ... 0x13 Reserved 0x14 ADDR 0x18 DATA 26.8 Bit Pos. 6 5 4 3 2 MODE[2:0] 1 0 ENABLE SWRST SDAHOLD[1:0] PINOUT LOWTOUT AMODE[1:0] ACKACT SMEN CMD[1:0] Reserved 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 15:8 CLKHOLD SYNCBUSY LOWTOUT 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 SR DIR ADDR[6:0] DRDY DRDY DRDY AMATCH AMATCH AMATCH PREC PREC PREC RXNACK COLL BUSERR GENCEN ADDR[7] ADDRMASK[6:0] DATA[7:0] Register Description - I2C Client Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16- and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers are optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC). Optional PAC writeprotection is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. For details, refer to Register Access Protection. Some registers are synchronized when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the "WriteSynchronized" or the "Read-Synchronized" property in each individual register description. For details, refer to 26.6.6. Synchronization. Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the peripheral is disabled. Enableprotection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 390 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.8.1 Control A Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRLA 0x00 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected, Write-Synchronized 31 30 LOWTOUT R/W 0 23 22 15 14 13 7 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 6 5 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 29 28 27 26 25 24 19 18 17 16 PINOUT R/W 0 12 11 10 9 8 4 3 MODE[2:0] R/W 0 2 1 ENABLE R/W 0 0 SWRST R/W 0 21 20 SDAHOLD[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit 30 – LOWTOUT SCL Low Time-Out This bit enables the SCL low time-out. If SCL is held low for 25ms-35ms, the Client will release its clock hold, if enabled, and reset the internal state machine. Any interrupt flags set at the time of time-out will remain set. Value Description 0 Time-out disabled. 1 Time-out enabled. Bits 21:20 – SDAHOLD[1:0] SDA Hold Time These bits define the SDA hold time with respect to the negative edge of SCL. These bits are not synchronized. Value Name Description 0x0 DIS Disabled 0x1 75NS 50-100ns hold time 0x2 450NS 300-600ns hold time 0x3 600NS 400-800ns hold time Bit 16 – PINOUT Pin Usage This bit sets the pin usage to either two- or four-wire operation: This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 4-wire operation disabled 1 4-wire operation enabled Bit 7 – RUNSTDBY Run in Standby This bit defines the functionality in standby sleep mode. This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 Disabled – All reception is dropped. 1 Wake on address match, if enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 391 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit Bits 4:2 – MODE[2:0] Operating Mode These bits must be written to 0x04 to select the I2C Client serial communication interface of the SERCOM. These bits are not synchronized. Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable Due to synchronization, there is delay from writing CTRLA.ENABLE until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to CTRL.ENABLE will read back immediately and the Enable Synchronization Busy bit in the Synchronization Busy register (SYNCBUSY.ENABLE) will be set. SYNCBUSY.ENABLE will be cleared when the operation is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 The peripheral is disabled or being disabled. 1 The peripheral is enabled. Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit resets all registers in the SERCOM, except DBGCTRL, to their initial state, and the SERCOM will be disabled. Writing '1' to CTRLA.SWRST will always take precedence, meaning that all other writes in the same write-operation will be discarded. Any register write access during the ongoing reset will result in an APB error. Reading any register will return the reset value of the register. Due to synchronization, there is a delay from writing CTRLA.SWRST until the reset is complete. CTRLA.SWRST and SYNCBUSY.SWRST will both be cleared when the reset is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 There is no reset operation ongoing. 1 The reset operation is ongoing. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 392 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.8.2 Control B Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRLB 0x04 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected, Write-Synchronized 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 ACKACT R/W 0 17 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 15 14 AMODE[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit 7 6 16 CMD[1:0] 13 12 11 10 9 8 SMEN R/W 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 Access Reset Bit 18 – ACKACT Acknowledge Action This bit defines the Client's acknowledge behavior after an address or data byte is received from the Host. The acknowledge action is executed when a command is written to the CMD bits. If smart mode is enabled (CTRLB.SMEN=1), the acknowledge action is performed when the DATA register is read. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 Send ACK 1 Send NACK Bits 17:16 – CMD[1:0] Command This bit field triggers the Client operation as the below. The CMD bits are strobe bits, and always read as zero. The operation is dependent on the Client interrupt flags, INTFLAG.DRDY and INTFLAG.AMATCH, in addition to STATUS.DIR. All interrupt flags (INTFLAG.DRDY, INTFLAG.AMATCH and INTFLAG.PREC) are automatically cleared when a command is given. This bit is not enable-protected. Table 26-1. Command Description CMD[1:0] DIR 0x0 0x1 0x2 X (No action) X (Reserved) Used to complete a transaction in response to a data interrupt (DRDY) 0 (Host write) Execute acknowledge action succeeded by waiting for any start (S/Sr) condition 1 (Host read) Wait for any start (S/Sr) condition © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Action Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 393 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit ...........continued CMD[1:0] DIR Action 0x3 Used in response to an address interrupt (AMATCH) 0 (Host write) Execute acknowledge action succeeded by reception of next byte 1 (Host read) Execute acknowledge action succeeded by Client data interrupt Used in response to a data interrupt (DRDY) 0 (Host write) Execute acknowledge action succeeded by reception of next byte 1 (Host read) Execute a byte read operation followed by ACK/NACK reception Bits 15:14 – AMODE[1:0] Address Mode These bits set the addressing mode. These bits are not write-synchronized. Value Name Description 0x0 MASK The Client responds to the address written in ADDR.ADDR masked by the value in ADDR.ADDRMASK. See SERCOM – Serial Communication Interface for additional information. 0x1 2_ADDRS The Client responds to the two unique addresses in ADDR.ADDR and ADDR.ADDRMASK. 0x2 RANGE The Client responds to the range of addresses between and including ADDR.ADDR and ADDR.ADDRMASK. ADDR.ADDR is the upper limit. 0x3 Reserved. Bit 8 – SMEN Smart Mode Enable When smart mode is enabled, data is acknowledged automatically when DATA.DATA is read. This bit is not write-synchronized. Value Description 0 Smart mode is disabled. 1 Smart mode is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 394 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.8.3 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENCLR 0x0C 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to disable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 DRDY R/W 0 1 AMATCH R/W 0 0 PREC R/W 0 Bit 2 – DRDY Data Ready Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Data Ready bit, which disables the Data Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Data Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Data Ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – AMATCH Address Match Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Address Match Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Address Match interrupt. Value Description 0 The Address Match interrupt is disabled. 1 The Address Match interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – PREC Stop Received Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Stop Received Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Stop Received interrupt. Value Description 0 The Stop Received interrupt is disabled. 1 The Stop Received interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 395 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.8.4 Interrupt Enable Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENSET 0x0D 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to enable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 DRDY R/W 0 1 AMATCH R/W 0 0 PREC R/W 0 Bit 2 – DRDY Data Ready Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will set the Data Ready bit, which enables the Data Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Data Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Data Ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – AMATCH Address Match Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will set the Address Match Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Address Match interrupt. Value Description 0 The Address Match interrupt is disabled. 1 The Address Match interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – PREC Stop Received Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will set the Stop Received Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Stop Received interrupt. Value Description 0 The Stop Received interrupt is disabled. 1 The Stop Received interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 396 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.8.5 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTFLAG 0x0E 0x00 - 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 DRDY R/W 0 1 AMATCH R/W 0 0 PREC R/W 0 Bit 2 – DRDY Data Ready This flag is set when a I2C Client byte transmission is successfully completed. The flag is cleared by hardware when either: • Writing to the DATA register. • Reading the DATA register with smart mode enabled. • Writing a valid command to the CMD register. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Data Ready interrupt flag. Bit 1 – AMATCH Address Match This flag is set when the I2C Client address match logic detects that a valid address has been received. The flag is cleared by hardware when CTRL.CMD is written. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Address Match interrupt flag. When cleared, an ACK/NACK will be sent according to CTRLB.ACKACT. Bit 0 – PREC Stop Received This flag is set when a stop condition is detected for a transaction being processed. A stop condition detected between a bus Host and another Client will not set this flag, unless the PMBus Group Command is enabled in the Control B register (CTRLB.GCMD=1). This flag is cleared by hardware after a command is issued on the next address match. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Stop Received interrupt flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 397 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.8.6 Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset STATUS 0x10 0x0000 - 15 SYNCBUSY R/W 0 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 CLKHOLD R/W 0 6 LOWTOUT R/W 0 5 4 SR R 0 3 DIR R 0 2 RXNACK R 0 1 COLL R/W 0 0 BUSERR R/W 0 Bit 15 – SYNCBUSY Synchronization Busy This bit is set when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is started. This bit is cleared when the synchronization of registers between the clock domains is complete. Bit 7 – CLKHOLD Clock Hold The Client Clock Hold (STATUS.CLKHOLD) bit is set when the Client is holding the SCL line low, stretching the I2C clock. Software must consider this bit a read-only status flag that is set when INTFLAG.DRDY or INTFLAG.AMATCH is set. This bit is cleared when the corresponding interrupt is cleared. If this bit is written as ‘1’ while the SCL line is held low, the SCL line will be released. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Bit 6 – LOWTOUT SCL Low Time-out This bit is set if an SCL low time-out occurs. This bit is cleared automatically if responding to a new start condition with ACK or NACK (write 3 to CTRLB.CMD) or when INTFLAG.AMATCH is cleared. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will clear the status. Value Description 0 No SCL low time-out has occurred. 1 SCL low time-out has occurred. Bit 4 – SR Repeated Start When INTFLAG.AMATCH is raised due to an address match, SR indicates a repeated start or start condition. This flag is only valid while the INTFLAG.AMATCH flag is one. Value Description 0 Start condition on last address match 1 Repeated start condition on last address match Bit 3 – DIR Read / Write Direction The Read/Write Direction (STATUS.DIR) bit stores the direction of the last address packet received from a Host. Value Description 0 Host write operation is in progress. 1 Host read operation is in progress. Bit 2 – RXNACK Received Not Acknowledge This bit indicates whether the last data packet sent was acknowledged or not. Value Description 0 Host responded with ACK. 1 Host responded with NACK. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 398 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit Bit 1 – COLL Transmit Collision If set, the I2C Client was not able to transmit a high data or NACK bit, the I2C Client will immediately release the SDA and SCL lines and wait for the next packet addressed to it. This flag is intended for the SMBus address resolution protocol (ARP). A detected collision in non-ARP situations indicates that there has been a protocol violation, and should be treated as a bus error. This status will not trigger any interrupt, and should be checked by software to verify that the data were sent correctly. This bit is cleared automatically if responding to an address match with an ACK or a NACK (writing 0x3 to CTRLB.CMD), or INTFLAG.AMATCH is cleared. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will clear the status. Value Description 0 No collision detected on last data byte sent. 1 Collision detected on last data byte sent. Bit 0 – BUSERR Bus Error The Bus Error bit (STATUS.BUSERR) indicates that an illegal bus condition has occurred on the bus, regardless of bus ownership. An illegal bus condition is detected if a protocol violating start, repeated start or stop is detected on the I2C bus lines. A start condition directly followed by a stop condition is one example of a protocol violation. If a time-out occurs during a frame, this is also considered a protocol violation, and will set STATUS.BUSERR. This bit is cleared automatically if responding to an address match with an ACK or a NACK (writing 0x3 to CTRLB.CMD) or INTFLAG.AMATCH is cleared. Writing a '1' to this bit will clear the status. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Value Description 0 No bus error detected. 1 Bus error detected. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 399 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.8.7 Address Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit ADDR 0x14 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 20 ADDRMASK[6:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 ADDR[7] R/W 0 7 6 5 3 2 1 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 4 ADDR[6:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 0 GENCEN R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bits 23:17 – ADDRMASK[6:0] Address Mask These bits act as a second address match register, an address mask register or the lower limit of an address range, depending on the CTRLB.AMODE setting. Bits 8:1 – ADDR[7:0] Address These bits contain the I2C Client address used by the Client address match logic to determine if a Host has addressed the Client. When using 7-bit addressing, the Client address is represented by ADDR[6:0]. When the address match logic detects a match, INTFLAG.AMATCH is set and STATUS.DIR is updated to indicate whether it is a read or a write transaction. Bit 0 – GENCEN General Call Address Enable A general call address is an address consisting of all-zeroes, including the direction bit (Host write). Value Description 0 General call address recognition disabled. 1 General call address recognition enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 400 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.8.8 Data Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit DATA 0x18 0x0000 Write-Synchronized, Read-Synchronized 15 14 13 12 7 6 5 4 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit DATA[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 7:0 – DATA[7:0] Data The Client data register I/O location (DATA.DATA) provides access to the Host transmit and receive data buffers. Reading valid data or writing data to be transmitted can be successfully done only when SCL is held low by the Client (STATUS.CLKHOLD is set). An exception occurs when reading the last data byte after the stop condition has been received. Accessing DATA.DATA auto-triggers I2C bus operations. The operation performed depends on the state of CTRLB.ACKACT, CTRLB.SMEN and the type of access (read/write). Writing or reading DATA.DATA when not in smart mode does not require synchronization. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 401 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.9 Register Summary - I2C Host Offset Name 0x00 CTRLA 0x04 CTRLB 0x08 0x09 DBGCTRL Reserved 0x0A BAUD 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E 0x0F INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG Reserved 0x10 STATUS 0x12 ... 0x13 Reserved 0x14 ADDR 0x16 ... 0x17 Reserved 0x18 DATA 26.10 Bit Pos. 7 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 RUNSTDBY 6 4 3 2 MODE[2:0] LOWTOUT 1 0 ENABLE SWRST SDAHOLD[1:0] INACTOUT[1:0] PINOUT ACKACT QCEN SMEN CMD[1:0] DBGSTOP 7:0 15:8 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 15:8 5 BAUD[7:0] BAUDLOW[7:0] CLKHOLD LOWTOUT BUSSTATE[1:0] RXNACK SYNCBUSY 7:0 15:8 ADDR[7:0] 7:0 15:8 DATA[7:0] SB SB SB MB MB MB ARBLOST BUSERR Register Description - I2C Host Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16- and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers are optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC). Optional PAC writeprotection is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. For details, refer to 26.5.7. Register Access Protection. Some registers are synchronized when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the "WriteSynchronized" or the "Read-Synchronized" property in each individual register description. For details, refer to 26.6.6. Synchronization. Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the peripheral is disabled. Enableprotection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 402 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.10.1 Control A Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRLA 0x00 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected, Write-Synchronized 31 30 LOWTOUT R/W 0 29 28 INACTOUT[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 SDAHOLD[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 19 18 17 16 PINOUT R/W 0 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 6 5 4 3 MODE[2:0] R/W 0 2 1 ENABLE R/W 0 0 SWRST R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Bit 30 – LOWTOUT SCL Low Time-Out This bit enables the SCL low time-out. If SCL is held low for 25ms-35ms, the Host will release its clock hold, if enabled, and complete the current transaction. A stop condition will automatically be transmitted. INTFLAG.SB or INTFLAG.MB will be set as normal, but the clock hold will be released. The STATUS.LOWTOUT and STATUS.BUSERR status bits will be set. This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 Time-out disabled. 1 Time-out enabled. Bits 29:28 – INACTOUT[1:0] Inactive Time-Out If the inactive bus time-out is enabled and the bus is inactive for longer than the time-out setting, the bus state logic will be set to idle. An inactive bus arise when either an I2C Host or Client is holding the SCL low. Enabling this option is necessary for SMBus compatibility, but can also be used in a non-SMBus set-up. Calculated time-out periods are based on a 100kHz baud rate. These bits are not synchronized. Value Name Description 0x0 DIS Disabled 0x1 55US 5-6 SCL cycle time-out (50-60µs) 0x2 105US 10-11 SCL cycle time-out (100-110µs) 0x3 205US 20-21 SCL cycle time-out (200-210µs) Bits 21:20 – SDAHOLD[1:0] SDA Hold Time These bits define the SDA hold time with respect to the negative edge of SCL. These bits are not synchronized. Value Name Description 0x0 DIS Disabled 0x1 75NS 50-100ns hold time 0x2 450NS 300-600ns hold time © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 403 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit Value 0x3 Name 600NS Description 400-800ns hold time Bit 16 – PINOUT Pin Usage This bit set the pin usage to either two- or four-wire operation: This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 4-wire operation disabled. 1 4-wire operation enabled. Bit 7 – RUNSTDBY Run in Standby This bit defines the functionality in standby sleep mode. This bit is not synchronized. Value Description 0 GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE is disabled and the I2C Host will not operate in standby sleep mode. 1 GCLK_SERCOMx_CORE is enabled in all sleep modes. Bits 4:2 – MODE[2:0] Operating Mode These bits must be written to 0x5 to select the I2C Host serial communication interface of the SERCOM. These bits are not synchronized. Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable Due to synchronization, there is delay from writing CTRLA.ENABLE until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to CTRL.ENABLE will read back immediately and the Synchronization Enable Busy bit in the Synchronization Busy register (SYNCBUSY.ENABLE) will be set. SYNCBUSY.ENABLE will be cleared when the operation is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 The peripheral is disabled or being disabled. 1 The peripheral is enabled. Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit resets all registers in the SERCOM, except DBGCTRL, to their initial state, and the SERCOM will be disabled. Writing '1' to CTRLA.SWRST will always take precedence, meaning that all other writes in the same write-operation will be discarded. Any register write access during the ongoing reset will result in an APB error. Reading any register will return the reset value of the register. Due to synchronization there is a delay from writing CTRLA.SWRST until the reset is complete. CTRLA.SWRST and SYNCBUSY.SWRST will both be cleared when the reset is complete. This bit is not enable-protected. Value Description 0 There is no reset operation ongoing. 1 The reset operation is ongoing. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 404 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.10.2 Control B Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRLB 0x04 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected, Write-Synchronized 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 ACKACT R/W 0 17 W 0 W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 QCEN R/W 0 8 SMEN R/W 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Access Reset Bit 16 CMD[1:0] Access Reset Bit 18 – ACKACT Acknowledge Action This bit defines the I2C Host's acknowledge behavior after a data byte is received from the I2C Client. The acknowledge action is executed when a command is written to CTRLB.CMD, or if Smart mode is enabled (CTRLB.SMEN is written to one), when DATA.DATA is read. This bit is not enable-protected. This bit is not write-synchronized. Value Description 0 Send ACK. 1 Send NACK. Bits 17:16 – CMD[1:0] Command Writing these bits triggers a Host operation as described below. The CMD bits are strobe bits, and always read as zero. The acknowledge action is only valid in Host Read mode. In Host Write mode, a command will only result in a repeated Start or Stop condition. The CTRLB.ACKACT bit and the CMD bits can be written at the same time, and then the acknowledge action will be updated before the command is triggered. Commands can only be issued when either the Client on Bus Interrupt flag (INTFLAG.SB) or Host on Bus Interrupt flag (INTFLAG.MB) is '1'. If CMD 0x1 is issued, a repeated start will be issued followed by the transmission of the current address in ADDR.ADDR. If another address is desired, ADDR.ADDR must be written instead of the CMD bits. This will trigger a repeated start followed by transmission of the new address. Issuing a command will set the System Operation bit in the Synchronization Busy register (SYNCBUSY.SYSOP). Table 26-2. Command Description CMD[1:0] Direction Action 0x0 0x1 0x2 X X 0 (Write) 1 (Read) X (No action) Execute acknowledge action succeeded by repeated Start No operation Execute acknowledge action succeeded by a byte read operation Execute acknowledge action succeeded by issuing a Stop condition 0x3 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 405 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit These bits are not enable-protected. Bit 9 – QCEN Quick Command Enable This bit is not write-synchronized. Value Description 0 Quick Command is disabled. 1 Quick Command is enabled. Bit 8 – SMEN Smart Mode Enable When Smart mode is enabled, acknowledge action is sent when DATA.DATA is read. This bit is not write-synchronized. Value Description 0 Smart mode is disabled. 1 Smart mode is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 406 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.10.3 Debug Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit DBGCTRL 0x08 0x00 PAC Write-Protection 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 0 DBGSTOP R/W 0 Bit 0 – DBGSTOP Debug Stop Mode This bit controls functionality when the CPU is halted by an external debugger. Value Description 0 The baud-rate generator continues normal operation when the CPU is halted by an external debugger. 1 The baud-rate generator is halted when the CPU is halted by an external debugger. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 407 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.10.4 Baud Rate Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit BAUD 0x0A 0x0000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 12 11 BAUDLOW[7:0] R/W R/W 0 0 4 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 BAUD[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 15:8 – BAUDLOW[7:0] Host Baud Rate Low If this bit field is non-zero, the SCL low time will be described by the value written. For more information on how to calculate the frequency, see SERCOM 23.6.2.3. Clock Generation – Baud-Rate Generator. Bits 7:0 – BAUD[7:0] Host Baud Rate This bit field is used to derive the SCL high time if BAUD.BAUDLOW is non-zero. If BAUD.BAUDLOW is zero, BAUD will be used to generate both high and low periods of the SCL. For more information on how to calculate the frequency, see SERCOM 23.6.2.3. Clock Generation – Baud-Rate Generator. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 408 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.10.5 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENCLR 0x0C 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to disable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 SB R/W 0 0 MB R/W 0 Bit 1 – SB Client on Bus Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Client on Bus Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Client on Bus interrupt. Value Description 0 The Client on Bus interrupt is disabled. 1 The Client on Bus interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – MB Host on Bus Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear the Host on Bus Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Host on Bus interrupt. Value Description 0 The Host on Bus interrupt is disabled. 1 The Host on Bus interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 409 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.10.6 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENSET 0x0D 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to enable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 SB R/W 0 0 MB R/W 0 Bit 1 – SB Client on Bus Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will set the Client on Bus Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Client on Bus interrupt. Value Description 0 The Client on Bus interrupt is disabled. 1 The Client on Bus interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – MB Host on Bus Interrupt Enable Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will set the Host on Bus Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Host on Bus interrupt. Value Description 0 The Host on Bus interrupt is disabled. 1 The Host on Bus interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 410 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.10.7 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTFLAG 0x0E 0x00 - 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 SB R/W 0 0 MB R/W 0 Bit 1 – SB Client on Bus The Client on Bus flag (SB) is set when a byte is successfully received in Host read mode, i.e., no arbitration lost or bus error occurred during the operation. When this flag is set, the Host forces the SCL line low, stretching the I2C clock period. The SCL line will be released and SB will be cleared on one of the following actions: • Writing to ADDR.ADDR • Writing to DATA.DATA • Reading DATA.DATA when smart mode is enabled (CTRLB.SMEN) • Writing a valid command to CTRLB.CMD Writing '1' to this bit location will clear the SB flag. The transaction will not continue or be terminated until one of the above actions is performed. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Bit 0 – MB Host on Bus This flag is set when a byte is transmitted in Host write mode. The flag is set regardless of the occurrence of a bus error or an arbitration lost condition. MB is also set when arbitration is lost during sending of NACK in Host read mode, or when issuing a start condition if the bus state is unknown. When this flag is set and arbitration is not lost, the Host forces the SCL line low, stretching the I2C clock period. The SCL line will be released and MB will be cleared on one of the following actions: • Writing to ADDR.ADDR • Writing to DATA.DATA • Reading DATA.DATA when smart mode is enabled (CTRLB.SMEN) • Writing a valid command to CTRLB.CMD Writing '1' to this bit location will clear the MB flag. The transaction will not continue or be terminated until one of the above actions is performed. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 411 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.10.8 Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit STATUS 0x10 0x0000 Write-Synchronized 15 14 7 CLKHOLD R 0 6 LOWTOUT R/W 0 13 12 11 10 SYNCBUSY R/W 0 9 8 5 4 BUSSTATE[1:0] R R 0 0 3 2 RXNACK R 0 1 ARBLOST R/W 0 0 BUSERR R/W 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit 10 – SYNCBUSY Synchronization Busy This bit is cleared when the synchronization of registers between the clock domains is complete. This bit is set when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is started. Bit 7 – CLKHOLD Clock Hold This bit is set when the Host is holding the SCL line low, stretching the I2C clock. Software should consider this bit when INTFLAG.SB or INTFLAG.MB is set. This bit is cleared when the corresponding interrupt flag is cleared and the next operation is given. If this bit is written while the SCL line is held low, the SCL line will be released. This bit is not write-synchronized. Bit 6 – LOWTOUT SCL Low Time-Out This bit is set if an SCL low time-out occurs. Writing '1' to this bit location will clear this bit. This flag is automatically cleared when writing to the ADDR register. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. This bit is not write-synchronized. Bits 5:4 – BUSSTATE[1:0] Bus State These bits indicate the current I2C bus state. When in UNKNOWN state, writing 0x1 to BUSSTATE forces the bus state into the IDLE state. The bus state cannot be forced into any other state. Writing BUSSTATE to idle will set SYNCBUSY.SYSOP. Value Name Description 0x0 UNKNOWN The bus state is unknown to the I2C Host and will wait for a stop condition to be detected or wait to be forced into an idle state by software 0x1 IDLE The bus state is waiting for a transaction to be initialized 0x2 OWNER The I2C Host is the current owner of the bus 0x3 BUSY Some other I2C Host owns the bus Bit 2 – RXNACK Received Not Acknowledge This bit indicates whether the last address or data packet sent was acknowledged or not. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit has no effect. This bit is not write-synchronized. Value Description 0 Client responded with ACK. 1 Client responded with NACK. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 412 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit Bit 1 – ARBLOST Arbitration Lost This bit is set if arbitration is lost while transmitting a high data bit or a NACK bit, or while issuing a start or repeated start condition on the bus. The Host on Bus interrupt flag (INTFLAG.MB) will be set when STATUS.ARBLOST is set. Writing the ADDR.ADDR register will automatically clear STATUS.ARBLOST. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear it. This bit is not write-synchronized. Bit 0 – BUSERR Bus Error This bit indicates that an illegal bus condition has occurred on the bus, regardless of bus ownership. An illegal bus condition is detected if a protocol violating start, repeated start or stop is detected on the I2C bus lines. A start condition directly followed by a stop condition is one example of a protocol violation. If a time-out occurs during a frame, this is also considered a protocol violation, and will set BUSERR. If the I2C Host is the bus owner at the time a bus error occurs, STATUS.ARBLOST and INTFLAG.MB will be set in addition to BUSERR. Writing the ADDR.ADDR register will automatically clear the BUSERR flag. Writing '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing '1' to this bit will clear it. This bit is not write-synchronized. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 413 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.10.9 Address Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit ADDR 0x14 0x0000 Write-Synchronized 15 14 13 12 7 6 5 4 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit ADDR[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 7:0 – ADDR[7:0] Address When ADDR is written, the consecutive operation will depend on the bus state: UNKNOWN: INTFLAG.MB and STATUS.BUSERR are set, and the operation is terminated. BUSY: The I2C Host will await further operation until the bus becomes IDLE. IDLE: The I2C Host will issue a start condition followed by the address written in ADDR. If the address is acknowledged, SCL is forced and held low, and STATUS.CLKHOLD and INTFLAG.MB are set. OWNER: A repeated start sequence will be performed. If the previous transaction was a read, the acknowledge action is sent before the repeated start bus condition is issued on the bus. Writing ADDR to issue a repeated start is performed while INTFLAG.MB or INTFLAG.SB is set. STATUS.BUSERR, STATUS.ARBLOST, INTFLAG.MB and INTFLAG.SB will be cleared when ADDR is written. The ADDR register can be read at any time without interfering with ongoing bus activity, as a read access does not trigger the Host logic to perform any bus protocol related operations. The I2C Host control logic uses bit 0 of ADDR as the bus protocol’s read/write flag (R/W); 0 for write and 1 for read. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 414 SAM D20 Family SERCOM I2C – Inter-Integrated Circuit 26.10.10 Data Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit DATA 0x18 0x0000 Write-Synchronized, Read-Synchronized 15 14 13 12 7 6 5 4 11 10 9 8 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit DATA[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 7:0 – DATA[7:0] Data The Host data register I/O location (DATA) provides access to the Host transmit and receive data buffers. Reading valid data or writing data to be transmitted can be successfully done only when SCL is held low by the Host (STATUS.CLKHOLD is set). An exception is reading the last data byte after the stop condition has been sent. Accessing DATA.DATA auto-triggers I2C bus operations. The operation performed depends on the state of CTRLB.ACKACT, CTRLB.SMEN and the type of access (read/write). Writing or reading DATA.DATA when not in smart mode does not require synchronization. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 415 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27. TC – Timer/Counter 27.1 Overview The TC consists of a counter, a prescaler, compare/capture channels and control logic. The counter can be set to count events, or it can be configured to count clock pulses. The counter, together with the compare/capture channels, can be configured to timestamp input events, allowing capture of frequency and pulse width. It can also perform waveform generation, such as frequency generation and pulse-width modulation (PWM). 27.2 Features • • • • • • Selectable configuration: – Up to eight 16-bit Timer/Counters (TC), each configurable as: • 8-bit TC with two compare/capture channels • 16-bit TC with two compare/capture channels • 32-bit TC with two compare/capture channels, by using two TCs Waveform Generation: – Frequency generation – Single-slope pulse-width modulation Input capture: – Event capture – Frequency capture – Pulse-width capture One input event Interrupts/output events on: – Counter overflow/underflow – Compare match or capture Internal prescaler © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 416 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.3 Block Diagram Figure 27-1. Timer/Counter Block Diagram BASE COUNTER PER PRESCALER count COUNTER OVF/UNF (INT Req.) clear load CONTROL LOGIC direction Top = Zero event =0 ERR (INT Req.) Update COUNT Compare / Capture CONTROL LOGIC WAVEFORM GENERATION CC0 match MCx (INT Req.) = 27.4 WOx Out Signal Description Signal Name Type Description WO[1:0] Digital output Waveform output Refer to I/O Multiplexing and Considerations for details on the pin mapping for this peripheral. One signal can be mapped on several pins. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 417 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 27.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. 27.5.1 I/O Lines In order to use the I/O lines of this peripheral, the I/O pins must be configured using the I/O Pin Controller (PORT). Related Links 21. PORT - I/O Pin Controller 27.5.2 Power Management This peripheral can continue to operate in any sleep mode where its source clock is running. The interrupts can wake up the device from sleep modes. Events connected to the event system can trigger other operations in the system without exiting sleep modes. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 27.5.3 Clocks The TC bus clock (CLK_TCx_APB, where x represents the specific TC instance number) can be enabled and disabled in the Power Manager, and the default state of CLK_TCx_APB can be found in the Peripheral Clock Masking section in “PM – Power Manager”. The different TC instances are paired, even and odd, starting from TC, and use the same generic clock, GCLK_TCx. This means that the TC instances in a TC pair cannot be set up to use different GCLK_TCx clocks. This generic clock is asynchronous to the user interface clock (CLK_TCx_APB). Due to this asynchronicity, accessing certain registers will require synchronization between the clock domains. Refer to 27.6.5. Synchronization for further details. 27.5.4 Interrupts The interrupt request line is connected to the Interrupt Controller. In order to use interrupt requests of this peripheral, the Interrupt Controller (NVIC) must be configured first. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 27.5.5 Events The events of this peripheral are connected to the Event System. Related Links 22. Event System (EVSYS) 27.5.6 Debug Operation When the CPU is halted in debug mode, this peripheral will halt normal operation. This peripheral can be forced to continue operation during debugging - refer to the Debug Control (DBGCTRL) register for details. 27.5.7 Register Access Protection Registers with write-access can be optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC), except for the following: • • • Interrupt Flag register (INTFLAG) Status register (STATUS) Read Request register (READREQ) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 418 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter • • • Count register (COUNT) Period register (PER) Compare/Capture Value registers (CCx) Note:  Optional write-protection is indicated by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in the register description. Write-protection does not apply for accesses through an external debugger. 27.5.8 Analog Connections Not applicable. 27.6 Functional Description 27.6.1 Principle of Operation The following definitions are used throughout the documentation: Table 27-1. Timer/Counter Definitions Name Description TOP The counter reaches TOP when it becomes equal to the highest value in the count sequence. The TOP value can be the same as Period (PER) or the Compare Channel 0 (CC0) register value depending on the waveform generator mode in Waveform Output Operations. ZERO The counter is ZERO when it contains all zeroes MAX The counter reaches MAX when it contains all ones UPDATE The timer/counter signals an update when it reaches ZERO or TOP, depending on the direction settings. Timer The timer/counter clock control is handled by an internal source Counter The clock control is handled externally (e.g. counting external events) CC For compare operations, the CC are referred to as “compare channels” For capture operations, the CC are referred to as “capture channels.” The counter in the TC can either count events from the Event System, or clock ticks of the GCLK_TCx clock, which may be divided by the prescaler. The counter value is passed to the CCx where it can be either compared to user-defined values or captured. The compare and capture registers (CCx) and counter register (COUNT) can be configured as 8-, 16- or 32-bit registers, with according MAX values. Mode settings determine the maximum range of the counter. In 8-bit mode, Period Value (PER) is also available. The counter range and the operating frequency determine the maximum time resolution achievable with the TC peripheral. The TC can be set to count up or down. Under normal operation, the counter value is continuously compared to the TOP or ZERO value to determine whether the counter has reached that value. In compare operation, the counter value is continuously compared to the values in the CCx registers. In waveform generator mode, these comparisons are used to set the waveform period or pulse width. Capture operation can be enabled to perform input signal period and pulse width measurements, or to capture selectable edges from an internal event from Event System. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 419 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.6.2 Basic Operation 27.6.2.1 Initialization The following registers are enable-protected, meaning that they can only be written when the TC is disabled (CTRLA.ENABLE =0): • Control A register (CTRLA), except the Run Standby (RUNSTDBY), Enable (ENABLE) and Software Reset (SWRST) bits Enable-protected bits in the CTRLA register can be written at the same time as CTRLA.ENABLE is written to '1', but not at the same time as CTRLA.ENABLE is written to '0'. Enable-protection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in the register description. The following bits are enable-protected: • Event Action bits in the Event Control register (EVCTRL.EVACT) Before enabling the TC, the peripheral must be configured by the following steps: 1. Enable the TC bus clock (CLK_TCx_APB). 2. Select 8-, 16- or 32-bit counter mode via the TC Mode bit group in the Control A register (CTRLA.MODE). The default mode is 16-bit. 3. Select one wave generation operation in the Waveform Generation Operation bit group in the Control A register (CTRLA.WAVEGEN). 4. If desired, the GCLK_TCx clock can be prescaled via the Prescaler bit group in the Control A register (CTRLA.PRESCALER). – If the prescaler is used, select a prescaler synchronization operation via the Prescaler and Counter Synchronization bit group in the Control A register (CTRLA.PRESYNC). 5. Select one-shot operation by writing a '1' to the One-Shot bit in the Control B Set register (CTRLBSET.ONESHOT). 6. If desired, configure the counting direction 'down' (starting from the TOP value) by writing a '1' to the Counter Direction bit in the Control B register (CTRLBSET.DIR). 7. For capture operation, enable the individual channels to capture in the Capture Channel x Enable bit group in the Control C register (CTRLC.CAPTEN). 8. If desired, enable inversion of the waveform output or IO pin input signal for individual channels via the Waveform Output Invert Enable bit group in the Control C register (CTRLC.INVEN). 27.6.2.2 Enabling, Disabling and Resetting The TC is enabled by writing a '1' to the Enable bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.ENABLE). The TC is disbled by writing a zero to CTRLA.ENABLE. The TC is reset by writing a one to the Software Reset bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.SWRST). All registers in the TC, except DBGCTRL, will be reset to their initial state, and the TC will be disabled. Refer to the CTRLA register for details. The TC should be disabled before the TC is reset in order to avoid undefined behavior. 27.6.2.3 Prescaler Selection The GCLK_TCx is fed into the internal prescaler. The prescaler consists of a counter that counts up to the selected prescaler value, whereupon the output of the prescaler toggles. If the prescaler value is higher than one, the counter update condition can be optionally executed on the next GCLK_TCx clock pulse or the next prescaled clock pulse. For further details, refer to Prescaler (CTRLA.PRESCALER) and Counter Synchronization (CTRLA.PRESYNC) description. Prescaler outputs from 1 to 1/1024 are available. For a complete list of available prescaler outputs, see the register description for the Prescaler bit group in the Control A register (CTRLA.PRESCALER). Note:  When counting events, the prescaler is bypassed. The joint stream of prescaler ticks and event action ticks is called CLK_TC_CNT. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 420 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter Figure 27-2. Prescaler PRESCALER Prescaler GCLK_TC EVACT GCLK_TC / {1,2,4,8,64,256,1024} CLK_TC_CNT COUNT EVENT 27.6.2.4 Counter Mode The Counter mode is selected by the Mode bit group in the Control A register (CTRLA.MODE). By default, the counter is enabled in the 16-bit counter resolution. The following three counter resolutions are available: • • • COUNT8: The 8-bit TC has its own Period register (PER). This register is used to store the period value that can be used as the top value for waveform generation. COUNT16: 16-bit is the default Counter mode. There is no dedicated Period register in this mode. COUNT32: This mode is achieved by pairing two 16-bit TC peripherals. In this mode, TC0 is paired with TC1, TC2 is paired with TC3, TC4 is paired with TC5, and TC6 is paired with TC7. When paired, the TC peripherals are configured using the registers of the even-numbered TC . The odd-numbered partner will act as Client, and the Client bit in the Status register (STATUS.Client) will be set. The register values of a Client will not reflect the registers of the 32-bit counter. Writing to any of the Client registers will not affect the 32-bit counter. Normal access to the Client COUNT and CCx registers is not allowed. 27.6.2.5 Counter Operations The counter can be set to count up or down. When the counter is counting up and the top value is reached, the counter will wrap around to zero on the next clock cycle. When counting down, the counter will wrap around to the top value when zero is reached. In one-shot mode, the counter will stop counting after a wraparound occurs. The counting direction is set by the Direction bit in the Control B register (CTRLB.DIR). If this bit is zero the counter is counting up, and counting down if CTRLB.DIR=1. The counter will count up or down for each tick (clock or event) until it reaches TOP or ZERO. When it is counting up and TOP is reached, the counter will be set to zero at the next tick (overflow) and the Overflow Interrupt Flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.OVF) will be set. It is also possible to generate an event on overflow or underflow when the Overflow/Underflow Event Output Enable bit in the Event Control register (EVCTRL.OVFEO) is one. It is possible to change the counter value (by writing directly in the COUNT register) even when the counter is running. When starting the TC, the COUNT value will be either ZERO or TOP (depending on the counting direction set by CTRLBSET.DIR or CTRLBCLR.DIR), unless a different value has been written to it, or the TC has been stopped at a value other than ZERO. The write access has higher priority than count, clear, or reload. The direction of the counter can also be changed during normal operation. See also the figure below. Figure 27-3. Counter Operation Period (T) Direction Change COUNT written MAX "reload" update "clear" update COUNT TOP ZERO DIR © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 421 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.6.2.5.1 Stop Command and Event Action A Stop command can be issued from software by using Command bits in the Control B Set register (CTRLBSET.CMD = 0x2, STOP). When a Stop is detected while the counter is running, the counter will be loaded with the starting value (ZERO or TOP, depending on direction set by CTRLBSET.DIR or CTRLBCLR.DIR). All waveforms are cleared and the Stop bit in the Status register is set (STATUS.STOP). 27.6.2.5.2 Re-Trigger Command and Event Action A re-trigger command can be issued from software by writing the Command bits in the Control B Set register (CTRLBSET.CMD = 0x1, RETRIGGER), or from event when a re-trigger event action is configured in the Event Control register (EVCTRL.EVACT = 0x1, RETRIGGER). When the command is detected during counting operation, the counter will be reloaded or cleared, depending on the counting direction (CTRLBSET.DIR or CTRLBCLR.DIR). When the re-trigger command is detected while the counter is stopped, the counter will resume counting from the current value in the COUNT register. Note:  When a re-trigger event action is configured in the Event Action bits in the Event Control register (EVCTRL.EVACT=0x1, RETRIGGER), enabling the counter will not start the counter. The counter will start on the next incoming event and restart on corresponding following event. 27.6.2.5.3 Count Event Action The TC can count events. When an event is received, the counter increases or decreases the value, depending on direction settings (CTRLBSET.DIR or CTRLBCLR.DIR). The count event action can be selected by the Event Action bit group in the Event Control register (EVCTRL.EVACT=0x2, COUNT). 27.6.2.5.4 Start Event Action The TC can start counting operation on an event when previously stopped. In this configuration, the event has no effect if the counter is already counting. When the peripheral is enabled, the counter operation starts when the event is received or when a re-trigger software command is applied. The Start TC on Event action can be selected by the Event Action bit group in the Event Control register (EVCTRL.EVACT=0x3, START). 27.6.2.6 Compare Operations By default, the Compare/Capture channel is configured for compare operations. When using the TC and the Compare/Capture Value registers (CCx) for compare operations, the counter value is continuously compared to the values in the CCx registers. This can be used for timer or for waveform operation. 27.6.2.6.1 Waveform Output Operations The compare channels can be used for waveform generation on output port pins. To make the waveform available on the connected pin, the following requirements must be fulfilled: 1. Choose a waveform generation mode in the Waveform Generation Operation bit in Waveform register (CTRLA.WAVEGEN). 2. Optionally invert the waveform output by writing the corresponding Waveform Output Invert Enable bit in the Control C register (CTRLC.INVx). 3. Configure the pins with the I/O Pin Controller. Refer to PORT - I/O Pin Controller for details. The counter value is continuously compared with each CCx value. On a comparison match, the Match or Capture Channel x bit in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.MCx) will be set on the next zero-to-one transition of CLK_TC_CNT (see the next figure). An interrupt/and or event can be generated on comparison match when INTENSET.MCx=1 and/or EVCTRL.MCEOx=1. There are four waveform configurations for the Waveform Generation Operation bit group in the Control A register (CTRLA.WAVEGEN) . This will influence how the waveform is generated and impose restrictions on the top value. The configurations are: • Normal frequency (NFRQ) • Match frequency (MFRQ) • Normal pulse-width modulation (NPWM) • Match pulse-width modulation (MPWM) When using NPWM or NFRQ configuration, the TOP will be determined by the counter resolution. In 8-bit counter mode, the Period register (PER) is used as TOP, and the TOP can be changed by writing to the PER register. In 16and 32-bit counter mode, TOP is fixed to the maximum (MAX) value of the counter. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 422 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter Related Links 21. PORT - I/O Pin Controller 27.6.2.6.2 Frequency Operation Normal Frequency Generation (NFRQ) For Normal Frequency Generation, the period time (T) is controlled by the period register (PER) for 8-bit counter mode and MAX for 16- and 32-bit mode. The waveform generation output (WO[x]) is toggled on each compare match between COUNT and CCx, and the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Flag (INTFLAG.MCx) will be set. Figure 27-4. Normal Frequency Operation Period (T) Direction Change COUNT Written MAX COUNT "reload" update "clear" update "match" TOP CCx ZERO WO[x] Match Frequency Generation (MFRQ) For Match Frequency Generation, the period time (T) is controlled by the CC0 register instead of PER or MAX. WO[0] toggles on each update condition. Figure 27-5. Match Frequency Operation Period (T) Direction Change COUNT Written MAX "reload" update "clear" update COUNT CC0 ZERO WO[0] 27.6.2.6.3 PWM Operation Normal Pulse-Width Modulation Operation (NPWM) NPWM uses single-slope PWM generation. For single-slope PWM generation, the period time (T) is controlled by the TOP value, and CCx controls the duty cycle of the generated waveform output. When up-counting, the WO[x] is set at start or compare match between the COUNT and TOP values, and cleared on compare match between COUNT and CCx register values. When down-counting, the WO[x] is cleared at start or compare match between the COUNT and ZERO values, and set on compare match between COUNT and CCx register values. The following equation calculates the exact resolution for a single-slope PWM (RPWM_SS) waveform: RPWM_SS = log(TOP+1) log(2) The PWM frequency (fPWM_SS) depends on TOP value and the peripheral clock frequency (fGCLK_TC), and can be calculated by the following equation: © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 423 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter fPWM_SS = fGCLK_TC N(TOP+1) Where N represents the prescaler divider used (1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 64, 256, 1024). Match Pulse-Width Modulation Operation (MPWM) In MPWM, the output of WO[1] is depending on CC1 as shown in the figure below. On every overflow/underflow, a one-TC-clock-cycle negative pulse is put out on WO[0] (not shown in the figure). Figure 27-6. Match PWM Operation Period(T) CCx= Zero CCx= TOP " clear" update " match" MAX CC0 COUNT CC1 ZERO WO[1] The table below shows the update counter and overflow event/interrupt generation conditions in different operation modes. Table 27-2. Counter Update and Overflow Event/interrupt Conditions in TC Name Operation TOP Update Output Waveform OVFIF/Event On Match On Update Up Down NFRQ Normal Frequency PER TOP/ ZERO Toggle Stable TOP ZERO MFRQ Match Frequency CC0 TOP/ ZERO Toggle Stable TOP ZERO NPWM Single-slope PWM PER TOP/ ZERO See description above. TOP ZERO MPWM Single-slope PWM CC0 TOP/ ZERO Toggle TOP ZERO Toggle 27.6.2.6.4 Changing the Top Value The counter period is changed by writing a new TOP value to the Period register (PER or CC0, depending on the waveform generation mode). If a new TOP value is written when the counter value is close to zero and counting down, the counter can be reloaded with the previous TOP value, due to synchronization delays. Then, the counter will count one extra cycle before the new TOP value is used. COUNT and TOP are continuously compared, so when a new TOP value that is lower than current COUNT is written to TOP, COUNT will wrap before a compare match. A counter wraparound can occur in any operation mode when up-counting without buffering, see the figure below. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 424 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter Figure 27-7. Changing the Top value with Up-Counting Operation Counter Wraparound MAX "clear" update "write" COUNT ZERO New TOP written to PER that is higher than current COUNT New TOP written to PER that is lower than current COUNT Figure 27-8. Changing the Top Value with Down-Counting Operation MAX "reload" update "write" COUNT ZERO New TOP written to PER that is higher than current COUNT New TOP written to PER that is lower than current COUNT 27.6.2.7 Capture Operations To enable and use capture operations, the event line into the TC must be enabled using the TC Event Input bit in the Event Control register (EVCTRL.TCEI). The capture channels to be used must also be enabled in the Capture Channel x Enable bit group in the Control C register (CTRLC.CPTENx) before capture can be performed. To enable and use capture operations, the corresponding Capture Channel x Enable bit in the Control C register (CTRLC.CAPTENx) must be written to '1'. Note:  The RETRIGGER, COUNT and START event actions are available only on an event from the Event System. 27.6.2.7.1 Event Capture Action The compare/capture channels can be used as input capture channels to capture events from the Event System and give them a timestamp. The following figure shows four capture events for one capture channel. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 425 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter Figure 27-9. Input Capture Timing events TOP COUNT ZERO Capture 0 Capture 1 Capture 2 Capture 3 The TC can detect capture overflow of the input capture channels: When a new capture event is detected while the Capture Interrupt flag (INTFLAG.MCx) is still set, the new timestamp will not be stored and INTFLAG.ERR will be set. 27.6.2.7.2 Period and Pulse-Width (PPW) Capture Action The TC can perform two input captures and restart the counter on one of the edges. This enables the TC to measure the pulse width and period and to characterize the frequency f and duty cycle of an input signal: f= 1 T dutyCycle = tp T Selecting PWP (pulse-width, period) in the Event Action bit group in the Event Control register (EVCTRL.EVACT) enables the TC to perform one capture action on the rising edge and the other one on the falling edge. The period T will be captured into CC1 and the pulse width tp in CC0. EVCTRL.EVACT=PPW (period and pulse-width)offers identical functionality, but will capture T into CC0 and tp into CC1. The TC Event Input Invert Enable bit in the Event Control register (EVCTRL.TCINV) is used to select whether the wraparound should occur on the rising edge or the falling edge. If EVCTRL.TCINV=1, the wraparound will happen on the falling edge. To fully characterize the frequency and duty cycle of the input signal, activate capture on CC0 and CC1 by writing 0x3 to the Capture Channel x Enable bit group in the Control C register (CTRLC.CPTEN). When only one of these measurements is required, the second channel can be used for other purposes. The TC can detect capture overflow of the input capture channels: When a new capture event is detected while the Capture Interrupt flag (INTFLAG.MCx) is still set, the new timestamp will not be stored and INTFLAG.ERR will be set. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 426 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter Figure 27-10. PWP Capture Period (T) external signal Pulsewitdh (tp) events MAX "capture" COUNT ZERO CC0 27.6.3 CC1 CC0 CC1 Additional Features 27.6.3.1 One-Shot Operation When one-shot is enabled, the counter automatically stops on the next counter overflow or underflow condition. When the counter is stopped, the Stop bit in the Status register (STATUS.STOP) is automatically set and the waveform outputs are set to zero. One-shot operation is enabled by writing a '1' to the One-Shot bit in the Control B Set register (CTRLBSET.ONESHOT), and disabled by writing a '1' to CTRLBCLR.ONESHOT. When enabled, the TC will count until an overflow or underflow occurs and stops counting operation. The one-shot operation can be restarted by a re-trigger software command, a re-trigger event, or a start event. When the counter restarts its operation, STATUS.STOP is automatically cleared. 27.6.4 Sleep Mode Operation The TC can be configured to operate in any sleep mode. To be able to run in standby, the RUNSTDBY bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.RUNSTDBY) must be written to one. The TC can wake up the device using interrupts from any sleep mode or perform actions through the Event System. 27.6.5 Synchronization Due to asynchronicity between the main clock domain and the peripheral clock domains, some registers need to be synchronized when written or read. The following bits are synchronized when written: • • Software Reset bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.SWRST) Enable bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.ENABLE) Required write-synchronization is denoted by the "Write-Synchronized" property in the register description. The following registers are synchronized when written: • • • • • Control B Clear register (CTRLBCLR) Control B Set register (CTRLBSET) Control C register (CTRLC) Count Value register (COUNT) Period Value register (PERIOD) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 427 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter • Compare/Capture Value registers (CCx) Required write-synchronization is denoted by the "Write-Synchronized" property in the register description. The following registers are synchronized when read: • • • • • • Control B Clear register (CTRLBCLR) Control B Set register (CTRLBSET) Control C register (CTRLC) Count Value register (COUNT) Period Value register (PERIOD) Compare/Capture Value registers (CCx) Required read-synchronization is denoted by the "Read-Synchronized" property in the register description. Related Links 13.3. Register Synchronization © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 428 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.7 Register Summary for 8-bit Registers Offset Name 0x00 CTRLA 0x02 READREQ 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x08 0x09 CTRLBCLR CTRLBSET CTRLC Reserved DBGCTRL Reserved 0x0A EVCTRL 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E 0x0F 0x10 0x11 ... 0x13 0x14 0x15 ... 0x17 0x18 0x19 INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG STATUS COUNT 27.8 Bit Pos. 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 7:0 7:0 7:0 7 6 5 4 3 WAVEGEN[1:0] PRESCSYNC[1:0] 2 1 MODE[1:0] ENABLE SWRST RUNSTDBY PRESCALER[2:0] ADDR[4:0] RREQ RCONT CMD[1:0] CMD[1:0] ONESHOT ONESHOT CPTEN1 CPTEN0 INVEN1 7:0 7:0 15:8 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 0 DIR DIR INVEN0 DBGRUN TCEI MCEO1 MC1 MC1 MC1 SYNCBUSY TCINV MCEO0 MC0 SYNCRDY MC0 SYNCRDY MC0 SYNCRDY SLAVE STOP COUNT[7:0] EVACT[2:0] ERR ERR ERR OVFEO OVF OVF OVF Reserved PER 7:0 PER[7:0] 7:0 7:0 CC[7:0] CC[7:0] Reserved CC0 CC1 Register Description for 8-bit Registers Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16- and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers are optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC). Optional PAC writeprotection is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. For details, refer to 27.5.7. Register Access Protection Some registers are synchronized when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the "WriteSynchronized" or the "Read-Synchronized" property in each individual register description. For details, refer to 27.6.5. Synchronization. Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the peripheral is disabled. Enableprotection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 429 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.1 Control A Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 15 CTRLA 0x00 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection, Write-Synchronized bits, Enable-Protected bits 14 Access Reset Bit Access Reset 7 13 12 PRESCSYNC[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 6 5 WAVEGEN[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 4 11 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 10 R/W 0 3 2 MODE[1:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 9 PRESCALER[2:0] R/W 0 8 R/W 0 1 ENABLE R/W 0 0 SWRST R/W 0 Bits 13:12 – PRESCSYNC[1:0] Prescaler and Counter Synchronization These bits select whether the counter should wrap around on the next GCLK_TCx clock or the next prescaled GCLK_TCx clock. It also makes it possible to reset the prescaler. These bits are not write-synchronized, but are enable-protected. Value Name Description 0x0 GCLK Reload or reset the counter on next generic clock 0x1 PRESC Reload or reset the counter on next prescaler clock 0x2 RESYNC Reload or reset the counter on next generic clock. Reset the prescaler counter 0x3 Reserved Bit 11 – RUNSTDBY Run in Standby This bit is used to keep the TC running in Standby mode. This bit is not write-synchronized, but is enable-protected. Value Description 0 The TC is halted in standby. 1 The TC continues to run in standby. Bits 10:8 – PRESCALER[2:0] Prescaler These bits select the counter prescaler factor. These bits are not write-synchronized, but are enable protected. Value Name Description 0x0 DIV1 Prescaler: GCLK_TC 0x1 DIV2 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/2 0x2 DIV4 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/4 0x3 DIV8 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/8 0x4 DIV16 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/16 0x5 DIV64 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/64 0x6 DIV256 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/256 0x7 DIV1024 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/1024 Bits 6:5 – WAVEGEN[1:0] Waveform Generation Operation These bits select the waveform generation operation. They affect the top value, as shown in “Waveform Output Operations”. It also controls whether frequency or PWM waveform generation should be used. How these modes differ can also be seen from “Waveform Output Operations”. These bits are not write-synchronized, but are enable-protected. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 430 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter Table 27-3. Waveform Generation Operation Value Name Operation Top Value 0x0 0x1 0x2 NFRQ MFRQ NPWM Normal frequency PER(1)/Max Match frequency CC0 Normal PWM PER(1)/Max 0x3 MPWM Match PWM CC0 Waveform Output on Match Waveform Output on Wraparound Toggle Toggle Clear when counting up Set when counting down Clear when counting up Set when counting down No action No action Set when counting up Clear when counting down Set when counting up Clear when counting down Note:  1. This depends on the TC mode. In 8-bit mode, the top value is the Period Value register (PER). In 16-bit and 32-bit modes it is the maximum value. Bits 3:2 – MODE[1:0] Timer Counter Mode These bits select the Counter mode. These bits are not write-synchronized, but are enable protected. Value Name Description 0x0 COUNT16 Counter in 16-bit mode 0x1 COUNT8 Counter in 8-bit mode 0x2 COUNT32 Counter in 32-bit mode 0x3 Reserved Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable Due to synchronization, there is delay from writing CTRLA.ENABLE until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to CTRLA.ENABLE will read back immediately, and the ENABLE Synchronization Busy bit in the SYNCBUSY register (SYNCBUSY.ENABLE) will be set. SYNCBUSY.ENABLE will be cleared when the operation is complete. This bit is not enable protected. Value Description 0 The peripheral is disabled. 1 The peripheral is enabled. Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit resets all registers in the TC, except DBGCTRL, to their initial state, and the TC will be disabled. Writing a '1' to CTRLA.SWRST will always take precedence; all other writes in the same write-operation will be discarded. Due to synchronization there is a delay from writing CTRLA.SWRST until the reset is complete. CTRLA.SWRST and SYNCBUSY.SWRST will both be cleared when the reset is complete. This bit is not enable protected. Value Description 0 There is no reset operation ongoing. 1 The reset operation is ongoing. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 431 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.2 Read Request Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Bit Access Reset Bit READREQ 0x02 0x0000 15 RREQ W 0 14 RCONT R/W 0 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 2 ADDR[4:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit 15 – RREQ Read Request Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. This bit will always read as zero. Writing a one to this bit requests synchronization of the register pointed to by the Address bit group (READREQ. ADDR) and sets the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY). Bit 14 – RCONT Read Continuously When continuous synchronization is enabled, the register pointed to by the Address bit group (READREQ.ADDR) will be synchronized automatically every time the register is updated. READREQ.RCONT prevents READREQ.RREQ from clearing automatically. For the continuous read mode, the RREQ bit is required to be set once the RCONT bit is set. Value Description 0 Continuous synchronization is disabled. 1 Continuous synchronization is enabled. Bits 4:0 – ADDR[4:0] Address These bits select the offset of the register that needs read synchronization. In the TC, only COUNT and CCx are available for read synchronization. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 432 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.3 Control B Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  CTRLBCLR 0x04 0x00 PAC Write-Protection, Read-Synchronized, Write-Synchronized This register allows the user to clear bits in the CTRLB register without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Control B Set register (CTRLBSET). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 CMD[1:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 2 ONESHOT R/W 0 1 0 DIR R/W 0 Bits 7:6 – CMD[1:0] Command These bits are used for software control of the TC. The commands are executed on the next prescaled GCLK_TC clock cycle. When a command has been executed, the CMD bit group will be read back as zero. Writing 0x0 to these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to any of these bits will clear the pending command. Table 27-4. Command Value Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 NONE RETRIGGER STOP - No action Force a start, restart or retrigger Force a stop Reserved Bit 2 – ONESHOT One-Shot on Counter This bit controls one-shot operation of the TC. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect Writing a '1' to this bit will disable one-shot operation. Value Description 0 The TC will wrap around and continue counting on an Overflow/Underflow condition. 1 The TC will wrap around and stop on the next Underflow/Overflow condition. Bit 0 – DIR Counter Direction This bit is used to change the direction of the counter. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will clear the bit and make the counter count up. Value Description 0 The timer/counter is counting up (incrementing). 1 The timer/counter is counting down (decrementing). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 433 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.4 Control B Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  CTRLBSET 0x05 0x00 PAC Write-Protection, Read-synchronized, Write-Synchronized This register allows the user to set bits in the CTRLB register without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Control B Clear register (CTRLBCLR). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 CMD[1:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 2 ONESHOT R/W 0 1 0 DIR R/W 0 Bits 7:6 – CMD[1:0] Command These bits are used for software control of the TC. The commands are executed on the next prescaled GCLK_TC clock cycle. When a command has been executed, the CMD bit group will be read back as zero. Writing 0x0 to these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to one of these bits will set a command. Table 27-5. Command Value Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 NONE RETRIGGER STOP - No action Force a start, restart or retrigger Force a stop Reserved Bit 2 – ONESHOT One-Shot on Counter This bit controls one-shot operation of the TC. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect Writing a '1' to this bit will enable one-shot operation. Value Description 0 The TC will wrap around and continue counting on an Overflow/Underflow condition. 1 The TC will wrap around and stop on the next Underflow/Overflow condition. Bit 0 – DIR Counter Direction This bit is used to change the direction of the counter. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will make the counter count down. Value Description 0 The timer/counter is counting up (incrementing). 1 The timer/counter is counting down (decrementing). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 434 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.5 Control C Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 CTRLC 0x06 0x00 PAC Write-Protection, Read-synchronized, Write-Synchronized 6 Access Reset 5 CPTEN1 R/W 0 4 CPTEN0 R/W 0 3 2 1 INVEN1 R/W 0 0 INVEN0 R/W 0 Bits 4, 5 – CPTENx Capture Channel x Enable These bits are used to select the capture or compare operation on channel x. Writing a '1' to CPTENx enables capture on channel x. Writing a '0' to CPTENx disables capture on channel x. Bits 0, 1 – INVENx Waveform Output x Inversion Enable These bits are used to select inversion on the output of channel x. Writing a '1' to INVENx inverts output from WO[x]. Writing a '0' to INVENx disables inversion of output from WO[x]. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 435 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.6 Debug Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit DBGCTRL 0x08 0x00 PAC Write-Protection 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 0 DBGRUN R/W 0 Bit 0 – DBGRUN Debug Run Mode This bit is not affected by a software Reset, and should not be changed by software while the TC is enabled. Value Description 0 The TC is halted when the device is halted in Debug mode. 1 The TC continues normal operation when the device is halted in Debug mode. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 436 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.7 Event Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit EVCTRL 0x0A 0x0000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected 15 14 13 MCEO1 R/W 0 12 MCEO0 R/W 0 11 10 9 8 OVFEO R/W 0 7 6 5 TCEI R/W 0 4 TCINV R/W 0 3 2 1 EVACT[2:0] R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 12, 13 – MCEOx Match or Capture Channel x Event Output Enable [x = 1..0] These bits enable the generation of an event for every match or capture on channel x. Value Description 0 Match/Capture event on channel x is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Match/Capture event on channel x is enabled and will be generated for every compare/capture. Bit 8 – OVFEO Overflow/Underflow Event Output Enable This bit enables the Overflow/Underflow event. When enabled, an event will be generated when the counter overflows/underflows. Value Description 0 Overflow/Underflow event is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Overflow/Underflow event is enabled and will be generated for every counter overflow/underflow. Bit 5 – TCEI TC Event Enable This bit is used to enable asynchronous input events to the TC. Value Description 0 Incoming events are disabled. 1 Incoming events are enabled. Bit 4 – TCINV TC Inverted Event Input Polarity This bit inverts the asynchronous input event source. Value Description 0 Input event source is not inverted. 1 Input event source is inverted. Bits 2:0 – EVACT[2:0] Event Action These bits define the event action the TC will perform on an event. Value Name Description 0x0 OFF Event action disabled 0x1 RETRIGGER Start, restart or retrigger TC on event 0x2 COUNT Count on event 0x3 START Start TC on event 0x4 0x5 PPW Period captured in CC0, pulse width in CC1 0x6 PWP Period captured in CC1, pulse width in CC0 0x7 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 437 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.8 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENCLR 0x0C 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to disable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET). Bit 7 6 Access Reset 5 MC1 R/W 0 4 MC0 R/W 0 3 SYNCRDY R/W 0 2 1 ERR R/W 0 0 OVF R/W 0 Bits 4, 5 – MCx Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable [x = 1..0] Writing a '0' to these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to MCx will clear the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Match or Capture Channel x interrupt. Value Description 0 The Match or Capture Channel x interrupt is disabled. 1 The Match or Capture Channel x interrupt is enabled. Bit 3 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Disable/Enable bit, which disables the Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – ERR Error Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will clear the Error Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Error interrupt. Value Description 0 The Error interrupt is disabled. 1 The Error interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will clear the Overflow Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Overflow interrupt request. Value Description 0 The Overflow interrupt is disabled. 1 The Overflow interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 438 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.9 Interrupt Enable Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENSET 0x0D 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to enable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR). Bit 7 6 Access Reset 5 MC1 R/W 0 4 MC0 R/W 0 3 SYNCRDY R/W 0 2 1 ERR R/W 0 0 OVF R/W 0 Bits 4, 5 – MCx Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable [x = 1..0] Writing a '0' to these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to MCx will set the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Match or Capture Channel x interrupt. Value Description 0 The Match or Capture Channel x interrupt is disabled. 1 The Match or Capture Channel x interrupt is enabled. Bit 3 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Disable/Enable bit, which disables the Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – ERR Error Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will set the Error Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Error interrupt. Value Description 0 The Error interrupt is disabled. 1 The Error interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will set the Overflow Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Overflow interrupt request. Value Description 0 The Overflow interrupt is disabled. 1 The Overflow interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 439 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.10 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTFLAG 0x0E 0x00 - 7 6 Access Reset 5 MC1 R/W 0 4 MC0 R/W 0 3 SYNCRDY R/W 0 2 1 ERR R/W 0 0 OVF R/W 0 Bits 4, 5 – MCx Match or Capture Channel x [x = 1..0] This flag is set on a comparison match, or when the corresponding CCx register contains a valid capture value. This flag is set on the next CLK_TC_CNT cycle, and will generate an interrupt request if the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET.MCx) is '1'. Writing a '0' to one of these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to one of these bits will clear the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt flag In capture operation, this flag is automatically cleared when CCx register is read. Bit 3 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Disable/Enable bit, which disables the Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – ERR Error Interrupt Flag This flag is set when a new capture occurs on a channel while the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt flag is set, in which case there is nowhere to store the new capture. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit clears the Error Interrupt flag. Bit 0 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Flag This flag is set on the next CLK_TC_CNT cycle after an Overflow condition occurs, and will generate an interrupt request if INTENCLR.OVF or INTENSET.OVF is '1'. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit clears the Overflow Interrupt flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 440 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.11 Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset STATUS 0x0F 0x08 - 7 SYNCBUSY R 0 6 5 4 SLAVE R 0 3 STOP R 1 2 1 0 Bit 7 – SYNCBUSY Synchronization Busy This bit is cleared when the synchronization of registers between the clock domains is complete. This bit is set when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is started. Bit 4 – SLAVE Client Status Flag This bit is only available in 32-bit mode on the Client TC (i.e., and/or ). The bit is set when the associated Host TC (, respectively) is set to run in 32-bit mode. Bit 3 – STOP Stop Status Flag This bit is set when the TC is disabled, on a Stop command, or on an overflow/underflow condition when the One-Shot bit in the Control B Set register (CTRLBSET.ONESHOT) is '1'. Value Description 0 Counter is running. 1 Counter is stopped. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 441 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.12 Counter Value, 8-bit Mode Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset COUNT 0x10 0x00 PAC Write-Protection, Write-Synchronized 7 6 5 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 4 3 COUNT[7:0] R/W R/W 0 0 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 7:0 – COUNT[7:0]  Counter Value These bits contain the current counter value. Note:  Prior to any read access, this register must be synchronized by the user by writing CTRLA.COUNTSYNC = 1. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 442 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.13 Period Value, 8-bit Mode Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit PER 0x14 0xFF Write-Synchronized 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 1 PER[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 7:0 – PER[7:0] Period Value These bits hold the value of the Period Buffer register PERBUF. The value is copied to PER register on UPDATE condition. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 443 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.8.14 Channel x Compare/Capture Value, 8-bit Mode Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 CCx 0x18 + x*0x01 [x=0..1] 0x00 Write-Synchronized 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 CC[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 7:0 – CC[7:0] Channel x Compare/Capture Value These bits contain the compare/capture value in 8-bit TC mode. In Match frequency (MFRQ) or Match PWM (MPWM) waveform operation (CTRLA.WAVEGEN), the CC0 register is used as a period register. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 444 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.9 Register Summary for 16-bit Registers Offset Name 0x00 CTRLA 0x02 READREQ 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x08 0x09 CTRLBCLR CTRLBSET CTRLC Reserved DBGCTRL Reserved 0x0A EVCTRL 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E 0x0F INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG STATUS 0x10 COUNT 0x12 ... 0x17 Reserved 0x18 CC0 0x1A CC1 27.10 Bit Pos. 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 7:0 7:0 7:0 7 6 5 4 3 WAVEGEN[1:0] PRESCSYNC[1:0] 2 1 MODE[1:0] ENABLE SWRST RUNSTDBY PRESCALER[2:0] ADDR[4:0] RREQ RCONT CMD[1:0] CMD[1:0] ONESHOT ONESHOT CPTEN1 CPTEN0 INVEN1 7:0 7:0 15:8 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 15:8 0 DIR DIR INVEN0 DBGRUN TCEI MCEO1 MC1 MC1 MC1 SYNCBUSY 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 TCINV MCEO0 MC0 SYNCRDY MC0 SYNCRDY MC0 SYNCRDY SLAVE STOP COUNT[7:0] COUNT[15:8] EVACT[2:0] ERR ERR ERR OVFEO OVF OVF OVF CC[7:0] CC[15:8] CC[7:0] CC[15:8] Register Description for 16-bit Registers Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16- and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers are optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC). Optional PAC writeprotection is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. For details, refer to 27.5.7. Register Access Protection Some registers are synchronized when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the "WriteSynchronized" or the "Read-Synchronized" property in each individual register description. For details, refer to 27.6.5. Synchronization. Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the peripheral is disabled. Enableprotection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 445 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.10.1 Control A Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 15 CTRLA 0x00 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection, Write-Synchronized bits, Enable-Protected bits 14 Access Reset Bit Access Reset 7 13 12 PRESCSYNC[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 6 5 WAVEGEN[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 4 11 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 10 R/W 0 3 2 MODE[1:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 9 PRESCALER[2:0] R/W 0 8 R/W 0 1 ENABLE R/W 0 0 SWRST R/W 0 Bits 13:12 – PRESCSYNC[1:0] Prescaler and Counter Synchronization These bits select whether the counter should wrap around on the next GCLK_TCx clock or the next prescaled GCLK_TCx clock. It also makes it possible to reset the prescaler. These bits are not write-synchronized, but are enable-protected. Value Name Description 0x0 GCLK Reload or reset the counter on next generic clock 0x1 PRESC Reload or reset the counter on next prescaler clock 0x2 RESYNC Reload or reset the counter on next generic clock. Reset the prescaler counter 0x3 Reserved Bit 11 – RUNSTDBY Run in Standby This bit is used to keep the TC running in Standby mode. This bit is not write-synchronized, but is enable-protected. Value Description 0 The TC is halted in standby. 1 The TC continues to run in standby. Bits 10:8 – PRESCALER[2:0] Prescaler These bits select the counter prescaler factor. These bits are not write-synchronized, but are enable protected. Value Name Description 0x0 DIV1 Prescaler: GCLK_TC 0x1 DIV2 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/2 0x2 DIV4 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/4 0x3 DIV8 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/8 0x4 DIV16 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/16 0x5 DIV64 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/64 0x6 DIV256 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/256 0x7 DIV1024 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/1024 Bits 6:5 – WAVEGEN[1:0] Waveform Generation Operation These bits select the waveform generation operation. They affect the top value, as shown in “Waveform Output Operations”. It also controls whether frequency or PWM waveform generation should be used. How these modes differ can also be seen from “Waveform Output Operations”. These bits are not write-synchronized, but are enable-protected. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 446 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter Table 27-6. Waveform Generation Operation Value Name Operation Top Value 0x0 0x1 0x2 NFRQ MFRQ NPWM Normal frequency PER(1)/Max Match frequency CC0 Normal PWM PER(1)/Max 0x3 MPWM Match PWM CC0 Waveform Output on Match Waveform Output on Wraparound Toggle Toggle Clear when counting up Set when counting down Clear when counting up Set when counting down No action No action Set when counting up Clear when counting down Set when counting up Clear when counting down Note:  1. This depends on the TC mode. In 8-bit mode, the top value is the Period Value register (PER). In 16-bit and 32-bit modes it is the maximum value. Bits 3:2 – MODE[1:0] Timer Counter Mode These bits select the Counter mode. These bits are not write-synchronized, but are enable protected. Value Name Description 0x0 COUNT16 Counter in 16-bit mode 0x1 COUNT8 Counter in 8-bit mode 0x2 COUNT32 Counter in 32-bit mode 0x3 Reserved Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable Due to synchronization, there is delay from writing CTRLA.ENABLE until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to CTRLA.ENABLE will read back immediately, and the ENABLE Synchronization Busy bit in the SYNCBUSY register (SYNCBUSY.ENABLE) will be set. SYNCBUSY.ENABLE will be cleared when the operation is complete. This bit is not enable protected. Value Description 0 The peripheral is disabled. 1 The peripheral is enabled. Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit resets all registers in the TC, except DBGCTRL, to their initial state, and the TC will be disabled. Writing a '1' to CTRLA.SWRST will always take precedence; all other writes in the same write-operation will be discarded. Due to synchronization there is a delay from writing CTRLA.SWRST until the reset is complete. CTRLA.SWRST and SYNCBUSY.SWRST will both be cleared when the reset is complete. This bit is not enable protected. Value Description 0 There is no reset operation ongoing. 1 The reset operation is ongoing. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 447 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.10.2 Read Request Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Bit Access Reset Bit READREQ 0x02 0x0000 15 RREQ W 0 14 RCONT R/W 0 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 2 ADDR[4:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit 15 – RREQ Read Request Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. This bit will always read as zero. Writing a one to this bit requests synchronization of the register pointed to by the Address bit group (READREQ. ADDR) and sets the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY). Bit 14 – RCONT Read Continuously When continuous synchronization is enabled, the register pointed to by the Address bit group (READREQ.ADDR) will be synchronized automatically every time the register is updated. READREQ.RCONT prevents READREQ.RREQ from clearing automatically. For the continuous read mode, the RREQ bit is required to be set once the RCONT bit is set. Value Description 0 Continuous synchronization is disabled. 1 Continuous synchronization is enabled. Bits 4:0 – ADDR[4:0] Address These bits select the offset of the register that needs read synchronization. In the TC, only COUNT and CCx are available for read synchronization. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 448 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.10.3 Control B Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  CTRLBCLR 0x04 0x00 PAC Write-Protection, Read-Synchronized, Write-Synchronized This register allows the user to clear bits in the CTRLB register without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Control B Set register (CTRLBSET). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 CMD[1:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 2 ONESHOT R/W 0 1 0 DIR R/W 0 Bits 7:6 – CMD[1:0] Command These bits are used for software control of the TC. The commands are executed on the next prescaled GCLK_TC clock cycle. When a command has been executed, the CMD bit group will be read back as zero. Writing 0x0 to these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to any of these bits will clear the pending command. Table 27-7. Command Value Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 NONE RETRIGGER STOP - No action Force a start, restart or retrigger Force a stop Reserved Bit 2 – ONESHOT One-Shot on Counter This bit controls one-shot operation of the TC. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect Writing a '1' to this bit will disable one-shot operation. Value Description 0 The TC will wrap around and continue counting on an Overflow/Underflow condition. 1 The TC will wrap around and stop on the next Underflow/Overflow condition. Bit 0 – DIR Counter Direction This bit is used to change the direction of the counter. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will clear the bit and make the counter count up. Value Description 0 The timer/counter is counting up (incrementing). 1 The timer/counter is counting down (decrementing). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 449 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.10.4 Control B Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  CTRLBSET 0x05 0x00 PAC Write-Protection, Read-synchronized, Write-Synchronized This register allows the user to set bits in the CTRLB register without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Control B Clear register (CTRLBCLR). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 CMD[1:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 2 ONESHOT R/W 0 1 0 DIR R/W 0 Bits 7:6 – CMD[1:0] Command These bits are used for software control of the TC. The commands are executed on the next prescaled GCLK_TC clock cycle. When a command has been executed, the CMD bit group will be read back as zero. Writing 0x0 to these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to one of these bits will set a command. Table 27-8. Command Value Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 NONE RETRIGGER STOP - No action Force a start, restart or retrigger Force a stop Reserved Bit 2 – ONESHOT One-Shot on Counter This bit controls one-shot operation of the TC. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect Writing a '1' to this bit will enable one-shot operation. Value Description 0 The TC will wrap around and continue counting on an Overflow/Underflow condition. 1 The TC will wrap around and stop on the next Underflow/Overflow condition. Bit 0 – DIR Counter Direction This bit is used to change the direction of the counter. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will make the counter count down. Value Description 0 The timer/counter is counting up (incrementing). 1 The timer/counter is counting down (decrementing). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 450 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.10.5 Control C Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 CTRLC 0x06 0x00 PAC Write-Protection, Read-synchronized, Write-Synchronized 6 Access Reset 5 CPTEN1 R/W 0 4 CPTEN0 R/W 0 3 2 1 INVEN1 R/W 0 0 INVEN0 R/W 0 Bits 4, 5 – CPTENx Capture Channel x Enable These bits are used to select the capture or compare operation on channel x. Writing a '1' to CPTENx enables capture on channel x. Writing a '0' to CPTENx disables capture on channel x. Bits 0, 1 – INVENx Waveform Output x Inversion Enable These bits are used to select inversion on the output of channel x. Writing a '1' to INVENx inverts output from WO[x]. Writing a '0' to INVENx disables inversion of output from WO[x]. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 451 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.10.6 Debug Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit DBGCTRL 0x08 0x00 PAC Write-Protection 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 0 DBGRUN R/W 0 Bit 0 – DBGRUN Debug Run Mode This bit is not affected by a software Reset, and should not be changed by software while the TC is enabled. Value Description 0 The TC is halted when the device is halted in Debug mode. 1 The TC continues normal operation when the device is halted in Debug mode. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 452 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.10.7 Event Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit EVCTRL 0x0A 0x0000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected 15 14 13 MCEO1 R/W 0 12 MCEO0 R/W 0 11 10 9 8 OVFEO R/W 0 7 6 5 TCEI R/W 0 4 TCINV R/W 0 3 2 1 EVACT[2:0] R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 12, 13 – MCEOx Match or Capture Channel x Event Output Enable [x = 1..0] These bits enable the generation of an event for every match or capture on channel x. Value Description 0 Match/Capture event on channel x is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Match/Capture event on channel x is enabled and will be generated for every compare/capture. Bit 8 – OVFEO Overflow/Underflow Event Output Enable This bit enables the Overflow/Underflow event. When enabled, an event will be generated when the counter overflows/underflows. Value Description 0 Overflow/Underflow event is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Overflow/Underflow event is enabled and will be generated for every counter overflow/underflow. Bit 5 – TCEI TC Event Enable This bit is used to enable asynchronous input events to the TC. Value Description 0 Incoming events are disabled. 1 Incoming events are enabled. Bit 4 – TCINV TC Inverted Event Input Polarity This bit inverts the asynchronous input event source. Value Description 0 Input event source is not inverted. 1 Input event source is inverted. Bits 2:0 – EVACT[2:0] Event Action These bits define the event action the TC will perform on an event. Value Name Description 0x0 OFF Event action disabled 0x1 RETRIGGER Start, restart or retrigger TC on event 0x2 COUNT Count on event 0x3 START Start TC on event 0x4 0x5 PPW Period captured in CC0, pulse width in CC1 0x6 PWP Period captured in CC1, pulse width in CC0 0x7 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 453 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.10.8 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENCLR 0x0C 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to disable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET). Bit 7 6 Access Reset 5 MC1 R/W 0 4 MC0 R/W 0 3 SYNCRDY R/W 0 2 1 ERR R/W 0 0 OVF R/W 0 Bits 4, 5 – MCx Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable [x = 1..0] Writing a '0' to these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to MCx will clear the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Match or Capture Channel x interrupt. Value Description 0 The Match or Capture Channel x interrupt is disabled. 1 The Match or Capture Channel x interrupt is enabled. Bit 3 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Disable/Enable bit, which disables the Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – ERR Error Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will clear the Error Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Error interrupt. Value Description 0 The Error interrupt is disabled. 1 The Error interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will clear the Overflow Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Overflow interrupt request. Value Description 0 The Overflow interrupt is disabled. 1 The Overflow interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 454 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.10.9 Interrupt Enable Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENSET 0x0D 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to enable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR). Bit 7 6 Access Reset 5 MC1 R/W 0 4 MC0 R/W 0 3 SYNCRDY R/W 0 2 1 ERR R/W 0 0 OVF R/W 0 Bits 4, 5 – MCx Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable [x = 1..0] Writing a '0' to these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to MCx will set the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Match or Capture Channel x interrupt. Value Description 0 The Match or Capture Channel x interrupt is disabled. 1 The Match or Capture Channel x interrupt is enabled. Bit 3 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Disable/Enable bit, which disables the Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – ERR Error Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will set the Error Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Error interrupt. Value Description 0 The Error interrupt is disabled. 1 The Error interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will set the Overflow Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Overflow interrupt request. Value Description 0 The Overflow interrupt is disabled. 1 The Overflow interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 455 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.10.10 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTFLAG 0x0E 0x00 - 7 6 Access Reset 5 MC1 R/W 0 4 MC0 R/W 0 3 SYNCRDY R/W 0 2 1 ERR R/W 0 0 OVF R/W 0 Bits 4, 5 – MCx Match or Capture Channel x [x = 1..0] This flag is set on a comparison match, or when the corresponding CCx register contains a valid capture value. This flag is set on the next CLK_TC_CNT cycle, and will generate an interrupt request if the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET.MCx) is '1'. Writing a '0' to one of these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to one of these bits will clear the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt flag In capture operation, this flag is automatically cleared when CCx register is read. Bit 3 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Disable/Enable bit, which disables the Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – ERR Error Interrupt Flag This flag is set when a new capture occurs on a channel while the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt flag is set, in which case there is nowhere to store the new capture. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit clears the Error Interrupt flag. Bit 0 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Flag This flag is set on the next CLK_TC_CNT cycle after an Overflow condition occurs, and will generate an interrupt request if INTENCLR.OVF or INTENSET.OVF is '1'. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit clears the Overflow Interrupt flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 456 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.10.11 Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset STATUS 0x0F 0x08 - 7 SYNCBUSY R 0 6 5 4 SLAVE R 0 3 STOP R 1 2 1 0 Bit 7 – SYNCBUSY Synchronization Busy This bit is cleared when the synchronization of registers between the clock domains is complete. This bit is set when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is started. Bit 4 – SLAVE Client Status Flag This bit is only available in 32-bit mode on the Client TC (i.e., and/or ). The bit is set when the associated Host TC (, respectively) is set to run in 32-bit mode. Bit 3 – STOP Stop Status Flag This bit is set when the TC is disabled, on a Stop command, or on an overflow/underflow condition when the One-Shot bit in the Control B Set register (CTRLBSET.ONESHOT) is '1'. Value Description 0 Counter is running. 1 Counter is stopped. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 457 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.10.12 Counter Value, 16-bit Mode Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset COUNT 0x10 0x00 PAC Write-Protection, Write-Synchronized 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 12 11 COUNT[15:8] R/W R/W 0 0 4 3 COUNT[7:0] R/W R/W 0 0 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 15:0 – COUNT[15:0]  Counter Value These bits contain the current counter value. Note:  Prior to any read access, this register must be synchronized by the user by writing CTRLA.COUNTSYNC = 1. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 458 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.10.13 Channel x Compare/Capture Value, 16-bit Mode Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 15 CCx 0x18 + x*0x02 [x=0..1] 0x0000 Write-Synchronized 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 CC[15:8] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 CC[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 15:0 – CC[15:0] Channel x Compare/Capture Value These bits contain the compare/capture value in 16-bit TC mode. In Match frequency (MFRQ) or Match PWM (MPWM) waveform operation (CTRLA.WAVEGEN), the CC0 register is used as a period register. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 459 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.11 Register Summary for 32-bit Registers Offset Name 0x00 CTRLA 0x02 READREQ 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x08 0x09 CTRLBCLR CTRLBSET CTRLC Reserved DBGCTRL Reserved 0x0A EVCTRL 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E 0x0F INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG STATUS 0x10 COUNT 0x14 ... 0x17 Reserved 0x18 CC0 0x1C CC1 27.12 Bit Pos. 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 7:0 7:0 7:0 7 6 5 4 3 WAVEGEN[1:0] PRESCSYNC[1:0] 2 1 MODE[1:0] ENABLE SWRST RUNSTDBY PRESCALER[2:0] ADDR[4:0] RREQ RCONT CMD[1:0] CMD[1:0] ONESHOT ONESHOT CPTEN1 CPTEN0 INVEN1 7:0 7:0 15:8 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 0 DIR DIR INVEN0 DBGRUN TCEI MCEO1 MC1 MC1 MC1 SYNCBUSY 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 TCINV MCEO0 MC0 SYNCRDY MC0 SYNCRDY MC0 SYNCRDY SLAVE STOP COUNT[7:0] COUNT[15:8] COUNT[23:16] COUNT[31:24] EVACT[2:0] ERR ERR ERR OVFEO OVF OVF OVF CC[7:0] CC[15:8] CC[23:16] CC[31:24] CC[7:0] CC[15:8] CC[23:16] CC[31:24] Register Description for 32-bit Registers Registers can be 8, 16, or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16- and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register, and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers are optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC). Optional PAC writeprotection is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. For details, refer to 27.5.7. Register Access Protection Some registers are synchronized when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the "WriteSynchronized" or the "Read-Synchronized" property in each individual register description. For details, refer to 27.6.5. Synchronization. Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can only be written when the peripheral is disabled. Enableprotection is denoted by the "Enable-Protected" property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 460 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.12.1 Control A Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 15 CTRLA 0x00 0x00000000 PAC Write-Protection, Write-Synchronized bits, Enable-Protected bits 14 Access Reset Bit Access Reset 7 13 12 PRESCSYNC[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 6 5 WAVEGEN[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 4 11 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 10 R/W 0 3 2 MODE[1:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 9 PRESCALER[2:0] R/W 0 8 R/W 0 1 ENABLE R/W 0 0 SWRST R/W 0 Bits 13:12 – PRESCSYNC[1:0] Prescaler and Counter Synchronization These bits select whether the counter should wrap around on the next GCLK_TCx clock or the next prescaled GCLK_TCx clock. It also makes it possible to reset the prescaler. These bits are not write-synchronized, but are enable-protected. Value Name Description 0x0 GCLK Reload or reset the counter on next generic clock 0x1 PRESC Reload or reset the counter on next prescaler clock 0x2 RESYNC Reload or reset the counter on next generic clock. Reset the prescaler counter 0x3 Reserved Bit 11 – RUNSTDBY Run in Standby This bit is used to keep the TC running in Standby mode. This bit is not write-synchronized, but is enable-protected. Value Description 0 The TC is halted in standby. 1 The TC continues to run in standby. Bits 10:8 – PRESCALER[2:0] Prescaler These bits select the counter prescaler factor. These bits are not write-synchronized, but are enable protected. Value Name Description 0x0 DIV1 Prescaler: GCLK_TC 0x1 DIV2 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/2 0x2 DIV4 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/4 0x3 DIV8 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/8 0x4 DIV16 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/16 0x5 DIV64 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/64 0x6 DIV256 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/256 0x7 DIV1024 Prescaler: GCLK_TC/1024 Bits 6:5 – WAVEGEN[1:0] Waveform Generation Operation These bits select the waveform generation operation. They affect the top value, as shown in “Waveform Output Operations”. It also controls whether frequency or PWM waveform generation should be used. How these modes differ can also be seen from “Waveform Output Operations”. These bits are not write-synchronized, but are enable-protected. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 461 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter Table 27-9. Waveform Generation Operation Value Name Operation Top Value 0x0 0x1 0x2 NFRQ MFRQ NPWM Normal frequency PER(1)/Max Match frequency CC0 Normal PWM PER(1)/Max 0x3 MPWM Match PWM CC0 Waveform Output on Match Waveform Output on Wraparound Toggle Toggle Clear when counting up Set when counting down Clear when counting up Set when counting down No action No action Set when counting up Clear when counting down Set when counting up Clear when counting down Note:  1. This depends on the TC mode. In 8-bit mode, the top value is the Period Value register (PER). In 16-bit and 32-bit modes it is the maximum value. Bits 3:2 – MODE[1:0] Timer Counter Mode These bits select the Counter mode. These bits are not write-synchronized, but are enable protected. Value Name Description 0x0 COUNT16 Counter in 16-bit mode 0x1 COUNT8 Counter in 8-bit mode 0x2 COUNT32 Counter in 32-bit mode 0x3 Reserved Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable Due to synchronization, there is delay from writing CTRLA.ENABLE until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to CTRLA.ENABLE will read back immediately, and the ENABLE Synchronization Busy bit in the SYNCBUSY register (SYNCBUSY.ENABLE) will be set. SYNCBUSY.ENABLE will be cleared when the operation is complete. This bit is not enable protected. Value Description 0 The peripheral is disabled. 1 The peripheral is enabled. Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit resets all registers in the TC, except DBGCTRL, to their initial state, and the TC will be disabled. Writing a '1' to CTRLA.SWRST will always take precedence; all other writes in the same write-operation will be discarded. Due to synchronization there is a delay from writing CTRLA.SWRST until the reset is complete. CTRLA.SWRST and SYNCBUSY.SWRST will both be cleared when the reset is complete. This bit is not enable protected. Value Description 0 There is no reset operation ongoing. 1 The reset operation is ongoing. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 462 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.12.2 Read Request Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Bit Access Reset Bit READREQ 0x02 0x0000 15 RREQ W 0 14 RCONT R/W 0 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 2 ADDR[4:0] R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Access Reset Bit 15 – RREQ Read Request Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. This bit will always read as zero. Writing a one to this bit requests synchronization of the register pointed to by the Address bit group (READREQ. ADDR) and sets the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY). Bit 14 – RCONT Read Continuously When continuous synchronization is enabled, the register pointed to by the Address bit group (READREQ.ADDR) will be synchronized automatically every time the register is updated. READREQ.RCONT prevents READREQ.RREQ from clearing automatically. For the continuous read mode, the RREQ bit is required to be set once the RCONT bit is set. Value Description 0 Continuous synchronization is disabled. 1 Continuous synchronization is enabled. Bits 4:0 – ADDR[4:0] Address These bits select the offset of the register that needs read synchronization. In the TC, only COUNT and CCx are available for read synchronization. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 463 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.12.3 Control B Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  CTRLBCLR 0x04 0x00 PAC Write-Protection, Read-Synchronized, Write-Synchronized This register allows the user to clear bits in the CTRLB register without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Control B Set register (CTRLBSET). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 CMD[1:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 2 ONESHOT R/W 0 1 0 DIR R/W 0 Bits 7:6 – CMD[1:0] Command These bits are used for software control of the TC. The commands are executed on the next prescaled GCLK_TC clock cycle. When a command has been executed, the CMD bit group will be read back as zero. Writing 0x0 to these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to any of these bits will clear the pending command. Table 27-10. Command Value Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 NONE RETRIGGER STOP - No action Force a start, restart or retrigger Force a stop Reserved Bit 2 – ONESHOT One-Shot on Counter This bit controls one-shot operation of the TC. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect Writing a '1' to this bit will disable one-shot operation. Value Description 0 The TC will wrap around and continue counting on an Overflow/Underflow condition. 1 The TC will wrap around and stop on the next Underflow/Overflow condition. Bit 0 – DIR Counter Direction This bit is used to change the direction of the counter. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will clear the bit and make the counter count up. Value Description 0 The timer/counter is counting up (incrementing). 1 The timer/counter is counting down (decrementing). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 464 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.12.4 Control B Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  CTRLBSET 0x05 0x00 PAC Write-Protection, Read-synchronized, Write-Synchronized This register allows the user to set bits in the CTRLB register without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Control B Clear register (CTRLBCLR). Bit 7 6 5 4 3 CMD[1:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 2 ONESHOT R/W 0 1 0 DIR R/W 0 Bits 7:6 – CMD[1:0] Command These bits are used for software control of the TC. The commands are executed on the next prescaled GCLK_TC clock cycle. When a command has been executed, the CMD bit group will be read back as zero. Writing 0x0 to these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to one of these bits will set a command. Table 27-11. Command Value Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 NONE RETRIGGER STOP - No action Force a start, restart or retrigger Force a stop Reserved Bit 2 – ONESHOT One-Shot on Counter This bit controls one-shot operation of the TC. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect Writing a '1' to this bit will enable one-shot operation. Value Description 0 The TC will wrap around and continue counting on an Overflow/Underflow condition. 1 The TC will wrap around and stop on the next Underflow/Overflow condition. Bit 0 – DIR Counter Direction This bit is used to change the direction of the counter. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will make the counter count down. Value Description 0 The timer/counter is counting up (incrementing). 1 The timer/counter is counting down (decrementing). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 465 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.12.5 Control C Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 CTRLC 0x06 0x00 PAC Write-Protection, Read-synchronized, Write-Synchronized 6 Access Reset 5 CPTEN1 R/W 0 4 CPTEN0 R/W 0 3 2 1 INVEN1 R/W 0 0 INVEN0 R/W 0 Bits 4, 5 – CPTENx Capture Channel x Enable These bits are used to select the capture or compare operation on channel x. Writing a '1' to CPTENx enables capture on channel x. Writing a '0' to CPTENx disables capture on channel x. Bits 0, 1 – INVENx Waveform Output x Inversion Enable These bits are used to select inversion on the output of channel x. Writing a '1' to INVENx inverts output from WO[x]. Writing a '0' to INVENx disables inversion of output from WO[x]. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 466 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.12.6 Debug Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit DBGCTRL 0x08 0x00 PAC Write-Protection 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 0 DBGRUN R/W 0 Bit 0 – DBGRUN Debug Run Mode This bit is not affected by a software Reset, and should not be changed by software while the TC is enabled. Value Description 0 The TC is halted when the device is halted in Debug mode. 1 The TC continues normal operation when the device is halted in Debug mode. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 467 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.12.7 Event Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit EVCTRL 0x0A 0x0000 PAC Write-Protection, Enable-Protected 15 14 13 MCEO1 R/W 0 12 MCEO0 R/W 0 11 10 9 8 OVFEO R/W 0 7 6 5 TCEI R/W 0 4 TCINV R/W 0 3 2 1 EVACT[2:0] R/W 0 0 Access Reset Bit Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 12, 13 – MCEOx Match or Capture Channel x Event Output Enable [x = 1..0] These bits enable the generation of an event for every match or capture on channel x. Value Description 0 Match/Capture event on channel x is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Match/Capture event on channel x is enabled and will be generated for every compare/capture. Bit 8 – OVFEO Overflow/Underflow Event Output Enable This bit enables the Overflow/Underflow event. When enabled, an event will be generated when the counter overflows/underflows. Value Description 0 Overflow/Underflow event is disabled and will not be generated. 1 Overflow/Underflow event is enabled and will be generated for every counter overflow/underflow. Bit 5 – TCEI TC Event Enable This bit is used to enable asynchronous input events to the TC. Value Description 0 Incoming events are disabled. 1 Incoming events are enabled. Bit 4 – TCINV TC Inverted Event Input Polarity This bit inverts the asynchronous input event source. Value Description 0 Input event source is not inverted. 1 Input event source is inverted. Bits 2:0 – EVACT[2:0] Event Action These bits define the event action the TC will perform on an event. Value Name Description 0x0 OFF Event action disabled 0x1 RETRIGGER Start, restart or retrigger TC on event 0x2 COUNT Count on event 0x3 START Start TC on event 0x4 0x5 PPW Period captured in CC0, pulse width in CC1 0x6 PWP Period captured in CC1, pulse width in CC0 0x7 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 468 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.12.8 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENCLR 0x0C 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to disable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET). Bit 7 6 Access Reset 5 MC1 R/W 0 4 MC0 R/W 0 3 SYNCRDY R/W 0 2 1 ERR R/W 0 0 OVF R/W 0 Bits 4, 5 – MCx Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable [x = 1..0] Writing a '0' to these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to MCx will clear the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Match or Capture Channel x interrupt. Value Description 0 The Match or Capture Channel x interrupt is disabled. 1 The Match or Capture Channel x interrupt is enabled. Bit 3 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Disable/Enable bit, which disables the Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – ERR Error Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will clear the Error Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Error interrupt. Value Description 0 The Error interrupt is disabled. 1 The Error interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will clear the Overflow Interrupt Enable bit, which disables the Overflow interrupt request. Value Description 0 The Overflow interrupt is disabled. 1 The Overflow interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 469 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.12.9 Interrupt Enable Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  INTENSET 0x0D 0x00 PAC Write-Protection This register allows the user to enable an interrupt without doing a read-modify-write operation. Changes in this register will also be reflected in the Interrupt Enable Clear register (INTENCLR). Bit 7 6 Access Reset 5 MC1 R/W 0 4 MC0 R/W 0 3 SYNCRDY R/W 0 2 1 ERR R/W 0 0 OVF R/W 0 Bits 4, 5 – MCx Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable [x = 1..0] Writing a '0' to these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to MCx will set the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Match or Capture Channel x interrupt. Value Description 0 The Match or Capture Channel x interrupt is disabled. 1 The Match or Capture Channel x interrupt is enabled. Bit 3 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Disable/Enable bit, which disables the Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – ERR Error Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will set the Error Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Error interrupt. Value Description 0 The Error interrupt is disabled. 1 The Error interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit will set the Overflow Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Overflow interrupt request. Value Description 0 The Overflow interrupt is disabled. 1 The Overflow interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 470 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.12.10 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTFLAG 0x0E 0x00 - 7 6 Access Reset 5 MC1 R/W 0 4 MC0 R/W 0 3 SYNCRDY R/W 0 2 1 ERR R/W 0 0 OVF R/W 0 Bits 4, 5 – MCx Match or Capture Channel x [x = 1..0] This flag is set on a comparison match, or when the corresponding CCx register contains a valid capture value. This flag is set on the next CLK_TC_CNT cycle, and will generate an interrupt request if the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt Enable bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET.MCx) is '1'. Writing a '0' to one of these bits has no effect. Writing a '1' to one of these bits will clear the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt flag In capture operation, this flag is automatically cleared when CCx register is read. Bit 3 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Disable/Enable bit, which disables the Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – ERR Error Interrupt Flag This flag is set when a new capture occurs on a channel while the corresponding Match or Capture Channel x Interrupt flag is set, in which case there is nowhere to store the new capture. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit clears the Error Interrupt flag. Bit 0 – OVF Overflow Interrupt Flag This flag is set on the next CLK_TC_CNT cycle after an Overflow condition occurs, and will generate an interrupt request if INTENCLR.OVF or INTENSET.OVF is '1'. Writing a '0' to this bit has no effect. Writing a '1' to this bit clears the Overflow Interrupt flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 471 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.12.11 Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset STATUS 0x0F 0x08 - 7 SYNCBUSY R 0 6 5 4 SLAVE R 0 3 STOP R 1 2 1 0 Bit 7 – SYNCBUSY Synchronization Busy This bit is cleared when the synchronization of registers between the clock domains is complete. This bit is set when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is started. Bit 4 – SLAVE Client Status Flag This bit is only available in 32-bit mode on the Client TC (i.e., and/or ). The bit is set when the associated Host TC (, respectively) is set to run in 32-bit mode. Bit 3 – STOP Stop Status Flag This bit is set when the TC is disabled, on a Stop command, or on an overflow/underflow condition when the One-Shot bit in the Control B Set register (CTRLBSET.ONESHOT) is '1'. Value Description 0 Counter is running. 1 Counter is stopped. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 472 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.12.12 Counter Value, 32-bit Mode Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit Access Reset COUNT 0x10 0x00 PAC Write-Protection, Write-Synchronized 31 30 29 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 23 22 21 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 28 27 COUNT[31:24] R/W R/W 0 0 20 19 COUNT[23:16] R/W R/W 0 0 12 11 COUNT[15:8] R/W R/W 0 0 4 3 COUNT[7:0] R/W R/W 0 0 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 31:0 – COUNT[31:0]  Counter Value These bits contain the current counter value. Note:  Prior to any read access, this register must be synchronized by the user by writing CTRLA.COUNTSYNC=1. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 473 SAM D20 Family TC – Timer/Counter 27.12.13 Channel x Compare/Capture Value, 32-bit Mode Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 31 CCx 0x18 + x*0x04 [x=0..1] 0x00000000 Write-Synchronized 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 19 18 17 16 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 11 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 CC[31:24] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 23 22 21 20 CC[23:16] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 15 14 13 12 CC[15:8] Access Reset Bit R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 4 CC[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 31:0 – CC[31:0] Channel x Compare/Capture Value These bits contain the compare/capture value in 32-bit TC mode. In Match frequency (MFRQ) or Match PWM (MPWM) waveform operation (CTRLA.WAVEGEN), the CC0 register is used as a period register. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 474 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28. 28.1 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Overview The ADC converts analog signals to digital values. The ADC has 12-bit resolution and is capable of converting up to 350 ksps. The input selection is flexible as both differential and single-ended measurements can be performed. An optional gain stage is available to increase the dynamic range. In addition, several internal signal inputs are available. The ADC can provide both signed and unsigned results. ADC measurements can be started by either application software or an incoming event from another peripheral in the device. ADC measurements can be started with predictable timing and without software intervention. Both internal and external reference voltages can be used. An integrated temperature sensor is available for use with the ADC. The bandgap voltage as well as the scaled I/O and core voltages can also be measured by the ADC. The ADC has a compare function for accurate monitoring of user-defined thresholds with minimum software intervention required. The ADC can be configured for 8-bit, 10-bit, or 12-bit results, reducing the conversion time. ADC conversion results are provided left or right adjusted, which eases calculation when the result is represented as a signed value. 28.2 Features • • • • • • • • • • • • • 8-bit, 10-bit, or 12-bit resolution Up to 350,000 samples per second (350 ksps) Differential and single-ended inputs: – Up to 32 analog input – 25 positive and 10 negative, including internal and external Five internal inputs – Bandgap – Temperature sensor – DAC – Scaled core supply – Scaled I/O supply 1/2x to 16x gain Single, Continuous and Pin-scan Conversion Options Windowing Monitor with Selectable Channel Conversion Range: – Vref [1v to VDDANA - 0.6V] – ADCx * GAIN [0V to -Vref ] Built-in Internal Reference and External Reference Options: – Four bits for reference selection Event-triggered Conversion for Accurate Timing (One Event Input) Hardware Gain and Offset Compensation Averaging and Oversampling with Decimation to Support, up to 16-bit Result Selectable Sampling Time © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 475 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.3 Block Diagram Figure 28-1. ADC Block Diagram CTRLA WINCTRL AVGCTRL WINLT SAMPCTRL WINUT EVCTRL OFFSETCORR SWTRIG GAINCORR INPUTCTRL ADC0 ... ADCn INT.SIG ADC POST PROCESSING RESULT ADC0 ... ADCn INT.SIG INT1V CTRLB INTVCC0/1 VREFA VREFB PRESCALER REFCTRL Note:  INT1V is the buffered internal reference of 1.0V, derived from the internal 1.1V bandgap reference. 28.4 Signal Description Signal Name Type Description VREFA Analog input External reference voltage A VREFB Analog input External reference voltage B ADC[19..0](1) Analog input Analog input channels Note:  Refer to Configuration Summary for details on exact number of analog input channels. Note:  Refer to I/O Multiplexing and Considerations for details on the pin mapping for this peripheral. One signal can be mapped on several pins. Related Links 6. I/O Multiplexing and Considerations 1. Configuration Summary 28.5 Product Dependencies In order to use this peripheral, other parts of the system must be configured correctly, as described below. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 476 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.5.1 I/O Lines Using the ADC's I/O lines requires the I/O pins to be configured using the port configuration (PORT). Related Links 21. PORT - I/O Pin Controller 28.5.2 Power Management The ADC will continue to operate in any Sleep mode where the selected source clock is running. The ADC’s interrupts, except the OVERRUN interrupt, can be used to wake up the device from sleep modes. Events connected to the event system can trigger other operations in the system without exiting sleep modes. Related Links 15. Power Manager (PM) 28.5.3 Clocks The ADC can be enabled in the Main Clock, which also defines the default state. This clock must be configured and enabled in the Generic Clock Controller (GCLK) before using the ADC. A generic clock is asynchronous to the bus clock. Due to this asynchronicity, writes to certain registers will require synchronization between the clock domains. Refer to Synchronization for further details. Related Links 14. GCLK - Generic Clock Controller 28.5.4 Interrupts The interrupt request line is connected to the interrupt controller. Using the ADC interrupt requires the interrupt controller to be configured first. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 28.5.5 Events The events are connected to the Event System. Related Links 22. Event System (EVSYS) 28.5.6 Debug Operation When the CPU is halted in Debug mode the ADC will halt normal operation. The ADC can be forced to continue operation during debugging. 28.5.7 Register Access Protection All registers with write-access are optionally write-protected by the peripheral access controller (PAC), except the following register: • Interrupt Flag Status and Clear (INTFLAG) register Optional write-protection by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC) is denoted by the "PAC Write-Protection" property in each individual register description. PAC write-protection does not apply to accesses through an external debugger. Related Links 10.5. PAC - Peripheral Access Controller 28.5.8 Analog Connections I/O-pins AIN0 to AIN19 as well as the VREFA/VREFB reference voltage pin are analog inputs to the ADC. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 477 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.5.9 Calibration The values BIAS_CAL and LINEARITY_CAL from the production test must be loaded from the NVM Software Calibration Area into the ADC Calibration register (CALIB) by software to achieve specified accuracy. 28.6 Functional Description 28.6.1 Principle of Operation By default, the ADC provides results with 12-bit resolution. 8-bit or 10-bit results can be selected in order to reduce the conversion time. The ADC has an oversampling with decimation option that can extend the resolution to 16 bits. The input values can be either internal (e.g., internal temperature sensor) or external (connected I/O pins). The user can also configure whether the conversion should be single-ended or differential. 28.6.2 Basic Operation 28.6.2.1 Initialization Before enabling the ADC, the asynchronous clock source must be selected and enabled, and the ADC reference must be configured. The first conversion after the reference is changed must not be used. All other configuration registers must be stable during the conversion. The source for GCLK_ADC is selected and enabled in the System Controller (SYSCTRL). Refer to SYSCTRL – System Controller for more details. When GCLK_ADC is enabled, the ADC can be enabled by writing a one to the Enable bit in the Control Register A (CTRLA.ENABLE). Related Links 16. SYSCTRL – System Controller 28.6.2.2 Enabling, Disabling and Reset The ADC is enabled by writing a '1' to the Enable bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.ENABLE). The ADC is disabled by writing CTRLA.ENABLE=0. The ADC is reset by writing a '1' to the Software Reset bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.SWRST). All registers in the ADC, except DBGCTRL, will be reset to their initial state, and the ADC will be disabled. The ADC must be disabled before it is reset. 28.6.2.3 Operation In the most basic configuration, the ADC samples values from the configured internal or external sources (INPUTCTRL register). The rate of the conversion depends on the combination of the GCLK_ADCx frequency and the clock prescaler. To convert analog values to digital values, the ADC needs to be initialized first, as described in 28.6.2.1. Initialization. Data conversion can be started either manually by setting the Start bit in the Software Trigger register (SWTRIG.START=1), or automatically by configuring an automatic trigger to initiate the conversions. A free-running mode can be used to continuously convert an input channel. When using free-running mode the first conversion must be started, while subsequent conversions will start automatically at the end of previous conversions. The automatic trigger can be configured to trigger on many different conditions. The result of the conversion is stored in the Result register (RESULT) overwriting the result from the previous conversion. To avoid data loss if more than one channel is enabled, the conversion result must be read as soon as it is available (INTFLAG.RESRDY). Failing to do so will result in an overrun error condition, indicated by the OVERRUN bit in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear register (INTFLAG.OVERRUN). When the RESRDY interrupt flag is set, the new result has been synchronized to the RESULT register. To enable one of the available interrupts sources, the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Set register (INTENSET) must be written to '1'. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 478 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.6.3 Prescaler The ADC is clocked by GCLK_ADC. There is also a prescaler in the ADC to enable conversion at lower clock rates. Refer to CTRLB for details on prescaler settings. Figure 28-2. ADC Prescaler DIV512 DIV256 DIV128 DIV64 DIV32 DIV4 DIV16 9-BIT PRESCALER DIV8 GCLK_ADC CTRLB.PRESCALER[2:0] CLK_ADC The propagation delay of an ADC measurement depends on the selected mode and is given by: • Single-shot mode: • PropagationDelay = Free-running mode: PropagationDelay = Table 28-1. Delay Gain + DelayGain 1 + Resolution 2 fCLK+ − ADC Resolution + DelayGain 2 fCLK+ − ADC Delay Gain (in CLK_ADC Period) INTPUTCTRL.GAIN[3:0] Free-running mode Name 28.6.4 Single shot mode Differential Mode Single-Ended Mode Differential mode Single-Ended mode 1X 0x0 0 0 0 1 2X 0x1 0 1 0.5 1.5 4X 0x2 1 1 1 2 8X 0x3 1 2 1.5 2.5 16X 0x4 2 2 2 3 Reserved 0x5 ... 0xE Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved DIV2 0 1 0.5 1.5 0xF ADC Resolution The ADC supports 8-bit, 10-bit or 12-bit resolution. Resolution can be changed by writing the Resolution bit group in the Control B register (CTRLB.RESSEL). By default, the ADC resolution is set to 12 bits. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 479 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.6.5 Differential and Single-Ended Conversions The ADC has two conversion options: differential and single-ended: • If the positive input may go below the negative input, the differential mode should be used in order to get correct results. • If the positive input is always positive, the single-ended conversion should be used in order to have full 12-bit resolution in the conversion. The negative input must be connected to ground. This ground could be the internal GND, IOGND or an external ground connected to a pin. Refer to the Control B (CTRLB) register for selection details. If the positive input may go below the negative input, creating some negative results, the differential mode should be used in order to get correct results. The differential mode is enabled by setting DIFFMODE bit in the Control B register (CTRLB.DIFFMODE). Both conversion types could be run in single mode or in free-running mode. When the free-running mode is selected, an ADC input will continuously sample the input and performs a new conversion. The INTFLAG.RESRDY bit will be set at the end of each conversion. 28.6.5.1 Conversion Timing The following figure shows the ADC timing for one single conversion. A conversion starts after the software or event start are synchronized with the GCLK_ADC clock. The input channel is sampled in the first half CLK_ADC period. Figure 28-3. ADC Timing for One Conversion in Differential Mode without Gain 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 CLK_ ADC START SAMPLE INT Converting Bit MS B 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 LS B The sampling time can be increased by using the Sampling Time Length bit group in the Sampling Time Control register (SAMPCTRL.SAMPLEN). As example, the next figure is showing the timing conversion. Figure 28-4. ADC Timing for One Conversion in Differential Mode without Gain, but with Increased Sampling Time 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 CLK_ ADC START SAMPLE INT Converting Bit © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries MS B 10 9 8 7 Complete Datasheet 6 5 4 3 2 1 LS B DS60001504F-page 480 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Figure 28-5. ADC Timing for Free Running in Differential Mode without Gain 2 1 3 4 5 6 7 9 8 10 11 12 13 6 4 2 0 14 15 16 8 6 CLK_ ADC START SAMPLE INT Converting Bit 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 11 10 9 8 7 5 3 1 11 10 9 7 5 Figure 28-6. ADC Timing for One Conversion in Single-Ended Mode without Gain 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 CLK_ADC START SAMPLE AMPLIFY INT Converting Bit MS B 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 LS B Figure 28-7. ADC Timing for Free Running in Single-Ended Mode without Gain 2 1 3 4 5 6 7 9 8 10 11 12 13 14 9 7 5 3 1 15 16 CLK_ADC START SAMPLE AMPLIFY INT Converting Bit 28.6.6 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 11 10 8 6 4 2 0 11 10 Accumulation The result from multiple consecutive conversions can be accumulated. The number of samples to be accumulated is specified by the Number of Samples to be Collected field in the Average Control register (AVGCTRL.SAMPLENUM). When accumulating more than 16 samples, the result will be too large to match the 16-bit RESULT register size. To avoid overflow, the result is right shifted automatically to fit within the available register size. The number of automatic right shifts is specified in the table below. Note:  To perform the accumulation of two or more samples, the Conversion Result Resolution field in the Control B register (CTRLB.RESSEL) must be set. Table 28-2. Accumulation Number of Accumulated Samples AVGCTRL. SAMPLENUM Intermediate Result Precision Number of Automatic Right Shifts Final Result Precision Automatic Division Factor 1 0x0 12 bits 0 12 bits 0 2 0x1 13 bits 0 13 bits 0 4 0x2 14 bits 0 14 bits 0 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 481 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) ...........continued 28.6.7 Number of Accumulated Samples AVGCTRL. SAMPLENUM Intermediate Result Precision Number of Automatic Right Shifts Final Result Precision Automatic Division Factor 8 0x3 15 bits 0 15 bits 0 16 0x4 16 bits 0 16 bits 0 32 0x5 17 bits 1 16 bits 2 64 0x6 18 bits 2 16 bits 4 128 0x7 19 bits 3 16 bits 8 256 0x8 20 bits 4 16 bits 16 512 0x9 21 bits 5 16 bits 32 1024 0xA 22 bits 6 16 bits 64 Reserved 0xB - 0xF 12 bits 12 bits 0 Averaging Averaging is a feature that increases the sample accuracy, at the cost of a reduced sampling rate. This feature is suitable when operating in noisy conditions. Averaging is done by accumulating m samples, as described in 28.6.6. Accumulation, and dividing the result by m. The averaged result is available in the RESULT register. The number of samples to be accumulated is specified by writing to AVGCTRL.SAMPLENUM. The division is obtained by a combination of the automatic right shift described above, and an additional right shift that must be specified by writing to the Adjusting Result/Division Coefficient field in AVGCTRL (AVGCTRL.ADJRES). Note:  To perform the averaging of two or more samples, the Conversion Result Resolution field in the Control B register (CTRLB.RESSEL) must be set to '1'. Averaging AVGCTRL.SAMPLENUM samples will reduce the un-averaged sampling rate by a factor 1 . AVGCTRL.SAMPLENUM When the averaged result is available, the INTFLAG.RESRDY bit will be set. Table 28-3. Averaging Number of Accumulated Samples AVGCTRL. SAMPLENUM Intermediate Result Precision Number of Automatic Right Shifts Division Factor AVGCTRL.ADJRES 1 0x0 12 bits 0 1 0x0 2 0x1 13 0 2 0x1 4 0x2 14 0 4 8 0x3 15 0 16 0x4 16 32 0x5 17 64 0x6 128 Final Result Precision Automatic Division Factor 12 bits 0 1 12 bits 0 0x2 2 12 bits 0 8 0x3 3 12 bits 0 0 16 0x4 4 12 bits 0 1 16 0x4 5 12 bits 2 18 2 16 0x4 6 12 bits 4 0x7 19 3 16 0x4 7 12 bits 8 256 0x8 20 4 16 0x4 8 12 bits 16 512 0x9 21 5 16 0x4 9 12 bits 32 1024 0xA 22 6 16 0x4 10 12 bits 64 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet Total Number of Right Shifts DS60001504F-page 482 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) ...........continued 28.6.8 Number of Accumulated Samples AVGCTRL. SAMPLENUM Reserved 0xB-0xF Intermediate Result Precision Number of Automatic Right Shifts Division Factor AVGCTRL.ADJRES Total Number of Right Shifts 0x0 Final Result Precision Automatic Division Factor 12 bits 0 Oversampling and Decimation By using oversampling and decimation, the ADC resolution can be increased from 12 bits up to 16 bits, for the cost of reduced effective sampling rate. To increase the resolution by n bits, 4n samples must be accumulated. The result must then be right-shifted by n bits. This right-shift is a combination of the automatic right-shift and the value written to AVGCTRL.ADJRES. To obtain the correct resolution, the ADJRES must be configured as described in the table below. This method will result in n bit extra LSB resolution. Table 28-4. Configuration Required for Oversampling and Decimation 28.6.9 Result Resolution Number of Samples to Average AVGCTRL.SAMPLENUM[3:0] Number of Automatic Right Shifts AVGCTRL.ADJRES[2:0] 13 bits 41 = 4 0x2 0 0x1 14 bits 42 = 16 0x4 0 0x2 15 bits 43 0x6 2 0x1 16 bits 44 = 256 0x8 4 0x0 = 64 Window Monitor The window monitor feature allows the conversion result in the RESULT register to be compared to predefined threshold values. The window mode is selected by setting the Window Monitor Mode bits in the Window Monitor Control register (WINCTRL.WINMODE[2:0]). Threshold values must be written in the Window Monitor Lower Threshold register (WINLT) and Window Monitor Upper Threshold register (WINUT). If differential input is selected, the WINLT and WINUT are evaluated as signed values. Otherwise they are evaluated as unsigned values. The significant WINLT and WINUT bits are given by the precision selected in the Conversion Result Resolution bit group in the Control B register (CTRLB.RESSEL). This means that e.g. in 8-bit mode, only the eight lower bits will be considered. In addition, in differential mode, the eighth bit will be considered as the sign bit, even if the ninth bit is zero. The INTFLAG.WINMON interrupt flag will be set if the conversion result matches the window monitor condition. 28.6.10 Offset and Gain Correction Inherent gain and offset errors affect the absolute accuracy of the ADC. The offset error is defined as the deviation of the actual ADC transfer function from an ideal straight line at zero input voltage. The offset error cancellation is handled by the Offset Correction register (OFFSETCORR). The offset correction value is subtracted from the converted data before writing to the Result register (RESULT). The gain error is defined as the deviation of the last output step’s midpoint from the ideal straight line, after compensating for offset error. The gain error cancellation is handled by the Gain Correction register (GAINCORR). To correct these two errors, the Digital Correction Logic Enabled bit in the Control B register (CTRLB.CORREN) must be set to '1'. Offset and gain error compensation results are both calculated according to: Result = Conversion value+ − OFFSETCORR ⋅ GAINCORR The correction will introduce a latency of 13 CLK_ADC clock cycles. In Free-running mode this latency is introduced on the first conversion only because the duration is always less than the propagation delay. In Single Conversion mode this latency is introduced for each conversion. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 483 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Figure 28-8. ADC Timing Correction Enabled START CONV0 CONV1 CORR0 CONV2 CORR1 CONV3 CORR2 CORR3 28.6.11 Interrupts The ADC has the following interrupt sources: • Result Conversion Ready: RESRDY • Window Monitor: WINMON • Overrun: OVERRUN Each interrupt source has an interrupt flag associated with it. The interrupt flag in the Interrupt Flag Status and Clear (INTFLAG) register is set when the interrupt condition occurs. Each interrupt can be individually enabled by writing a one to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Set (INTENSET) register, and disabled by writing a one to the corresponding bit in the Interrupt Enable Clear (INTENCLR) register. An interrupt request is generated when the interrupt flag is set and the corresponding interrupt is enabled. The interrupt request remains active until the interrupt flag is cleared, the interrupt is disabled, or the ADC is reset. An interrupt flag is cleared by writing a one to the corresponding bit in the INTFLAG register. Each peripheral can have one interrupt request line per interrupt source or one common interrupt request line for all the interrupt sources. This is device dependent. Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller for details. The user must read the INTFLAG register to determine which interrupt condition is present. Related Links 10.2. Nested Vector Interrupt Controller 28.6.12 Events The ADC can generate the following output events: • Result Ready (RESRDY): Generated when the conversion is complete and the result is available. • Window Monitor (WINMON): Generated when the window monitor condition match. Setting an Event Output bit in the Event Control Register (EVCTRL.xxEO=1) enables the corresponding output event. Clearing this bit disables the corresponding output event. Refer to the Event System chapter for details on configuring the event system. The peripheral can take the following actions on an input event: • Start conversion (START): Start a conversion. • Conversion flush (FLUSH): Flush the conversion. Setting an Event Input bit in the Event Control register (EVCTRL.xxEI=1) enables the corresponding action on input event. Clearing this bit disables the corresponding action on input event. Note:  If several events are connected to the ADC, the enabled action will be taken on any of the incoming events. The events must be correctly routed in the Event System. Related Links 22. Event System (EVSYS) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 484 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.6.13 Sleep Mode Operation The run in the Standby bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.RUNSTDBY) controls the behavior of the ADC during Standby Sleep mode. When CTRLA.RUNSTDBY = 0, the ADC is disabled during sleep, but maintains its current configuration. When CTRLA.RUNSTDBY = 1, the ADC continues to operate during sleep. When CTRLA.RUNSTDBY = 0, the analog blocks are powered off for the lowest power consumption. This necessitates a start-up time delay when the system returns from sleep. When CTRLA.RUNSTDBY = 1, any enabled ADC interrupt source can wake-up the CPU, except the OVERRUN interrupt.. While the CPU is sleeping, ADC conversion can only be triggered by events. 28.6.14 Synchronization Due to asynchronicity between the main clock domain and the peripheral clock domains, some registers need to be synchronized when written or read. When executing an operation that requires synchronization, the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY) will be set immediately, and cleared when synchronization is complete. The Synchronization Ready interrupt can be used to signal when synchronization is complete. If an operation that requires synchronization is executed while STATUS.SYNCBUSY=1, the bus will be stalled. All operations will complete successfully, but the CPU will be stalled and interrupts will be pending as long as the bus is stalled. The following bits are synchronized when written: • • Software Reset bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.SWRST) Enable bit in the Control A register (CTRLA.ENABLE) The following registers are synchronized when written: • • • • • Control B (CTRLB) Software Trigger (SWTRIG) Window Monitor Control (WINCTRL) Input Control (INPUTCTRL) Window Upper/Lower Threshold (WINUT/WINLT) Required write-synchronization is denoted by the "Write-Synchronized" property in the register description. The following registers are synchronized when read: • • Software Trigger (SWTRIG) Input Control (INPUTCTRL) Required read-synchronization is denoted by the "Read-Synchronized" property in the register description. Related Links 13.3. Register Synchronization © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 485 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.7 Register Summary Offset Name Bit Pos. 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 CTRLA REFCTRL AVGCTRL SAMPCTRL 0x04 CTRLB 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 15:8 0x06 ... 0x07 0x08 0x09 ... 0x0B 0x0C 0x0D ... 0x0F 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 RUNSTDBY ENABLE SWRST REFSEL[3:0] SAMPLENUM[3:0] SAMPLEN[5:0] CORREN FREERUN LEFTADJ DIFFMODE PRESCALER[2:0] REFCOMP ADJRES[2:0] RESSEL[1:0] Reserved WINCTRL 7:0 WINMODE[2:0] 7:0 START Reserved SWTRIG FLUSH Reserved 0x10 INPUTCTRL 0x14 0x15 0x16 0x17 0x18 0x19 EVCTRL Reserved INTENCLR INTENSET INTFLAG STATUS 0x1A RESULT 0x1C WINLT 0x1E ... 0x1F Reserved 0x20 WINUT 0x22 ... 0x23 Reserved 0x24 GAINCORR 0x26 OFFSETCORR 0x28 CALIB 0x2A DBGCTRL 28.8 7 7:0 15:8 23:16 31:24 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 MUXPOS[4:0] MUXNEG[4:0] INPUTSCAN[3:0] GAIN[3:0] SYNCEI INPUTOFFSET[3:0] WINMONEO RESRDYEO SYNCRDY SYNCRDY SYNCRDY WINMON WINMON WINMON OVERRUN OVERRUN OVERRUN STARTEI RESRDY RESRDY RESRDY SYNCBUSY RESULT[7:0] RESULT[15:8] WINLT[7:0] WINLT[15:8] 7:0 15:8 WINUT[7:0] WINUT[15:8] 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 7:0 15:8 7:0 GAINCORR[7:0] GAINCORR[11:8] OFFSETCORR[7:0] OFFSETCORR[11:8] LINEARITY_CAL[7:0] BIAS_CAL[2:0] DBGRUN Register Description Registers can be 8, 16 or 32 bits wide. Atomic 8-, 16- and 32-bit accesses are supported. In addition, the 8-bit quarters and 16-bit halves of a 32-bit register and the 8-bit halves of a 16-bit register can be accessed directly. Some registers are optionally write-protected by the Peripheral Access Controller (PAC). Write-protection is denoted by the Write-Protected property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 486 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Some registers require synchronization when read and/or written. Synchronization is denoted by the WriteSynchronized or the Read-Synchronized property in each individual register description. Some registers are enable-protected, meaning they can be written only when the ADC is disabled. Enable-protection is denoted by the Enable-Protected property in each individual register description. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 487 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.1 Control A Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRLA 0x00 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 RUNSTDBY R/W 0 1 ENABLE R/W 0 0 SWRST R/W 0 Bit 2 – RUNSTDBY Run in Standby This bit indicates whether the ADC will continue running in standby sleep mode or not: Value Description 0 The ADC is halted during standby sleep mode. 1 The ADC continues normal operation during standby sleep mode. Bit 1 – ENABLE Enable Due to synchronization, there is a delay from writing CTRLA.ENABLE until the peripheral is enabled/disabled. The value written to CTRL.ENABLE will read back immediately and the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY) will be set. STATUS.SYNCBUSY will be cleared when the operation is complete. Value Description 0 The ADC is disabled. 1 The ADC is enabled. Bit 0 – SWRST Software Reset Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit resets all registers in the ADC, except DBGCTRL, to their initial state, and the ADC will be disabled. Writing a one to CTRL.SWRST will always take precedence, meaning that all other writes in the same write-operation will be discarded. Due to synchronization, there is a delay from writing CTRLA.SWRST until the reset is complete. CTRLA.SWRST and STATUS.SYNCBUSY will both be cleared when the reset is complete. Value Description 0 There is no reset operation ongoing. 1 The reset operation is ongoing. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 488 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.2 Reference Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset REFCTRL 0x01 0x00 Write-Protected 7 REFCOMP R/W 0 6 5 4 3 R/W 0 2 1 REFSEL[3:0] R/W R/W 0 0 0 R/W 0 Bit 7 – REFCOMP Reference Buffer Offset Compensation Enable The accuracy of the gain stage can be increased by enabling the reference buffer offset compensation. This will decrease the input impedance and thus increase the start-up time of the reference. Value Description 0 Reference buffer offset compensation is disabled. 1 Reference buffer offset compensation is enabled. Bits 3:0 – REFSEL[3:0] Reference Selection These bits select the reference for the ADC. Table 28-5. Reference Selection REFSEL[3:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5-0xF INT1V INTVCC0 INTVCC1 VREFA VREFB 1.0V voltage reference 1/1.48 VDDANA 1/2 VDDANA (only for VDDANA > 2.0V) External reference External reference Reserved Note:  INT1V is the buffered internal reference of 1.0V, derived from the internal 1.1V bandgap reference. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 489 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.3 Average Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit AVGCTRL 0x02 0x00 Write-Protected 7 Access Reset 6 R/W 0 5 ADJRES[2:0] R/W 0 4 3 R/W 0 R/W 0 2 1 SAMPLENUM[3:0] R/W R/W 0 0 0 R/W 0 Bits 6:4 – ADJRES[2:0] Adjusting Result / Division Coefficient These bits define the division coefficient in 2n steps. Bits 3:0 – SAMPLENUM[3:0] Number of Samples to be Collected These bits define how many samples should be added together.The result will be available in the Result register (RESULT). Note: if the result width increases, CTRLB.RESSEL must be changed. SAMPLENUM[3:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 0x8 0x9 0xA 0xB-0xF 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 128 256 512 1024 1 sample 2 samples 4 samples 8 samples 16 samples 32 samples 64 samples 128 samples 256 samples 512 samples 1024 samples Reserved © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 490 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.4 Sampling Time Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 7 SAMPCTRL 0x03 0x00 Write-Protected 6 Access Reset 5 4 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 SAMPLEN[5:0] R/W R/W 0 0 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 5:0 – SAMPLEN[5:0] Sampling Time Length These bits control the ADC sampling time in number of half CLK_ADC cycles, depending of the prescaler value, thus controlling the ADC input impedance. Sampling time is set according to the equation: CLKADC Sampling time = SAMPLEN+1 ⋅ 2 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 491 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.5 Control B Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit CTRLB 0x04 0x0000 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 15 14 13 12 11 Access Reset Bit 7 6 Access Reset 5 4 RESSEL[1:0] R/W R/W 0 0 3 CORREN R/W 0 10 R/W 0 9 PRESCALER[2:0] R/W 0 8 R/W 0 2 FREERUN R/W 0 1 LEFTADJ R/W 0 0 DIFFMODE R/W 0 Bits 10:8 – PRESCALER[2:0] Prescaler Configuration These bits define the ADC clock relative to the peripheral clock. PRESCALER[2:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6 0x7 DIV4 DIV8 DIV16 DIV32 DIV64 DIV128 DIV256 DIV512 Peripheral clock divided by 4 Peripheral clock divided by 8 Peripheral clock divided by 16 Peripheral clock divided by 32 Peripheral clock divided by 64 Peripheral clock divided by 128 Peripheral clock divided by 256 Peripheral clock divided by 512 Bits 5:4 – RESSEL[1:0] Conversion Result Resolution These bits define whether the ADC completes the conversion at 12-, 10- or 8-bit result resolution. RESSEL[1:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 12BIT 16BIT 10BIT 8BIT 12-bit result For averaging mode output 10-bit result 8-bit result Bit 3 – CORREN Digital Correction Logic Enabled Value Description 0 Disable the digital result correction. 1 Enable the digital result correction. The ADC conversion result in the RESULT register is then corrected for gain and offset based on the values in the GAINCAL and OFFSETCAL registers. Conversion time will be increased by X cycles according to the value in the Offset Correction Value bit group in the Offset Correction register. Bit 2 – FREERUN Free Running Mode Value Description 0 The ADC run is single conversion mode. 1 The ADC is in free running mode and a new conversion will be initiated when a previous conversion completes. Bit 1 – LEFTADJ Left-Adjusted Result Value Description 0 The ADC conversion result is right-adjusted in the RESULT register. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 492 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Value 1 Description The ADC conversion result is left-adjusted in the RESULT register. The high byte of the 12-bit result will be present in the upper part of the result register. Writing this bit to zero (default) will right-adjust the value in the RESULT register. Bit 0 – DIFFMODE Differential Mode Value Description 0 The ADC is running in singled-ended mode. 1 The ADC is running in differential mode. In this mode, the voltage difference between the MUXPOS and MUXNEG inputs will be converted by the ADC. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 493 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.6 Window Monitor Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit WINCTRL 0x08 0x00 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 R/W 0 1 WINMODE[2:0] R/W 0 0 R/W 0 Bits 2:0 – WINMODE[2:0] Window Monitor Mode These bits enable and define the window monitor mode. WINMODE[2:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5-0x7 DISABLE MODE1 MODE2 MODE3 MODE4 No window mode (default) Mode 1: RESULT > WINLT Mode 2: RESULT < WINUT Mode 3: WINLT < RESULT < WINUT Mode 4: !(WINLT < RESULT < WINUT) Reserved © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 494 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.7 Software Trigger Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit SWTRIG 0x0C 0x00 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 7 6 5 4 3 Access Reset 2 1 START R/W 0 0 FLUSH R/W 0 Bit 1 – START ADC Start Conversion Writing this bit to zero will have no effect. Value Description 0 The ADC will not start a conversion. 1 The ADC will start a conversion. The bit is cleared by hardware when the conversion has started. Setting this bit when it is already set has no effect. Bit 0 – FLUSH ADC Conversion Flush After the flush, the ADC will resume where it left off; i.e., if a conversion was pending, the ADC will start a new conversion. Writing this bit to zero will have no effect. Value Description 0 No flush action. 1 "Writing a '1' to this bit will flush the ADC pipeline. A flush will restart the ADC clock on the next peripheral clock edge, and all conversions in progress will be aborted and lost. This bit will be cleared after the ADC has been flushed. After the flush, the ADC will resume where it left off; i.e., if a conversion was pending, the ADC will start a new conversion. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 495 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.8 Input Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INPUTCTRL 0x10 0x00000000 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 R/W 0 R/W 0 GAIN[3:0] Access Reset Bit Access Reset Bit R/W 0 23 R/W 0 15 22 21 INPUTOFFSET[3:0] R/W R/W 0 0 14 13 Access Reset Bit 7 6 5 Access Reset 20 19 R/W 0 R/W 0 12 11 R/W 0 R/W 0 4 3 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 18 17 INPUTSCAN[3:0] R/W R/W 0 0 10 MUXNEG[4:0] R/W 0 2 MUXPOS[4:0] R/W 0 16 R/W 0 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 27:24 – GAIN[3:0] Gain Factor Selection These bits set the gain factor of the ADC gain stage. GAIN[3:0] Name Description 0x0 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5-0xE 0xF 1X 2X 4X 8X 16X DIV2 1x 2x 4x 8x 16x Reserved 1/2x Bits 23:20 – INPUTOFFSET[3:0] Positive Mux Setting Offset The pin scan is enabled when INPUTSCAN != 0. Writing these bits to a value other than zero causes the first conversion triggered to be converted using a positive input equal to MUXPOS + INPUTOFFSET. Setting this register to zero causes the first conversion to use a positive input equal to MUXPOS. After a conversion, the INPUTOFFSET register will be incremented by one, causing the next conversion to be done with the positive input equal to MUXPOS + INPUTOFFSET. The sum of MUXPOS and INPUTOFFSET gives the input that is actually converted. Bits 19:16 – INPUTSCAN[3:0] Number of Input Channels Included in Scan This register gives the number of input sources included in the pin scan. The number of input sources included is INPUTSCAN + 1. The input channels included are in the range from MUXPOS + INPUTOFFSET to MUXPOS + INPUTOFFSET + INPUTSCAN. The range of the scan mode must not exceed the number of input channels available on the device. Bits 12:8 – MUXNEG[4:0] Negative Mux Input Selection These bits define the Mux selection for the negative ADC input selections. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 496 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Value 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x08-0x1 7 0x18 0x19 0x1A-0x1 F Name PIN0 PIN1 PIN2 PIN3 PIN4 PIN5 PIN6 PIN7 - Description ADC AIN0 pin ADC AIN1 pin ADC AIN2 pin ADC AIN3 pin ADC AIN4 pin ADC AIN5 pin ADC AIN6 pin ADC AIN7 pin Reserved GND IOGND - Internal ground I/O ground Reserved Bits 4:0 – MUXPOS[4:0] Positive Mux Input Selection These bits define the Mux selection for the positive ADC input. The following table shows the possible input selections. If the internal bandgap voltage or temperature sensor input channel is selected, then the Sampling Time Length bit group in the SamplingControl register must be written. MUXPOS[4:0] Group configuration Description 0x00 0x01 0x02 0x03 0x04 0x05 0x06 0x07 0x08 0x09 0x0A 0x0B 0x0C 0x0D 0x0E 0x0F 0x10 0x11 0x12 0x13 0x14-0x17 0x18 0x19 0x1A 0x1B 0x1C 0x1D-0x1F PIN0 PIN1 PIN2 PIN3 PIN4 PIN5 PIN6 PIN7 PIN8 PIN9 PIN10 PIN11 PIN12 PIN13 PIN14 PIN15 PIN16 PIN17 PIN18 PIN19 ADC AIN0 pin ADC AIN1 pin ADC AIN2 pin ADC AIN3 pin ADC AIN4 pin ADC AIN5 pin ADC AIN6 pin ADC AIN7 pin ADC AIN8 pin ADC AIN9 pin ADC AIN10 pin ADC AIN11 pin ADC AIN12 pin ADC AIN13 pin ADC AIN14 pin ADC AIN15 pin ADC AIN16 pin ADC AIN17 pin ADC AIN18 pin ADC AIN19 pin Reserved Temperature reference Bandgap voltage 1/4 scaled core supply 1/4 scaled I/O supply DAC output Reserved © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries TEMP BANDGAP SCALEDCOREVCC SCALEDIOVCC DAC Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 497 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.9 Event Control Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit EVCTRL 0x14 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 Access Reset 5 WINMONEO R/W 0 4 RESRDYEO R/W 0 3 2 1 SYNCEI R/W 0 0 STARTEI R/W 0 Bit 5 – WINMONEO Window Monitor Event Out This bit indicates whether the Window Monitor event output is enabled or not and an output event will be generated when the window monitor detects something. Value Description 0 Window Monitor event output is disabled and an event will not be generated. 1 Window Monitor event output is enabled and an event will be generated. Bit 4 – RESRDYEO Result Ready Event Out This bit indicates whether the Result Ready event output is enabled or not and an output event will be generated when the conversion result is available. Value Description 0 Result Ready event output is disabled and an event will not be generated. 1 Result Ready event output is enabled and an event will be generated. Bit 1 – SYNCEI Synchronization Event In Value Description 0 A flush and new conversion will not be triggered on any incoming event. 1 A flush and new conversion will be triggered on any incoming event. Bit 0 – STARTEI Start Conversion Event In Value Description 0 A new conversion will not be triggered on any incoming event. 1 A new conversion will be triggered on any incoming event. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 498 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.10 Interrupt Enable Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTENCLR 0x16 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 Access Reset 5 4 3 SYNCRDY R/W 0 2 WINMON R/W 0 1 OVERRUN R/W 0 0 RESRDY R/W 0 Bit 3 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable bit and the corresponding interrupt request. Value Description 0 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the Synchronization Ready interrupt flag is set. Bit 2 – WINMON Window Monitor Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Window Monitor Interrupt Enable bit and the corresponding interrupt request. Value Description 0 The window monitor interrupt is disabled. 1 The window monitor interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the Window Monitor interrupt flag is set. Bit 1 – OVERRUN Overrun Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Overrun Interrupt Enable bit and the corresponding interrupt request. Value Description 0 The Overrun interrupt is disabled. 1 The Overrun interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the Overrun interrupt flag is set. Bit 0 – RESRDY Result Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will clear the Result Ready Interrupt Enable bit and the corresponding interrupt request. Value Description 0 The Result Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Result Ready interrupt is enabled, and an interrupt request will be generated when the Result Ready interrupt flag is set. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 499 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.11 Interrupt Enable Set Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTENSET 0x17 0x00 Write-Protected 7 6 Access Reset 5 4 3 SYNCRDY R/W 0 2 WINMON R/W 0 1 OVERRUN R/W 0 0 RESRDY R/W 0 Bit 3 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Synchronization Ready Interrupt Enable bit, which enables the Synchronization Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Synchronization Ready interrupt is enabled. Bit 2 – WINMON Window Monitor Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Window Monitor Interrupt bit and enable the Window Monitor interrupt. Value Description 0 The Window Monitor interrupt is disabled. 1 The Window Monitor interrupt is enabled. Bit 1 – OVERRUN Overrun Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Overrun Interrupt bit and enable the Overrun interrupt. Value Description 0 The Overrun interrupt is disabled. 1 The Overrun interrupt is enabled. Bit 0 – RESRDY Result Ready Interrupt Enable Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit will set the Result Ready Interrupt bit and enable the Result Ready interrupt. Value Description 0 The Result Ready interrupt is disabled. 1 The Result Ready interrupt is enabled. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 500 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.12 Interrupt Flag Status and Clear Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit INTFLAG 0x18 0x00 - 7 6 Access Reset 5 4 3 SYNCRDY R/W 0 2 WINMON R/W 0 1 OVERRUN R/W 0 0 RESRDY R/W 0 Bit 3 – SYNCRDY Synchronization Ready This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag. This flag is set on a one-to-zero transition of the Synchronization Busy bit in the Status register (STATUS.SYNCBUSY), except when caused by an enable or software reset, and will generate an interrupt request if INTENCLR/SET.SYNCRDY is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Synchronization Ready interrupt flag. Bit 2 – WINMON Window Monitor This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag or by reading the RESULT register. This flag is set on the next GCLK_ADC cycle after a match with the window monitor condition, and an interrupt request will be generated if INTENCLR/SET.WINMON is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Window Monitor interrupt flag. Bit 1 – OVERRUN Overrun This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag. This flag is set if RESULT is written before the previous value has been read by CPU, and an interrupt request will be generated if INTENCLR/SET.OVERRUN is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Overrun interrupt flag. Bit 0 – RESRDY Result Ready This flag is cleared by writing a one to the flag or by reading the RESULT register. This flag is set when the conversion result is available, and an interrupt will be generated if INTENCLR/SET.RESRDY is one. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect. Writing a one to this bit clears the Result Ready interrupt flag. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 501 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.13 Status Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset STATUS 0x19 0x00 - 7 SYNCBUSY R 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 7 – SYNCBUSY Synchronization Busy This bit is cleared when the synchronization of registers between the clock domains is complete. This bit is set when the synchronization of registers between clock domains is started. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 502 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.14 Result Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  RESULT 0x1A 0x0000 Read-Synchronized Bit 15 14 13 10 9 8 R 0 12 11 RESULT[15:8] R R 0 0 Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 RESULT[7:0] Access Reset R 0 R 0 R 0 R 0 Bits 15:0 – RESULT[15:0] Result Conversion Value These bits will hold up to a 16-bit ADC result, depending on the configuration. In single conversion mode without averaging, the ADC conversion will produce a 12-bit result, which can be left- or right-shifted, depending on the setting of CTRLB.LEFTADJ. If the result is left-adjusted (CTRLB.LEFTADJ), the high byte of the result will be in bit position [15:8], while the remaining 4 bits of the result will be placed in bit locations [7:4]. This can be used only if an 8-bit result is required; i.e., one can read only the high byte of the entire 16-bit register. If the result is not left-adjusted (CTRLB.LEFTADJ) and no oversampling is used, the result will be available in bit locations [11:0], and the result is then 12 bits long. If oversampling is used, the result will be located in bit locations [15:0], depending on the settings of the Average Control register (AVGCTRL). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 503 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.15 Window Monitor Lower Threshold Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit WINLT 0x1C 0x0000 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 12 11 WINLT[15:8] R/W R/W 0 0 4 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 WINLT[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 15:0 – WINLT[15:0] Window Lower Threshold If the window monitor is enabled, these bits define the lower threshold value. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 504 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.16 Window Monitor Upper Threshold Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit Access Reset Bit WINUT 0x20 0x0000 Write-Protected, Write-Synchronized 15 14 13 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 7 6 5 12 11 WINUT[15:8] R/W R/W 0 0 4 10 9 8 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 3 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 WINUT[7:0] Access Reset R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 15:0 – WINUT[15:0] Window Upper Threshold If the window monitor is enabled, these bits define the upper threshold value. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 505 SAM D20 Family Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 28.8.17 Gain Correction Name:  Offset:  Reset:  Property:  Bit 15 GAINCORR 0x24 0x0000 Write-Protected 14 13 Access Reset Bit Access Reset 12 11 R/W 0 7 6 5 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 4 3 GAINCORR[7:0] R/W R/W 0 0 10 9 GAINCORR[11:8] R/W R/W 0 0 8 R/W 0 2 1 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 R/W 0 Bits 11:0 – GAINCORR[11:0] Gain Correction Value If the CTRLB.CORREN bit is one, these bits define how the ADC conversion result is compensated for gain error before being written to the result register. The gain-correction is a fractional value, a 1-bit integer plusan 11-bit fraction, and therefore 1/2 VREG.bit.RUNSTDBY = 0. Table 32-9. Current Consumption - Device Variant B Mode Conditions CPU running a While(1) algorithm CPU running a While(1) algorithm CPU running a While(1) algorithm, with GCLKIN as reference CPU running a Fibonacci algorithm ACTIVE CPU running a Fibonacci algorithm CPU running a Fibonacci algorithm, with GCLKIN as reference CPU running a CoreMark algorithm CPU running a CoreMark algorithm CPU running a CoreMark algorithm, with GCLKIN as reference IDLE0 IDLE1 IDLE2 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries TA Vcc Min. Typ. Max. 25°C 3.3V - 2.27 2.30 85°C 3.3V - 2.32 2.36 25°C 1.8V - 2.27 2.30 85°C 1.8V - 2.33 2.37 25°C 3.3V - 43*freq +108 44*freq +108 85°C 3.3V - 44*freq +148 45*freq +147 25°C 3.3V - 3.04 3.07 85°C 3.3V - 3.09 3.12 25°C 1.8V - 3.04 3.08 85°C 1.8V - 3.09 3.12 25°C 3.3V - 59*freq +109 60*freq +109 85°C 3.3V - 60*freq +149 60*freq +149 25°C 3.3V - 3.90 3.95 85°C 3.3V - 4.03 4.07 25°C 1.8V - 3.51 3.55 85°C 1.8V - 3.59 3.63 25°C 3.3V - 77* freq +108 78* freq +110 85°C 3.3V - 79 * freq + 146 80* freq +147 25°C 3.3V - 1.28 1.29 85°C 3.3V - 1.32 1.34 25°C 3.3V - 0.95 0.98 85°C 3.3V - 0.99 1.01 25°C 3.3V - 0.76 0.76 85°C 3.3V - 0.78 0.79 Complete Datasheet Units mA μA (with freq in MHz) mA μA (with freq in MHz) mA μA (with freq in MHz) mA DS60001504F-page 560 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C ...........continued Mode Conditions TA Vcc Min. Typ. Max. XOSC32K running RTC running at 1 kHz(2) 25°C 3.3V - 2.47 - 85°C 3.3.V - 17.74 94 25°C 3.3V - 1.35 85°C 3.3V - 16.38 STANDBY XOSC32K and RTC stopped(2) Units μA 90 Notes:  1. These values are based on characterization. 2. Measurements were done with SYSCTRL->VREG.bit.RUNSTDBY = 0. Table 32-10. Wake-up Time Mode Conditions IDLE0 OSC8M used as main clock source, cache disabled IDLE1 OSC8M used as main clock source, cache disabled IDLE2 OSC8M used as main clock source, cache disabled STANDBY OSC8M used as main clock source, cache disabled TA Min. Typ. Max. 25°C 3.3 4.0 4.5 85°C 3.4 4.0 4.5 25°C 10.5 12.1 13.7 85°C 12.1 13.6 15.0 25°C 11.7 13.0 14.3 85°C 13.0 14.5 15.9 25°C 17.5 19.6 21.4 85°C 18.0 19.7 21.4 Units Figure 32-1. Measurement Schematic VDDIN VDDANA VDDIO Amp 0 VDDCORE © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 561 μs SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 32.7 Peripheral Power Consumption Default conditions, except where noted: • • • • • • • • • Operating conditions – VVDDIN = 3.3 V Oscillators – XOSC (crystal oscillator) stopped – XOSC32K (32 kHz crystal oscillator) running with external 32kHz crystal – OSC8M at 8MHz Clocks – OSC8M used as main clock source – CPU, AHB and APBn clocks undivided The following AHB module clocks are running: NVMCTRL, HPB2 bridge, HPB1 bridge, HPB0 bridge – All other AHB clocks stopped The following peripheral clocks running: PM, SYSCTRL – All other peripheral clocks stopped I/Os are inactive with internal pull-up CPU in IDLE0 mode Cache enabled BOD33 disabled In this default conditions, the power consumption Idefault is measured. Operating mode for each peripheral in turn: • • • • • • • • • Configure and enable the peripheral GCLK (When relevant, see conditions) Unmask the peripheral clock Enable the peripheral (when relevant) Set CPU in IDLE0 mode Measurement Iperiph Wake-up CPU via EIC (async: level detection, filtering disabled) Disable the peripheral (when relevant) Mask the peripheral clock Disable the peripheral GCLK (when relevant, see conditions) Each peripheral power consumption provided in table x-9 is the value (Iperiph - Idefault), using the same measurement method as for global power consumption measurement. Table 32-11. Typical Peripheral Power Consumption Peripheral Conditions Typ. Units RTC fGCLK_RTC = 32kHz, 32 bit counter mode 5.6 μA WDT fGCLK_WDT = 32kHz, normal mode with EW 4.2 AC Both fGCLK = 8MHz, Enable both COMP 25.8 TCx(1) fGCLK = 8MHz, Enable + COUNTER in 8 bit mode 41.5 SERCOMx.I2CM(2) fGCLK = 8MHz, Enable 50.3 SERCOMx.I2CS(2) fGCLK = 8MHz, Enable 23.6 SERCOMx.SPI(2) fGCLK = 8MHz, Enable 47.9 SERCOMx.USART(2) fGCLK = 8MHz, Enable 47.6 Notes: 1. All TCs share the same power consumption values. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 562 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 2. All SERCOMs share the same power consumption values. 32.8 I/O Pin Characteristics 32.8.1 Normal I/O Pins Table 32-12. RevD and later normal I/O Pins Characteristics Symbol Parameter RPULL Pull-up - Pull-down resistance VIL Input low-level voltage VIH Input high-level voltage Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units 20 40 60 kΩ VDD = 1.62V-2.7V - - 0.25*VDD V VDD = 2.7V-3.63V - - 0.3*VDD VDD = 1.62V-2.7V 0.7*VDD - - VDD = 2.7V-3.63V 0.55*VDD - - VOL Output low-level voltage VDD > 1.6V, IOL max - 0.1*VDD 0.2*VDD VOH Output high-level voltage VDD > 1.6V, IOH max 0.8*VDD 0.9*VDD - IOL Output low-level current VDD = 1.62V-3V, PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR=0 - - 1 VDD = 3V-3.63V, PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR=0 - - 2.5 VDD = 1.62V-3V, PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR=1 - - 3 VDD = 3V-3.63V, PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR=1 - - 10 VDD = 1.62V-3V, PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR=0 - - 0.7 VDD = 3V-3.63V, PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR=0 - - 2 VDD = 1.62V-3V, PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR=1 - - 2 VDD = 3V-3.63V, PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR=1 - - 7 PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR=0 load = 5pF, VDD = 3.3V - - 15 PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR=1 load = 20pF, VDD = 3.3V - - 15 PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR=0 load = 5pF, VDD = 3.3V - - 15 PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR=1 load = 20pF, VDD = 3.3V - - 15 Pull-up resistors disabled -1 +/-0.015 1 IOH tRISE tFALL ILEAK Output high-level current Rise time(1) Fall time(1) Input leakage current mA ns μA Note: 1. These values are based on simulation. These values are not covered by test limits in production or characterization. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 563 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C Table 32-13. SAMD20 revC/revB Normal I/O Pins Characteristics Symbol Parameter RPULL Pull-up - Pull-down resistance VIL Input low-level voltage VIH Conditions Input high-level voltage Min. Typ. Max. Units 20 40 60 kΩ VDD = 1.62V-2.7V - - 0.25*VDD V VDD = 2.7V-3.63V - - 0.3*VDD VDD = 1.62V-2.7V 0.7*VDD - - VDD = 2.7V-3.63V 0.55*VDD - - VOL Output low-level voltage VDD > 1.6V, IOL max - 0.1*VDD 0.2*VDD VOH Output high-level voltage VDD > 1.6V, IOH max 0.8*VDD 0.9*VDD - IOL Output low-level current VDD = 1.6V-3V - - 8 VDD = 3V-3.63V - - 20 VDD = 1.6V-3V - - 4.5 VDD = 3V-3.63V - - 10 load = 30pF,VDD = 3.3V, slope range [10%-90%] - 7 - - 9.5 - Pull-up resistors disabled -1 +/-0.015 1 IOH Output high-level current time(1) tRISE Rise tFALL Fall time(1) ILEAK Input leakage current(2) mA ns μA Notes:  1. These values are based on simulation. These values are not covered by test limits in production or characterization. 2. For PA22 of WLCSP27 Package -2 μA 0.2*VDDANA - 0.1V 4. The ADC channels on pins PA08, PA09, PA10, PA11 are powered from the VDDIO power supply. The ADC performance of these pins will not be the same as all the other ADC channels on pins powered from the VDDANA power supply. 5. The gain accuracy represents the gain error expressed in percent. Gain accuracy (%) = (Gain Error in V x 100) / (2*VREF/GAIN) Table 32-24. Single-Ended Mode (Device Variant A)(1,2,3) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units ENOB Effective Number of Bits With gain compensation - 9.5 9.8 Bits TUE Total Unadjusted Error 1x gain - 10.5 14.0 LSB INL Integral Non-Linearity 1x gain 1.0 1.6 3.5 LSB DNL Differential Non-Linearity 1x gain ±0.5 ±0.6 ±0.95 LSB Gain Error Ext. Ref. 1x -5.0 0.7 +5.0 mV Ext. Ref. 0.5x ±0.2 ±0.34 ±0.4 % Ext. Ref. 2x to 16X ±0.01 ±0.1 ±0.2 % GE Gain Accuracy (4) OE Offset Error Ext. Ref. 1x -5.0 1.5 +5.0 mV SFDR Spurious Free Dynamic Range 63.1 65.0 67.0 dB SINAD Signal-to-Noise and Distortion 1x Gain FCLK_ADC = 2.1 MHz 47.5 59.5 61.0 dB Signal-to-Noise Ratio FIN = 40 kHz 48.0 60.0 64.0 dB Total Harmonic Distortion AIN = 95% FSR -65.4 -63.0 -62.1 dB SNR THD © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 570 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C ...........continued Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units Noise RMS T = 25°C - 1.0 - mV Table 32-25. Single-Ended Mode (Device Variant B)(1,2,3) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units ENOB Effective Number of Bits With gain compensation - 9.5 9.8 Bits TUE Total Unadjusted Error 1x gain - 10.5 27 LSB INL Integral Non-Linearity 1x gain 1 1.6 5 LSB DNL Differential Non-Linearity 1x gain ±0.5 ±0.6 ±0.95 LSB Gain Error Ext. Ref. 1x -5 0.7 5 mV Ext. Ref. 0.5x ±0.2 ±0.34 ±0.6 % Ext. Ref. 2x to 16X ±0.01 ±0.1 ±0.3 % GE Gain Accuracy (4) OE Offset Error Ext. Ref. 1x -5 1.5 10 mV SFDR Spurious Free Dynamic Range 1x Gain 63.1 65 67 dB SINAD Signal-to-Noise and Distortion FCLK_ADC = 2.1 MHz 47.5 59.5 61 dB SNR Signal-to-Noise Ratio FIN = 40 kHz 48 60 64 dB THD Total Harmonic Distortion AIN = 95% FSR -65.4 -63 -62.1 dB Noise RMS T = 25°C - 1 - mV Notes:  1. Maximum numbers are based on the characterization and not tested in production, and for 5% to 95% of the input voltage range. 2. Respect the input common mode voltage through the following equations. Where, VCM_IN is the Input channel common mode voltage for all VIN: – VCM_IN < 0.7*VDDANA + VREF/4 – 0.75V – VCM_IN > VREF/4 – 0.3*VDDANA - 0.1V 3. The ADC channels on the PA08, PA09, PA10, PA11 pins are powered from the VDDIO power supply. The ADC performance of these pins will not be the same as all the other ADC channels on pins powered from the VDDANA power supply. 4. The gain accuracy represents the gain error expressed in percent. Gain accuracy (%) = (Gain Error in V x 100) / (VREF/GAIN). 32.10.4.1 Performance with the Averaging Digital Feature Averaging is a feature which increases the sample accuracy. ADC automatically computes an average value of multiple consecutive conversions. The numbers of samples to be averaged is specified by the Number-of-Samplesto-be-collected bit group in the Average Control register (AVGCTRL.SAMPLENUM[3:0]) and the averaged output is available in the Result register (RESULT). Table 32-26. Averaging feature Average Number Conditions SNR (dB) SINAD (dB) SFDR (dB) ENOB (bits) 1 In differential mode, 1x gain, VDDANA=3.0V, VREF=1.0V, 350 ksps T= 25°C 66.0 65.0 72.8 9.75 67.6 65.8 75.1 10.62 32 69.7 67.1 75.3 10.85 128 70.4 67.5 75.5 10.91 8 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 571 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 32.10.4.2 Performance with the hardware offset and gain correction Inherent gain and offset errors affect the absolute accuracy of the ADC. The offset error cancellation is handled by the Offset Correction register (OFFSETCORR) and the gain error cancellation, by the Gain Correction register (GAINCORR). The offset and gain correction value is subtracted from the converted data before writing the Result register (RESULT). Table 32-27. Offset and Gain correction feature Gain Factor Conditions Offset Error (mV) Gain Error (mV) Total Unadjusted Error (LSB) 0.5x In differential mode, 1x gain, VDDANA=3.0V, VREF=1.0V, 350 ksps T= 25°C 0.25 1.0 2.4 0.20 0.10 1.5 2x 0.15 -0.15 2.7 8x -0.05 0.05 3.2 16x 0.10 -0.05 6.1 1x 32.10.4.3 Inputs and Sample and Hold Acquisition Times The analog voltage source must be able to charge the sample and hold (S/H) capacitor in the ADC in order to achieve maximum accuracy. Seen externally the ADC input consists of a resistor (RSAMPLE) and a capacitor (CSAMPLE). In addition, the source resistance (RSOURCE) must be taken into account when calculating the required sample and hold time. The figure below shows the ADC input channel equivalent circuit. Figure 32-5. ADC Input VDDANA/2 RSOURCE Analog Input AINx CSAMPLE RSAMPLE VIN To achieve n bits of accuracy, the CSAMPLE capacitor must be charged at least to a voltage of VCSAMPLE ≥ VIN × 1 − 2− n + 1 The minimum sampling time tSAMPLEHOLD for a given RSOURCEcan be found using this formula: tSAMPLEHOLD ≥ RSAMPLE + RSOURCE × CSAMPLE × n + 1 × ln 2 for a 12 bits accuracy: tSAMPLEHOLD ≥ RSAMPLE + RSOURCE × CSAMPLE × 9.02 where tSAMPLEHOLD = 1 2 × fADC 32.10.5 Digital to Analog Converter (DAC) Characteristics Table 32-28. Operating Conditions Symbol Parameter VDDANA Analog supply voltage © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Conditions Complete Datasheet Min. Typ. Max. Units 1.62 - 3.63 V DS60001504F-page 572 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C ...........continued Symbol Parameter Min. Typ. Max. Units External reference voltage 1.0 - VDDANA-0.6 V INT1V(2) - 1 - V VDDANA - VDDANA - V Linear output voltage range 0.05 - VDDANA-0.05 V Minimum resistive load 5 - - kΩ Maximum capacitance load - - 100 pF - 160 230 μA AVREF DC supply current (1) IDD Conditions Voltage pump disabled Notes:  1. These values are based on characterization, and are not covered by test limits in production. 2. It is the buffered internal reference of 1.0V derived from the internal 1.1V bandgap reference. Table 32-29. Clock and Timing Symbol Parameter Conversion rate Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Normal mode - - 350 For ΔDATA = +/-1 - - 1000 VDDNA > 2.6V - - 2.85 μs VDDNA < 2.6V - - 10 μs Cload = 100pF Rload > 5kΩ Startup time Units ksps Note:  The values in this table are based on simulation, and are not covered by test limits in production or characterization. Table 32-30. Accuracy Characteristics (Device Variant A) Symbol Parameter RES Input resolution Conditions (1) VREF = Ext 1.0V INL Integral non-linearity VREF = VDDANA VREF = INT1V VREF = Ext 1.0V DNL Differential non-linearity VREF = VDDANA VREF = INT1V Min. Typ. Max. Units - - 10 Bits VDD = 1.6V 0.75 1.1 2.5 VDD = 3.6V 0.6 1.2 1.5 VDD = 1.6V 1.4 2.2 2.5 VDD = 3.6V 0.9 1.4 1.5 VDD = 1.6V 0.75 1.3 1.5 VDD = 3.6V 0.8 1.2 1.5 VDD = 1.6V ±0.9 ±1.2 ±1.5 VDD = 3.6V ±0.9 ±1.1 ±1.2 VDD = 1.6V ±1.1 ±1.5 ±1.7 VDD = 3.6V ±1.0 ±1.1 ±1.2 VDD = 1.6V ±1.1 ±1.4 ±1.5 VDD = 3.6V ±1.0 ±1.5 ±1.6 LSB LSB GE Gain error Ext. VREF ±1.5 ±5 ±10 mV OE Offset error Ext. VREF ±2 ±3 ±6 mV © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 573 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C Note:  1. All values are measured using a conversion rate of 35 ksps . Table 32-31. Accuracy Characteristics (Device Variant B) Symbol Parameter RES Input resolution Conditions (1) Integral non-linearity VREF = VDDANA VREF = INT1V VREF = Ext 1.0V DNL Differential non-linearity Typ. Max. Units - - - 10 Bits VDD = 1.6V 0.75 1.1 2.5 LSB VDD = 3.6V 0.6 1.2 1.5 VDD = 1.6V 1.4 2.2 2.5 VDD = 3.6V 0.9 1.4 1.5 VDD = 1.6V 0.75 1.3 3.1 VDD = 3.6V 0.8 1.2 2.7 VDD = 1.6V ±0.9 ±1.2 ±1.5 VDD = 3.6V ±0.9 ±1.1 ±1.2 VDD = 1.6V ±1.1 ±1.5 ±1.7 VDD = 3.6V ±1.0 ±1.1 ±1.2 VDD = 1.6V ±1.1 ±1.4 ±3.0 VDD = 3.6V ±1.0 ±1.5 ±2.9 VREF = Ext 1.0V INL Min. VREF = VDDANA VREF = INT1V LSB GE Gain error Ext. VREF ±1.5 ±5 ±10 mV OE Offset error Ext. VREF ±2 ±3 ±6 mV Min. Typ. Max. Units Positive input voltage range 0 - VDDANA Negative input voltage range 0 - VDDANA Hysteresis = 0, Fast mode -15 0.0 +15 mV Hysteresis = 0, Low power mode -25 0.0 +25 mV Hysteresis = 1, Fast mode 20 50 80 mV Hysteresis = 1, Low power mode 15 40 75 mV Changes for VACM = VDDANA/2 100 mV overdrive, Fast mode - 60 116 ns Changes for VACM = VDDANA/2 100 mV overdrive, Low power mode - 225 370 ns Enable to ready delay Fast mode - 1 2 μs Enable to ready delay Low power mode - 12 19 μs Note:  1. All values are measured using a conversion rate of 35 ksps. 32.10.6 Analog Comparator Characteristics Table 32-32. Electrical and Timing (Device Variant A) Symbol Parameter Offset Hysteresis Propagation delay tSTARTUP Startup time © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Conditions Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 574 V SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C ...........continued Symbol Parameter Min. Typ. Max. Units INL (3) -1.4 0.75 +1.4 LSB (3) -0.9 0.25 +0.9 LSB Offset Error (1,2) -0.200 0.260 +0.920 LSB Gain Error (1,2) -0.89 0.215 0.89 LSB DNL VSCALE Conditions Notes:  1. According to the standard equation V(X)=VLSB*(X+1); VLSB=VDDANA/64. 2. Data computed with the Best Fit method. 3. Data computed using histogram. Table 32-33. Electrical and Timing (Device Variant B) Symbol Parameter Min. Typ. Max. Positive input voltage range 0 - VDDANA Negative input voltage range 0 - VDDANA Hysteresis = 0, Fast mode -15 0 15 mV Hysteresis = 0, Low power mode -25 0 25 mV Hysteresis = 1, Fast mode 20 50 80 mV Hysteresis = 1, Low power mode 15 40 75 mV Changes for VACM=VDDANA/2 100 mV overdrive, Fast mode - 90 180 ns Changes for VACM=VDDANA/2 100 mV overdrive, Low power mode - 282 520 ns Enable to ready delay Fast mode - 1 2.6 µs Enable to ready delay Low power mode - 12 22 µs -1.4 0.75 1.4 LSB -0.9 0.25 0.9 LSB -0.2 0.26 0.92 LSB -0.89 0.215 0.89 LSB Offset Hysteresis Propagation delay tSTARTUP Startup time Conditions INL (3) VSCALE DNL (3) Offset Error (1,2) Gain Error (1,2) Units Notes:  1. According to the standard equation V(X)=VLSB*(X+1); VLSB=VDDANA/64. 2. Data computed with the Best Fit method. 3. Data computed using histogram. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 575 V SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 32.10.7 Bandgap and Internal 1.0V Reference Characteristics Table 32-34. Bandgap and Internal 1.0V Reference Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units BANDGAP Bandgap reference Over voltage and [-40°C, +85°C] 1.08 1.1 1.12 V Over voltage at 25°C 1.09 1.1 1.11 Over voltage and [-40°C, +85°C] 0.98 1 1.02 Over voltage at 25°C 0.99 1 1.01 Internal 1.0V reference voltage (1) INT1V Note:  1. These values are based on simulation and are not covered by production test limits. 32.10.8 Temperature Sensor Characteristics 32.10.8.1 Temperature Sensor Characteristics Table 32-35. Temperature Sensor Characteristics(1) Symbol Parameter Temperature sensor output voltage Conditions Min. Typ. T= 25°C, VDDANA = 3.3V - 0.667 - V 2.3 2.4 2.5 mV/°C Temperature sensor slope Max. Units Variation over VDDANA voltage VDDANA = 1.62V to 3.6V -1.7 1 3.7 mV/V Temperature Sensor accuracy Using the method described in the following section -10 - 10 °C Note: 1. These values are based on characterization. These values are not covered by test limits in production. 2. See also rev C errata concerning the temperature sensor. 32.10.8.2 Software-based Refinement of the Actual Temperature The temperature sensor behavior is linear but it depends on several parameters such as the internal voltage reference which itself depends on the temperature. To take this into account, each device contains a Temperature Log row with data measured and written during the production tests. These calibration values should be read by software to infer the most accurate temperature readings possible. This Software Temperature Log row can be read at address 0x00806030. The Software Temperature Log row cannot be written. This section specifies the Temperature Log row content and explains how to refine the temperature sensor output using the values in the Temperature Log row. 32.10.8.2.1 Temperature Log Row All values in this row were measured in the following conditions: • VDDIN = VDDIO = VDDANA = 3.3V • ADC Clock speed = 1MHz • ADC mode: Free running mode, ADC averaging mode with 4 averaged samples • ADC voltage reference = 1.0V internal reference (INT1V) • ADC input = Temperature sensor Table 32-36. Temperature Log Row Content Bit position Name Description 7:0 ROOM_TEMP_VAL_INT Integer part of room temperature in °C 11:8 ROOM_TEMP_VAL_DEC Decimal part of room temperature © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 576 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C ...........continued Bit position Name Description 19:12 HOT_TEMP_VAL_INT Integer part of hot temperature in °C 23:20 HOT_TEMP_VAL_DEC Decimal part of hot temperature 31:24 ROOM_INT1V_VAL 2’s complement of the internal 1V reference drift at room temperature (versus a 1.0 centered value) 39:32 HOT_INT1V_VAL 2’s complement of the internal 1V reference drift at hot temperature (versus a 1.0 centered value) 51:40 ROOM_ADC_VAL 12-bit ADC conversion at room temperature 63:52 HOT_ADC_VAL 12-bit ADC conversion at hot temperature The temperature sensor values are logged during test production flow for Room and Hot insertions: • • ROOM_TEMP_VAL_INT and ROOM_TEMP_VAL_DEC contains the measured temperature at room insertion (e.g. for ROOM_TEMP_VAL_INT=25 and ROOM_TEMP_VAL_DEC=2, the measured temperature at room insertion is 25.2°C). HOT_TEMP_VAL_INT and HOT_TEMP_VAL_DEC contains the measured temperature at hot insertion (e.g. for HOT_TEMP_VAL_INT=83 and HOT_TEMP_VAL_DEC=3, the measured temperature at room insertion is 83.3°C). The temperature log row also contains the corresponding 12-bit ADC conversions of both Room and Hot temperatures: • • ROOM_ADC_VAL contains the 12-bit ADC value corresponding to (ROOM_TEMP_VAL_INT, ROOM_TEMP_VAL_DEC) HOT_ADC_VAL contains the 12-bit ADC value corresponding to (HOT_TEMP_VAL_INT, HOT_TEMP_VAL_DEC) The temperature log row also contains the corresponding 1V internal reference of both Room and Hot temperatures: • • • ROOM_INT1V_VAL is the 2’s complement of the internal 1V reference value corresponding to (ROOM_TEMP_VAL_INT, ROOM_TEMP_VAL_DEC) HOT_INT1V_VAL is the 2’s complement of the internal 1V reference value corresponding to (HOT_TEMP_VAL_INT, HOT_TEMP_VAL_DEC) ROOM_INT1V_VAL and HOT_INT1V_VAL values are centered around 1V with a 0.001V step. In other words, the range of values [0,127] corresponds to [1V, 0.873V] and the range of values [-1, -127] corresponds to [1.001V, 1.127V]. INT1V == 1 - (VAL/1000) is valid for both ranges. 32.10.8.2.2 Using Linear Interpolation For concise equations, we’ll use the following notations: • • • • • • (ROOM_TEMP_VAL_INT, ROOM_TEMP_VAL_DEC) is denoted tempR (HOT_TEMP_VAL_INT, HOT_TEMP_VAL_DEC) is denoted tempH ROOM_ADC_VAL is denoted ADCR, its conversion to Volt is denoted VADCR HOT_ADC_VAL is denoted ADCH, its conversion to Volt is denoted VADCH ROOM_INT1V_VAL is denoted INT1VR HOT_INT1V_VAL is denoted INT1VH Using the (tempR, ADCR) and (tempH, ADCH) points, using a linear interpolation we have the following equation: VADC − VADCR VADCH − VADCR temp − tempR = tempH − tempR Given a temperature sensor ADC conversion value ADCm, we can infer a coarse value of the temperature tempC as: [Equation 1] © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 577 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C tempC = tempR + ADCm ⋅ 1 212 − 1 ADCH ⋅ − ADCR ⋅ INT1VH 212 − 1 INT1VR 212 − 1 − ADCR ⋅ ⋅ tempH − tempR INT1VR 212 − 1 Note 1: in the previous expression, we’ve added the conversion of the ADC register value to be expressed in V Note 2: this is a coarse value because we assume INT1V=1V for this ADC conversion. Using the (tempR, INT1VR) and (tempH, INT1VH) points, using a linear interpolation we have the following equation: INT1V − INT1VR INT1VH − INT1VR temp − tempR = tempH − tempR Then using the coarse temperature value, we can infer a closer to reality INT1V value during the ADC conversion as: INT1Vm = INT1VR + INT1VH − INT1VR ⋅ tempC − tempR tempH − tempR Back to [Equation 1], we replace INT1V=1V by INT1V = INT1Vm, we can then deduce a finer temperature value as: [Equation 1bis] tempf = tempR + 32.11 ADCm ⋅ INT1Vm 212 − 1 ADCH ⋅ − ADCR ⋅ INT1VH 212 − 1 INT1VR 212 − 1 − ADCR ⋅ ⋅ tempH − tempR INT1VR 212 − 1 NVM Characteristics Table 32-37. Maximum Operating Frequency VDD range NVM Wait States Maximum Operating Frequency Units 0 14 MHz 1 28 2 42 3 48 0 24 1 48 1.62V to 2.7V 2.7V to 3.63V Note:  On this Flash technology, a maximum number of 8 consecutive write is allowed per row. Once this number is reached, a row erase is mandatory. Table 32-38. Flash Endurance and Data Retention Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units RetNVM25k Retention after up to 25k cycles Average ambient 55°C 10 50 - Years RetNVM2.5k Retention after up to 2.5k cycles Average ambient 55°C 20 100 - Years RetNVM100 Retention after up to 100 cycles Average ambient 55°C 25 >100 - Years CycNVM Cycling Endurance(1) -40°C < Ta < 85°C 25k 150k - Cycles © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 578 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C Note:  1. An endurance cycle is a write and an erase operation. Table 32-39. EEPROM Emulation(1) Endurance and Data Retention Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units RetEEPROM100k Retention after up to 100k cycles Average ambient 55°C 10 50 - Years RetEEPROM10k Retention after up to 10k cycles Average ambient 55°C 20 100 - Years -40°C < Ta < 85°C 100k 600k - Cycles CycEEPROM Cycling Endurance(2) Notes:  1. The EEPROM Emulation is a software emulation described in the “Application Note AT03265”. 2. An endurance cycle is a write and an erase operation. Table 32-40. NVM Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units tFPP Page programming time - - - 2.5 ms tFRE Row erase time - - - 6 ms tFCE DSU chip erase time (CHIP_ERASE) - - - 240 ms 32.12 Oscillators Characteristics 32.12.1 Crystal Oscillator (XOSC) Characteristics 32.12.1.1 Digital Clock Characteristics The following table describes the characteristics for the oscillator when a digital clock is applied on XIN. Table 32-41. Digital Clock Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fCPXIN XIN clock frequency Digital mode - - 32 MHz 32.12.1.2 Crystal Oscillator Characteristics The following table describes the characteristics for the oscillator when a crystal is connected between XIN and XOUT as shown in the figure Oscillator Connection. The user must choose a crystal oscillator where the crystal load capacitance CL is within the range given in the table. The exact value of CL can be found in the crystal data sheet. The capacitance of the external capacitors (CLEXT) can then be computed as follows: Load Capacitance Equation CLOAD = ([CXIN + CLEXT] * [CXOUT + CLEXT]) / ([CXIN + CLEXT + CLEXT + CXOUT]) + CSTRAY Where: CLOAD = Crystal Mfg. CLOAD specification CXIN = XOSC XIN pin data sheet specification CXOUT = XOSC XOUT pin data sheet specification CLEXT = Required external crystal load capacitor CSTRAY (Osc PCB capacitance) = 1.5 pf per 12.5 mm (0.5 inches) (TRACE W = 0.175 mm, H = 36 μm, T = 113 μm) For CXIN and CXOUT within 4 pf of each other, assume CXIN ~= CXOUT ~= CXTAL_EFF = ((CXIN+CXOUT) / 2) (Averaging CXIN and CXOUT will effect final calculated CLOAD value by less than 0.25 pf.) The load capacitance equation can then be simplified as follows: © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 579 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C CLEXT = 2*CLOAD - CXTAL_EFF - 2*CSTRAY Table 32-42. Crystal Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter fOUT Crystal oscillator frequency ESR Crystal Equivalent Series Resistance Safety Factor = 3 The AGC doesn’t have any noticeable impact on these measurements. Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units 0.4 - 32 MHz f = 0.455 MHz, CL = 100 pF , XOSC.GAIN = 0 - - 5.6K Ω f = 2 MHz, CL = 20 pF , XOSC.GAIN = 0 - - 416 f = 4 MHz, CL = 20 pF , XOSC.GAIN = 1 - - 243 f = 8 MHz, CL = 20 pF , XOSC.GAIN = 2 - - 138 f = 16 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 3 - - 66 f = 32 MHz, CL = 18 pF , XOSC.GAIN = 4 - - 56 CXIN Parasitic capacitor load - 5.9 - pF CXOUT Parasitic capacitor load - 3.2 - pF f = 2 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 0, AGC off 27 65 85 μA f = 2 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 0, AGC on 14 52 73 f = 4MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 1, AGC off 61 117 150 f = 4MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 1, AGC on 23 74 100 f = 8 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 2, AGC off 131 226 296 f = 8 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 2, AGC on 56 128 172 f = 16 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 3, AGC off 305 502 687 f = 16 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 3, AGC on 116 307 552 Current Consumption f = 32 MHz, CL = 18 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 4, AGC off 1031 1622 2200 tSTARTUP Startup time © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries f = 32 MHz, CL = 18 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 4, AGC on 278 615 1200 f = 2 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 0, ESR = 600Ω - 14K 48K f = 4 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 1, ESR = 100Ω - 6800 19.5K f = 8 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 2, ESR = 35Ω - 5550 13K f = 16 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 3, ESR = 25Ω - 6750 14.5K f = 32 MHz, CL = 18 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 4, ESR = 40Ω - 5.3K 9.6K Complete Datasheet cycles DS60001504F-page 580 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C Figure 32-6. Oscillator Connection Xin C LEXT Crystal LM C SHUNT RM C STRAY CM Xout C LEXT 32.12.2 External 32 kHz Crystal Oscillator (XOSC32K) Characteristics 32.12.2.1 Digital Clock Characteristics The following table describes the characteristics for the oscillator when a digital clock is applied on the XIN32 pin. Table 32-43. Digital Clock Characteristics (1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fCPXIN32 XIN32 clock frequency Digital mode - 32.768 - kHz DCxin XIN32 clock duty cycle Digital mode - 50 - % Note:  1. These values are based on simulation. These values are not covered by test or characterization. 32.12.2.2 Crystal Oscillator Characteristics Figure 32-6 and the equation in 32.12.1.2. Crystal Oscillator Characteristics also applied to the 32  kHz oscillator connection. The user must choose a crystal oscillator where the crystal load capacitance CL is within the range given in the table. The value of CL can be found in the crystal data sheet. For the computation of the external capacitors (CLEXT) value, refer to the logic detailed in XOSC Crystal Oscillator Characteristics. Table 32-44. 32 kHz Crystal Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter fOUT Crystal oscillator frequency tSTARTUP Startup time CL Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units - 32768 - Hz - 28K 30K cycles Crystal load capacitance - - 12.5 pF CSHUNT Crystal shunt capacitance - 0.1 - CXIN32 Parasitic capacitor load - 3.1 - CXOUT32 Parasitic capacitor load - 3.3 - © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries ESRXTAL = 39.9  kΩ, CL = 12.5  pF Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 581 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C ...........continued Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units IXOSC32K Current consumption AGC off - 1.22 2.19 - - - - - 141 AGC ESR Crystal equivalent series resistance f = 32.768 kHz Safety Factor = 3 on(1) CL= 12.5 pF μA kΩ Note:  1. Refer to the Revision D/Revision C/Revision B errata related to the XOSC32K. 32.12.3 Digital Frequency Locked Loop (DFLL48M) Characteristics Table below provides the characteristics of the DFLL48M. Table 32-45. DFLL48M Characteristics - Closed Loop Mode(1)(2) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fOUT Average Output frequency fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz 47 48 49 fREF Reference frequency Jitter Period jitter fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz - - 0.42 ns IDFLL Power consumption on VDDIN fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz. For SAMD20 revision C devices - 397 - fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz. For SAMD20 revision D devices and later. - 292 - fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz DFLLVAL.COARSE = DFLL48M COARSE CAL DFLLVAL.FINE = 512 DFLLCTRL.BPLCKC = 1 DFLLCTRL.QLDIS = 0 DFLLCTRL.CCDIS = 1 DFLLMUL.FSTEP = 10 100 200 500 Quick lock disabled, Chill cycle disabled, CSTEP = 3, FSTEP = 1, fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz - 600 - tLOCK Lock time MHz 0.732 32.768 35.1 kHz μA μs Notes:  1. Refer to the revision C/revision B errata related to the DFLL48M. 2. All parts are tested in production to be able to use the DFLL as main CPU clock whether in DFLL Closed Loop mode with an external OSC reference or in DFLL Closed Loop mode using the internal OSC8M (Only applicable for revision C). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 582 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 32.12.4 32.768kHz Internal oscillator (OSC32K) Characteristics Table 32-46. 32kHz RC Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. fOUT Calibrated against a 32.768kHz reference at 25°C, over [-40, +85]°C, over [1.62, 3.63]V 28.508 32.768 34.734 kHz Calibrated against a 32.768kHz reference at 25°C, at VDD = 3.3V 32.276 32.768 33.260 Calibrated against a 32.768kHz reference at 25°C, over [1.62, 3.63]V 31.457 32.768 34.079 IOSC32K Output frequency Current consumption Typ. Max. Units - 0.67 1.31 μA tSTARTUP Startup time - 1 2 cycle Duty - 50 - % Min. Typ. Max. Units Duty Cycle 32.12.5 Ultra Low Power Internal 32kHz RC Oscillator (OSCULP32K) Characteristics Table 32-47. Ultra Low Power Internal 32kHz RC Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions fOUT Output frequency Calibrated against a 32.768kHz reference at 25°C, over [-40, +85]C, over [1.62, 3.63]V 25.559 32.768 38.011 kHz Calibrated against a 32.768kHz reference at 25°C, at VDD = 3.3V 31.293 32.768 34.570 Calibrated against a 32.768kHz reference at 25°C, over [1.62, 3.63]V 31.293 32.768 34.570 IOSCULP32K(1)(2) - - 125 nA tSTARTUP Startup time - 10 - cycles Duty Duty Cycle - 50 - % Notes: 1. These values are based on simulation. These values are not covered by test limits in production or characterization. 2. This oscillator is always on. 32.12.6 8MHz RC Oscillator (OSC8M) Characteristics Table 32-48. Internal 8MHz RC Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions fOUT Calibrated against a 8MHz reference at 25°C, over [-40, +85]C, over [1.62, 7.8 3.63]V Output frequency Min. Typ. Max. Units 8 8.16 MHz Calibrated against a 8MHz reference at 25°C, at VDD=3.3V 7.94 8 8.06 Calibrated against a 8MHz reference at 25°C, over [1.62, 3.63]V 7.92 8 8.08 34.5 71 96 μA tSTARTUP Startup time - 2.1 3 μs Duty - 50 - % IOSC8M Current consumption IDLE2 on OSC32K versus IDLE2 on calibrated OSC8M enabled at 8MHz (FRANGE=1, PRESC=0) Duty cycle © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 583 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 32.13 PTC Typical Characteristics 32.13.1 Figure 32-7. Power Consumption [μA] 1 sensor, noise countermeasures disabled, f=48MHz, Vcc=3.3V 140 120 100 80 Scan rate 10ms 60 Scan rate 50ms 40 Scan rate 100ms Scan rate 200ms 20 0 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 Sample averaging Figure 32-8. Power Consumption [μA] 1 sensor, noise countermeasures Enabled, f=48MHz, Vcc=3.3V 200 180 160 140 120 Scan rate 10ms 100 80 Scan rate 50ms 60 Scan rate 100ms 40 Scan rate 200ms 20 0 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 Sample averaging © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 584 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C Figure 32-9. Power Consumption [μA] 10 sensors, noise countermeasures disabled, f=48MHz, Vcc=3.3V 1200 1000 800 Scan rate 10ms 600 Scan rate 50ms Scan rate 100ms 400 Scan rate 200ms 200 Linear (Scan rate 50ms) 0 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 Sample averaging Figure 32-10. Power Consumption [μA] 10 sensors, noise countermeasures Enabled, f=48MHz, Vcc=3.3V 900 800 700 600 500 Scan rate 10ms 400 Scan rate 50ms 300 Scan rate 100ms 200 Scan rate 200ms 100 0 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 Sample averaging © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 585 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C Figure 32-11. Power Consumption [μA] 100 sensors, noise countermeasures disabled, f=48MHz, Vcc=3.3V 5000 4500 4000 3500 3000 Scan rate 10ms 2500 2000 Scan rate 50ms 1500 Scan rate 100ms 1000 Scan rate 200ms 500 0 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 Sample averaging Figure 32-12. Power Consumption [μA] 100 sensors, noise countermeasures Enabled, f=48MHz, Vcc=3.3V 1800 1600 1400 1200 1000 Scan rate 10ms 800 Scan rate 50ms 600 Scan rate 100ms 400 Scan rate 200ms 200 0 1 2 4 8 16 32 64 Sample averaging © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 586 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C Figure 32-13. CPU Utilization 80 % 70 % 60 % 50 % Channel count 1 40 % Channel count 10 30 % Channel count 100 20 % 10 % 0% 10 32.14 50 100 200 Timing Characteristics 32.14.1 External Reset Table 32-49. External reset characteristics Symbol Parameter Condition tEXT Minimum reset pulse width Min. Typ. Max. Units 10 - - ns 32.14.2 SERCOM in SPI Mode Timing Figure 32-14. SPI timing requirements in Host mode SS tSCKR tMOS tSCKF SCK (CPOL = 0) tSCKW SCK (CPOL = 1) tSCKW tMIS MISO (Data Input) tMIH tSCK MSB LSB tMOH tMOH MOSI (Data Output) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries MSB LSB Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 587 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C Figure 32-15. SPI timing requirements in Client mode SS tSSCKR tSSS tSSCKF tSSH SCK (CPOL = 0) tSSCKW SCK (CPOL = 1) tSSCKW tSIS MOSI (Data Input) tSIH MSB tSOSS MISO (Data Output) tSSCK LSB tSOS tSOSH MSB LSB Table 32-50. SPI timing characteristics and requirements(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions tSCK SCK period Host tSCKW SCK high/low width Host - 0.5*tSCK - tSCKR SCK rise time(2) Host - - - Host - - - time(2) Min. Typ. Max. Units 84 ns tSCKF SCK fall tMIS MISO setup to SCK Host - 29 - tMIH MISO hold after SCK Host - 8 - tMOS MOSI setup SCK Host - tSCK/2 - 16 - tMOH MOSI hold after SCK Host - 16 - tSSCK Client SCK Period Client 1*tCLK_APB - - tSSCKW SCK high/low width Client 0.5*tSSCK - - tSSCKR SCK rise time(2) Client - - - Client - - - time(2) tSSCKF SCK fall tSIS MOSI setup to SCK Client tSSCK/2 - 19 - - tSIH MOSI hold after SCK Client tSSCK/2 - 5 - - tSSS SS setup to SCK Client PRELOADEN=1 2*tCLK_APB + tSOS - - PRELOADEN=0 tSOS+7 - - tSSH SS hold after SCK Client tSIH - 4 - - tSOS MISO setup SCK Client - tSSCK/2 - 20 - tSOH MISO hold after SCK Client - 20 - tSOSS MISO setup after SS low Client - 16 - tSOSH MISO hold after SS high Client - 11 - © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 588 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C Notes:  1. These values are based on simulation. These values are not covered by test limits in production. 2. See 32.8. I/O Pin Characteristics. 32.14.3 SERCOM in I2C Mode Timing The following table describes the requirements for devices connected to the I2C Interface Bus. Timing symbols refer to the figure below. Figure 32-16. I2C Interface Bus Timing tOF tHIGH tR tLOW tLOW SCL tSU;STA tHD;STA tHD;DAT tSU;DAT tSU;STO SDA tBUF Table 32-51. I2C Interface Timing(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions SCL(3) Min. Typ. Max. Units - - 300 ns tR Rise time for both SDA and tOF Output fall time from VIHmin to VILmax (3) 10pF < Cb(2) < 400pF 7.0 10.0 50.0 tHD;STA Hold time (repeated) START condition fSCL > 100kHz, Host tLOW-9 - - tLOW Low period of SCL Clock fSCL > 100kHz 113 - - tBUF Bus free time between a STOP and a START condition fSCL > 100kHz tLOW - - tSU;STA Setup time for a repeated START condition fSCL > 100kHz, Host tLOW+7 - - tHD;DAT Data hold time fSCL > 100kHz, Host 9 - 12 tSU;DAT Data setup time fSCL > 100kHz, Host 104 - - tSU;STO Setup time for STOP condition fSCL > 100kHz, Host tLOW+9 - - tSU;DAT;rx Data setup time (receive mode) fSCL > 100kHz, Client 51 - 56 tHD;DAT;tx Data hold time (send mode) fSCL > 100kHz, Client 71 90 138 Notes:  1. These values are based on simulation. These values are not covered by test limits in production. 2. Cb = Capacitive load on each bus line. Otherwise noted, value of Cb set to 20pF. 3. These values are based on characterization. These values are not covered by test limits in production. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 589 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 85°C 32.14.4 SWD Timing Figure 32-17. SWD Interface Signals Read Cycle From debugger to SWDIO pin Stop Park Tri State Thigh Tos Data Data Parity Start Tlow From debugger to SWDCLK pin SWDIO pin to debugger Tri State Acknowledge Tri State Write Cycle From debugger to SWDIO pin Stop Park Tri State Tis Start Tih From debugger to SWDCLK pin SWDIO pin to debugger Tri State Acknowledge Data Data Parity Tri State Table 32-52. SWD Timings(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Max. Thigh SWDCLK High period VVDDIO from 3.0 V to 3.6 V, maximum external capacitor = 40 pF 10 Tlow SWDCLK Low period 10 500000 Tos SWDIO output skew to falling edge SWDCLK -5 5 Tis Input Setup time required between SWDIO 4 - Tih Input Hold time required between SWDIO and rising edge SWDCLK 1 - Units 500000 ns Note: 1. These values are based on simulation. These values are not covered by test limits in production or characterization. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 590 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C 33. Electrical Characteristics at 105°C 33.1 Disclaimer All typical values are measured at T = 25°C unless otherwise specified. All minimum and maximum values are valid across operating temperature and voltage unless otherwise specified. These electrical characteristics are relevant for SAMD20 revision D and later. This chapter contains only Electrical Characteristics specific for the SAM D20 at 105°C. For all other values or missing characteristics, refer to the SAM D20 Electrical Characteristics at 85°C chapter. 33.2 Absolute Maximum Ratings Stresses beyond those listed in the following table may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at these or other conditions beyond those indicated in the operational sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. Table 33-1. Absolute Maximum Ratings Symbol Parameter Min. Max. Units VDD Power supply voltage 0 3.8 V IVDD Current into a VDD pin - 48(1) mA mA IGND Current out of a GND pin - 68(1) VPIN Pin voltage with respect to GND and VDD GND-0.6V VDD+0.6V V Storage temperature -60 150 °C Tstorage Note:  1. The maximum source current is 24 mA and maximum sink current is 34 mA per cluster. A cluster is a group of GPIOs as shown in GPIO Clusters table. Each VDD/GND pair is connected to 2 clusters, hence current consumption through the pair will be a sum of the clusters source/sink currents. 33.3 General Operating Ratings The device must operate within the ratings listed in the following table in order for all other electrical characteristics and typical characteristics of the device to be valid. Table 33-2. General operating conditions Symbol Parameter Min. Typ. Max. Units VDD Power supply voltage 1.62(1) 3.3 3.63 V VDDANA Analog supply voltage 1.62(1) 3.3 3.63 V TA Temperature range -40 25 105 °C TJ Junction temperature - - 125 °C Notes:  1. With BOD33 disabled. If the BOD33 is enabled, check BOD33 LEVEL ValueTable 33-10. 2. In debugger cold-plugging mode, NVM erase operations are not protected by the BOD33 and BOD12. NVM erase operation at supply voltages below specified minimum can cause corruption of NVM areas that are mandatory for correct device behavior. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 591 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C Related Links 32.10.3.1. BOD33 33.4 Maximum Clock Frequencies Table 33-3. Maximum GCLK Generator Output Frequencies Symbol Description Conditions Max. Units fGCLKGEN0 / fGCLK_MAIN fGCLKGEN1 GCLK Generator Output Frequency Undivided 48 Divided 32 MHz fGCLKGEN2 fGCLKGEN3 fGCLKGEN4 fGCLKGEN5 fGCLKGEN6 fGCLKGEN7 Table 33-4. Maximum Peripheral Clock Frequencies Symbol Description Max. Units fCPU CPU clock frequency 32 MHz fAHB AHB clock frequency 32 MHz fAPBA APBA clock frequency 32 MHz fAPBB APBB clock frequency 32 MHz fAPBC APBC clock frequency 32 MHz fGCLK_DFLL48M_REF DFLL48M Reference clock frequency 35.1 kHz fGCLK_WDT WDT input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_RTC RTC input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EIC EIC input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_0 EVSYS channel 0 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_1 EVSYS channel 1 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_2 EVSYS channel 2 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_3 EVSYS channel 3 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_4 EVSYS channel 4 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_5 EVSYS channel 5 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_6 EVSYS channel 6 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_7 EVSYS channel 7 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_SERCOMx_SLOW Common SERCOM slow input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_SERCOM0_CORE SERCOM0 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_SERCOM1_CORE SERCOM1 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_SERCOM2_CORE SERCOM2 input clock frequency 48 MHz © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 592 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C ...........continued Symbol Description Max. Units fGCLK_SERCOM3_CORE SERCOM3 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_SERCOM4_CORE SERCOM4 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_SERCOM5_CORE SERCOM5 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_TC0, GCLK_TC1 TC0,TC1 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_TC2, GCLK_TC3 TC2,TC3 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_TC4, GCLK_TC5 TC4,TC5 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_TC6, GCLK_TC7 TC6,TC7 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_ADC ADC input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_AC_DIG AC digital input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_AC_ANA AC analog input clock frequency 64 kHz fGCLK_DAC DAC input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_PTC PTC input clock frequency 48 MHz 33.5 Power Consumption The values provided in the Current Consumption table are measured values of power consumption under the following conditions, except where noted: • • • • • • • • • • Operating conditions – VVDDIN = 3.3 V Wake up time from Sleep mode is measured from the edge of the wake up signal to the execution of the first instruction fetched in Flash. Oscillators – XOSC (crystal oscillator) with an external 32 MHz clock on XIN – XOSC32K (32 kHz crystal oscillator) stopped – DFLL48M stopped Clocks – XOSC used as main clock source, except otherwise specified – CPU, AHB clocks undivided – APBA clock divided by 4 – APBB and APBC bridges off The following AHB module clocks are running: NVMCTRL, APBA bridge – All other AHB clocks stopped The following peripheral clocks running: PM, SYSCTRL, RTC – All other peripheral clocks stopped I/Os are inactive with internal pull-up CPU is running on Flash with 1 wait states Low-power cache enabled BOD33 disabled © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 593 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C Table 33-5. Current Consumption - Variant A Mode Conditions Min. Typ. Max. CPU running a While(1) algorithm - 2.55 2.75 CPU running a While(1) algorithm VDDIN =1.8V, CPU is running on Flash with 3 Wait states - 2.56 2.82 CPU running a While(1) algorithm, CPU is running on Flash with 3 Wait states with GCLKIN as reference - 42*freq +318 42*freq +432 CPU running a Fibonacci algorithm - 4.21 4.59 CPU running a Fibonacci algorithm VDDIN = 1.8V, CPU is running on Flash with 3 Wait states - 4.23 4.57 - 80*freq +320 82*freq +432 CPU running a CoreMark algorithm - 6.02 6.54 CPU running a CoreMark algorithm VDDIN = 1.8V, CPU is running on Flash with 3 Wait states - 5.21 5.57 CPU running a CoreMark algorithm, CPU is running on Flash with 3 Wait states with GCLKIN as reference - 96*freq +322 98*freq +432 IDLE0 - 1.55 1.62 IDLE1 - 1.13 1.18 IDLE2 - 0.96 1.01 25°C - 71.3 - 105°C - 214 627 25°C - 69.8 - 105°C - 212 624 ACTIVE TA CPU running a Fibonacci algorithm, CPU is running on Flash with 3 Wait states with GCLKIN as reference XOSC32K running RTC running at 1 kHz (1) STANDBY XOSC32K and RTC stopped (1) 105°C Units mA μA (with freq. in MHz) mA μA (with freq. in MHz) mA μA (with freq in MHz) mA μA Note:  1. Measurements were done with SYSCTRL->VREG.bit.RUNSTDBY = 1. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 594 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C Table 33-6. Current Consumption - Variant B Mode Conditions TA Min. Typ. Max. CPU running a While(1) algorithm 105°C - 2.37 2.41 CPU running a While(1) algorithm VDDIN =1.8V, CPU is running on Flash with 3 Wait states 105°C - 2.37 2.41 CPU running a While(1) algorithm, CPU is running on Flash with 3 Wait states with GCLKIN as reference 105°C - 44*freq +187 45*freq +189 CPU running a Fibonacci algorithm 105°C - 3.13 3.16 CPU running a Fibonacci algorithm VDDIN = 1.8V, CPU is running on Flash with 3 Wait states 105°C - 3.13 3.17 CPU running a Fibonacci algorithm, CPU is running on Flash with 3 Wait states with GCLKIN as reference 105°C - 60*freq +188 60*freq +191 CPU running a CoreMark algorithm 105°C - 4.09 4.13 CPU running a CoreMark algorithm VDDIN = 1.8V, CPU is running on Flash with 3 Wait states 105°C - 3.65 3.68 CPU running a CoreMark algorithm, CPU is running on Flash with 3 Wait states with GCLKIN as reference 105°C - 80*freq +185 80*freq +186 IDLE0 105°C - 1.36 1.38 IDLE1 105°C - 1.03 1.04 IDLE2 105°C - 0.81 1.82 25°C - - - 105°C - - 244 25°C - 59.81 - 105°C - 120.57 240 25°C - 2.47 - 105°C - 41.79 163 ACTIVE XOSC32K running RTC running at 1 kHz (1) XOSC32K and RTC stopped (1) STANDBY XOSC32K running RTC running at 1 kHz(2) XOSC32K and RTC stopped (2) 25°C 1.35 105°C 40.40 Units mA μA (with freq. in MHz) mA μA (with freq. in MHz) mA μA (with freq in MHz) mA μA 160 Notes:  1. Measurements were done with SYSCTRL->VREG.bit.RUNSTDBY = 1. 2. Measurements were done with SYSCTRL->VREG.bit.RUNSTDBY = 0. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 595 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C Table 33-7. Wake-up Time Mode Conditions TA IDLE0 IDLE1 OSC8M used as main clock source, low power cache disabled IDLE2 105°C STANDBY Min. Typ. Max. 3.8 4 4.1 12.8 14.3 15.7 13.7 15.2 16.6 18.7 20.1 21.6 Units Figure 33-1. Measurement Schematic VDDIN VDDANA VDDIO Amp 0 VDDCORE 33.6 Injection Current Stresses beyond those listed in the table below may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at these or other conditions beyond those indicated in the operational sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. Table 33-8. Injection Current(1) Symbol Description min. max. Unit Iinj1 (2) I/O pin injection current -1 +1 mA Iinj2 (3) I/O pin injection current -15 +15 mA Iinjtotal Sum of I/O pins injection current -45 +45 mA © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 596 μs SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C Notes:  1. Injecting current may have an effect on the accuracy of analog blocks 2. Conditions for Vpin: Vpin < GND-0.6V or 3.6V2.0V - VDDANA/2 - V 2.0V < VDDANA < 3.63V -1.0 - +1.0 % Differential mode -VREF/GAIN - +VREF/GAIN V Single-ended mode 0.0 - +VREF/GAIN V - 3.5 - pF - - 3.5 kΩ - 1.25 2.78 mA (2) (2) Conversion range (1) CSAMPLE Sampling capacitance (2) RSAMPLE Input channel source resistance (2) IDD DC supply current (1) fCLK_ADC = 2.1MHz (3) Notes:  1. These values are based on characterization. These values are not covered by test limits in production. 2. These values are based on simulation. These values are not covered by test limits in production or characterization. 3. In this condition and for a sample rate of 350 ksps, a conversion takes 6 clock cycles of the ADC clock (conditions: 1X gain, 12-bit resolution, differential mode, free-running). 4. All single-shot measurements are performed with VDDANA > 2.7V (cf. ADC errata). 5. It is the buffered internal reference of 1.0V derived from the internal 1.1V bandgap reference. Table 33-12. Differential Mode (Device Variant A)(1,2,3,4) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units ENOB Effective Number Of Bits With gain compensation - 10.5 10.7 bits TUE Total Unadjusted Error 1x Gain 1.5 4.3 17.0 LSB INL Integral Non Linearity 1x Gain 1.0 1.3 6.3 LSB DNL Differential Non Linearity 1x Gain ±0.3 ±0.5 ±0.95 LSB Ext. Ref 1x -15.0 2.5 +20.0 mV VREF = VDDANA/1.48 -20.0 -1.5 +10.0 mV VREF = INT1V -15.0 -5.0 +10.0 mV Ext. Ref. 0.5x ±0.1 ±0.2 ±0.45 % Ext. Ref. 2x to 16x ±0.1 ±0.2 ±2.0 % Ext. Ref. 1x -10.0 -1.5 +10.0 mV VREF = VDDANA/1.48 -10.0 0.5 +10.0 mV VREF = INT1V -10.0 3.0 +10.0 mV Gain Error GE Gain Accuracy (5) OE Offset Error SFDR Spurious Free Dynamic Range 1x Gain 64.2 70.0 78.9 dB SINAD Signal-to-Noise and Distortion FCLK_ADC = 2.1 MHz 61.4 65.0 66.0 dB SNR Signal-to-Noise Ratio FIN = 40 kHz 64.3 65.5 66.0 dB Total Harmonic Distortion AIN = 95% FSR -74.8 -64.0 -65.0 dB THD © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 599 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C ...........continued Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units Noise RMS T=25°C 0.6 1.0 1.6 mV Table 33-13. Differential Mode (Device Variant B)(1,2,3,4) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units ENOB Effective Number Of Bits With gain compensation - 10.5 10.9 bits TUE Total Unadjusted Error 1x Gain 1.5 4.3 17 LSB INL Integral Non Linearity 1x Gain 1 1.3 6.3 LSB DNL Differential Non Linearity 1x Gain ±0.3 ±0.5 ±0.95 LSB Ext. Ref 1x -15 2.5 20 mV VREF = VDDANA/1.48 -20 -1.5 10 mV VREF = INT1V -40 -5 40 mV Ext. Ref. 0.5x ±0.1 ±0.2 ±0.45 % Ext. Ref. 2x to 16x ±0.1 ±0.2 ±2.0 % Ext. Ref. 1x -20 -1.5 20 mV VREF = VDDANA/1.48 -20 0.5 20 mV VREF = INT1V -40 3 40 mV Gain Error GE Gain Accuracy (5) OE Offset Error SFDR Spurious Free Dynamic Range 1x Gain 64.2 70 78.9 dB SINAD Signal-to-Noise and Distortion FCLK_ADC = 2.1 MHz 61.4 65 66 dB SNR Signal-to-Noise Ratio FIN = 40 kHz 64.3 65.5 66 dB THD Total Harmonic Distortion AIN = 95% FSR -74.8 -64 -65 dB Noise RMS T = 25°C 0.6 1 1.6 mV Notes:  1. Maximum numbers are based on characterization and not tested in production, and valid for 5% to 95% of the input voltage range. 2. Dynamic parameter numbers are based on characterization and not tested in production. 3. Respect the input common mode voltage through the following equations (where VCM_IN is the Input channel common mode voltage): a. If |VIN| > VREF/4 • VCM_IN < 0.95*VDDANA + VREF/4 – 0.75V • VCM_IN > VREF/4 -0.05*VDDANA -0.1V b. If |VIN| < VREF/4 • VCM_IN < 1.2*VDDANA - 0.75V • VCM_IN > 0.2*VDDANA - 0.1V 4. The ADC channels on pins PA08, PA09, PA10, PA11 are powered from the VDDIO power supply. The ADC performance of these pins will not be the same as all the other ADC channels on pins powered from the VDDANA power supply. 5. The gain accuracy represents the gain error expressed in percent. Gain accuracy (%) = (Gain Error in V x 100) / (2*VREF/GAIN) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 600 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C Table 33-14. Single-Ended Mode (Device Variant A)(1,2,3) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units ENOB Effective Number of Bits With gain compensation - 9.5 9.8 Bits TUE Total Unadjusted Error 1x gain - 10.5 40.0 LSB INL Integral Non-Linearity 1x gain 1.0 1.6 7.5 LSB DNL Differential Non-Linearity 1x gain ±0.5 ±0.6 ±0.95 LSB Gain Error Ext. Ref. 1x -5.0 0.7 +5.0 mV Ext. Ref. 0.5x ±0.1 ±0.34 ±0.4 % Ext. Ref. 2x to 16X ±0.01 ±0.1 ±0.15 % GE Gain Accuracy (4) OE Offset Error Ext. Ref. 1x -5.0 1.5 +10.0 mV SFDR Spurious Free Dynamic Range 1x Gain 63.1 65.0 66.5 dB SINAD Signal-to-Noise and Distortion FCLK_ADC = 2.1 MHz 50.7 59.5 61.0 dB SNR Signal-to-Noise Ratio FIN = 40 kHz 49.9 60.0 64.0 dB Total Harmonic Distortion AIN = 95% FSR -65.4 -63.0 -62.1 dB Noise RMS T = 25°C - 1.0 - mV THD Table 33-15. Single-Ended Mode (Device Variant B)(1,2,3) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units ENOB Effective Number of Bits With gain compensation - 9.5 9.9 Bits TUE Total Unadjusted Error 1x gain - 10.5 45 LSB INL Integral Non-Linearity 1x gain 1 1.6 7.5 LSB DNL Differential Non-Linearity 1x gain ±0.5 ±0.6 ±0.95 LSB Gain Error Ext. Ref. 1x -15 0.7 15 mV Ext. Ref. 0.5x ±0.2 ±0.34 ±0.6 % Ext. Ref. 2x to 16X ±0.01 ±0.1 ±0.3 % GE Gain Accuracy(4) OE Offset Error Ext. Ref. 1x -15 1.5 25 mV SFDR Spurious Free Dynamic Range 1x Gain 63.1 65 66.5 dB SINAD Signal-to-Noise and Distortion FCLK_ADC = 2.1 MHz 50.7 59.5 61 dB SNR Signal-to-Noise Ratio FIN = 40 kHz 49.9 60 64 dB Total Harmonic Distortion AIN = 95% FSR -65.4 -63 -62.1 dB Noise RMS T = 25°C - 1 - mV THD © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 601 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C Notes:  1. Maximum numbers are based on the characterization and not tested in production, and for 5% to 95% of the input voltage range. 2. Respect the input common mode voltage through the following equations (where VCM_IN is the Input channel common mode voltage) for all VIN: – VCM_IN < 0.7*VDDANA + VREF/4 – 0.75V – VCM_IN > VREF/4 – 0.3*VDDANA - 0.1V 3. The ADC channels on pins PA08, PA09, PA10, PA11 are powered from the VDDIO power supply. The ADC performance of these pins will not be the same as all the other ADC channels on pins powered from the VDDANA power supply. 4. The gain accuracy represents the gain error expressed in percent. Gain accuracy (%) = (Gain Error in V x 100) / (VREF/GAIN). 33.7.3.1 Inputs and Sample and Hold Acquisition Times The analog voltage source must be able to charge the sample and hold (S/H) capacitor in the ADC in order to achieve maximum accuracy. Seen externally the ADC input consists of a resistor (RSAMPLE) and a capacitor (CSAMPLE). In addition, the source resistance (RSOURCE) must be taken into account when calculating the required sample and hold time. The figure below shows the ADC input channel equivalent circuit. Figure 33-3. ADC Input VDDANA/2 RSOURCE Analog Input AINx CSAMPLE RSAMPLE VIN To achieve n bits of accuracy, the CSAMPLE capacitor must be charged at least to a voltage of VCSAMPLE ≥ VIN × 1 − 2− n + 1 The minimum sampling time tSAMPLEHOLD for a given RSOURCEcan be found using this formula: tSAMPLEHOLD ≥ RSAMPLE + RSOURCE × CSAMPLE × n + 1 × ln 2 for a 12 bits accuracy: tSAMPLEHOLD ≥ RSAMPLE + RSOURCE × CSAMPLE × 9.02 where tSAMPLEHOLD = 33.7.4 1 2 × fADC Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) Characteristics Table 33-16. Operating Conditions Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units VDDANA Analog supply voltage - 1.62 - 3.63 V © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 602 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C ...........continued Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units External reference voltage - 1.0 - VDDANA-0.6 V INT1V - - 1 - V VDDANA - - VDDANA - V Linear output voltage range - 0.05 - VDDANA-0.05 V Minimum resistive load - 5 - - kΩ Maximum capacitance load - - - 100 pF DC supply current (1) Voltage pump disabled - 160 378 μA AVREF IDD Note:  1. These values are based on characterization and are not covered by test limits in production. Table 33-17. Clock and Timing Symbol Parameter Conditions Typ. Max. Units Cload=100pF Normal mode - - 350 Rload > 5 kΩ For ΔDATA= ±1 - - 1000 VDDNA > 2.6V - - 2.85 μs VDDNA < 2.6V - - 10 μs Conversion rate tSTARTUP Min. Startup time ksps Note:  These values are based on simulation and are not covered by test limits in production or characterization. Table 33-18. Accuracy Characteristics (Device Variant A) Symbol Parameter Conditions (1) Min. Typ. Max. Units RES Input resolution - - - 10 Bits VDD = 1.6V 0.75 1.1 2.0 VDD = 3.6V 0.6 1.2 2.5 VDD = 1.6V 1.4 2.2 3.5 VDD = 3.6V 0.9 1.4 1.5 VDD = 1.6V 0.75 1.3 2.5 VDD = 3.6V 0.8 1.2 1.5 VDD = 1.6V ±0.9 ±1.2 ±2.0 VDD = 3.6V ±0.9 ±1.1 ±1.5 VDD = 1.6V ±1.1 ±1.7 ±3.0 VDD = 3.6V ±1.0 ±1.1 ±1.6 VDD = 1.6V ±1.1 ±1.4 ±2.5 VDD = 3.6V ±1.0 ±1.5 ±1.8 VREF = Ext 1.0V INL Integral non-linearity VREF = VDDANA VREF = INT1V VREF = Ext 1.0V DNL Differential non-linearity VREF = VDDANA VREF = INT1V LSB LSB GE Gain error Ext. VREF ±1.0 ±5 ±10 mV OE Offset error Ext. VREF ±2 ±3 ±8 mV © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 603 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C Note:  1. All values are measured using a conversion rate of 35 ksps. Table 33-19. Accuracy Characteristics (Device Variant B) Symbol Parameter RES Input resolution Conditions (1) VREF = Ext 1.0V INL Integral non-linearity VREF = VDDANA VREF = INT1V VREF = Ext 1.0V DNL Differential non-linearity VREF = VDDANA VREF = INT1V Min. Typ. Max. Units - - 10 Bits VDD = 1.6V 0.75 1.1 2 LSB VDD = 3.6V 0.6 1.2 2.5 VDD = 1.6V 1.4 2.2 3.5 VDD = 3.6V 0.9 1.4 1.5 VDD = 1.6V 0.75 1.3 3.1 VDD = 3.6V 0.8 1.2 2.7 VDD = 1.6V ±0.9 ±1.2 ±2.0 VDD = 3.6V ±0.9 ±1.1 ±1.5 VDD = 1.6V ±1.1 +-1.7 ±3.0 VDD = 3.6V ±1.0 ±1.1 ±1.6 VDD = 1.6V ±1.1 ±1.5 ±3.0 VDD = 3.6V ±1.0 ±1.5 ±2,9 LSB GE Gain error Ext. VREF ±1.0 ±5 ±12 mV OE Offset error Ext. VREF ±2 ±3 ±8 mV Min. Typ. Max. Units Positive input voltage range 0 - VDDANA Negative input voltage range 0 - VDDANA Hysteresis = 0, Fast mode -15 0.0 +15 mV Hysteresis = 0, Low power mode -25 0.0 +25 mV Hysteresis = 1, Fast mode 20 50 80 mV Hysteresis = 1, Low power mode 15 40 75 mV Changes for VACM=VDDANA/2 100mV overdrive, Fast mode - 60 116 ns Changes for VACM=VDDANA/2 100mV overdrive, Low power mode - 225 370 ns Enable to ready delay Fast mode - 1 2 μs Enable to ready delay Low power mode - 12 19 μs Note:  1. All values measured using a conversion rate of 35 ksps. 33.7.5 Analog Comparator Characteristics Table 33-20. Electrical and Timing (Device Variant A) Symbol Parameter Offset Hysteresis Propagation delay tSTARTUP Startup time © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Conditions Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 604 V SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C ...........continued Symbol Parameter Min. Typ. Max. Units INL (3) -1.4 0.75 +1.4 LSB DNL (3) -0.9 0.25 +0.9 LSB Offset Error (1,2) -0.200 0.260 +0.920 LSB Gain Error (1,2) -0.89 0.215 0.89 LSB Min. Typ. Max. Units Positive input voltage range 0 - VDDANA Negative input voltage range 0 - VDDANA Hysteresis = 0, Fast mode -15 0.0 +15 mV Hysteresis = 0, Low power mode -25 0.0 +25 mV Hysteresis = 1, Fast mode 20 50 80 mV Hysteresis = 1, Low power mode 15 40 75 mV Changes for VACM=VDDANA/2 100mV overdrive, Fast mode - 90 180 ns Changes for VACM=VDDANA/2 100mV overdrive, Low power mode - 282 520 ns Enable to ready delay Fast mode - 1 2.6 μs Enable to ready delay Low power mode - 12 22 μs INL(3) -1.4 0.75 +1.4 LSB DNL (3) -0.9 0.25 +0.9 LSB -0.200 0.260 +0.920 LSB -0.89 0.215 0.89 LSB VSCALE Conditions Notes:  1. According to the standard equation V(X) = VLSB * (X + 1); VLSB = VDDANA / 64. 2. Data computed with the Best Fit method. 3. Data computed using histogram. Table 33-21. Electrical and Timing (Device Variant B) Symbol Parameter Conditions Offset Hysteresis Propagation delay tSTARTUP Startup time VSCALE Offset Error (1,2) Gain Error (1,2) V Notes:  1. According to the standard equation V(X) = VLSB * (X + 1); VLSB = VDDANA / 64. 2. Data computed with the Best Fit method. 3. Data computed using histogram. 33.7.6 Temperature Sensor Characteristics Table 33-22. Temperature Sensor Characteristics(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units Temperature sensor output voltage T = 25°C, VDDANA = 3.3V - 0.667 - V 2.3 2.4 2.5 mV/°C Temperature sensor slope © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 605 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C ...........continued Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units Variation over VDDANA voltage VDDANA = 1.62V to 3.6V -4 1 6 mV/V Temperature sensor accuracy Using the method described in section 32.9.8.2 -10 - 10 °C Note: 1. These values are based on characterization. These values are not covered by test limits in production. Related Links 32.10.8.2. Software-based Refinement of the Actual Temperature 33.8 NVM Characteristics Table 33-23. Maximum Operating Frequency VDD range NVM Wait States Maximum Operating Frequency Units 1.62V to 2.7V 0 14 MHz 1 28 2 32 0 20 1 32 2.7V to 3.63V Note:  On this flash technology, a max number of 4 consecutive write is allowed per row. Once this number is reached, a row erase is mandatory. Table 33-24. Flash Endurance and Data Retention Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units RetNVM25k Retention after up to 25k cycles Average ambient 55°C 10 50 - Years RetNVM2.5k Retention after up to 2.5k cycles Average ambient 55°C 20 100 - Years RetNVM100 Retention after up to 100 cycles Average ambient 55°C 25 >100 - Years -40°C < Ta < 105°C 25k 150k - Cycles CycNVM Cycling Endurance(1) Note:  1. An endurance cycle is a write and an erase operation. Table 33-25. EEPROM Emulation(1) Endurance and Data Retention Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units RetEEPROM100k Retention after up to 100k cycles Average ambient 55°C 10 50 - Years RetEEPROM10k Retention after up to 10k cycles Average ambient 55°C 20 100 - Years CycEEPROM Cycling Endurance(2) -40°C < Ta < 105°C 100k 600k - Cycles Notes:  1. The EEPROM Emulation is a software emulation described in the App note AT03265. 2. An endurance cycle is a write and an erase operation. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 606 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C Table 33-26. NVM Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units tFPP Page programming time - - - 2.5 ms tFRE Row erase time - - - 6 ms tFCE DSU chip erase time (CHIP_ERASE) - - - 240 ms 33.9 Oscillators Characteristics 33.9.1 Crystal Oscillator (XOSC) Characteristics 33.9.1.1 Digital Clock Characteristics The following table provides the characteristics for the oscillator when a digital clock is applied on XIN. Table 33-27. Digital Clock Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fCPXIN XIN clock frequency - - - 32 MHz 33.9.1.2 Crystal Oscillator Characteristics The following table provides the characteristics for the oscillator when a crystal is connected between XIN and XOUT as shown in the figure Oscillator Connection. The user must choose a crystal oscillator where the crystal load capacitance CL is within the range given in the table below. The exact value of CL can be found in the crystal data sheet. The capacitance of the external capacitors (CLEXT) can then be computed as follows: Load Capacitance Equation: CLOAD = ([CXIN + CLEXT] * [CXOUT + CLEXT]) / ([CXIN + CLEXT + CLEXT + CXOUT]) + CSTRAY Where: CLOAD = Crystal Mfg. CLOAD specification CXIN = XOSC XIN pin data sheet specification CXOUT = XOSC XOUT pin data sheet specification CLEXT = Required external crystal load capacitor CSTRAY (Osc PCB capacitance) = 1.5 pF per 12.5 mm (0.5 inches) (TRACE W = 0.175 mm, H = 36 μm, T = 113 μm) For CXIN and CXOUT within 4 pF of each other, assume CXIN ~= CXOUT ~= CXTAL_EFF = ((CXIN+CXOUT) / 2) (Averaging CXIN and CXOUT will effect final calculated CLOAD value by less than 0.25 pF.) The load capacitance equation can then be simplified as follows: CLEXT = 2*CLOAD - CXTAL_EFF - 2*CSTRAY Table 33-28. Crystal Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fOUT - 0.4 MHz Crystal oscillator frequency © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet - 32 DS60001504F-page 607 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C ...........continued Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units ESR f = 0.455 MHz, CL = 100 pF XOSC.GAIN = 0 - - 5.6K Ω f = 2 MHz, CL = 20 pF XOSC.GAIN = 0 - - 416 f = 4 MHz, CL = 20 pF XOSC.GAIN = 1 - - 243 f = 8 MHz, CL = 20 pF XOSC.GAIN = 2 - - 138 f = 16  MHz, CL = 20 pF XOSC.GAIN = 3 - - 66 f = 32 MHz, CL = 18 pF XOSC.GAIN = 4 - - 56 Crystal Equivalent Series Resistance Safety Factor = 3 The AGC doesn’t have any noticeable impact on these measurements. CXIN Parasitic capacitor load - 5.9 - pF CXOUT Parasitic capacitor load - 3.2 - pF f = 2 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 0, AGC off 27 65 87 μA f = 2 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 0, AGC on 14 52 76 f = 4 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 1, AGC off 61 117 155 f = 4 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 1, AGC on 23 74 104 f = 8 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 2, AGC off 131 226 308 f = 8 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 2, AGC on 56 128 181 f = 16 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 3, AGC off 305 502 714 f = 16 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 3, AGC on 116 307 590 Current Consumption f = 32 MHz, CL = 18 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 4, AGC off 1031 1622 2260 tSTARTUP Startup time © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries f = 32 MHz, CL = 18 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 4, AGC on 278 615 1280 f = 2 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 0, ESR = 600Ω - 14K 48K f = 4 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 1, ESR = 100Ω - 6800 19.5K f = 8   MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 2, ESR = 35Ω - 5550 13K f = 16   MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 3, ESR = 25Ω - 6750 14.5K f = 32 MHz, CL = 18 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 4, ESR = 40Ω - 5.3K 9.6K Complete Datasheet cycles DS60001504F-page 608 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C Figure 33-4. Oscillator Connection Xin C LEXT Crystal LM C SHUNT RM C STRAY CM Xout C LEXT 33.9.2 External 32 kHz Crystal Oscillator (XOSC32K) Characteristics 33.9.2.1 Digital Clock Characteristics The following table describes the characteristics for the oscillator when a digital clock is applied on the XIN32 pin. Table 33-29. Digital Clock Characteristics (1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fCPXIN32 XIN32 clock frequency - - 32.768 - kHz DCxin XIN32 clock duty cycle - - 50 - % Note:  1. These values are based on simulation and not covered by the test or characterization. 33.9.2.2 Crystal Oscillator Characteristics Figure 32-6 and the equation in 32.12.1.2. Crystal Oscillator Characteristics also applies to the 32 kHz oscillator connection. The user must choose a crystal oscillator where the crystal load capacitance CL is within the range given in the table. The exact value of CL can be found in the crystal data sheet. For the computation of the external capacitors (CLEXT) value, refer to the logic detailed in XOSC Crystal Oscillator Characteristics. Table 33-30. 32 kHz Crystal Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fOUT Crystal oscillator frequency - - 32768 - Hz tSTARTUP Startup time ESRXTAL = 39.9 kΩ, CL = 12.5 pF - 28K 30K cycles CL Crystal load capacitance - - - 12.5 pF CSHUNT Crystal shunt capacitance - - 0.1 - CXIN32 Parasitic capacitor load - - 3.1 - CXOUT32 Parasitic capacitor load - 3.3 - © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 609 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C ...........continued Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units IXOSC32K Current consumption AGC off - 1.22 2.25 μA - - - - - 141 AGC ESR Crystal equivalent series resistance F = 32.768 kHz Safety Factor = 3 on(1) CL=12.5 pF kΩ Note: 1. Refer to the revision D/revision C/revision B errata related to the XOSC32K. 33.9.3 Digital-Frequency Locked Loop (DFLL48M) Characteristics Table 33-31. DFLL48M Characteristics - Closed Loop Mode(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fOUT Average Output frequency fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz 47 48 49 MHz fREF Reference frequency - 0.732 32.768 35.1 kHz Jitter Period jitter fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz - - 0.84 ns IDFLL Power consumption on VDDIN fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz - 292 - μA tLOCK Lock time fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz DFLLVAL.COARSE = DFLL48M COARSE CAL DFLLVAL.FINE = 512 DFLLCTRL.BPLCKC = 1 DFLLCTRL.QLDIS = 0 DFLLCTRL.CCDIS = 1 DFLLMUL.FSTEP = 10 100 200 500 μs Quick lock disabled, Chill cycle disabled, CSTEP = 3,FSTEP = 1, fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz - 600 - Note: 1. Refer to the revision C/revision B errata pertaining to the DFLL48M. 2. All parts are tested in production to be able to use the DFLL as main CPU clock whether in DFLL closed-loop mode with an external OSC reference or in DFLL closed-loop mode using the internal OSC8M (only applicable for revision C). 33.9.4 32.768 kHz Internal oscillator (OSC32K) Characteristics Table 33-32. 32 kHz RC Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fOUT Output frequency Calibrated against a 32.768 kHz reference at 25°C, over [-40, +105]C, over [1.62, 3.63]V 28.508 32.768 35.062 kHz Calibrated against a 32.768 kHz reference at 25°C, at VDD = 3.3V 32.276 32.768 33.260 Calibrated against a 32.768 kHz reference at 25°C, over [1.62, 3.63]V 31.457 32.768 34.079 IOSC32K Current consumption - - 0.67 1.62 μA tSTARTUP Startup time - - 1 2 cycle © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 610 SAM D20 Family Electrical Characteristics at 105°C ...........continued Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units Duty Duty Cycle - - 50 - % 33.9.5 Ultra-Low Power Internal 32 kHz RC Oscillator (OSCULP32K) Characteristics Table 33-33. Ultra-Low Power Internal 32 kHz RC Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fOUT Output frequency Calibrated against a 32.768 kHz reference at 25°C, over [-40, +105]C, over [1.62, 3.63]V 25.559 32.768 39.016 kHz Calibrated against a 32.768 kHz reference at 25°C, at VDD = 3.3V 31.293 32.768 34.570 Calibrated against a 32.768 kHz reference at 25°C, over [1.62, 3.63]V 31.293 32.768 34.570 IOSCULP32K(1)(2) - - - - 180 nA tSTARTUP Startup time - - 10 - cycles Duty Duty Cycle - - 50 - % Notes: 1. These values are based on simulation and not covered by test limits in production or characterization. 2. This oscillator is always on. 33.9.6 8 MHz RC Oscillator (OSC8M) Characteristics Table 33-34. Internal 8 MHz RC Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fOUT Calibrated against a 8 MHz reference at 25°C, over [-40, +105]C, over [1.62, 3.63]V 7.65 8 8.17 MHz Calibrated against a 8 MHz reference at 25°C, at VDD = 3.3V 7.94 8 8.06 Calibrated against a 8 MHz reference at 25°C, over [1.62, 3.63]V 7.92 8 8.08 - 71 168 μA IOSC8M Output frequency Current consumption IDLEIDLE2 on OSC32K versus IDLE2 on calibrated OSC8M enabled at 8 MHz (FRANGE = 1, PRESC = 0) tSTARTUP Startup time - - 2.1 3 μs Duty - - 50 - % Duty cycle © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 611 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ 34. AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ 34.1 Disclaimer The AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics described in this chapter only apply to the Device Variant B. The electrical characteristics for Device Variant B described in chapters "32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C" and "33. Electrical Characteristics at 105°C" do not meet the requirements of AEC-Q100. All typical values are measured at T = 25°C unless otherwise specified. All minimum and maximum values are valid across operating temperature and voltage unless otherwise specified. The BOD33 must always be activated (SYSCTRL.BOD33[ENABLE] = 1) when the device is used under the AEC-Q100 grading. This secures power-up, startup sequence, and power-down events. It will participate in protecting the data and code loaded into the embedded Flash memory. Usage of the BOD33 in sampled mode (SYSCTRL.BOD33[MODE] = 1) is discouraged. BOD33 must be kept in continuous mode (SYSCTRL.BOD33[MODE] = 0) whenever power consumption is not a concern. The temperature readings achieved through the Temperature Sensor (TSENS) feature do not meet the requirements of AEC-Q100. No specifications can be defined for the Temperature Sensor (TSENS). This feature must not be used with AEC-Q100 parts. The Low-Power mode of the regulator cannot be used while entering the STANDBY power-saving configuration with AEC-Q100 parts. Such configuration will not meet the Safety definitions and requirements of the AEC-Q100. SYSCTRL VREG.RUNSTDBY = 1 must always be set before entering the STANDY power-saving configuration. 34.2 Absolute Maximum Ratings Stresses beyond those listed in the following table, may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at these or other conditions beyond those indicated in the operational sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. Table 34-1. Absolute maximum ratings Symbol Parameter Min. Max. Units VDD Power supply voltage 0 3.8 V IVDD Current into a VDD pin - 28(1) mA IGND Current out of a GND pin - 39(1) mA VPIN Pin voltage with respect to GND and VDD GND-0.3V VDD+0.3V V Storage temp -60 150 °C Tstorage Note:  1. Maximum source current is 14 mA and maximum sink current is 19.5 mA per cluster. A cluster is a group of GPIOs as shown in the following table. Each VDD/GND pair is connected to 2 clusters, hence current consumption through the pair will be a sum of the clusters source or sink currents. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 612 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Table 34-2. GPIO Clusters PACKAGE CLUSTER SUPPLY PINS CONNECTED GPIO TO THE CLUSTER 64 pins TQFP and VQFN 48 pins TQFP and VQFN 32 pins TQFP and VQFN 1 PB31 PB30 PA31 PA30 VDDIN pin56/GND pin54 2 PA28 PA27 PB23 PB22 VDDIN pin56/GND pin54 and VDDIO pin 48/GND pin47 3 PA25 PA24 PA23 PA22 PA21 PA20 PB17 PB16 PA19 PA18 4 PA15 PA14 PA13 PA12 PB15 PB14 PB13 PB12 PB11 PB10 5 PA11 PA10 PA09 PA08 6 PA07 PA06 PA05 PA04 PB09 PB08 PB07 PB06 7 PB05 PB04 PA03 PA02 PA01 PA00 PB03 PB02 1 PA31 PA30 VDDIN pin44/GND pin42 VDDIN pin44/GND pin42 and VDDIO pin36/GND pin35 PA17 VDDIO pin 48/GND pin47 and VDDIO pin34/GND pin33 PA16 VDDIO pin 34/GND pin33 and VDDIO pin21/GND pin22 VDDIO pin21/GND pin22 2 PA28 PA27 PB23 PB22 3 PA25 PA24 PA23 PA22 4 PA11 PA10 PA09 PA08 5 PA07 PA06 PA05 6 PA03 PA02 PA01 1 PA31 PA30 2 PA28 PA27 PA25 PA24 PA23 PA22 PA19 PA18 3 PA07 PA06 PA05 PA04 PA03 PA02 PA01 PA00 PA19 PA18 VDDANA pin 8/GNDANA pin7 PB01 PA17 PB00 PA16 VDDANA pin 8/GNDANA pin7 PA15 PA14 PA13 PA12 PB11 PB10 VDDIO pin36/GND pin35 and VDDIO pin17/GND pin18 PA21 PA20 PA04 PB09 PB08 VDDANA pin6/GNDANA pin5 PA00 PB03 PB02 VDDANA pin6/GNDANA pin5 VDDIO pin17/GND pin18 VDDIN pin30/GND pin 28 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries PA17 PA16 PA15 Complete Datasheet PA14 PA11 PA10 PA09 PA08 VDDIN pin30/GND pin 28 and VDDANA pin9/GND pin10 VDDANA pin9/GND pin10 DS60001504F-page 613 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ 34.3 General Operating Ratings The device must operate within the ratings listed in the table in order for all other electrical characteristics and typical characteristics of the device to be valid. Table 34-3. General operating conditions Symbol Parameter Min. Typ. Max. Units VDD Power-supply voltage 2.7 3.3 3.63 V VDDANA Analog-supply voltage 2.7 3.3 3.63 V TA Temperature range -40 25 125 °C TJ Junction temperature - - 145 °C Note:  1. In debugger Cold-Plugging mode, the NVM erase operations are not protected by the BOD33 and BOD12. NVM erase operation at supply voltages below specified minimum can cause corruption of NVM areas that are mandatory for correct device behavior. 34.4 Supply Characteristics The following supply characteristics are applicable to the operating temperature range: TA = -40°C to 125°C, unless otherwise specified and are valid for a junction temperature up to TJ = 145°C. Table 34-4. Supply Characteristics Voltage Symbol Conditions VDDIO VDDIN VDDANA Full-Voltage Range Min. Max. Units 2.7 3.63 V Table 34-5. Supply Rise Rates Symbol Fall Rate Conditions Rise Rate Max. Min.(1) Max. 50E-3 430E-6 0.1 Units VDDIO VDDIN DC supply peripheral I/Os, internal regulator, and analog-supply voltage V/us VDDANA Note:  1. The Minimum Supply Rise Rate does not apply if the voltage on the Reset pin is lower than VIL.max (see 34.8.5 External Reset Pin) until VDD reaches a minimum voltage of 1.73V. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 614 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ 34.5 Maximum Clock Frequencies Table 34-6. Maximum GCLK Generator Output Frequencies Symbol Description Conditions Max. Undivided 48 Units fGCLKGEN0/fGCLK_MAIN fGCLKGEN1 fGCLKGEN2 fGCLKGEN3 fGCLKGEN4 GCLK Generator Output Frequency fGCLKGEN5 MHz Divided 32 fGCLKGEN6 fGCLKGEN7 Table 34-7. Maximum Peripheral Clock Frequencies Symbol Description Max. Units fCPU CPU clock frequency 32 MHz fAHB AHB clock frequency 32 MHz fAPBA APBA clock frequency 32 MHz fAPBB APBB clock frequency 32 MHz fAPBC APBC clock frequency 32 MHz fGCLK_DFLL48M_REF DFLL48M Reference clock frequency 33 kHz fGCLK_WDT WDT input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_RTC RTC input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EIC EIC input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_0 EVSYS channel 0 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_1 EVSYS channel 1 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_2 EVSYS channel 2 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_3 EVSYS channel 3 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_4 EVSYS channel 4 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_5 EVSYS channel 5 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_6 EVSYS channel 6 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_EVSYS_CHANNEL_7 EVSYS channel 7 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_SERCOMx_SLOW Common SERCOM slow input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_SERCOM0_CORE SERCOM0 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_SERCOM1_CORE SERCOM1 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_SERCOM2_CORE SERCOM2 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_SERCOM3_CORE SERCOM3 input clock frequency 48 MHz © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 615 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ ...........continued Symbol Description Max. Units fGCLK_SERCOM4_CORE SERCOM4 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_SERCOM5_CORE SERCOM5 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_TC0, GCLK_TC1 TC0, TC1 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_TC2, GCLK_TC3 TC2, TC3 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_TC4, GCLK_TC5 TC4, TC5 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_TC6, GCLK_TC7 TC6, TC7 input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_ADC ADC input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_AC_DIG AC digital input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_AC_ANA AC analog input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_DAC DAC input clock frequency 48 MHz fGCLK_PTC PTC input clock frequency 48 MHz Note:  1. These values are based on simulation and not covered by production test limits or characterization. 34.6 Power Consumption The values provided in the table Current Consumption are measured values of power consumption under the following conditions, except where noted: • • • • • • • • • Operating conditions: – VVDDIN = 3.3 V Wake up time from Sleep mode is measured from the edge of the wakeup signal to the execution of the first instruction fetched in Flash. Oscillators – XOSC (crystal oscillator) stopped – XOSC32K (32 kHz crystal oscillator) running with external 32 kHz crystal – DFLL48M using XOSC32K as reference and running at 48 MHz Clocks – DFLL48M used as main clock source, except otherwise specified. – CPU, AHB clocks undivided – APBA clock divided by 4 – APBB and APBC bridges off The following AHB module clocks are running: NVMCTRL, APBA bridge – All other AHB clocks stopped The following peripheral clocks running: PM, SYSCTRL, RTC – All other peripheral clocks stopped I/Os are inactive with internal pull-up CPU is running on Flash with 1 wait states NVMCTRL cache enabled © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 616 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Table 34-8. Current Consumption (2) Mode Conditions CPU running a While(1) algorithm CPU running a While(1) algorithm, with GCLKIN as reference CPU running a Fibonacci algorithm ACTIVE CPU running a Fibonacci algorithm, with GCLKIN as reference CPU running a CoreMark algorithm CPU running a CoreMark algorithm, with GCLKIN as reference IDLE0 - IDLE1 - IDLE2 XOSC32K running RTC running at 1 kHz(1) STANDBY XOSC32K and RTC stopped(1) TA Vcc Min. Typ. Max. 25°C 3.3V - 2.27 2.48 125°C 3.3V - 2.41 3.32 25°C 3.3V - 43*freq +108 52*freq +135 125°C 3.3V - 44*freq +276 50*freq +949 25°C 3.3V - 3.04 3.26 125°C 3.3V - 3.19 3.76 25°C 3.3V - 59*freq +109 62*freq +133 125°C 3.3V - 60*freq +276 58*freq +953 25°C 3.3V - 3.90 4.42 125°C 3.3V - 4.34 4.81 25°C 3.3V - 77* freq +108 85* freq +130 125°C 3.3V - 25°C 3.3V - 1.28 1.37 125°C 3.3V - 1.44 2.05 25°C 3.3V - 0.97 1.05 125°C 3.3V - 1.09 1.70 25°C 3.3V - 0.76 0.83 125°C 3.3V - 0.88 1.50 25°C 3.3V - 62.00 85.00 125°C 3.3.V - 198.00 442.00 25°C 3.3V - 61.00 84.00 125°C(3) 3.3V - 196.00 438 Units mA μA (with freq in MHz) mA μA (with freq in MHz) mA μA 83 * freq + 288 81* freq +974 (with freq in MHz) mA μA Notes:  1. Measurements were done with SYSCTRL->VREG.bit.RUNSTDBY = 1. 2. These values are based on characterization and not covered by test limits in production unless otherwise specified. 3. These values are screened during production. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 617 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Table 34-9. Wake-up Time Mode Conditions IDLE0 OSC8M used as main clock source, cache disabled IDLE1 OSC8M used as main clock source, cache disabled IDLE2 OSC8M used as main clock source, cache disabled STANDBY OSC8M used as main clock source, cache disabled TA Min. Typ. Max. 25°C - 4.0 - 125°C - 4.0 - 25°C - 12.1 - 125°C - 14.9 - 25°C - 13.0 - 125°C - 15.8 - 25°C - 19.6 - 125°C - 20.6 - Units Figure 34-1. Measurement Schematic VDDIN VDDANA VDDIO Amp 0 VDDCORE © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 618 μs SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ 34.7 Peripheral Power Consumption Default conditions, except where noted: • • • • • • • • • Operating conditions – VVDDIN = 3.3 V Oscillators – XOSC (crystal oscillator) stopped – XOSC32K (32 kHz crystal oscillator) running with external 32 kHz crystal – OSC8M at 8 MHz Clocks – OSC8M used as main clock source – CPU, AHB, and APBn clocks undivided The following AHB module clocks are running: NVMCTRL, HPB2 bridge, HPB1 bridge, HPB0 bridge – All other AHB clocks stopped The following peripheral clocks running: PM, SYSCTRL – All other peripheral clocks stopped I/Os are inactive with internal pull-up CPU in IDLE0 mode Cache enabled BOD33 disabled In this default conditions, the power consumption Idefault is measured. Operating mode for each peripheral in turn: • • • • • • • • • Configure and enable the peripheral GCLK (When relevant, see conditions) Unmask the peripheral clock Enable the peripheral (when relevant) Set CPU in IDLE0 mode Measurement Iperiph Wake-up CPU through EIC (async: level detection, filtering disabled) Disable the peripheral (when relevant) Mask the peripheral clock Disable the peripheral GCLK (when relevant, see conditions) Each peripheral power consumption details provided in table x-9 is the value (Iperiph - Idefault), using the same measurement method as for global power consumption measurement. Table 34-10. Typical Peripheral Power Consumption Peripheral Conditions Typ. RTC fGCLK_RTC = 32 kHz, 32 bit counter mode 6.2 WDT fGCLK_WDT = 32 kHz, normal mode with EW 3.4 AC Both fGCLK = 8 MHz, Enable both COMP 116.0 TCx(1) fGCLK = 8 MHz, Enable + COUNTER in 8 bit mode 42.3 SERCOMx.I2CM(2) fGCLK = 8 MHz, Enable 76.9 SERCOMx.I2CS(2) fGCLK = 8 MHz, Enable 36.5 SERCOMx.SPI(2) fGCLK = 8 MHz, Enable 70.6 SERCOMx.USART(2) fGCLK = 8 MHz, Enable 88.0 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet Units μA DS60001504F-page 619 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Notes:  1. All TCs share the same power consumption values. 2. All SERCOMs share the same power consumption values. 34.8 I/O Pin Characteristics 34.8.1 Normal I/O Pins Table 34-11. Normal I/O Pin Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units RPULL Pull-up and Pull-down resistance - 20 40 60 kΩ VIL Input low-level voltage VDD = 2.7V-3.63V - - 0.3*VDD VIH Input high-level voltage VDD = 2.7V-3.63V 0.55*VDD - - VOL Output low-level voltage VDD > 2.7V, IOL max. - 0.1*VDD 0.2*VDD VOH Output high-level voltage VDD > 2.7V, IOH max. 0.8*VDD 0.9*VDD - VDD = 2.7V-3.63V, PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR = 0 - - 2.5 VDD = 2.7V-3.63V, PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR = 1 - - 10 VDD = 2.7V-3.63V, PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR = 0 - - 2 VDD = 2.7V-3.63V, PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR = 1 - - 7 PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR = 0 load = 5 pF, VDD = 3.3V - - 15 PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR = 1 load = 20 pF, VDD = 3.3V - - 15 PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR = 0 load = 5 pF, VDD = 3.3V - - 15 PORT.PINCFG.DRVSTR = 1 load = 20 pF, VDD = 3.3V - - 15 Pull-up resistors disabled -1 +/-0.015 1 IOL Output low-level current IOH Output high-level current tRISE Rise time(1) Fall time(1) tFALL ILEAK Input leakage current V mA ns μA Note:  1. These values are based on simulation and not covered by test limits in production or characterization. 34.8.2 I2C Pins Refer to I/O Multiplexing and Considerations to obtain the list of I2C pins. Table 34-12. I2C Pins Characteristics in I2C configuration Symbol Parameter RPULL Pull-up - Pull-down resistance © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Condition Complete Datasheet Min. Typ. Max. Units 20 40 60 kΩ DS60001504F-page 620 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ ...........continued Symbol Parameter Condition Min. Typ. Max. VIL Input low-level voltage VDD = 2.7V-3.63V - - 0.3*VDD VIH Input high-level voltage VDD = 2.7V-3.63V 0.55*VDD - - VHYS Hysteresis of Schmitt trigger inputs 0.08*VDD - - VOL Output low-level voltage VDD > 2.7V IOL = 3 mA - - 0.4 IOL Output low-level current VOL = 0.4V 3 - - VOL = 0.6V 6 - - fSCL SCL clock frequency - - 400 Units V mA kHz I2C pins timing characteristics can be found in 32.14.3. SERCOM in I2C Mode Timing. 34.8.3 XOSC Pin The XOSC pins behave as normal pins when used as normal I/Os. For additional information, refer to the Table 32-12. 34.8.4 XOSC32 Pin The XOSC32 pins behave as normal pins when used as normal I/Os. For additional information, refer to the Table 32-12. 34.8.5 External Reset Pin The External Reset pin has the same electrical characteristics as normal I/O pins. For additional information, refer to the Table 32-12. 34.9 Injection Current Stresses beyond those listed in the table below may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at these or other conditions beyond those indicated in the operational sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. Table 34-13. Injection Current(1) Symbol Description min. max. Unit Iinj1 (2) I/O pin injection current -1 +1 mA Iinjtotal Sum of I/O pins injection current -45 +45 mA Notes:  1. Injecting current may have an effect on the accuracy of analog blocks. 2. Conditions for Vpin: Vpin < GND-0.3V or 3.6V 0.2*VDDANA - 0.1V The gain accuracy represents the gain error expressed in percent. Gain accuracy (%) = (Gain Error in V x 100) / (2*Vref/GAIN). With gain compensation enabled (REFCTRL.REFCOMP = 1). Table 34-21. Single-Ended Mode (1,2,4) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units ENOB Effective Number of Bits 1x Gain, Ext. Ref. 2V ≤ VREF≤ 3V 8.9 9.9 10.1 Bits TUE Total Unadjusted Error 1x Gain, Ext. Ref. 2V ≤ VREF ≤ 3V 1.6 7 22 LSB INL Integral Non-Linearity 1x Gain, Ext. Ref. 2V ≤ VREF ≤ 3V 1.0 1.5 3.0 LSB DNL Differential Non-Linearity 1x Gain, Ext. Ref. 2V ≤ VREF≤ 3V ±0.5 ±0.8 ±0.95 LSB Gain Error 1x Gain, Ext. Ref. 2V ≤ VREF ≤ 3V -7.1 -0.3 7.1 mV 0.5x Gain, Ext. Ref. 2V ≤ VREF≤ 3V ±0.1 ±0.2 ±0.4 % 2x to 16x Gain, Ext. Ref. 2V ≤ VREF≤ 3V ±0.2 ±0.6 ±0.9 % GE Gain Accuracy (3) OE Offset Error 1x Gain, Ext. Ref. 2V ≤ VREF ≤ 3V -9 5.5 28 mV SFDR Spurious Free Dynamic Range 70 80 84 dB SINAD Signal-to-Noise and Distortion 1x Gain Ext. Ref. 2V ≤ VREF ≤ 3V 56 61 62 dB SNR Signal-to-Noise Ratio 58 63 64 dB THD Total Harmonic Distortion AIN = 95% FSR -68 -67 -59 dB Noise RMS T = 25°C - 1 6 mV © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries FCLK_ADC = 2.1 MHz FIN = 40 kHz Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 626 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Notes:  1. Specifications are based on characterization and not covered by production screening. 2. Respect the input common mode voltage through the following equations (where VCM_IN is the Input channel common mode voltage) for all VIN: VCM_IN < 0.7*VDDANA + VREF/4 – 0.75V 3. 4. VCM_IN > VREF/4 – 0.3*VDDANA - 0.1V The gain accuracy represents the gain error expressed in percent. Gain accuracy (%) = (Gain Error in V x 100) / (VREF/GAIN). With gain compensation enabled (REFCTRL.REFCOMP = 1) 34.10.4.1 Performance with the Averaging Digital Feature Averaging is a feature which increases the sample accuracy. ADC automatically computes an average value of multiple consecutive conversions. The numbers of samples to be averaged is specified by the Number-of-Samplesto-be-Collected bit group in the Average Control register (AVGCTRL.SAMPLENUM[3:0]) and the averaged output is available in the Result register (RESULT). Table 34-22. Averaging feature Average Number Conditions 1 In Differential mode, 1x gain, VDDANA = 3.0V, VREF = 2.0V, 350 ksps T = 25°C 8 32 128 SNR (dB) SINAD (dB) SFDR (dB) ENOB (bits) 66 65 85 10.5 68 66 87 11.4 70 67 88 11.6 71 67 88 11.7 34.10.4.2 Performance with the Hardware Offset and Gain Correction Inherent gain and offset errors affect the absolute accuracy of the ADC. The offset error cancellation is handled by the Offset Correction register (OFFSETCORR) and the gain error cancellation, by the Gain Correction register (GAINCORR). The offset and gain correction value is subtracted from the converted data before writing the Result register (RESULT). Table 34-23. Offset and Gain correction features Gain Factor Conditions Offset Error (mV) Gain Error (mV) Total Unadjusted Error (LSB) 0.25 1.0 2.4 0.20 0.10 1.5 0.15 -0.15 2.7 -0.05 0.05 3.2 0.10 -0.05 6.1 0.5x 1x 2x 8x In differential mode, 1x gain, VDDANA = 3.0V, VREF = 2.0V, 350 ksps T = 25°C 16x 34.10.4.3 Inputs and Sample and Hold Acquisition Times The analog voltage source must be able to charge the Sample-and-Hold (S/H) capacitor in the ADC to achieve maximum accuracy. Seen externally the ADC input consists of a resistor (RSAMPLE) and a capacitor (CSAMPLE). In addition, the source resistance (RSOURCE) must be considered when calculating the required S/H time. The figure below shows the ADC input channel equivalent circuit. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 627 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Figure 34-5. ADC Input VDDANA/2 RSOURCE Analog Input AINx CSAMPLE RSAMPLE VIN To achieve ‘n’ bits of accuracy, the CSAMPLE capacitor must be charged at least to a voltage of VCSAMPLE ≥ VIN × 1 − 2− n + 1 The minimum sampling time tSAMPLEHOLD for a given RSOURCE can be calculated using this formula: tSAMPLEHOLD ≥ RSAMPLE + RSOURCE × CSAMPLE × n + 1 × ln 2 For a 12 bits accuracy: tSAMPLEHOLD ≥ RSAMPLE + RSOURCE × CSAMPLE × 9.02 where, tSAMPLEHOLD = 1 2 × fADC 34.10.5 Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) Characteristics Table 34-24. Operating Conditions Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units VDDANA Analog supply voltage - 2.7 - 3.63 V External reference voltage - 2.0 - VDDANA-0.6 V INT1V - - 1 - V VDDANA - - VDDANA - V - Linear output voltage range - 0.1 - VDDANA-0.1 V - Minimum resistive load - 5 - - kΩ - Maximum capacitance load - - - 100 pF IDD DC supply current (1) Voltage pump disabled - 160 290 μA AVREF Note:  1. These values are based on characterization and are not covered by test limits in production. Table 34-25. Clock and Timing Symbol Parameter Conversion rate Startup time © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Conditions Cload = 100 pF Rload > 5kΩ Normal mode VDDNA > 2.7V Complete Datasheet Min. Typ. Max. Units - - 350 ksps - - 2.85 μs DS60001504F-page 628 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Note:  The values in this table are based on simulation and are not covered by test limits in production or characterization. Table 34-26. Accuracy Characteristics Symbol Parameter RES Input resolution INL Conditions (1) Integral non-linearity DNL Differential non-linearity GE Gain error OE Offset error VDD Min. Typ. Max. Units - - 10 Bits VREF = EXT. Vol. Ref. [2.7 - 3.6] V -1.3 ±0.6 1.3 VREF = VDDANA [2.7 - 3.6] V -2 ±1 2 VREF = INT1V [2.7 - 3.6] V -3.7 ±0.7 3.7 VREF = EXT. Vol. Ref. [2.7 - 3.6] V -0.7 ±0.3 0.7 VREF = VDDANA [2.7 - 3.6] V -0.5 ±0.3 0.5 VREF = INT1V [2.7 - 3.6] V -3.9 ±0.6 3.9 VREF = EXT. Vol. Ref. [2.7 - 3.6] V -14 -6.7 1.8 VREF = INT1V [2.7 - 3.6] V -24 -5.4 12 VREF = VDDANA [2.7 - 3.6] V -52 -30 -7 VREF = EXT. Vol. Ref. [2.7 - 3.6] V -12 1.2 13 VREF = INT1V [2.7 - 3.6] V -16 -0.4 12 VREF = VDDANA [2.7 - 3.6] V -5.5 4 15 LSB mV mV Note:  1. All values are measured using a conversion rate of 35 ksps. 34.10.6 Analog Comparator Characteristics Table 34-27. Electrical and Timing Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Positive input voltage range - 0 - VDDANA Negative input voltage range - 0 - VDDANA Hysteresis = 0, Fast mode -26 0 26 mV Hysteresis = 0, Low-Power mode -28 0 28 mV Hysteresis = 1, Fast mode 8 50 102 mV Hysteresis = 1, Low-Power mode 14 40 75 mV Changes for VACM = VDDANA/2 100 mV overdrive, Fast mode - 90 180 ns Changes for VACM = VDDANA/2 100 mV overdrive, LowPower mode - 282 534 ns Enable to ready delay Fast mode - 1 3 µs Enable to ready delay Low-Power mode - 14 23 µs Offset Hysteresis Propagation delay tSTARTUP Startup time © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet Units DS60001504F-page 629 V SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ ...........continued Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units INL (3) - -1.6 0.75 1.6 LSB (3) - -0.95 0.25 0.95 LSB Offset Error (1,2) - -0.2 0.26 1.04 LSB Gain Error (1,2) - -0.89 0.215 2 LSB DNL VSCALE Notes:  1. According to the standard equation, V(X) = VLSB*(X+1); VLSB = VDDANA/64. 2. Data computed with the Best Fit method. 3. Data computed using histogram. 34.10.7 Bandgap and Internal 1.0V Reference Characteristics Table 34-28. Bandgap and Internal 1.0V Reference Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units BANDGAP Bandgap reference Over voltage and [-40°C, +125°C] 1.06 1.1 1.12 V Over voltage at 25°C 1.07 1.1 1.12 Over voltage and [-40°C, +125°C] 0.96 1 1.02 Over voltage at 25°C 0.97 1 1.02 INT1V Internal 1.0V reference voltage (1) Note:  1. These values are based on simulation and are not covered by production test limits. 34.11 NVM Characteristics Table 34-29. Maximum Operating Frequency VDD range NVM Wait States Maximum Operating Frequency 0 20 1 32 2.7V to 3.63V Units MHz Note:  On this Flash technology, a maximum number of 8 consecutive write is allowed per row. Once this number is reached, a row erase is mandatory. Table 34-30. Flash Endurance and Data Retention Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units RetNVM25k Retention after up to 25k cycles Average ambient 55°C 10 50 - Years RetNVM2.5k Retention after up to 2.5k cycles Average ambient 55°C 20 100 - Years RetNVM100 Retention after up to 100 cycles Average ambient 55°C 25 >100 - Years CycNVM Cycling Endurance(1) -40°C < Ta < 125°C 25k - - Cycles Note:  1. An endurance cycle is a write and an erase operation. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 630 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Table 34-31. EEPROM Emulation(1) Endurance and Data Retention Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units RetEEPROM100k Retention after up to 100k cycles Average ambient 55°C 10 50 - Years RetEEPROM10k Retention after up to 10k cycles Average ambient 55°C 20 100 - Years CycEEPROM Cycling Endurance(2) -40°C < Ta < 125°C 100k - - Cycles Notes:  1. The EEPROM Emulation is a software emulation as described in the Application Note “AT03265”. 2. An endurance cycle is a write and an erase operation. Table 34-32. NVM Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units tFPP Page programming time - - - 2.5 ms tFRE Row erase time - - - 6 ms tFCE DSU chip erase time (CHIP_ERASE) - - - 240 ms 34.12 Oscillators Characteristics 34.12.1 Crystal Oscillator (XOSC) Characteristics 34.12.1.1 Digital Clock Characteristics The following table describes the oscillator characteristics when a digital clock is applied on XIN. Table 34-33. Digital Clock Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fCPXIN XIN clock frequency Digital mode - - 32 MHz 34.12.1.2 Crystal Oscillator Characteristics The following table describes the oscillator characteristics when a crystal is connected between XIN and XOUT as shown in the following figure. The user must choose a crystal oscillator where the crystal load capacitance CL is within the range given in the table. The exact value of CL can be found in the crystal data sheet. The capacitance of the external capacitors (CLEXT) can then be computed as follows: Load Capacitance Equation CLOAD = ([CXIN + CLEXT] * [CXOUT + CLEXT]) / ([CXIN + CLEXT + CLEXT + CXOUT]) + CSTRAY Where: CLOAD = Crystal Mfg. CLOAD specification CXIN = XOSC XIN pin data sheet specification CXOUT = XOSC XOUT pin data sheet specification CLEXT = Required external crystal load capacitor CSTRAY (Osc PCB capacitance) = 1.5 pF per 12.5 mm (0.5 inches) (TRACE W = 0.175 mm, H = 36 μm, T = 113 μm) For CXIN and CXOUT within 4 pF of each other, assume CXIN ~= CXOUT ~= CXTAL_EFF = ((CXIN+CXOUT) / 2) (Averaging CXIN and CXOUT will effect final calculated CLOAD value by less than 0.25 pF.) The load capacitance equation can then be simplified as follows: CLEXT = 2*CLOAD - CXTAL_EFF - 2*CSTRAY © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 631 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Table 34-34. Crystal Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fOUT Crystal oscillator frequency - 0.4 - 32 MHz f = 0.455 MHz, CL = 100 pF , XOSC.GAIN = 0 - - 5.6K f = 2 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 0 - - 330 f = 4 MHz, CL = 20 pF , XOSC.GAIN = 1 - - 240 f = 8 MHz, CL = 20 pF , XOSC.GAIN = 2 - - 105 f = 16 MHz, CL = 20 pF ,XOSC.GAIN = 3 - - 60 f = 32 MHz, CL = 18 pF ,XOSC.GAIN = 4 - - 55 - 5.9 - pF - 3.2 - pF f = 2 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 0, AGC off - 65 240 f = 2 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 0, AGC on - 52 240 f = 4 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 1, AGC off - 117 309 f = 4 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 1, AGC on - 74 281 f = 8 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 2, AGC off - 226 435 f = 8 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 2, AGC on - 128 356 f = 16 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 3, AGC off - 502 748 f = 16MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 3, AGC on - 307 627 f = 32 MHz, CL = 18 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 4, AGC off - 1622 2344 f = 32 MHz, CL = 18pF, XOSC.GAIN = 4, AGC on - 615 1422 f = 2 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 0, ESR = 600Ω - 15.6K 51.0K f = 4MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 1, ESR = 100Ω - 6.3K 20.1K f = 8 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 2, ESR = 35Ω - 6.2K 20.3K cycles f = 16 MHz, CL = 20 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 3, ESR = 25Ω - 7.7K 21.2K f = 32 MHz, CL = 18 pF, XOSC.GAIN = 4, ESR = 40Ω - 6.0K 14.2K ESR Crystal Equivalent Series Resistance Safety Factor = 3 The AGC doesn’t have any noticeable impact on these measurements. CXIN Parasitic capacitor load CXOUT Parasitic capacitor load Current Consumption tSTARTUP Startup time © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries - Complete Datasheet Ω DS60001504F-page 632 μA SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Figure 34-6. Oscillator Connection Xin C LEXT Crystal LM C SHUNT RM C STRAY CM C LEXT Xout 34.12.2 External 32 kHz Crystal Oscillator (XOSC32K) Characteristics 34.12.2.1 Digital Clock Characteristics The following table describes the characteristics for the oscillator when a digital clock is applied on the XIN32 pin. Table 34-35. Digital Clock Characteristics (1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fCPXIN32 XIN32 clock frequency Digital mode - 32.768 - kHz DCxin XIN32 clock duty cycle Digital mode - 50 - % Note:  1. These values are based on simulation. These values are not covered by test or characterization. 34.12.2.2 Crystal Oscillator Characteristics Figure 32-6 and the equation in 32.12.1.2. Crystal Oscillator Characteristics also applied to the 32  kHz oscillator connection. The user must choose a crystal oscillator where the crystal load capacitance CL is within the range given in the table. The value of CL can be found in the crystal data sheet. For the computation of the external capacitors (CLEXT) value, refer to the logic detailed in XOSC Crystal Oscillator Characteristics. Table 34-36. 32 kHz Crystal Oscillator Characteristics Symbol Parameter fOUT Crystal oscillator frequency tSTARTUP Startup time CL Min. Typ. Max. Units - 32768 - Hz - 28K 31K cycles Crystal load capacitance - - 12.5 CSHUNT Crystal shunt capacitance - 0.1 - CXIN32 Parasitic capacitor load - 3.1 - CXOUT32 Parasitic capacitor load - 3.3 - © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Conditions ESRXTAL = 39.9  kΩ, CL = 12.5  pF TQFP64/48/32 packages Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 633 pF SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ ...........continued Symbol Parameter Conditions IXOSC32K Current consumption ESR Crystal equivalent series resistance f = 32.768 kHz Safety Factor = 3 VDD = 3.0V, AGC off VDD = 3.0V, AGC on(1) CL= 12.5 pF Min. Typ. Max. - 1.22 2.33 - - - - - 100 Units μA kΩ Note:  1. Refer to the Errata and Data Sheet Clarification document regarding the AGC feature of XOSC32K. 34.12.3 Digital-Frequency Locked Loop (DFLL48M) Characteristics The following tables provide the characteristics of the DFLL48M. Table 34-37. DFLL48M Characteristics - Open Loop Mode Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fOUT Output frequency DFLLVAL.COARSE = DFLL48M COARSE CAL DFLLVAL.FINE = 512 over [-40, +125]C, over [2.7, 3.6]V 44.50 48.00 51.75 MHz fOUT Output frequency DFLLVAL.COARSE = DFLL48M COARSE CAL DFLLVAL.FINE = 512 at Ta = 25°C, over [2.7, 3.6]V 46.60 48.00 49.40 MHz IDFLL Power consumption on VDDIN DFLLVAL.COARSE = DFLL48M COARSE CAL DFLLVAL.FINE = 512 - 403 457 µA tSTARTUP Startup time DFLLVAL.COARSE = DFLL48M COARSE CAL DFLLVAL.FINE = 512 fOUT within 90 % of final value - 8 12 µs Table 34-38. DFLL48M Characteristics - Closed-Loop Mode(1)(2) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units fOUT Average Output frequency fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz, 100 ppm DFLLMUL = 1464 47.50 48.00 48.44 MHz fREF Reference frequency 0.732 32.768 33 kHz IDFLL Power consumption on VDDIN - 457 - μA - 350 - μs fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz, 100 ppm fREF = XOSC32K 32.768 kHz , 100 ppm DFLLMUL = 1464 DFLLVAL.COARSE = DFLL48M COARSE CAL tLOCK Lock time DFLLVAL.FINE = 512 DFLLCTRL.BPLCKC = 1 DFLLCTRL.QLDIS = 0 DFLLCTRL.CCDIS = 1 DFLLMUL.FSTEP = 10 Notes:  1. Refer to the revision C/revision B errata related to the DFLL48M. 2. All parts are tested in production to be able to use the DFLL as the main CPU clock in DFLL Closed Loop mode with an external XOSC32K reference. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 634 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ 34.12.4 32.768 kHz Internal oscillator (OSC32K) Characteristics Table 34-39. 32 kHz RC Oscillator Characteristics Symbol fOUT Parameter Conditions Output frequency Min. Typ. Max. Calibrated against a 32.768 kHz reference at 25°C, over [-40, +125]°C, over [2.7, 3.63]V 26.214 32.768 39.321 Calibrated against a 32.768 kHz reference at 25°C, at VDD = 3.3V 32.113 32.768 33.423 Calibrated against a 32.768 kHz reference at 25°C, over [2.7, 3.63]V 31.457 32.768 34.079 Units kHz IOSC32K Current consumption - - 0.67 5 μA tSTARTUP Startup time - - 1 2 cycle Duty Duty Cycle - - 50 - % Min. Typ. Max. Units 34.12.5 Ultra-Low Power Internal 32 kHz RC Oscillator (OSCULP32K) Characteristics Table 34-40. Ultra-Low Power Internal 32kHz RC Oscillator Characteristics Symbol fOUT Duty Parameter Conditions Calibrated against a 32.768 kHz reference at 25°C, over [-40, +125]C, over [2.7, 3.63]V 24.576 32.768 40.960 Calibrated against a 32.768 kHz reference at 25°C, at VDD = 3.3V 30.474 32.768 35.061 Calibrated against a 32.768 kHz reference at 25°C, over [2.7, 3.63]V 30.146 32.768 35.389 Output frequency Duty Cycle - 50 - kHz % 34.12.6 8 MHz RC Oscillator (OSC8M) Characteristics Table 34-41. Internal 8 MHz RC Oscillator Characteristics Symbol fOUT Parameter Conditions Min. Typ. Max. Units Calibrated against a 8 MHz reference at 25°C, over [-40, +125]C, over [2.7, 3.63]V 7.57 8 8.36 Calibrated against a 8 MHz reference at 25°C, at VDD = 3.3V 7.88 8 8.10 Calibrated against a 8 MHz reference at 25°C, over [2.7, 3.63]V 7.87 8 8.10 Output frequency MHz IOSC8M Current consumption With default SYSCTRL.OSC8M[FRANGE, CALIB] loaded from Flash at startup and SYSCTRL.OSC8M[PRESC] = 0 - - 78 μA tSTARTUP Startup time - - 2.4 3.9 μs Duty Duty cycle - - 50 - % © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 635 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ 34.13 PTC Characteristics Table 34-42. Sensor Load Capacitance Symbol Mode PTC channel Max Sensor Load (1) Y0 15 Y1 22 Y2 18 Units Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Self-capacitance CLOAD Y7 Y8 Y9 pf 22 Y10 Y11 Y12 Y13 Y14 Y15 Mutual-capacitance All 29 Note:  1. Capacitance load that the PTC circuitry can compensate for each channel. Table 34-43. Analog Gain Settings (1,2) Symbol Gain Setting Average GAIN_1 1.0 GAIN_2 2.0 GAIN_4 3.8 GAIN_8 7.8 GAIN_16 12.8 GAIN_32 - Notes:  1. Analog Gain is a parameter of the QTouch Library. Refer to the QTouch Library Peripheral Touch Controller User Guide. 2. GAIN_16 and GAIN_32 settings are not recommended, otherwise the PTC measurements might get unstable. Power Consumption The values provided in the Power Consumption table below are measured values of power consumption under the following conditions: © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 636 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Operating Conditions: VDD = 3.3V Clocks: OSC8M used as main clock source, running undivided at 8 MHz. CPU is running on flash with 0 wait states, at 8 MHz. PTC running at 4 MHz. PTC Configuration: Mutual-Capacitance mode One touch channel System Configuration: Standby Sleep mode enabled. RTC running on OSCULP32K: used to define the PTC scan rate through the event system. Drift Calibration disabled: no interrupts, PTC scans are performed in Standby mode. Drift Calibration enabled: RTC interrupts (wakeup) the CPU to perform PTC scans. PTC drift calibration is performed every 1.5 sec. Table 34-44. Power Consumption (1) Symbol Parameters Drift Calibration PTC scan rate (msec) 10 50 Disabled 100 200 IDD (2) Current Consumption 10 50 Enabled 100 200 Oversamples Ta Typ. Max. Units 4 67 487 16 75 498 4 62 481 16 64 484 4 62 481 16 63 482 4 61 481 62 482 71 495 16 79 507 4 64 485 16 65 489 4 63 485 16 64 487 4 62 484 16 63 484 16 4 Max. 125°C Typ. 25°C Notes:  1. These values are based on characterization. 2. On this table, the LDO Voltage Regulator is enabled in Standby mode (SYSCTRL.VREG.RUNSTDBY = 1). © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 637 µA SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ 34.14 Timing Characteristics 34.14.1 External Reset Table 34-45. External Reset Characteristics (1) Symbol Parameter Condition tEXT Minimum reset pulse width Min. Typ. Max. Units 10 - - ns Note:  1. These values are based on simulation. These values are not covered by test limits in production or characterization. 34.14.2 SERCOM in SPI Mode Timing Figure 34-7. SPI Timing Requirements in Host Mode SS tSCKR tMOS tSCKF SCK (CPOL = 0) tSCKW SCK (CPOL = 1) tSCKW tMIS MISO (Data Input) tMIH tSCK MSB LSB tMOH tMOH MOSI (Data Output) MSB LSB Figure 34-8. SPI Timing Requirements in Client Mode SS tSSCKR tSSS tSSCKF tSSH SCK (CPOL = 0) tSSCKW SCK (CPOL = 1) tSSCKW tSIS MOSI (Data Input) tSIH MSB tSOSS MISO (Data Output) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries tSSCK LSB tSOS tSOSH MSB LSB Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 638 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Table 34-46. SPI Timing Characteristics and Requirements(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions tSCK SCK period Host tSCKW SCK high/low width Host - 0.5*tSCK - tSCKR SCK rise time(2) Host - - - Host - - - time(2) Min. Typ. Max. Units 84 ns tSCKF SCK fall tMIS MISO setup to SCK Host - 29 - tMIH MISO hold after SCK Host - 8 - tMOS MOSI setup SCK Host - tSCK/2 - 16 - tMOH MOSI hold after SCK Host - 16 - tSSCK Client SCK Period Client 1*tCLK_APB - - tSSCKW SCK high/low width Client 0.5*tSSCK - - tSSCKR SCK rise time(2) Client - - - Client - - - time(2) tSSCKF SCK fall tSIS MOSI setup to SCK Client tSSCK/2 - 19 - - tSIH MOSI hold after SCK Client tSSCK/2 - 5 - - tSSS SS setup to SCK Client PRELOADEN=1 2*tCLK_APB + tSOS - - PRELOADEN=0 tSOS+7 - - tSSH SS hold after SCK Client tSIH - 4 - - tSOS MISO setup SCK Client - tSSCK/2 - 20 - tSOH MISO hold after SCK Client - 20 - tSOSS MISO setup after SS low Client - 16 - tSOSH MISO hold after SS high Client - 11 - Notes:  1. These values are based on simulation. These values are not covered by test limits in production. 2. See 32.8. I/O Pin Characteristics. 34.14.3 SERCOM in I2C Mode Timing The following table describes the requirements for devices connected to the I2C Interface Bus. Timing symbols refer to the figure below. Figure 34-9. I2C Interface Bus Timing tOF tHIGH tR tLOW tLOW SCL tSU;STA tHD;STA tHD;DAT tSU;DAT SDA tSU;STO tBUF © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 639 SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Table 34-47. I2C Interface Timing(1) Symbol Parameter tR Conditions Rise time for both SDA and Min. Typ. Max. - - 300 SCL(3) tOF Output fall time from VIHmin to VILmax (3) 10 pF < Cb(2) < 400 pF 7.0 10.0 50.0 tHD;STA Hold time (repeated) START condition fSCL > 100 kHz, Host tLOW-9 - - tLOW Low period of SCL Clock fSCL > 100 kHz 113 - - tBUF Bus free time between a STOP and a START condition fSCL > 100 kHz tLOW - - tSU;STA Setup time for a repeated START condition fSCL > 100 kHz, Host tLOW+7 - - tHD;DAT Data hold time fSCL > 100 kHz, Host 9 - 12 tSU;DAT Data setup time fSCL > 100 kHz, Host 104 - - tSU;STO Setup time for STOP condition fSCL > 100 kHz, Host tLOW+9 - - tSU;DAT;rx Data setup time (receive mode) fSCL > 100 kHz, Client 51 - 56 tHD;DAT;tx Data hold time (send mode) fSCL > 100 kHz, Client 71 90 138 Units Notes:  1. These values are based on simulation and not covered by test limits in production. 2. Cb = Capacitive load on each bus line. Otherwise noted, value of Cb set to 20 pF. 3. These values are based on characterization and not covered by test limits in production. 34.14.4 SWD Timing Figure 34-10. SWD Interface Signals Read Cycle From debugger to SWDIO pin Stop Park Tri State Thigh Tos Data Data Parity Start Tlow From debugger to SWDCLK pin SWDIO pin to debugger Tri State Acknowledge Tri State Write Cycle From debugger to SWDIO pin Stop Park Tri State Tis Start Tih From debugger to SWDCLK pin SWDIO pin to debugger Tri State © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Acknowledge Data Complete Datasheet Data Parity Tri State DS60001504F-page 640 ns SAM D20 Family AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125℃ Table 34-48. SWD Timings(1) Symbol Parameter Conditions Min. Max. Thigh SWDCLK High period VVDDIO from 3.0 V to 3.6 V, maximum external capacitor = 40 pF 10 Tlow SWDCLK Low period 10 500000 Tos SWDIO output skew to falling edge SWDCLK -5 5 Tis Input Setup time required between SWDIO 4 - Tih Input Hold time required between SWDIO and rising edge SWDCLK 1 - Units 500000 ns Note:  1. These values are based on simulation. These values are not covered by test limits in production or characterization. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 641 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 35. Packaging Information 35.1 Thermal Considerations Related Links 35.1.2. Junction Temperature 35.1.1 Thermal Resistance Data The following table summarizes the thermal resistance data for non-AEC-Q100 packages.. Table 35-1. Thermal Resistance Data for non-AEC-Q100 packages Package Type θJA θJC 32-pin TQFP 68.0°C/W 25.8°C/W 48-pin TQFP 78.8°C/W 12.3°C/W 64-pin TQFP 66.7°C/W 11.9°C/W 32-pin VQFN 37.2°C/W 13.1°C/W 48-pin VQFN 33.0°C/W 11.4°C/W 64-pin VQFN 33.5°C/W 11.2°C/W 64-ball UFBGA 67.4°C/W 12.4°C/W 45-ball WLCSP 37.0°C/W 0.36°C/W 27-ball WLCSP 84.54°C/W 16.86°C/W The following table summarizes the thermal resistance data for AEC-Q100 packages. Table 35-2. Thermal Resistance Data for AEC-Q100 packages 35.1.2 Package Type θJA θJC 64-pin TQFP 53.7 15.4 48-pin TQFP 58.6 16.1 32-pin TQFP 58.2 18.8 64-pin VQFN 28.4 12 48-pin VQFN 27.6 12.7 32-pin VQFN 29.8 15.9 Junction Temperature The average chip-junction temperature, TJ, in °C can be obtained from the following: 1. 2. TJ = TA + (PD x θJA) TJ = TA + (PD x (θHEATSINK + θJC)) where: • • • • • θJA = Package thermal resistance, Junction-to-ambient (°C/W), see Thermal Resistance Data θJC = Package thermal resistance, Junction-to-case thermal resistance (°C/W), see Thermal Resistance Data θHEATSINK = Thermal resistance (°C/W) specification of the external cooling device PD = Device power consumption (W) TA = Ambient temperature (°C) © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 642 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information From the first equation, the user can derive the estimated lifetime of the chip and decide if a cooling device is necessary or not. If a cooling device has to be fitted on the chip, the second equation should be used to compute the resulting average chip-junction temperature TJ in °C. Related Links 35.1. Thermal Considerations 35.2 Package Drawings Note:  For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http:// www.microchip.com/packaging. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 643 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 35.2.1 64-Pin TQFP for Industrial and AEC-Q100 Variants 64-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT)-10x10x1 mm Body, 2.00 mm Footprint [TQFP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D D1 D1/2 D NOTE 2 A B E1/2 E1 A E A SEE DETAIL 1 N 4X N/4 TIPS 0.20 C A-B D 1 3 2 4X NOTE 1 0.20 H A-B D TOP VIEW A2 A 0.05 C SEATING PLANE 0.08 C 64 X b 0.08 e A1 C A-B D SIDE VIEW Microchip Technology Drawing C04-085C Sheet 1 of 2 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 644 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 64-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT)-10x10x1 mm Body, 2.00 mm Footprint [TQFP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging H c  L (L1)  X=A—B OR D X SECTION A-A e/2 DETAIL 1 Notes: Units Dimension Limits Number of Leads N e Lead Pitch Overall Height A Molded Package Thickness A2 Standoff A1 Foot Length L Footprint L1  Foot Angle Overall Width E Overall Length D Molded Package Width E1 Molded Package Length D1 c Lead Thickness b Lead Width  Mold Draft Angle Top  Mold Draft Angle Bottom MIN 0.95 0.05 0.45 0° 0.09 0.17 11° 11° MILLIMETERS NOM 64 0.50 BSC 1.00 0.60 1.00 REF 3.5° 12.00 BSC 12.00 BSC 10.00 BSC 10.00 BSC 0.22 12° 12° MAX 1.20 1.05 0.15 0.75 7° 0.20 0.27 13° 13° 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Chamfers at corners are optional; size may vary. 3. Dimensions D1 and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.25mm per side. 4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-085C Sheet 2 of 2 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 645 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 64-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT)-10x10x1 mm Body, 2.00 mm Footprint [TQFP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging C1 E C2 G Y1 X1 RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits E Contact Pitch Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Width (X28) X1 Contact Pad Length (X28) Y1 Distance Between Pads G MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.50 BSC 11.40 11.40 MAX 0.30 1.50 0.20 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-2085B Sheet 1 of 1 Table 35-3. Device and Package Maximum Weight 300 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries mg Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 646 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information Table 35-4. Package Reference Package Outline Drawing MCHP reference C04-00085 JESD97 Classification E3 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 647 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 35.2.2 64-Pin VQFN for Industrial Variants 64-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (TMB) - 9x9 mm Body [VQFN] Atmel Legacy Global Package Code ZST Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging 64X 0.08 C D A 0.10 C B N 1 2 NOTE 1 E (DATUM B) (DATUM A) 2X 0.15 C 2X A1 TOP VIEW 0.15 C 0.10 (A3) C A B D2 A SEATING C PLANE SIDE VIEW 0.10 C A B E2 e 2 NOTE 1 K 2 1 N L e BOTTOM VIEW 64X b 0.10 0.05 C A B C Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21441-TMB Rev A Sheet 1 of 2 © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 648 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 64-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (TMB) - 9x9 mm Body [VQFN] Atmel Legacy Global Package Code ZST Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging Notes: Units Dimension Limits Number of Terminals N e Pitch Overall Height A Standoff A1 A3 Terminal Thickness Overall Length D Exposed Pad Length D2 Overall Width E E2 Exposed Pad Width Terminal Width b Terminal Length L Terminal-to-Exposed-Pad K MIN 0.80 0.00 4.60 4.60 0.15 0.30 0.20 MILLIMETERS NOM 64 0.50 BSC 0.90 0.02 0.203 REF 9.00 BSC 4.70 9.00 BSC 4.70 0.20 0.40 - MAX 1.00 0.05 4.80 4.80 0.25 0.55 - 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Package is saw singulated 3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21441-TMB Rev A Sheet 2 of 2 © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 649 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 64-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (TMB) - 9x9 mm Body [VQFN] Atmel Legacy Global Package Code ZST Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging C1 X2 EV 64 1 2 ØV G2 C2 Y2 EV Y1 G1 X1 SILK SCREEN E RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits E Contact Pitch Optional Center Pad Width X2 Optional Center Pad Length Y2 Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Width (X64) X1 Contact Pad Length (X64) Y1 Contact Pad to Center Pad (X64) G1 Contact Pad to Contact Pad (X60) G2 Thermal Via Diameter V Thermal Via Pitch EV MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.50 BSC MAX 4.80 4.80 8.90 8.90 0.30 0.90 1.60 0.20 0.30 1.00 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. 2. For best soldering results, thermal vias, if used, should be filled or tented to avoid solder loss during reflow process Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21441-TMB Rev A Sheet 1 of 2 Note:  The exposed die attach pad is not connected electrically inside the device. © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 650 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information Table 35-5. Device and Package Maximum Weight 200 mg Table 35-6. Package Reference Package Outline Drawing MCHP reference C04-21441 JESD97 Classification E3 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 651 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 35.2.3 64 pin VQFN for AEC-Q100 Variants 64-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (5LX) - 9x9x1.0 mm Body [VQFN] With 5.4 mm Exposed Pad and Stepped Wettable Flanks Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging 64X 0.08 C D NOTE 1 A 0.10 C B N 1 2 E (DATUM B) (DATUM A) 2X 0.10 C 2X 0.10 A1 TOP VIEW 0.10 C (A3) A C A B SEATING C PLANE D2 SIDE VIEW (K) 0.10 A C A B A E2 e 2 A4 NOTE 1 2 1 D3 SECTION A-A N L e BOTTOM VIEW 64X b 0.10 0.05 STEPPED WETTABLE FLANK C A B C Microchip Technology Drawing C04-483 Rev D Sheet 1 of 2 © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 652 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 64-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (5LX) - 9x9x1.0 mm Body [VQFN] With 5.4 mm Exposed Pad and Stepped Wettable Flanks Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging Notes: Units Dimension Limits Number of Terminals N e Pitch Overall Height A Standoff A1 Terminal Thickness A3 Overall Length D Exposed Pad Length D2 Overall Width E Exposed Pad Width E2 b Terminal Width Terminal Length L Terminal-to-Exposed-Pad K D3 Wettable Flank Step Length Wettable Flank Step Height A4 MILLIMETERS NOM MAX 64 0.50 BSC 0.90 0.80 1.00 0.02 0.00 0.05 0.203 REF 9.00 BSC 5.30 5.40 5.50 9.00 BSC 5.40 5.30 5.50 0.25 0.20 0.30 0.40 0.30 0.50 1.40 REF 0.035 0.060 0.085 0.10 0.19 MIN 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Package is saw singulated 3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-483 Rev D Sheet 2 of 2 © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 653 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 64-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (5LX) - 9x9x1.0 mm Body [VQFN] With 5.4 mm Exposed Pad and Stepped Wettable Flanks Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging C1 X2 EV 64 1 2 ØV G2 C2 Y2 EV G1 Y1 X1 SILK SCREEN E RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits E Contact Pitch Optional Center Pad Width X2 Optional Center Pad Length Y2 Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Width (X64) X1 Contact Pad Length (X64) Y1 Contact Pad to Center Pad (X64) G1 Contact Pad to Contact Pad (X60) G2 Thermal Via Diameter V Thermal Via Pitch EV MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.50 BSC MAX 8.90 8.90 5.50 5.50 0.30 0.85 1.28 0.20 0.33 1.20 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. 2. For best soldering results, thermal vias, if used, should be filled or tented to avoid solder loss during reflow process Microchip Technology Drawing C04-2483 Rev D Table 35-7. Device and Package Maximum Weight © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 200 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries mg Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 654 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information Table 35-8. Package Reference Package Outline Drawing MCHP reference C04-00483 JESD97 Classification E3 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 655 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 35.2.4 64-ball UFBGA 64-Ball Ultra Thin Fine-Pitch Ball Grid Array Package (BQB) - 5x5x0.65 mm Body [UFBGA]; Atmel Legacy Global Package Code CAH Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging 64X 0.10 C D A 0.10 C 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 B A B C D E E F G H 2X 0.10 C 2X A1 TOP VIEW 0.10 C (S) (M) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 SEATING PLANE 8 A C END VIEW H G e 2 F E E2 D C B A NOTE 1 e D2 BOTTOM VIEW 64X Øb 0.15 0.05 C A B C Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21153 Rev A Sheet 1 of 2 © 2020 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 656 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 64-Ball Ultra Thin Fine-Pitch Ball Grid Array Package (BQB) - 5x5x0.65 mm Body [UFBGA]; Atmel Legacy Global Package Code CAH Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging Units Dimension Limits Number of Terminals N e Pitch Overall Height A Ball Height A1 Mold Thickness M Substrate Thickness S Overall Length D Ball Array Length D2 Overall Width E Ball Array Width E2 b Ball Width MIN – 0.14 0.20 MILLIMETERS NOM 64 0.50 BSC – 0.19 0.25 REF 1.36 REF 5.00 BSC 3.50 BSC 5.00 BSC 3.50 BSC 0.25 MAX 0.65 0.24 0.3 Notes: 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21153 Rev A Sheet 2 of 2 © 2020 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 657 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 64-Ball Ultra Thin Fine-Pitch Ball Grid Array Package (BQB) - 5x5x0.65 mm Body [UFBGA]; Atmel Legacy Global Package Code CAH Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 A B G C D C2 E F G H SILK SCREEN ØX E C1 RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits Contact Pitch E Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Width (Xnn) X Contact Pad to Contact Pad (Xnn) G MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.50 BSC 3.50 BSC 3.50 BSC MAX 0.20 0.30 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-23153 Rev A © 2020 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 658 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information Table 35-9. Device and Package Maximum Weight 27.4 mg Table 35-10. Package Reference Package Outline Drawing MCHP reference C04-21153 JESD97 Classification E8 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 659 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 35.2.5 48-Pin TQFP for Industrial and AEC-Q100 Variants 48-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (Y8) - 7x7x1.0 mm Body [TQFP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D D1 D1 2 D 2 D E1 2 A B E E1 A NOTE 1 A E 2 N N/4 TIPS 0.20 C A-B D 1 2 3 0.20 C A-B D 4X e 2 e TOP VIEW C SEATING PLANE A A2 48X A1 48X b 0.08 0.08 C C A-B D SIDE VIEW Microchip Technology Drawing C04-300-Y8 Rev D Sheet 1 of 2 © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 660 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 48-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (Y8) - 7x7x1.0 mm Body [TQFP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging ϴ2 ϴ1 R2 H R1 ϴ2 c ϴ L (L1) SECTION A-A Notes: Number of Terminals Pitch Overall Height Standoff Molded Package Thickness Overall Length Molded Package Length Overall Width Molded Package Width Terminal Width Terminal Thickness Terminal Length Footprint Lead Bend Radius Lead Bend Radius Foot Angle Lead Angle Mold Draft Angle Units Dimension Limits N e A A1 A2 D D1 E E1 b c L L1 R1 R2 ϴ ϴ1 ϴ2 MIN 0.05 0.95 0.17 0.09 0.45 0.08 0.08 0° 0° 11° MILLIMETERS NOM 48 0.50 BSC 1.00 9.00 BSC 7.00 BSC 9.00 BSC 7.00 BSC 0.22 0.60 1.00 REF 3.5° 12° MAX 1.20 0.15 1.05 0.27 0.16 0.75 0.20 7° 13° 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-300-Y8 Rev D Sheet 2 of 2 © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 661 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 48-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (Y8) - 7x7x1.0 mm Body [TQFP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging C1 G C2 SILK SCREEN 48 Y1 1 2 X1 E RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits E Contact Pitch Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Width (X48) X1 Contact Pad Length (X48) Y1 Distance Between Pads G MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.50 BSC 8.40 8.40 MAX 0.30 1.50 0.20 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. 2. For best soldering results, thermal vias, if used, should be filled or tented to avoid solder loss during reflow process Microchip Technology Drawing C04-2300-Y8 Rev D Table 35-11. Device and Package © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. Maximum Weight 140 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries mg Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 662 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information Table 35-12. Package Reference Package Outline Drawing MCHP reference C04-00300 JESD97 Classification E3 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 663 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 35.2.6 48-Pin VQFN for Industrial Variants 48-Lead Very Thin Quad Flat Pack No-Leads (T3B) 7x7x0.9 mm [VQFN] With 5.15x5.15 mm Exposed Pad; Atmel Legacy Global Package Code ZLG Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging A1 48X 0.08 C D NOTE 1 A 0.08 C B N 1 2 E (DATUM B) (DATUM A) 2X 0.15 C 2X TOP VIEW 0.15 C (A3) 0.10 C A B D2 A SEATING C PLANE SIDE VIEW E2 e 2 2 1 NOTE 1 0.10 C A B N L e BOTTOM VIEW 48X b 0.10 0.05 C A B C Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21425 Rev A Sheet 1 of 2 © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 664 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 48-Lead Very Thin Quad Flat Pack No-Leads (T3B) 7x7x0.9 mm [VQFN] With 5.15x5.15 mm Exposed Pad; Atmel Legacy Global Package Code ZLG Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging Notes: Units Dimension Limits Number of Terminals N e Pitch Overall Height A Standoff A1 A3 Terminal Thickness Overall Length D Exposed Pad Length D2 Overall Width E E2 Exposed Pad Width Terminal Width b Terminal Length L Terminal-to-Exposed-Pad K MIN 0.80 0.00 5.05 5.05 0.18 0.30 0.20 MILLIMETERS NOM 48 0.50 BSC 0.85 0.02 0.20 REF 7.00 BSC 5.15 7.00 BSC 5.15 0.25 0.40 - MAX 0.90 0.05 5.25 5.25 0.30 0.50 - 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Package is saw singulated 3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21425 Rev A Sheet 2 of 2 © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 665 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 48-Lead Very Thin Quad Flat Pack No-Leads (T3B) 7x7x0.9 mm [VQFN] With 5.15x5.15 mm Exposed Pad; Atmel Legacy Global Package Code ZLG Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging C1 X2 EV 48 1 2 ØV C2 Y2 G2 EV G1 Y1 X1 SILK SCREEN E RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits E Contact Pitch Optional Center Pad Width X2 Optional Center Pad Length Y2 Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Width (X20) X1 Contact Pad Length (X20) Y1 Contact Pad to Center Pad (X48) G1 Contact Pad to Contact Pad (X44) G2 Thermal Via Diameter V Thermal Via Pitch EV MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.50 BSC MAX 5.15 5.15 6.90 6.90 0.30 0.90 0.20 0.20 0.33 1.20 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. 2. For best soldering results, thermal vias, if used, should be filled or tented to avoid solder loss during reflow process Microchip Technology Drawing C04-23425 Rev A Note:  The exposed die attach pad is not connected electrically inside the device. © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 666 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information Table 35-13. Device and Package Maximum Weight 140 mg Table 35-14. Package Reference Package Outline Drawing MCHP reference C04-21425 JESD97 Classification E3 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 667 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 35.2.7 48 pin VQFN for AEC-Q100 Variants 48-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (U5B) - 7x7 mm Body [VQFN] With 5.15 mm Exposed Pad and Stepped Wettable Flanks; Atmel Legacy ZLH Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging 48X 0.08 C D A 0.10 C D 4 B N E 4 1 2 NOTE 1 E (DATUM B) (DATUM A) 2X 0.10 C 2X TOP VIEW 0.10 C A1 0.10 C A B (A3) D2 A SEATING C PLANE 0.10 C A B DETAIL A SIDE VIEW A A E2 A4 e 2 2 1 D3 SECTION A-A N (K) L e BOTTOM VIEW 48X b 0.10 0.05 C A B C Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21493 Rev A Sheet 1 of 2 © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 668 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 48-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (U5B) - 7x7 mm Body [VQFN] With 5.15 mm Exposed Pad and Stepped Wettable Flanks; Atmel Legacy ZLH Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging DETAIL 1 ALTERNATE TERMINAL CONFIGURATIONS Notes: Units Dimension Limits N Number of Terminals e Pitch Overall Height A Standoff A1 Terminal Thickness A3 Overall Length D Exposed Pad Length D2 E Overall Width Exposed Pad Width E2 b Terminal Width L Terminal Length Terminal-to-Exposed-Pad K D3 Wettable Flank Step Length Wettable Flank Step Height A4 MIN 0,80 0.00 5.05 5.05 0.20 0.35 0.10 MILLIMETERS NOM MAX 48 0.50 BSC 0.85 0.90 0.02 0.05 0.203 REF 7.00 BSC 5.15 5.25 7.00 BSC 5.15 5.25 0.25 0.30 0.40 0.45 0.53 REF 0.085 0.19 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Package is saw singulated 3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21493 Rev A Sheet 2 of 2 © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 669 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 48-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (U5B) - 7x7 mm Body [VQFN] With 5.15 mm Exposed Pad and Stepped Wettable Flanks; Atmel Legacy ZLH Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging C1 X2 EV 48 1 ØV 2 G2 C2 Y2 EV G1 Y1 X1 SILK SCREEN E RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits E Contact Pitch Optional Center Pad Width X2 Optional Center Pad Length Y2 Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Width (X48) X1 Contact Pad Length (X48) Y1 Contact Pad to Center Pad (X48) G1 Contact Pad to Center Pad (X44) G2 Thermal Via Diameter V Thermal Via Pitch EV MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.50 BSC MAX 5.25 5.25 6.90 6.90 0.30 0.85 0.20 0.40 0.30 1.00 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. 2. For best soldering results, thermal vias, if used, should be filled or tented to avoid solder loss during reflow process Microchip Technology Drawing C04-23493 Rev A Table 35-15. Device and Package © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. Maximum Weight 140 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries mg Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 670 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information Table 35-16. Package Reference Package Outline Drawing MCHP reference C04-21493 JESD97 Classification E3 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 671 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 45-ball WLCSP 45-Ball Wafer Level Chip Scale Package (FSB) - 2.944x2.699 mm Body [WLCSP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D A B NOTE 1 (DATUM A) E (DATUM B) 2X 0.03 C 2X 0.03 C C SEATING PLANE TOP VIEW SEE DETAIL A A SIDE VIEW D1 45X Øb 0.15 0.05 e E1 C A B C e 35.2.8 NOTE 1 e 2 e BOTTOM VIEW Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21247 Rev A Sheet 1 of 2 © 2017 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 672 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 45-Ball Wafer Level Chip Scale Package (FSB) - 2.944x2.699 mm Body [WLCSP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging (A3) 0.10 C A2 A1 45X 0.075 C DETAIL A Number of Terminals Pitch Overall Height Bump Height Die Thickness Backside Coating Overall Length Overall Bump Pitch Overall Width Overall Bump Pitch Terminal Width Units Dimension Limits N e A A1 A2 A3 D D1 E E1 b MILLIMETERS NOM MAX 45 0.40 BSC 0.483 0.17 0.20 0.23 0.178 0.203 0.228 0.04 REF 2.944 BSC 2.40 2.699 BSC 2.079 BSC 0.23 0.26 0.29 MIN Notes: 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Package is saw singulated 3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21247 Rev A Sheet 2 of 2 © 2017 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 673 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 45-Ball Wafer Level Chip Scale Package (FSB) - 2.944x2.699 mm Body [WLCSP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging ØX E C1 E SILK SCREEN C2 RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits Contact Pitch E Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Diameter (X45) X MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.40 BSC 2.079 BSC 2.40 BSC 0.26 MAX Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-23247 Rev A Table 35-17. Device and Package Maximum Weight © 2017 Microchip Technology Inc. 7.3 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries mg Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 674 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information Table 35-18. Package Reference Package Outline Drawing MCHP reference C04-21247 JESD97 Classification E1 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 675 R SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 35.2.9 32-Pin TQFP for Industrial and AEC-Q100 Variants 32-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT) - 7x7x1.0 mm Body [TQFP] 2.00 mm Footprint; Also Atmel Legacy Global Package Code AUT Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D D1 D 32X TIPS 0.20 C A-B D A B E1 A E A N NOTE 1 1 2 4X 0.20 H A-B D 32X b 0.20 e C A-B D TOP VIEW C SEATING PLANE 0.10 C A A2 32X 0.10 C A1 SIDE VIEW Microchip Technology Drawing C04-074 Rev C Sheet 1 of 2 © 2017 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 676 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 32-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT) - 7x7x1.0 mm Body [TQFP] 2.00 mm Footprint; Also Atmel Legacy Global Package Code AUT Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging H  L (L1) SECTION A-A Notes: Units Dimension Limits N Number of Leads e Lead Pitch A Overall Height A1 Standoff Molded Package Thickness A2 Foot Length L Footprint L1 Foot Angle  E Overall Width D Overall Length Molded Package Width E1 Molded Package Length D1 b Lead Width Mold Draft Angle Top MIN 0.05 0.95 0.45 0° 0.30 11° MILLIMETERS NOM 32 0.80 BSC 1.00 0.60 1.00 REF 9.00 BSC 9.00 BSC 7.00 BSC 7.00 BSC 0.37 - MAX 1.20 0.15 1.05 0.75 7° 0.45 13° 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-074 Rev C Sheet 2 of 2 © 2017 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 677 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 32-Lead Thin Plastic Quad Flatpack (PT) - 7x7 mm Body [TQFP] 2.00 mm Footprint; Also Atmel Legacy Global Package Code AUT Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging C1 G C2 Y X SILK SCREEN E RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits E Contact Pitch Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Width (Xnn) X Contact Pad Length (Xnn) Y Contact Pad to Contact Pad (Xnn) G MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.80 BSC 8.40 8.40 MAX 0.55 1.55 0.25 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-2074 Rev C Table 35-19. Device and Package Maximum Weight © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 100 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries mg Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 678 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information Table 35-20. Package Reference Package Outline Drawing MCHP reference C04-00074 JESD97 Classification E3 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 679 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 35.2.10 32-Pin VQFN for Industrial Variants 32-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (S8B) - 5x5 mm Body [VQFN] With 3.60 mm Exposed Pad; Atmel Legacy Global Package Code ZKV Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging 32X 0.08 C D NOTE 1 A 0.10 C B N 1 2 E (DATUM B) (DATUM A) 2X 0.15 C 2X A1 TOP VIEW 0.15 C (A3) 0.10 C A B A SEATING C PLANE D2 0.10 C A B SIDE VIEW E2 e 2 K 2 1 NOTE 1 N L e 32X b 0.10 0.05 C A B C BOTTOM VIEW Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21402 Rev A Sheet 1 of 2 © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 680 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 32-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (S8B) - 5x5 mm Body [VQFN] With 3.60 mm Exposed Pad; Atmel Legacy Global Package Code ZKV Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging Notes: Units Dimension Limits Number of Terminals N e Pitch Overall Height A Standoff A1 A3 Terminal Thickness Overall Length D Exposed Pad Length D2 Overall Width E E2 Exposed Pad Width Terminal Width b Terminal Length L Terminal-to-Exposed-Pad K MIN 0.80 0.00 3.50 3.50 0.18 0.30 0.20 MILLIMETERS NOM 32 0.50 BSC 0.90 0.02 0.20 REF 5.00 BSC 3.60 5.00 BSC 3.60 0.25 0.40 - MAX 1.00 0.05 3.70 3.70 0.30 0.50 - 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Package is saw singulated 3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21402 Rev A Sheet 1 of 2 © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 681 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 32-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (S8B) - 5x5 mm Body [VQFN] With 3.60 mm Exposed Pad; Atmel Legacy Global Package Code ZKV Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging C1 X2 EV 32 1 2 C2 Y2 ØV G2 EV G1 Y1 X1 SILK SCREEN E RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits E Contact Pitch Optional Center Pad Width X2 Optional Center Pad Length Y2 Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Width (X32) X1 Contact Pad Length (X32) Y1 Contact Pad to Center Pad (X32) G1 Contact Pad to Contact Pad (X28) G2 Thermal Via Diameter V Thermal Via Pitch EV MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.50 BSC MAX 3.70 3.70 5.00 5.00 0.30 0.85 0.23 0.20 0.30 1.00 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. 2. For best soldering results, thermal vias, if used, should be filled or tented to avoid solder loss during reflow process Microchip Technology Drawing C04-23402 Rev A Note:  The exposed die attach pad is connected inside the device to GND and GNDANA. © 2018 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 682 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information Table 35-21. Device and Package Maximum Weight 90 mg Table 35-22. Package Reference Package Outline Drawing MCHP reference C04-21402 JESD97 Classification E3 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 683 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 35.2.11 32 pin VQFN for AEC-Q100 Variants 32-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (RTB) - 5x5 mm Body [VQFN] With 3.6x3.6 mm Exposed Pad and Stepped Wettable Flanks; Atmel Legacy ZBS Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D NOTE 1 A B N 1 2 E (DATUM B) (DATUM A) 2X 0.10 C 2X TOP VIEW 0.10 C C SEATING PLANE A1 0.10 C A 32X (A3) 0.08 C SIDE VIEW 0.10 C A B D2 A4 DETAIL A D3 A A E2 e 2 SECTION A–A PARTIALLY PLATED K 2 1 NOTE 1 0.10 C A B N L e BOTTOM VIEW 32X b 0.10 0.05 C A B C Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21391 Rev E Sheet 1 of 2 © 2017 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 684 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 32-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (RTB) - 5x5 mm Body [VQFN] With 3.6x3.6 mm Exposed Pad and Stepped Wettable Flanks; Atmel Legacy ZBS Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging DETAIL 1 ALTERNATE TERMINAL CONFIGURATIONS Units Dimension Limits Number of Terminals N e Pitch Overall Height A Standoff A1 A3 Terminal Thickness Overall Length D Exposed Pad Length D2 Overall Width E Exposed Pad Width E2 b Terminal Width Terminal Length L Terminal-to-Exposed-Pad K D3 Wettable Flank Step Cut Width Wettable Flank Step Cut Depth A4 MIN 0.80 0.00 3.50 3.50 0.20 0.35 0.20 0.10 MILLIMETERS NOM MAX 32 0.50 BSC 0.90 1.00 0.035 0.05 0.203 REF 5.00 BSC 3.60 3.70 5.00 BSC 3.60 3.70 0.25 0.30 0.40 0.45 0.085 0.19 Dimensions D3 and A4 above apply to all new products released after November 1, and all products shipped after January 1, 2019, and supersede dimensions D3 and A4 below. No physical changes are being made to any package; this update is to align cosmetic and tolerance variations from existing suppliers. Notes: Wettable Flank Step Length Wettable Flank Step Height D3 A4 0.035 0.10 0.06 - 0.085 0.19 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Package is saw singulated 3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21391 Rev E Sheet 2 of 2 © 2017 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 685 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 32-Lead Very Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (RTB) - 5x5 mm Body [VQFN] With 3.6x3.6 mm Exposed Pad and Stepped Wettable Flanks; Atmel Legacy ZBS Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging C1 X2 EV 32 G1 1 ØV 2 CH C2 G2 Y2 EV X1 X1 SILK SCREEN E RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits E Contact Pitch Optional Center Pad Width X2 Optional Center Pad Length Y2 Exposed Pad 45° Corner Chamfer CH Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Width (X32) X1 Contact Pad Length (X32) Y1 Contact Pad to Center Pad (X32) G1 Contact Pad to Contact Pad (X28) G2 Thermal Via Diameter V Thermal Via Pitch EV MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.50 BSC MAX 3.70 3.70 0.25 5.00 5.00 0.30 0.80 0.25 0.20 0.30 1.00 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. 2. For best soldering results, thermal vias, if used, should be filled or tented to avoid solder loss during reflow process Microchip Technology Drawing C04-23391 Rev. E Table 35-23. Device and Package Maximum Weight © 2017 Microchip Technology Inc. 90 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries mg Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 686 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information Table 35-24. Package Reference Package Outline Drawing MCHP reference C04-21391 JESD97 Classification E3 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 687 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 35.2.12 27-ball WLCSP 27-Ball Wafer Level Chip Scale Package (CS) - 2.199x2.215x0.483 mm Body [WLCSP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D 27X A 0.05 C D 4 1 E 4 0.06 C 3 2 4 5 6 7 8 9 B A B NOTE1 C E D (DATUM B) (DATUM A) E 2X F 0.03 C 2X A1 TOP VIEW 0.03 C A2 eD 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 A3 8 9 A SEATING C PLANE e F E SIDE VIEW e5 D eE C B e2 A NOTE 1 e e3 e4 27X Øb 0.015 0.007 C A B C BOTTOM VIEW Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21517 Rev C Sheet 1 of 2 © 2020 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 688 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 27-Ball Wafer Level Chip Scale Package (CS) - 2.199x2.215x0.483 mm Body [WLCSP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging Notes: Units Dimension Limits Number of Terminals N e Terminal Pitch Terminal Pitch e2 e3 Terminal Pitch e4 Terminal Offset e5 Terminal Offset Overall Terminal itch eD eE Overall Terminal Pitch A Overall Height Standoff A1 A3 Terminal Thickness Overall Length D E Overall Width b Ball Width MILLIMETERS NOM MAX 27 0.40 BSC 0.35 BSC 0.20 BSC 0.191 BSC 0.177 BSC 1.60 BSC 1.73 BSC 0.403 0.443 0.483 0.17 – 0.23 0.036 0.044 0.040 2.199 BSC 2.215 BSC 0.24 – 0.30 MIN 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Package is saw singulated 3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-21517 Rev C Sheet 2 of 2 © 2020 Microchip Technology Inc. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 689 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information 27-Ball Wafer Level Chip Scale Package (CS) - 2.199x2.215x0.483 mm Body [WLCSP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging C1 G 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B EDGE OF PACKAGE E5 C C2 ℄ CENTER OF PACKAGE D E E2 F SILK SCREEN E3 X E E4 ℄ CENTER OF PACKAGE RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits E Contact Pitch E2 Contact Pitch E3 Contact Pitch Contact Offset E4 E5 Contact Offset Contact Diameter X Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad to Contact Pad (Xnn) G2 MILLIMETERS NOM 0.40 BSC 0.35 BSC 0.20 BSC 0.191 BSC 0.169BSC MIN MAX 0.24 1.60 BSC 1.73 BSC 0.16 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. 2. Ball pattern is not centered on the package. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-23517 Rev C Table 35-25. Device and Package © 2020 Microchip Technology Inc. Maximum Weight 3.9 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries mg Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 690 SAM D20 Family Packaging Information Table 35-26. Package Reference 35.3 Package Outline Drawing MCHP reference C04-21517 JESD97 Classification E1 Soldering Profile The following table gives the recommended soldering profile from J-STD-20. Table 35-27. Recommended Soldering Profile Profile Feature Green Package Average Ramp-up Rate (217°C to peak) 3°C/s max. Preheat Temperature 175°C ±25°C 150-200°C Time Maintained Above 217°C 60-150s Time within 5°C of Actual Peak Temperature 30s Peak Temperature Range 260°C Ramp-down Rate 6°C/s max. Time 25°C to Peak Temperature 8 minutes max. A maximum of three reflow passes is allowed per component. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 691 SAM D20 Family Schematic Checklist 36. Schematic Checklist 36.1 Introduction This chapter describes a common checklist which should be used when starting and reviewing the schematics for a SAM D20 design. This chapter illustrates a recommended power supply connection, how to connect external analog references, programmer, debugger, oscillator and crystal. 36.1.1 Operation in Noisy Environment If the device is operating in an environment with much electromagnetic noise it must be protected from this noise to ensure reliable operation. In addition to following best practice EMC design guidelines, the recommendations listed in the schematic checklist sections must be followed. In particular placing decoupling capacitors very close to the power pins, a RC-filter on the RESET pin, and a pull-up resistor on the SWCLK pin is critical for reliable operations. It is also relevant to eliminate or attenuate noise in order to avoid that it reaches supply pins, I/O pins and crystals. 36.2 Power Supply The SAM D20 supports a single power supply from 1.62V - 3.63V. 36.2.1 Power Supply Connections Figure 36-1. Power Supply Schematic (1) 1.62V-3.63V Close to device (for every pin) VDDANA 100nF 10µF GNDANA VDDIO 100nF VDDIN (2) (2) (2) VDDCORE 1µF GND Notes:  1. VDDANA and VDDIO were shorted during characterization and a Ferrite bead was not used. 2. Not all capacitors are required. Refer to electrical characteristics tables 32.17 and 34.15 to know which capacitors are mandatory and their values. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 692 SAM D20 Family Schematic Checklist Table 36-1. Power Supply Connections, VDDCORE From Internal Regulator Signal Name Recommended Pin Connection Description VDDIO Digital supply voltage 1.62V - 3.63V Decoupling/filtering capacitors 100nF(1)(2) and 10μF(1) Decoupling/filtering inductor 10μH(1)(3) VDDIN 1.62V - 3.63V Decoupling/filtering capacitors: Core supply voltage cf electrical characteristics tables 32.17 and 34.15 to know which capacitors are mandatory and their values. VDDANA 1.62V - 3.63V Decoupling/filtering capacitors 100nF(1)(2) and 10μF(1) Analog supply voltage Ferrite bead(4) prevents the VDD noise interfering the VDDANA VDDCORE 1.6V to 1.8V Decoupling/filtering capacitor 1μF(1)(2) Core supply voltage / external decoupling pin GND Ground GNDANA Ground for the analog power domain Notes:  1. These values are only given as typical examples. 2. Decoupling capacitor should be placed close to the device for each supply pin pair in the signal group, low ESR caps should be used for better decoupling. 3. An inductor should be added between the external power and the VDD for power filtering. 4. Ferrite bead has better filtering performance than the common inductor at high frequencies. It can be added between VDD and VDDANA for preventing digital noise from entering the analog power domain. The bead should provide enough impedance (e.g. 50Ω at 20MHz and 220Ω at 100MHz) for separating the digital power from the analog power domain. Make sure to select a ferrite bead designed for filtering applications with a low DC resistance to avoid a large voltage drop across the ferrite bead. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 693 SAM D20 Family Schematic Checklist 36.3 External Analog Reference Connections The following schematic checklist is only necessary if the application is using one or more of the external analog references. If the internal references are used instead, the following circuits are not necessary. Figure 36-2. External Analog Reference Schematic With Two References Close to device (for every pin) 4.7μF 100nF 4.7μF 100nF Figure 36-3. External Analog Reference Schematic With One Reference Close to device (for every pin) VREFA EXTERNAL REFERENCE 4.7μF 100nF GND VREFB 100nF GND Table 36-2. External Analog Reference Connections Signal Name Recommended Pin Connection Description VREFx 1.0V to VDDANA - 0.6V for ADC External reference from VREFx pin on the analog port 1.0V to VDDANA- 0.6V for DAC Decoupling/filtering capacitors 100nF(1)(2) and 4.7μF(1) GND 1. 2. Ground These values are given as a typical example. Decoupling capacitor should be placed close to the device for each supply pin pair in the signal group. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 694 SAM D20 Family Schematic Checklist 36.4 External Reset Circuit The external Reset circuit is connected to the RESET pin when the external Reset function is used. The circuit is not necessary when the RESET pin is not driven low externally by the application circuitry. The reset switch can also be removed, if a manual reset is not desired. The RESET pin itself has an internal pull-up resistor, hence it is optional to add any external pull-up resistor. A pull-up resistor makes sure that the reset does not go low and unintentionally cause a device reset. An additional resistor has been added in series with the switch to safely discharge the filtering capacitor, that is, preventing a current surge when shorting the filtering capacitor, which again can cause a noise spike that can have a negative effect on the system. Figure 36-4. External Reset Circuit Schematic VDD 2.2k Ω 330Ω 100pF RESET GND Figure 36-5. External Reset Circuit Schematic (EFT Immunity Enhancement) VDD 2.2kΩ 330Ω 100pF RESET GND Note:  This reset circuit is intended to improve EFT immunity, but does not filter low-frequency glitches, which makes it not suitable as an example for applications requiring debouncing on a reset button. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 695 SAM D20 Family Schematic Checklist Table 36-3. Reset Circuit Connections Signal Name Recommended Pin Connection Description RESET Reset pin Reset low-level threshold voltage VDDIO = 1.6V - 2.0V: Below 0.33 * VDDIOVDDIO = 2.7V - 3.6V: Below 0.36 * VDDIODecoupling/filter capacitor 100 pF(1)Pull-up resistor 2.2 kΩ(1)(2)Resistor in series with the switch 330Ω(1) 1. 2. 36.5 These values are given as a typical example. The SAM D20 features an internal pull-up resistor on the RESET pin, hence an external pull-up is optional. Clocks and Crystal Oscillators The SAM D20 can be run from internal or external clock sources, or a mix of internal and external sources. An example of usage will be to use the internal 8MHz oscillator as source for the system clock, and an external 32.768kHz watch crystal as clock source for the Real-Time counter (RTC). 36.5.1 External Clock Source Figure 36-6. External Clock Source Example Schematic External Clock XIN XOUT/GPIO NC/GPIO Table 36-4. External Clock Source Connections 36.5.2 Signal Name Recommended Pin Connection Description XIN XIN is used as input for an external clock signal Input for inverting oscillator pin XOUT/GPIO Can be left unconnected or used as normal GPIO Crystal Oscillator Figure 36-7. Crystal Oscillator Example Schematic XIN CLEXT XOUT CLEXT The crystal should be located as close to the device as possible. Long signal lines may cause a load too high to operate the crystal, and cause crosstalk to other parts of the system. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 696 SAM D20 Family Schematic Checklist Table 36-5. Crystal Oscillator Checklist Signal Name Description (1)(2) XIN Load capacitor CLEXT XOUT Load capacitor CLEXT(1)(2) 1. 2. 36.5.3 Recommended Pin Connection External crystal between 0.4 to 30 MHz Use the equation in Crystal Oscillator Characteristics to calculate CLEXT. Decoupling capacitor should be placed close to the device for each supply pin pair in the signal group. External Real Time Oscillator The low-frequency crystal oscillator is optimized for use with a 32.768 kHz watch crystal. When selecting crystals, load capacitance and crystal’s Equivalent Series Resistance (ESR) must be considered. Both of these values are specified by the crystal vendor. The SAM D20 oscillator is optimized for very low-power consumption, hence the user must pay close attention while selecting crystals. Refer to the table below for maximum ESR recommendations on 9 pF and 12.5 pF crystals. The low-frequency crystal oscillator provides an internal load capacitance of typical values available in Table 32 kHz Crystal Oscillator Characteristics. This internal load capacitance and PCB capacitance can use a crystal inferior to 12.5 pF load capacitance without external capacitors as shown in the following figure. Table 36-6. Maximum ESR Recommendation for 32.768 kHz Crystal Crystal CL (pF) Maximum ESR [kΩ] 12.5 313 Note: Maximum ESR is typical value based on characterization. These values are not covered by test limits in production. Figure 36-8. External Real Time Oscillator without Load Capacitor XIN32 32.768kHz XOUT32 However, to improve crystal accuracy and safety factor, it has been recommended to add external capacitors as shown in the figure below. To find suitable load capacitance for a 32.768 kHz crystal, refer to the crystal data sheet. Figure 36-9. External Real Time Oscillator with Load Capacitor XIN32 CLEXT 32.768kHz XOUT32 CLEXT Table 36-7. External Real Time Oscillator Checklist Signal Name Recommended Pin Connection Description XIN32 Load capacitor CLEXT(1)(2) Timer oscillator input © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 697 SAM D20 Family Schematic Checklist ...........continued Signal Name Recommended Pin Connection Description XOUT32 Load capacitor CLEXT(1)(2) Timer oscillator output 1. 2. Use the equation in Crystal Oscillator Characteristics to calculate CLEXT. Decoupling capacitor must be placed close to the device for each supply pin pair in the signal group. Note:  To minimize the cycle-to-cycle jitter of the external oscillator, keep the neighboring pins as steady as possible. For neighboring pin details, refer to the Oscillator Pinout section. 36.5.4 Calculating the Correct Crystal Decoupling Capacitor To calculate correct load capacitor for a given crystal, refer to Oscillator Characteristics for parasitic load capacitance values and equation to calculate CLEXT. 36.6 Unused or Unconnected Pins For unused pins, the default state of the pins will give the lowest current leakage. Therefore, no need to configure unused pins to lower the power consumption. 36.7 Programming and Debug Ports For programming and/or debugging the SAM D20 the device should be connected using the Serial Wire Debug, SWD, interface. Currently the SWD interface is supported by several Microchip and third party programmers and debuggers, like the JTAGICE3, SAM-ICE, ATMEL_ICE or SAM D20 Xplained Pro ( SAM D20 evaluation kit) Embedded Debugger. Refer to the JTAGICE3, SAM-ICE, ATMEL_ICE or SAM D20 Xplained Pro user guides for details on debugging and programming connections and options. For connecting to any other programming or debugging tool, refer to that specific programmer or debugger’s user guide. The SAM D20 Xplained Pro evaluation board for the SAM D20 supports programming and debugging through the onboard embedded debugger so no external programmer or debugger is needed. Note that a pull-up resistor on the SWCLK pin is critical for reliable operations. Refer to related link for more information. Figure 36-10. SWCLK Circuit Connections VDD 1kΩ SWCLK © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 698 SAM D20 Family Schematic Checklist Table 36-8. SWCLK Circuit Connections Pin Name Description Recommended Pin Connection SWCLK Serial wire clock pin Pull-up resistor 1kΩ Related Links 36.1.1. Operation in Noisy Environment 36.7.1 Cortex Debug Connector (10-pin) For debuggers and/or programmers that support the Cortex Debug Connector (10-pin) interface the signals should be connected as shown in the figure below with details described in the next table. Figure 36-11. Cortex Debug Connector (10-pin) VDD Cortex Debug Connector (10-pin) VTref 1 SWDIO GND SWDCLK GND NC NC NC NC nRESET RESET SWCLK SWDIO GND Table 36-9. Cortex Debug Connector (10-pin) Header Signal Name Description Recommended Pin Connection SWDCLK Serial wire clock pin Pull-up resistor 1kΩ SWDIO Serial wire bidirectional data pin RESET Target device reset pin, active low Refer to 36.4. External Reset Circuit. 36.7.2 VTref Target voltage sense, should be connected to the device VDD GND Ground 10-pin JTAGICE3 Compatible Serial Wire Debug Interface The JTAGICE3 debugger and programmer does not support the Cortex Debug Connector (10-pin) directly, hence a special pinout is needed to directly connect the SAM D20 to the JTAGICE3, alternatively one can use the JTAGICE3 squid cable and manually match the signals between the JTAGICE3 and SAM D20. The following figure describes how to connect a 10-pin header that support connecting the JTAGICE3 directly to the SAM D20 without the need for a squid cable. To connect the JTAGICE3 programmer and debugger to the SAM D20, one can either use the JTAGICE3 squid cable, or use a 10-pin connector as shown in the figure below with details given in the next table to connect to the target using the JTAGICE3 50 mil cable directly. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 699 SAM D20 Family Schematic Checklist Figure 36-12. 10-pin JTAGICE3 Compatible Serial Wire Debug Interface 10-pin JTAGICE3 Compatible VDD Serial Wire Debug Header SWDCLK GND 1 NC RESET VTG SWDIO RESET NC NC NC NC SWCLK SWDIO GND Table 36-10. 10-pin JTAGICE3 Compatible Serial Wire Debug Interface 36.7.3 Header Signal Name Description SWDCLK Serial wire clock pin SWDIO Serial wire bidirectional data pin RESET Target device reset pin, active low VTG Target voltage sense, should be connected to the device VDD GND Ground 20-pin IDC JTAG Connector For debuggers and/or programmers that support the 20-pin IDC JTAG Connector, e.g. the SAM-ICE, the signals should be connected as shown in the next figure with details described in the table. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 700 SAM D20 Family Schematic Checklist Figure 36-13. 20-pin IDC JTAG Connector VDD 20-pin IDC JTAG Connector VCC 1 NC NC GND NC GND SWDIO GND SWDCLK GND NC GND NC GND* nRESET GND* NC GND* NC GND* RESET SWCLK SWDIO GND Table 36-11. 20-pin IDC JTAG Connector Header Signal Name Description SWDCLK Serial wire clock pin SWDIO Serial wire bidirectional data pin RESET Target device reset pin, active low VCC Target voltage sense, should be connected to the device VDD GND Ground GND* These pins are reserved for firmware extension purposes. They can be left open or connected to GND in normal debug environment. They are not essential for SWD in general. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 701 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History 37. Datasheet Revision History The referring page numbers in this section are referred to this datasheet. The referring revision in this section are referring to the datasheet revision. 37.1 Revision F - 03/2022 This revision includes numerous typographical corrections throughout the document. All other changes are described as follows: Section Description General The SPI and I2C standards use the terminology "Master" and "Slave". The equivalent Microchip terminology, "Host" and "Client," is used in this document. This terminology has been updated throughout this document for this revision. RTC Added a note to the RCONT bitfield in the READREQ Register. SERCOM SPI Removed erroneous text in Host with Several Clients. TC • • • • Electrical Characteristics at 85°C • • 37.2 Updated the CTRLA Register with a new Register property for 8-bit, 16-bit and 32-bit Registers Updated the 8-bit COUNT Register with a new note and an updated Register Property Updated the 16-bit COUNT Register with a new note and an updated Register Property Updated the 32-bit COUNT Register with a new note and an updated Register Property In SERCOM in SPI Mode Timing the table had minor formatting updates applied, and the typical and maximum values for tSCK switched In SERCOM in I2C Mode Timing minor formatting updates were applied to the table AEC-Q100 Electrical Characteristics at 125°C In SERCOM in SPI Mode Timing the table had minor formatting updates applied, and the typical and maximum values for tSCK switched. Acronyms and Abbreviations Removed references to the TCC as this product does not contain a TCC. Revision E - 11/2020 This revision includes numerous typographical corrections throughout the document. All other changes are described as follows: Section Description Pinout Updated the pinout for UFBGA64 to show the GND pins as black in color. GCLK Updated the GENDIV register with a Write-Synchronized property and added a new column to the table under the DIV bit field SYSCTRL Updated the AMPGC and GAIN bits of the XOSC register with a new text EVSYS Updated the Features with a new text for the last line item NVMCTRL Updated the LOCK register with a new reset value ADC Updated Power Management and Sleep Mode Operation. ADC OVERRUN interrupt cannot wake up the device from Sleep mode. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 702 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History ...........continued Section DAC • • Updated the Block Diagram to represent ADC input Updated the CTRLB Register with a new table value for the EOEN bit Electrical Specifications at 85℃ The following updates were performed: • Under Absolute Maximum Ratings, the GPIO Clusters table was updated with revised information for new packages • Added Note 1 to Current Consumption - Device Variant A • Added Note 2 to Current Consumption - Device Variant B • Updated the Maximum Peripheral Clock Frequencies table in Maximum Clock Frequencies • Updated the POR Operating Principle Diagram in Power-On Reset (POR) Characteristics • Updated the Operating Conditions table in Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) Characteristics with a new note • Updated the equation in XOSC Crystal Oscillator Characteristics • Updated XOSC32K Digital Clock Characteristics with a new note • Updated XOSC32K Crystal Oscillator Characteristics with a new text Electrical Specifications at 105℃ The following updates were performed: • Under Absolute Maximum Ratings, a new information was added • Updated the Maximum Peripheral Clock Frequencies table in Maximum Clock Frequencies • Updated the POR Operating Principle Diagram in Power-On Reset (POR) Characteristics • Updated the Operating Conditions table in Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) Characteristics with a new note • Updated the equation in XOSC Crystal Oscillator Characteristics • Updated XOSC32K Digital Clock Characteristics with a new note • Updated XOSC32K Crystal Oscillator Characteristics with a new text AEC-Q100 Electrical Specifications Added Electrical Specifications chapter for AEC-Q100 Packaging Information 37.3 Description • • Removed references to moisture sensitivity for each package Updated the Package Drawings to the latest version Revision D - 03/2020 This revision includes typographical corrections throughout the document. For a list of other items, refer to the following table: Section Updates Features Added 27-ball WLCSP package Configuration Summary Updated the SAM D20 Family Features table, and added WLCSP27 package Ordering Information • • Updated Pin Count field for 27-pin and 45-pin WLCSP packages Added Note 3 and 4 Pinout • • A note is added for the QFN32/TQFP32 package WLCSP27 pinout added © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 703 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History ...........continued Section Updates I/O Multiplexing and Considerations Ball number is added for WLCSP27, WLCSP45 and UFBGA packages in PORT Function Multiplexing SERCOM I2C • • SYSCTRL Updated the VREG Register with a new Reserved bit and new note. TC – Timer/Counter • • AC Updated number of timers from five to eight in Features sub-section Updated Counter Mode sub-section for 32-bit Counter mode (COUNT32) Updated Figure 29-2 Continuous Measurement Example with a new name for first signal. Packaging Information 37.4 Updated the CLKHOLD bit description in STATUS Slave Register Updated ADDR bits from 7 to 8 in the Master Address register, ADDR • • Updated Thermal Resistance Data for 27-ball WLCSP package Added WLCSP27 package drawing for the 27-ball WLCSP package Revision C - 11/2019 This revision includes typographical corrections throughout the document. For a list of other items, refer to the following table: Section Updates PORT SERCOM Updated the PMUX Register with information for 0x5 for the PMUXO and PMUXE bits. I2C Updated the Diagram I2C Master Behavioral Diagram in I2C Master Operation. SERCOM I2C Updated the chapter to remove the following duplicate sections: • Receiving Data Packets • High Speed Mode • 10 Bit Addressing • Receiving Address Packets SERCOM I2C Updated the Diagram I2C Slave Behavioral Diagram in I2C Slave Operation. SERCOM I2C Updated the following Registers: • STATUS Slave Register With R/W information for the CLKHOLD bit • STATUS Master Register was updated with information for the SCL line Electrical Characteristics at 85°C • Updated the Equation in Crystal Oscillator Characteristics Electrical Characteristics at 105°C • Updated the Equation in Crystal Oscillator Characteristics Schematic Checklist • Updated Crystal Oscillator with CLEXT information in the figure and table replacing 15pF Updated External Real Time Oscillator with information for CLEXT in the figure and table replacing 22pF Updated Calculating the Correct Crystal Decoupling Capacitor with a new reference to Oscillator Characteristics for an updated equation Updated External Reset Circuit with a new diagram • • • Power Domain Overview Corrected the color of the pins on the right side of the diagram to blue. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 704 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History 37.5 Rev. B - 11/2017 General update This revision contains updates to restore content that was omitted in the previous version of the document, and to remove content that is not applicable to this device family. The following content was restored: • Column F in Table 6-1 • 7.1. Power Domain Overview • Power Supply Connection (see Figure 7-1) • PAC2 Write Protect Clear register bits (see 10.6.3.1. WPCLR) • PAC2 Write Protect Set register bits (see 10.6.3.2. WPSET) • DSU Block Diagram (see Figure 12-1) • Analog Comparator Block Diagram (see 29.3. Block Diagram) The following content was removed: • DMAC and DMA references were removed throughout the document • RWW and RWWEE references were removed throughout the Non-Volatile Memory Controller chapter and elsewhere in the document • Features Asynchronous Fractional Mode and related references were removed from the Baud Rate Equation table (see Table 23-2) The number of Timer/Counters (TC) was updated to eight. 1. Configuration Summary The Flash size was updated to include 16 KB. 9.4. NVM User Row Mapping The NVM User Row Mapping table was updated (see Table 9-3). 19. EIC – External Interrupt Controller Removed the CONFIG2 register (see 19.8. Register Description). Electrical Characteristics at 85°C The Bandgap (Internal 1.1V reference) Characteristics were updated (see Table 32-34). 35. Packaging Information The WLCSP packaging information was updated (see 35.2.8. 45-ball WLCSP). 37.6 Rev. A - 08/2017 General updates 37.7 • • • • Updated the document from Atmel to Microchip style and template The literature number changed from the Atmel 42129 to the Microchip DS60001504. The Data Sheet revision letter was restarted to A An ISBN number was added Rev. P - 09/2016 9. Memories Updated the BOOTPROT default value in NVM User Row Mapping: default value = 0x7 except for WLCSP that has default value = 0x3 12. DSU - Device Service Unit Updated the Registers "Reset Value" 13. Clock System Added the section: 13.5. Disabling a Peripheral 16. SYSCTRL – System Controller Description added on setting up AMPGC bit in XOSC register 22. Event System (EVSYS) 22.8.1. CTRL.SWRST: Added recommendation when doing a software reset © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 705 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History 18. RTC – Real-Time Counter Updated the description in 18.6.3.3. Clock/Calendar (Mode 2): Example added on how the clock counter works in calendar mode 27. TC – Timer/Counter The ENABLE and SWRST bits in 27.8.1. CTRLA register are not enable protected 36. Schematic Checklist Updated External Real Time Oscillator: Added note on how to minimize jitter 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C at 85°C Electrical Characteristics at 105°C 37.8 • Editing update • Updated General Operating Ratings – Added note about the NVM erase operations in debugger cold-plugging mode • Updated Crystal Oscillator Characteristics – Removed the package condition from the Table 32-44 • – Updated 33.6. Injection Current • Updated 33.3. General Operating Ratings – Added note about the NVM erase operations in debugger cold-plugging mode • Updated Crystal Oscillator Characteristics – Removed the package condition from the Table 32-44 Rev. O - 08/2016 Description Description: Updated CoreMark score from 2.14 to 2.46 CoreMark/MHz. Block Diagram Updated Block Diagram. Power Manager Updated description for bits [31:4] in 15.8.9. APBBMASK. System Control Updated description in Drift Compensation. 32. Electrical 32.10.3. Brown-Out Detectors Characteristics: Updated Table 32-19. Characteristics at 85°C 32.12.3. Digital Frequency Locked Loop (DFLL48M) Characteristics: Note 2 in Table 32-45 updated to only be applicable for die revision C. Schematic Checklist Updated the content in section Unused or Unconnected Pins. Power Supply Schematic: VDDCORE decoupling capacitor value updated from 100nF to 1nF. 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°C at 85°C Electrical Characteristics at 105°C • Updated 32.2. Absolute Maximum Ratings – Vpin: min and max changed respectively from GND-0.3V to GND-0.6V and from GND+0.3V to GND+0.6V • Added 32.9. Injection Current • Updated 33.2. Absolute Maximum Ratings – Vpin: min and max changed respectively from GND-0.3V to GND-0.6V and from GND+0.3V to GND+0.6V • • – Added 33.6. Injection Current 32.10.3.1. BOD33: Updated Table 32-20. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 706 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History 37.9 Rev. N - 01/2015 Electrical Characteristics • Updated Table 32-21 in the 32.10.4. Analog-to-Digital (ADC) Characteristics – added two rows. One for Internal ratiometric reference 0 error and the other for Internal ratiometric reference 1 error – added more details in Conditions of VREFINTVCC0 and VREFINTVCC1 Errata • • Added Errata revision E Updated Errata revision D: – Added new Errata references: 12290; 13950 and 13951 – Updated Errata reference 13574: The software workaround: In I2C Slave mode, writing the CTRLB register when in the AMATCH or DRDY interrupt service routines can cause the state machine to reset – Updated Errata reference 13276 Workaround 2: At 105ºC, use the ADC in single shot mode only with VDDANA > 2.7V Updated Errata revision C: – Added new Errrata reference:13951 – Updated Errata reference 10537 Updated Errata revision B: – Added new Errrata reference:13951 • • Appendix 37.10 • Added 33. Electrical Characteristics at 105°C Rev. M - 12/2014 Signal Description List • VREFP renamed VREFA and VREFB in the 5. Signal Descriptions List Memories • Added a table note to the Table 9-4 12. DSU - Device Service Unit • Updated the Register Summary – Added register bit AMOD[1:0] Updated the register ADDR – Added the description of “Bits 1:0 – AMOD[1:0]” • System Controller • • Removed all references to 1khz from 16.6.3. 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator (XOSC32K) Operation, 16.6.4. 32kHz Internal Oscillator (OSC32K) Operation and 16.6.5. 32kHz Ultra Low Power Internal Oscillator (OSCULP32K) Operation Changed EN1K bits to “Reserved” in 16.8.6. XOSC32K and in 16.8.7. OSC32K PORT • Updated 21.6.3. I/O Pin Configuration – Removed reference to Open-drain ADC - Analog-to-Digital Converte • Replaced AREFA/AREFB by VREFA/VREFB in 28.5.8. Analog Connections DAC - Digital -to-Analog Converter • Replaced VREFP by VREFA in 30.6.2.4. Digital to Analog Conversion and in 30.6.7.1. DAC as an Internal Reference © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 707 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History Electrical Characteristics • • • • 32.10.3. Brown-Out Detectors Characteristics: – Added Figure 32-3, Figure 32-4 and clarifications. – Updated conditions in the Table 32-19 and in the Table 32-20. 32.10.4. Analog-to-Digital (ADC) Characteristics: – Updated conditions in the Table 32-26 and in the Table 32-27. Updated the table Table 32-45 in 32.12.3. Digital Frequency Locked Loop (DFLL48M) Characteristics: – Renamed “Power consumption on VDDANA” to “Power consumption on VDDIN” – Added IDFLL specific typical value for revD and later Updated the table Table 32-50 in 32.14.2. SERCOM in SPI Mode Timing: – The value of tSCK SCK period updated from 42 to 84 Package Information • Updated 35.1. Thermal Considerations: – Added ThetaJA and ThetaJC values for the packages: 64-ball UFBGA and 45-ball WLCSP Schematic Checklist • • • Updated the Introduction Content Replaced AREFA/AREFB by VREFA/VREFB in the content Updated the content in the36.7. Programming and Debug Ports – Updated all sub-sections, tables and figures Errata • Updated Errata revision D: – Added Errata reference 13574 related to CTRLB register / I2C in Slave Mode. 37.11 Rev. L - 09/2014 Features • • Added UFBGA64 and WLCSP45 packages Introduced the 105ºC devices Pinout • Added two more pinouts: 4.1.2. UFBGA64 and 4.2.2. WLCSP45 Configuration Summary • Updated1. Configuration Summary to include UFBGA64 and WLCSP45 packages Ordering Information • Updated 2. Ordering Information (1) to include UFBGA64, WLCSP45 packages and the ordering codes for 105ºC devices Peripheral Configuration • Updated 11. Peripherals Configuration Summary – Added one column “SleepWalking” in the Table 11-1 15. Power Manager (PM) • Updated the table note 1 of the Table 15-3 System Controller • Updated 16.5.4. Interrupts – Interrupt source “BOD33DET - BOD33 Detection” is an Asynchronous interrupt that can be used to wake-up the device from any sleep mode Watchdog Timer • Updated 17.6.3.1. Always-On Mode – Added conditions for which CTRL.ALWAYSON bit must never be set to one by software Updated 17.6.4. Interrupts – Early Warning (EW) is an asynchronous interrupt that can be used to wake-up the device from any sleep mode • © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 708 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History 18. RTC – Real-Time Counter • Updated the section Interrupts – Overflow (INTFLAG.OVF), Compare n (INTFLAG.CMPn), Alarm 0 (INTFLAG.ALARMn) and Synchronization Ready (INTFLAG.SYNCRDY) are all asynchronous and can be used to wake-up the device from any sleep mode 19. EIC – External Interrupt Controller • Updated the section Interrupts – External interrupt pins (EXTINTx) and Non-maskable interrupt pin (NMI) are both asynchronous and can be used to wake-up the device from any sleep mode 21. PORT - I/O Pin Controller • Updated the Basic Operation section – Instances “pad” changed to “pin” – Edited the content in the section 22. Event System (EVSYS) • Updated the section Interrupts – Overrun Channel x (OVRx) and Event Detected Channel x (EVDx) are asynchronous and can be used to wake-up the device from any sleep mode Updated the section Sleep Mode Operations • SERCOM USART • Updated the section Interrupts – RXS, RXC, TXC and DRE interrupts are asynchronous and can be used to wake-up the device from any sleep mode. 28. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) • • Fix a typo in the description of the bitfield MUXPOS of the register INPUTCTRL Added more info to the table “Delay Gain” and about the propagation delay in sub-section 7.3 “Prescaler” Electrical Characteristics • Updated the Maximum Clock Frequencies – Added the Table 32-6 – Renamed the Table 32-7 to "Maximum Peripheral Clock Frequencies" and updated the whole table content including the symbols and descriptions Added the section Peripheral Power Consumption Updated the section I/O Pin Characteristics – Updated the table Table 32-11 For tRISE and tFALL added different load conditions depending on DVRSTR value Updated SERCOM in SPI Mode Timing – Added typical tSCK in the table Table 32-44 Updated Voltage Regulator Characteristics – Added minimum value to the Cout parameter in the Table 32-15 Updated Digital Frequency Locked Loop (DFLL48M) Characteristics – Renamed the Table 32-39 to DFLL48M Characteristics - Closed Loop Mode – Updated the content and the table note of the Table 32-39 Updated the Analog-to-Digital (ADC) Characteristics – Table 32-19. Operating Conditions Updated Single rate (single shot) maximum value to 300 ksps • • • • • • • Schematic Checklist • Updated the table note 3 – Updated Table 32-20 and Table 32-21: Added definition of the gain accuracy parameter Updated Temperature Sensor Characteristics – Updated the table Table 32-29. Temperature Sensor Characteristics Added temperature sensor accuracy parameters and its condition Added link for the values of XIN32/XOUT32 pins parasitic capacitance in the Table 32-38. 32kHz Crystal Oscillator Characteristics © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 709 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History Package Information • Added two more packages: 64UFBGA and 45WLCSP Errata • Updated errata for revision B, C and D. Added errata references: 10805, 12015, 12499, 13140, 13140 and 13268 37.12 Rev. K – 05/2014 Description • Updated the content in the Description Block Diagram • VREFP on DAC renamed VREFA Memories • Updated the tableNVM User Row Mapping – Changed the WDT window default value, WINDOW_1 to 0x5 DSU - Device Service Unit • Updated DSU Chip Identification Method: – “Family” renamed “Product family” and subfamily became “Product series” Updated the protection state of the device in Starting CRC32 Calculation • SYSCTRL - System Controller • • • • • • Updated 8MHz Internal Oscillator (OSC8M) Operation – Updated the description of writing to FRANGE and CALIB Updated the table Behavior of the Oscillators – DFLL renamed DFLL48M Added Note on how to enter standby mode in: – External Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator (XOSC) Operation – 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator (XOSC32K) Operation Added VREG register – Added VREG register in Register Summary – Updated the description of Bit 6 – RUNSTDBY and Bit 13 – FORCELDO Updated the description of Interrupts Updated OSC8M – Bits 11:0 - CALIB has two calibration fields CALIB[11-6] and CALIB[5:0] RTC - Real-Time Counter • Updated Analog Connections – TOSC1 and TOSC2 renamed respectively XIN32 and XOUT32 PORT • Updated Principle of Operation – The reference for Pin Configuration registers changed to PINCFGy SERCOM SPI • Updated CTRLB register – Bit 17 - RXEN is R/W TC - Timer/Counter • • Updated the table Waveform Generation Operation Updated CTRLC register – Bits 1:0 - INVENx: Waveform Output x Invert Enable AC - Analog Comparators • Added Bit 7 - LPMUX in CTRLA register and updated Register Summary DAC - Digital -to-Analog Converter • • Added a new DAC in the Block Diagram with VREFP replaced by VREFA Updated Signal Description – VREFP renamed VREFA © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 710 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History Electrical Characteristics • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • ERRATA 37.13 • • • Updated the table Absolute maximum ratings – Updated IVDD and IGND max values – Added a detailed table note for IVDD and IGND Added the table GPIO Clusters Updated the table General operating conditions – Removed table note (1) related to the operating conditions Updated the table Current Consumption – Updated values in ACTIVE and IDLE0/1/2 modes – Updated the max values @ 85ºC in STANDBY modes l Max values updated to 100μA both for RTC stopped and RTC running Updated I/O Pin Characteristics section – Updated title of the table to RevD and later normal I/O Pins Characteristics – Updated IOL and IOH values in the table RevD and later normal I/O Pins Characteristics – Updated IOL and IOH in the table I2C Pins Characteristics in I2C configuration Table note (1) on COUT removed from the table Decoupling requirements Updated the content in Analog Characteristics – Updated max value of VPOT-in the table POR Characteristics. New max value is 1.32V – Updated table note 3 in Differential Mode – Updated table note 2 in Single-Ended Mode – Updated RSAMPLE in the table Operating Conditions Added conversion rate for max 1000ksps in the table Clock and Timing Updated the table Accuracy Characteristics – Added table note “All values measured using a conversion rate of 350ksps” Updated Software-based Refinement of the Actual Temperature – Added the address of the temperature log row Updated the table DFLL48M Characteristics - Closed Loop Mode – Removed the Tlcoarse parameter as it is already set from calibration – Updated IDFLL and tSTARTU typical values Updated Crystal Oscillator Characteristics section: – Updated the max values of ESR – Updated the typical values of CXIN and CXOUT Updated the table 32kHz Crystal Oscillator Characteristics: – Updated the table note Updated the max value of ESR to 141kΩ, the typical values of CXIN32 and CXOUT32 to respectively 3.1 and 3.3pF Updated the table I2C Interface Timing – Added table note (3) to tR and tOF Added Errata Revision D Updated Errata Revision C Updated Errata Revision B Rev. J – 12/2013 NVMCTRL - Non-Volatile Memory Controller © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Updated the NVM NVMCTRL.CTRLB register. Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 711 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History 37.14 Rev. I 12/2013 General Removed Preliminary Description • Updated the description Features • Power Consumption has been updated to Down to 8μA running the Peripheral Touch Controller Configuration Summary Updated the Configuration Summary Ordering Information Updated Ordering Information • Added AT prefix at the start of the ordering codes Block Diagram • • Added the description of the connection between PORT and ARM CORTEX-M0+ CPU: ARM SINGLE CYCLE IOBUS Renamed GENERIC CLOCK to GENERIC CLOCK CONTROLLER I/O Multiplexing and Updated the Table 5-1. PORT Function Multiplexing Considerations • Renamed all GCLK/IO[x] to GCLK_IO[x] • Updated the description of the Serial Wire Debug Interface Pinout section • Added SWDIO to PA31 column G in the Table 5-1 and added a footnote Product Mapping Changed Peripheral to AHB-APB Signal Description • • Removed GCLK from the heading “Generic Clock Generator” Renamed IO[7:0] to GCLK_IO[7:0] Memories • • • • Added a new section Serial Number Software Calibration Row changed to Software Calibration Area Added Figure 9-1. Calibration and Auxiliary space Updated the Table 9-4. NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping – Added the BOD33 and BOD12 default settings – Added DFLL48M COARSE CAL and DFLL48M FINE CAL – Added table notes on rev C (Bit 40 and Bit 41) to the Table 9-3. NVM User Row Mapping 12. DSU - Device Service Unit • Updated the Table 12-7. Register Summary – Redefined DID register. FAMILY changed from 4 bits to 5 bits and SERIES from 8 bits to 6 bits Updated the Device Identification- DID register – Updated Family and Series bit registers – Updated the Table 12-8. Device Selection. Added ATSAMD20E18A device at 0xA. • Clock System • • • • • • Updated the clock names in the Figure 13-1. Clock distribution Updated the description of Generic Clock generators and Generic Clocks in the Clock Distribution Updated the Figure 13-2. Example of SERCOM clock – Synchronous Clock Controller renamed to Main clock controller Updated the descriptive content of the Read-Synchronization section Changed the title “Enable Write-Synchronization” to Write-Synchronization of CTRL.ENABLE Updated the content in Clocks after Resetsection – Renamed GCLKMAIN to GCLK_MAIN © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 712 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History Generic Clock Controller • • • • • • • • Updated the Overview section and renamed GCLK_PERIPH to GCLK_PERIPHERAL throughout the datasheet Updated the Features list Updated Figure 14-1. Device Clocking Diagram and added a figure note Updated links in the sections: Power Manageme and in Clocks Updated the content in the Functional Description – Added links in the section Initialization for GENDIV, GENCTRL and CLKCTRL – Updated the Figure 14-3. Generic Clock Generator – Renamed “External Clock” to Generic Clock Output on I/O Pins and updated the description – Updated the Figure 14-4. Generic Clock Multiplexer – Updated the descriptive content in the Disabling a Generic Clock” section – Updated the Figure 14-5. GCLK Indirect Access. GCLK becomes Generic Clock – Updated links in the sections: Run in Standby Mode and Synchronization Added a table note on the Reset of GENCTRL register Added a third column “Generator Clock Source” in the tableGENCTRL Reset Value after a Power Reset Updated the content and replaced the text “if the generator is not used by the RTC” by the “if the generator is not used by the RTC and not a source of a 'locked' generic clock” in two tables:GENCTRL Reset Value after a User Reset and GENDIV Reset Value after a User Reset © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 713 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History Power Manager • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • Updated the content Overview – “power save modes” is changed to “sleep modes” – A new line is added: “This is because during STANDBY sleep mode the internal voltage regulator will be in low power mode” Updated Featureslist – Clock control: “Generates” is changed to “Controls” Updated le content in the Clockssection – “This clock” is changed to “The clock source for GCLK_MAIN” Updated the content in Interrupts section – Added: “Refer to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller" Updated Register Access Protection – Added: “Refer to Interrupt Flag Status and Clear - INTFLAG register for details” – Added: “Refer to Reset Cause - RCAUSE register for details” Updated the sections: Synchronous Clocks and Sleep Mode Controller – Added: "see Table 15-4. Sleep Mode Overview" Updated Reset Controller section – “resets” corrected to “reset” Updated Initialization section – Added: “- refer to Reset Cause - RCAUSE register for details” Updated Selecting the Synchronous Clock Division Ratio – Added: “(APBxSEL.APBxDIV)” Updated the figure Synchronous Clock Selection and Prescaler Updated Clock Ready Flag section – “CKSEL” is changed to “CPUSEL” Updated the Peripheral Clock Masking section – Added: “refer to APBA Mask - APBAMASK register for details” – The first sentence below the figure has been changed to: “When the APB clock for a module is not provided its registers cannot be read or written.” Updated the content Clock Failure Detector section – “CFDEN.CTRL” has been changed to “CTRL.CFDEN” – Added: “Refer to Control - CTRL register for details” – “divided” has been changed to “undivided” – “is generated, if enabled” has been changed to "is set and the corresponding interrupt request will be generated if enabled" – “GCLKMAIN” has been changed to “GCLK_MAIN” – Added: Note 3 Updated the table Effects of the Different Reset Events – “GCLK” has been changed to “Generic Clock” Updated the figure Reset Controller Updated the table Sleep Mode Entry and Exit – Two notes (“Synchronous” and “Asynchronous”) are added below the table Updated the Sleep Mode Controller section – Updated the text in STANDBY mode © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 714 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History Power Manager (cont.) • • • • • 16. SYSCTRL – System Controller • • • • • • • • • • Updated the table Sleep Mode Overview – Replaced the table with an accurate one Updated IDLE Mode section – Second bullet: “any non-masked interrupt” changed to “the occurrence of any interrupt that is not masked in the NVIC Controller” Updated STANDBY Mode section – “GCLK” is changed to “Generic Clock” Added: SleepWalking section Updated Bit 4 – BKUPCLK: Backup Clock Select” – “GCLKMAIN” is changed to “GCLK_MAIN” Updated the content in Overview section – “XOSC, XOSC32K, OSC32K, OSCULP32K, OSC8M, DFLL48M, BOD33, BOD12, VREG and VREF” is changed to “clock sources, brown out detectors, on-chip voltage regulator and voltage reference of the device." – Added: “ refer to Power and Clocks Status - PCLKSR register" – Added: “(INTENSET)” – Added: “(INTENCLR)” – Added: “(INTFLAG)” Updated the content in Principle of Operationsection – Added two tables for the behavior of Oscillators and Sleep modes Updated Register Access Protection – Added: “- refer to INFLAG Updated Analog Connections section – Changed “load. Refer” to “load, refer” Updated External Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator (XOSC) Operation section – Changed “the only” to “only the” – “the XTAL Enable bit (XOSC.XTALEN) must written to one” is changed to “a one must be written to the XTAL Enable bit (XOSC.XTALEN)." Updated the content in 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator (XOSC32K) Operation section – “power-on, reset” is changed to “power-on reset (POR)” – Added: "XOSC32K can provide two clock outputs when connected to a crystal.” Updated the content in 8MHz Internal Oscillator (OSC8M) Operation section Updated the content in 32kHz Internal Oscillator (OSC32K) Operation section – Changed “CALIB” to “OSC32K.CALIB” – Changed “non-volatile memory” to “NVM Software Calibration ROW” – Added: “(refer to NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping Updated the content in 32kHz Ultra Low Power Internal Oscillator (OSCULP32K) Operation section – Added: 32kHz Ultra Low Power Internal Oscillator (OSCULP32K) Control - OSCULP32K register Updated the content in Closed-Loop Operation section – List #3: Changed “device” to “DFLL” – Below “Drift Compensation”: “set” has been replaced by “triggered” – The text “shown in the SYSCTRL Block Diagram" has been removed © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 715 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History SYSCTRL - System Control (cont.) • • • • • • • • • • • • 17. WDT – Watchdog Timer • Updated Additional Features – The text “when disabling the DFLL48M” below “Wake from Sleep Modes” has been replaced by the text “when the DFLL is turned off” Updated 3.3V Brown-Out Detector (BOD33) section – “Brown-Out Detector” is replaced by “BOD33” Updated 32kHz Internal Oscillator (OSC32K) Control - OSC32K register – The reference for Bits 22:16 - CALIB[6:0] has been corrected Updated the table Start-UpTime for External Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator – Both notes for this table has been updated/changed – New “Note 3” is added Updated the table Start-Up Time for 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator – Both notes for this table has been updated/changed – New “Note 3” is added Updated the table Start-Up Time for 32kHz Internal Oscillator – New column for “Number of OSC32K Clock Cycles” is added – The values in the column for the “old” “Number of OSC32K Clock Cycles” has been corrected – Both notes for this table has been updated/changed – New “Note 3” is added Updated DFLL48M Control - DFLLCTRL register – For “Property” the following has been added: “, Write-Synchronized” – Removed RUNSTDBY Updated DFLL48M Value - DFLLVAL register – For “Property” the following has been added: “, Read-Synchronized” Updated Register Access Protection register – In the bullet point the following is added: “ refer to Interrupt Flag Status and Clear - INTFLAG register” Updated Principle of Operation section – Added: “- refer to Control - CTRL register "and “- refer to Interrupt Enable Clear - INTENCLR register” Updated the Default Reset value in 8MHz Internal Oscillator (OSC8M) Control - OSC8M register and fixed the RANGE bitfield Updated the description of the Bit 4 DFLL Ready in Power and Clocks Status - PCLKSR register and updated Bit 11 BOD33 Synchronization Ready • • Updated Intitialization – Added: “- refer to CTRL register”, “- refer to CONFIG register”, and “- refer to EWCTRL regsiter” Updated Normal Mode – Added: “- refer to Clear - CLEAR register Updated the description of the Bit 2 (CTRL.WEN) in the Control - CTRL register Removed “Asynchronous Watchdog Clock Characterization” 25. SERCOM SPI – SERCOM Serial Peripheral Interface • Updated the description of the SPI Transfer Modes section RTC - Real-Time Counter • Updated Register Access Protection section – Added: “- refer to INTFLAG register”, “- refer to READREQ register”, “- refer to STATUS register”, and “- refer to DBGCTRL register” Updated the content in Initialization section – Added: “- refer to Event Control - EVCTRL register” • • © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 716 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History EIC - External Interrupt Controller • • • • NVMCTRL - NonVolatile Memory Controller • • • • • • • • PORT • • Updated the content in Events section – Added text “External Interrupt Controller generates events as pulses” Updated the content Sleep Mode Operation section – Added text “Using WAKEUPEN[x]=1 with INTENSET=0 is not recommended” Updated the content Register Access Protection – Added: “- refer to INTFLAG register” and “- refer to NMIFLAG register” Updated Additional Features – Added: “- refer to NMICTRL register” Updated Power Management section – Added: “- refer to CTRLB register” Added Basic Operations section Updated Interrupts section – Added a reference link to Nested Vector Interrupt Controller Updated the description of NVM Read section Updated the content in Register Access Protection section Added: “- refer to INTFLAG regsiter” and “- refer to STATUS register” Updated the description of MANW bit in CTRLB register Updated the description of ERROR and READY bits in INTENCLR register Updated CPU Local Bus section – Added: “- refer to DIR register”, “- refer to OUT register”, “- refer to IN register", and “- refer to CTRL register” Updated Principle of Operation section – Added: “- refer to DIR register”, “- refer to OUT register”, “- refer to PINCFG0 register”, “- refer to IN register”, and “- refer to PMUX0 register” TC • Updated the table Waveform Generation Operation. Switched “Clear” and “Set” for CCO value (MPWM). ADC • Updated the content in Sleep Mode Operation section – Added “While the CPU is sleeping, ADC conversion can only be triggered by vents” Software Calibration Row changed to Software Calibration Area • AC • Updated the content in Sleep Mode Operation section – Added “While the CPU is sleeping, single-shot comparisons are only triggerable by events” © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 717 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History Electrical Characteristics • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • Package 37.15 • • Updated Disclaimer section. Removed the preliminary disclaimer Updated the table Absolute maximum ratings – Updated IVDD and IGND max values – Added TSTORAGE Updated the table General operating conditions – Added VDDIO - VDDANA Updated the table Current Consumption – Added min and max values – Added consumption data Updated IOL and IOH in the table RevD and later normal I/O Pins Characteristics Updated VHYS min value in I2C Pins Characteristics in I2C configuration Duplicated all tables in the table I/O Pin Characteristics” to differentiate rev D (the table RevD and later normal I/O Pins Characteristics) from rev C (the table RevC and later normal I/O Pins Characteristics) Updated the table and renamed to Voltage Regulator Electrical Characteristics – Added condition to VDDCORE characteristics Updated the table BOD33 LEVEL Value – Added a table note to specify BOD33.LEVEL default production settings Updated the table BOD33 Characteristics – Added current consumption data (IBOD33) ADC Characteristics: Removed the min value of IDD from the table Operating Conditions Updated the Bandgap Gain Error min and max values in the table Differential Mode DAC characteristics: Updated IDD values and conditions in the table Operating Conditions Removed the table note from the table Bandgap (Internal 1.1V reference) characteristics Updated the Accuracy unit in the table Accuracy Characteristics Removed tFFP from the tableNVM Characteristics Updated the table Temperature Sensor Characteristics Updated the content in Crystal Oscillator (SOSC) Characteristics section – Added new characterization data – Removed fCPXIN min value from Digital Clock Characteristics table Changed the title to Digital Frequency Locked Loop (DFLL48M) Characteristics and added table note to DFLL48M Characteristics - Closed Loop Mode Updated the table 32kHz Crystal Oscillator Characteristics – Updated IXOSC32K – Added a table note for “AGC on”: data are not yet available for rev D Added current consumption data (IOSC32K) in the table 32kHz RC Oscillator Characteristics Updated IOSC8M in the table Internal 8MHz RC Oscillator Characteristics Added notes to 64QFN, 48QFN and to 32QFN packages Updated Device and Package Maximum Weight for 32-pin TQFP and for 32-pin QFN – Device and Package Maximum Weight is 100mg for TQFP32 and 90mg for QFN32 Rev. H 10/2013 Configuration Summary Added 256KB Flash and 32KB SRAM to the SAM D20E Ordering Information Added ATSAMD20E18 ordering code SYSCTRL Added note to INFLAG register © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 718 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History NVMCTRL Updated links to the Flash size for EEPROM emulation table SERCOM USART Updated the table Transmit Data Pinout. SERCOM PAD[X] renamed PAD[X] ADC • • • Updated the Features list. Added "Up to 350,000 samples per second (350ksps)" Updated the broken link for INPUTCTRL register Removed “Additional Features” Schematic Checklist • • • Added information about JTAGICE3 compatible SWD connector Updated connector names to match the names used by ARM Added information about general debugging and programming to Programming and Debug Ports Electrical Characteristics • • • • Updated the table General operating conditions. Added table note related to BOD33 Updated I/O Pin Characteristics. All VDDANA ranges are 1.62V - 2.7V and 2.7V - 3.63V Updated Digital Frequency Locked Loop (DFLL48M) Characteristics Updated the table Supply Rise Rates – Replaced the Maximum value that was based on simulation by the actual measurement value – Removed the unused columns Updated the typical values of while(1) at 1.8V in the table Current Consumption Updated the table Decoupling requirements – Used measurement values – Removed the min and max values – Added values for CIN and COUT – Added a table note Updated the table ADC: Operating Conditions – Added min and max values for IDD – Updated typical values Updated the table Single-Ended Mode – Added min and max values – Added characteristics for ENOB, SFDR, SINAD and THD • • • • Electrical Characteristics • • • • • • • • • ERRATA 37.16 Features Replaced VDD by VDDANA in the table Clock and Timing Updated the table Electrical and Timing – Added min and max values – Added characterization data for VSCALE Updated the tables: Differential Mode, Accuracy Characteristics and Temperature Sensor Characteristics – Added min and max values Updated the tableFlash Endurance and Data Retention and EEPROM Emulation Endurance and Data Retention . Added table note related to the cycling endurance Added output frequency characteristics data to the tables: 32kHz RC Oscillator Characteristics, Ultra Low Power Internal 32kHz RC Oscillator Characteristics and Internal 8MHz RC Oscillator Characteristics Updated all tables in I/O Pin Characteristics section. Added new characterization data Added VDDCORE characteristics to the Voltage Regulator Electrical Characteristics Updated the tables: POR Characteristics, Bandgap (Internal 1.1V reference) characteristics, BOD33 LEVEL Value and BOD33 Characteristics. Added new characterization data Updated all tables in Oscillators Characteristics section. Added new characterization data Added Errata Revision C Rev. G - 10/2013 Added the Power Consumption © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 719 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History GCLK Updated Division Factor • Generic clock generator 0 has 8 division factor bits - DIV[7:0] NVMCTRL Updated the table Flash size for EEPROM emulation Electrical characteristics • • • • 37.17 Updated the table Current Consumption. Added values of CPU running a “While(1)” algorithm Moved the PTC typical figures from the Typical characteristics into the Electrical Characteristics Updated the Analog Characteristics Cout max value in the Decoupling requirements table is 1000nF instead of 200nF Updated the NVM Characteristics: – Added note about the max number of consecutive write in a row before an erase becomes mandatory – Removed all “based on simulation” notes – Updated the tables: Maximum Operating Frequency, Flash Endurance and Data Retention and EEPROM Emulation Endurance and Data Retention Rev. F - 10/2013 I/O Multiplexing and Considerations Updated the table PORT Function Multiplexing • PA16 and PA17 are I2C pins in SERCOM1 Memories Updated the table NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping • Bit Positions [14:3] and [26:15] are “Reserved” ADC Updated the Calibration according to the update done in the NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping Typical Characteristics Added the PTC in the Typical Characteristics ERRATA Added PTC in Errata Revision B 37.18 Rev. E - 09/2013 Ordering Information Updated the figure of the Ordering Information • Removed “H = -40 - 85C NiPdAu Plating” from the Package Grade • Renamed “Product Variant” to “Device variant” in the figure of the Ordering Information DSU Updated the DID register • Renamed SUBFAMILY [7:0] bits to SERIES [7:0] bits • The whole description of the DID bit registers updated • Added Device (all products in the SAM D20 family) column in Device Selection table (DEVSEL) SYSCTRL Added ENABLE bits for the BODs and oscillators Electrical characteristics Updated Supply Characteristics • Updated the table Supply Rise Rates Updated the I/O Pin Characteristics • Fixed typos in the tables RevD and later normal I/O Pins Characteristics, SAMD20 revC/revB Normal I/O Pins Characteristics and I2C Pins Characteristics in I2C configuration: “Vdd” was missing in some cells of the tables. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 720 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History 37.19 Rev. D - 08/2013 Description The content updated General Fixed different typos throughout the datasheet and applied correctly the template Block Diagram • DSU Added 2KB RAM and 16KB FLASH Updated the Block Diagram • Removed HRAM from the block diagram Clock System • • The description of the Basic Read Request has been updated Updated the figure Synchronization SYSCTRL • • Updated the writing of the interrupt sources in the Interrupts section Added the reference to INFLAG register NVMCTRL Updated the figure Row Organization • Removed the blue mark from the figure PORT • • EVSYS IOBUS address 0x60000000 added in CPU Local Bus section Removed RWM from the description Updated the CHANNEL register: • Bits 25:24: CHANNEL:PATH description updated. Schematic Checklist • • • Updated the Introduction content Replaced all TDB by their respective values Corrected the typo: the Ohm symbol in External Reset Circuit Electrical Characteristics • • Removed the colors from Electrical Characteristics Added footnote in the table Operating Conditions, fADC = 6 * CLKADC Table Of Contents • Applied correctly the template for the TOC 37.20 Rev. C – 07/2013 Description Updated the front page: • Removed the “Embedded Flash” from the title and from the description on the page 1 • Replaced “speeds” by “frequencies” on the page 1 • Added a sub-bullet on PTC in feature list (256-Channel capacitive touch and proximity sensing) on the page 2 • Replaced IO lines by IO pins on the page 2 Configuration Summary Updated the table • The RTC • I/O lines changed to I/O pins • Changed 32.768kHz high-accuracy oscillator to 32.768kHz oscillator • Changed 32.768kHz ultra-low power internal oscillator to 32kHz ULP oscillator • Changed 8MHz internal oscillator to 8MHz high-accuracy internal oscillator • Updated SW Debug Interface • Updated the WDT © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 721 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History Ordering information • • Replaced “base line” by “general purpose” Centered the tables except the ordering code table. About the Document • • • Renamed the chapter to Appendix A and Appendix B Moved the two Appendixes at the end of the datasheet Changed the tag of the tables to the tag of appendix tables Pinout • • • • Updated the description of “Multiplexing Signals” Replaced “PORT controller” by “PORT” Set the table PORT Function Multiplexing as a continuing table and updated the table notes Replaced I/O lines by I/O pins Signal Description • Removed the column “Comment” from the table Power Supply • • • Removed “nominal” from power supplies Updated the description of vector regulator Added link to the “Schematic Checklist” Clock System Added the link in the description of Write-Synchronization Power Manager Updated the table Sleep Mode Overview: • The column “Clock Sources” has been updated with new commands • The table note 2 replaced by a reference to On-demand, Clock Requests ADC Updated the content in Interrupt Flag Status and Clear - INFLAG register: • Bit 2: INTFLAG.WINMON description updated • Bit 1: INTFLAG.OVERRUN description updated • Bit 0: INTFLAG.RESRDY description updated DAC • • • Register Summary: DATA and DATABUF register bit fields updated. DATA register: Bit fields and description updated. DATABUF register: Bit fields and description updated. 32. Electrical Characteristics at 85°CElectrical Chara Added Electrical Characteristicsat 85ºC Package Information Corrected the 64 pins QFN drawing 37.21 Rev. B – 07/2013 Block Diagram Added output from Analog Comparator block Signal Description Updated the content in Signal Description table Memories Added OSC32K Calibration (bit position 44:38) in the table NVM Software Calibration Area Mapping DSU Updated the content in Die Identification - DID register: • Bit 15:12: Added DIE[3:0] bit group • Bit 11:8: Added REVISION[3:0] bit group EVSYS Updated Features: Number of event generators updated from 59 to 58 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 722 SAM D20 Family Datasheet Revision History SERCOM SPI Updated Control A - CTRLA register: • Bit 16: CTRLA.DOPO updated to Bit17:16: CTRLA.DOPO[1:0] • Bit 17:16 - DOPO[1:0] description updated Updated Status - STATUSregister: • Bit 2 - STATUS.BUFOVF description updated ADC Added Accumulation section Updated Averaging section Updated Oversampling and Decimation section AC Heading updated from Basic Operation to Starting a Comparison. Updated the list of write-synchronized bits and registers in Synchronization section Register property updated to “Write-Synchronized” in registers: SYSCTRL • Control A - CTRLA and Comparator Control n - COMPCTRLn • • Removed VDDMON and ENABLE bits from registers. Updated start-up time tables for XOSC32K and OSC32K: – XOSC register: Table Start-UpTime for External Multipurpose Crystal Oscillator – XOSC32K register: Table Start-Up Time for 32kHz External Crystal Oscillator – OSC32K register: TableStart-Up Time for 32kHz Internal Oscillator Errata Rev. B Errata Revision B updates: • Device: Two errata added (10988 and 10537) • PM: Two errata added (10858 and 11012) • XOSC32K: One errata added (10933) • DFLL48M: Two errata added (10634, 10537), one errata updated (10669) • EVSYS: One errata added (10895) • SERCOM: Two errata added (10812 and 10563), one errata removed (10563) • ADC: One errata updated (10530) • Flash: One errata updated (10804) Errata Rev. A Status changed to “Not Sampled” 37.22 1. Rev. A - 06/2013 Initial revision © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 723 SAM D20 Family Conventions 38. Conventions 38.1 Numerical Notation Table 38-1. Numerical Notation 38.2 Symbol Description 165 Decimal number 0b0101 Binary number (example 0b0101 = 5 decimal) '0101' Binary numbers are given without prefix if unambiguous 0x3B24 Hexadecimal number X Represents an unknown or don't care value Z Represents a high-impedance (floating) state for either a signal or a bus Memory Size and Type Table 38-2. Memory Size and Bit Rate 38.3 Symbol Description KB (kbyte) kilobyte (210 = 1024) MB (Mbyte) megabyte (220 = 1024*1024) GB (Gbyte) gigabyte (230 = 1024*1024*1024) b bit (binary '0' or '1') B byte (8 bits) 1kbit/s 1,000 bit/s rate (not 1,024 bit/s) 1Mbit/s 1,000,000 bit/s rate 1Gbit/s 1,000,000,000 bit/s rate word 32 bit half-word 16 bit Frequency and Time Table 38-3. Frequency and Time Symbol Description kHz 1 kHz = 103 Hz = 1,000 Hz KHz 1 KHz = 1,024 Hz, 32 KHz = 32,768 Hz MHz 1 MHz = 106 Hz = 1,000,000 Hz GHz 1 GHz = 109 Hz = 1,000,000,000 Hz s second © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 724 SAM D20 Family Conventions ...........continued 38.4 Symbol Description ms millisecond µs microsecond ns nanosecond Registers and Bits Table 38-4. Register and Bit Mnemonics Symbol Description R/W Read/Write accessible register bit. The user can read from and write to this bit. R Read-only accessible register bit. The user can only read this bit. Writes will be ignored. W Write-only accessible register bit. The user can only write this bit. Reading this bit will return an undefined value. BIT Bit names are shown in uppercase. (Example ENABLE) FIELD[n:m] A set of bits from bit n down to m. (Example: PINA[3:0] = {PINA3, PINA2, PINA1, PINA0} Reserved Reserved bits are unused and reserved for future use. For compatibility with future devices, always write reserved bits to zero when the register is written. Reserved bits will always return zero when read. Reserved bit field values must not be written to a bit field. A reserved value won't be read from a read-only bit field. PERIPHERALi If several instances of a peripheral exist, the peripheral name is followed by a number to indicate the number of the instance in the range 0-n. PERIPHERAL0 denotes one specific instance. Reset Value of a register after a power Reset. This is also the value of registers in a peripheral after performing a software Reset of the peripheral, except for the Debug Control registers. SET/CLR Registers with SET/CLR suffix allows the user to clear and set bits in a register without doing a read-modify-write operation. These registers always come in pairs. Writing a ‘1’ to a bit in the CLR register will clear the corresponding bit in both registers, while writing a ‘1’ to a bit in the SET register will set the corresponding bit in both registers. Both registers will return the same value when read. If both registers are written simultaneously, the write to the CLR register will take precedence. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 725 SAM D20 Family Acronyms and Abbreviations 39. Acronyms and Abbreviations The below table contains acronyms and abbreviations used in this document. Table 39-1. Acronyms and Abbreviations Abbreviation Description AC Analog Comparator ADC Analog-to-Digital Converter ADDR Address AES Advanced Encryption Standard AHB Advanced High-performance Bus AMBA Advanced Microcontroller Bus Architecture APB AMBA Advanced Peripheral Bus AREF Analog Reference Voltage BOD Brown-out Detector CAL Calibration CC Compare/Capture CCL Configurable Custom Logic CLK Clock CRC Cyclic Redundancy Check CTRL Control DAC Digital-to-Analog Converter DAP Debug Access Port DFLL Digital Frequency Locked Loop DPLL Digital Phase Locked Loop DSU Device Service Unit EEPROM Electrically Erasable Programmable Read-Only Memory EIC External Interrupt Controller EVSYS Event System FDPLL Fractional Digital Phase Locked Loop, also DPLL GCLK Generic Clock Controller GND Ground GPIO General Purpose Input/Output I2C Inter-Integrated Circuit IF Interrupt Flag INT Interrupt MBIST Memory Built-In Self-Test MEM-AP Memory Access Port © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 726 SAM D20 Family Acronyms and Abbreviations ...........continued Abbreviation Description MTB Micro Trace Buffer NMI Non-maskable Interrupt NVIC Nested Vector Interrupt Controller NVM Nonvolatile Memory NVMCTRL Nonvolatile Memory Controller OSC Oscillator PAC Peripheral Access Controller PC Program Counter PER Period PM Power Manager POR Power-on Reset PORT I/O Pin Controller PTC Peripheral Touch Controller PWM Pulse-Width Modulation RAM Random-Access Memory REF Reference RTC Real-Time Counter RX Receiver/Receive SEEP SmartEEPROM Page SERCOM Serial Communication Interface SMBus System Management Bus SP Stack Pointer SPI Serial Peripheral Interface SRAM Static Random Access Memory SUPC Supply Controller SWD Serial Wire Debug TC Timer/Counter TRNG True Random Number Generator TX Transmitter/Transmit ULP Ultra Low-Power USART Universal Synchronous and Asynchronous Serial Receiver and Transmitter VDD Common voltage to be applied to VDDIO and VDDANA VDDIO Digital Supply Voltage VDDANA Analog Supply Voltage VREF Voltage Reference © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 727 SAM D20 Family Acronyms and Abbreviations ...........continued Abbreviation Description WDT Watchdog Timer XOSC Crystal Oscillator © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 728 SAM D20 Family The Microchip Web Site Microchip provides online support via our web site at www.microchip.com/. This web site is used as a means to make files and information easily available to customers. Accessible by using your favorite Internet browser, the web site contains the following information: • • • Product Support – Data sheets and errata, application notes and sample programs, design resources, user’s guides and hardware support documents, latest software releases and archived software General Technical Support – Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ), technical support requests, online discussion groups, Microchip consultant program member listing Business of Microchip – Product selector and ordering guides, latest Microchip press releases, listing of seminars and events, listings of Microchip sales offices, distributors and factory representatives Customer Change Notification Service Microchip’s customer notification service helps keep customers current on Microchip products. Subscribers will receive e-mail notification whenever there are changes, updates, revisions or errata related to a specified product family or development tool of interest. To register, access the Microchip web site at www.microchip.com/. Under “Support”, click on “Customer Change Notification” and follow the registration instructions. Customer Support Users of Microchip products can receive assistance through several channels: • • • • Distributor or Representative Local Sales Office Field Application Engineer (FAE) Technical Support Customers should contact their distributor, representative or Field Application Engineer (FAE) for support. Local sales offices are also available to help customers. A listing of sales offices and locations is included in the back of this document. Technical support is available through the web site at: www.microchip.com/support Microchip Devices Code Protection Feature Note the following details of the code protection feature on Microchip devices: • • • • • Microchip products meet the specification contained in their particular Microchip Data Sheet. Microchip believes that its family of products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the market today, when used in the intended manner and under normal conditions. There are dishonest and possibly illegal methods used to breach the code protection feature. All of these methods, to our knowledge, require using the Microchip products in a manner outside the operating specifications contained in Microchip’s Data Sheets. Most likely, the person doing so is engaged in theft of intellectual property. Microchip is willing to work with the customer who is concerned about the integrity of their code. Neither Microchip nor any other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of their code. Code protection does not mean that we are guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.” Code protection is constantly evolving. We at Microchip are committed to continuously improving the code protection features of our products. Attempts to break Microchip’s code protection feature may be a violation of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act. If such acts allow unauthorized access to your software or other copyrighted work, you may have a right to sue for relief under that Act. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 729 SAM D20 Family Legal Notice Information contained in this publication regarding device applications and the like is provided only for your convenience and may be superseded by updates. It is your responsibility to ensure that your application meets with your specifications. MICROCHIP MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WRITTEN OR ORAL, STATUTORY OR OTHERWISE, RELATED TO THE INFORMATION, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO ITS CONDITION, QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR PURPOSE. Microchip disclaims all liability arising from this information and its use. Use of Microchip devices in life support and/or safety applications is entirely at the buyer’s risk, and the buyer agrees to defend, indemnify and hold harmless Microchip from any and all damages, claims, suits, or expenses resulting from such use. No licenses are conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, under any Microchip intellectual property rights unless otherwise stated. Trademarks The Microchip name and logo, the Microchip logo, AnyRate, AVR, AVR logo, AVR Freaks, BeaconThings, BitCloud, CryptoMemory, CryptoRF, dsPIC, FlashFlex, flexPWR, Heldo, JukeBlox, KeeLoq, KeeLoq logo, Kleer, LANCheck, LINK MD, maXStylus, maXTouch, MediaLB, megaAVR, MOST, MOST logo, MPLAB, OptoLyzer, PIC, picoPower, PICSTART, PIC32 logo, Prochip Designer, QTouch, RightTouch, SAM-BA, SpyNIC, SST, SST Logo, SuperFlash, tinyAVR, UNI/O, and XMEGA are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other countries. ClockWorks, The Embedded Control Solutions Company, EtherSynch, Hyper Speed Control, HyperLight Load, IntelliMOS, mTouch, Precision Edge, and Quiet-Wire are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. Adjacent Key Suppression, AKS, Analog-for-the-Digital Age, Any Capacitor, AnyIn, AnyOut, BodyCom, chipKIT, chipKIT logo, CodeGuard, CryptoAuthentication, CryptoCompanion, CryptoController, dsPICDEM, dsPICDEM.net, Dynamic Average Matching, DAM, ECAN, EtherGREEN, In-Circuit Serial Programming, ICSP, Inter-Chip Connectivity, JitterBlocker, KleerNet, KleerNet logo, Mindi, MiWi, motorBench, MPASM, MPF, MPLAB Certified logo, MPLIB, MPLINK, MultiTRAK, NetDetach, Omniscient Code Generation, PICDEM, PICDEM.net, PICkit, PICtail, PureSilicon, QMatrix, RightTouch logo, REAL ICE, Ripple Blocker, SAM-ICE, Serial Quad I/O, SMART-I.S., SQI, SuperSwitcher, SuperSwitcher II, Total Endurance, TSHARC, USBCheck, VariSense, ViewSpan, WiperLock, Wireless DNA, and ZENA are trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other countries. SQTP is a service mark of Microchip Technology Incorporated in the U.S.A. Silicon Storage Technology is a registered trademark of Microchip Technology Inc. in other countries. GestIC is a registered trademark of Microchip Technology Germany II GmbH & Co. KG, a subsidiary of Microchip Technology Inc., in other countries. All other trademarks mentioned herein are property of their respective companies. © 2017, Microchip Technology Incorporated, Printed in the U.S.A., All Rights Reserved. ISBN: 978-1-6683-0059-6 Quality Management System Certified by DNV ISO/TS 16949 Microchip received ISO/TS-16949:2009 certification for its worldwide headquarters, design and wafer fabrication facilities in Chandler and Tempe, Arizona; Gresham, Oregon and design centers in California and India. The Company’s quality system processes and procedures are for its PIC® MCUs and dsPIC® DSCs, KEELOQ® code hopping devices, Serial EEPROMs, microperipherals, nonvolatile memory and analog products. In addition, Microchip’s quality system for the design and manufacture of development systems is ISO 9001:2000 certified. © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 730 Worldwide Sales and Service AMERICAS ASIA/PACIFIC ASIA/PACIFIC EUROPE Corporate Office 2355 West Chandler Blvd. Chandler, AZ 85224-6199 Tel: 480-792-7200 Fax: 480-792-7277 Technical Support: http://www.microchip.com/ support Web Address: www.microchip.com Atlanta Duluth, GA Tel: 678-957-9614 Fax: 678-957-1455 Austin, TX Tel: 512-257-3370 Boston Westborough, MA Tel: 774-760-0087 Fax: 774-760-0088 Chicago Itasca, IL Tel: 630-285-0071 Fax: 630-285-0075 Dallas Addison, TX Tel: 972-818-7423 Fax: 972-818-2924 Detroit Novi, MI Tel: 248-848-4000 Houston, TX Tel: 281-894-5983 Indianapolis Noblesville, IN Tel: 317-773-8323 Fax: 317-773-5453 Tel: 317-536-2380 Los Angeles Mission Viejo, CA Tel: 949-462-9523 Fax: 949-462-9608 Tel: 951-273-7800 Raleigh, NC Tel: 919-844-7510 New York, NY Tel: 631-435-6000 San Jose, CA Tel: 408-735-9110 Tel: 408-436-4270 Canada - Toronto Tel: 905-695-1980 Fax: 905-695-2078 Australia - Sydney Tel: 61-2-9868-6733 China - Beijing Tel: 86-10-8569-7000 China - Chengdu Tel: 86-28-8665-5511 China - Chongqing Tel: 86-23-8980-9588 China - Dongguan Tel: 86-769-8702-9880 China - Guangzhou Tel: 86-20-8755-8029 China - Hangzhou Tel: 86-571-8792-8115 China - Hong Kong SAR Tel: 852-2943-5100 China - Nanjing Tel: 86-25-8473-2460 China - Qingdao Tel: 86-532-8502-7355 China - Shanghai Tel: 86-21-3326-8000 China - Shenyang Tel: 86-24-2334-2829 China - Shenzhen Tel: 86-755-8864-2200 China - Suzhou Tel: 86-186-6233-1526 China - Wuhan Tel: 86-27-5980-5300 China - Xian Tel: 86-29-8833-7252 China - Xiamen Tel: 86-592-2388138 China - Zhuhai Tel: 86-756-3210040 India - Bangalore Tel: 91-80-3090-4444 India - New Delhi Tel: 91-11-4160-8631 India - Pune Tel: 91-20-4121-0141 Japan - Osaka Tel: 81-6-6152-7160 Japan - Tokyo Tel: 81-3-6880- 3770 Korea - Daegu Tel: 82-53-744-4301 Korea - Seoul Tel: 82-2-554-7200 Malaysia - Kuala Lumpur Tel: 60-3-7651-7906 Malaysia - Penang Tel: 60-4-227-8870 Philippines - Manila Tel: 63-2-634-9065 Singapore Tel: 65-6334-8870 Taiwan - Hsin Chu Tel: 886-3-577-8366 Taiwan - Kaohsiung Tel: 886-7-213-7830 Taiwan - Taipei Tel: 886-2-2508-8600 Thailand - Bangkok Tel: 66-2-694-1351 Vietnam - Ho Chi Minh Tel: 84-28-5448-2100 Austria - Wels Tel: 43-7242-2244-39 Fax: 43-7242-2244-393 Denmark - Copenhagen Tel: 45-4450-2828 Fax: 45-4485-2829 Finland - Espoo Tel: 358-9-4520-820 France - Paris Tel: 33-1-69-53-63-20 Fax: 33-1-69-30-90-79 Germany - Garching Tel: 49-8931-9700 Germany - Haan Tel: 49-2129-3766400 Germany - Heilbronn Tel: 49-7131-67-3636 Germany - Karlsruhe Tel: 49-721-625370 Germany - Munich Tel: 49-89-627-144-0 Fax: 49-89-627-144-44 Germany - Rosenheim Tel: 49-8031-354-560 Israel - Ra’anana Tel: 972-9-744-7705 Italy - Milan Tel: 39-0331-742611 Fax: 39-0331-466781 Italy - Padova Tel: 39-049-7625286 Netherlands - Drunen Tel: 31-416-690399 Fax: 31-416-690340 Norway - Trondheim Tel: 47-7289-7561 Poland - Warsaw Tel: 48-22-3325737 Romania - Bucharest Tel: 40-21-407-87-50 Spain - Madrid Tel: 34-91-708-08-90 Fax: 34-91-708-08-91 Sweden - Gothenberg Tel: 46-31-704-60-40 Sweden - Stockholm Tel: 46-8-5090-4654 UK - Wokingham Tel: 44-118-921-5800 Fax: 44-118-921-5820 © 2022 Microchip Technology Inc. and its subsidiaries Complete Datasheet DS60001504F-page 731
ATSAMD20J15A-ANT 价格&库存

很抱歉,暂时无法提供与“ATSAMD20J15A-ANT”相匹配的价格&库存,您可以联系我们找货

免费人工找货